Search results
Pages
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Interim Catalog, 1985
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
............. 2
Essential Information ................ 3
Options ........................... 3
Courses ........................ 5-24
Introduction & Calendar
A R T . . . BIO . . . BUS.. . C H M . . . ECO
. . . EDE . . . EDS . . . ENG . . . FRE . . .
GER.. . SPA.. . G S T . . . HPE . . . HIS...
Show more
............. 2
Essential Information ................ 3
Options ........................... 3
Courses ........................ 5-24
Introduction & Calendar
A R T . . . BIO . . . BUS.. . C H M . . . ECO
. . . EDE . . . EDS . . . ENG . . . FRE . . .
GER.. . SPA.. . G S T . . . HPE . . . HIS
. . . I N S . . . M A T . . . MUS . . . N U R . . .
P H Y . . . P O L . . . PSY.. . REL.. . SOC
. . . SWK . . . SPC . . . Lifetime Sports
1985
Interim Catalog
AUGSBURC
COLLEGE
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Augsburg College lnterim
The interim is an integral part of the school year at Augsburg College. It is particularly
intended to be a time for both students and faculty to employ styles of teaching and learning
and to investigate questions and topics in places and ways not possible during the regular
term. Since one course equals a full time load, students should plan to spend the same
amount of time in class and preparing for class as thcy would for a four course load during
Fall and Spring semesters.
january 1985
S M T W T F S
Calendar for Full Credit Courses
..................................................................................Interim Registration
............................................................................Late Interim Registration
.......................................................................................... First Day of Interim
November 5-9
December 10
January 3
Class 1 9:00 a.m.
Class 11 1:00 p.m.
Last day for cancel/add
Last day for determining grading system with Registrar
Last day for withdrawing from full courses
Interim ends
...................................................................................
..............................
...................................................
....................................................................................................
fanuary 4
January 17
January 21
January 30
Calendar for Half Credit Courses
.....................
.
.............................. First group of half credit courses begins
January 3
January4
January 9
January 11
January 16
Ianr~ary17
January 1R
...............................,..................... last rlay to cancel/add half crcdit courses
........................ b a t day d~tetmininggrad in^, systcm lor half credit courses
....................
.
.........-.. Last day for withrlrawing from half cretlit roursm
....................................................... First group of half crcdit courses encis
.................................................. Second group of half credit courses bcgins
..................................,............. Last clay to cancel/add half credit cour~es
janunry 23 ................ Last day for determining grading system for hatf credit courses
January 25 ...................................... Last day for witlrdrawing from half crcdit courses
Iant~ary30 ....................
........ .
.
.
.........*....................................... lnfcrim ends
The interim day is divided into two blocks of time:
I - 8:00 - 12:OO Noon 11 - 1:00 - 5:00 p.m.
The number and length of class meetings as well as the beginning time will be arranged
the first day of class.
POSTMASTER
Volume 115, Number 4
Winter 1984
612/300-1001
AUGSBURG COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) is published four times a year in Spring, Summer,
Fall, and Winter by Augsburg College, 731 21st Avenue South, Minneapolis, M N 55454.
Second-class postage paid at Minneapolis, Minnesota.
Essential Information
One course is considered a full time load during interim and no student is permitted to
register for more than one course credit during the period.
There is no tuition refund for a student who chooses not to enroll in an interim course.
Most interim courses are graded traditionally on a scale of 4.0 to 0. Students generally have
the option to register on a Pass/No credit basis. A few interim courses are graded only on
the P/N system; this is indicated in the course description.
Some courses are offered with either upper or lower division standing. Such interim courses
have two numbers listed and the student must select. Students registering for upper division
standing should anticipate additional assignments and a more rigorous grading standard.
To graduate, an Augsburg student is required to complete 35 courses of which at least
three must be interim courses (or one interim less than the number of years of full time
enrollment at Augsburg; e.g., a transfer enrolled full time for two years is required to
complete one interim for graduation.)
This Catalog
This catalog lists courses by departments with departments listed in alphabetical order. At
the end of the book are listings of other courses not offered by Augsburg but recognized
by the College for interim credit. Further descriptions and information about these courses
are available in the lnterim office, Memorial 230. Students may also register for one of the
Lifetime Sports listed on the last page.
Location Key
L-Library Building
M-Music Hall
OM-Old Main
P-Psychology Building
S-Science Hall
Options
lnternational Interims-Students are invited to consider being part of one of the three
overseas interims offered by Augsburg College during January 1985. These interims are
under the following departments:
Health-Sailing in the Virgin Islands
German-The Rhine Frontier
Religion-The Confrontation of Cultures and Religions i n Hawaii
Augsburg students are also eligible for participation in one of the 24 international interims
offered by the Upper Midwest Association for lnternational Education (UMAIE) as well as
travel interims offered by other 4-1 -4 schools in the country.
Further academic description, travel details and cost estimates are available in the lnterim
Office and from Mary Kingsley in the lnternational Center, Old Main 20.
Students interested in participating in one of these international interims should apply in
the lnternational Center before November 1. Additions to the overseas groups usually
cannot be made after that date.
There will be no June interim in 1985.
Internships - Students electing an internship must present a completed internship learning
contract to the Internship Office (Memorial 230) no later than Tuesday, November 20.
Contract forms are available in the same office.
Independen! or Directed Study - Students may elect a projirnrn of independent study
(upper rlivision 4 W )o x d i r r r t ~ rstudy
l
(lower division 299) fnr inlerim. I:acitlIy n~embers
or
arp strongly discouraged from accepting responsibillty (or mnre than onp indf*p~ndent
direct~dstudy per int~rim.Sludents choosing to pursue independent or directed study
must:
A. Meet departmental requirements,
B, Present to the lnterini Direclor for approval a copy of the proposed study plan approved
by he supervising fac~~lty
memher. This proposal must be submitted at least one week
and nnt later ihan December 4. Appropriate study proposal forms
before re~isiralior~
can be obtained in the lnterim Office.
Interims at Other Schmtg - Airgburg students may enroll at any other 4-1-4 Institution
whiclt offers a reciprocal interim arrangement. Catalogs of these interims can bc rnrrsulted
in thr Interim O f f ~ c The
.
Interlm Secretary wlll hell) stutients in applyinfi for registration
at other schools. Registralinn (or inrerims at !he other Twin Cities c o l l ~ ~ e
will
s b r donr at
Augsl~urgduring the regi~tarregistration period. Most courses tnughl rii~rlng!he ~nlrrim.I!
otlirr 4-1-4 srlronls arc accepl~rltor credil by Augsburg, I>ut may not necessarily be acparticlrlarly afcepted as meeting At~gsburg'sdislrihutioti rcquirernents. This q~~allftcation
(ects courses offered Inr the R~ligionreqi~iremenl.
Non-Augsburg Students
Augsbr~rgCc~llcgvwdcornes stutlenls From other 4-1-4 schods for the january interim
witho~rthairinn charges provided lhp slurtent's home institl~tionap,rees not to charge tu~tinn
to Augsburp, slurlcnts for the January lcrrn. The waiver nf cuition dow nnl include sppcial
fees, Iloi15ingor board cosls. Olller sti~dentswlll be charged $775 far the Interim course.
Students interester1 In regiswring for an Augsburg lnterim should write to the Interim Director for application forms or use t h forms
~
provided by the interim rlffice af their own
schoot. Therc is an application processing fee of $10. Thew sturl~ntrare welcomr! to stay
on campus but are no[ required to tlo so. Requests for Interim housing should be made
to the lnterim Office.
Augsburg Policy
It is the policy of hugsburgCollege not to discriminate on the basis of race, creed, national
or ethnic origin, age, marital status, sex or handicap as required by Title IX of the 1972
Educational Amentlments or Section 504 of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973, as amended,
in its admissions policies, educational programs, activities and employment practices.
Need More Help?
Check with:
The lnterim Office (Memorial 230).
The lnterim Secretary, Ruth Maertens at 330-1025, or
The Interim Director, Dr. Don Gustafson at 330-1192.
Courses
Art Interim '85: Washington
D.C. and New York
ART 1 14-4501, 245-4502
Instructor: Philip Thompson
This course will provide students with the opportunity to visit major museums of art in
Washington D.C. and New York (including the National Gallery of Art, National Portrait
Gallery, Hirshhorn Museum and Sculpture Garden, Freer Gallery of Oriental Art, Guggenheim Museum, Whitney Museum of American Art and others). There will also be visits in
New York to the studios of emerging artists.
Participants will be traveling from January 7 through 18. Days preceding the trip will be
spent in preparatory lectures and visits to Twin Cities museums. The days after the trip
will focus on comparative lectures and provide individuals with an opportunity to complete
personal projects or assignments.
Students may opt to take this course as a drawing course, as an art history course or as a
directed or independent study for either lower or upper division credit.
The tour price will be approximately $995 and will include transportation, housing, most
meals and tours.
Distribution: Art-Music
Time: I............ Room: O M 17
The Biology of Aging
B I O 185-4504
Instructor: Robert Herforth
At some time or another in our lives most of us will either directly experience aging or be
influenced by people undergoing age-related changes. This course will concentrate on the
biological aspects of such changes. What is the nature of these age-related changes?What
factors influence the rate of aging? Do cells isolated from the body show aging? Is aging
the result of deterioration of certain cells or tissues of the body? What are the current
theories as to the biological basis of aging? Is aging controlled by a biological clock?These
and other questions will be addressed in this course by means of classroom lectures and
discussions of assigned readings. Evaluation will be based on several quizzes and exams
given during the course.
The
idl log^ of
~~ricul'ture
B I O 234-4505
Instructor: Roberta Lammers
We will be taking a critical look at agriculture from the perspective of biology. What is the
relationship of hunger and starvation to agricultural practices - is agriculture producing
too little food for the world's population? What kinds of environmental effects have resulted
from attempts to increase production in the U.S. and in the third world? What is the nature
of hunger and malnutrition? What effect will biotechnology (genetic engineering, cloning,
etc.) have on agriculture and agricultural production?
Class periods will be a combination of lecture and discussion. Evaluation will be based on
one test, class participation and a log of readings.
Time: I .............. Room: S 31 9
Immunology
BIO 386-4506
Instructor: Neal Thorpe
A study of the immune system, emphasizingantibody structure and function, cell-mediated
immunity, the development of the immune system, immunopathology, molecular recognition at cell surfaces as related to immune phenomena, and cancer biology and immunology. lmmunological and serological techniques will be considered and demonstrated.
Lectures and discussions with grades based on examinations.
Prerequisites: BIO 111, 112
Time: II
Room: S 205
.............
Augsburg Goes to Business
BUS 321 -4507
Instructor: Thomas Morgan
This course is designed to provide students with exposure to a wide range of business
functions through on-site visits to a variety of organizations in the Twin Cities, both large
and small, private and public. The experiences will be oriented toward integrating what
students have been exposed to in the classroom with practical issues which they will
encounter on the job. Students will visit an average of three different situations each week
and meet one day each week for discussion and lecture material.
Evaluations will be based upon participation and a formal business plan which students
prepare and present.
Prerequisites: Permission of instructor
Time: I ............ Room: O M 11
r
Chemistr for Changing Times
CHM 100 - 4 08
Instructor: Arlin Gyberg
This is a non-laboratorychemistry course based on the very popular book by John H. Hill
of the same title. It is not a traditional chemistry course and does not assume a science
background. Basic science and math are introduced early and are taught as needed for
understanding the various topics and implications. The course does assume the student is
interested in and concerned about the relationship of chemistry to life and living.
Chemistry has been intlmately a part of liberal education for centuries. The early scientlsts
were coilsidered to be philosophers and their societies were phitosaphical societies. In
recent decades [he human seeking of p e ~ a n a independence
l
lias led lo chemistry becornlng a pntt of everyday life to Ihe point nf aclual depenrlence on chemislry, We live
in a world of pe~ticidps,fertilizers, plastics, "the pill," foot! additives ant1 pracessed lootl5,
vitamin supplements. the energy crisis, chemical deper~dcncy,biocides, pollutants, drugs,
searching lor life an other planets, genetic ~nanipt~lation,
and it goes on and on. Ernottons
and mental disorders can often be tracctl to chemical imbalan~e.The common dragged
out, grumpy feeling after an allernoon nap is a resul! of a chemical imbalance. The nature
of a liangover is the result of a complex system ol' altered body chemistry. Even learn~ng
appears to be the result of chemical reaction to form a "memory mo!~cule."Most of t h ~
problems we face are molecular in nature. What then but chemistry can better help us to
~~nderstand
ourselves, our society, our world, and our tinlverse? Come join us as we take
a rnolrcular look at the human condition. This course will be offered in a lecture/discussiun
format. Films will supplement the lecture/discussion periods. Quizzes and tests will be
used for evaluation. This course does not satisfy prerequisites for Chemistry 106, 116 or
223.
Distribution: Chemistry-Biology
Time: I.............. Room: S 315
Understanding International Trade and Finance
ECO 360-4509
Instructor: Ed Sabella
This will be a study of the underlying forces affecting the economic relations among nations.
We will consider the development and bases of international trade, the balance of payments, the mechanics of adjustment and general commercial policies. Grading will be on
the basis of examinations and possible other written assignments.
Prerequisites: ECO 122 and 123 or permission of instructor
Time: II..............Room: M 22
Elements of Mathematical Economics
ECO 353-4510
Instructor: Satya Gupta
In Business and Economics, development of analytical skills is imperative. This course will
be designed to help attain this goal.
Economics will be explained using mathematics as a tool. Examples from Finance, Management, and Marketing will also be solved.
Evaluation will be through tests and assignments.
Prerequisites: ECO 123
Time: II........... Room: O M 23
Teacher Education with New Boundaries
EDE-413-4519, EDS 41 3-4520
Instructor: Lauretta Pelton
This course will give the student the opportunity to expand his/her knowledge about
teacher education and the schools in a chosen geographic area beyond Minnesota. The
student is encouraged to do the greater share of research at the chosen location. This will
include a specified number of days/hours to be spent in a school. This research will also
help the student identify courses s/he can take to fulfill requirements of that locale, and
to better prepare for that setting should s/he choose to live there. The student will research:
1. the professional and licensure requirements of the chosen state or country, its job
market, salary scale and level of living.
2. the expectations in the school curriculum as identified by local and extended educational governing powers.
3. various education concerns such as teacher unions, cultural make-up of the schools
along with related implications, testing-grading-promoting, etc.
Should a student prefer to remain in Minnesota for a specialized study related to curriculum
or school systems, that student will select an area of the elementary curriculum for intensive
study as it is developed and implemented at all grade levels in a specific school district.
The student will acquaint him/herself with: 1) the school's curriculum guide and resources
for that subject area and 2) appropriate resources found outside that school system.
As a result of this research the student will develop and complete one or more education
projects which will be used in future teaching. All activities related to the project will be
submitted in completed form.
Because much of the course will follow the format of an independent study, each student
will contact the instructor prior to December 15, to make known in writing the location
of choice, specific objectives, strategies and evaluative procedures for him/her to fullfill
the requirements of the course.
Prerequisites: ED 255 or permission of instructor
Time: I .................. Room: L 6
m
Student Teaching
EDS 481 - 451 1
EDS482-4512
EDS 483 - 4513
EDS 484 - 4514
EDE 481 - 451 5
EDE482-4516
EDE 483 - 451 7
EDE 484 - 4518
Instructor: Sheldon Fardig
Observing and directing learning under supervision of college and secondary school personnel. This is a full day experience in a school.
Prerequisities: Acceptance in Education Program and permission of instructor.
Grading P/N only
Time: I .................. Room: L 4
The Short Story
ENG 240-4521, 340-4522
Instructor: Richard Sargent
We will read a variety of short stories for pleasure and understanding. The selected stories
will include the major genres, such as the science fiction of Ray Bradbury and Arthur C.
Clarke, the detective fiction of Arthur Conan Doyle, the humor of Mark Twain, and the
experimental fiction of John Barth and Jorge Luis Borges. Women such as Doris Lessing
and Joyce Carol Oates and blacks such as Richard Wright and James Baldwin will be among
the authors studied, as will writers from a variety of nationalities.
Although the course will not involve a systemafic analysis of the llistory of the form of the
short story, a sufficient number of classics will be assigned for the student to appreciate
the historical development from Poe to Paley. The course will involve practice in ways of
approaching litenlure ant1 will Include study of the l)as~ccr~tical(erminology, so it would
be an appropriate coursc for st~ldentswho have no1 yet studied literature at the college
level.
Students are expected to read the stories, participate in class discussions, write a paper on
a topic selected with the advice of the teacher, and take several tests and a final essay
exam. Effective Writing is not a prerequisite but students will be expected to write with
clarity.
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication and Theater Arts
Time: I ............... Room: M 23
Creative Writing Workshop: The Prose Poem
ENG 362-4523
Instructor: John Mitchell
Three students from each of the five colleges of the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities
will be chasen, on the basis of portfolios submitted to their respective English departmrnts,
for pattiripation In this w ~ r k ~ h oThe
p . conlent of the course will emphasize the participants'
own crearrve work during the Inrerim, including d~scussionant1 critictsm. In additton, there
will besome study nf the tradition of thc prose poem internationally, Altllough thc emphnsiq
will FII upon the prose poem, students may use Ihe form as an originaling basis for poems
and short stories. Thus wrilers of both prose and poptry are invited to participatr. Grstllng
will be basetl upon cornpletlon and revision nf poems during the course, with some conslclemtion given to class participation. Students are encouraged l o take the coirrse for
P/N credit.
Interested Augsburg students should contact John Mitchell of the English Department and
submit selected examples of their writing to him by 11/I184.
Prerequisites: Permission of the instructor
Time: II........... Room: O M 13
Beginning French I
FRE 11 1-4524
Instructor: Ruth Askov
This course will provide an ;tnrroduc!ion tn the French language and culture. We will
practice situational Frrnch to develop lisfening anrl speaking skills, rernforced by some
reading and writing o l the languaae. Tlip pmnunt:iattonsystem and basic sentvnc~structures
at a rudini~ntnrylevel.
are taught to enallle ~~ndcrslanrl~ng
and sr3l.l-~xpr~s~ion
Evaluation will be through group cultural study and individual projects on a cultural topic.
There w ~ l be
l oral and written quizzes and daily 30-minute laboratory assignments.
Distribution: Foreign Language
Time: II........... Room: O M 25
January 3-27, 1985
The Rhine Frontier:
Germany Meets Rome and France
GER 333-4525
w d D zkh
Instructor: Donald Steinmetz
J-LveQ. LO"-&Since Roman times, the fandsalongil~eRhine have been one of the most significant frontier
areas of Europe. Here German ant1 Roman ct~lturt~s
clashed and mixed. Here modern
Germany and France have their r m l s i r ~tlir rrnplre of Charlemagne. Here romanesque
and gothic architecture I l n u r i s l ~ ~ind the Middle Ages. tlcre Germans and French fought
in three recent wars. It i 5 s~ichpvenls w l ~ i c llij i t v ~<11;1p~rl
!
l~fe
and left so many monuments
between the Rhine and the Meuse. The student will study and "relive" the h~storyof this
area on location, from the Roman monuments of Trier and Cologne, Charlemagne's Aachen,
to the battlefields of World Wars I and II and the dynamic society of present-day Germany.
The course will be conducted primarily in Trier, Germany, with excursions to nearby sites.
Tr~eris ideal for this purpose. Perhaps the oldest city in Germany, Trier is rich in monuments
dating from Roman times to the present, and Important historical sites of five countries are
less than 100 miles away. Lectures, discussions, and readings will be principally in German
according to the student's entering level of competence.
P/N only. Grading will be based on oral exams and diary to be kept in German.
Prerequisities: German 112 or equivalent
Cost: $1690
Distribution: Foreign Language
-
Beginning Spanish II
SPA 112-4526
Instructor: Gunta Rozentals
This course is intended for students who have completed Spanish 111 or its equivalent. It
is an intensive study of the basic grammar structures beyond the present and the past
tenses to enable the student to use the four basic language skills at a level that is acceptable
for the fulfillment of the language requirement. The objectives are achieved through classroom practice, homework, and language laboratory exercises. Grading is based on tests,
exams, homework and classroom participation involving oral skills.
Prerequisites: Spanish 111 or equivalent
Distribution: Foreign Language
Time: I ............ Room: O M 25
a
? How to Ace a Term Paper by Really Trying
GST 165-4527
Instructor: Myles Stenshoel
edit
s
Participants will engagein rewrite and gkwntea paper/on which they originally received
s are
s
. .
grades of C or less. The goal/is (1) to improve the paper/to the 7
level
an ~lif-ithadL,,,I
and (2) to develop, in the process, competency
excellent
in writing/gaad papers.
Students will work with
I
such issues as bibliographical adequacy, documentation,
L U uC c
and
originality, organization, clarity, literary quality,/validity of logic and conclusions. Technical
trivia, such as typography, spelling and punctuation, will be part of the regimen.
G
The course will require joint activity as well as individual work. The grades will be based
degree of
(of?)
on the/improvement m / t h e paper and on the development of writing and editing skills.
Prerequisities: By permission of instructor after a sufficiently bad term paper has been
submitted to him
Time: I............ Room: O M 22
Recreational Rhythms and Activities
HPE 232 - 4528
Instructor: Bethany Shifflett
Theory and practice in teaching and performing American heritage and international folk
dances. Exposure to New Games concepts and activities. The majority of the course grade
is based upon participation in class activities, a teaching assignment, and a written test.
This is a 1/2 credit course.
Time: I - Jan 3-16 ................. Room: Melby
Administration and Supervision
.of the School Health Program
HPE 410 - 4529
Instructor: Richard Borstad
Historical background, legal bases, school health services, and relationships to community
health program and resources. Methods and materials in health education with laboratory
experience in classroom and community.
Periodic exams covering lecture and textbook assignments; written summaries of professional journal articles; in-class activites, including a presentation on a teaching method.
Prerequisites: HPE 320
Time: I
Room: Melby 13
.........................
+
January 5-24, 1985
Sailing in the Virgin Islands
HPE 455-4530
Designed for the beginning and intermediate sailor interested in the art and practice of
sailboat cruising. The course will focus on taking the participant to a competent level of
sailboat handling (anchoring, mooring, helming and crewing). The student will live aboard
a 42' fixed keel sailboat with six or seven other people and will function as an active crew
member.
Actual on-the-water instruction will be the major part of the course. This will be supplemented by sessions dealing with safety, boat handling, boat systems, provisioning, trip
planning, piloting and navigation. Sailing will include cruises to various islands and cays in
the British and American Virgin Islands.
Snorkeling and windsurfing will be available on an optional basis.
Evaluation will be based on individual demonstrated competencies in crewing and leadership in the role of "acting captain." A daily ships log will be kept by all participants and
a final written exam will be given.
Cost: $21 00
Distribution: Lifetime Sports
Coaching of Basketball
HPE 477-4531
Instructor: David Boots
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching basketball. Exams, on-the-floor
coaching techniques, and a scouting report will be the methods of evaluation.
This is a 112 credit course.
Time: I - January 17-30 ................ Room: Melby
Officiating of Basketball
HPE 481 -4532
Instructor: Al Kloppen
This course wlll focus on learning the rules and mechanics of the game of basketball. There
will b~ practjcal experience on thc floor. Students completing the course should be ready
for certification by lie Minnesola High Schoul Association. Grade evaluation will be based
upon tesfs,papers prepared and performance on Ihe Iloor. Whilr l l ~ e r are
e no prerequisites,
it is highly advisable that students have some basketl,all playing experience.
This is a 1/2 credit course.
Time: II, January 3-16 ,.................. Room: Melby
Paris in the Nineteenth Century
HIS 114 - 4536
Instructor: Orloue Gisselquist
The French are sometimes accused of thinking of Paris as the "navel of the universe."
There's a bit of "sour grapes" caricature in that clever statement. For if one could pick
out ;I cily w t ~ i c hin the Ii~s!thousanrl years has heen mnre important to Western Civilization
than any other, olie could make a gord case ior Paris. In this course we will study fhe
history of !flat city In a n p periorl n( i t s grcatne55, [he ni~ieleenthcentury. We will usc?some
rearlinsi.; almul France, Park, ant! Modern itrl.ianism, lnrt n main ~mpllasisin our reading
ant1 approach to the sulrriect wlll ke thr usp nf some nineteen1h centirry IYrrnr:hnovcls as
lils1orir:;11snurres k ~ lhp
r str~dvof Paris. We will tlius have Ilie opporlunify to study the
city of Paris in this century in some fullness, read some great literature, and develop our
talents in the use of historical material. As a bonus we will double (maybe quadruple!) our
enjoyment of a future trip to Paris. The course will be conducted in part as a lecture course
and in part as a seminar (discussion of readings, short papers, and shared reports- all part
of the evaluation). There will be a final exam.
Distribution: History-Philosophy; Urban Concerns
Time: II................Room: P 3
20th Century South Asia
HIS 162-4537
Instructor: Don Gustafson
This geographic area has produced the largest working democracy in the world today; from
this people have come one of our century's greatest "saints" and also one of the most
renowned statesmen; it is a standard example for population crisis and world hunger illustrations. South Asia is all this- and much more.
This course is designed for the student who has interest but little or no background in nonwestern subjects-though others are also welcome. The heart of the course will be in a
wide assortment of readings (some of them really excellent) but there will also be lectures,
time for discussion and frequent breaks for slide presentations.
Grades will be based on general level of participation, on some written work and probably
a test.
Distribution: History-Philosophy
Time: I ................Room: O M 16
Eastward to America: Limited Hospitality
HIS 220-4534, 320-4535
Instructor: Khin Khin Jensen
An investigation of !he rationalc for the in~migrationpattern, economic opportunities, and
social, pnli tical and ~ c a r ~ o r nprot)lems
ir
~ncounlcredby h e following ilnrni~rants.Cliinesc,
Japanrse ancl Koreans in the Unitc~rlStates. Focus on thew Ihrre ~ t h n i groups
r
will Involve
boil^ the "old" immigrants and the "new" ~~lnnii~mnts.
Course w ~ lutilize
l
ethnir. sprakt~rs
(Cllin~se,Iapanes~anrl Koreans) In a home env~ronmenl-rlrf~~tr~iorr
format. Tticre wilt
he pthnic medls, r!thnic rooking d~rno~~stratinns,
films, slides and f ~ ~trips-all
l d
these arp
important components of the course as IS the academ~ccomponent of read~ngs,etc.
Focus is on the experiences of these ethnic groups in Hawaii, California and Minnesota.
Upper division students will do a paper and a journal, lower division will do a journal.
There will be an exam on the text and readings.
Fees: $1 5 for meals and films etc.
Prerequisites: Lower Division, None
Upper Division, sophomore standing and consent of instructor
Distribution: History and Philosophy
Time: I ................Room: L 1
Introduction to Oral History
HIS 481-4538
Instructor: Rrchard Nelson
This course will investigate the methods and approaches involved in writing history from
oral sources. Students will read and discuss material on the natwe of on1 hrstory during
.the first week af the course. The remainder of the twm wIII be reserved for ldentlfication
of and research on a topic which wlll include the techniquesof oral history. A paper based
on this m a r c h wlll be due an the lad day of the lerrn.
Prerequisrtes: Permrssron of the rnstructor
Trme: II................Room: O M 10
The Philosophy of Healing
INS 141-4547, 341 -4548
J
.+
522
Instructor: Pam Weiss-Farnan and Mark Fuehrer
Since a human being is a besouled body, wholeness must involve bath the mind and the
body. Further, since the mlnd Is the prlnclpal directed !orce In human Mngs, wholeness
Is directed by rhtt mind. Dlseese in a person can therefore be approached as a phenomenon
that requires rhe respo,nse hat just of the whole v a n but under the dlrectfan of the
mind, the human being can strive to cooperate with natum In the process of healing either
diseases of the mind or the body. Westem and Eastern philasophles ask (he question,
"How can one heal~oneself?'' and have evolved some startling a n w e k about prwpectlve,
attitude, and knowledge of disease. In western healing, we now ask how our technaloglcal
apptoach can be merged with personal healing. Shew concepts fall into a pattern, that
when analyzed, reveals a power ode has over one's health.
I0 this coutw there dl be readings and lectures coverin8 philmopHcal views of beallng,
western and nonwestern approsches to disease and healin and an opportunity to team
about a d Investipte further variovr heating praflfcasand t&enpirs such as acupuncture,
biofedbqck , homeopathy, massage and so on.
Course grades wrll be determrned largely from a paper Upper drvrsron students wrll be
expected to produce a longer and more sophrstrcated paper than those tak~ngthe course
for lower drvisron credlt.
Time: II................Room: O M 16
Brush Up
MAT 103-4539
Instructor: Bev Durkee
This dome & deifgnedai a bruslr ry, lh arithmetic and elementaryal a h skills for students
scoring lon the Mathemattcs Placementexamination. ~ h ci,u&
&
vdbe pmkuia'dh WI
forrmdme m elementarycdvatlon or who will be tahng it.Hniaa p n d r m a w
of the work will be dofie err the computer, There w#l be d1agnosj.I~tesb to detwmine
study mh homework assignment5 to gain skills, and written problem wl\rfr(gtests to
deteMlhe achievement. Grades wltl be d~temiinedby test scores. Coufie of Budy Fs
completely rndividuallzed.
Prerequ~sites:Mathematics Placement Examination score I.
Time: I ................Room: S 112
Mathematical Modeling
M A T 132-4069
Instructor: Paul Hulse
This course will focus on the development of mathematical models to describe and study
selected problems in the "real world." The course will emphasize the use of analytical
methods of mathematics to study these problems.
Prerequisites: Basic algebra and geometry
Distribution: Mathematics-Physics
Time: I ................Room: S 2 13
An Exposure of Chaos in Modern Cosmic Models
M A T 136-4540, 336-4541
-
Instructor: Henrv Follinastad
An exploralion of malh-related ideas and Space-Age research which critically re-evaluates
present "scientific dagmas" un the universe and the smaller cosmic models of earth, life,
and mnnkinrl. New Spacp-Age data, much of it ignored or misinterpreted, is uncovered to
show inadequacies and contradictions in cosmology, relativity, macroevolution, and their
links to geology, biology, and the humanities. Space-Age alternatives are also presented
to integrate the flood of news media with past knowledge.
Class instruction and individual research will include study of the historical and modern
impact of math-related cosmic models, and will note some misuses of mathematics which
have elevated some "scientific speculation" into "scientific fact." A written research paper
is required in one of six major areas discussed.
Upper division students will show broader research scope and writing ability and will
present extensive oral summaries of their papers.
Distribution: Mathematics-Physics
Time: I ................Room: O M 23
FORTRAN
M A T 270-4567
Instructor: Leo Lake
A study of the FORTRAN programming language to expand the student's knowledge of
languages. This course is especially vital to computer students who will work with the
scientific community where FORTRAN is a well entrenched language. The course will
involve daily lectures, extensive programming on the PDP 11 and a programming project
on which grading will be based.
Prerequisites: One course with a study of a computer language (e.g. MAT 145, 170, or 175
or BUS 250)
Time: II................Room: S 112
Special Functions and Their Applications
in the Physical Scien~ces
M A T 327-4542
Instructor: Mark Engebretson
(See description under Physics)
Introduction to Music Therapy:
A Clinical Overview
MUS 1 10-4543
Instructor: Roberta Metzler
Visitafton of clinfcal facilities in the Metrnpolltan area to &serve nruslc therapy in pracflce.
Obieciives o l the couKe will be to become familiar with a variety of clientele (including
mentally retarried, emolinnalty disturbed, and ph!tsicalfy handicapped), and to ut)serve
how music therapy functions with rlitterenl popula~ions.In adclitiun to lie (ield trips,
classroom discussions will include an nvervlcw of music therapy practices and Iheory in
Ihis coirntry ant! abroad. Evaluation will be based on tests, field trip reports, and clas5
participation. h sper~alfee of $1 5.00 will be reqir~rcd,to cover h e cost rrl Transportation.
A speclal class project will be required for upper division credtl. Sti~dentllmes must be
flexible, lo allow Inr Creld trlps during rither the morn in^ or alfcrnoon.
Fee: $15.00
Distribution: Art - Music
Time: I1................Room: M 24
Improvisation in Music
MUS 129-4544, 329-4545
Instructor: Stephen Gabrielsen
The objective of this course is to learn to improvise in a variety of styles.
Procedure: Assignments will be given using differing improvisational techniques. Students
will perform for each other in class.
Upper division students will be expected to produce additional improvisations.
Prerequisites: Minimal ability on a musical instrument or instructor's permission
Distribution: Art-Music
Time: I ................Room: M 4
Trends and Issues in Nursing
NUR 330-4546
Instructor: Alice Stark
This course is intended to give students a broad perspective by introducing current trends
and issues in health care anti Ihe profession of nursing. Many of the Issues are controversial,
are relevant to current practice and have po!en!ial lor br-rraching eCfecIs in health care.
Students will be graded on group pr~sentalion~
and written exam~nations.
Prerequisites: Registered Nurse
Time: I ................Room: O M 12
el
Introduction to Weather
PHY 106-4568
Instructor: Noel Petit
A study of the science of meteorology which will provide a working knowledge of the
principles of atmospheric science. Attention will be given to four basic areas: observing
the weather (including state of the art instrumentation), understanding weather patterns,
forecasting weather changes and understanding the world's climate. Related topics to be
included are: hydrology (study of the earth's water cycle), pollution, economic effects of
the weather, and weather's impact on world events. This course is designed to be an
elective or satisfy the Mathematics-Physics distribution requirement for the liberal arts
student. The course will include daily lectures, assignments (one or two laboratory sessions
per week), two one-hour examinations and a research project.
Prerequisites: High school algebra
Distribution: Mathematics-Physics
Room: S 31 5
Time: II................
1985 Oak Ridge Associated Universities
Science ~ i n i m e s t e r
PHY 322-4549
Instructor: Kermit E. Paulson
A study of nuclear radiation with emphasis on applications and "hands-on" laboratory
experience for the individual student. The course will consist of (1) introductory work on
radiation detection and measurement at Augsburg, (2) participation in the 1985 Oak Ridge
Associated Universities Science Minimester where the student has the opportunity to study
projects in nuclear radiation physics, radiobiology, radiochemistry, environmental radiation,
coal technology, health physics, and radiological safety; and (3) summary and evaluation
of the program back at Augsburg.
This course is a cooperative venture with Oak Ridge Associated Universities-Professional
Training program. Two weeks of the course will be spent in Oak Ridge, Tennessee utilizing
the instructional staff and laboratory facilities of ORAU. These facilities provide an opportunity for laboratory experience not normally available to undergraduate students.
Fees: The cost for travel and housing will be approximately $300.
Prerequisites: Consent of instructor.
Time: I ................Room: S 24
Special Functions and their Applications
in the Physical Sciences
PHY 327-4550
MAT 327-4542
Instructor: Mark Engebretson
Certain mathematical functions find use throughout the physical sciences and engineering
disciplines because of the high degree of symmetry they can represent. This course will
acquaint the student with three categories of functions and their applications: Legendre
polynomials and spherical harmonics, Fourier series and transforms, and functions of a
complex variable. High resolution graphics using the Tektronix 4051 Graphic Computer
will be used to enhance understanding of the symmetries involved.
Student performance will be evaluated on the basis of several problem sets and project.
Prerequisite: Physics 122 or consent of instructor; Mathematics 224 or equivalent
Time: I ................Room: O M 21
The United Nations
POL 166-4551, 366-4552
Instructor: Manjula Shyam
The course will involve detailed study of:
a) strudurp, purpose and fundions of the ~ n l ~ eNations,
d
b) geographical, historical, culhtrat, pr~liticalancl economic backgvound of the member
states of the Sectlrily Council,
C) s~lectedcurrent topics h e f n r ~the Un~tedNations.
d) procerlural rutes of the Security Cotlncil.
The course will lead to a six to eight hnur sirnulatlon of a meeting a l the Security Cotlncit,
Evaluation of students in the cnurse will be based on three slinrt papers and on performance
in I ~ Psimulation. Participation in !he simulation is ct~lnpulsory.
Upper rflvisiun studrnts will be requireri to sul,mil an adtlliional paper anatyzlng the political
processes o l r h Security
~
Council.
Prerequtsites: Onp pollrlcat sclcnce course for upper division credil
Distribution: Economics-Political Sc~ence
Time: II................Room: M 23
Self-identity and Values
PSY 110-4553
Inslructot: Norman Ferguson
The objecfive o l this course will be to examine the concept of "sclf" nr "selCidentity"
(Wha am I? What do Itlrlnk and feel about myseltl). Thth rrlalinnship betwwn sell-irlent~ty
and personal values will also be explored. Though the course will li,~vemainly a psychological locus, r e l ~ r ~ n will
c e be m;ltl~lo splriiual ;mi ~~I~Ilosophirat
lssue~Illat relate to thc
conc~ptsof selktdentity anrl values. The cuntent of tlir course will rover topics surh as:
the acquisition and drv~lnplnpntrrl srtCirlen~r~y
and values, rncluding fhe i n f l u ~ nof
~ rsex
roles; ihc clarificaiinn of values; ttw growth anti rliitngr uf self-irlrnl~tyand vatues during
aclul~hood:arbd !he relationship be'tween sel(+itlent~ty
and spirilual grriwth,
Class lime will be devoter[ mainly to the discussion of these issues In small groups. A n i v ~
participation tly each sturl~nlt s ~xpecretlalong with the sharlng of relevani intlivitlual
experiences. Evaluation will be based on class partfcipalior?,one or Iwo short papers, and
possibly one exam. This cuurw may not sut>stitute for PSY 105 lor stilrl~ntspursuing a
rnnrar or minor in (~sy~lrology.
Gr~rlingP/N only.
Prerequisites: Permission of instructor
Distribution: Psychology-Sociology
Time: I ................Room: P 1
Christianity in Modern Africa
REL 366-4554
Instructor: Bradley Hot!
This course wltl focus on two regions of Africa: the West and the 5011th. Stude~lfswill be
introduced to IrazlitionalAfrtcan cullure ant1 religion, the introduction of Christianity, and
!he present dev~lopmentof indigenous cl~urchesin West Africa. The newer "Independent
African Chr~rches"will be studied, as well as attempts to forrnulat~"African Christian
Theology." A major sectlon of the cnurse will locus nn conZernpurary responws nichurclies
in Soutl~Africa to the apartheid system of racial segregatlnn. There will he lectures and
discus5ion of reading materials, films, and visiting resource persons. Students will be evaluated On several short IPS15 ant1 a short research paper.
Prerequisites: One course in religion.
Distribution: Religion (Only one Interim course may be used toward graduation religion
requirements)
Time: II ................Room: O M 18
i
W
January 2-26, 1985
The Confrontation of Cultures
and Religions in Hawaii
REL 321 -4555
Instructor: John Benson
A studv of Rudrlllism, I'rrrlestanl Christianity, Mormoni~ln,and I'olynesian rellgion wilh
t o 1lietr ~nl~rrvlaticbn
in Hawall. Speci~lartt*nllnn glveii t r ~the following:
r p ~ c l aatlenlinn
l
IIIP n i e e t i n ~nf New F n ~ l ~ ~Cillvinlrm
ntl
and tlllwaii,ln trild~tionalculf~rrcand r e l ~ ~ nnrl
~on
i t s results today: the rnPcllnK ofCl~rislianityand bull1 Chlncsc and J,~pdnese
Rutirllilsm ;n
I-lawsti today; ,!t~rl I l l ? rlpl)rtl;lcIi nf ~I~PCIIILIICII n l ] l i s i t Clir~st
~
oiLaltcr Day S,aints (Mr~r~nons)
to 1 I i ~
P t ~ l \ v ~ e s i i lEllorts
l~.
will also tw made tn 51udy aliperls nf Ch~nescanrl Iqiarlcse
cultures and relif!lons In the~rown r i ~ h t .
Evaluation will be based on class participation and the submission of a journal.
Grading: P/N only
Prerequisites:one religion course (Only one interim course may be used toward graduation
religion requirements)
Cost: $1 745
Distribution: Religion
The Lutheran Heritage
REL 345-4556
Instructor: Eugene Skibbe
The Lutheran Church 1s the largest Protestant church in the world. We will examine the
Lutheran Church as it is today, ils origins tn the lhfh cPnrury, anti Its development and
cultural influence during 450 year5 01 hislory. The texl by Brrg~ndoffwill provide an
overview. Lecture and class disc~lssiol~
will den1 with examples of Lulheran wifnrss In the
Gospel In art, music, missions, phl!nsol~f~y,
s o c ~ o l o ~and
y Ilicnbgy. Retluirrrnents will
include two exams and one short paper.
Prerequisites: One course in religion
Distribution: Religion (Only one interim course may be used toward graduation religion
requirements)
Time: I ................Room: M 24
Ethnicity and Community in Urban Society
SOC 261 -4560
Instructor: Gordon Nelson
It has been suggested that the persistence of ethnic neighborhoods in American cities has
functioned as a locus of community in urban life. Moreover, it is argued that these communities have provided stability and identity in the face of the dehumanizing tendencies
in an industrialized and bureaucraticized society. This course will attempt to assess the
extent to which the foregoing assertions might apply to ethnic neighborhoods in the Twin
Cities. After some preliminary background sessions and readings, each member of the class
will be asked, either individually or as part of a group, to explore a particular ethnic
community in the Twin Cities and report back to the class. This class presentation and a
final examination will be the basis of evaluation for the course.
Prerequisites: None
Distribution: Urban Concerns
Time: I ................Room: M 22
Exploring the Human Services
SWK 257-4557
Instructor: Mary Lou Willlams
Thirty hours per week nt vorunteer work in a human service agency is comblned w i ~ h
readings and weekly seminars. An opportunity to discovcr whetllcr e career in human
services is for you. Evaluation will bp bawd on submission of jnurrlals, rurnrnary of experience ant1 a [inal examination. Siudcnls will br asketl ln merl with Inslructar before
the enri of Fall semester to iliscuss selection of agency and structure uf the course.
Objec!tves:
1. To develop special awareness of the kinds of problems for which people seek help.
2. To increas~knowledge of ll>eservic~sgiven by tlie agency in which student is serving,
3. To gain knowtcdge of the prnf~ssionalsin the organ~zation,including thew skills, competencies, et!ur:at~on, and [raining.
4. To gain l~cginningknowledg~abr~utthe diversity of human services agencicls.
5. To increase r~nrl~fitanding
nf sell in relatlnn to [he human service tleld.
Time: I ................Room: P 3
Field Work Ill
SWK 466-4558 (1 course), 466-4559
(l/2
course)
Instructor. Maria Brown
The objectives a l the class are to use sup~rvisoryrelationship lo increase interprrtive a5
wetl as social work ~wrfnrrnancecornpctence; (n ptomotr gradual entry into direcl soclal
work practice; to increase competence in !lip client contaci p h a ~ eof the problem solving
process; 10 increase s~utlcntsell-awareness in regart1 In profc$%ional
praclice Interests, areas
of strength, and areas for personal/professiunal rlevelopmcnt: 10 promote competence tn
the full process of problem solving, with spet:ial emphasr~c ~ nanalysis anrl r~solurionstage5.
Course content will be conttnuation of Field Work I!-educationally fociised iield placement in a social service agullcy.
Students will spend t 5 (ar 30) hours per week in field placement, plus one hour per week
in faculty facilitated supportive seminar held on campus.
Evaluations will be made in writing by Field Instructor using previously developed contract
and social work evaluation form.
Note: Course is offered for 1/2 (15 hours per week) or full (30 hours per week) credit. If
for full credit, 1/2 credit will be based on non-client contact tasks.
Prerequisites: Minimum of 2.0 in Field Work I and in Field Work 11; candidacy status
Time: Arrange with instructor
Imagination and Humor in Communication
SPC 165-4561, 365-4562
Instructor: Ray Anderson
Imagination, creative rhinktng, and humor are importan! dimensions of communication
thc lunctinns of
competence. The major purposes of h i s course are to lwttpr t~t~drrsfand
imaaination, the creative process, and the nature of Irurnor: to improve crealive thinking;
and lo ~ncreasr:the ahrliry to procli~cee[fecl~vehumor.
Thew will be lectures and readfngs on these topics, a study of niod~ls,and a variety of
assignments, in writing and speaking. T h ~ r ewill be a ntrrnber of experimental project5
Involving humor; IIIP ernount o l atlel-ttiongiven in this fapic wit1 rlepenrl in part upon tlw
interests of the class.
Evaluation will be based on essay examinations and on the creative projects. For upper
division students, one or more additional papers will be required.
Prerequisites: Beginning Speech, Freshman English
Time: II................Room: L 1
Story Theater (Children's Theater)
SPC 285-4563
Instructor: Ailene Cole
This class will improvise, produce, and perform a children's play. Whatever is neededscript, costumes, props, lights, scenery, music, dance-will be created and executed by
the class. Performances are scheduled for the final week.
Time: 9:30-12:OO and 1:00-3:00 p.m. ................Stage 2
Other Courses
These courses are offered by Institutions or gmups not canneaed with Augsburg College
but have been a p p r o v ~ dfor credit by the College. Most carry a tuition cost plus other
expenses which are the rt?sponsihrlityofthe stud~nt.They are offered only on a P/N basis.
Fuller descriptions and details fnr registering are available in the Interim Office.
ART 163-4564 Basic Spinning, Weaving and Dyeing
Offered by the Weavers Guild of Minnesota. Tuition and materials cost
$1 74.
POL 398-4565 Washington Interim: After the Inauguration: Continuity or Change?
POL 398-4566 Washington Interim: The Legal System and Legal Careers
Washington lnterim provides a combined program of lectures, site visits,
and seminar situations focusing on a particular area or topic in Washington,
D.C. Information on either of the above programs, housing and financial
assistance is available from Dr. Milda Hedblom in Memorial 117A.
Augsburg Lifetime Sports
The following activities are available to students during interim. They do not carry
official credit, but they do meet the lifetime sports requirement for graduation. Students
may participate in any one of these without registering for the course, but will be
expected to pay any fees whether or not the student registers for the course.
Weightlifting
HPE 002-4571
Instructor: Paul Grauer
Distribution: Lifetime Sports
Time: 9:20 ................Melby
Running
HPE 002-4572
Instructor: Paul Grauer
Distribution: Lifetime Sports
Time: 12:OO noon ................Melby
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Golden Valley Lutheran College Catalog, 1984-1985
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
v
~I
I
i
j
l
Golden Valley
Lutheran
Colleg__
e_,__
Catalog
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN
COLLEGE CATALOG
Published Annually by
Golden Valley Lutheran College
6125 Olson Highway
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55422
Phone (612) 542-1216
Accreditation
Golden Valley Lutheran College is accredited by...
Show more
v
~I
I
i
j
l
Golden Valley
Lutheran
Colleg__
e_,__
Catalog
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN
COLLEGE CATALOG
Published Annually by
Golden Valley Lutheran College
6125 Olson Highway
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55422
Phone (612) 542-1216
Accreditation
Golden Valley Lutheran College is accredited by the North Central
Association of Colleges and Secondary Schools.
Directions for Correspondence
General College Policy ...... Bernt C. Opsal, President of the College
Academic Information ........ J. Philip Worthington, Academic Dean
Admissions .............. Thomas R. Hanson, Director of Admissions
Business and Financial Affairs .... Vivian Wiemerslage, Business Office
Development ......... Russell B. Helgeson, Director of Development
Financial Aid .............. Brenda Johnson, Director of Financial Aid
Records and Transcripts ................. Marilyn J. Adams, Registrar
Student Affairs .................... Harold Moore, Dean of Students
Golden Valley Lutheran College in compliance with State and Federal laws and
regulations, does not discriminate on the basis of race, color, national origin, sex,
age, marital status, handicap, or status as a veteran in the administration of its
admissions policies, scholarship and loan programs, educational programs, activities
and employment policies. Inquiries regarding compliance and grievance procedures
may be directed to the college office manager, Vivian Wiemerslage.
This catalog supersedes The Golden Valley Lutheran College 1983-84 Catalog.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
TABLE
FC
College Calendar
6
President's Greeting
3
NTENTS
7
General Information
9
History, The Campus and Its Location, Philosophy and Objectives,
Accreditation and Transfer of Credit, Affiliations, General Guidelines.
Student Life
13
New Student Pre-Registration, Counseling Services, Health Services,
Library, Insurance, Housing Services, Student Government and Social
Life, Religious Life, Chapel, Student Use of Automobiles, Alcohol and
Drug Abuse, Athletics, Music, Drama, Honor Society, Alumni Association.
Admissions Information
19
Application Procedure, Transfer Students, Adult Students, International Students.
Costs
21
Student Costs, Charges by Quarter, Payment Plan, Refund Schedule,
Books and Supplies.
Financial Aid
25
Gift Aid, Loans, Work Opportunities, Procedure for Applying for
Financial Aid, Scholarships.
Academic Program
31
General Academic Information, Orientation and Registration.
Graduation Requirements
37
Liberal Arts and Transfer Program, Specialized Program, Junior College
Certificate, One-Year Vocational Certificate.
Programs of Study
41
Course Descriptions
57
Divisions: Biblical and Theological Studies; Communications; Social
Science; Mathematics, Natural Sciences, and Computer Science; Physical
Education and Recreation Leadership; Creative Arts; Business and
Vocational Studies.
Directory
80
Board of Regents, Administration, Faculty, Student Services Personnel.
Index
86
6
COLLEGE CALENDAR
CALENDAR 1984-85
Fall Quarter
September 3-7
September 8
September 9
September 10
September 10
September 12
September 21
September 28
October 5
October 8-12
October 13
November 5-8
November 16-21
November 21
Student orientation and registration for all
students
President's Reception - 6:00 p.m. - Gymnasium
All college worship
Classes begin
Opening convocation - 9:50 a.m.
Final day for payment of fall quarter fees
without late fee
Final day to add a class or change a class section
Final day to withdraw from a course with a grade of W
Final day to submit work for incomplete courses
Midquarter examinations
Homecoming
Registration for winter quarter
Final examinations
Quarter ends after completion of final examinations
Winter Quarter
December 3
December 5
December
December
December
December
14
16
21
21
January 7
January 11
January 14-18
January 22-24
February 4-7
February 25-28
February 28
Classes begin
Final day for payment of winter quarter fees without
late fee
Final day to add a class or change a class section
Festival of the Christ Child
Final day to withdraw from a course with a grade of W
Christmas vacation begins after the traditional observance at 11:30 a.m.
Classes resume
Final day to submit work for incomplete courses
Midquarter examinations
Days of Prayer and Praise
Registration for spring quarter
Final examinations
Quarter ends after completion of final examinations
Spring Quarter
March 11
March 13
March 22
March 29
April 4
April 5-7
April 8
April 8-12
April 23-25
May 3
May 7
May 20-23
May 24
Classes begin
Final day for payment of spring quarter fees
without late fee
Final day to add a class or change a class section
Final day to withdraw from a course with a grade of W
Final day to submit work for incomplete courses
Easter vacation
Classes resume
Midquarter examinations
Pre-registration for fall quarter
Spring banquet
Honors Day
Final examinations
Commencement
Calendar Subject to Change
PRESIDENT'S GREETING
7
President's
Greeting
Experiences during the first year after high school play a major role in
one's development of a philosophy of life. This consequently determines
how one lives his or her life.
Golden Valley Lutheran College was established with the main
purpose of providing an opportunity for the student to develop a
philosophy of life founded on Christian convictions.
We strive to provide this foundation for life by emphasizing a
personalized education which includes the opportunity for the study of
both liberal arts and the Scriptures. This is a curriculum we believe will
best help the student understand the world in which he or she will be
living and working.
We ask that those who come have an open mind, a grateful heart and a
desire to learn. Preparation for "making a living" is not sufficient for the
Christian today. Golden Valley Lutheran College is also designed to
provide an education which will serve as preparation for "making a life."
Bernt C. Opsal, President
GENERAL IN FORMATION
9
GENERAL INFORMATION
History
Golden Valley Lutheran college is a two-year coeducational liberal arts
college established in 1967 by The Lutheran Bible Institute of Minneapolis. Beginning as a Bible institute in 1919, The Lutheran Bible Institute
moved from St. Paul to Minneapolis in 1929. In 1961 it moved to Golden
Valley, a suburb four miles west of downtown Minneapolis. Through the
years this educational institution has addressed itself to the needs of
people and has sought to meet those needs by establishing programs
appropriate to the times. The College is inter-Lutheran and is not directly
affiliated with any particular Lutheran synod. It cooperates with and
seeks to serve all synods and society as a whole. The College admits qualified
men and women from various geographic, cultural, economic, racial, and
religious backgrounds.
The Campus and Its location
Golden Valley Lutheran College is located on a beautiful 30-acre
campus in Golden Valley, a western suburb of Minneapolis. The greater
Twin City area is a cultural, recreational, and sports center of the Upper
Midwest.
The academic life of the students is centered in a large two-level
complex. Classrooms, library, faculty and administrative offices, a prayer
chapel, the College auditorium-gymnasium, cafeteria and lounges are
located in this building.
Four residence halls on campus, Alpha, Beta, Gamma, and Delta
dormitories, house approximately 400 students. The facilities include
fireplace lounges, laundry facilities, rooms for prayer and meditation,
and apartments for residence hall directors. Adjacent to Gamma dormitory
is the Commons, a student lounge and recreation area. A student center
is located in Delta dormitory.
10
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Philosophy and Objectives
Golden Valley Lutheran College is a liberal arts institution w1tn
programs of study in general education, Biblical literature, music,
physical development, and semi-professional training. It seeks to provide
two years of higher education for students interested in the arts and
sciences, and also to give opportunity for a study of the sources of the
Christian faith. Through special activities the College provides the basis
for personal growth and cultural enrichment. Students are encouraged
to participate in community and church activities.
In order to reach these goals, Golden Valley Lutheran College offers
students a choice of one of the following curricula:
1. Completion of a two-year liberal arts education that functions
according to the standards common to the academic enterprise
and that prepares the student to transfer to a four-year college or
university.
2. Completion of a two-year program that provides the basis for semiprofessional employment in the fields of church staff work,
mission, secretarial work, sodal service, recreational leadership,
law enforcement and a cooperative computer training program.
3. Study of the Bible and liberal arts in a collegiate setting for
individuals who do not intend to pursue a degree or a semiprofessional program.
Golden Valley Lutheran College strives to supplement these curricular
programs by emphasizing the following objectives with opportunities ...
to develop knowledge of the Judea-Christian world view as set
forth in the literature of the Old and New Testaments and an
analysis on the part of each student concerning his or her basic
beliefs and spiritual commitments.
to develop service motivated standards of conduct for young
adults as they move into the many areas of national life, including
social improvement, community involvement and active membership in Christian congregations.
to appreciate the great works of art, music and the theatre th rough
courses and cultural events which take place on the campus and in
the metropolitan area.
to attain physical well-being through the application of standards
conducive to good health and through participation in physical
education and sports activities.
to develop personal self-confidence through the determination
of individual goals, the building of relationships with other people
and the experience of companionship in a Christian setting.
GENERAL IN FORMATION
11
Accreditation and Transfer of Credit
Golden Valley Lutheran College received regional accreditation
through the North Central Association of Colleges and Schools in
July of 1978. Thus, entering students can be confident that if they
make a creditable record at Golden Valley Lutheran College, their
credits will normally transfer to other colleges and universities. Students
who are planning to continue their education at a college with limited
transfer of religion credits may register for the religion courses which are
listed in the liberal arts departments. Through the proper selection, most
religion courses are transferable. A student with a satisfactory academic
record can normally complete a bachelor's degree two full academic
years after receiving the Associate in Arts degree from Golden Valley
Lutheran College.
Affiliations
North Central Association of Colleges and Schools
Registered with the Minnesota Higher Education Coordinating Board
Lutheran Educational Conference of North America
National Association of Independent Colleges and Universities
American Association of Community and Junior Colleges
Minnesota Association of Community and Junior Colleges
National Junior College Athletic Association - Region XIII
Minnesota Community College Conference
General Guidelines
Golden Valley Lutheran College is oriented to the Christian Gospel
and expects its students to live accordingly. Each student is expected to
be familiar with the regulations and standards pertaining to student
conduct as described in the Student Life Handbook.
The College reserves the right not to accept an applicant or to
withdraw the privilege of a student to return after any quarter and to
discipline those who conduct themselves in a manner which is not in the
best interest of the individual, other students, or the College.
STUDENT LIFE
13
STUDENT LIFE
Campus life at Golden Valley Lutheran College provides activities and
experiences which help develop the whole person. The programs of the
College provide wholesome recreation designed to stimulate spiritual
and intellectual growth. Students are involved in the planning of social
activities which can enrich college life and foster friendships.
New Student Pre ... Registration
Prior to the start of the fall quarter, new students are invited to the
campus to participate in pre-registration activities. During this time the
student will have an opportunity to learn more about the College and
meet staff and faculty personnel who will assist in course planning for the
coming year.
Selected sophomores are available to help the new students become
familiar with and adjust to college life.
Counseling Services
The major decisions which students have to make during their early
college years are often difficult and perplexing. Counseling provides a
service which helps students learn ways of solving their academic,
vocational, social, emotional and spiritual problems.
Each student is assigned to a faculty advisor who will assist him or her in
planning an appropriate schedule of classes for each academic term. In
addition to individual counseling, several counseling groups, concerned
with matters such as personal growth, chemical dependency and other
problems, meet regularly. Each student also may make appointments to
visit with instructors, residence hall directors, the deans, the College
nurse or others on the staff who can give assistance.
Study skills assistance is provided for students who need to improve
their reading rate, reading comprehension, spelling, mathematics skills,
study skills, or writing skills.
Health Services
The College has a full-ti me registered nurse on the staff to provide basic
medical services. Stu'dents requiring additional treatment are usually
referred to the Golden Valley Clinic which is located less than a mile from
the campus. Major Twin City hospitals also are readily accessible.
14
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Library
The library, located on the ground floor of the Main building, provides
a variety of materials and services to support the college curricula. There
are over 30,000 volumes, 247 periodicals, local and national newspapers,
and a substantial vertical file in the collection. Through the Minnesota
Interlibrary Telecommunications Exchange (MINITEX) the student has
access to a vast network of more than ten million volumes in a five state
area. In addition, there is a sizeable audiovisual collection including
phonograph records and casssettes, as well as filmstrips with necessary
listening and viewing equipment available to the students.
Insurance
The College does not assume any responsibility for the loss of or
damage to personal property. Many families have homeowners policies
that will cover losses of family members at college.
Housing Services
Golden Valley Lutheran College is primarily a residential college. If
space is available, full-time students live in the College residence halls.
Exceptions are those who are married, commute from their homes, or who
work for their board and room. Students living on campus participate in
the cafeteria program which provides three meals a day, seven days a
week. The price fixed for the weekly 21 meal plan is set with the
knowledge that a certain percentage of the meals will be missed during a
week. Students who are commuting may purchase individual meals in
the College cafeteria.
Student Government and Social Life
A forum for student expression and student-initiated improvements in
campus life is provided by a Student Senate chosen from the student
body. This representative group serves as a coordinator of studentfaculty relations. It seeks continually to improve and make student life
more enjoyable.
The social program of the College is under the supervision of the
Student Activities Commission (SAC). Homecoming, Sno-Daze and the
Spring Banquet are examples of the many social activities available.
Disciplinary problems are arbitrated by the student Judiciary Board.
STUDENT LIFE
15
Religious life
As an institution of Christian higher education, Golden Valley Lutheran
College believes that religious life activities are an integral part of its
program. Therefore the College provides regularly scheduled chapel
services, campus worship services, transportation to local church services,
all-campus devotions, dormitory devotions and Christian student organizations. Special programs include the Days of Prayer & Praise and the
Christmas Festival of the Christ Child. Religious activities are coordinated
by the faculty Chapel & Special Events Committee and by a student Faith &
Life Commission.
Many students also participate in Christian Service activities in the
community and in world mission activities. The College has a Fellowship
of Christian Athletes chapter in which many students take an active part.
There also is an opportunity to serve on outreach teams which travel to
present the Gospel in word and song.
Chapel
All classes are dismissed each morning for a 25-minute chapel
program. These programs are varied in content. Some are in the nature of
worship services conducted by students, faculty, or guest speakers, while
others include films, lectures, drama, music or other special convocation
programs.
The chapel service is the heart and center of our collegiate program. It
is here that messages are shared from the Scriptures, and opportunity is
given for worship, intellectual stimulation and the development of a
sense of community.
Each student is encouraged to participate in the chapel services of the
college community and to attend public worship every Sunday.
Student Use of Automobiles
Parking space is limited on campus. Those students who do not need
an automobile for commuting or transportation to or from work are
urged not to bring a vehicle to college. Those who do need an
automobile or motorcycle must secure a parking permit through the
business office. The Dean of Students has the right to terminate a permit
at any time if circumstances warrant such action. The College assumes no
responsibility for damage, theft, or vandalism involving student vehicles.
16
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Alcohol and Drug Abuse
Goiden Vaiiey Lutheran Coiiege strongiy discourages aii students from
using alcohol and/or mood altering drugs. Students possessing, using, or
under the influence of alcohol or drugs on campus, in college-approved
housing, or at college-sponsored events both on and off campus will be
subject to disciplinary action. In instances where college officials are
informed that Golden Valley Lutheran College students have caused a
disturbance off campus in connection with the use of alcohol or drugs
the College reserves the right to take disciplinary action.
Golden Valley Lutheran College upholds all federal and state statutes
pertaining to the illegal use of alcohol or drugs. A student who uses,
possesses, or persuades someone else to use alcohol or drugs in violation
of the law will be subject to disciplinary action. The College's action will
be determined by the circumstances surrounding each individual case.
The College provides counseling services and support groups for those
with chemical dependency problems.
Athletics
Through the physical education and athletic programs the College
seeks to teach the value of good health and physical fitness, to cultivate
interest in the proper use of leisure time, to develop character and good
sportsmanship and to give instruction in various sports and games used in
recreational activities. Intercollegiate athletic competition for men is
available in football, baseball, basketball, soccer, track, marathon, and
cross country. Women may participate in intercollegiate basketball, cross
country, softball, volleyball, marathon and track competition. The College
is a member of the Minnesota Community College Conference, and the
National Junior College Athletic Association.
Intramural programs are available for both men and women. These
include activities such as volleyball, basketball, broomball and softball.
Music
Golden Valley Lutheran College is sensitive to the cultural and spiritual
values that music contributes to our society. It desires, therefore, to
cultivate and nurture student interest and participation in music by
giving opportunity for self-expression as a member of a performing
group. These groups include the Golden Valley Lutheran College Choir,
a selected group of 65 voices; the Madrigal Singers, a smaller ensemble
which specializes in certain types of music literature; the Golden Valley
Singers, a women's chorus; a pep band and concert band; the Golden
Valley Orchestra, a community and college organization; and various
vocal and instrumental ensembles. In addition to specific courses in the
field of music, the College offers private voice and instrumental
instruction.
STUDENT LIFE
17
The location of the College in the Twin City area provides opportunity
for students to gain a new appreciation of the fine arts. Community
concerts, the Minnesota Orchestra, the Minneapolis Civic Orchestra, the
St. Paul Chamber Orchestra, and programs given by other colleges
including the University of Minnesota, offer continuing opportunities
for cultural enrichment.
Drama
The drama program at Golden Valley Lutheran College is two-fold in its
purpose. It attempts to expose the student to the inner workings of the
College theatre, and it seeks to foster a sense of appreciation for
drama by encouraging active participation in the field.
Phi Theta Kappa Honor Society
A chapter of Phi Theta Kappa, a national honor society for two-year
colleges, was established in 1981 at Golden Valley Lutheran College. The
purpose of the honor society is to recognize and encourage scholarship.
Alumni Association
The Golden Valley Lutheran College Alumni Association works with
former students to maintain an on-going relationship with the College
and with each other. It seeks to develop a well-informed and supportive
group of alumni through social events and programs planned each year.
All former students are considered alumni of the College.
ADMISSIONS INFORMATION
A MISSI
19
NS I F RMATI
Golden Valley Lutheran College seeks students who are interested in a
quality education with a Christian orientation. All applicants for admission
must have earned a high school diploma or its equivalent. In addition,
each applicant must furnish required references, satisfactory test scores,
and complete a personal interview with an admissions counselor.
Perhaps the best way to determine if Golden Valley Lutheran College
can meet your needs is to visit our campus. Accordingly, we invite you
and your parents to the campus so that you can become acquainted with
our faculty, students, and administration. For an appointment please
write or call the Office of Admissions.
The admissions office is located in the main classroom building and is
open Monday through Friday from 8:15 a.m. to 4:30 p.m., Saturdays from
9:00 a.m. to 1 :00 p.m. and at other times by appointment.
Application Procedure
Application materials are available from the Office of Admissions.
Applicants are advised to follow these steps in applying:
1. Complete and return the Application for Admission together with
the non-refundable $10 application fee to: Office of Admissions,
Golden Valley Lutheran College, 6125 Olson Highway, Minneapolis,
Minnesota 55422.
2.
Request your high school and all colleges you have attended to
forward your academic transcript(s) to the Office of Admissions.
3.
Submit test results from the American College Test (ACT), the
Preliminary Scholastic Aptitude Test (PSAT), or the Scholastic
Aptitude Test (SAT).
4.
Applications are considered in the order they are received. The
student is generally notified of the admissions decision within two
weeks of the time the application file is complete. Although there
is no absolute deadline for applying, high school students are
advised to apply for admission as early in their senior year as
possible. This is particularly true for those who desire financial aid.
5.
A student who is offered admission must notify the Office of
Admissions if he or she accepts the offer. A $100.00 tuition deposit
is required within three weeks after notification of acceptance has
been made. The deposit is refundable until May 1st. The date the
College receives this deposit determines the order in which a
student will register for the fall quarter. This tuition deposit is
applied to the first quarter tuition when the student enrolls.
6.
Priority for dormitory room assignment is given on the basis of the
date the tuition deposit is received. A student contracts for a room
for the entire school year, beginning with fall term.
20
7.
8.
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
After the student has accepted the offer of admission, the College
will provide the medical history form to be completed and
returned.
Room assignments and matriculation information will be mailed
during the summer.
Transfer Students
College work completed at other accredited institutions may be
applied toward a degree at Golden Valley Lutheran College. Transfer
students are required to follow regular admission procedures and submit
an official transcript of their record from each college attended. Credit
for college work will be accepted toward an Associate in Arts Degree
providing the work is satisfactory in quality and is applicable toward the
divisional requirements of the College. Transfer credit will not be
granted for courses in which a grade below C- was received.
Adult Students
An admissions counselor provides guidance for adult students
-who are deciding to attend college for the first time or
-who are now planning to return after their college education has
been interrupted.
Counseling is available for adult students concerning entrance requirements, transfer of credits, financial aid and course planning. For
those who apply and are eligible, scholarship funds are available. Both
full-time and part-time students may apply.
International Students
All international students seeking admission to Golden Valley Lutheran
College must submit an International Student Application for Admission,
a declaration of finances and appropriate school transcripts. International
students are strongly encouraged to submit results of writing the Test of
English as a Foreign Language (TOEFL).
COSTS
21
C STS
Student Costs
1984~85
The following explains the basic costs to the student and the financial aids that are available to assist the student in meeting these costs.
The College reserves the right to change the costs of tuition, board, room
or fees at any time.
The charges that are made to students for tuition, room and board do
not adequately cover the costs of operating the College. Approximately
35% of the cost of operation must come from gifts and grants. In the
present budget, this amounts to over one million dollars a year.
Therefore, over and above all help given, each student receives the
equivalent of a $2,000 scholarship per year in order to cover the total
expenses of the operation.
The College does not receive direct financial support from any
denomination or Lutheran synod. Gift income is received from congregations, organizations and foundations, and by matching funds from
Lutheran Brotherhood and other corporations.
Most of the funds, however, come as individual gifts from alumni,
parents and friends of the College. Over 600 people are supporting the
College through the INASMUCH program whereby they have pledged
and/or paid from $1,000 to $25,000 over a three year period. As we make
our needs known, the Lord answers our prayers through the gifts of these
many friends.
SUMMARY OF EXPENSES
Resident
Tuition
Board, Room, and Telephone
Total
$5,265.00
$2,414.00
$7,679.00
22
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Charges By Quarter
The College operates on a quarter system with three quarters per
academic year. A student who registers for 12 credits or more is
considered a full-time student; one who registers for less than 12 credits
is considered a part-time student.
Tuition for full-time student ............................. . $1,755.00
Tuition per credit for part-time student .................. .
147.00
Board, room, and telephone (average) ................... .
805.00
Laboratory fees per course .............................. .
12.00
Physical education fees per course
Varsity courses ....................................... .
10.00
Fee for swimming, karate, bowling,
golf, and tennis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.00-26.00
Fee for all other P. E. activity courses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5.00
Humanities 200 fee per credit
For GVLC students currently enrolled .................. .
15.00
For students not currently enrolled at GLVC ............ .
30.00
Music fees
Private voice and instrument lessons ................... .
75.00
Voice and piano classes per student. ................... .
37.50
Organ rental ......................................... .
14.00
Practice room fee .................................... .
10.00
Late registration fee .................................... .
20.00
This fee is charged if a student fails to register during the
registration period for any quarter. It is waived only in cases
of illness or family emergencies.
Late payment fee ....................................... .
15.00
This fee is charged to a student who does not pay the
balance on his or her account within two days after classes
begin for the quarter.
Special fees not refundable after 10th day of classes include:
laboratory, personal orientation, physical education, organ
rental, practice room, and music fees for voice and
instrument lessons.
Miscellaneous fees
Car registration and parking permit per quarter ......... .
5.00
Damage deposit ...................................... .
25.00
Special examinations .................................. .
5.00
Transcript fee (first two copies free) .................... .
2.00
Advance tuition deposit for second year students ......... .
100.00
Fall Registration is based upon the order in which the
above payment is received. (Non-refundable).
COSTS
23
P~yment Plan
The account of each student is payable at the time of registration and in
accordance with the Full Payment Plan listed in this section.
Students in need of credit must make arrangements with the Business
Office before registration can be completed. When credit is extended, a
finance charge of one and one half percent a month (18% APR) is added.
No student is permitted to register if the account for a preceding
quarter has not been paid in full. Grades cannot be released, transcripts
cannot be forwarded, and degrees cannot be granted until all financial
obligations have been met.
Payment Schedule for 1984-85
On Campus
Fall Quarter
$ 750.00
June 19
750.00
July 17
750.00
August 17
357.00
Registration Day
$2,607.00
Winter Quarter On Campus
$ 750.00
September 28
900.00
October 15
886.00
November 1
$2,536.00
Spring Quarter On Campus
$ 750.00
December 12
900.00
January 9
886.00
February 1
$2,536.00
Off Campus
$ 700.00
700.00
355.00
+ Sp. fees
Sp. fees
$1,755.00
Off Campus
$ 700.00
700.00
355.00
+ Sp. fees
$1,755.00
Off Campus
$ 700.00
700.00
+ Sp. fees
355.00
$1,755.00
+Sp. fees
+ Sp. fees
Refund Schedule
Students who decide to withdraw from college after they have
registered and paid their tuition will receive a tuition refund computed
from the date the withdrawal form was signed and returned to the
Registrar.
During first week. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90%
During second week....................................... 75%
During the third through the fifth week . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50%
During sixth week . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25%
After sixth week ...................................... No refund
Room and Board Refunds. If the student leaves school after the sixth
week, there will be no room refund. Through the sixth week, the student
will be charged for the time spent on campus plus a two-week room
charge. Students will be charged for board through the end of the week
in which they leave the campus. If a refund is due the student, a check will
be sent within a reasonable time.
24
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Books and Supplies
Textbooks, art, and coiiege suppiies may be purchased at the coiiege
bookstore. Stationery, college seals, banners, and other items also are
available for the convenience of students. All purchases must be paid for
in cash. Students should have $100.00 to $125.00 available at the beginning
of the school year for books. Estimated book costs for the entire year are
$200.00 to $300.00.
FINANCIAL AID
25
FINANCIAL AID
Golden Valley Lutheran College recognizes the close relationship between students, parents, and the College in meeting the costs of a quality
education. Our program of financial assistance is designed to help
qualified students who desire a Golden Valley Lutheran College education.
Golden Valley Lutheran College Aid
Academic Scholarships are awarded to those students who graduate in
the top quarter of their high school class or to transfer students who have
a 3.00 grade average with a minimum of 12 hours. Scholarships vary in
amount and are renewed each year provided the recipient maintains a
3.00 grade average in academic work at Golden Valley Lutheran College.
Presidential Scholarships are special awards to students graduating in
the top 5% of their high school class.
Activity Awards are available to students who show special abilities in
music, drama, art, or athletics. These awards are based on recommendations from coaches and professors with respect to talent and ability to
perform. Athletic recipients also must abide by the rules and regulations
of the Minnesota Community College Conference.
Christian Service/Leadership Grants are available to students who have
been active in their church and community. Aspects of Christian service
or leadership that are considered include, but are not limited to,
teaching, music, volunteer work and counseling.
Special Grants and Scholarships have been established by alumni and
other friends of the College. These funds are for students whose
qualifications meet the conditions and requirements of the specified
award.
Minnesota State Aid
Minnesota State Scholarships and Grants are available to Minnesota
residents planning to attend one of the eligible Minnesota colleges.
Awards are based on financial need and educational costs and may range
up to $3,251 per year.
Students may apply for a grant by completing an ACT Family Financial
Statement (FFS), including the section for Minnesota State Scholarship
and Grant-In-Aid applicants.
26
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Federal Government Aid
Pell Grants are available frorn the federal government for students
meeting certain financial need qualifications. Such grants may total up to
$1,900 per year and do not have to be repaid. Students may apply for this
grant by checking the appropriate box on either the ACT Family Financial
Statement or CSS Financial Aid Form.
National Direct Student Loans are funded by the federal government
and administered by the College. Loans are granted on the basis of
validated financial need. The loans are made at an interest rate of 5% with
the student paying neither interest nor principal until six months after
graduation or leaving college. Repayment must be completed within 10
years.
Guaranteed Student Loans enable eligible students to borrow directly
up to $2,500 annually from participating banks or other lenders at an
interest rate of 8%. Repayment of loan principal and interest begins six
months after graduation or leaving college.
The Minnesota Student Loan Program provides Guaranteed Student
Loans to eligible students who are unable to find a participating lender to
fund them.
Parent Loans for Undergraduate Student (Plus). This program helps
parents borrow money to pay for their children's cost of attending
postsecondary schools without the constraint of collateral securing the
loan. Parents of undergraduate students may borrow $3,000 per year for
each dependent, undergraduate student to a maximum of $15,000 per
student. Repayment begins within 60 days of disbursement. Normal
repayment is made over a five to ten year period at an interest rate of 12%.
The number and amount of each payment depends on the size of the
debt and the parents' ability to pay. The minimum repayment is $600 per
year. PLUS loans do not require a needs test.
Work Opportunities
College Work - Study enables students who demonstrate financial
need an opportunity to help defray college expenses through part-time
employment. Work - Study students may be employed in the cafeteria,
in maintenance, as clerical assistants to professors, library and audiovisual assistants, resident assistants, or in other available positions.
Student Employment. There are numerous part-time employment
positions available in the Golden Valley community and the surrounding
area. Our College bulletin board carries notices of available employment.
Other Assistance Programs
College Payment Schedule: Because most people prefer to pay
educational expenses in installments, Golden Valley Lutheran College
has set up a tuition payment plan. This plan is a convenient payment
program beginning in June and ending in February.
Hidden Subsidy: Golden Valley Lutheran College gives a "hidden
subsidy" each year to every student who attends the College as a full-
FINANCIAL AID
27
time student. This "hidden subsidy" reflects the fact that the total
instructional program at the College costs more than the total amount
received from tuition and fees. Such a "hidden subsidy" is made possible
by gifts from many sources, especially church congregations, alumni, and
friends of the College. The College also receives income from endowment funds.
Lutheran Brotherhood Loan - If a member of the student's family
holds a Lutheran Brotherhood Insurance policy, a student may borrow
up to $2,500 per year from the Lutheran Brotherhood Insurance Society
at the same rates described under Federal Insured Student Loans.
Other Grants - There are a number of grants and scholarships
available from other sources. The student is encouraged to consult his or
her high school counselor and the Director of Financial Aid at Golden
Valley Lutheran College for other federal, state, and communitysponsored scholarships and grants.
Procedure for Applying for Financial Aid
1.
To apply for admission to Golden Valley Lutheran College, request
an application form from the Office of Admissions, Golden Valley
Lutheran College, 6125 Olson Highway, Golden Valley, MN 55422.
2. If you are applying only for Golden Valley Lutheran scholarships and
grants - and not for state or federal grants - indicate this on the
Golden Valley Lutheran College Financial Aid Application.
3. To apply for federal or Minnesota aid you must complete a Family
Financial Statement and a Student Data Form using income information
for the 1983 tax year and submit it to ACT. Forms are available from
your high school guidance counselor or by writing the Office of
Admissions at Golden Valley Lutheran College. Although the FFS is
preferred, non-Minnesota residents may submit the CSS Financial
Aid Form. Allow six to eight weeks for processing of the ACT Family
Financial Statement.
4. Since all financial aid programs have limited funds, within ten days of
our notifying you that you will receive financial aid you must let us
know that you accept the offer. Funds that are not accepted are given
to other students who need them.
All types of financial assistance are made for only one academic year.
Students, however, may expect to receive financial assistance for the
second year if they remain in good academic and personal standing and if
their financial need continues. If a student withdraws during any quarter,
he or she forfeits the entire amount of gift aid that has been awarded
from College funds for the quarter. He or she also forfeits proportionate
amounts of aid awarded from state or federal funds for that quarter.
Golden Valley Lutheran College makes every effort to enable all
accepted students to attend regardless of financial resources. Your
financial need may be met through a combination of federal, state, and
institutional financial aid programs. We encourage students and parents
to visit campus to discuss financial planning.
28
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Scholarships
The AAi.. Lutheran American Minority Scholarship Program is available
for any Lutheran American minority person who is a member of a
Lutheran church, or is an immigrant who has been sponsored by a
Lutheran organization and is attending Golden Valley Lutheran College.
In any case, the recipient must be a member of a Lutheran church.
Scholarships range from $200 to $1,000 and can be renewed each year.
The AAL Lutheran Campus Scholarship Program is for students who
hold a certificate of membership and insurance from the Aid Asssociation
for Lutherans. The awards are based on academic achievement, Christian
character and professional promise.
The Berean Scholarship is given annually by the Bereans, an organization
of wives of the faculty and staff members at the College.
The David Bjelland Memorial Scholarship is given by Mrs. David
Bjelland because of her late husband's keen interest in Bible study and
the training of lay people for service to the Lord.
The Ethel Borge Memorial Scholarship has been established by Pastor
and Mrs. Alton C.O. Halverson in memory of her aunt, Ethel Borge.
The Ronald Chagnon II Memorial Scholarship has been established by
Mr. and Mrs. Ronald Chagnon, Sr. in memory of their son Ron who was a
student at Golden Valley Lutheran College.
The Wilson Fagerberg Memorial Scholarship has been established in
memory of Pastor Wilson Fagerberg, a long time faculty member in the
Department of Biblical Studies at Golden Valley Lutheran College.
The Gjernes Scholarship is provided annually through the Martha
Gjernes Estate.
The James Robert and John William Gustafson Scholarship has been
established by Mrs. Thora Tofte in memory of her husband and son. It is
awarded to a student interested in Christian service, ministry, missionary
work or Bible study.
The Haaland Scholarship has been established by Mrs. 0. T. Haaland to
be awarded to a student interested in a career of Christian service.
The Jackson Scholarship is given by Mrs. Eddie Jackson and the late Mr.
Jackson in recognition of their keen interest in Bible study and the
training of lay people for service to the Lord.
The Gunnar I. Johnson Memorial Scholarship has been established by
the Johnson family in memory of Mr. Johnson who was the contractor for
the construction of the Golden Valley Lutheran College Campus, 19611977.
The William A. Johnson Scholarship has been established by William A.
Johnson to be awarded each year to a worthy student of strong Christian
character who is interested in a business career.
The Liberian Student Scholarship has been established by Mr. and Mrs.
Ernest Overdahl and Dr. and Mrs. Scot Hutton to assist students from
Liberia.
The M. T. lillehaugen Memorial Scholarship is in memory of the late
Mr. Lillehaugen who was a good friend and supporter of the College. It is
to be used to "help defray the expenses for some g'ood student going into
church work, a person with a Christian commitment and one who
indicates a good Christian example."
FINANCIAL AID
29
The Lovaas Scholarship has been established by the late Samuel Lovaas
to be used for the training of a missionary student who intends to enter
missionary work.
The Lutheran Brotherhood Junior College Scholarship is awarded on
the basis of scholastic achievement and religious leadership.
The Lutheran Brotherhood Graduate Award for junior and senior years
at a Lutheran College is awarded to a sophomore student planning to
transfer to a four-year Lutheran college.
The Mai Scholarship is an annual scholarship from Mr. and Mrs. Arthur
Mai, former students, as an expression of appreciation for what this
school has meant to them.
The Richard Melvig Memorial Scholarship has been established in
memory of Ricky Melvig who had wanted to become a doctor but didn't
live to realize his dream. It is given to a returning student who exhibits
faith, character, and an interest in the sciences.
The Nelson Mission Scholarship has been established by Dr. and Mrs.
Russell E. Nelson to be awarded each year to a worthy student who has
chosen to prepare for full-time work in the area of mission. Dr. Nelson
was a faculty member and director of mission at the College.
The Edith B. Norberg Scholarship has been established in memory of
Edith and Edwin Norberg to provide scholarships for students pursuing a
career in church music.
The Pihl Scholarship has been established by Mr. and Mrs. Charles R.
Pihl. Mr. Pihl served as chairman and member of the Board of Regents of
the College.
The Ponwith Scholarship has been provided by Miss Sadie Ponwith, a
former student, teacher, and librarian, and her sister, the late Miss Alice
Ponwith, also a former student and staff member. It is awarded to
students showing evidence of Christian character, leadership, and
scholarship.
The Golden Valley Rotary Scholarship provided by the Golden Valley
Rotary Club awards two scholarships annually to two worthy students.
The Sampson Memorial Scholarship is given in memory of August and
Mabel Sampson, parents of Mrs. Russell B. Helgesen, the wife of our
Development Di rector.
The Savik Memorial Scholarship has been established by the family of
the late Oscar Savik, who was a member of the Board of Regents of the
College and advisor to the President.
The Tang Scholarship is provided by Dr. Christopher Tang, a former
faculty member, and Mrs. Tang in memory of their parents, Mr. and Mrs.
Han Ching Tang and Mr. and Mrs. Zi Hui Chang.
The Tang Church History Scholarship is given by Dr. and Mrs.
Christopher Tang in honor of Anna C. Tang and is intended for a student
who has shown excellence in church history courses.
The Manda Twete Scholarship has been provided by Miss Manda
Twete, a friend of the College. It is awarded to a student on the basis of
Christian character and demonstrated need.
The Mary D. Wagner Scholarship Fund has been established by Mrs.
Wagner for needy and worthy students who are particularly interested in
the study of the Bible.
ACADEMIC PROGRAM
31
ACA EMIC PROGRAM
Golden Valley Lutheran College grants three types of two-year
completion awards: the Associate in Arts Degree (Liberal Arts and
Transfer Program), the Associate in Arts Degree (Specialized Program),
and the Junior College Certificate. A one-year Vocational Certificate is
awarded for completion of a selected one-year vocational curriculum.
Golden Valley Lutheran College is a liberal arts institution which allows
a student to concentrate in the areas of general education, Biblical and
theological studies, or a specific vocation.
Students who plan to earn a four-year degree are encouraged to satisfy
general education requirements while attending Golden Valley Lutheran
College. When this suggestion is followed, students may concentrate on
their major and other requirements during the last two years of college.
General education courses invite the student to learn about the world,
the scientific method, the society in which he or she lives, the fine arts
and humanities, and the eternal values perceived in Biblical and
theological studies.
General Academic Information
Credit load and Student Classification
A normal credit load consists of 16 credits per quarter. Exceptions to
this credit load will be considered in consultation with a student's
academic advisor. Permission to take more than 18 credits must be
granted by the Academic Dean. Individuals enrolled for 12 or more
credits per quarter are considered full-time students. Individuals with
less than 12 credits are considered part-time students. A student who has
earned less than 45 cumulative credits is classified as a freshman. A
student who has earned 45 or more cumulative credits is classified as a
sophomore.
The auditing of courses is not encouraged since classroom capacities
are needed by students interested in earning college credit. Auditors are
required to do all work assigned by the instructor and tuition costs are the
same as costs for credit.
32
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN.COLLEGE
Grading and Honor Point System
/\ student's grade point average is computed at the end of each
quarter. The grade point average is determined by dividing the number
of earned honor points by the number of credits attempted. Honor
points are computed by the following scale:
Honor Points
Per Credit
Grade
4
Superior
A
3
Above Average
B
2
c Average
1
Below Average
D
Failure
0
F
I
V
W
WF
s
u
Incomplete*
Audit
Withdrawn**
Withdrawn, failing**
Satisfactory***
Unsatisfactory***
2
for J.C.C. only
*Incomplete work, must be made up satisfactorily by the end of the
fourth week of the next term the student attends or within one year if the
student does not return to Golden Valley Lutheran College. If a student
desires an extension beyond four weeks, he or she must secure approval
of the instructor involved and must petition the Scholastic Standing
Committee for the extension. If the work is not completed in the allotted
time, the grade becomes an F.
**Withdrawals after the third week of classes and through mid-term
are indicated by W or WF (to be determined by the instructor); and after
the mid-term and until the last regularly scheduled class day of each
quarter by a W, WF, or Fas determined by the instructor. A student may
not drop a course after final examinations begin.
***The grading system of Sand U is used only for those courses which
are taken to meet the requirements of the Junior College Certificate. An
S counts as two honor points per credit for the Junior College Certificate
only and will not be credited toward an Associate in Arts Degree. The U
grade yields no honor points or credits.
Academic Honors
An Honors List composed of those students who have earned a grade
point average of 3.00-3.49 is compiled at the end of each term. Those
students who achieve a grade point average of 3.50 or better are included
on the Dean's List.
ACADEMIC PROGRAM
33
Academic Progress
In accordance with policies established by the administration and
faculty, a student will be counseled in relation to academic progress
toward the Associate in Arts degree: (a) when a student's grade point
average is less than 2.00; (b) when his or her transcript shows two or more
grades of I (Incomplete) in one quarter. If a student's grade point average
falls below 1.50 he or she will be placed on academic probation until the
grade point average is raised to 1.50 or above. The College reserves the
right to dismiss a student if his or her academic performance is regarded
as unsatisfactory.
Eligibility for Varsity Sports
Eligibility rules for participation in varsity sports at Golden Valley
Lutheran College conform to the National Junior College Athletic
Association eligibility rules. In general, in order to participate in a varsity
sport, a student must be a full-time (12 credits) student during the
qualifying and competing quarter. During the qualifying quarter, he or
she must earn a grade point average of 1.5 or better in at least 10 hours of
course work listed in the College Catalog. Freshmen enrolled at GVLC in
their first quarter of college are exempt from the qualifying quarter
requirements. A student's eligibility is reviewed each quarter and all
hours of a complete course (subject) must be counted in computing a
student's grade point average. (See NJCAA Eligibility Rules.)
No student shall be certified on an eligibility list until the College has
received the final transcript indicating the high school graduation date
and any college transcript(s), if another college has been previously
attended. The responsibility to obtain any such transcripts rests upon the
individual student.
Credit by Special Examination
Under special circumstances, a student may seek to gain credits or
exemption by special examination, in accordance with specific departmental policies.
Transfer Students
The actual number of credits accepted in transfer from other institutions
are entered on the student's record, but transferred credits and grade
points are not included in the computation of the grade point average.
Transfer credit will not be granted for courses in which a grade below
C- was received.
34
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Class Attendance
Each student is responsible for regular class attendance and for
completing work as required in each class. With respect to unexcused
absences, excused absences, or make-up work, it is the student's
responsibility to learn the policy of each instructor. The instructor's
policy is usually stated in the course outline. At the discretion of the
instructor, a student may be withdrawn from a course for an excessive
number of unexcused absences or uncompleted assignments.
Independent Study
A maximum of six credits in Independent Study may be applied toward
the Associate in Arts Degree. The student must meet the criteria
established by the department and have the approval of the chairperson of
the department in which he or she plans to do the study. Standards
require a 3.0 average in the department in which Independent Study is
taken, a limit of four credits per term in Independent Study, and a
demonstration of relevance to the student's academic objectives. Independent Study applications are available in the Registrar's Office.
Bible and English Requirements
All students enrolled for eight credits or more are required to take at
least one Bible course each quarter that they attend classes at the
College. A student who transfers from another college is not required to
complete the full 18 credits in Bible but is required to take one course
each quarter while enrolled at the College. All Bible core courses listed in
the Department of Biblical Studies will satisfy this requirement.
All degree seeking students are required to register for English until
the sequence, English 111and112 - College Composition, and English
113 - Introduction to Literature, has been completed. Placement in
English 100, 110, or 111 will be determined by specific English Placement
tests administered to all new students during student orientation in the
fall, or at the time of their registration for winter or for spring quarters.
Co-Curricular Activity Credits
A total of nine credits in co-curricular activities may be applied toward
an Associate in Arts Degree. The three credits of required physical
education are not included in this category. Co-curricular activities
include all music ensembles, theatre practice, Christian service, additional physical education activity courses after the three required courses
are completed, and activity credits that a transfer student might bring to
the College.
With regard to co-curricular activities other than varsity sports, a
student who earns a grade point average of less than 1.Sfor a quarter may
have co-curricular activities curtailed or programs of study reduced, at
the discretion of the Scholastic Standing Committee.
ACADEMIC PROGRAM
35
Orientation and Registration
All students must report to the College for Orientation Days as
indicated in the calendar in this catalog.
The orientation period includes a series of placement and personality
tests which are used to provide a more effective placement and
counseling service for students. Both new and returning students are
required to register on the days indicated in the calendar.
Registration is not completed until the student has made settlement for
the quarter charges at the Bookkeeping Office.
All students have at their disposal the advice and counsel of faculty
advisors. Before registering for any term, the student must consult with
his or her advisor concerning the schedule of study. The selection of the
proper courses is the individual student's responsibility.
Changes in Registration
Necessary changes to eliminate conflicts and to correct evident
mistakes in registration may be permitted during the first ten days of
classes, with the written approval of the academic advisor. A Change of
Course Permit for this purpose may be obtained in the Registrar's Office.
After the tenth day, no regularly scheduled classes may be added except
by special permission.
Repeating a Course
A student may repeat only courses in which a grade of Dor F has been
received. The intention to repeat a course must be certified at the time of
registration for the course. If a student repeats a course in which a Dor F
grade has been received, only the more recent grade and credit earned
will be included in the computation of the grade point average. Both
grades, however, will remain on the student's permanent record.
Withdrawals from the College
A student who wishes to withdraw from the College during any term,
must make application for this action in the Office of the Registrar.
Failure to comply with this regulation may deprive a student of refund
privileges and result in an F grade in all classes. Partial refunds on fees
already paid will be based on the date the application was signed and
returned to the Registrar's Office.
GRADUATION REQUIREMENTS
37
GRADUATION
REQUIREMENTS
The responsibility rests with the student for seeing that his or her
program includes all requirements for graduation.
Applicants for admission should study the requirements for graduation outlined in this section of the catalog and plan their college
program as a whole as early as possible. A student who is in doubt about
how certain requirements are interpreted should consult with his or her
academic advisor, the Registrar, or the Academic Dean. When circumstances might warrant a justifiable modification in a requirement, a
petition (obtained from the Registrar) should be submitted to the
Committee on Academic Affairs.
38
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Associate in Arts Degree:
Liberal Arts and Transfer Program
This program is designed for students who intend to gain a general
knowledge of the arts and sciences and who intend to transfer to a fouryear college or university for completion of a Bachelor's Degree. A
student receiving this degree must be in residence three terms, one of
which must be the term in which the student graduates. The requirements for this degree are:
1. Completion of the divisional requirements as outlined below. The
further requirements in a selected curriculum are recommended
and the student should attempt to fulfill them.
2. Completion of 92 credits with a minimum cumulative grade point
average of 2.00 (C average).
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
DIVISIONAL
REQUIREMENTS
Biblical and Theological
Studies
Communications
Social Science
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
CREDIT
HOURS
COURSES
18
Bible Core
9
12
8-12
Creative Arts
6
Physical Education
3
English 111, 112, 113
Business 200, 210 and all Social
Science courses except History
102, Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service
courses
All Mathematics or Natural
Science courses except
Mathematics 100, 101
All Creative Arts courses except
Applied Music, Ensembles,
Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education activity courses. (One
credit only per varsity sport)
GRADUATION REQUIREMENTS
39
Associate in Arts Degree:
Sp.ecialized Program
This program is designed for students who intend to seek employment
after two years of college or for those who intend to pursue an education
of a specialized nature. A student receiving this degree must be in
residence three terms, one of which must be the term in which the
student graduates. The requirements for this degree are:
1. Completion of the divisional requirements as outlined below plus
the additional requirements of a selected curriculum.
2. Completion of 92 credits with a minimum cumulative grade point
average of 2.00 (C average).
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
DIVISIONAL
REQUIREMENTS
Biblical and Theological
Studies
Communications
Social Science
CREDIT
HOURS
COURSES
18
Bible Core
9
6
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
4
Creative Arts
3
Physical Education
3
English 111, 112, 113
All Social Science courses except
History 102, Humanities 200, Personal Orientation and Social Service courses
All Mathematics or Natural
Science courses except
Mathematics 100, 101
All Creative Arts courses except
Applied Music, Ensembles, Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education activity courses. (One credit
only per varsity sport)
40
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
The Junior College Certificate
This certificate will be awarded to those students who cornplete two
years of work on a curriculum but do not satisfy the requirements for an
Associate in Arts Degree. The requirements for the Junior College
Certificate are:
1. Completion of a minimum of 88 credits including one Bible
Course per term.
2. A minimum cumulative grade point average of 1.00.
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
The One-Year Vocational Certificate
This certificate will be awarded to those students who fulfill the
following requirements:
1. Completion of 46 credits (including one Bible Course per quarter)
with a minimum cumulative grade point average of 2.00 (C average).
2. Completion of the requirements for a selected curriculum.
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
41
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
Details of the curricula listed below are outlined on the pages which
follow. The student should select a curriculum and be familiar with its
requirements before registration. The College reserves the right to
change curriculum requirements when the necessity arises.
A. Curricula leading to the Associate in Arts Degree: Liberal Arts and
Transfer Program
1. Basic Liberal Arts
2. Liberal Arts with concentration in Basic Science
3. Liberal Arts with concentration in Biblical and Theological
Studies
4. Liberal Arts with concentration in Business Administration
5. Liberal Arts with concentration in Computer Science
6. Liberal Arts with concentration in courses for Specific Professions
a. Agriculture
b. Classics
c. Corrective Therapy
d. Dentistry
e. Education - Elementary
f.
Education - Secondary
g. Education - Special
h. Forestry
i.
Law
j. Medicine
k. Music (Pre-Bachelor of Arts)
I. Music (Pre-Bachelor of Music)
m. Nursing
n. Occupational Therapy
o. Pharmacy
p. Physical Education
q. Physical Therapy
r. Recreation Leadership
B. Curricula leading to the Associate in Arts Degree: Specialized
Program
1. Church Staff Work
2. Computer Training and Electronics Technican
3. Law Enforcement
4. Office Administration
5. Secretarial - General
6. Secretarial - Legal
7. Secretarial - Medical
8. Secretarial - Parish
9. Social Service
10. World Mission
C. Curricula leading to the One-Year Vocational Certificate
1. General Secretarial
2. Legal Secretarial
3. Medical Secretarial
4. Office Administration
42
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
A. Curricula leading to The Associate in Arts Degree:
liberal Arts and Transfer Program
1. BASIC LIBERAL ARTS This curriculum is recommended for those planning
to transfer to a university or four-year college. The courses listed below fulfill
the normal two-year general education requirements for the Bachelor of Arts
Degree. Since many colleges require one or two years of foreign language or
variations of work in some of the fields, the student and his or her advisor will
make the relevant selections in relation to the student's future plans and the
school to which a transfer is planned. Completion of this curriculum leads to
the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Social Science
18
9
3
12
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Creative Arts
8-12
Physical Education
3
Foreign Language
Electives
0-15
14-33
6
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Business 200, 210 and all Social Science
courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal Orientation
and Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
See department listings
Courses in special field of interest
2. LIBERAL ARTS WITH CONCENTRATIONS IN BASIC SCIENCE This
curriculum is recommended for those planning to transfer to a university or
four-year college for degrees in science or technology. The student, with the
aid of his or her advisor, will make the relevant course selections in relation
to his or her future plans and the school to which a transfer is planned.
Completion of this curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Social Science
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
18
9
3
12
41-51
Creative Arts
6
Physical Education
3
Foreign Language
0-12
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Business 200, 210 and all Social Science
courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal Orientation
and Social Service courses.
Selections from Mathematics (except
100, 101), Biology, Chemistry, and
Physics
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
German 101, 102, 103 recommended
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
43
3. LIBERAL ARTS WITH CONCENTRATION IN BIBLICAL AND THEOLOGICAL
STUDIES This curriculum is recommended for those who want to combine
their general studies in the liberal arts and sciences with a more extensive
program of Biblical and theological studies. The Bible core sequence may be
supplemented by more extensive offerings in the study of the Bible,
Theology, and Applied Christianity. Completion of this curriculum leads to
the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Social Science
27-36
9
3
15
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Creative Arts
8-12
Physical Education
3
Foreign Language
Electives
0-15
0-21
6
Bible Core; Theology 121, 122, 123;
selections from New Testament
recommended
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Business 200, 210 and all Social Science
courses except History 102
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Greek 101, 102, 103 recommended
See department listings
4. LIBERAL ARTS WITH CONCENTRATION IN BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
This curriculum offers courses to satisfy requirements for two years of a fouryear degree program. Admissions requirements for junior-year status at fouryear institutions vary. Students should be guided by the program requirements
of the universities to which they plan to transfer. Advisors will assist in planning a
program that will meet the four year college's lower division requirements.
Completion of this curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Computer Science
Social Science
18
9
3
8
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 required
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
3
12
Computer Science 160 required
Business 200, 210 required; Sociology
100, Psychology 202-203
recommended
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Business 101, 102, 103, 120, 150
Creative Arts
6
Physical Education
3
18
Business
Required Courses
Business Electives
0-13
General Electives
0-12
Electives in Business should be selected
after consulting the four-year
college's requirements
See department listings
44
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
5. LIBERAL ARTS WITH CONCENTRATION IN COMPUTER SCIENCE This
curriculum is recommended for those planning to transfer to a university or
four-year college for degrees in computer science or technology. The
student, with the aid of his or her advisor, will make the relevant course
selections in relation to his or her future plans and the college to which a
transfer is planned. Completion of this curriculum leads to the Associate in
Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
Bible Core
English
9
English 111, 112, 113
Speech
3
Speech 100 or 120 recommended
Social Science
12
Business 200, 210 recommended
Mathematics and
8-18
Mathematics 102 required;
Natural Sciences
Mathematics 103, 110, 120
recommended
12
Computer Science
Computer Science 160, 170, 210, 220
6
All courses except Applied Music,
Creative Arts
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Physical Education
3
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
0-12
German 101, 102, 103 recommended
Foreign Language
0-21
See department listings
Electives
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
45
6. LIBERAL ARTS CURRICULA FOR STUDENTS INTERESTED IN SPECIFIC
PROFESSIONS The College has established specific preliminary training for
students desiring entrance into certain professions. Students interested in
these professions should consult the appropriate college catalogs, discuss
plans with their faculty advisor, and check with the Registrar to insure proper
course selection. Completion of one of the following curricula leads to an
Associate in Arts Degree and satisfies the basic requirements for the first two
years of the particular professional program.
a. Agricultural
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
b. Classics
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
c. Corrective Therapy
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
d. Dentistry
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
Speech 100 or 120
History 201, 202, 203
Geography 100
Mathematics 102, 103
Biology 111, 112, 113
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Business 200, 210
English 221
History 111, 112
Anthropology 100
Greek 101, 102, 103, 300
German 101, 102, 103 Recommended
Speech 100 or 120
Psychology 202, 203
Biology 111, 232, 233
Physical Education 120, 130, 200, 210
Mathematics 102, 103, 201
Biology 111, 112, 113
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Education Students planning to teach on the elementary or secondary level
will need a four-year program in the Liberal Arts or Sciences and the teacher
education courses required for a certificate. The curricula outlined below
fufill requirements for a Minnesota certificate for the first two years.
Completion of any one of these curricula leads to the Associate in Arts
Degree.
e. Education -
Elementary
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
Geography 100
History 201, 202, 203
Psychology 202, 203, 210
Biology 113
Physical Education 120, 130
Private lessons in piano and voice are
recommended
f. Education - Secondary
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
Psychology 202, 203, 210
Sociology 110, 210, 212
Physical Education 120, 130
Emphasis on a special field of interest
46
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
g. Education - Special
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
h. Forestry
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
i. law
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
Psychology 202, 203, 210
Sociology 110, 210, 212
Physical Education 120, 130
Mathematics 102, 103, 110, 200
Biology 111, 112, 121, 222, 223
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Physics 102
Business 200, 210
Speech 100 or 120
History 201, 202, 203
Political Science 100, 200
Psychology 202, 203
Sociology 110, 210, 212
Business 200, 210, 230
j. Medicine
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
k. Music (Pre-Bachelor of Arts)
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
I. Music (Pre-Bachelor of Music)
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Social Science
6-9
Natural Science
4
Physical Education
3
Creative Arts
51
Electives
m. Nursing
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
Mathematics 102, 103, 201
Biology 111, 112, 113
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Physics 102, 103
One year of foreign language when
necessary
History 121, 122, 123 recommended
Music 111, 112, 113, 211, 212, 213;
Applied Music - 6 credits;
Ensembles - 6 credits
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
History 121, 122, 123 recommended
Biology 113 recommended
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Music 111, 112, 113, 121, 122, 123, 131,
132, 133, 211, 212, 213; Applied Music
- 6 credits; Ensembles - 6 credits
See department listings
Psychology 202
Sociology 100 or 110
Biology 111, 232, 233
Chemistry 101, 102
Physics 102
German 101, 102, 103 recommended
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
47
n. Occupational Therapy
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
Speech 100 or 120
Psychology 202, 203, 210
Biology 111, 112, 232, 233
Chemistry 101, 102
Physical Education 120, 130
o. Pharmacy
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
Mathematics 102, 103
Biology 111, 112, 113, 231
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
p. Physical Education
The curriculum outlined below will earn the Associate in Arts Degree and
provides the necessary prerequisites leading to the Minnesota teaching
certificate.
History 121, 122, 123, 201, 202, 203, or
The Basic Liberal Arts
Sociology 100, 110, 210 or Psychology
Curriculum and including:
202, 203 recommended
Biology 111, 112, 232, 233
Physical Education 110, 120, 130, 200,
210
q. Physical Therapy
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
Speech 100 or 120
Mathematics 102
Physics 102, 103
Biology 111, 112, 232, 233
Physical Education 120, 130
Psychology 120 or 210
Chemistry 101, 102, 103 recommended
r. Recreation Leadership
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
Speech 100 or 130
Sociology 100, 110, 212 or Psychology
202, 203 recommended
Physical Education 110, 120, 200, 210;
three one credit Physical
Education activity courses
Recreation Leadership 110, 120, 210,
220, 230
48
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
B. Curricula Leading to The Associate in Arts Degree:
Specialized Program
1. CHURCH STAFF WORK The following curriculum ,provides training for
the responsibilities of a church staff worker. The responsibilities that may be
assigned to a church staff worker often fall into the following general
categories; parish education, youth work, visitation, and parish secretary.
Completion of this curriculum leads to an Associate in Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
Theology and Church
9
History
English
9
Speech
3
Social Science
6
Mathematics and
4
Natural Sciences
Physical Education
3
Creative Arts
Secretarial Science
Applied Christianity
Electives
3
4-11
22-24
2-11
Bible Core
Theology 121, 122, 123; Church
History 200
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 150
Psychology 120, Sociology 120
Biology 113 recommended
Three one credit Physical
Education activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Secretarial Science 102 (101, 103 may be
required depending on course
background of student)
Applied Christianity 122, 123, 130,
201, 202, 203' 211, 221, 223' 230
Sociology and Psychology courses
recommended
2. COMPUTER TRAINING OR ELECTRONIC TECHNICIAN Cooperative
educational programs are available between Golden Valley Lutheran College and Control Data Institute for training as computer technicians and
programmers, and between GVLC and Northwestern Electronics Institute
for training in the field of Electronics Technician. Students spend at least one
academic year at the College and complete a specified course with Control
Data or Northwestern Electronics. A maximum of 45 credits from these
institutions will be accepted toward the Associate in Arts Degree. Completion
of the entire curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
12
Bible Core
English
9
English 111, 112, 113
Social Science
6
Selections from History 123, Sociology
100, 110, 120 recommended
Selections from Mathematics
10-15
Mathematics and
102, 103, Physics 102, 103
Natural Sciences
3
Three one credit Physical Education
Physical Education
activity courses
3
All courses except Applied Music,
Creative Arts
Ensembles, Theatre 120
0-21
See department listings
Electives
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
49
3. LAW ENFORCEMENT The following curriculum, combining courses in
Biblical studies, the liberal arts and law enforcement, leads to the Associate in
Arts Degree and provides a foundation for a career in law enforcement.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Speech
3
Social Science
12
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Physical Education
6
Creative Arts
3
4
Law Enforcement
23
Electives
14
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Selections from Political Science 100,
Psychology 120, Sociology 100,
110, 120, 210, 212 recommended
Biology 113 recommended
Physical Education 150 and
three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Law Enforcement 100, 110, 120, 130,
150, 160, 170, 180
See department listings
4. OFFICE ADMINISTRATION This two-year curriculum offers a variety of
business administration and office skills courses for the student interested in
an entry-level business position. Completion of this curriculum leads to the
Associate in Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Social Science
6
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Physical Education
Creative Arts
4-8
3
3
Business
17-20
Business/
Secretarial Science/
Computer Science
Electives
Electives
19-35
0-13
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 13
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics
100, 101
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Business 101, 102, 120, 140, 150
(Secretarial Science 101 may
be required depending on
background of the student)
Selections from Business,
Secretarial Science, Computer
Science courses
See department listings
50
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
5. GENERAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this two-year curriculum, combining instruction in Biblical s.tudies, the liberal arts and secretarial skills,
leads to the Associate in Arts Degree and prepares the student for a career as
a general secretary.
~
· ·
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Social Science
6
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Computer Science
Physical Education
4
Creative Arts
3
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
3
3
44-51
0-2
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
Computer Science 160
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Business 110, 140, 150;
Secretarial Science 102, 103, 110,
112, 113, 122, 212, 213, 242, 243
(Secretarial Science 101, 111 may be
required depending on background
of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
6. LEGAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this two-year curriculum, combining
courses in Biblical studies, the liberal arts and legal secretarial training, leads
to the Associate in Arts Degree and prepares the student for a career as a
legal secretary.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Social Science
6
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Computer Science
Creative Arts
4
Physical Education
3
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
3
3
46-53
0
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
Computer Science 160
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Business 140, 150, 230; Secretarial
Science 102, 103, 110, 112, 113,
122, 212, 213, 231, 242, 243
(Secretarial Science 101, 111 may be
required depending on background
of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
51
7. MEDICAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this two-year curriculum, combining courses in Biblical studies, the liberal arts and medical secretarial
training, leads to the Associate in Arts Degree and prepares the student for a
career as a medical secretary.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Social Science
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Computer Science
Physical Education
Creative Arts
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
18
9
6
8-12
3
3
3
43-50
0
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service courses
Biology 111, 232 required
Computer Science 160
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Business 140, 150; Secretarial
Science 102, 103, 110, 112,
113, 122, 212, 213, 221, 242, 243
(Secretarial Science 101, 111 may
be required depending on
background of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
8. PARISH SECRETARIAL Completion of this curriculum, which combines
training in Biblical studies, secretarial skills and liberal arts, prepares the
student for the position of Parish Secretary, and leads to the Associate in Arts
Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Social Science
18
9
6
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Physical Education
4
3
Creative Arts
3
Business/Secretarial
Science
41-48
Applied Christianity
13
Electives
0
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
Psychology 120 required;
Psychology or Sociology
courses recommended
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Business 140, 150; Secretrial
Science 102, 103, 110, 112, 113,
122, 212, 213, 242, 243
(Secretarial Science 101, 111 may
be required depending on
background of the student)
Applied Christianity 122, 123, 130,
221, 230
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
52
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
9. SOCIAL SERVICE This program is designed to train the student to assist the
professional Social Service Worker in areas of reception, group care, case
,,,,.. .. I, +..-..,......--h..-.. .. ...._,..,..:,..+.-.n.r-r. .-r..rr.r."lf-:r..-. +hn ..
,...,nrl .. ri.h1hiliT..,.tir.n. r..-..mr-.lo.tir.n
VVVI " ' LC:aLI IC:I Q.).:'11.)LQI ...... c:;, I \,.";LI \._;QllVI 1, l l I L i u p y UI IU I \.....I IULJllltUll'-./11. '-..-VI 11p1Ll1VI I
of this curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree. The program is
designed for students who wish to find employment after two years in
college.
-i.Y'\.\/
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Speech
3
Social Science
18
Social Service
Internship
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Creative Arts
9-18
Physical Education
3
Electives
4
3
16-25
Bible Core
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 120 required; Speech 150
recommended
Psychology 202, 203, 210; Sociology
100, 110, 120
Selections from Social Service 101,
102, 103, 201, 202, 203
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Physical Education 120, 130, Recreation
Leadership 220, Sociology 210
recommended
10. WORLD MISSION Current trends indicate that the Church's need is for
candidates with bachelor's degrees or with training in specialized fields such
as Bible and theology, medicine, education, business, agriculture, electronics,
aviation or secretarial skills. Interested students should plan for extended
and thorough preparation. The curriculum outlined below combines
concentrated Bible study, a liberal arts background, an introduction to the
missionary task, and opportunities for a variety of contacts with people
directly involved in church work in various parts of the world. Completion of
the two-year curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
Theology
6
English
9
Speech
3
Social Science
12
Mathematics and
Natural Sciences
Physical Education
8-12
3
Creative Arts
3
Christian Service
Applied Christianity
World Mission
Electives
2
9
6
9-13
Bible Core
Theology 121, 122, 123
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service courses
Biology 113 recommended
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120
Christian Service 110
All Applied Christianity courses
Mission 100, 110, 120
See department listings
54
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
C. Curricula leading to the One-Year Vocational Certificate
GE~JERAL SECRET,.'\Rli\!. Completion of this one-year curriculum} combining instruction in secretarial skills and Biblical studies, leads to a
Vocational Certificate.
1.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Physical Education
1
Business/Secretarial
Science/Computer
Science
Electives
34-46
0
Bible Core
A one credit Physical Education
activity course
(Business 110 or Computer
Science 160), Business 140, 150;
Secretarial Science 110, 112,
113, 122, 212, 242, 243
(Secretarial Science 102, 103, 111
may be required depending on
background of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
Students entering the One-Year General Secretarial Program must have
completed one year of high school typing. Business 150 substitutes for
college composition. Students, however, must take English 100 and/or
English 110 if test results indicate need.
2. LEGAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this one-year curriculum, combining
Biblical studies and legal secretarial courses, leads to a Vocational Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Physical Education
1
Busi ness/Secreta rial
Science
Electives
36-48
0
Bible Core
A one credit Physical Education activity
course
Business 140, 150, 230; Secretarial
, Science 110, 112, 113, 122, 212,
231, 242, 243 (Secretarial
Stience 102, 103, 111
may be required depending
on background of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
Students entering the One-year Legal Secretarial Curriculum must have
completed one year of high school typing. Business 150 substitutes for
college composition. Students, however, must take English 100 and/or
English 110 if test results indicate need.
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
55
3. MEDICAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this one-year curriculum, combining Biblical studies and medical secretarial courses, leads to a Vocational
Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Physical Education
1
Busi ness/Secreta ri aI
Science
Electives
33-45
0-3
Bible Core
A one credit Physical Education activity
course
Business 140, 150; Secretarial Science
110, 112, 113, 122, 212, 221, 242, 243
(Secretrial Science 102, 103, 111 may
be required depending on
background of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
Students entering the One-year Medical Secretarial Program must have
completed one year of high school typing. Business 150 substitutes for
college composition. Students, however, must take English 100 and/or
English 110 if test results indicate need.
4. OFFICE ADMINISTRATION Completion of this one-year curriculum,
combining Biblical studies and office administration courses, leads to a
Vocational Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Physical Education
1
Business/Secretarial
Science
Busi n ess/Secreta rial
Science/Computer
Science Electives
Electives
13-16
23
0-6
Bible Core
A one credit Physical Education
activity course
Business 140, 150;
Secretarial Science 110, 122
(Secretarial Science 101 may
be required depending on
background of the student)
Selections from Business,
Secretarial Science,
Computer Science courses
See Department Listings
Business 150 substitutes for college composition. Students, however, must
take English 100 and/or English 110 if test results indicate need.
5. WORLD MISSION Completion of the one-year curriculum leads to a
Vocational Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
Theology and Church
History
English
Social Science
9
9
6
9
Physical Education
Christian Service
Applied Christianity
World Mission
Electives
1-2
6-12
6-12
0
Bible Core
Theology 121, 122, 123; Church History
200
English 111, 112
Selections from Philosophy 211, 212, 213;
Political Science 200;
Anthropology 100, 110
A one credit Physical Education
activity course
Christian Service 110
Applied Christianity 130, 150, 211
Mission 100, 110, 120, 200
See department listings
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
57
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
The descriptions of courses are arranged according to divisions. The
course numbering system is as follows: The first digit of the course
number indicates (1) freshman course, (2) sophomore course, or (3)
special course for advanced students. The second digit indicates the
standing of the course within the Department. The third digit indicates
the term in which the course is offered - (1) fall quarter, (2) winter
quarter, (3) spring quarter, and (0) flexible scheduling.
The College reserves the right to cancel classes with inadequate
enrollment or to change course offerings when the necessity arises.
I. DIVISION OF BIBLICAL AND THEOLOGICAL STUDIES
A sequence of Biblical courses has been established to provide maximum
coverage of Biblical concepts by students taking the minimum Bible requirement.
The Bible Core courses are:
N.T. 101, 103, 110, 120, 130, 140, 202, 203
O.T. 102, 201
Greek 101, 102, 103
History 102
English 230
The Bible Core Sequence is as follows:
FRESHMEN
N.T. 101 or 120
Fall Quarter
Winter Quarter
O.T. 102 or N.T. 140
or History 102
N.T. 103 or 110 or 130
Spring Quarter
SOPHOMORES
O.T. 201
N.T. 202
N.T. 203 or English 230
A student may substitute Greek 101, 102, 103 for 9 credits of required Bible Core
courses.
DEPARTMENT OF BIBLICAL STUDIES
O.T. 102 Covenant History of the Old Testament
3 credits
The covenant purposes and acts of God as they appear in the historical record of
God's people in the Old Testament, with some reference to the continuation and
fulfillment of the covenant promise in the New Testament, especially the Gospel
of John. Student may not receive credit for both 0.T. 102 and History 102.
O.T. 201 Isaiah-Jeremiah
3 credits
An historical survey of the last two centuries of the Kingdom of Judah and a study
of the prophecies of Isaiah and Jeremiah as they reached their fulfillment in the
Messiah of the New Testament.
N.T. 101 Luke-Acts
3 credits
A study of the life of Christ and the fundamental teachings of the Christian
Church through the student's personal involvement with the text of Scripture.
N.T. 103 Pauline Epistles
3 credits
The structure, historical setting, purposes and content of Paul's Epistles to the
Galatians, I Corinthians and Prison Epistles are studied with an emphasis upon
their relevance to our day.
58
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
N.T. 110 The Gospel According to Matthew
3 credits
A brief survey of the Jewish, Greek and Roman backgrounds, a short introduction
to the Gospels, and an intensive study of the life and work of Christ in the light of
Old Testament prophecy. Offered alternate years.
-
N.T. 120 Epistle to the Hebrews
3 credits
A study of the fulfillment of Old Testament prophecy in Jesus Christ and His
supremacy and finality. The student is involved with the inductive method of
studying the Bible. Offered alternate years.
N.T. 130 General Epistles
3 credits
An inductive study of the Epistles of James, Peter, John and Jude with special
attention paid to their unique features as compared to other New Testament
epistles. Offered alternate years.
N.T. 140 The Gospel of John
3 credits
An inductive study concentrating upon the Person and work of Jesus Christ as
seen uniquely in the theology of John.
N.T. 202 Romans
3 credits
An intensive study of the Epistle to the Romans, considering its background,
doctrinal content and inspirational message, and emphasizing the doctrine of
justification by faith with its implications for the Christian life.
N.T. 203 Apocalyptic Literature
3 credits
A survey of the struggle of the Church against Rome, 70-100 A.D. and the central
Christology of the Book of Revelation with student interpretation and evaluation of study results.
Bible 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Study of special Biblical problems or areas suited to students' needs and interests.
Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF THEOLOGY AND CHURCH HISTORY
Courses in this department cannot be substituted for the Bible core courses.
Theology 121 God's Way of Salvation
2 credits
A study of justification, sanctification and the Christian hope of eternal life as set
forth by the Scriptures. The course utilizes the inductive method.
Theology 122 The God of Redemption
2 credits
A study of the Scriptures and other sources utilizing the inductive technique and
with concentration on the attributes of God, the incarnation, the Person and
redemptive work of Christ, the sanctifying work of the Holy Spirit, and the
relevance of faith in the Triune God in relation to the great fact of redemption.
Theology 123 The Church and the Means of Grace
2 credits
A study of Scripture and collateral readings using the inductive technique with
respect to the means of grace and the role of the Church as custodian thereof.
Theology 300 Independent Study
1 to 2 elective credits per term
Study of special theological problems or areas suited to students' needs and
interests. Department approval necessary.
Church History 200 Religion in Modem America
3 credits
Survey of the role and importance of religion in the United States with emphasis
upon changing conditions and practices among the various religious groups and
upon the Lutheran heritage. Especially for the Church Staff Work Curriculum.
Church History 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special problems and areas of study in Church History. Department approval
necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
59
11. DIVISION OF COMMUNICATIONS
DEPARTMENT OF ENGLISH
Placement in ESL, English 100, 110, or 111 is determined by specific English
Placement tests administered to all new students during student orientation in
the fall, or at the time of their registration for winter or for spring quarters.
English ESL English as a Second Language
2 elective credits per term
ESL is a course in English for international students. Emphasis is placed on spoken
English and on students' development of their communication skills. By
repeating pronunciation drills, memorizing dialogues, reviewing basic grammar
and practicing American idioms and sentence patterns, students increase their
fluency in English. Students in ESL must be enrolled concurrently in an English
composition course. ESL requires three scheduled hours per week, provides two
elective credits per quarter, and normally is required of all international students
each quarter they are in attendance.
English 100 Basic Composition I
1 credit for junior College Certificate only
Designed for the student needing individualized instruction in basic sentence
and paragraph construction. Successful completion of the course (passing grade)
is necessary before the student can enter English 110 and then the required
English sequence (English 111, 112, 113). This course meets three hours each week.
English 110 Basic Composition II
3 elective credits
For students entering college who need intensive work in mastering basic
academic skills in English Composition. Successful completion of this course
(passing grade) is necessary before these students can enter the required
sequence of English courses (English 111, 112, 113). Students are granted elective
credit toward the AA Degree, but since this course may not transfer to four-year
colleges, students are advised to take more than the normal 92 credits. Students in
this course are required to attend four hours of class and/or additional sessions
each week.
English 111, 112, 113 (A, B, C, D, E or F) College Composition and
Introduction to Literature
3 credits per course
The regular series of courses in freshman College Composition English 111 and
112 place emphasis on the students' development and competence in English
writing skills and their ability to understand and respond to selected readings.
English 113 offers study of specific genre, themes and/or topics in literature.
Course titles may vary and may include studies in the Immigrant Experiences,
Satire, Social Concerns in Literature, Poetry, the Contemporary Short Novel and
the Experience of Fiction. Nine credits of College English are required of all
students (with the exception of one-year vocational students). Normally, College
English courses must be taken in sequence.
English 120 Directed Study in Journalism
1 elective credit per term
(maximum of 3 credits)
Students are involved in the production of a major publication, including
exercise in layout and design, copywriting, photography, and editing.
English 130 Creative Writing
3 credits
Students are given the opportunity to write poetry, short stories, essays and other
literary forms. Topics such as literary criticism and marketing are discussed.
Students read and evaluate each other's work.
English 210 Topics in Literature
3 credits
Study of specific genre, themes and/or topics in literature. Course titles may vary
and may include studies in the Immigrant Experiences, Satire, Social Concerns
in Literature, Poetry, the Contemporary Short Novel and the Experience of
Fiction.
60
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
English 211, 212, 213 American Literature
3 credits per course
211: The New Garden of Eden: The 17th & 18th Centuries
212: The Snake in the Garden: The 19th Century
213: The Garden Becomes a Wasteland: The 20th Century
English 221, 222, 223 World Literature
3 credits per course
Chronological survey of major writers, works, genres, themes and movements in
world thought and literature from ancient to modern times. Fall Term: Ancient
East, Greece, Rome and the Middle Ages. Winter Term: Renaissance, Neoclassical and Romantic Literature. Spring Term: The Modern Age (1850 to the
present).
English 230 Literature of the Bible
3 credits
Students do extensive reading of the narratives, poems, and apocalyptic writings
primarily from the Old Testament. Emphasis is placed on reading the selections as
pieces of literature.
English 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special study programs to fit student needs and interest. May be taken any term.
Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF SPEECH
Speech 100 Fundamentals of Public Speaking
3 credits
A study of the basic concepts used in organizing and delivering speeches.
Emphasis on preparing and giving informative speeches.
Speech 120 Interpersonal Communication
3 credits
Study of the concepts of interpersonal communication patterns and the
characteristics of ineffective and effective communication behavior.
Speech 130 Oral Interpretation
3 credits
Theory and practice of the techniques of selecting and performing literature
orally. Students will study methods of analyzing literature, and will develop
techniques for reading prose,\ poetry and other literary selections. Offered
alternate years.
3 credits
Speech 150 Small Group Communications
Participation in and analysis of behavioral and work norms in small groups.
Includes a study of leadership roles, conflict resolution patterns, informal
counseling, and the decision making process.
Speech 210 Public Speaking
3 credits
A study of theories and ethics of persuasion. Practice in the art of speaking to
persuade or actuate. Prerequisite: Speech JOO or instructor's approval.
Speech 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Research or other creative projects within a speech communication discipline.
Department approval necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
61
DEPARTMENT OF FOREIGN LANGUAGES
German 101, 102, 103 Elementary German
4 credits per course
Fundamentals of grammar, vocabulary, pronounciation, writing, reading and
speaking; reading of some simple German prose and poetry. Prerequisite:
completion of or concurrent registration in English 111.
German 201, 202, 203 Intermediate German
3 credits per course
Review of Elementary German and further study of literary selections; emphasis
is on speaking, reading and writing German during the winter and spring terms.
Prerequisite: German 101, 102, 103 or two years of high school German or
instructor's approval.
German 210 Directed Readings in German
2 credits per term
(maximum 6 credits)
Students become familiar with selected works of German literature, and increase
their reading speed and comprehension of German. Department approval
necessary.
German 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special study programs to fit students' needs and interests. May be taken any
term. Department approval necessary.
5 credits per course
Greek 101, 102, 103 Elementary Greek
Theoretical and practical study of elementary Greek grammar; readings and
parsing of selections from the Book of Acts and other selections. Instructor's
approval necessary for first year students.
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Greek 300 Independent Study
Special study programs to fit students' needs and interests. Department approval
necessary.
Additional Languages-Arrangements can be made for the study of other
languages, such as Spanish, French, and Russian if students can provide their own
transportation. Interested students should contact the Academic Dean.
62
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
111. DIVISION OF SOCIAL SCIENCE
DEPARTMENT OF HISTORY, POLITICAL SCIENCE AND GEOGRAPHY
History 102 History of Ancient Israel
3 credits
Survey of the history of Ancient Israel and the development of the religious
insight of the Hebrew people. Attention also is given to the importance of
Mesopotamia and Egyptian contributions to the literature of the Bible. Student
may not receive credit for both O.T. 102 and History 102.
History 111 History of Ancient Greece
3 credits
Survey of Greek history and culture from the Minoan period through Hellenistic
times.
History 112 History of Ancient Rome
3 credits
Survey of Roman history and culture from prehistoric times through the late
Roman Empire.
3 credits
History 113 History of Medieval Europe
Survey of European civilization from the transformation of the Roman Empire
through the fifteenth century.
History 121, 122, 123 History of Western Civilization
3 credits per course
Survey of the development and accomplishments of Western Civilization with
emphasis on institutional, intellectual and spiritual aspects. Fall term: Late
Medieval, Renaissance and Reformation. Winter term: Early Modern Europe.
Spring term; Modern Europe in a World Setting.
History 201, 202, 203 History of the United States
3 credits per course
Survey of the history of the American people with primary emphasis on their
social, intellectual, political, and economic growth. Fall: Pre-Colonial through
Early National Period; Winter: War of 1812through Reconstruction; Spring: 1877
to the present.
History 230 Topics in History
3 credits
Topics in history of special interest to students and instructors, such as the history
of women, ethnic histories, period histories, movement studies or institutional
histories. Prerequisite: Relevant survey course or consent of instructor.
History 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special historical periods and problems; research into particular areas of student
interest. May be taken any term. Department approval necessary.
Political Science 100 American Government and Politics
3 credits
Study of the principles and structure of Federal Government in the United States
and of political issues of the current scene.
Political Science 200 Modern Political Thought
3 credits
Comparative study of Communism, Fascism and Modern Capitalism in the light
of the contemporary Christian thought.
Political Science 210 Topics in Political Science
3 credits
Topics in political science of special interest to students and instructors, such as
comparative political thought, practical politics, foundations of democratic
thought or study of political institutions. Prerequisite: Relevant survey course or
instructor's approval.
Political Science 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Research into special areas of student interest. May be taken any term. Department approval necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
63
Geography 100 Human Geography
3 credits
Survey of the basic tools and concepts of geography and the distribution patterns
of physical and human environment, plus emphasis on selected areas.
Geography 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special interests and area studies. May be taken any term. Department approval
necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF PHILOSOPHY AND HUMANITIES
Philosophy 101 Introduction to Philosophy
3 credits
Introduction to the functions and problems of philosophy with more detailed
consideration of the problems of knowledge, existence, freedom, good and evil.
Philosophy 102 Ethics
3 credits
Study of the reality of conscience and the implications of Christian faith for
ethical standards of conduct as related to self, family, society, church and state.
Emphasis is placed on students' practical questions concerning right and wrong.
Philosophy 103 Logic
3 credits
A study of the principles of correct reasoning with emphasis on the recognition
and assessment of arguments. Equal consideration is given to informal and formal
logic.
Philosophy 200 Topics in Philosophy
3 credits
Philosophical problems and topics of special interest to particular students.
Philosophy 201, 202, 203 History of Western Philosophy
3 credits per course
Survey of the important men and movements in the development of philosophical thought from the Greeks to the present. Fall term: Ancient philosophy.
Winter term: Medieval philosophy. Spring term: Modern philosophy. Offered
alternate years.
Philosophy 211, 212, 213 Philosophy of
Non-Christian Religions
3 credits per course
A study of the philosophical systems of the major religions of the world, exclusive
of Christianity. Fall: Introduction to Philosophy of Religion, African and other
traditional religions, Islam; Winter: Review of Philosophy of Religion, Judaism;
Spring: Eastern religions (Hinduism, Shinto, Taoism, Confucianism) with special
emphasis on Buddhism.
Philosophy 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Study of special philosophical problems or areas appropriate to the students'
needs and interests. Department approval necessary.
Humanities 200 Travel and Study
1 to 3 elective credits
Cultural enrichment through travel. Tours guided or arranged by faculty
members. Substantial papers and reports required. Normally this course counts
as elective credit. Credits may be used to fulfill divisional requirements upon
divisional approval.
64
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
DEPARTMENT OF PSYCHOLOGY AND PERSONAL ORIENTATION
Psychology 120 Psychology of Adjustment
3 credits
Development of a knowledge of psychology that will be useful in attaining more
effective personal living and relationships with other people.
Psychology 202, 203, General Psychology
3 credits per course
Study of the more significant facts and principles in the field of human behavior,
provides a basic introduction to several areas of specialization in psychology.
Prerequisite for Psychology 203: Psychology 202.
Psychology 210 Child Development
3 credits
Study of human growth and development from conception through preadolescence. Review of research and theories. Prerequisite: Two or more terms
of college work completed or instructor's approval.
Psychology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Designed for students who wish to investigate special interests. May be taken any
term. Department approval necessary.
Personal Orientation 100 Individual Work in College Study Skills
one credit per term for junior College Certificate only.
Arranged on an individual basis for students desiring to work on a single aspect of
study skills, mathematics, reading, spelling or vocabulary development. Laboratory
sessions in the skills center.
Personal Orientation 110 Efficient Reading
1 elective credit
Arranged on an individual basis to enable students to develop skills in
vocabulary, reading comprehension, and reading rate for success in college and
later life. Laboratory sessions in the skills center.
Personal Orientation 120 College Vocabulary Development 2 elective credits
Designed to introduce students to basic principles of vocabulary development.
Aimed at general vocabulary as well as the specific vocabularies of various
academic disciplines.
Personal Orientation 130 How to Study in College
1 elective credit
Practice of methods of study developed from information based on research and
student experience. Concerned with efficient and effective methods of concentration, use of time, taking lecture notes, textbook reading, organizing
material, preparing for and taking examinations.
Personal Orientation 160 Fundamentals of Spelling
1 elective credit
Designed to provide the student with a systematic approach to spelling; the
course will utilize a self-paced, audio-tutorial format.
Personal Orientation 170 The Research Paper
1 or 2 elective credits
Designed to provide the student with the skills necessary to create a research
paper; the course will utilize the self-paced, audio-tutorial format. The end result
of the course will be the production of a research paper for another class.
Prerequisite: English 111 or instructor's permission. Laboratory sessions in the skills
center.
Personal Orientation 200 Career and life Planning
2 elective credits
Designed to teach skills for making career decisions appropriate to the student's
values, needs, aptitudes, skills or talents, interests and goals. Laboratory sessions
in the library.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
65
DEPARTMENT OF SOCIOLOGY, SOCIAL SERVICE AND ANTHROPOLOGY
Sociology 100 Introduction to Sociology
3 credits
Study of the structures and functions of society and culture as seen through
sociological perspectives; focus is on selected problems, social organizations and
socialization in the context of change.
Sociology 110 Social Problems
3 credits
Survey of contemporary social problems with development of the students'
understanding of the processes involved in historical, social and cultural change.
Sociology 120 Marriage and Family
3 credits
Study of the life cycle, mate selection, marital adjustment and parent-child
relationships; to provide practical help for those interested in preparing for
marriage from a Christian point of view.
Sociology 130 Urban Field Experience
1 elective credit per course
(maximum 3 credits)
Combines theoretical and practical knowledge and experience designed to
orient students to the urban setting. Different offerings of the course will focus
on different topics. Hours arranged for lectures and laboratory periods.
Sociology 210 The Urban Center
3 credits
Introduction to the problems of modern cities, urban ecology, urban institutions
and the urban way of life. Prerequisite: Sociology 100 or instructor's approval.
Offered alternate years.
Sociology 212 Minority Group Relations
3 credits
Study of minority groups, especially Native and Black Americans, and the
problems of the contemporary scene. Prerequisite: Sociology 100 or instructor's
approval. Offered alternate years.
Sociology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special sociological problems and areas of study to fit the students' interests. May
be taken any term. Department approval necessary.
Social Service, 101, 102, 103, 104, 201, 202, 203, 204 Internship 1-3 credits per term
Practical experience and observation in working with social service agencies;
orientation and help in choosing vocational goals in different areas of social
service. Designed for the Social Service Curriculum.
Anthropology 100 Introduction to Physical Anthropology and Archaeology
3 credits
Survey of the field of physical anthropology and the archaeological methods
used in the study of prehistory. Offered alternate years.
Anthropology 110 Introduction to Cultural Anthropology
3 credits
Survey of the field of cultural anthropology with the study of the varieties of the
human race, their origins, cultural characteristics, and spiritual orientation.
Offered alternate years.
Anthropology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special anthropological problems and areas of study to fit the students' interests.
Department approval necessary.
66
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
IV. DIVISION OF MATHEMATICS, NATURAL SCIENCES, AND
COMPUTER SCIENCE
DEPARTMENT OF MATHEMATICS
Mathematics 100 Basic Algebra
1 credit for
junior College Certificate only
Review of arithmetic, factoring, the fundamental algebraic operations, rational
expressions, linear equations, roots and radicals, quadratic equations. Class
meets three hours per week.
Mathematics 101 Intermediate Algebra
3 elective credits
Introduction to basic mathematical concepts, sets, the number system, factoring,
fractions, inequalities, linear, and quadratic equations. Students are required to
attend three hours of class and an additional fourth hour each week in the skills
center. Prerequisite: one year of high school algebra.
Mathematics 102 College Algebra
5 credits
Algebraic operations with real numbers, linear and quadratic functions, polynomials, combinations, binomial theorem, probability, mathematical induction, analytic geometry, matrices and determinants. Prerequisite: Mathematics
101 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 103 Pre-Calculus
4 credits
Functions and inverse functions, exponential and logarithmic functions, trigonometric functions and trigonometric identities, solution of triangles, complex
numbers, polar coordinates and analytic geometry. Prerequisite: Mathematics
102 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 110 Introductory Statistics
4 credits
Study of basic statistical concepts: probability, sampling, normal distribution,
statistical estimation, and hypothesis testing. Problems are applied in the fields of
business, social and physical sciences. Prerequisite: Mathematics 101 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 120 Finite Mathematics
5 credits
Computing with BASIC computer language. Principles of counting and probability, business mathematics, matrices and inverse matrices, Markov chains,
linear programming including simplex method. Prerequisite: Mathematics 101 or
instructor's approval.
Mathematics 200 Elements of Calculus
5 credits
A short course with applications in biology, business and social sciences. Short
review of algebra. Continuity and the limit of a function. Derivative and its
interpretation, maximum and minimum problems, antiderivative, the definite
integral, exponential and logarithmic functions, functions of several variables.
Prerequisite: Mathematics 102 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 201 Calculus I
5 credits
Short review of algebra, introduction to plane analytic geometry. The derivatives
of functions and their applications. The integration of simpler functions and the
applications. Prerequisite: Mathematics 103 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 202 Calculus II
5 credits
Differentiation and integration of trigonometric and logarithmic functions.
Techniques of integration: by parts, by change, of variable, by approximation
methods, etc. Parametric equations and polar coordinates. Applications to
geometrical and physical problems. Prerequisite: Mathematics 201 or instructor's
approval.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
67
Mathematics 203 Calculus Ill
5 credits
Vector treatment of three-dimensional analytic geometry, functions of two or
m~re variables, multiple integrals, indeterminate forms, infinite series, and
differential equations. Applications. Prererequisite: Mathematics 202 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects and problems for advanced students. Department approval
necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF PHYSICS
Physics 100 Environmental Physics
4 credits
Survey of physics as related to the environment and everyday experiences of the
physical world. The concepts in mechanics, heat, sound, light and atomic physics
are developed non-mathematically. One double laboratory per week is devoted
to student projects or to experiments in the laboratory. Primarily for non-science
majors. No prerequisite.
Physics 102 General Physics I
5 credits
Study of physical principles in mechanics, fluids, wave motion, and heat, with
applications to practical situations. Demonstration lectures and problem sessions. One double laboratory period per week. Primarily for students in science
or in various technical areas. Prerequisite: Mathematics 101 or instructor's
approval.
Physics 103 General Physics II
5 credits
The fundamental physical concepts in electricity, magnetism, optics, and nuclear
physics will be studied using practical applications. Demonstration lectures and
problem sessions. One double laboratory period per week. Primarily for students
in science or in technical areas. Prerequisite: Physics 102 or instructor's approval.
Physics 120 Field Experience in Physics 1 credit per course (maximum 4 credits)
Hours arranged for lecture and laboratory periods.
Physics 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects and problems for advanced students. Department approval
necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF BIOLOGY
Biology 111 Life Studies 1
4 credits
Introduction to biology - life versus non-life, cellular design and process,
organism types (unity amidst complexity), energy sources, yields, and efficiencies
in life systems. One lecture period, two discussions and one two-hour research
laboratory weekly.
Biology 112 Life Studies II
4 credits
The individual life pattern - cell regulation and division, sex cell formation and
union, genetics and embryology, intercellular effects and immune response,
physiology and neuromechanisms. One lecture period, two discussions and one
two-hourresearch laboratory weekly.
Biology 113 Environmental Biology
4 credits
Traces exploration - conservation - ecology - consciousness through perspectives of behavior, populations, ecosystems and biosphere understanding
and application. One lecture period, two discussions and one two-hour
research laboratory weekly.
68
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Biology 114 Field Ecology
4 credits per term
An ecosystem approach to the local flora and fauna of selected geographic areas.
Hours arranged for lecture and laboratory periods.
Biology 120 Field Experience in Biology 1 credit per course (maximum 4 credits)
Combines theoretical and practical knowledge and e>,<perience designed to
provide career guidance and development to better direct educational and
occupational planning. Hours arranged for lecture and laboratory periods.
Biology 121 Plant Studies
4 credits
The study of plant cells and tissues with a survey of the major phyla of the nonvascular plants and their adaptions to the environment. Some field studies and
taxonomy of the local trees and fall flowers. Two lectures and two double
laboratory periods per week.
Biology 213 Introduction to Botany
4 credits
The study of major phyla of vascular plants and plant growth, regulations,
reproduction and photosynthesis. This course will give experience in the green
house environment. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111or112 or 113 or instructor's approval.
Biology 223 Introduction to Ecology
4 credits
The study of the structure and function of an ecosystem with field studies of at
least two major ecosystems. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per
week. Prerequisite: Biology 111 or 112 or 113 or instructor's approval.
Biology 231 Microbiology
4 credits
Practical application of bacteriological techniques in analyzing disease parameters, public health measures, agricultural and industrial usefulness of the
smallest life systems. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111 or concurrent registration in Biology 111 or instructor's
approval.
Biology 232 Anatomy
4 credits
Gross and microscopic structure of the human body from a functional standpoint
utilizing charts, models, skeletons and manikins. Cat dissection to demonstrate
mammalian anatomy. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111 or 112 or instructor's approval.
Biology 233 Physiology
4 credits
Organ systems of the human body. Laboratory exercises include blood typing,
recording of the heart beat, respiration, muscle contraction, experiments on
digestion, urinalysis, coordinated with a brief study of the anatomy of each
system. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per week. Prerequisite:
Biology 232, or instructor's approval.
Biology 242 Animal Studies
4 credits
A study of the diversity and hetertrophic way of life of animals common to this
area. Two lectures and two double laboratory periods per week. Prerequisite:
Biology 111 or instructor's approval.
Biology 243 Genetics
4 credits
An introductory course in the principles of heredity will begin with Mendelian
genetics, and then progress to cell division and reproduction, molecular
structure, DNA, protein synthesis, gene expression, mutagenesis, and conclude
with population genetics, genetic engineering, and variabilities. Emphasis will be
on human inheritance. Three lectures and one double laboratory period per
week. Prerequisite: Biology 111 or instructor's approval.
Biology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
69
DEPARTMENT OF CHEMISTRY
Chemistry 100 Environmental Chemistry
4 credits
Study of the environment and the role chemistry plays in life. Topics of current
interest such as storage of atomic wastes, food additives, air pollution, solid
wastes and the development of the environment are discussed, along with the
chemical principles required for a more thorough understanding of them. Three
lectures and one double laboratory period per week. Primarily for non-science
majors. No prerequisite.
Chemistry 101, 102, 103 General Chemistry
4 credits per course
Chemistry 101 is introductory, including measurement, reactions, stiochiometry,
atom structure, molecule bonding and structure, equilibrium, acids and pH.
Chemistry 102 has topics of states of matter, periodic table and properties of
elements, industrial applications, organic and biochemistry. Chemistry 103
stresses environmental concerns, redox and electrochemistry, chemical analysis,
nuclear chemistry, energy, and consumer chemistry. Laboratory sessions
parallel the lecture topics, with experiments on measurement, scientific method,
separations, equilibrium, acid-base, electrochemistry, polyrf\ers, organic reactions, biochemistry, gas laws, qualitative analysis of ions, and water analysis for
dissolved oxygen and hardness. Chemistry 101, 102, 103 must be taken in
sequence. Three lectures and one double period of laboratory per week.
Chemistry 201, 202, 203, Organic Chemistry
4 credits per course
Study of structure, reactions and nomenclature of both aliphatic and aromatic
hydrocarbons, halides, alcohols, ethers, carboxylic acids, aldehydes, ketones,
and amines. The latter part of the course deals with larger functional groups such
as keto acids, etc. Considerable time will be spent on l.R. spectra and N.M.R.
spectra to help identify compounds. Three lectures and one double lab per week.
Prerequisite for Chemistry 201 is Chemistry 103 or instructor's approval.
Chemistry 201, 202, 203 must be taken in sequence.
Chemistry 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF COMPUTER SCIENCE
3 credits
An introduction to computers, the role of computers, current uses in business
and education, and functions in terms of hardware and software.
Computer Science 170 Introduction to Programming-Basic
3 credits
Fundamentals of programming with emphasis on the logical processes necessary
for the use of computers. Students work with computers, programs and the
construction of algorithms. Basic language. Laboratory sessions. Prerequisite:
Math 102 or concurrent registration in Math 102 or instructor's approval.
Computer Science 210 Structured Programming Techniques-Pascal
3 credits
Structured programming, file management, variable types, and algorithm
realizations. Laboratory sessions. Prerequisite: Computer Science 160 or 170 or
instructor's approval.
Computer Science 220 Advanced Programming
3 credits
Topics include data base management, real time systems, engineering and
business applications. Pascal and Fortran. Laboratory sessions. Prerequisite:
Computer Science 210 or instructor's approval.
Computer Science 160 Introduction to Computer Science
70
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
V. DIVISION OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND
RECREATION LEADERSHIP
DEPARTMENT OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION
Physical Education 101, 102, 103 (Activity Courses)
1 credit per course
Fall
Winter
Spring
101E Bowling
102R Badminton
103L Baseball
1011 Conditioning
102B Basketball
103E Bowling
102E Bowling
101] Cross Country
1031 Conditioning
101A Football
1021 Conditioning
103W Golf
101 N Karate
102Q Cross Country Skiing
103N Karate
101 S Soccer
102V Volleyball
103X Softball
101D Swimming
103D Swimming
101T Tennis
103T Tennis
101V Volleyball
103U Track
Physical Education 110 Introduction to Physical Education
3 credits
Study of physical education and athletics in the schools, and the philosophy and
basic principles of physical education and recreation leadership.
Physical Education 120 Health and First Aid
3 credits
Study of modern concepts and practices of health applied to the individual and
community. Also includes the American Red Cross First Aid Course.
Physical Education 130 Drugs and Chemical Dependency
2 credits
Study of the personal use and misuse of dependency on tobacco, alcohol, drugs
and other chemicals. Identification of users and information regarding the
resources and help available to people. Designed to meet certification requirements.
Physical Education 140 Cardiopulmonary Resuscitation (CPR) 1 elective credit
The procedure used when cardiac arrest occurs. Course includes instruction and
Official Certification in the skills of CPR.
Physical Education 150 Advanced First Aid
3 credits
Offered for Law Enforcement students as a part of the curriculum required by the
Minnesota Board of Peace Officers Standards and Training. Includes the practices
and procedures for advanced first aid, CPR, and rescue methods and techniques.
Class meets 40-50 hours per term.
Physical Education 160 Football Officiating
1 elective credit
Philosophy, principles and problems of officiating at football games. Interpretations of game rules and officiating procedures. One lecture period per week.
Additional hours arranged by the instructor.
Physical Education 170 Basketball Officiating
1 elective credit
Philosophy, principles and problems of officiating at basketball games. Interpretations of game rules and officiating procedures. One lecture period per
week. Additional hours arranged by the instructor.
Physical Education 180 Baseball and Softball Officiating
1 elective credit
Philosophy, principles and problems of officiating at baseball and softball games.
Interpretations of game rules and officiating procedures. One lecture period per
week. Additional hours arranged by the instructor.
Physical Education 200 Individual and Dual Sports
3 credits
Study of theory and practice in teaching and officiating individual and dual
sports.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
Physical Education 210 Team Sports
71
3 credits
Study of theory and practice in teaching and officiating team sports.
Physical Education 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF RECREATION LEADERSHIP
Recreation Leadership 110 Introduction to Recreation and Park Leadership
3 credits
Examination of the history and development of park and recreation movement;
professional and service organizations; orientation to the professional field.
Recreation Leadership 120 Introduction to Recreation Programming
3 credits
Introduction to the directing and leading of recreation work and the writing of
recreation programs. (YMCA, YWCA, Boy Scouts,' Girl Scouts, churches, community centers, etc.)
Recreation Leadership 210 Camp Craft
3 credits
Basic skills and practical experience in various phases of camping and outdoor
education.
Recreation Leadership 220 Leadership in Social Activities
3 credits
Techniques of leadership in social games, parties and outings.
Recreation Leadership 230 Internship
1 to 3 elective credits per course
Practical experience under the direction of full-time workers in the fields of
parks, recreation management and Y.M.C.A.-Y.W.C.A.
72
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
VI. DIVISION OF CREATIVE ARTS
DEPARTMENT OF ART
Art 100 Introduction to Visual Arts
3 credits
Introduction to visual art through the study of aesthetics, philosophy, techniques
and history of art. Includes attending art exhibits and other cultural events and
researching personal ideas as they relate to the world of art.
Art 101, 102, 103 Art History of the Western World
3 credits per course
Survey of painting, sculpture and architecture as they relate to history and
culture in the Western world. Fall Term: Pre-history to Early Christian. Winter
Term: Middle Ages to Baroque. Spring Term: Nineteenth Century to Present.
Offered alternaie years.
Art 110 Two Dimensional Design
3 credits
A basic study of the principles of design together with the discovery of design
sources in nature.
Art 121 Basic Drawing
3 credits
Exploration and use of various drawing materials and methods. Emphasis on
the development of visual perception and personal aesthetics.
Art 122 Drawing
3 credits
An extension of Art 121 with more extensive experiences in the manipulation
of visual elements and pictorial structure. Prerequisite: Art 121 or instructor's
approval.
Art 123 Drawing
3 credits
Continuation of Art 121 and 122. Students learn to see design and form
relationships and experiment with a variety of drawing media. Subject matter
includes still life and the figure. Prerequisite Art 122 or instructor's approval.
Art 130 Printmaking
3 credits
An exploration and study of wood and other materials for making prints in
monochrome and color.
Art 140 Watercolor
3 credits
An introduction to the watercolor medium with emphasis on compositional and
technical problems. Subject matter includes still life and landscape.
Art 202, 203 Painting
3 credits per course
Basic experiences in the use of oil and acrylic to acquaint the student with the
mediums and to encourage the development of personal imagery and technique. Prerequisite: Art 121 or instructor's approval.
Art 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special study for advanced students based upon the proposal of the student in
consultation with the instructor. Department approval required.
DEPARTMENT OF MUSIC
Music 100 Introduction to Music
3 credits
The development of perceptive listening through the study of representative
musical works, their styles, structure and relationship to cultural history. Primarily
for non-music majors.
Music 111,112, 113 Theory
4 credits per course
Course sequence in music theory developing the student's knowledge and skills
in part writing, keyboard sight-singing and ear-training. Includes studies of the
science of sound, the rudiments of music, intervals, triads and inversions,
survey of non-harmonic tones and seventh chords. Music 111, 112, 113 must be
taken in sequence.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
Music 121, 122, 123 History of Music
73
3 credits per course
Survey of musical thought and achievement from primitive origins to the
twentieth century. Intended for music majors but may be taken by any student
upon approval of the instructor. Offered alternate years.
Music 131, 132, Choral Conducting
2 credits per course
Study of the fundamentals of conducting with practical experience in conducting
student ensembles. Includes studies of vocal problems, score and clef reading,
baton technique and transpositions. Meets three periods per week. Offered
alternate years.
2 credits
Music 133 Instrumental Conducting
Study of the fundamentals of conducting with practical experience in conducting
student ensembles. Includes studies of instrumental problems, score and clef
reading, baton technique and transpositions. Meets three periods per week.
Offered alternate years.
Music 211, 212, 213 Advanced Theory
4 credits per course
Study of Baroque composition including detailed study of non-harmonic tones,
seventh chords, altered chords, modal harmony and two-, three-, four-part
counterpoint. Also includes a survey of music styles from the Baroque to the
present with a concentration on twentieth century techniques of music composition. Prerequisite: Music 111, 112, 113 or instructor's approval. Music 211, 212,
213 must be taken in sequence.
Music 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. May be taken any term. Department
approval necessary.
APPLIED MUSIC
Applied Music 110A Voice Lessons
1 credit per term
Study of vocal technique and literature. Emphasis on sacred literature including
oratorio, with time devoted to Italian and German art songs. One half-hour
lesson per week.
Applied Music 1108 Piano Lessons
1 credit per term
Instruction in piano performance, including study of techniques through scales,
arpeggios and other exercises. One half-hour lesson per week.
Applied Music 110C Organ Lessons
1 credit per term
Graded course in organ playing beginning with study .of manual and pedal
techniques. Literature studies include examples from all periods of music.
Renaissance to Neo-Classic. Service playing problems also are studied. One halfhour lesson per week.
Applied Music 1100 Brass Lessons
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a brass instrument. One half-hour lesson per week.
Applied Music 110E Percussion Lessons
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a percussion instrument or instruments. One half-hour
lesson per week.
Applied Music 110F String Lessons
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a string instrument. One half-hour lesson per week.
Applied Music 110G Woodwind Lessons
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a woodwind instrument. One half-hour lesson per week.
Applied Music 110H Guitar Lessons
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on guitar. One half-hour lesson per week.
74
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Applied Music 110P Piano Class Lessons
1 credit per term
Basic keyboard skills and music reading, designed for the adult beginner with little or
no background. ~v1eets 2 periods pei vveek.
Applied Music 110V Voice Class Lessons
1 credit per term
A study of basic vocal techniques of singing. Songs and other materials used will
be suited to the individual student. This class is intended for the beginner as well
as students preparing for private study. It is open to music majors and anyone
interested in developing their vocal abilities. Meets 2 periods per week.
ENSEMBLES
Music Ensemble 110A Golden Valley Lutheran College Choir 1 credit per term
Open to all students by audition, but limited to 65 members. Examples from all
periods of music literature are selected for performance. Besides numerous
concerts in and around the Twin City area, an extended tour is made each spring.
The choir meets four periods per week.
Music Ensemble 110B Golden Valley Singers
1 credit per term
Open to all women students of the College. Study and presentation of treble
choral music, both accompanied and a cappella. The chorus meets four periods
per week.
Music Ensemble 110C The Madrigal Singers
1 credit per term
Students are selected from the Golden Valley Lutheran College Choir. Literature
used includes Madrigal and Carol. Numerous concerts are given through the
year.
Music Ensemble 1100 Symphonic Choir
)12 credit per term
Open to all members of the student body and the community.
Music Ensemble 110H Band
1 credit per term
Open to all college students by audition. The group performs literature from all
eras and styles. A tour is organized each year. The band performs regularly for
College convocations and presents formal concerts each quarter. The stage band
is formed from this group. The band meets four periods per week.
Music Ensemble 1101 College-Community Orchestra
1 credit per term
Open to all qualified students and community members by audition. The
orchestra performs standard orchestral literature each quarter in addition to
accompanying the College choirs at Christmas.
Small Ensembles
1 credit per term
Students are given the opportunity to participate in small instrumental ensembles.
The ensembles perform regularly for convocations, concerts and at local church
services. Membership is by audition or consent of director.
Music Ensemble 110J Brass Ensemble
Music Ensemble 110K Percussion Ensemble
Music Ensemble 110L Stage Band
Music Ensemble 110M String Ensemble
Music Ensemble 110N Woodwind Ensemble
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
75
DEPARTMENT OF THEATRE
Theatre 100 Introduction to Theatre
3 credits
Stu·dy of Theatre as a performing art. The aesthetic function of theatre and its role
in Western culture will be discussed, as well as the role and function of the various
theatre artists such as actor, director, and designer.
Theatre 110 Beginning Acting
3 credits
An experiential course which focuses on honesty in characterization through
various means including theatre games, improvisation, and the development of
scenes.
Theatre 120 Theatre Practice
1 elective credit per term (maximum: 3 credits)
Participation in College sponsored theatre productions. Open to students
assigned performing or technical roles. Instructor's approval required.
Theatre 130 Elements of Technical Theatre
4 credits
A basic introduction to both design theory and design execution in the theatre.
Emphasis placed on the technical aspects of scene design, lighting, costuming
and sound. Prerequisite: Theatre 100 or instructor's approval.
Theatre 200 History of Theatre
3 credits
An examination of the phenomenon of Theatre Arts from a historical perspective. Emphasis will be placed on a particular period. The historical development
of both dramatic literature and staging techniques will be examined, as well as the
influence of other historical events upon them. Prerequisite: Theatre 100
or instructor's approval.
Theatre 210 Advanced Acting
3 credits
Intense scene study directed toward the development of a personal technique of
honest characterization through various periods and styles of plays. Prerequisite:
Theatre 110 or instructor's approval.
Theatre 220 Directing for the Theatre
4 credits
An introduction to the role and function of the director in modern theatre.
Emphasis will be placed on the elements of the director's craft as well as his
relationship to the other theatre artists. Preparation of scenes and exercises will
culminate in a final scene or a short one-act play. Prerequisite: Theatre 100 &
Theatre 110 or instructor's approval.
Theatre 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects for advanced students of research projects within selected
theatre disciplines. Department approval necessary.
76
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
VII. DIVISION OF BUSINESS AND VOCATIONAL STUDIES
DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS
Business 100 Computer Keyboarding
1 credit
Introductory keyboarding theory designed for students in computer science or
general education.
Business 101 Accounting I
4 credits
Study of fundamental principles and procedures of accounting; classifying and
reporting data on balance sheets and income statements.
Business 102 Accounting 11
4 credits
Continuation of Accounting I; analyzing financial statements and analytical
functions of accounting; partnership and corporate accounting. Prerequisite:
Business 101 or instructor's approval.
Business 103 Accounting 111
4 credits
Accounting as a planning and controlling tool in the decision-making process of
management; funds statements; cost accounting: job order and process cost.
Prerequisite: Business 102 or instructor's approval.
Business 110 Personal Finance
3 credits
Fundamental concepts of personal financial management: insurance, budgeting,
credit, savings, investments, retirement and estate problems and consumer
concerns. General Education course open to all students.
Business 120 Introduction to Business
3 credits
A survey of the ownership, organization, management, major functions, environment, and ethics of American business. Aimed at assisting students to
establish more specific career goals in the field of business. General Education
course open to all students.
Business 140 Business Mathematics
3 credits
Application of mathematical skills to practical business situations. Topics include:
fundamentals review, percentages, interest, discounts, payroll, taxes, profits,
losses, stocks, bonds, and insurance.
Business 150 Business Communications
3 credits
General principles of effective communication in business; writing of various
types of business letters and reports; stress on vocabulary and the mechanics of
language as applied to writing business reports and letters.
Business 200 Principles of Economics - Macroeconomics
4 credits
National income economics, gross national product, indicators of economic
activity, the money and banking system, monetary and fiscal policies to fight
inflation and unemployment, principles of world economics, international trade,
and the balance of payments.
Business 210 Principles of Economics - Microeconomics
4 credits
Supply, demand and price, competition, monopoly, oligopoly, and anti-trust
policy. Pricing of the factors of production and distribution of income. Prerequisite: Business 200 or instructor's approval.
Business 230 Legal Environment
3 credits
The study and discussion of the various legal institutions and principles which
may effect an individual within society.
Business 270 Marketing
3 credits
Examination of the total marketing process, including the distribution of goods
and services from producer to consumer; processes of retailing, wholesaling,
pricing and government regulations. Offered alternate years.
Business 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
77
DEPARTMENT OF SECRETARIAL SCIENCE
3 credits
Secretarial Science 101 Personal Typewriting
Mastery of the keyboard and proper technique of typewriting. Not open to
students with one year of high school typing except by instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 102 Typewriting II
4 credits
Students build speed and accuracy in straight-copy typing, and increase their
skills in composition, rough-draft typing, editing production and analysis of the
following components of typewriting communication: business letters, memos,
manuscripts, business reports, business forms and tables. Prerequisite: Secretarial
Science 101 or instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 103 Executive Typewriting
4 credits
This course emphasizes performance at the executive level requiring sustained
high-level production speed with the ability to edit, organize, solve problems
and produce high-quality work. Speed and accuracy in straight-copy and
production work are stressed. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science 102 or instructor's
approval.
Secretarial Science 110 Accounting Fundamentals
4 credits
General office accounting procedures; payroll records, tax records, records of a
physician and an attorney. Practice Set which will include basic accounting cycle.
General Education course open to all students.
Secretarial Science 111 Elementary Shorthand
4 credits
Fundamentals of Forkner Shorthand Theory for beginning students or for
students who have had less than one year of Forkner or Gregg Shorthand.
Secretarial Science 112 Intermediate Shorthand
4 credits
Emphasis on speed, accuracy and vocabulary. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science
111 or instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 113 Advanced Shorthand
4 credits
Advanced dictation and transcription. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science 112 or
instructor's approva I.
Secretarial Science 122 Machine Calculation
3 credits
Instruction in the use of electronic printing calculators, electronic display
calculators, plus study of practical business computations.
Secretarial Science 212 Introduction to Word Processing
2 credits
Introductory concepts of word ·processing with practical exercises in entering,
editing, and printing letters and manuscripts using a word processing program.
Secretarial Science 213 Shorthand Transcription
2 credits
Refresher course for Gregg and Forkner students with emphasis on speed
building and transcription techniques. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science 113 or
instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 220 Supervised Work Experience 1 elective credit per term
Credit for work experience in an office-type environment. Students must
register during quarter in which they receive credit. Applications must be
approved by secretarial science department in advance.
Secretarial Science 221 Medical Terminology
2 credits
Study of medical terms used in the branches of medicine; emphasis on prefixes
and suffixes; use of medical reference books.
Secretarial Science 231 legal Terminology
2 credits
Study of legal terms used in probate, real estate, litigations, wills, estates,
partnerships and corporations.
78
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Secretarial Science 242 Administrative Office Procedures
4 credits
A study of office duties, responsibilities, activities and procedures with emphasis
on obtaining a job, records management (filing) and business attitudes. Individualized
instruction in specialized areas including medical, legal, and general office
procedures.
Secretarial Science 243 Specialized Machine Transcription
4 credits
Individualized machine transcription for general, medical, and legal specialties.
Secretarial Science 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF LAW ENFORCEMENT
Law Enforcement 100 Introduction to Criminal Justice
3 credits
Survey of the history and principles of law enforcement in American society, the
criminal justice system, courts, state and federal agencies.
Law Enforcement 110 Law Enforcement Operations and Procedures
3 credits
An overview of the relationships between the police and community and the era
of crime prevention, the elements of verbal and non-verbal communication, and
their role in effective law enforcement procedure.
Law Enforcement 120 Juvenile Problems & Justice
3 credits
An overview of the principles of the juvenile justice system, its laws, problems,
and procedures.
Law Enforcement 130 Criminal Evidence and Procedure
3 credits
Criminal evidence for police, types of evidence, criminal procedures in various
courts, arrest, search and seizure, collection of evidence, interviews and line-up
procedure.
Law Enforcement 150 Criminal Law
3 credits
The development, application and enforcement of local, state and federal laws
that deal with criminal behavior, including a study of the Minnesota Criminal
Code.
Law Enforcement 160 Constitutional Law
3 credits
Study and analysis of the United States Constitution and its amendments that
pertain to law enforcement. Also studied are Federal and State legal decisions
that apply to law enforcement problems.
Law Enforcement 170 Psychology for Law Enforcement
3 credits
An introduction to the psychological aspects of the law enforcement profession
with particular attention to the personal and professional adjustments demanded
by this career.
Law Enforcement 180 Report Writing 2 credits
Interviews and Interrogation
Designed for law enforcement students. The course will have intensive work in
the techniques of interviewing and interrogations, field note taking, criminal
investigative and follow-up report writing.
Law Enforcement 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Special projects and research into areas of student interest in the fields of law
enforcement. Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF APPLIED CHRISTIANITY
Christian Service 110A, 1108, 110C Christian Service Projects
1 credit per course per term
Student assignments to various projects provide in-service training in various
phases of Christian work. Regular reports to the department are required.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
79
Applied Christianity 122, 123 Christian Education
3 credits per course
Winter term: Study of the human relations of the teaching-learning process,
acquaintance with the age of ability differences, and individual potential of
children. An in-depth child study will be made by each student. Spring term:
Study of the objectives of Christian Education and practice of teaching methods.
Applied Christianity 130 Youth Leadership
3 credits
Study of the needs and goals of youth leadership in the church, and of the
philosophies, organizational structures, resources and materials of the youth
organizations and departments of the major Lutheran synods.
Applied Christianity 150 Evangelism
3 credits
The evangelical task of the church is recognized as of prime importance, and the
responsibility of the individual Christian to personalize the Gospel within the
parish and community is stressed.
Applied Christianity 201, 202, 203 Christian Education Project
1/2 to 11/ 2 credits per term (3 cr~dits required).
Classroom orientation and practical teaching experience under supervision.
Applied Christianity 211 Christian Education Seminar
3 credits
Study of materials available in the field of Christian Education; discussion of
teaching experiences (Applied Christianity 201); acquaintance with methods and
materials in adult Christian education.
Applied Christianity 221 Church Staff Work 1
3 credits
Study of basic principles and their relationship to professional ethics, professional relationships, the ministry of the laity, the organization and functioning
of the parish, techniques of visitation and public relations. For parish workers,
parish secretaries, and lay assistants.
Applied Christianity 223 Church Staff Work II
3 credits
Study of strategies and models for the development of programs designed to
meet a congregation's particular needs.
Applied Christianity 230 Church Staff Field Work
1 to 3 credits
Practical experience in the various aspects of parish work through personal
supervised field work with the cooperation of local congregations. Twenty-four
hours of work are required for one credit.
Applied Christianity 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
Designed for students who wish to investigate special interests. May be taken any
term. Department approval necessary.
Mission 100 Introduction to Mission
2 credits
Study of the theology of mission, some basic principles of communciating the
Gospel to non-Christian people, and some current practices in the work of the
Church in various countries of the world.
Mission 110 History of World Mission I
2 credits
Study of the major leaders and developments in the missionary effort of the
nineteenth century.
Mission 120 History of World Mission II
2 credits
Study of the major leaders and developments in the missionary effort of the
twentieth century.
Mission 200 Mission Internship
1 to 6 credits
A flexible program of study designed to provide the student opportunities for
contact with people directly involved in church work in various countries of the
world. Students may study and serve under the supervision of experienced
missionaries at times to be arranged.
Mission 300 lndepen·dent Study
1 to 3 elective credits per term
~pec~~I ~r?jec!:. fort.he _:;tudent who has a se~ious interest in the world mission of
80
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
DIRECTORY
Board of Regents
OFFICERS
Chairman/
PAUL G. PETERSON
Vice Chairman/
TRUDY ROGNESS JENSEN
Secretary/
LOUISE SUNDET
Treasurer/
NORMA HAYER DOLLIFF
MEMBERS OF THE BOARD
OF REGENTS
EVONNE ANDERSON
ALC, Farming, Homemaker
Halstad, Minnesota
THE REVEREND ELDER K. BENTLEY
ALC, Pastor
Immanuel Lutheran Church
St. Paul, Minnesota
DR. LAWRENCE M. BRINGS
Regent Emeritus
ALC, Chairman of the Board
T.S. Denison & Co., Inc.
Minneapolis, Minnesota
MARKS. DALQUIST
LCA, President
Maid of Scandinavia
Minneapolis, Minnesota
THE REVEREND MICHAELE. DOBBINS
LCA, Pastor
Holy Cross Lutheran Church
St. Paul, Minnesota
NORMA HA YER DOLLI FF
ALC, Officer and Director
F.C. Hayer Company
Edina, Minnesota
TRUDY ROGNESS JENSEN
ALC, Counseling Services; Chair,
Minnesota lnterreligious Committee
for Bio-Medical Ethics; Coordinator,
Jewish-Christian Relations, ALC;
Consultant, The National Hospice
Organization
Edina, Minnesota
DR. MARLIN J.E. JOHNSON
LCA, Specialist in Internal Medicine
Quain & Ramstad Clinic
Bismarck, North Dakota
WOODROW P. LANGHAUG
ALC, Vice Chairman of the Board
Lutheran Brotherhood
Minneapolis, Minnesota
RAYBURN E. NORLING
ALC, Executive Vice President
Willmar Poultry Co.
Willmar, Minnesota
ELMER N. OLSON
ALC, Past President
Elmer N. Olson Co.
Minneapolis, Minnesota
PAUL G. PETERSON
LCA, Manager
Higher Education Support
Fraternal Division
Lutheran Brotherhood
Minneapolis, Minnesota
THE REVEREND PAUL 0. ROMSTAD
ALC, Pastor
Woodlake Lutheran Church
Richfield, Minnesota
RUTH E. RUPP
LCA, Chief Executive Officer
Rupp Industries
Burnsville, Minnesota
THE REVEREND JOHN P. FOLKERDS
LCA, Pastor
Zion Lutheran Church
Buffalo, Minnesota
THE REVEREND
DR. WALTER SUNDBERG, JR.
ALC, Assistant Pastor
Como Park Lutheran Church
St. Paul, Minnesota
THE REVEREND
VERNON D. GUNDERMANN
LC-MS, Pastor
Beautiful Savior Lutheran Church
New Hope, Minnesota
LOUISE SUNDET
LCA, Officer and Director
Century Mfg. Co.
Excelsior, Minnesota
DIRECTORY
LOUISE SUNDET
LCA, Officer and Director
Century Mfg. Co.
Excelsior, Minnesota
RALPH 0. THRANE
LC-MS, Vice President and Director
of Acquistions and Mergers
The Pillsbury Company
Minneapolis, Minnesota
JOHN YACKEL
ALC, Publisher, Manager
American Guidance Service
Circle Pines, Minnesota
81
Faculty
MYRON H. BLANCH/Law Enforcement
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN. 1979ROY BLOOMQUIST/Radio Director
B.A., Wisconsin State University, Superior, WI; Augustana Theological
Seminary, Rock Island, IL; Maywood
Seminary, Chicago, IL 1961-
THE REVEREND
LAUREN E. YOUNGDALE
LCA, Chaplain
Fergus Falls, Minnesota
WILLIAM BOLM/Physical Education,
Recreation,Counselor
B.S., Western Michigan University, Kalamazoo, Ml; M.A. (Physical Education),
St. Thomas College, St. Paul, MN; M.A.
(Counseling), St. Thomas College, St.
Paul, MN 1971-
THE REVEREND CARLETON E. ZAHN
LC-MS, Pastor
Peace Lutheran Church
Robbinsdale, Minnesota
ROGER W. BROWN/Law Enforcement
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; graduate study, Mankato
State University, Mankato, MN 1979-
LEGAL COUNSEL
DOUGLAS CAREY /Voice
B.S. and M.Ed., University of North
Dakota, Grand Forks, North Dakota
1978-
ROBERT M. SKARE,
ALC, Attorney
Best & Flanagan
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Administration
BERNT C. OPSAL/President
J. PHILIP WORTHINGTON/
Academic Dean
HAROLD E. MOORE, JR./
Dean of Students
RUSSELL B. HELGESEN/Director of
Development
MARILYN J. ADAMS/Registrar
BRENDA JOHNSON/Financial Aid
Director
AL TON C.O. HALVERSON/Director
of Public Relations
THOMAS R. HANSON/Director of
Admissions
VIVIAN WIEMERSLAGE/
Business Office Manager
JACQOL YN CHERNE/English, Applied
Christianity
B.A., Augsburg College, Minneapolis,
MN; M.A., United Theological Seminary, New Brighton, MN; graduate
study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1967, 1970
GERALD L. DAHL/Sociology
B.A. Wheaton College, Wheaton, IL;
M.S.W., University of Nebraska,
Lincoln, NB; member of Academy of
Certified Social Workers. 1975SONJA M. DAHLAGER/Business
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
graduate study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1979-
82
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
PAUL E. DRANGEID/Biology,
Physical Education
B.A., St. Olaf College, f'"~orthfield, ~v1N;
M.S., South Dakota State University,
Brookings, S.D.; graduate work at:
Colorado School Mines, Golden, CO;
University of Chattanooga, TN; University of West Virginia, Morgantown,
WV; University of Vermont, Burlington, VT; Philadelphia College of Pharmacy and Science, PA; Boyce Thompson Plant Research Institute, Yonkers,
N.Y.; Ripon College, WS; Knox College, Galesburg, IL. 1979WILLIAM P. EFFERTZ/Law
Enforcement
B.B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; advanced study, FBI
Academy, 1976JANICE EGGERSGLUESS/Business
Education
B.A., Gustavus Adolphus College St.
Peter, MN; M.S., St. Cloud State
University, St. Cloud, MN 1969JEANNE EKHOLM/Music
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN
1978JANICE GRAVDAHL/Business
Education
B.S., Bemidji State University, Bemidji,
MN 1972JOHN V. GRONLl/Philosophy,
Biblical Theology
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M. Div., Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN; M.A.,
Pacific Lutheran University, Tacoma,
WA; additional graduate study, Pacific
Lutheran Theological Seminary, Berkeley, CA; D. Min., Luther Theological
Seminary, St. Paul, MN 1976RUTH A. HALVERSON/Journalism
B.A., St. Cloud State University, St.
Cloud MN; additional study, University
of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1977LEE ANNE HANSEN/English, German
B.A., Augsburg College, Minneapolis,
MN; Graduate School, University of
Munich, Munich, Germany; finished
courses for Ph.D., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1973-
THOMAS R. HANSON/Director
of Admissions
B.S. B, University of ~v1i n nesota, l"v1i napol is, MN; M.B.A., Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute; Troy, NY 1982DOROTHY L. HAUGEN/Physical
Education
B.S., Wheaton College, Wheaton, IL
1978PAUL T. HIRDMAN/Sociology,
Psychology, Counselor
A.A., Waldorf College, Forest City, IA;
B.A., Augsburg College, Minneapolis,
MN; M. Div., Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN; Ph.D., University of
North Dakota, Grand Forks, North
Dakota 1979JUDY HYLAND/World Mission
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
graduate study, University of California
at Berkeley, Berkeley, CA; College of
Chinese Studies, Baguio, Philippines
1981JEAN JOHNSON/Business Education
B.S., University of North Dakota,
Grand Forks, ND 1974PATRICIA M. JOHNSON/Speech
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
graduate study, Georgetown University, Washington, D.C. and University
of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1981PRllDU KllVE/Physics, Mathematics
B.A., Berea College, Berea, KY; M.A.
University of Buffalo, Buffalo, NY 1973MARK KROLL/Computer Science
Bachelor of Mathematics; Masters in
E.E.; course work completed for Ph.D.
in Electrical Engineering, University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1982GAIL LANDO/English
B.A., Wisconsin State, Eau Claire, WI;
M.A., St. Cloud State University, St.
Cloud, MN 1972PHYLLIS LARSON/English, Mission
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A.T., College of St.
Thomas, St. Paul, MN; course work
completed for Ph.D. in Asian Studies,
University of Minnesota, Minneapolis,
MN 1973-
DI RECTORY
RICHARD LAUE/History, Political
Science
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of Minnesota; additional graduate study,
University of Strasbourg, France and the
University of Minnesota, Minneapolis,
MN 1966JAMES L. LEFFERTS/Chemistry,
Mathematics
A.B. Bowdoin College, Brunswick, ME;
Ph.D. Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, MA; Post-doctoral
Fellow, University of Oklahoma, Norman, OK 1983SEVERT LEGRED/Physical Education
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A., Mankato State College, Mankato, MN; additional graduate study,
Southern Illinois University, Carbondale, IL. 1969LUTHER LERSETH/Biblical
Theology, Applied Christianity
B.A., Augustana College, Sioux Falls, S.
Dakota; B. Th., Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN 1978DEON M. LIEN/Residence
Hall Director, Physical Education
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN
1983WILLIAM E. LUNDQUIST/Physical
Education
B.S., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.Ed., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1966WILLIAM J. MAVITY/Law Enforcement
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneaps, MN; J.D., University of Minnesota Law School, Minneapolis, MN
1983HAROLD E. MOORE, JR./Dean of
Students, Business, Director
of Counseling Services
B.A., University of Denver, Denver,
CO; J.D., University of Denver, College of Law, Denver, CO; additio~al
study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; United Theological
Seminary, New Brighton, MN 1980-
83
JOHN F. NELSON/Residence Hall
Director, Physical Education
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A. graduate program, University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1983PATRICIA NORTWEN/Piano
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of Minnesota 1967WA YNE D. OLSON/English
B.A., University of South Dakota, Vermillion, SD; M.A., Mankato State University, Mankato, MN; additional graduate study, New York University, New
York, NY 1983BERNT C. OPSAL/President
B.A., Upsala College, East Orange,
NJ; B. Th., Luther Seminary, St. Paul,
MN; Biblical Seminary, New York, NY;
M.A., New York University, New York,
NY; additional graduate stud~, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN;
Litt. D., Concordia College, St. Paul,
MN 1954BRYAN J. PHILLIPS/Computer Science
Bachelors of Industrial Engineering,
General Motors Institute, Flint, Ml 1983MAHLON PITNEY /Psychology, Personal
Orientation, Counselor
B.A., Macalester College, St. Paul, M.N;
M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1970.MARLO F. PUTZ/Biology
B.S., Gustavus Adolphus College, St.
Peter, MN; M.A., St. Cloud State
University, St. Cloud, MN 1968PAUL 0. ROMSTAD/Theology
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M. Div., Luther Theological Seminary,
St. Paul, MN 1981DONALD A. SCHLAEFER/
Law Enforcement
B.S. in Commerce, University of North
Dakota, Grand Forks, ND; J.D., University of North Dakota Law School,
Grand Froks, ND; Training Coordinator
for the FBI in Minneapolis, MN 1983-
84
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
DOROTHY SEAGARD/Music, Voice
and Choral
B.M., Westminster Choir College,
Princeton, NJ; graduate study, Chicago
Opera Guild; Eastman School of Music,
Rochester, NY; University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1962JOHN C. SEAGARD/Music, Choral,
Organ
B.M., M.M., Eastman School of Music,
Rochester, NY; Lutheran Bible Institute;
Augustana College, Rock Island, IL;
Westminster Choir College, Princeton,
NJ; Chicago Opera Repertoire Guild;
additional graduate study, Eastman
School of Music, Rochester, NY 1962RICHARD M. SERENA/Librarian
B.S., Columbia University, New York,
NY; M.L.S., Columbia University, New
York, NY 1976MARY S. SICILIA/American Studies,
Personal Orientation
B.S., Northwestern College, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; Ph.D.,
course work completed University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1977PAUL W. SIEMERS/Theatre
B.A., Bethel College, Roseville,
M.A., University of Minnesota,
neapolis, MN; Ph.D. course work
pleted, University of Minnesota,
neapolis, MN 1981-
MN;
MincomMin-
ROGER SNYDER/Music, Band and
Orchestra
B.S., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1977MARIL YN A. ST ALHEI M/English and
Applied Christianity
B.S., University of Wisconsin, Eau Claire,
WI; M.S., University of Wisconsin, Stout,
WI 1976GERALD SWANSON/ Art
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.F.A., University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1972KATHRYN SWANSON/English
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1971-
LOIS UTZINGER/String Lessons
and Ensembles
B.A., Carleton College, Northfield,
Minnesota; M.M., Uni~ersity of Michigan, Ann Arbor, Ml; additional graduate study, University of Michigan, Ann
Arbor, Ml; University of North Dakota,
Grand Forks, ND 1978RUSSELL A. VIKSTROM/Biblical
Theology, Philosophy
B.A., Augustana College, Rock Island,
IL; M. Div., Augustana Seminary, Rock
Island, IL; additional graduate study,
Biblical Seminary, New York, NY; Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul,
MN 1953JERRY M. WALLEVAND/Biblical
Theology, Greek
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; B.A., Luther College, Decorah, IA; B.Th., Luther Theological
Seminary, St. Paul, MN; Ph.D., University of St. Andrews, Scotland; graduate
study Edinburgh University, Edinburgh,
Scotland 1982J. PHILIP WORTHINGTON/Academic
Dean, Biblical Theology
B.A., Gustavus Adolphus College, St.
Peter, MN; C.T.; Luther Theological
Seminary, St. Paul, MN; S.T.M., Biblical
Seminary, New York, NY; M.A., New
York University, course work completed for Ed.D., New York University,
New York, NY 1974-
DIRECTORY
Student Services Personnel
VERNON J. BITTNER/Counselor
B.A.;St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
B.D., Northern Baptist Theological Seminary, Chicago, IL; S.T.M., Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN; S.T.D.,
San Francisco Theological Seminary,
San Francisco, CA 1978CHERYL M. ECKSTAM/Housing
Director, Counselor
B.A., University of North Carolina at
Greensboro, Greensboro, NC; M.Ed.,
University of Virginia. Charlottesville,
VA
LORI J. NORNES/Residence Hall
Director, SAC Coordinator
A.A., Golden Valley Lutheran College;
B.A., Mankato State University, Mankato, MN
LOIS NYSTUL/Director of
Health Service
R.N., Fairview School of Nursing, Minneapolis, MN; B.A., Metropolitan State
University, St. Paul, MN
TIMOTHY ). SAVARESE/Residence Hall
Director, Intramural Coordinator
A.A., Golden Valley Lutheran College;
B.A., Concordia College, Moorhead,
MN
DOUGLAS L. SILL/Manager of
Student Union
A.A., Golden Valley Lutheran College,
Minneapolis, MN; additional study,
South Dakota State University, Brookings, SD; Dunwoody Institute, Minneapolis, MN; St. Paul Bible College,
St. Bonifacius, MN
SALLY TAVERNIER/Security Officer
A.A., Golden Valley Lutheran College,
Minneapolis, MN
CAROL TOMER/Residence Hall
Director, Director Campus Activities
B.A., Luther College, Decorah, IA; additional study, University of Minnesota,
Minneapolis, MN; Luther Northwestern
Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN 1980-
85
86
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
INDEX
Academic Honors ................ 32
Academic Program ............... 31
Academic Progress ............... 33
Accreditation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2, 11
Administration ................... 81
Admissions Information .......... 19
Adult Students ................... 20
Affiliations ....................... 11
Agriculture ...................... 45
Alcohol and Drug Abuse ......... 16
Alumni Association ............... 17
Anthropology .................... 65
Application Procedure ............ 19
Applied Christianity .......... 78, 79
Art .............................. 72
Associate in Arts Degree ...... 38, 39
Athletics .................... 16, 33
Attendance, Classroom ........... 34
Automobiles ..................... 15
Band ........................ 16, 74
Biblical and Theological
Studies ................. 43, 57, 58
Bible Requirement ............... 34
Biology ...................... 67, 68
Board and Room Costs ....... 21, 22
Board of Regents ............ 80, 81
Books and Supplies .............. 24
Business ..................... 43, 76
Calendar ........................ 6
Chapel .......................... 15
Charges by Quarter .............. 22
Chemistry ....................... 69
Choir ....................... 16, 74
Christian Service ................. 78
Church History .................. 58
Church Staff Work ............... 48
Classics .......................... 45
Co-curricular Activity Credits ..... 34
College Objectives ............... 10
Communications .......... 59, 60, 61
Computer Science ........... 44, 69
Computer Training ............... 48
Corrective Therapy ............... 45
Correspondence, Directions For ... 2
Costs ......................... 21-24
Counseling Services .............. 13
Course Descriptions ........... 57-79
Creative Arts ................. 72-75
Degree and Certificates ........ 38-40
Dentistry ........................ 45
Deposits and Fees ......... 19, 21, 22
Directory ..................... 80-85
Dormitories ..................... 14
Drama .......................... 17
Education ....................... 45
Electronics Technician ............ 48
Eligibility for Varsity Sports ........ 33
Employment, Student ............. 26
English ...................... 59, 60
English Requirement ............. 34
Faculty ....................... 81-84
Fees ..................... 19, 21, 22
Financial Aid .................... 25
Forestry ......................... 46
General Guidelines ............... 11
General Information ............. 9
Geography .................. 62, 63
German ......................... 61
Grading and Honor Point System .. 32
Graduation Requirements ........ 37
Greek ........................... 61
Health Services .................. 13
History .......................... 62
Honor Society ................... 17
Housing Services ................. 14
Humanities ...................... 63
Incomplete Work ................ 32
Independent Study ............... 34
Instrumental Lessons ......... 73, 74
Insurance ....................... 14
International Students ............ 20
Junior College Certificate ......... 40
Languages ....................... 61
Law ............................. 46
Law Enforcement ............ 49, 78
Liberal Arts, Basic ................ 42
INDEX
Library .......................... 14
Loans ........................... 26
Location of the College .......... 5,9
Map ............................ 5
Mathematics ................. 66, 67
Medicine ........................ 46
Mission .................. 52, 55, 79
Music .............. 16, 46, 72, 73, 74
New Testament Studies ....... 57, 58
Nursing ......................... 46
Occupational Therapy ............ 47
Office Administration ........ 49, 55
Old Testament Studies ............ 57
Orchestra ................... 16, 74
Orientation and Registration ...... 35
Part-Time Students ............... 31
Payment Plan .................... 23
Personal Orientation ............. 64
Pharmacy ........................ 47
Philosophy of College ............ 10
Philosophy ...................... 63
Physical Education ........ 47, 70, 71
Physical Therapy ................. 47
Physics .......................... 67
Political Science .................. 62
Pre-registration .................. 13
Probation, Academic ............. 33
Programs of Study ............. 41-55
Psychology ...................... 64
Recreation Leadership ........ 47, 71
Refund Schedule ................. 23
Registration ..................... 35
87
Registration, Changes in .......... 35
Religious Life .................... 15
Repeating a Course .............. 35
Room and Board Costs ....... 21, 22
Science, Basic .................... 42
Scholarships ................. 28, 29
Secretarial
General ................... 50, 54
Legal ...................... 50, 54
Medical ................... 51, 55
Parish ......................... 51
Secretarial Science ........... 77, 78
Social Life ....................... 14
Social Science ................ 62-65
Social Service ................ 52, 65
Sociology ........................ 65
Special Examination .............. 33
Speech .......................... 60
Student Government ............. 14
Student Life ..................... 13
Student Services Personnel ........ 85
Study Skills Assistance ........ 13, 64
Theatre ......................... 75
Theology ........................ 58
Transfer of Credits ........... 11, 33
Transfer Students ............ 20, 33
Tuition ...................... 21, 22
Vocational Certificate ............ 38
Vocational Studies ............ 77-79
Voice Lessons .................... 73
Withdrawals from Class ........... 35
Withdrawals from the College ..... 35
Work Opportunities .............. 26
Office of Admissions
Golden Valley Lutheran College
6125 Olson Memorial Highway (55)
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55422
(612) 542-1212
NON-PROFIT ORG.
U.S. POSTAGE
PAID
MINNEAPOLIS, MINN.
PERMIT NO. 1439
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Summer Catalog, 1985
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
An Official Publication of
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
PAID
Second Class
Postage
-
Minneapolis
MN
-
[
11
BugsbumColf'egeisa fobryeat, fully accwditd liberal art5
colle8e affil lated with The American Lutheran Church. Located
in the h...
Show more
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
An Official Publication of
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
PAID
Second Class
Postage
-
Minneapolis
MN
-
[
11
BugsbumColf'egeisa fobryeat, fully accwditd liberal art5
colle8e affil lated with The American Lutheran Church. Located
in the heartof thewin Cities, he small college environment,
h
t 1700 sfudmts dufing the academic war, 'rs enriched by the
many cul~ml,sporting and recreaflunal adIvities found In this
vlmbtant metropolitan area*An active summer corn bl nihg classes
and participation in nmtimpaliun wen& is s delightful and
Augsburg College provides a diverse summer curriculum
includlng regulaf courses, ihternships, independent studies and
student teachingom two terms. Tkm I runsfrom June3-June 28,
Term It runs from luly I-August 9. This brochure presents the
Summer School Ppgrarn and wci5 correct at the time of
publication.
bmaden ing experience.
Term I
Term I I
Preregistration with Tuition Discount
April 24
April 24
Confirmation of Registration
Classes Begin
Balance of Tuition Due
June 3
Last Day to:
Change Grading Option
Drop Class Without Notation
Register with a Late Fee of $10.00
(No registrations will be accepted
after this date)
June 5
Holiday
None
Last Day to Withdraw From Class (W)
June 17
July 22
Classes End
June 28
August 9
Grades Due in Registrar's Office
July 3
August 14
Summer Students m y take one course duringTerm I and h r v ~
cou,rsesduringTern 11. Unless otherwise indicated, ail courses
carry a value of om course &it,
the equiwalent of fwsemester
urrdits crsfx quanerdits. Coum fulfilling Augsburgdistribution requirementsare SQ nored in the couwe descriptions.
,Cwtselmklsare indicated by the first digit of the three digit
c ~ u ~ n , u m1bore 2,
~ lower division, primarily for freshmen and
sophomores; 3 or 4, upper division, primarily for juniors and
seniors; and 5, graduate leveI.
Cou-s Regutnrly Taught durfng the academic year are more
fully d&crj'lbRd in the October AUGSBlJRG COLLEGE CATALOG.
if:you need more information about a special summer offering,
please contactthe Summer School Oftice
Independent Study and Internships in addition to those listed
may be pursued during the summer in a number of departments.
lnternships involve work experience related to the academic
program in an agency, government, or industry. Consult the
Summer School Office for information.
Students Needing Housing may obtain information from the
Director of Housing.
Persons Planning to Attend Summer School are advised to
preregister as soon as possible, since courses without substantial
demand may be dropped.
The College Reserves the Right to Cancel Listed Courses.
1
Additional information and registration forms may be obtained
from the Summer School Office. Write or call:
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
SUMMER SCHOOL OFFICE
Memorial Hall -230
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
(612) 330-1025
Pat Parker, Director
Ruth Maertens, Secretary
Term I Summer School students are required to confirm their
registrations on June3; Term I1 registrations must be confirmed on
July 1. This procedure Includes canfirmation of all preregistered comes and applies to Tptern'shipsand independent
studies as well as to regularly scheduled courses.
Confirmation of registration will take place at the Registrar's
Office, 114 Science Hall, between the hours of 8:30 a.m. and 6:30
p.m. on June 3 and July 1.
The balance owing for tuition must be paid before registration
is confirmed. Augsburg Students please note: Balance due on
Augsburg account from previous termls must be p a ~ din full
before confirmation of registration.
Persons in Good Standing at regionally accredited colleges and
universities, graduates of such institutions, and students admitted
for the next Fall Term are eligible to attend Augsburg Summer
School. Good standing implies that the student has been
admitted and not subsequently dropped by that institution.
Other Persons wishing to take summer school work should contact the Director of Summer School to ascertain eligibility under
special circumstances.
Acceptance as a summer student does not imply admission as a
regular student of Augsburg College. Those wishing to begin a
degree program at the college should apply for admission
through the Office of Admission.
Financial Aid is limited to the Guaranteed Student Loan. Any
student taking 1 course is regarded as a half-time student for the
summer and is eligible for a Guaranteed Student Loan. Contact
the Financial Aid Office to make loan arrangements (330-1046).
A late fee of $10.00 will be assessed for Term I registrations
completed on June 4 and June 5. A late fee of $10.00 will be
assessed for Term II registrations completed on July 2 and July 3.
Registrations will not be accepted after these dates.
To cancel your registration, add a course, or drop a course and
enroll in another course, fill out a CancelIAdd form at the Registrar's
Office. There is a charge of $5.00 for changing a registration
after the first day of each term. This must be done by 3:30 p.m.
on June 5 for Term I courses and by 3:30 p.m. on July 3 for
Term II courses. This procedure applies to internships and
independent studies as well as scheduled courses. Any refund
or adjustment of fees is determined according to thei'Tuition
Refund Policy".
Augsburg Col lege admirs students of any race, color, national and
ethnic origin to all rights, privilege, pmgrarns, and activities
generally accorded or made milable to studen& at the school. It
does not discriminateon the basis of race, color, creed, national
and ethnic origin in employment practices or administration of its
educational policies, admissions policies, scholarship and loan
programs and athletic and other school-admi nistered programs.
The tuition charge for Summer School is $340.00 for each course
taken for credit, unless otherwise indicated. The audit charge
(non-credit) is $170.00 for each course. Laboratorylspecial fees are
noted with course descriptions.
Preregistration on April 24 will result in a savings of $30.00 for
each course taken. This reduced tuition of $310.00 per course
applies only to those courses for which the student preregisters
on April 24. A nonrefundable deposit of $50.00 per course is
required at this time and is applied to designated course tuition.
If a course is cancelled due to low enrollment, a substitution may
be made without loss of discount. Students may preregister for
both Term I and Term II courses on April 24; tuition discount
applies to both terms.
After April 24, students may preregister at the Registrat's Office on
an ongoing basis during regular office hours. The required $50.00
per course nonrefundable deposit is applied to designated course
tuition. Substitutions allowed if course is cancelled.
35W from the NorthTake Washington Ave. exit and turn left on Washington (turns right
onto Cedar Ave.), turn left at Riverside, right at 21st Ave. S.
The $50.00 deposit is not refundable. Refund of all or part of the
remaining fee is calculated from the first day of the term to the date
of the student's official course cancellation at the Registrat's Office.
Schedule of Refunds
Refund
(No refund after the dates listed below)
Term I
June 3
June4
June 5
June 6
June 7
Term I I
1-94 East from MinneapolisTake 25th Ave. exit, turn left at 25th Ave., turn left at Riverside, turn
left at 21st Ave. S.
1-94 West from St. PaulTake Riverside exit, turn right at Riverside, turn left at 21st Ave. S.
35W from the SouthFollow 1-94 St. Paul signs (move right lane after each of two
mergers).Take 25th Ave. exit and turn left on 25th Ave., turn left at
Riverside, turn left at 21st Ave. S.
A
U
C
C
O
S
L
B
L
U
E
R
G
G
E
FOREIGN LANGUAGES
GER 111-8126
BEGINNING GERMAN I
Steinmetz
Classroom practice speaking, understanding and reading basic German for students
with no previous background in German. Dist.: Yes.
OM29
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M, T, W, Th,F
JUNE3-JUNE 28
SPA 111-8127
BEGINNING SPANISH I
Kingsley
Aims to develop four basic skills: understanding, speaking, reading, and writing of
elementary Spanish. Introduction to culture of Spanish-speakingworld. Dist.: Yes.
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M, T, W,Th,F
OM23
ART
ART 107-8100
DRAWING
Bollman
Drawingin pencil, charcoal, ink, and pastels. Subjects includestill-life, figures, building
HEALTH EDUCATION A N D PHYSICAL EDUCATION
HPE 410-8128
ADMINISTRATION &SUPERVISION
Borstad
OF SCHOOL HEALTH PROGRAM
Historical background, legal bases, school health services, and relationshipsto community health program and resources. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 320.
,W, Th
M22
5:OO-8:00 p.m.
M, 1
lntcdnrs and mreriors, and experimental work. Dist.: Yes.
1 :00-4:OQp.m.
M, T, W, Th
O M 17
Bollman
ART 223-81011368-8102 PRINTMAKING I & II
Principles and methods of print making in a variety of media including etching,
silkscreen and woodcut. Dist.: Yes.
1:OO-4:00 p.m.
M, T, W, Th
OM17
HPE 491-8129
THERAPEUTIC EXERCISE
Utterberg
Study of the treatment of disease and injury. General principles and administration of
neuro-muscular re-education. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 350, 351, 354.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
1,Th and Arranged
M5
(1st meeting 614, 6:00 p.m.)
BIOLOGY
Mickelberg
HUMAN ANATOMY AND
PHYSIOLOGY
Professional course in the structure and function of the human body. Dist.: Yes.
10:30-1:00 p.m. Lect.
M, T, W,Th,F
5205
1:30-4:30 p.m. Lab.
T, W, Th
5214
BIO 103-8103
HPE 493-8130
ORGANIZATION &ADMINISTRATION
Husing
OF CORRECTIVE THERAPY
Administrative guidelines and history of ACTA and North Central Chapter. Construction
of CT treatment clinic; equipment, employment, public relationsand ethics. Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
T,Th and Arranged
M24
(1st meeting 614, 6:00 p.m.)
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
BUS 101-8104
PRINCIPLES OF FINANCIAL
Kader
ACCOUNTING
Introduction to business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of accounting,
the accounting cycle and preparation of financial statements. D~st.:No.
L1
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M, T, W, Th, F
HPE 495-81311496-8132 PROFESSIONALAFFILIATION
497-8133
Hospital affiliation of 444 hours required. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 485,491 and approval of department.
BUS 135-8105
INTRODUCTION TO MARKETING
Cerrito
Principles of basic policy and strategy issues in marketing. Legal, ethical, competitive,
behavioral, economic and technological factors as they affect product, promotion,
marketing channel and pricing decisions. Dist.: NO.
O M 10
9:30-11:50a.m.
M, T, W, Th, F
INTERNSHIPS
HISTORY
HIS 299-81361499-8137
Kader
Arranged
DIRECTED STUDY1
INDEPENDENT STUDY
(Diverse Topics: See Instructor)
Gustafson
Arranged
INTERDISCIPLINARY
CHEMISTRY
GENERAL ORGANIC & BIOLOGICAL
Staff
CHEMISTRY
First term of a two semester course, general chemistry principles and an introduction
to organic chemistry. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisites: High school chemistry.
9:30-11:50a.m. lect.
M,T,W,Th,F
5315
T, W, Th
5327
1:OO- 3:00 p.m. Lab.
Arranged
HIS 233-81341433-8135 WOMEN'S ROLES I N AMERICA
Stadurn
Examination of women's roles in the family, the workplace, and in voluntary organizations from Colonial America to the 1980's. Includes comparisons based on class, race,
ethnicity and geographic region. Dist.: Yes.
M22
1:OO-4:00 p.m.
M, T, W, Th
BUS 261-8106
FUNDAMENTALS OF FINANCE
Morgan
Theory of acquisition, allocation, and managementof funds within the firm; sources
and uses, of long and short term funds, cost of capital, capital budgeting, leverage,
dividend policy and related topics. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 101, 102.
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M,T, W,Th, F
M22
BUS 399-8107
Saugestad
INS 399-8138
C H M 109-8108
INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arranged
NURSING
I
I
NUR 303-8152
CONTEMPORARY NURSING I
Nilsson
(112 course)
This course is oneof the transitional courses that introduce the student to components of the professional role and begin the professional socialization process.
9:30-l l:50 a.m.
M,T,W,Th,F
M5
I
ECO 120-8109
ECONOMICS OF URBAN ISSUES
Sabella
Study of economic implications of problems facing a metro-urban environment. Bv
-,
independent study only. Dist.: Yes.
Arranged
ECO 122-81 10
1
PRINCIPLESOF ECONOMICS
Gupta
(MACRO)
Introduction to macro-economics; national income analysis, monetary and fiscal
policy, international trade, economic growth. Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
M, T, W, Th
M4
EDUCATION
I
I
I
EDE 353-81 11
YOUNG CHILDREN WITH
R. Anderson
SPECIAL NEEDS
Understanding administrative guidelines and teacher competencies involved in a
mainstreamed prekindergarten or daycare program.
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M, T, W,Th, F
OM22
(% course) June 10-21
EDE375-8112
DISCOVERY I N THE WORLD
Pelton
OF KINDERGARTEN
Kindergarten curriculum, materials, and teaching approaches. Lab. arranged.
Prerequisite to student teaching at kindergarten level and to obtaining a license for
teaching at that level. Consent of instructor. Dist.: No.
9:30- 1l:50 a.m.
M, T, W, Th, F
L4
PHI 120-8139
ETHICS
Fuehrer
This course takes a long, hard look at possible grounds for making moral decisions,
and at the moral judgments about personal and social issues resulting from them.
Dist.: Yes.
M4
9:30-1 l:50 a.m.
M, T, W,Th,F
INTRODUCTION TO LOGIC
Bailey
PHI 130-8140
Examination of ruleswhich govern valid argument sand aid in developing the ability
to recognize and construct sound arguments. Dist.: Yes.
9:30-ll:50a.m.
M, T, W, Th,F
OM13
POLITICAL SCIENCE
POL 158-8141
POLITICAL PATTERNS A N D
Hedblom
PROCESSES
An analysis of basic patterns in the political system and decision-making process with
some comparison of major political systems and discussion of contemporary issues.
Dist.: Yes.
OM11
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M, T,W, Th,F
POL 299-81421499-8143 DIRECTED STUDY1
INDEPENDENT STUDY
(Topic by arrangement)
Hedblom
POL 199-81441399-8145 INTERNSHIPS
Hedblom
Arranged
STUDENT TEACHING
Student teaching lor both efemntary and wondaw educalian Is d i e d by the
Department d Eduqtl~n
duringthegeneralpwiad lmm the middle of june ta the end
olJuly.Thexact dates are determind tn conjunction with the school system. A l l of
the m u m u w i r e acceptance intothe kpartmtof Educatimprogram. Cmtm
tk Registfar's Offtce kurexaci dates and caurse number ta be used in registration.
EDE 481-81 131482-8114 STUDENT TEACHING:
R. Anderson
483-81 151484-8116 PREKINDERGARTEN
Students required to have 160 child contact hours. Placement arrangement by
instructor. Additional $35.00 fee. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: Acceptance, Education Department.
Arranged
EDE 481-81 171482-8118 STUDENT TEACHING:
Pelton
483-81 191484-8120 ELEMENTARY OR KINDERGARTEN
Observing and directing learning experiences in elementary schools under supervision
of college and public school personnel. Additional $35.00 fee. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: Acceptance, Education Department.
Arranged
EDS 481-81211482-8122 STUDENTTEACHING:
Fardig
483-81231484-81 24 SECONDARY
Observing and directing learning experiences on secondary school level under
supervision of college and high school personnel. Additional $35.00 fee. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: Acceptance, Education Department.
Arranged
LOVE I N LITERATURE
ENG 269-8125
Blackburn
ewrnim Ihrydep~ctImso f p d - k I=, IndludinqThe
This course WIII
of Songs," Ov~d's
Tk+ArtOTbw, Shakespea& AwhPaandldCe~riaA ~Id$umril@r
N~ght's
Dream, ~ s ~ 1 o h nthenobrlowblmof
~ ~ e ,
FannyHill,hd
manly IoveofA ~ b ~ m x r e d & v r o l 8 c 5 r t w r ~ t h e m q ; l n i n g f d l m a n d
thus, perhaps, IaeItsdf. DM.:
9:30- 1l:50 a.m.
M, T, W, Th, F
M23
mg
Arranged
PSYCHOLOGY
GENERAL PSYCHOLOGY
PSY 105-8146
Anderegg
Methods and approaches used in psychology for purpose of understanding behavior;
research procedures associated with study of behavior. Dist.: Yes.
1:00-4:00 p.m.
M, T, W, Th
PI
RELIGION
REL 369-8147
RELIGIOUS IMAGINATION I N
Skibbe
MODERN LITERATURE
Particularities of religious discernment, symbolism and world view. Reading and discussion of nine works (novels, poetry, etc.j. Class meets approximately every ither day.
Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisites: 111 or 221.
9:30-ll:50a.m.
M, T, W,Th, F
SOCIOLOGY
SOC 241-8148
INTRODUCTION TO CULTURAL
Gerasimo
ANTHROPOLOGY
An examination of the ideas ofnprimitive", "civilized, and "progress": a comparison
of alternate realities as found in different cultures and varying social contexts.
Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
M, T, W, Th
L1
SOC 199-81491399-8150 INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arranged
SPEECH, C O M M U N I C A T I O N S A N D THEATER ARTS
BEGINNING SPEECH
SPC 111-8151
Basic approach to effective speaking and critical listening. Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
M, T, w, Th
Cole
M23
HEALTH EDUCATION A N D PHYSICAL EDUCATION
JULY 1-AUGUST 9
ART
ART 107-9100
DRAWING
B. Olson
As a way of seeing and a means of personal expression working with a variety of media,
pencil, pen, charcoal, pastel. Dist.: Yes.
5:30-9:00 p.m.
M, J, Jh
OM17
ART 118-91011355-9102 PAINTING I & II
B. Olson
Watercolor-Acrylic; translating the visual world of nature, landscapes, still life, using
design concepts, developing personal expression and exploringvariety of techniques.
Weekly critiques. Dist.: Yes.
5:30-9:00 p.m.
M, T,Th
OM17
ART 132-91031132-9104 PHOTOGRAPHY
Friederichsen
The camera used as a tool for visual creativity and expression; black and white, color,
and photographic processes. Need access to a 35 mm camera. Dist.: Yes.
Estimated cost of film, etc.: $75.00.
2:30-6:00 p.m.
M, W Section I
OM4
6:00-9:30 p.m.
M, W Section II
BIOLOGY
HPE 485-91 19
APPLIED ADAPTED ACTIVITIES
Lieske
Consideration of ambulation, self care, adapted sports and games, and swimming for
the handicapped. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 350, 351, and 355.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
T,Th & Arranged
M24
(1st meeting 7/2,6:00 p.m.)
HPE 487-9120
NEUROLOGY & PATHOLOGY
Lundgren
An introduction to neurology and pathology for the corrective therapist. Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
M, W
M24
(1st meeting 7/1,6:00 p.m.)
HPE 495-91211496-9122 PROFESSIONALAFFILIATION
497-9123
Hospital affiliation of 444 hours required. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 485,491 and approval of department.
Saugestad
Arranged
HISTORY
EASTERN EUROPE I N THE 2OTH
S. Anderson
CENTURY
Examines the nationality problem in Austria, Russia and Germany, and the creation
of new "national statesnafter the war. World War II Nazi occupation to postwar Soviet
domination, and the start of the Cold War over East Europe. Also recent crises.
Dist.: Yes.
Additional work required for upper division credit.
5:30-9:00 p.m.
T,Th
HIS 239-91241339-9125
INTERDISCIPLINARY
BIO 108-9105
MICROBIOLOGY
Arvold
Basic microbial features considered as well as application of microbiology to fields of
medicine and sanitation. Dist.: No.
6:00-9:30 p.m. Lect.
M, W
5205
J, Th
5202
6:OO-9:30 p.m. Lab
INS 399-9126
INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arranged
MATHEMATICS
MAT 114-9143
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
BUS 102-9106
PRINCIPLES OF MANAGERIAL
Kader
ACCOUNTING
Introduction to business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of managerial
accounting. Planning and controlling processes, decision-makingand behavioral considerations. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 101.
6:00-9:30 p.m.
J, Th
5205
BUS 145-9107
FUNDAMENTALS OF MANAGEMENT
Cerrito
Developmentof the theory of management, organization, staffing, planningand control.
The nature of authority, accountability and responsibility, analysis of the role of the
professional manager. Dist.: No.
10:05-1l:30 a.m.
M, J, W,Jh, F
M23
BUS 399-9108
1
INTERNSHIPS
Kader
Arranged
CHEMISTRY
GENERAL, ORGANIC, & BIOLOGICAL
Staff
CHEMISTRY
Second semester of two semester course emphasizing organic and biological chemistry
around the theme: the molecular basis of life. Dist.: Yes.
Prereauisites: 109 or equivalent with de~artmental~ermission.
CHM 110-9109
COLLEGE ALGEBRA AND
B. Loe
TRIGONOMETRY
Fundamental operations, factoring, fractions, functions and graphs, linear equations,
exponents and radicals, quadratic equations, ratio and variation, progressions, binomial
theorem, logarithms and trigonometric functions. Students who have completed 124
may register for credit only with consent of instructor. Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:30p.m.
T,Jh
5112
PHYSICS
PHY 101-9127
ASTRONOMY
PaulsonIStaff
Study of solar system, stars, galaxies. Optical instruments explained; use of 12-inch
reflecting telescope, 8-inch Celestron, 3-inch Questar. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisites: Elementary algebra.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
J, Th
LI
POLITICAL SCIENCE
POL 299-91281499-9129 INDEPENDENT STUDY
(Topics by Arrangement)
Hedblom
Arranged
POL 199-91301399-9131 INTERNSHIPS
Hedblom
Arranged
RELIGION
REL 111-9132
INTRODUCTION TO THEOLOGY
Benson
Zn intrnd~lrtinn
t n t h ~ a r a d ~ m i c d i ~ c i n l i n ~ n f t h ~ n l n to
e vtahn~dr l i a l n vhetween
~l~
-,
10:OO-12:OO N. Lab
T, W,Th
S327
ECONOMICS
RELIGIONS OF INDIA:
Benson
HINDUISM & BUDDHISM
Historical, literary and sociological perspectives from antiquity to present. Uses
primary texts, Hindu ritual films. Dist.: Yes.
8:30-9:55 a.m.
M, T,W,Th,F
M24
ECO 123-9111
PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS
Sabella
(MICRO)
lntroduction to micro-economics, the theory of the household, firm, market structures
and income distribution. Application of elementary economic theory to market policy.
Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
M, w
M22
SOCIAL WORK
SWK 255-9134
GROUP WORK I N A
Perry
WILDERNESS MEDIUM
Canoes-an eight day canoe trip in the Quetico Provincial Park of Ontario. Gain
practice and knowledge necessary to lead wilderness trips effectively. Study the process
of a winderness group as a social system. Dist.: No.
Additional fee.
(See instructor for details)
ECO 353-91 12
ELEMENTS OF MATHEMATICAL
Gupta
ECONOMICS
Economics concepts explained using mathematics as a tool. Examples from finance,
management, and marketingwill also be solved. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 123.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
T, Th
M4
I'
I
ENG 226-9114
CREATIVE WRITING
Mitchell
The purpose of the course is to encourage and guide, by means of appropriate models,
theories, and criticism, writing in narrative and poetic modes of expression. Dist.: No.
11:40a.m.-1:25p.m.
M,T,W,Th
OM11
I
ENG 245-91 16
INTRODUCTION TO LITERATURE
Gidmark
Introductionto the study of fiction, drama, and poetry. Particularattention will be devoted
todmlopingcritical and analytical skills in reading and writing about literature. Strongly
recommendedfor English majors and minors. Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
T,Th
M23
FOREIGN LANGUAGES
SWK 499-9135
INDEPENDENT STUDY
Brown
Arranged
SWK 399-9136
INTERNSHIPS
Brown
Arranged
I
ECO 392-91 13
MONEY & BANKING
Gupta
Monetary and bankingsystems, particularlycommercial banks, and the Federal Reserve
System. Emphasis on monetary theory and policy Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 122.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
M, W
M4
ENG 241-9115
INTRODUCTION TO CINEMA ARTS
Mitchell
An investigation of the artistic qualities and the historical development of the film
medium. The course includesthe viewing and discussingof both feature length and short
films. Dist.: Yes (for So., Jr., Sr.).
5:30-9:00 p.m.
5123
M, W
w
SOC 220-91 371320-9138 SOCIOLOGY OF LAW
Pike
This course examines the nature of law, its effect on society, and the effect of society
on it. From a sociological perspective, we will explore cross-cultural notions of law,
deterrence, the criminal justice system, the legal profession, and corporate crime.
Dist.: Psychology-Sociology.
Prerequisites: 121 or Introductory Pol. Sci. course or permission of instructor.
10:05-1 l:30 a.m.
M,T, W, Th,F
M22
SOC 356-91 39
ISSUES I N CONTEMPORARY
Bloom
CORRECTIONS
Analysis of adult correctional programsand processes. Lectures, discussion, and site
visits to correctional institutions and government offices. Dist.: No.
1:30-5:00 p.m.
T,Th
M22
SOC 199-91401399-9141 INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arranged
SPEECH, C O M M U N I C A T I O N , THEATER
SPC 367-9142
THEATER I N THE TWIN CITIES
Cole
Studying, viewing, and critiquing the acting and production of five plays. Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
T,Th
2815 41st Ave. So., Mpls., M N 55406 (Tel.: 721-2565)
GER 112-9117
BEGINNING GERMAN II
Steinmetz
Classroom practice in speaking, understandingand reading basic German. Lab. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisites: 111 or equivalent.
10:05-1 l:30 a.m.
M, T, W, Th
OM29
SPA 112-9118
BEGINNING SPANISH II
Kingsley
Aims todwelop the four basic skills: understanding, speaking, reading, and writing of
elementary Spanish. lntroduction to culture of Spanish-speaking world. Dist.: Yes.
8:30-9:55 a.m.
M,T, W,Th, F
OM29
M24
REL 372-9133
ECO 120-91 10
ECONOMICS OF URBAN ISSUES
Sabella
Study of economic implications of problems facing a metreurban environment. By inde
pendent study only. Dist.: Yes.
Arranged
ENGLISH
-
the church and the world which concerns Christian doctrine. Dist.: ye;
10:05-1 l:30 a.m.
M, T, W, Th,F
A
U
C
G
O
S
L
B
L
U
E
R
G
G
E
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg Weekend College Catalog, 1984-1985
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
INFORMATION SESSIONS
Adults who are interested in Augsburg Weekend College
are encouraged to attend one of the information sessions
that are scheduled throughout the year. These information
sessions are free of charge and are approximately two
hours in length. Please call the Weekend Colleg...
Show more
INFORMATION SESSIONS
Adults who are interested in Augsburg Weekend College
are encouraged to attend one of the information sessions
that are scheduled throughout the year. These information
sessions are free of charge and are approximately two
hours in length. Please call the Weekend College Office
(330-1782) to receive further details on these information
sessions or to sign up for one of the follow~ngdates:
FOR FALLTRIMESTER, 1984
Saturday, May 19
Saturday, June 9
Saturday, June 23
Saturday, July 14
Tuesday, July 31
Saturday, August 11
FOR WINTER TRIMESTER, 1985
Saturday, October 6
Saturday, November 3
Saturday, December 8
FOR SPRING TRIMESTER, 1985
Saturday, January 19
Saturday, February 16
Saturday, March 9
For more information write or call:
Augsburg Weekend College Office
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, MN 55454
9:00 a.m.
9:00 a.m.
9:00 a.m.
INTRODUCTION TO
AUGSBURG WEEKEND COLLEGE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1984-85 Calendar
inside front cover
3
Introductionto Augsburg Weekend College
Characteristics of the Educational Program
4
Degrees and Majors
5
6
Business Administration
Communication
8
Management Information Systems (MIS)
10
Nursing
1
1
Social Work
12
Deans List
13
Student Support Services
13
Assessment of Previous Learning Program (APL) 1
4
Fees and Payment Schedule
15
Refund Schedule
15
6
Financial Aid
1Admissions Procedure
17
Campus Map
18119
About Augsburg College
20
Campus Location
inside back cover
Purpose
Augsburg Weekend College provides an educational alternative to
adults who desire college experience but who work or have other
commitments during the week. It is a means by which men and women
may earn a baccalaureate degree, gain skills for professional
advancement, prepare for career change, or pursue a personal interest
in one or more areas of the liberal arts.
The Adult as Student
The Augsburg Weekend College program is designed to meet the
needs and preferences of adult learners. The program is based on the
assumption that the men and women who enroll in Weekend College
will be mature, self-disciplined and well-motivated adult learners who
seek a balance of classroom experience and individualized study. Each
course is therefore divided into periods of concentrated on-campus
study separated by time for independent study and class preparation.
Alternate Weekends
To accommodate this format for learning, classes meet on alternate
weekends for three and a half hours on either Friday evening, Saturday
morning, Saturday afternoon, or Sunday afternoon. Each class selected
by the student involves commitment to one of these four class periods.
Weekend College students may take from one to four different courses
by attending class every other weekend.
Community of Learners
This bulletin is published for the convenience of Augsburg Weekend
College students. Weekend College is a program of Augsburg
College and is subject to the policies and provisions as stated in the
Augsburg College catalog.
Essential to the goals of Augsburg Weekend College is participation in a
community of adult learners. Learning can be enhanced when the
student is involved in a stable community that provides opportunity and
encouragement to become involved in interaction both in and out of the
classroom. This community will be enriched by the presence of both
men and women with a variety of work and life experiences.
To facilitate this kind of community interaction, Augsburg encourages
Weekend College students to make use of college facilities such as the
library and college center, to take the opportunity of having shared
meals and coffee breaks, to participate in optional chapel services and
lunchtime seminars, and to attend other college activities such as music
and dramatic presentations and athletic events.
-
r
CHARACTERISTICS
OF T.HE EDUCATIONAL PROGRAM
Educational Mission
For over a century Augsburg College has emphasized intellectual
freedom in the search for knowledge. Our academic program builds on
a liberal arts foundation to help students understand the past, interpret
the present, and plan for the future.
As in the weekday program, Augsburg Weekend College offers
students a unique combination of the liberal arts disciplines and
professional education. Our goals are to help students develop the
intellectual skills and attitudes to be lifelong learners, increase their
competence in selected areas of professional work, and accomplish a
higher level of personal growth.
Accreditation and Affiliations
Augsburg College is fully accredited by the North Central Association of
Colleges and Secondary Schools and The National Council for the
Accreditation of Teacher Education (Secondary and Elementary). Our
programs are approved by The American Chemical Society, The
Council on Social Work Education and the National League for Nursing.
We are a member of the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities
(ACTC), Lutheran Education Council in North America, Minnesota
Private College Council, National Association for Music Therapy, Inc.,
and are registered with the Minnesota Higher Education Coordinating
Board (HECB).
DEGREES AND MAJORS
Augsburg Weekend College allows adults to begin a baccalaureate
degree program or to continue their education after beginning at
another time or institution. It also enables adults to add a second major
to an already completed college degree. The following information
outlines what is involved in completing a degree or major in Augsburg
Weekend College.
Baccalaureate Degree
The baccalaureate degree program in Augsburg Weekend College is
essentially the same as the weekday program. A total of 35 semester
courses are required to graduate and may be fulfilled through transfer
of previous work, assessment of previous learning experience, or
Weekend College coursework. (Augsburg semester courses are valued
at 4 semester credits and 6 quarter credits.) Included in the 35 total
courses must be an approved major program, eleven upper division
courses, and courses selected from the following liberal arts spectrum
(transfer courses and courses taken in the major may also be counted
for distribution requirements):
Augsburg College prides itself on its highly qualified faculty. Members of
the faculty serve as academic advisers to students who are in the p r e
major stage of planning as well as to students in declared major fields.
One approved course from each of seven areas:
Art- Music
History - Philosophy
Economics- Political Science
English-Speech, Communication and Theater Arts
Psychology -Sociology
Chemistry - Biology
Mathematics- Physics
Library
Two courses or demonstrated competence in a foreign language
Students and faculty use a carefully selected library of some 138,000
volumes plus audio-visual materials, with access to over 5,000,000
volumes through the Twin Cities private college consortium and Minitex.
Three courses (or one course per year of study) in religious studies
lnternships
Demonstrated proficiency in two lifetime sports
Faculty
lnternships on and off campus are an established part of most
academic programs, helping students make career choices and develop
experience in their chosen fields.
One course in the area of urban concerns, women's studies, or minority
studies
Majors
Augsburg Weekend College students may select from five separate
majors, each with a number of career conctntrai~on_S)Aminor is available
n of these academic areas excep! nuislr?g
4
5
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
This major prepares students in the areas of management, financial
accounting, finance, and marketing. To provide a combination of applied
skills and theoretical background, each of these majors is
interdisciplinary in approach, including an average of nine business
administration courses and six courses from supporting fields such as
economics, computer programming, communications, philosophy, and
mathematics. Majors in Business Administration are candidates for the
Bachelor of Arts degree.
Core Courses
All students who pursue a major in Business Administration will
complete the following core courses:
BUS 101 Principles of Financial Accounting
BUS 102 Principles of Managerial Accounting
BUS 131 Business Law
BUS 261 Fundamentals of Finance
BUS 379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
ECO 122 Principles of Economics (Macro)
ECO 123 Principles of Economics (Micro)
ECO 251 lntermediate Microeconomics
Accounting ~ l s f e ~ v a f p
Students who w ~ s hin pursue a c i . u n i n g ) n a j o r will complete the
'
following courses In additior; to t%e core:
BUS 262 lntermediate Accounting I
BUS 263 lntermediate Accounting II
BUS 381 Managerial Cost Accounting
BUS 483 Auditing
or 484 Advanced Accounting
ECO 258 lntermediate Macroeconomics
or 391 Public Finance
or 392 Money and Banking
Finance Uajw
y'dr'ZILkL
Students will take the following courses in addition to the core:
BUS 262 lntermediate Accounting I
BUS 373 Financial Management: Theory and Cases
BUS 381 Managerial Cost Accounting
or 382 Tax Accounting
BUS 478 lnvestments and Financial Institutions
ECO 258 lntermediate Macroeconomics
or 391 Public Finance
or 392 Money and Ba
Management
Students will complete the following courses in addition to the core:
BUS 145 Fundamentals of Management
BUS 250 Data Processing
BUS 340 Personnel Administration
BUS 373 Financial Management: Theory and Cases
or 478 lnvestments and Financial Institutions
BUS 440 Operations Management
ECO 340 Managerial Decision Making
ECO 445 Managerial Economics
Supporting Courses: Students with the help of their advisor will plan
supporting coursework from the following list:
PHI
PSY
PSY
SOC
SOC
or
SPC
or
SPC
ENG
120 Ethics
371 Psychology of the Individual: Male and Female
373 Organizational Psychology
241 lntroduction to Cultural Anthropology
375 Social Psychology
383 Racial and Minority Group Relations
354 Interpersonal Communications
355 Small Group Communications
113131 3 Public Speaking OR
225, 226, or 227 Advanced Writing
Marketing ~
~
~
Students will complete the following courses in addition to the core:
BUS 135 lntroduction to Marketing
BUS 250 Data Processing
BUS 330 Marketing Research and Analysis
BUS 430 Marketing Management
ECO 258 lntermediate Macroeconomics
ECO 445 Managerial Economics
(Continued Next Page)
7 1 ~ r ~ W s n r W k M i -
c).lk Kau u ,v+
.
U
C
~'&'&CS?
I
Communication Electives
Supporting Courses:
PHI 120 Ethics
SPC 351 Argumentation
or 352 Persuasion
SPC 353 Advertising
Business#linor
.
,\
Mmid+Sr~~
6 courses, including Business Administration 101, 102 and one of 261,
373, 379, 478; and one of 262, 379, 381 ; and Economics 122 and 123.
Other configurations for the Business Administration minor may be
permitted on consultation with the department chairperson.
COMMUNICATION
Communication is an interdisciplinary major which is broad in scope
and practical in application. The program consists of 15 courses; five in
related supporting fields such as psychology, sociology, speech, and
philosophy. Included is at least one course of internship experience in a
work setting serving the career goals of individual students. Students
may focus their lecture courses toward the development of career skills
in public relations and advertising, human relations, or supervisory
management. Majors in communication are candidates for the Bachelor
of Arts degree.
d
Required Communication Core
SPC 342 Mass Communications in Society
SPC 351 Argumentation
or 352 Persuasion
SPC 354 Interpersonal Communication
SPC 399 Internship
ENG 225 Advanced Writing
Required Supporting Courses:
SPC 113 Public Speaking
PHI 130 Logic
PSY 105 General Psychology
SOC 121 Principles of Sociology
or 241 lntroduction to Cultural Anthropology
SOC 375 Social Psychology
With the help of an academic advisor, the student will select five (5)
elective courses designed to meet additional background and skill
requirements in the careerareas of public relations and advertising,
human relations, or supervisory management.
The following are some of the electives recommended in each area:
Public Relations and Advertising:
BUS 135 Introduction to Marketing
BUS 145 Fundamentals of Management
BUS 379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
ENG 226 or 227 Creative Writing or Journalism
PSY 373 Organizational Psychology
SPCIART 132 Photography
SPCIART 225, 230 Visual Communications I, II
SPC 353 Advertising
SPC 480 Public RelationslPromotionaI Communications
Human Relations:
PSY 373 Organizational Psychology
PSY 485 Counseling Psychology
SOC 231 Sociology of the Family
SOC 383 Racial & Minority Group Relations
SPC 329 Intercultural Communication
SPC 353 Small Group Communication
SPC 480 Public Relations~PromotionalCommunications
Supervisory Management:
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
ECO
PSY
SPC
SPC
SPC
145 Fundamentals of Management
250 Data Processing
340 Personnel Administration
379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
440 Operations Management
340 Managerial Decision-Making
373 Organizational Psychology
353 Advertising
355 Small Group Communication
480 Public RelationsiPromotionaI Communications
Communication Minor
Five courses approved by the department.
MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEMS (MIS)
The MIS major prepares students to work in the growing field of
information management. The major combines courses and skills from
both the business and computer science majors to help students learn
about the identificatipn, organization, analysis and processing of
information in a buslnm s a n g .
*&3,u&
CSC
CSC
CSC
CSC
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
240
340
350
352
101
102
145
250
261
375
475
479
ECO
EGO
ECO
or
ECO
122
123
340
445
379
umyd
Algorithms for Computer Science
Elementary Computer Science
Digital Communications and Computer Networks
Data Structures and File Processing
Data Base Management and Decision
Principles of Financial Accounting
Principles of Managerial Accounting
Fundamentals of Management
Data Processing
Fundamentals of Finance
lnformation Systems in the Organization
lnformation Systems Analysis and Design
Intermediate Quantitative Methods for Economics and
Business
Principles of Economics-Macro
Principles of Economics-Micro
Managerial Decision Making
Managerial Economics
Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
174 Mattremdcal Algorithms br CarnpuOm Science
CSC
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
EC0
240
250
375
475
101
261
123
Elementary Computer Science
Data Processing
lnformation Systems in the Organization
lnformation Systems Analysis and Design
Principles of Financial Accounting
Fundamentals of Finance
Principles of Economics-Micro
NURSING MAJOR
Augsburg Weekend College offers registered nurses an upper division
nursing major as a second step toward the completion of the Bachelor of
Science degree. Fully accredited by the National League for Nursing, this
major is a professional program that is accessible to nurses who work and
are unable to attend classes during the weekdays.
Admissions - Procedures
Admission to the BSN program includes first being accepted into Augsburg
Weekend College through the procedures described on page 17. As
candidates for the nursing major, RN's must demonstrate evidence of
completion of an associate degree or diploma program, current nursing
practice, and Minnesota licensure. While an RN may take general
education courses, prerequisite courses for the nursing major,and two
initial courses in the major itself (NUR 303, 304), further progress in the
major is contingent upon:
1. Satisfactory completion at a college or university of the prerequisite
courses (Anatomy and Physiology, Microbiology, Inorganic Chemistry,
Organic or Biochemistry, English Composition, lntroductory Sociology
and lntroductory Psychology).
2. A cumulative gradepoint average of at least 2.5. A** U
q C~
q
~
3. Successful completion of validation testing for transfer of credit for
basic nursing courses.
Required Courses in the Nursing Major
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
NUR
PSY
303
304
310
311
325
330
350
403
404
423
437
355
Contemporary Nursing I: Communication Group (l/2 course)
Contemporary Nursing II: Nursing Theory ('12 course)
Community Health Nurs~ngI
Community Health Nursing II
Nursing Process
Trends and Issues in Nursing
Introduction to Nursing Research
Contemporary Nursing Ill: Nursing with Families
Contemporary Nursing IV: Leadership Management
Practicum in Nursing I
Practicum in Nursing II
Brain and Behavior
Recommended Supporting Courses
PHI 380
SPC 354
Ethics of Medicine and Health Care
Interpersonal Communication
d '4,
STUDENT SUPPORT SERVICES
SOCIAL WORK
Accredited by the Council on Social Work Education, the Bachelor of
Science in Social Work degree program at Augsburg College is built on
a solid liberal arts foundation, on theory-based training, and on
professionally directed field experiences. As important, social work
education at Augsburg is built on an appreciation for the needs,
concerns, and values of the individuals and groups who constitute
today's multi-cultural society. The Social Work major in Augsburg
Weekend College includes nine courses from the departments of
psychology, biology, and sociology. Concentrations are possible in the
areas of aging, chemical dependency, corrections, social ministries, and
youth work. Field work ,is an important component nf The program.
Social Work Courses*
Wq
SWK 257 Practicum in Human Services
SWK 260 Humans Developing
SWK 361 Systems of Social Welfare
SWK 363 Methods and Skills of Social Work
SWK 364 Field Work I
SWK 461 Advanced Methods and Skills in Social Work
SWK 462 Field Work II
SWK 463 Community Development and Organization
SWK 464 Field Work IV
SWK 465 Social Policy: Analysis and Development
SWK 466 Field Work 111 (Yz course)
SWK 467 The Social Worker as Professional
Required Supporting Courses:
BIO 101 Human Biology
PSY 105 General Psychology
SOC 121 Principles of Sociology
SOC 231 Sociology of the Family
SOC 365 Quantitative Analysis and Program Evaluation
SOC 375 Social Psychology
SOC 383 Racial and Minority Group Relations
*Students interested in Social Work should begin their program with the
required supporting courses. The professional sequence will be offered
when a sufficient number of students are ready for that portion of the
program.
Social Welfare Minor
6 courses including 257 or department approved alternative internship,
361, 463; Psychology 351 or Sociology 375; Sociology 383; and
Political Science 121 or 158 or 325, or Social Work 465.
Augsburg Weekend College provides a number of student services to
assist adults in making educational and career plans, accomplishing the
academic tasks of a college education, working on their own personal
development, and participating in activities beyond the classroom.
Some of these services are:
Academic Planning
All Augsburg Weekend College students will have access to expert
academic advising services on an on-going basis to provide for
efficient, effective planning. Students enrolling in Weekend College who
have had college experience will have their previous work evaluated
early in the admissions process.
Career Planning Setvices
Staff from the Career Planning and Placement Office will assist adults in
assessing their career goals and personal abilities. This service, in
combination with sound academic advising from faculty in a chosen
major field, can result in an appropriate and manageable educational
and career plan for the individual involved.
Academic Skills Center
This center exists to help students enhance their skills in the areas of
writing, reading, math, time management, and study skills. Academic
tutors in specialized course areas are also available through the Center.
CounselinglSupport Groups
Individual and group activities are available to students who wish to
work on a personal growth interest or concern or who simply want to
have the experience of being in a support group of people who share
some similar characteristics andlor interests.
DEAN'S LIST
-
--
The Dean's list is published after each trimester, listing students whose grade
point average for the trimester is 3.5 or better, based on a minimum of two full
courses, or equivalent, graded on the traditional grading system, with no
incompletes in the courses offered for credit.
ASSESSMENT OF PREVIOUS
LEARNING (APL) PROGRAM
FEES AND PAYMENT SCHEDULE
Augsburg College recognizes that learning can and does take place in
many life situations. Some of t h ~ slearning may be appropriate for credit
recognition within the disciplines thai compose the academic programs
of a liberal arts college. The APL program (Assessment of Previous
Learning) at Augsburg provides a means by which a student's previous
learning, other than that which is transferred from another accredited
institution, may be presented for examination for possible credit toward
the completion of a baccalaureate degree.
Not all learning from life experience, however, is appropriate for credit
recognition at a liberal arts college. Such learning must meet two
essential criteria: (1) it is relevant to coursework in a field of study within
the Augsburg liberal arts curriculum and (2) it can be objectively
demonstrated either by comprehensive examination or committee
evaluation.
The APL program at Augsburg provides several means by which
students may have' their previous learning assessed for credit
recognition:
L
15.00
$ 475.00
$ 325.00**
$
$
50.00
20.00
There will be a $10 additional fee for registration after the regularly
scheduled time, and a $25 late fee for registration after the first class
weekend.
Students who achieve acceptable scores in CLEP exams may receive
academic credit in Augsburg College. CLEP exams are available in a
variety of general and specific subject areas. For more information,
contact the Admissions Office (330-1002).
REFUND SCHEDULE
Departmental Assessment
A per course tuition refund will be made on the following basis:
(Students are responsible for cancelling courses with the Registrar's
Office in order to be eligible for the tuition refund.)
Students who wish to receive credit for a specific academic course and
do not have transcript evidence of completed work may request a
departmental assessment of previous learning. This will most often
include an examination that covers the essential components of the
course involved. For more information, contact the Registrar's
Office (330-1036).
CAP (Credit Assessment Process)
$
LATE FEES
CLEP (College Level Examination Program)
This is a credit assessment alternative in which a faculty committee
completes a credit evaluation of a learning portfolio submitted by the
student. Informational meetings and consultation are provided for
students who wish to prepare a portfolio of previous learning for credit
assessment. Students may apply for CAP after completing at least four
courses of academic work at Augsburg College with a cumulative GPA
of at least 2.5. For more information, contact the Registrar's
Office (330-1036).
Application Fee
(payable once, non-refundable)
Tuition
(per trimester course)*
Tuition
(per summer course)*
Lifetime Sports:
Fee for course
Fee for assessment of previous learning
-
Prior to the first scheduled class meeting - 100%
Prior to the second scheduled class meeting - 80%
Prior to the third scheduled class meeting - 60%
No refund after the third scheduled class meeting.
"Augsburg courses are comparatively large blocks of academic credit.
One Augsburg course is the equivalent of 6 quarter credits. 35 total
courses are needed to graduate.
**Tuition charge for 1984 summer terms.
FINANCIAL AID
There are a number of ways In which students may receive assistance
in meeting the costs of Augsburg Weekend College. The Financial Aid
Office will assist adults In assessing financial need and constructing an
aidlpayment program from the following alternatives:
Who May Apply
Men or women who have:
1) Graduated from high school or have earned a G.E.D. Certificate.
2) Demonstrated academic ability with satisfactory performance in high
school or previous college work.
Company Tuition Assistance Programs
Many comp~tfiies,agencies, and corprations offer full or partial tuition
assistance to employees who parffclpate in work-related or degree-
Admissions Process
1) Complete the aitached application form and return it along with
$1 5.00 to the Augsburg Weekend College Office.
oriented Goliege programs. Augsburg provides several payment plans
by which employees may handle tuition reimbursement.
Pell Grant Program
This is a federal aid program, based on need, that is available to
students who take at least a two-course load in Weekend College.
Minnesota Part-time Student Grant Program
The State of Minnesota provides an aid program, based on need, for
state residents who take a part-time load in an eligible Minnesota
institution such as Augsburg College.
Augsburg Tuition Grant
Augsburg College will provide grants and scholarships to Weekend
College students who show academic potential and have financial need.
Guaranteed Student LoanlMinnesota State Student
Loan Program
Studenb must carry at lea& owhall the normat full-time load. Eligibility
for the loan is determined by the Offlm of Student Financial S
~
W h ~ nrepayment begins, the student pays the full interest; 9% for
borrowers after January 1,1981. The maximum loan is $2,500 per year
or mthe cost of educatjon, whichever is less, and the aggregate
undergraduate maxfmum Es $1 2,500.Loan applicatlans are avall&e at
Augsburg, m e banks, a d the Minnesota StaZeiLoan Ofnce.
To Apply for Financial Aid
S
k
r
d
w
1) Complete the Appllcadon for Admission and indicate your desire to
also apply for financial aid.
2) The Financial Aid Office will m d you the necessary application
forms (or you may pick them up at the Financial Aid Office, 152
Science Hall).
3) Complete and return the financial aid forms by the deadlines
indicated.
4) Accept the financial aid offered, in whole or in part, within the
deadline stated.
~
.
2) Have official transcripts from all previously attended post-secondary
institutions sent to the Augsburg Weekend College Office. Applicants
with less than one year of previous coliege work should include their
high school transcripts or G.E.D. Certificates.
3) The Augsburg Weekend College Admissions Committee will review
the application materials and notify students regarding acceptance
and registration procedures.
4) Students who are transferring previous college work to their
Augsburg Weekend College degree program will be informed with
their acceptance notification as to the number of courses and degree
requirements that remain to be completed far the baccalaureate
degree.
5) Students who are accepted and whc choose to enroll in one or
more Augsbilrg Weekend College courses are asked to make a
$5i3.00tuition depgsit prior to rsgistration for that term.
6) Studefits who wlsh to apply for financial aid please refer to that
section of this bulletin.
Augsburg Weekend Colleae students will not be required to take
college entrance examinations. Ths Admissions Committee may.
however, request that !he studeni have a personal interview with a
Weekend College facultylsraff member or submit letters of
recommendation to the Committee. Students who are admitted
conditionally may .be referred to the Academic Skills Center and
encouraged to participate in the developmental skills programs that
are available.
Application Deadlines
Fall Trimester, 1984 - August 15, 1984
Winter Trimester, 1985 - December 15, 1984
Spring Trimester, 1985 - March 15, 1985
CAMPUS MAP
14. Stage 2 Theater
15. Little Theater
16. East Hall
A. Admissions Parking
B. Student Parking
C. Main Entrance-TunnellRamplSkyway
D. Quadrangle
E. Faculty-Staff Parking
F. Mur, hy Square
G. Practice Field
H. Fairview-St. Mary's Parking Ramp
CAMPUS MAP
FALL TRIMESTER, 1984
Class Schedule
Friday
6:OO-9:30
BUS 145
PHY 111
POL 326
SOC 383
Fundamentals of Management
Physics, Computers & Society*
Political Parties and Behavior
Racial and Minority Group Relations
Saturday BUS 101
8:30-12:OO BUS 250
BUS 261
BUS 381
CHM 109
E C 0 258
ENG 111
MAT 104
POL 342
SPC 113
SWK 463
Principles of Financial Accounting
Data Processing*
Fundamentals of Finance
Managerial Cost Accounting
General Chemistry*
lntermediate Macroeconomics
Effective Writing
Basic Math II*
Mass Communications
Public Speaking
Community Development & Organization
Saturday
1:15-4:45
BUS 101
BUS 135
BUS 262
BUS 440
ECO 251
MAT 174
NUR 303
NUR 325
PSY 105
SOC 231
SPC 354
Principles of Financial Accounting
Introduction to Marketing
lntermediate Accounting I
Operations Management
lntermediate Microeconomics
Math Algorithms for Computer Science I*
Contemporary Nursing I (Xcourse)
Nursing Process
General Psychology
Sociology of the Family
Interpersonal Communication
Sunday
1:15-4:45
ART 130 Photography
REL 363 Religion in America
SWK 361 Systems of Social Welfare
*This class will involve additional class or lab hours to be arranged.
Courses may be added to or subtracted from the class schedule on the
basis of enrollment.
WINTER TRIMESTER, 1985
Class Schedule
Friday
6:OO-9:30
ENG 351
HIS 467
PSY 373
SPC 113
SWK 364
Saturday B l O 101
8130-12100 BUS 101
BUS 102
BUS 263
BUS 373
CHM 110
ECO 123
MAT 174
MAT 175
NUR 350
PHI 130
SOC 121
SPC 354
Saturday
1:15-4:45
Sunday
1 :15-4:45
American Literature Since 1920
20th Century Asians
Organizational Psychology
Public Speaking
Field Work l
Human Biology
Principles of Financial Accounting
Principles of Managerial Accounting
Intermediate Accounting II
Financial Management
Organic and Biological Chemistry*
Microeconomics
Math Algorithms for Computer Science I*, **
Math Algorithms for Computer Science Il*
lntroduction to Nursinn
- Research
Logic
Principles of Sociology
Interpersonal Communication
BUS 102
BUS 330
BUS 340
BUS 375
E C 0 392
E C 0 445
MAT 114
NUR 304
SPC 352
SWK 363
Principles of Managerial Accounting
Marketing Research and Analysis
Personnel Administration
lnformation Systems in the Organization
Money and Banking
Managerial Economics
College Algebra and Trigonometry*
Contemporary Nursing II ( M course)
Persuasion
Methods and Skills of Social Work
ART 106
REL 111
Calligraphy
lntroduction to Theology
* This class will involve additional class or lab hours to be arranged.
** Continued from Fall Trimester.
Courses may be added to or subtracted from the class schedule on the
basis of enrollment.
SPRING TRIMESTER, 1985
Class Schedule
Friday
6:OO-9:30
ART 352 Women's Art History
POL 170 Law in the United States
SOC 375 Social Psychology*
Saturday 810 108
8130-12100 BUS 131
BUS 261
BUS 478
BUS 484
ECO 340
MAT 175
PHI 120
PSY 355
SPC 352
SWK 364
Microbiology*
Business Law
Fundamentals of Finance
Investments and Financial Institutions
Advanced Accounting
Managerial Decision Making
Math Algorithms for Computer Science II*, **
Ethics
Brain and Behavior*
Persuasion
Field Work I**
Saturday
1:15-4:45
BUS 102
BUS 379
BUS 430
BUS 475
ECO 122
ENG 111
ENG 225
NUR 330
REL 380
SPC 355
S WK 363
Principles of Managerial Accounting
Quantitative Methods for Business*
Marketing Management
lnformation Systems Analysis and Design
Macroeconomics
Effective Writing
Advanced Writing
Trends and Issues in Nursing
Music of the Western Church
Small Group Communication
Methods and Skills for Social Work**
Sunday
1:15-4:45
CSC 240
SPA 111
NOR 111
NUR 310
Elementary Computer Science*
Beginning Spanish
Beginning Norwegian
Community Health Nursing I
* This class will involve additional class or lab hours to be arranged.
** Continued from Winter Trimester.
Courses may be added to or subtracted from the class schedule on the
basis of enrollment.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
I
- -
--
II
ART 106 Calligraphy
Study of the art and craft calligraphy. Development of calligraphic skills in pen and brush with ink and paint.
i
ART 132 Photography
The camera used as a tool for visual creativity and expression
with attention to black and white photographic process. Needs
access to 35mm camera.
Distribution: Art
Major: Elective in Public Relations/Advertising major
Distribution: Art
i
I
I
I
1
ART 225 Visual Communications I
The theory and practice of visual perception and communication
using elements such as color, line, shape, texture, and
pictoral images.
Distribution: Art
Major: Elective in Public Relations/Advertising major
ART 3 3 0 Y!sual Communlcaflo~s11
A study of tho visual communications in magazines, television,
film, advertising symbols, and other mass media. Practice in
the areas of photography, typography, and illustration.
(Prereq: 225)
Distribution: Art (upper division)
Major: Elective in Public Relations/Advertising major
ART 352 Women's Art History
A study of women's image in the visual arts in relationship to
women's place within tile cultural, economic, and sociological
envfronmenl of each perrod.
Distribution: Art, Urban Concerns/Minority Studies, (upper
division)
810 101
1
1
I
Human Blolagy
&SIC b~ologrcal
concepts from an anthropmenttic point of
VIEW. An attempt to answer such questions as: What makes
man just another member of the biotic fold? Does man have a
niche in the ecosystem? What influence does man have on the
environment? What ~nfluencedoes the environment, especially
the urban environment, have on man? (Doesnot apply to the
major or minor).
Distribution: Biology
Major: Required supporting course in Social Work
610 108 Microbiology
Basic microbial features are considered as well as applications
of microbiology to the field of medicine and sanitation. For
student nurses, health majors or consent of the instructor.
(Prereq: Chem 109 and concurrent registration in Chem 110
or consent of instructor. Does not apply to major or minor)
Distribution: Biology
Major: Prerequisite for the BSN major
BUS 101 Prlnclples of Flnanclal Accounting
lntroductionto business activities, basic concepts, and fundamentals of accounting, the accounting cycle and preparation
of financial statements.
Major: Required for Business Administration core and MIS major
BUS 102 Prlnclples of Managerlal Accounting
lntroductionto business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of managerial accounting. Planning and controlling
processes, decision-makingand behavioral considerations.
(Prereq: 101)
Major: Required for Business Administration core and MIS major
BUS 13 1 Buslness Law
Legal rules relating to contracts, agency, negotiable instruments, property and business organizations under the Uniform
Commercial Code.
Major: Required for Business Administration core
BUS 135 lntroductlon to Marketlng
Principles of basic policy and strategy issues in marketing.
Legal, ethical, competitive, behavioral, economic and technological factors as they affect product, promotion, marketing
channel and pricing decisions.
Major: Required for Marketing major, elective in Public Relations1Advertising major
BUS 145 Fundamentals of Management
Development of the theory of management, organization, staffing,
planning and control. The nature of authority, accountability and
responsibility, analysis of the role of the professional manager.
Major: Required for Business Management major in Business
Administration and MIS major, elective in Public Relations1
Advertising and Supervisory Management majors
in Communication
BUS 2 5 0 Data Processing
An introduction to COBOL and other non-scientific programming
languages.
Major: Required in Business Management and Marketing major
and MIS major; elective in Supervisory Management major
BUS 2 6 1 Fundamentals of Finance
Theory of acquisition, allocation and management of funds
w~thlnthe flr~n:sources and uses of long and short term funds,
cost of capital, capital budgeting, leverage, dividend policy,
and related topics. (Prereq. 101, 102)
Major: Required for Business Administration core and
MIS major
BUS 262 lnkrmedlate Accounting I
An analysis of accountrnc] theory pertaining to financial
statements, income concepts, capital stock and surplus accounts,
current and long-term zlssets. (Prereq: 101, 102)
Major: Required in the Accounting and Finance majors
BUS 263 Intermediate Accountlng 11
An analysa of accounting theory pertaining to investments,
tangible and intangible f~xedassets, liabilities and reserved:
actuarial topics. Additional emphasis on income determ~nat~on
considering price lev4 changes. (Prereq: 262)
Major: Required in the Accounting major
BUS 330 Marketing Research and Analysls
Research proces as an aid to rlecision-making in marketing
managemenl; respArch methodology; marketing research results;
evaluation of the effectiveness of research In marketing.
(Prereq: Bus. Acl. 135 or consent of rnstructor)
Major: Required in Marketing major (upper division)
BUS 340 Personnel AdmlnPstratlon
Personnel funct~onIn business, acquisit~onand utilization of
human resources, deslrahle work~ngrelationships; effective Integrat~onof tile worker wilh the qoals of the f~rmand society.
(Prereq, Bus. Ad. I 4 5 or consent of ~nstnlctor)
Major: Required for Business Management major, elective in
Supervisory Management major (upper division)
BUS 373 Financial Management: Theories and Cases
Advar:ceci financ~altheory: a systelns approach to financial
slrtlcture and policy. Emphasis on dcxaiurl-making,prwentation
through literature, reacllngs, lecturer; and case material.
(Prereq: 261 )
Major: Required in Finance and Business Management majors
(upper division)
BUS 3 7 5 Information Systems in the Organization
Design and implementation of organizational structure and
structural change. An informational processing point of view
to examine design of communication, decision making and
task systems.
Major: Required in the MIS major (upper division)
BUS 379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
An introduction to quantttat~verwsonlny, descr!ptrve measures,
prohabilitv,sampling distributions, inference and estimation
wlth ernphas~son thekr use in appliecl prablrsms in b~~sinoss
ant1 ecnnomlcs. (Prureq: I-llgh Scllool Algebra)
Major: Required for Business Administration core and MIS
major (upper division)
BUS 478 Investments and Financial fnstltutlons
Appraisal of the risklreturn relationships of various types of
securities from the viewpoint at bolh individual and institutional
investors. Extensive coverage of capital markets and portfolio
management. (Prereq: 261. ECO 3'32 is strongly recommended)
I
I
I
C#M 109 Qeneml, Owanlc and Blologieal Chemistry
Deslgned for students who need a survey of the fundamentals
of general, organlc and b~ologlcalchem~stryfor careers in
allied health areas such as nurslng (~ncludingAugsburg's
upper dlv~sionprogram). Open also to other students.
F~rstterm, general chemistry prlnc~plesand an ~ntroduction
to organic chemisrry Will ~ncludsarranged time for laboratory
work This course does not apply toward Ihe major or mlnor
in chem~stry.
Distribution: Chemistry
Major: Required prerequisite for Nursing major
Major: Required in Accounting major and one of a choice
of two required courses in the Finance major (upper division)
BUS 430 Marketing Management
Integration of rnark~trnywlth other bi~sinessfunctions; marketing
management and dec~s~on
rnaktng, planr-iing marketing programs,
chanrir?lsof distribution, pricing, product selling and promot~on
policies. (Prereq: 511sAd 330 or consent of ~nstructor)
I
BUS 440 Operaflons Management
Concepts and pr'inciples r d a t d to the management of operating
functions. Examples from service industries, non-profit
organizations and manufaclurinq. Taught from a managerial
wlnt of view. Topics ~nclude:an ovcrv~ewof operations,
planning clp~ratronproceses, product~vitymeasurement,
standards, forecasting, concepts of quality, inventory manage
ment, principles of scheduling, and operational control
information systems. (Prereq: Junior or Senior or consent
of instructor)
Major: Required in the Business Management major and an
elective in the Supervisory Management major (upper division)
BUS 4 7 5 lnformation Systems Analysis and Design
The process of defining information requirements,construction
of a logical model of information system and the preparation of
a general design. Discussion of the procedures to define
program specifications, documentation, and plan implementation.
Major: Required in the MIS major (upper division)
BUS 484 Advanced Accounting
Accounting for business combinations, governmental accounting, partnership accounting and fund accounting. (Prereq: 263)
Major: Required in the Accounting major (upper division)
BUS 3 8 1 Managerlad Cost AecauntPng
Accounting tools for plann~ngand control of economic activities.
Plannln(l, buclqeting, standard cost systems, as well as other
q~mnlitativnand hnhavlor;~ltoprm. ( Proreq: 101, 102)
Major: Required in the Marketing major (upper division)
Major: Required in the Finance major and one of a choice of
two required courses in the Management major (upper division)
1
+
CHM 110 Generat, Omanic and Eiolagfef Chemlstry
Continuati011of Chemistry 109. Organic and biological
chemistry with special applications lo human phys~ological
chem~stry.Will include arranged time for laboratory work.
Does not apply toward the major or minor In chemistry.
Distribution: Chemistry
Major: Required prerequisite for Nursing major
CSC 2 4 0 Elementary Computer Sclence
An introduction to computer organization and structure, assembly
and machine languages, computer logic design, number and
character representations, and functions of components of
computer systems. Continued development of structured programming concepts. (Prereq: Math 175 or both Math 124 and
Computer Science 170)
Major: Required in the MIS major
ECO 122 Prlnclples of Economics [Macro)
An ~nlroductionto macroeconomics; national income analysis,
monetary an? fiscal policy, internatlonal trade, economic
growth, Appllcalion of elementary economic theory to current
economic problems. May be taken independently of Economics
123 or 120. Economics 122 and 123 may b?taken In either order.
Distribution: Economics
Major: Required for Business Administration core
ECO 123 Principles of Economics (Micro)
An introduction to microeconomics, the theory of the house
hold, firm, market structures and income distribution.
Application of elementary economic theory to market policy.
May be taken independently of Economics 122 or 120.
Economics 122 and 123 may be taken in either order.
Distribution: Economics
Major: Required for Business Administration core
ECO 2 5 1 Intermediate Mlcroeconomics
Theory of resource allocation, analysis of consumer behavior,
firm and industry; the pricing of factors of production and
income distribution; introduction to welfare economics.
( Prereq: 123)
Major: Required for Business Administration core
0
ECO 445 Managerial Economics
Integrates economic theory and corresponding practices in
business. Among the topics considered are theories and
practices in forecasting, estimation of demand and cost
functions, price and non-price competition, production and
cost considerations, and an analysis of economic problems of
relevance to management. (Prereq: Eco 251 or equivalent or
consent of instructor)
Major: Required in the Management and Marketing majors and
one of a choice of two required courses in the MIS major
(upper division)
ENG 111 Effective Writing
The study of composition with emphasis on expository writing.
Attention to correct usage, logical organization, and the
research paper. The grading system for this course is either
PIN or 2.0-4.OlN.
ECO 2 5 8 Intermediate Macroeconomics
Determinants of national income, employment and price level
analyzed via macromodels. Attention paid to areas of monetaryfiscal policy, growth and the business cycle. (Prereq: 122)
Major: Required in the Marketing major and one of a choice
of three required courses in the Accounting and Finance majors
Distribution: Required for graduation
ENG 2 2 5 Advanced Expository Writlng
The development of essays in a variety of rhetorical modes,
which may include identification, definition, classification,
illustration,comparison and contrast, and analysis. Particular
attention will be given to stylistic and organizational matters
through the course's workshop format, in which students'
papers are read and discussed. (Prereq: 111)
Major: Required for Communications core, elective for
Business Management major
ECO 340 Managerial Decision Making
Provides a sound conceptual understanding of the modern
techniques of management science to prepare students to
make better business and economic decisions. Emphasis is on
applications, which are taken from the areas of transportation,
marketing, porl-folio selection, environmental protection,
the shortest route, inventory models, information systems,
etc. (Prereq: Econ. 123, Bus. Ad. 101 and high school
algebra or equivalents)
Major: Required for Business Management major and MIS major,
elective in Supervisory Management major (upper division)
ENG 2 4 1 introduction to Cinema Art
An investigation of the artistic qualities and the historical
development of the film medium. The course includes the
viewing and discussing of both feature length and short films.
Distribution: English
ECO 392 Money and Banking
Functioning of the monetary and banking systems, particularly
commercial banks, the Federal Reserve System and its role in
relation to aggregate economic activity. Emphasis placed on
monetary theory and policy. (Prereq: 122)
ENG 2 6 1 Modern Fiction
Significant works of selected prose writers, chiefly European,
of the twentieth century.
Distribution: English
Major: One of a choice of three required courses in the
Accounting and Finance majors (upper division)
i
n
1
ENG 3 5 1 American Literature Since 1920
A study of some recent and contemporary writers and literary
movements. Attention is given to the dynamics of American
society and its intricate relationshipto the literature. Special
emphasis is given to the city as setting and symbol in modern
American literature.
Distribution: English or Urban Concerns (upper division)
MAT 114 College Algebra and Trigonometry
FRE 111 Bqlnning French
Designed to ~ntroducethe student with no previous background
in French to the language and to French culture. The prcF
nunc~ationsystem and basic sentence structures are taught
to enahle understanding and expression on a rudimentary level.
Distribution: Foreign Language
,-
IffBeginning Oerman
Course I 1 1 is for students with no previous background. Aims
at developing basic skills. Classroom practice in speaking,
understanding and read~ngbasic German. Goals: abll~tyto
read extended narratives in simple German, insights Into German cuRur~and ~arlicloatianIn short c o n ~ e ~ t i o nLaboratory
s.
materials available.
IL
MAT 174 Mathemetleaf Algorithms for Computer Science I
A sludy of Boolean algebras, finite sums, infinite series,
areas, integrals, functions, and finlte d~fferences,while
learning a higher level computer programming language.
(Prereq: Score of IV on Math Placement Exam)
Major: Required for the MIS major
Distribution: Foreign Language
HIS 3 3 1
Teplcs Im U.S. History: $945to Present
A survey of the p r ~ n c ~trends
pl
In American politia and
foreign policy from the end of Wor.ld War II to the present.
Social and cu2turnl trends also are emphasized, particularly
as they relate to politics and the conduct of foreign pol~cy.
MAT 175 Mathematical Algorithms for Computer Science I1
Further programming work in studying derivatives and antiderivatives, graph theory, comvinatorics, searching and
sorting, probability, groups, transcendental functions, and
functions of several variables. (Prereq: 174)
Distribution: History (upper division)
NOR 11 1 Beginning Norwegian
Inlrociuction of the four basic language skills: speaking.
20th Century Asfans
There are more Asians In the world today than any other ~ c r p l e .
In this course we will look at some of Ihe events and processes
of our century which have created today's Asians. There will
be a particular focus on certain of the great individuals such
as Gandhi, Mao, Ho and Atlaturk who as individuals and as
leaders lamd ihe chatlenges of rnoderntzatton and of the wed.
Distribution: History (upper division)
Ilsten~ng,reading and writing. Stress on spoken rather
than litwary Norwegian. Laboratory work expected. (The
continoation of Norwegian, NOR 112, will be offered in
Summer, 1985)
Distribution: Foreign Language
NUR 3 0 3 Contemporary Nursing I:
Communkations/Group [lh course)
I
MAT f 04 B a s k Math #U
A review of hasic arithmetic concepts and a study of algebraic
expressions including exponents, radicals, and rational expressions; algebraic processes including factoring; solving
in one variable, lncluchng linear
equations and ineq~~allties
and quadratic; and graphs of linear and quadratic equations
and linear inequalities In two variables. Does not satisfy
llie general educat~onrequirement In mathematics.
Fundamental operations, factoring, fractions, functions, and
graphs, linear equations, exponents and radicals, quadratic
equations, ratio and variation, progression, binomial theorem,
logarithms and trigonometric functions.
Distribution: Math
Major: Strongly recommended for Business Administration
major prior to taking Bus 379 and for the MIS major prior to
taking Mat 174
P
*
This course is one of the transitional courses that introduces
the student to components of the professional role and begins
the professional and socialization process. The communication
process is emphasized as one means by which the nurseclient
relationship is established and maintained. Interactive
communication theories are explored for their applicability
to changing roles and professional practice.
Major: Required for upper division Nursing major
NUR 3 0 4 Contemporary Nursing 11:
Nursing Theory [lh course)
The course introduces theories and conceptual thinking in
the process of professional development:The function of
theory in guiding nursing practice is emphasized. Selected
nursing theories are examined.
Major: Required for upper division Nursing major
PHI 130 Logic
Suppose someone gives you reasons, and then says you must
accept a particular conclusion. Must you? When does a
conclusion validly follow from premises? Here we examine
the rules which govern valid arguments and work to develop
your ability to recognize and construct sound arguments.
Distribution: Philosophy
Majoc Required supporting course for Communication major
NUCI 3 10 Community Health Nursing I
7 his course focuses on systems theory, change, and concepts
of health as they apply to current ~omrnunityhealth issues
and the practce of nursing. Cl~nlcalapplication of course
content will involve making a health assessment and exptorinq (? ~ o m r n ~ ~ nhealth
i t y Issue. (Fall-klun~or
year.
Prereq: Acceptance into the Nursing major)
Major: Required for upper division Nursing major
NUR 3 2 5 Nursing Process
In this course the student learns approaches to assessment and
the use of assessment tools in the nursing process. The student
uses communication skills to obtain a health history and
negotiate health goals. Cl~nlcatexperiences provide the student
with an opportunity to mnko a holistic health assessment with~n
a developmental framework. (Junlar year. Prereq: Acceptance
into the Nursing major)
Majoc Required for upper division Nursing major
NUR 330 Trends and Issues In Nursinlq
Th~scourse 1s rles~qnecito ~nvestiqateIhe curr'ent responsibilities
of the protwional nurse. Cantnrnpora~ysocial and professional
trends and issties are explored In lrght of their implications
for nursing practice.
Major: Required for upper division Nursing major
lVUR 350 Intmdrrctkn tu Nursing Reseamh
The researcl~procnss and m ~ t h o d sappropriate to nursing are
the focl~sof this course Issue of ethrcs in nursing research are
explored Studenis critique nilrslng msearch for ~ t s
applicability
to nurslng pracllce. (Junlor year Prereq: Acceptance ~ntothe
i\lurslnq major. Math 1 21 or a course In descriptive stat tstics)
Majoc Required for upper division Nursing major
PH1 120 Ettrfcs
Sornet~rnesyou say that a certain action is right or condemn it
as wronn. Whv do you thtnlc it is right7 Rec-..l.nuseyou like it?
Are thek bettier ~ P A S O ~ Sfor thinking mmething rrght or wrong?
I h ~ cotlrse
s
taltes a long, liarcl loolc at poss~blegrounds for
rnnkinn moral clecisrcrnn, and at the moral ji~dgrnentsabout
persorial and soclal ~ s s u rosult~ng
~s
from thcm.
Distribution: Philosophy
Majoc Required for the Marketing major and a recommended
supporting course for the Management major
f1
PHY 11 1 Physfcs, Cornpute~sand Saclety
A study of the ti~stor~cal
development of selected topics in
phystcal sctence. Attention will be given to the interaction of
physics and its assocrated technology with philosophy, religion,
ancl culture. Stirdy of mechanics, electricity, and dlgltal
electronics wjll lead up to discussion of the meaning of twentieth
century physics and of the role of electronics and computers
in modern society. M~crocornputers
will be used extens~vely
in the laboratory.
Distribution: Physics
POL 12 1 American Government and Politlcs
The polrtics of American government including the forms of
political ideas; the pattern of participation; the dynamics of
congressional, presidential and bureaucrat~cpolicymaking;
and current Issues in American society.
Distribution: Political Science
POL 170 Law in the United States
A survey of American law and legal process. Theories of law;
law and society; roles of courts, police, lawyers, and juries;
the United States Constitution as "supreme" law, law as
politics; historic and contemporary legal issues.
Distribution: Political Science
POL 326 Political Partles and Behavlor
The political behavior of the electorate emphasizing public
opinion and political parties in the electoral process. Field
work with political parties and interest groups and media in
presidential elections. (Prereq: 1 course in Political Science
or consent of instructor)
Distribution: Political Science (upper division)
POL 342 Mass Communlcatlons In Soclety
Effects of mass communications on individual behavior; the
uses and control of mass media for political and social purposes including a study of censorship, newsmaking, entertainment and public affairs programming.
Distribution: Urban Concerns (upper division)
Major: Required for the Communication major
PSY 105 General Psychology
An introduction to the methods and approaches used in psychology for the purpose of understanding behavior. The
structure of the field of psychology, including its major
sub-areas, is emphasized.
Distribution: Psychology
Major: Required supporting course for Communication majors
and Social Work major, a prerequisite for advanced courses
in psychology
r
I
v
PSY 355 Braln and Behavlor
A survey of the funct~onsof the nervous system which are
respons~bl~
for behavior in animals and human beings. Major
toprcs include: sleep and wahefullness, motivation and emotion,
le~rningand memory and mental disorders. {Prereq: 105 and
one course in biology)
Major: Required prerequisite course for upper division
Nursing major
Distribution: Sociology
Major: Required supporting course for Communication major
and Social Work major
SOC 2 3 1 Sociology of the Famlly
An examination of the family as a social institution. The
process of dating, mate selection, marital adjustment and
divorce. The relationship of the family to its institutional
and cultural context.
Major: Required supporting course in Social Work major
and an elective in the Human Relations major
REL 111 lntroductlon to Theology
An introduction to the academic discipline of theology and to
the dialogue between the church and the world which concerns
Christian doctrine.
Distribution: Religion
REL 380 Muslc of the Western Church
Development and influence of the music of the Christian
church. Designed for the general student as well as for
organists, choir directors, and pretheological students.
Distribution: Religion or Music (upper division)
REL 354 Life of the Church in the City
The Gospel and various forms of ministry evident in urban
structures.
Distribution: Religion or Urban Concerns (upper division)
REL 363 Religion in America
A study of the development of religion in America. Special
attention to the rise of religious liberty, revivalism, denominations and the responses of religion to the challenges
of its environing culture.
Distribution: Religion (upper division)
SOC 12 1 Principles of SacloIogy
Sociology as a mode of analysis or way of knowing. Its application to an understanding of basic aspects of society; socialization, family life, social inequalities, largescale institutions,
etc. Sociology as an academic discipline and profession.
PSY 373 OgranfzeHonal Psychology
Theoret~calmnceptualirations of organizational behavior.
Faclors and practices such as management styles, evaluation
and maintenance of work effectiveness, and social influences.
An organizational field experience. (Prereq: 105)
Major: Supporting course for Business Management major and
elective for all Communication majors (upper division)
REL 2 2 1 Blbllcal Studies
The origin, literary character, and transmission of the Biblical
documents. The task of biblical interpretation. The history of
Israel and the emergence of the church.
Distribution: Religion
REL 3 5 6 #/story of Rellglons
An introductory survey of some of the major living religions
of the world, incltlding Hinduism, Buddhism, Confucianism,
Taoism, Shinto and Islam. Lectures plus some discussion of
primary documents from these religious communities.
Distribution: Religion (upper division)
4
I
L
SOC 375 Social Psychology
An exammation of the idea of "group", its relationship to
indiv~clualbehavior and society. An analysis of the ldeas of
"self and "identrty" and what part they play in understanding
view
interpersonal relations and human behavior. A soc~olag~cal
of mental health, h look at the malor ass~~mptions
ancl pracesses
underly~ngoirr everyday life-a look at the trivial, the ordinary
and the taken-for-granted. "Symbolic rnteraction", an imporrant
orlontation in social psychology, will be usecl as a way of dcallng
w~th(he major rssues In the caurse. (Prereq: 121 or Psych 105)
Major: Required supporting course for Communication majors
and Social Work major, elective supporting course for
Business Management major (upper division)
SPC 3 5 5 Small Group Communication
A study of group dynamics and leadership with emphasis on
factors involved in effective functioning within small groups
and organizations.
SOC 3 8 3 Raclal and Mlnorlty Group Relations
The dimensions of racial and minority group relations. Major
attention is focused upon prejudice, racism, and the role of
self-understanding.
Distribution: Speech (upper division)
Major: Recommended supporting course in the Business
Management, Human Relations and Supervisory Management
majors
Distribution: Minority Studies
Majoc Required supporting course for Social Work major and
elective supporting course in the Business Management major
(upper division)
SPA 111 Beglmnlmg Spanish
Aims to dc:velop the four basic skills understanding, speaking,
readfng, and writing of elementary Spanish. Introduction to
culture of Spanish-speakingworld. Laboratory work is an
integral part of the course. (The continuatton of Spanish,
SPA 112, will be offered in Summer, 1985)
L
SPC 480 Public Relations/PromotionaI Communications
Public Relations in the modern world of communication,
marketing and business. An overview of public relations as a
career and a survey of basic promotional communication in
profit and non-profit organizations.
Major: Elective in all Communication majors (upper division)
Distribution: Foreign Language
SWK 361 Systems of Social Welfare
An examination of fundamental aspects of the various
systems of social welfare in the U.S. and the role of social
work in them. Special emphasis on analysis of the major
assumptions and movements contributory to the rise of the
welfare state; description of a selection of modern service
systems, the profession of social work, its ethics, values,
and historical development. Guest lectures, research paper.
(Sophomore or consent of instructor)
SPC 113 Public Speaklng
3 13 Basic problems of effective speaking and listening. May be
taken for lower and upper division credit upon consultation
with instructor.
Distribution: EnglishISpeech
Majoc Required supporting course in Communication major
Elective supporting course in Business Management major
Major: Required for Social Work major (upper division)
SPC 352 Persuaskn
Theory of persuasion and propaganda, practical work in speech
and promotional projects.
SWK 363 Methods and Skills of Social Work
Basic features of the helping process; theoretical foundations,
principles and techniques of social work interventive methods,
and practical experience necessary for social work practice
with individuals and small groups; development of the student's
repertoire of relationship building skills. Lecture-discussion
sessions and/or laboratory exercises each week. (Prereq:
361, Junior)
Majoc Required for Communications major, supporting course
in Marketing major (upper division)
SPC 3 5 3 Advertislng
An introduction to print and broadcast advertising and promotion as important elements in modern marketing and
communication.
Majoc Supporting course in Marketing major, elective in
Public RelationsIAdvertising and Supervisory Manage
ment majors (upper division)
SPC 3 5 4 Intemrsonal Communlcat~on
A study of the dynamics of human interaction through verbal
and non-vwbal messages; emphasis on factors that build
rekatimsh~psand help lo overcome communication barriers.
Distribution: EnglishISpeech (upper division)
Majoc Required for Communication core, elective supporting
course in Business Management major
Major: Required in the Social Work major (upper division)
I
I
\
S WK 364 Field Work I
Beginning supervised professional experience in a social work
agency focusing on interviewing experience and relationship
building. Ten hours per week, plus one small group supportive/
discussion seminar per week. (Prereq: 361, Junior, concurrent
with 363)
Major: Required in the Social Work major (upper division)
SWK 4 6 1 Advanced Methods and Skills In Soclal Work
Enlargement and refinement of practice skills through lecture,
classroom exercise and regular class work. Enlargement of
social group work skills, emphasis on development of generalist
practice skills and eclectic approaches. Lectures and/or
laboratory exercises each week. (Prereq: 2.0 in 363 and in
364, candidacy status, or consent of instructor. Concurrent
with 462)
Majoc Required in the Social Work major (upper division)
SWK 462 Field Work I1
Progressively responsible supervised professional social work
experience including work with individuals, families, groups
and/or communities in a social service agency. Ten hours
per week, plus one supportive/discussionseminar per week.
(Prereq: completion and 2.0 in 361,362, 364, candidacy
status; concurrent with 461 and 467)
I
I
t
Winter
Trimester
Spring
Trimester
Orientation
Aug 25, '84
Jan 3, '85
Apr 11, '85
Registration
Aug 25, '84
Jan 5, '85
Apr 13, '85
Classes Begin
Sep 7-9, '84
Jan 4-6, '85
Apr 12-14, '85
Last day to register and/
or drop class without
record notation.
Sep 9, '84
Jan 6, '85
Apr 14, '85
Last day to designate
grading option.
Oct 21, '84
Feb 17, '85
May 18, '85
Last day to withdraw
from class.
Nov 18, '84
Mar 10, '85
Jun 9, '85
Classes end
Dec 2, '84
Mar 24, '85
Jun 23, '85
Final exams
Dec 7-9, '84
Mar 2431, '85 Jun 28-30, '85
Final grades due
Dec 17, '84
Apr 8, '85
I
Majoc Required in the Social Work major (upper division)
SWK 463 Community Development and Orgsnlxaffon
Locality development and social c h ~ n g ethrough community
organisateon, social planning, and soclal action. Emphasis on:
1) survey of histor~calforrnsaf social change, 2) understanding
the basic issues and strategres relevant to social protest and
change, 3) examination of the role of staff, and of thc functions
and rnterrelationsh~psof comrnunlty organizations, and 4) knowledge of and actual practice in the essential prrnciples and
techniques of olqaniririg. (Prereq:Senlor or consent of
instructor)
Majoc Required in the Social Work major (upper division)
Fall
Trimester
I
Ju18, '85
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Interim Catalog, 1984
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUCSBURC COLLEGE
Minneapolis, Minnesota
1984 Interim Catalog
POSTMASTER
Volume 114, Number 4
Winter 1983
612/300-1001
AUCSBURC COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) is published four times a year in Spring, Summer, Fall,
and Winter by Augsburg College, 731 21st Avenue South, Minneapolis, M N 55454. Sec...
Show more
AUCSBURC COLLEGE
Minneapolis, Minnesota
1984 Interim Catalog
POSTMASTER
Volume 114, Number 4
Winter 1983
612/300-1001
AUCSBURC COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) is published four times a year in Spring, Summer, Fall,
and Winter by Augsburg College, 731 21st Avenue South, Minneapolis, M N 55454. Secondclass postage paid at Minneapolis, Minnesota.
Augs,burgCollege lnterim
The interim is an integral part of the school year at Augsburg College. It is particularly
intended to be a time for both students and faculty to employ styles of teaching and learning
and to investigate questions and topics in places and ways not possible during the regular
term. Since one course equals a full time load, students should plan to spend the same
amount of time in class and preparing for class as they would for a four course load during
Fall and Spring semesters.
0
OCT
NOV
DEC
Calendar for Full Credit Courses
....................................
October 31-November 4.
Interim Registration
December 5 ...........................................Late Interim Registration
First Day of Interim
January 3.. .................................................
Class 1 9:00 a.m.
Class 11 1:00 p.m.
January 4..
Last day for cancel/add
January 17.. ................ Last day for determining grading system with Registrar
January 20.. ........................... Last day for withdrawing from full courses
January 27.. ......................................................
Interim ends
..............................................
Calendar for Half Credit Courses
...............................
January 3..
First group of half credit courses begins
January 4 . . .............................Last day to cancel/add half credit courses
January 9 . ........... Last day for determining grading system for half credit courses
January 11.. .....................Last day for withdrawing from half credit courses
January 13.. ...............................First group of half credit courses ends
January 16.. ...........................Second group of half credit courses begins
January 17.. ............................Last day to cancel/add half credit courses
January 23. .......... Last day for determining grading system for half credit courses
January 25.. ..................... Last day for withdrawing from half credit courses
January27........................................................
lnterimends
The interim day is divided into two blocks of time:
II - 1:00 - 5:00 p.m.
I - 8:00 - 12:OO Noon
The number and length of class meetings as well as the beginning time will be arranged the
first day of class.
4/l nterim
Essential Information
One course is considered a full time load during interim and no student is permitted to
register for more than one course credit during the period.
There i s no tuition refund for a student who chooses not to enroll in an interim course.
Most interim courses are graded traditionally on a scale of 4.0 to 0. Students generally have
the option to register on a Pass/No credit basis. A few interim courses are graded only on the
P/N system; this i s indicated in the course description.
Some courses are offered with either upper or lower division standing. Such interim courses
have two numbers listed and the student must select. Students registering for upper division
standing should anticipate additional assignments and a more rigorous grading standard.
To graduate, an Augsburg student is required to complete 35 courses of which at least three
must be interim courses (or one interim less than the number of years of full time enrollment
at Augsburg; e.g., a transfer enrolled full time for two years is required to complete one
interim for graduation.)
This Catalog
This catalog lists courses by departments with departments listed in alphabetical order. At the
end of the book are listings of other courses not offered by Augsburg but recognized by the
College for interim credit. Further descriptions and information about these courses are
available in the lnterim Office, Memorial 230. Students may also register for one of the
Lifetime Sports listed on the last page.
Location Key
L-Library Building
M-Music Hall
OM-Old Main
P-Psychology Building
S-Science Hall
Options
International Interims-Students are invited to consider being part of one of the three
overseas interims offered by Augsburg College during January 1984. These interims are under
the following departments:
Health-Sailing i n the Virgin Islands
Political Science - Mass Media and Politics i n Britain, France, Germany and Austria
Religion-Israel and Egypt: Archaeology and Religion
Augsburg students are also eligible for participation in one of the 28 international interims
offered by the Upper Midwest Association for lnternational Education (UMAIE) as well as
travel interims offered by other 4-1-4 schools in the country.
Further academic description, travel details and cost estimates are available in the lnterim
Office and from Mary Kingsley in the lnternational Center, Old Main 20.
Students interested in participating i n one of these international interims should apply in the
lnternational Center before November 1. Additions to the overseas groups usually cannot be
made after that date.
There will be no June interim in 1984.
-
Internships
Students electing an internship interim must present a completed internship
learning contract to the Internship Office (Memorial 230) no later than Tuesday, November
22. Contract forms are available in the same office.
Independcmt or DhWcd Study
Students may elect a program of independent study
(upper dlvislon 499) or directed study (!owerdivblon 299) for interim. Faculty members are
strongly drseouraged fram accepting responsibility for more than one independent or
dlrected study per interlm. student^ choosing to pursue independent or directed study must:
-
A. Meet departmental requirements,
6. Present to the lnterim Director for approval a copy of the proposed study plan approved
by the supervising faculty member. This proposal must be submitted at -I
one week
before registration and not later than November 28. Apprgpriatestudy propo$alforms can
be obtained in the lnterim Office.
Inftdma at Qthw -Is
Augsburg students may enroll at any other 4-74 Instltutlan
which offers a reclprocai lnterlm arrangepent. CataIags of these Interlmscan be consulted in
the Interim Offlee. The Interim Secretary wIti help students in appiylng for ~giwrationat
other schoals. Registration for lntwlms at rhe h e r Twin CMes college wlll be done at
Augsburg during the regular reghtratlon period. Most courses taught during the interim w
other 4-14schoolsare accepted forcredit by Aughurg, but ma not necessarily beaccepted
as meeting Augsburp'r distributhn rsquirem~ntr.Thls quiklcailon putlcuhtly J f a
courses offered for the Reiiglon requirement.
-
Non-Aupburg Students
e welcamee studenw from athat 44-4 schools far the jaiiiiary Interim
*hkoul tul~ion%rp provided he wudcnlt honr instlhltlon ql.a.not to cbar
to Au$bug students for the January tern. he walver of tuition,does not Indu$
e special
luirion
fees, housing or board costs. 0 t h nudem wlII be c h a r d $720 for the lnterlm course,
#upburg Cot
Students interested in regfstwing for an Aupburg lnterim should write to the lnterim
Director for application forms or use the forms provided by the interim office at their own
school.* These students are welcom to stay on campus but are not required to do so.
Requests for interim housingsfiwld bemadeto fie lnterim Office.
*There is an application processing fee of $10.
ku burg Policy
H"
Aug ufg College adml4 studehts of any race, golor, rtatlonal and ethnk origln ro all the
rl$hts, btiufI<&.s, figrams, and acthltlesgeneraI y accorded or made available to studentsat
,the school, It do= trot dlscrimlnq~on the basis of race, col,ar,crded, national and e~hrltc
orlgtn in eq6layrbent flfactiw or adrniitIstqatlon of Its edtFdatfonal>
policies, admission$poIi-dw, icholprshlp and loan programs, and ~thleticand other school-administer& programs.
Need More Help?
Check with:
The lnterim Office (Memorial 230),
The lnterim Secretary, Ruth Maertens at 330-1025, or
The lnterim Director, Dr. Don Gustafson at 330-1192.
.
Courses
Calligraphy
ART 106 - 4001,306 - 4002
Instructor: Philip Thompson
Study of the art and craft of calligraphy. Development of calligraphic skills i n pen and brush
with ink and paint. Three completed design projects in lettering or line are required. For
upper division credit a major project is required.
Distribution: Art-Music
Time: I . . ...... Room: O M 4
Nutrition: You Are What You Eat
BIO 104 - 4003
Instructor: Erwin Mickelberg
Designed to discuss the foods that we eat in a popular fashion. After a review of the human
digestive system, each of the three basic food types will be discussed along with the role of
minerals, vitamins and water.
An attempt will be made to dispel the mysteries and the manufactured information in the
media, to make application to individual concerns, and to address the controversy concerning
food additives.
Distribution: Chemistry-Biology
Time: 11.. ...... Room: S 213
Heredity, Evolution, and Humankind
BIO 110 - 4004
Instructor: Ralph Sulerud
Where did I come from? What am I7 Where am I going? certainly must rank among the more
fundamental quertions which intrigue and torment members of our specips. While at one
l w e i weseek phtlosophlcat and religious answers, h i o l n ~ yIS invokecl at another level. I t l s t h ~
intent of this course to addresrrhesc questions and others through thesrudy of ~ v o t u t l o nand
heredfry {genetlrs). The concept of organic evolution continues to have i t s critics, a matter
which we shall consider. Yet to lhrt va5l majority of hlologists the evolution of life is not only
accep~edbut ir rcaasded as the single most significant confrihurion which biology has made
to human knowledgr. We will study I ~ Pevidence in support of evolution. rht? proposed
mechanisms of ttip ~volutionaryprocess, and, a5 time permits, the course or evolution from
primiltvr! forms to humans. Some principles ol genetics will be studied for the primary
purpose of making 11 possible rn undcrstand evolurionary mechanisms. Ways in which people
e s he discussed.
influence rhrir own evoluiion and that olol her ~ p e r ~ wlll
Classes will consist largely of lectures and discussions. Grading will be based on quizzes and
tests.
Prerequisites: A high school general biology course
Distribution: Chemistry-Biology
Time: I . . ...... Room: S 212
Wetland Ecology
BIO 311 - 4005
Instructor: Roberta Lammers
I n Wetland Ecology we will study the complexity, variety and importance of freshwater
wetlands (i.e. bogs, marshes, fens, swamps, etc.). The physical aspects of these wetlands as
well as the interrelationships of some of their major organisms like sedges, insects, and
sphagnum will be considered. Students will be re uired to pursue4nclependent reading on
wetland organisms of particular Interest to them. T e course work will also include required
reading, discussion and leeura, lab observation d wetland organisms, and local field trips
depending on the weather. We shall examine critically the potential ofMinnesota's wetlands
as an energy source. Grading will be based on one test and the presentation (written or oral)
of the independent reading.
Prerequisites: Biology 111,112
Distribution: Chemistry-Biology
Time: I........ Room: S 213
1
Personal Investment and the Stock Market
-
BUS 257 4006
Instructor: Thomas Morgan
The course i s designed t o familiarize the novice with the basic components of the personal
investment decision.
Course content will include examination and discussion of alternative investment instruments
and the markets in which they are transacted. I n addition to assigned readings, students will
be expected to complete several small projects. Evaluation of course performance will be
based upon successful completion of projects and a final exam. This course is not recommended for upper class business majors.
Time: I........ Room: O M 13
Management Simulation Games
BUS 378 - 4074
Instructor: Amin Kader
In this course the students will be grouped into teams. Each team controls a company which
manufactures and sells a line of multiple products. The company competes against other
companies; each manufactures and sells similar products. Each team attempts to outperform
other teams by selecting what could be perceived by the team as the optimum operating
strategy. This strategy includes setting selling prices, production volumes, marketing expenditures, plant and securities investments, as well as stockholders' dividends. Grading will be
P/N only with evaluation on the basis of the work done and its results.
Prerequisites: BUS 135 and 261, ECO 122 and 123 or permission of instructor
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 11
8/l nterim
Chemistry for Changing Times
C H M 100 - 4009
Instructor: Arlin Gyberg
This is a non-laboratory chemistry course based on the very popular book by John H. Hill of
the same title. It is not a traditional chemistry course and does not assume a science
background. Basic science and math are introduced early and are taught as needed for
understanding the various topics and implications. The course does assume the student is
interested in and concerned about the relationship of chemistry to life and living.
Chemistry has been intimately a part of liberal education for centuries. The early scientists
were considered to be philosophers and their societies were philosophical societies. In
recent decades the human seeking of personal independence has led to chemistry becoming
a part of everyday life to the point of actual dependence on chemistry. We live in a world of
pesticides, fertilizers, plastics, "the pill," food additives and processed foods, vitamin
supplements, the energy crisis, chemical dependency, biocides, pollutants, drugs, searching
for life on other planets, genetic manipulation, and it goes on and on. Emotions and mental
disorders can often be traced to chemical imbalance. The common dragged out, grumpy
feeling after an afternoon nap is a result of a chemical imbalance. The nature of a hangover is
the result of a complex system of altered body chemistry. Even learning appears to be the
result of chemical reaction to form a "memory molecule." Most of the problems we face are
molecular in nature. What then but chemistry can better help us to understand ourselves, our
society, our world, and our universe? Come join us as we take a molecular look at the human
condition. This course will be offered in a lecture/discussion format. Films will supplement
the lecture/discussion periods. Quizzes and tests will be used for evaluation. This course
does not satisfy prerequisites for Chemistry 106,116 or 223.
Distribution: Chemistry-Biology
Time: I . . ...... Room: S 315
Principles of Economics (Micro)
ECO 123 - 4007
Instructor: Satya Gupta
An introduction to microeconomics: the theory of the household, firm, market structures
and income distribution. Application of elementary economic theory to market policy. May
be taken independently of Economics 122 or 120.
Distribution: Economics-Political Science
Time: 11.. ...... Room: L 1
Welfare Economics
ECO 454 - 4008
Instructor: Ed Sabella
Basic concepts and propositions: Pareto optimality, economic efficiency of alternative market
structures, social welfare functions, normative concepts of economic theory. Applications to
various problems and disciplines. Course evaluation will be based on exams (take-home) and
projects.
Prerequisites: ECO 251 or permission of instructor
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 16
Student Teaching
EDS 481 - 4010 EDE 481 - 4014
EDS 482 - 4011 EDE 482 - 4015
EDS 483 - 4012 EDE 483 - 4016
EDS 484 - 4013 EDE 484 - 4017
Instructor: Sheldon Fardig
Observing and directing learning under supervision of college and secondary school
personnel. This is a full day experience in a school.
Prerequisites: Acceptance in Education Program and permission of instructor.
Grading: P/N only
Time: I.. . . . . . . Room: L 4
Emily Dickinson: The Poems and the Person
ENG 140 - 4018, 340 - 4019
Instructor: Ronald Palosaari
Unknown in her lifetime, Emily Dickinson now is regarded as one of America's finest poets.
Her poetry was so unknown that the sister who shared with her the family home did not
know of it until, following Emily's deathbed instructions, she began to burn Emily's papers.
What was spared the fire is now ours to devour.
Emily Dickinson spent most of her life within the family home confining her relationships to a
very few, being regarded as mysterious or eccentric by very many. Some biographers have
suggested she retreated from the world to give herself to poetry since her time and place
made no provision for a female professional poet. Others trace her seclusion to various family
relationships or personal problems or frustrated dreams of love. Whatever the cause, out of
the mystery of her life comes the glory of her poetry.
During the interim we will study both her poetry and some of the major studies of her life.
Each student will read one of her biographies as well as her poetry. Students who desire may
pursue independent research in her biography or her poetry or in general historical topics
that mav illumine either the Doems or the Derson.
Studenk opting for upper d i i s i o n credit will be graded on a more rigorous level than those
opting for lower division credit.
Prerequisites: A course in literature or permission of instructor
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication & Theater Arts
Time: I..
Room: O M 16
. . . . ..
10/l nterim
People Under Pressure
ENG 211 - 4020
Instructor: Barbara Andersen
The child, the youth, the middle-aged, the old, all live under pressure-political, social,
religious and personal. What these pressures are and how people cope with them provide the
focus for the course. This i s not, however, a course in depression, for pressure and stress
often have positive results. And many people respond to pressure with courage, grace and
even wit.
We will read several genres, mostly of the 20th century, and works that are not usually
covered in literature courses. Among the works being considered are Waters, The Man Who
Killed the Deer; Potok, M y Name is Asher Lev; Brautigan, Trout Fishing i n America; Wright,
Native Son; Pym, Excellent Women; Hassler, Simon's Night; Lindbergh, Gift from the Sea;
Turgenev, Fathers and Sons; Albee, The American Dream and The Zoo Story; Anderson, I
Never Sang for M y Father; Gordon, Final Payments. Students will have some choice of works
to read.
Evaluation will be based on discussions, some in-class writing, reading quizzes, oral reports
(optional) and two examinations.
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication & Theater Arts
Time: I.. . . . . . Room: O M 10
.
Six Guns and Samurai Swords: A Comparative Studyof American Western and Japanesesamurai Films
ENG 233 - 4021
SOC 233 - 4058
Instructors: Jerry Gerasimo and John Mitchell
The purpose of the course is to clarify the thematic form of the Western and the Samurai film
by comparing their respective myths, their social premises, and their conventions: for
example, the ritualized duel and the use of proxemic patterns (treatments of space) i n ways
that are implicitly cultural. Although both genres are highly popular, they are vividly useful
for esthetic, cultural, and anthropological comparison. Students will be required to attend all
film presentations (approximately 10 feature films), to read selected texts, and to make a final
written report.
Laboratory Fee: $35
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication & Theater Arts
Time: 1 1 . . . . . . . . Room: M 24
French Civilization Today
FRE 332 - 4022
Instructor: Ruth Aaskov
The study of 20th Century French civilization will extend and deepen our understanding of
the French and the role of their country in the world today. We will investigate the concerns
and the situation of the people vis-a-vis their family, friends, institutions, economy,
government. The study of "documents authentiques" as well as articles, essays, Guide France,
slides, music, art, and technology will help ascertain the major French contributions to our
civilization since 1900.
We will participate i n a variety of group and individualized activities: common readings with
discussion, illustrated presentations, projects and reports, field trips and media experiences
- all in order to broaden and deepen our French experience.
Evaluation will include the completion of assigned tasks and reports, participation and
contribution to the group, several brief quizzes, and individual progress in the ability to
initiate, develop, and present a topic or study within the course.
Materials will be largely i n French to assure an authentic French experience.
Prerequisites: FRE 311 or consent of instructor
Time: I........ Room: O M 25
German Civilization and Culture I1
CER 332 - 4024
Instructor: Don Steinmetz
Survey of significant currents of development which have shaped present-day Germany,
Austria and Switzerland since the Age of Enlightenment. The contemporary scene is
considered in view of its roots in intellectual, geo-political, artistic and scientific history of the
German-speaking peoples. The course will be taught in German.
Prerequisites: GER 311 or permission of instructor
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 27
Beginning Norwegian
NOR 111 - 4025
Instructor: Leif Hansen
The course provides an introductlo,n to the basic skills of 115tening, speaking, reading, and
writing. The first class sessions are conducted without the use of a printed texf. Later class
sessions provide a thorough lntroducrion to the structures of contemporary Norwegian, but
oral expression is emphasized throughout the course. Oral and written tests. Laboratory work
expected.
Distribution: Foreign Language
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 29
Norwegian Conversation and Composition
NOR 311 - 4026
Instructor: Leif Hansen
Intensive practice in spoken Norwegian with emphasis on pronunciation and original
composition. Some attention given to regional variations in spoken Norwegian and to
differences between the two official languages of Norway. Laboratory work and field
experience required.
Prerequisites: NOR 211 or equivalent
Time: To be arranged with instructor.. . . . . . . Room: O M 29
Spanish of the Business and the Professional World
SPA 215 - 4023
Instructor: Cunta Rozentals
Objectives: To give the students the basics needed to cope with professional situations by
preparing them to work with Spanish-speaking clients i n various fields. Content: Introduction to the communication patterns and technical expressions used in health care, education,
welfare, law enforcement and business areas. Layout and style of Spanish business letters.
Evaluation: Tests and performance in simulations of true-to-life situations.
Prerequisites: SPA 212
Time: I.. . . . . . . Room: OM 21
Recreational Rhythms and Activities
HPE232-4027
Instructor: Bethany Shifflett
Theory and practice in teaching and performing American heritage and international folk
dances. Exposure to New Games concepts and activities. The majority of the course grade is
based upon participation in class activities, a teaching assignment, and a written test.
This offering equals only 1/2 course credit.
Time: I - Jan. 3-13.. . . . . . . Room: Melby
Administration and Supervision
of the School Health Program
HPE410-4075
Instructor: Richard Borstad
Historical background, legal bases, school health services, and relationships to community
health program and resources. Methods and materials in health education with laboratory
experience in classroom and community.
Periodic exams covering lecture and textbook assignments; written summaries of professional
journal articles; in-class activities, including a presentation on a teaching method.
Prerequisites: HPE 320
Time: I . . . . . . Room: Melby 13
. .
January 7-26,1984
Sailing in the Virgin Islands
HPE 455 - 4029
Instructor: Joyce Pfaff
Designed for the beginning and intermediate sailor interested in the art and practice of
sailboat cruising. The course will focus on taking the participant to a competent level of
sailboat handling (anchoring, mooring, helming and crewing). The student will live aboard a
42' fixed keel sailboat with six or seven other people and will function as an active crew
member.
Actual on-the-water instruction will be the major part of the course. This will be supplemented by sessions dealing with safety, boat handling, boat systems, provisioning, trip
planning, piloting and navigation. Sailing will include cruises to the various islands and cays in
the British and American Virgin Islands.
Snorkeling and windsurfing will be available on an optional basis.
Evaluation will be based on individual demonstrated competencies in crewing and leadership
in the role of "acting captain." A daily ships log will be kept by all participants and a final
written exam will be given.
Cost: $1995.00
Distribution: Lifetime Sports
Prevention and Care of Athletic Injuries
HPE475-4028
Instructor: Doug Nelson
Emphasis placed on preventing injuries. Treatment of common athletic injuries. Practical
experience in taping and training-room procedures.
Prerequisites: HPE 350 Kinesiology
This course equals only 1/2 course credit.
Time: I - Jan. 16 - 27.. . . . . . . Room: Melby 12
The Japanese-AmericanExperience:
Relocation & Redress
HIS 240 - 4030,340 - 4031
Instructor: Khin Khin Jensen
This course is a study of the Japanese-American experience, primarily in the United States,
but will include mini units of their relocation experience in Canada and some Latin American
countries. Special focus will be given to the forced evacuation of several hundred JapaneseAmericans during World War II, how and why they were uprooted from homes and
businesses at short notice. How did this ethnic group adjust to detention in camps, survive
the trauma of their wartime experience, e.g. psychological impact on young and old? The
redress issue, the report of the recent judicial commission appointed by Congress to
investigate the relocation, will be an important component of the course, e.g. constitutional
issues related to the rights of scores of American citizens. Perspectives of immigrant
restrictions, and the contribution of the Japanese to American economy and society will be
examined.
Japanese-Americans from the Twin Cities, films, slides, recordings and readings will be used
as resources. Ethnic meals. Some evening meetings will replace day sessions.
Grades will be based on discussion, a journal, an exam, and for upper division there will be a
project. Fees - $15.00.
Prerequisites: Lower division none. Upper division - one college history course or consent
of instructor.
Distribution: History-Philosophy
Time: I... . . . . Room: L 1
.
Paris in the Nineteenth Century
-
HIS 114 4032
Instructor: Orloue Gisselquist
The French are sometimes accused of thinking of Paris as the "navel of the universe." There's
a bit of "sour grapes" caricature i n that clever statement. For if one could pick out a city
which i n the last thousand years has been more important to Western Civilization than any
other, one could make a good case for Paris. I n this course we will study the history of that
city in one period of its greatness, the nineteenth century. We will use some readings about
France, Paris, and Modern urbanism, but the main emphasis in our reading and approach to
the subject will be the use of some nineteenth century French novels as historical sources
for the study of Paris. We will thus have the opportunity to study the city of Paris in this
century in some fullness, read some great literature, and develop our talents i n the use of
historical material. As a bonus we will double (maybe quadruple!) our enjoyment of a future
trip to Paris. The course will be conducted i n part as a lecture course and in part as a seminar
(discussion of readings, short papers, and shared reports-all part of the evaluation). There
will be a final exam.
Distribution: History-Philosophy; Urban Concerns
Time: 11.. . . . . . Room: O M 23
.
The Minnesota Political Tradition
HIS 356 - 4033
Instructor: Carl Chrislock
An interpretive survey of Minnesota political history from territorial days to the present.
Attention will focus not only on narrative political history, but also on the underlying forceseconomic, ethnic, religious and cultural-that have helped shape the state's political culture.
Procedures wttl be essentially traditional: lecture-discussion, assjgned and optional readings,
a term paper or hook reviews, and a final examination (basically essay). Some audio-visual
aids (transparencies of polirical cartoons, video cassettes of Arthur Naftalin's conversations
with Mtnnesolta gouernors,slides~will bc used; and an effort to recruit oursidespeakers with
political experience will be made.
Prerequisites: One course in U.S. history, or consent of instructor.
Time: 11..
Room: M 23
......
Classics of Western Thought
H U M 275 - 4034
Instructors: Richard Nelson, Bruce Reichenbach
The period between the exhaustion of ancient civilization and the emergence of early
modern Europe (ca. 500-1700) was an age of discovery and creativity in Western culture. The
BBC series Civilization will provide the visual center from which we will develop the various
perspectives on literature, philosophy, religion, politics, art and science which can be found
during this period. The course will emphasize the mutual impact of ideas and events.
Presentations by guest speakers and readings from major works representing different
disciplines will supplement the film series.
There will be a mid-term, a final exam and a short paper required of all registrants.
Time: I..
Room: S 112
......
An Exposure of Chaos in Modern Cosmic Models
MAT 136 - 4035,136 - 4036
Instructor: Henry Follingstad
An exploratlon of math-related Ideas and Space-Age research which critically re-evaluates
present "scientific dogmas" on the universe and the smaller cosmic models of earth, life, and
mankind. New Space-Age data, much of it ignored or misinterpreted, is uncovered to show
inadequacies and contradictions in cosmology, relativity, macroevolution, and their links to
geology, biology, and the humanities. Space age alternatives are also presented to integrate
the flood of new data with past knowledge.
Class instruction and individual research will include study of the historical and modern
impact of math-related cosmic models, and will note some misuses of mathematics which
have transformed scientific speculation into "scientific fact." A written research paper is
required i n one of six major areas discussed.
Upper division students will show broader research scope and writing ability and will present
extensive oral summaries of their papers.
Distribution: Mathematics-Physics
Room: O M 23
Time: I..
......
Numerical Pattern Processing Through Programming
-
MAT 144 4037,211 - 4038
Instructor: Larry Copes
I n this course students will learn to write elementary computer programs in the Pascal
language. The programs will generate numerical and other mathematical data to be
examined for patterns. With the help of the instructor and each other, students will test
conjectures through data analysis and further programs. Work will be in individual, small
group, and classroom settings. Evaluation will be through individual programs and written
reports.
For students registering for MAT 211, the patterns and reports will require the mathematical
maturity of one who has completed a semester of college mathematics at the calculus level.
All students should expect to spend four to five hours per day in the computer room.
Prerequisites: for 144 - Croup I l l score on Augsburg Mathematics Placement Examination
for 211 - MAT 124 or 174
Distribution: Mathematics-Physics
Room: S 205
Time: I..
......
The Electronics of Music
MUS 210 - 4041,410 - 4042
Instructor: Robert Karlkn
An opportunity for students to explore, experience, and create some sounds of 20th Century
music. Through a "hands-on" approach, participants will be involved in:
1. making multi-track recordings on half-track, quarter-track, and cassette decks through an
eight-track mixer.
2. individually creating and mixing sounds of traditional sound sources as well as analog and
computer-controlled synthesizers.
The study and application of practical electronic technology used in music will be combined
with aesthetic considerations in the creative aspects of the art.
Though no prerequisites are necessary for participation i n the class, i t is expected that
students will bring to it an interest in, and curiosity about, the many ways in which electronics
technology is involved i n the field of music today. Music majors and students registering for
upper division credit will be assigned special projects.
Students will be able to concentrate on aspects of recording, creative electronic music, or a
combination of the above.
Distribution: Art-Music
Time: 11..
Room: M 25
......
Broadway Musical
MUS 285 - 4043
Instructors: JamesJohnson and Steve Cabrielsen
The preparation and performance of a Broadway musical including singing, acting, set design
and building, choreography, dancing. A variety of talents and interests are used. Li'l Abner is
the present musical under consideration.
Costumes will be made by members i n the class. Fees for material will be paid by members
wearing those costumes.
Room: M Sateren
Time: I..
......
Trends and Issues in Nursing
NUR 330 - 4044
Instructor: Pam Farnan
This course is intended to give students a broad perspective by introducing current trends
and issues in health care and the profession of nursing. Many of the issues are controversial,
are relevant to current practice and have potential for far-reaching effects in health care.
Students will be graded on group presentations and written examinations.
Prerequisites: Registered Nurse
Time: I........ Room: O M 12
Introductory Meteorology: Weather and Climate
PHY 106 - 4045
Instructor: Ken Erickson
A study sf Ihe science and wonders of he atmosphere, The course Is deslgned t o provide a
working knowledge of the basic science principles required for understand in^ weather and
climate. Attenlion will he given to the overall weather pattprns of the earth and to thc many
varied aspects af weather, some of which Include: the relationship of sun, earth and
atmosph~re, clouds and precipltatinn, thunderstorms, tornadoes and hurricanes, weather
monitoring and lorecasting, rhe influence a l wealher on pollution, fronts and cyclones, and
o i the sky. The course i s designed to he an elective or to satisfy the
o p ~ i c a phenomena
l
distribution requirement for the liberal arts student. Grading will he basetl on exams,
laboratory exercises and a paper.
Prerequisites: Elementary Algebra (high school)
Distribution: Mathematics-Physics
Time: I.. ...... Room: S 108
Politics and Policy Making in Public Education
POL136-4046,336- 4047
Instructor: Jo Fraatz
This course examines politics and policies in American public schools, and provides
opportunities for students to analyze policy problems and propose their own solutions. Most
of the allotted class time will be used for a combination of lectures and discussion; time
outside of class will be spent reading, thinking, and writing. The objectives of the course
include:
1. To learn something about the difficulties of working in public schools;
2. To learn something about the prospects for changing public schools;
3. To learn how to analyze policy problems and policy solutions;
4. To develop and improve writing skills.
Written assignments will take the form of policy memos to which students will be asked to
respond. Evaluations will be made on the following basis: 1 & 2 - 10 points each; 3 & 4 - 15
points each; 5 & 6 - 20 points each; Class participation - 10 points.
Grades will be determined after all points earned on these requirements are added up at the
end of the course. Students wishing credit for an upper division course must be at least
sophomores and will be required to do a 10-page book critique in addition to meeting the
above requirements.
Distribution: Economics-Political Science
Time: 1 1 . . ...... Room: M 22
Mass Media and Politics in Britain,
France, Germany and Austria
POL 344 - 4048
SPC 344 4064
Instructor: Milda Hedblom
-
This course provides a close-up study of four European mass media systems and the relations
of those systems with political rulers and the broader public. Through seminar discussion, site
visits, media observation, and briefings with public officials and media professionals and
scholars, students learn about major issues in each country. We begin in London, after a week
move to Paris - remaining for several days to compare British and French media and politics.
Departing Paris by overnight train, we stop two days in Salzburg before proceeding to
Vienna, the site of Austrian national media and the Parliament. From Vienna we continue to
Prague for the weekend, then conclude the program in Berlin with briefings on German
media and U.S. international radio operations.
Distribution: Economics-Political Science
Grading: P/N only
Theologies of Politics
POL 386 - 4049
Instructor: Myles Stenshoel
An inquiry into political perceptions, attitudes and preferences associated with various
theological premises from early Christian times to the present. Students will encounter views
of Paul, Augustine and Aquinas; a comparative approach to Reformation theology in the
political expressions of Luther and Calvin; and, in a 20th century sampling, perspectives of
Reinhold Niebuhr, the Moral Majority and Liberation theology.
Goal: An enhanced understanding of ways in which theological and political thought are
mutually dependent and of the political expression of particular theological values and
assumptions.
Methods: Lecture, reading, thinking, discussing and writing -a paper on a relevant subject
chosen by the student:
Evaluation: Quizzes, paper, participation.
Prerequisites: REL 111 and a political science course or permission of instructor.
Time: I.. . . . . . Room: O M 11
.
The Male Jail
PSY 286 - 4077,386 - 4078
Instructor: Lyla Anderegg
A prisoner of his sex, his gender, his society, he devotes his existence to the development of
serious disease and a death occurring a decade earlier than the female. His obituary: "He was
a real man."
A review of the psychological, physical and legal data bearing upon the status of the
American Male, circa 1982.
Additional assignments will be given to upperclass students requiring research, integration of
materials, added involvement in the community.
Evaluation by quality of oral presentation, kind and level of first-person information
gathering and written test.
Prerequisites: General Psychology for upper division status.
Distribution: Psychology-Sociology
Time: 11.. ...... Room: P 2
Nature and Uses of Consciousness
PSY 335 - 4050
Instructor: Richard Marken
Consciousness was what psychology was about until Watson discovered behavior. This course
will investigate various approaches to understanding consciousness (and, of course, the
unconscious). The goal is to become conscious of the functional significance of consciousness
and related phenomena (volition, awareness). Evaluation will be based on class participation
and a final paper.
Prerequisites: General Psychology
Time: I........ Room: P 2
Issues in Science and Religion
REL 374 - 4051
Instructors: John Benson and Mark Engebretson
For some in our society science is the driving engine of a better, more secure life. For others,
including some Christians, science and its associated technologies constitute a grave threat.
This course will begin with a historical overview of the relations between science and the
Christian faith, emphasizing three periods: the origins of the Christian faith, the development
of "modern" science and mechanistic philosophy; and the reevaluation of science and
nature in the 20th century.
The following are some of the questions to be dealt with: Has science made the Bible
obsolete?Are scientists really that smart? Has modern physics made it easier to be a Christian?
Can computers save us?Why do science and religion always seem to be fighting one another?
Grades will be based on class discussion of assigned readings, two short tests and a written
project.
Prerequisites: Religion (Only one interim course may be used toward graduation religion
requirements)
Distribution: Religious studies
Time: 1 1 . . ...... Room: O M 18
The Lutheran Heritage
REL 345 - 4052
Instructor: Eugene Skibbe
The Lutheran Church i s the largest Protestant church in the world. We will examine the
Lutheran Church as it is today, its origins in the 16th century, and its development and
cultural influence during 450 years of history. The text by Bergendoff will provide an
overview. Lecture and class discussion will deal with examples of Lutheran witness to the
Gospel i n art, music, missions, philosophy, sociology and theology. Requirements will
include two exams and one short paper.
Prerequisites: One course in religion
Distribution: Religious studies (Only one interim course may be used toward graduation
religion requirements)
Time: I . . . . . . Room: M 22
..
Israel and Egypt: Archaeology
and Religion
REL 375 - 4053
Instructor: Philip Quanbeck
1-
'
Israel is a<mall country - a young country, but a focal point for international politics and the
study of world religions. Egypt, larger and older, boasts a 5,000-year-old civilization as well as
contemporary importance in the Arab world. I n this interim we visit archaeological and
religious sites i n both nations. During our week i n Jerusalem, the ancient story comes alive as
we live in the O l d City, visit the Church of the Holy Sepulchre, the Dome of the Rock, and the
Aska Mosque, and see the Western Wall - a place of special religious importance to the
Jews. O n bus tours out of Jerusalem we visit Bethlehem, Nazareth, Hebron, Caesarea,
Qumran, Masada, Beer-sheba, and the Sea of Galilee. During four days in Egypt we tour
Cairo, Memphis, Sakkara, and the Giza Pyramids.
Distribution: Religious studies (Only one interim course may be used toward graduation
religion requirements)
Grading: P/N only
Practicum in Human Services
-
SWK 257 4054
Instructor: Rosalie Clark
Thirty hours per week of volunteer work i n a human service agency is combined with
readings and weekly seminars. An opportunity to discover whether a career in human
services is for you. Evaluation will be based on submission of journals, summary of experience
and a final examination. Students will be asked t o meet with instructor before the end of Fall
semester to discuss selection of agency and structure of the course.
Objectives:
1. To develop special awareness of the kinds of problems for which people seek help.
2. To increase knowledge of the services given by the agency in which student is serving.
3. To gain knowledge of the professionals i n the organization, including their skills,
competencies, education, and training.
4. To gain beginning knowledge about the diversity of human services agencies.
5. To increase understanding of self in relation to the human service field.
Time: I.. . . . . . Room: M 22
.
Field Work Ill
SWK 466 - 4055, (1 course), 466 - 4076 (M course)
Instructor: Maria Brown
The objectives of the class are to use supervisory relationship to increase interpretive as well
as social work performance competence; to promote gradual entry into direct social work
practice; to increase competence in the client contact phase of the problem solving process;
to increase student self-awareness in regard to professional practice interests, areas of
strength, and areas for personal/professionaI development; to promote competence i n the
full process of problem solving, with special emphasis on analysis and resolution stages.
Course content will be continuation of Field Work Il-educationally focused field placement
i n a social service agency.
Students will spend 15 (or 30) hours per week in field placement, plus one hour per week in
faculty facilitated supportive seminar held on campus.
Evaluations will be made i n writing by Field Instructor using previously developed contract
and social work evaluation form.
Note: Course is offered for 1/2 (15 hours per week) or full (30 hours per week) credit. If for
full credit, 1/2 credit will be based on non-client contact tasks.
Prerequisites: Minimum of 2.0 in Field Work I and in Field Work II; candidacy status
Time: Arrange with instructor
The Housing Pyramid Came:
Public Policy and Your Future
SOC 143 - 4056,343 - 4057
Instructor: Carry Hesser
Course objectives include 1) To introduce students to the study of public policy and how it
impacts their lives and futures; 2) Through reading, discussion and simulations the students
will learn the critical issues that are operative in the processes and decision-making that goes
into the choices and execution of public policy; 3) Using housing and neighborhoods as the
focus of attention, students will work in groups to research and understand viable public
policies currently in place to meet housing and neighborhood needs, as well as alternatives to
the present policies; and 4) Experience policy-making and project planning through
simulation and contact with practicing policy makers and planners.
Requirements: Active participation in simulations; reflection and analysis of simulations in
journals; group/individual research project with class report (students desiring upper
division credit will do a more extensive analysis, with greater quantity and quality) and a final
exam. Each requirement is worth 25% of the final grade.
Prerequisites: One introductory social science course or permission of instructor
Distribution: Urban Concerns
Time: I . . . . . . . . Room: M 25
Six Guns and Samurai Swords: A Comparative Study
of American Western and Japanese Samurai Films
SOC 233 - 4058
ENC 233 - 4021
Instructors: Jerry Cerasimo and John Mitchell
(See description on p. 10)
22/l nterjm
Sociology of Law
SOC 220 - 4059
Instructor: Diane Pike
This course examines the nature of law, its effect on society, and the effect of society on it.
From a sociological perspective, we will explore cross-cultural notions of law, deterrence, the
criminal j u s t i ~ esystem, the legal profession, and corporate crime. The basic course format
will be lecture and discussion, much of the latter based on the reading assignments.
Evaluation i s based on participation and two examinations. Students desiring upper division
credit will be asked to write a short paper on an assigned question in addition to the exams.
Prerequisites: Principles of Sociology or introductory Political Science course or permission
of instructor
Distribution: Psychology-Sociology
Time: 1 1 . . ...... Room: O M 10
The Sociology of Gambling
SOC 313 - 4060
Instructor: Gordon Nelson
Recent research has examlned the phenomenon of gambling from a saclological perspective.
What rypeof person i s llkely to gamble? What Is the nature of the wmk-force i n the gambling
industry?Is gambling a social problem or a social beneflh These are some of the questions
raised in published sociological studies. The'course will focus o n these studla. Students will
be expected to read and discuss this materlal and t o pass a final examination. I n addition, i n
order to oixerve n gambling society within a legalized setting, the course will Include a field
trip to Las Vegas. Cost of the field trip {travel and lodging) wlll be approximately $300.
Prerequisites: Consent of instructor
Time: I........ Room: O M 22
Imagination and Humor in Communication
-
SPC 165 4061,365 - 4062
Instructor: Ray Anderson
Imagination, creative rhinking, and humor are important dimensions of communication
competence. The major purposes of this course are 10 better understand the functions of
imagination, the creative process, and the nature of humor; to improve creative thinking;
and to increase the ability to protluce effective humor.
There will be lectures and readings on these topics, a study of models, and a variety of
assignments, i n writing and speaking. There will be a number of experimental projects
involving humor; the amount of attention given to this topic will depend in part upon the
interests of the class.
Evaluation will be based on essay examinations and on the creative projects. For upper
division students, one or more additional papers will be required.
Prerequisites: Beginning Speech, Freshman English
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication & Theater Arts
Time: 11.. ...... Room: S 112
Story Theater (Children's Theater)
-
SPC 285 4063
Instructor: Ailene Cole
This class will improvise, produce, and perform a children's play. Whatever is needed-script,
costumes, props, lights, scenery, music, dance-will be created and executed by the class.
Performances are scheduled for the final week.
Time: 9:30-12:OO and 1:OO-3:00 p.m.. . . . . . Stage 2
..
Mass Media and Politics in Britain,
France, Germany and Austria
SPC 344 - 4064
POL344-4048
Instructor: Milda Hedblom
(See description on p. 18)
Other Courses
These courses are offered by institutions or groups not connected with Augsburg College but
have been approved for credit by the College. Most carry a tuition cost plus other expenses
which are the responsibility of the student. They are offered only on a P/N basis. Fuller
descriptions and details for registering are available in the lnterim Office.
ART 163 - 4065 Basic Spinning, Weaving and Dyeing
Offered by the Weavers Guild of Minnesota. Tuition and materials cost $174.
GST 120 - 4071 Wilderness (branch of Plymouth Christian Youth Center)
A splendid course at the PCYC base on the edge of the Boundary Waters
Canoe Area in northern Minnesota near Grand Marais. Approximate cost:
$400.
HPE 106 - 4066 Ski Interim (Park City, Utah)
Comprehensive program with lessons and seminars by professional ski
instructors. Open to all from novice to expert. Special courses for those
interested in and qualified for ski patrol and ski instructor. Package fee of
approximately $995 includes lodging, lift tickets, lessons, lectures, seminars
and cross country ski outing. Does not include transportation or food
(condos have cooking facilities). Dates are Jan. 7 - 28. Contact Joyce Pfaff
(Melby Hall basement or at 330-1248) for further information and registration
materials.
HPE 484 - 4069 Teaching Tennis the Professional Way
A course for students who want to learn how to teach tennis - taught by
professionals. Cost: $175. Time 9:00 - 12:OO M, T, Th at the Minneapolis
Tennis Center
POL 398 - 4067 Washington Interim: The Making of a President
POL 398 - 4068 Washington Interim: The Legal System and Legal Careers
Washington lnterim provides a combined program of lectures, site visits, and
seminar situations focusing on a particular area or topic in Washington, D.C.
Information on either of the above programs, housing and financial assistance is available from Jo Fraatz in Memorial 113.
24/l nterim
Augsburg Lifetime Sports
The following activities are available to students during interim. They do not carry official
credit, but they do meet the lifetime sports requirement for graduation. Students may
participate i n any one of these without registering for the course, but will be expected to pa
any fees whether or not the student registers for the course.
Racquetball
HPE 002 - 4071
Instructor: Dave Boots
Learn rules and skills necessary to enjoy racquetball.
Distribution: Lifetime Sports.
Time: 9:20.. ...... Melby
Badminton
HPE 002 - 4072
Instructor: Dave Boots
Basic techniques and theory of beginning badminton - much of the class time will be spent in
singles and doubles games and tournaments. There will be no written tests or outsid
assignments. Grading is P/N and is based on attendance and participation.
Distribution: Lifetime Sports.
Time: 12:OO Noon.. ...... Melby
American Karate
HPE002-4073
Instructor: Mike Teitelbaum
The form, basic techniques and practical usage of American Karate, taught by a certified
Second Degree MKA Black Belt instructor. Fee of approximately $20.00.
Distribution: Lifetime Sports.
Time: 12:OO - 1:00 M, W, F . . ...... Melby
Weightlifting
HPE 002-4079
Instructor: Paul Grauer
Distribution: Lifetime Sports
Time: 9:20.. ...... Melby
Running
HPE 002 - 4080
Instructor: Paul Grauer
Distribution: Lifetime Sports
Time: 12:OO noon.. ...... Melby
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Summer Catalog, 1984
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUGSBURG COLLEGE (USPS #490-310)
An Official Publication of
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
PA1D
Second Class
Postage
Minneapolis
MN
Augsburg College i s a four-year, fully accredited liberal arts
college affiliated with The American Lutheran Church. Located...
Show more
AUGSBURG COLLEGE (USPS #490-310)
An Official Publication of
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
PA1D
Second Class
Postage
Minneapolis
MN
Augsburg College i s a four-year, fully accredited liberal arts
college affiliated with The American Lutheran Church. Located
in the heart of the Twin Cities, the small college environment,
about 1500 students during the academic year, is enriched by the
many cultural, sporting and recreational activities found in this
vibrant metropolitan area. An active summer combining classes
and participation in metropolitan events is a delightful and
broadening experience.
I
Additional information and registration forms may be obtained
from the Summer School Officc:. Write or call:
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
SUMMER SCHOOL OFFICE
Memorial Hall -230
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, M N 55454
(612) 330-1025
Pat Parker, Director
Ruth Maertens, Secretary
Postmaster
Volume 115, Number 1
Summer, 1984
6121330-1025
AUCSBURC COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) is published four times
a year in Spring, Summer, Fall, and Winter by Augsburg College,
731 21st Avenue South, Minneapolis, M N 55454. Second-class
postage paid at Minneapolis, Minnesota.
Augsburg College provides a diverse summer curriculum
including regular courses, internships, independent studies and
student teaching over two terms. Term I runs from May 29-)une
22, Term II runs from June25-August 3. This bmchum presents
the Summer School Pmgmn and was correct at the time of
publication.
Term I
Term I I
Preregistration with Tuition Discount
April 18
April 18
Confirmation of Registration
Classes Begin
Balance of Tuition Due
May 29
June 25
Last Day to:
Change Grading Option
Drop Class Without Notation
Register with a Late Fee of $10.00
(No registrations will be accepted
after this date)
May 31
June 27
Holiday
None
Last Day to Withdraw From Class (W)
June 18
July 13
Classes End
June 22
August 3
Grades Due in Registrafs Office
June 27
Summer Students may take one course during Term I and two
courses during Term II. Unless otherwise indicated, all courses
carry a value of one course credit, the equivalent of four semester
credits or six quarter credits. Courses fulfilling Augsburg distribution requirements are so noted in the course descriptions.
Persons in Good Standing at regionally accredited colleges and
universities, graduates of such institutions, and students admitted
forthe next Fall Term are eligible to attend Augsburg Summer
School. Good standing implies that the student has been
admitted and not subsequently dropped by that institution.
Course Levels are indicated by the first digit of the three digit
course number: 1 or 2, lower division, primarily for freshmen and
sophomores, 3 or 4, upper division, primarily for juniors and
seniors, and 5, graduate level.
Other Persons wishing to take summer school work should contact the Director of Summer School to ascertain eligibility under
special circumstances.
Courses ~egularlyTaught during the academic year are more
fully described in the October AUGSBURG COLLEGE CATALOG.
If you need more information about a special summer offering,
please contact the Summer School Office.
Independent Study and Internships in addition to those listed
may be pursued during the summer in a number of departments.
lnternships involve work experience related to the academic
program in an agency, government, or industry. Consult the
Summer School Office for information.
Students Needing Housing may obtain information from the
Director of Housing.
Acceptance as a summer student does not imply admission as a
regular student of Augsburg College. Those wishing to begin a
degree program at the college should apply for admission
through the Office of Admission.
Financial Aid is limited to the Guaranteed Student Loan. Any
student taking 1 course is regarded as a half-time student for the
summer and is eligible for a Guaranteed Student Loan. Contact
the Financial Aid Office to make loan arrangements (330-1046).
Persons Planning to Attend Summer School are advised to
preregister as soon as possible, since courses without substantial
demand may be dropped.
The College Reserves the Right to Cancel Listed Courses.
Augsburg College admits students of any race, color, national and
ethnic origin to all rights, privileges, programs, and activities
generally accorded or made available to students at the school. It
does not discriminate on the basis of race, color, creed, national
and ethnic origin in employment practices or administration of its
educational policies, admissions policies, scholarship and loan
programs and athletic and other school-administered programs.
Term I Summer School students are required to confirm their
registrations on May 29; Term II registrations must be confirmed
on June 25. This procedure includes confirmation of all preregistered courses and applies to internships and independent
studies as well as to regularly scheduled courses.
Confirmation of registration will take place at the Registrar's
Office, 114 Science Hall, between the hours of 8:30 a.m. and 6:30
p.m. on May 29 and June 25.
The balance owing for tuition must be paid before registration
is confirmed. Augsburg Students please note: Balance due on
Augsburg account from previous termls must be paid in full
before confirmation of registration.
A late fee of $10.00 will be assessed for Term I registrations
completed on May 30 and May 31. A late fee of $10.00 will be
assessed for Term II registrations completed on June 26 and June
27. Registrations will not be accepted after these dates.
To c a n r d your regictl-~tiun,
arld a course, o r d r t ~ pa <:oirrscl and
enroll ir) another cotr~,sc,fill OUI i l Cancc.l/Add form a1 11>(* Registrar's
Clfficc There i s a charge of $5.00 for changing a registration
after the first day oC each term. This must br! done by 3340 pm.
on May 31 (or Term I courses and hy 3:30 p.m. nn June27 for
Term II courses. This procedure applies to internships and
independent studies as well as scheduled courses. Any refund
or adjustment of fees is determined according to the "Tuition
Refund Policy".
The tuition charge for Summer School is $325.00 for each course
taken for credit, unless otherwise indicated. The audit charge
(non-credit) i s $163.00 for each course. Laboratorylspecial fees
are noted with course descriptions.
Preregistration on April 18 will result in a s,ivings ot $25.00 for
e,~chcourse taken. This redtrceti ti~itivnof $.$00.00per coirrse
cipplies only to hose courses for which the sttldent prert!gisters
on April '18. A nonrefundable d ~ o o s iof
l $50.00 pel. kt>ul.scis
rc?rli~ired
at his tirne anci i s applietl lo desigri~tedrour-setuition.
If a course is carirelled dur to low enrollment, a sul)stitution r ~ y
he rriadc w i t h n ~loss
~ t of disc:ount. Stutl~nts[nay prr!rclgister Cur
1~0thTer*rnI anri Tcarrn It courses on April 18; tuition rlisr:ouri~
i
dl)plicb>t c I~ ~ o l ltcrms.
After April 18, students may preregister at the Registrar's Office on
an ongoing basis during regular office hours. The required $50.00
per course nonrefundable deposit is applied to designated course
tuition. Substitutions allowed if course is cancelled.
The $50.00 deposit is not refundable. Refund of all or part of the
remaining fee is calculated from the first day of the term to the date
of the student's official course cancellation at the Registrar's Office.
Schedule of Refunds
(No refund after the dates listed below)
Refund
Term I
Term II
100Ol0
901'0
801'0
701'0
60%
May 29
May 30
May 31
June 1
June4
June 25
June 26
June 27
June 28
June 29
MAY 29-JUNE 22
ART 107-8501
DRAWING
B. Olson
As a way of seeing and a means of personal expression working with a variety of media,
pencil, pen, charcoal, pastel. Dist.: Yes
O M 17
M, T,W,Th
9:00 a.m.-1 2:00 n.
1
B. Olson
ART 118-85021355-8503 PAINTING I& II
Watercolor-Acrylic; translating thevisual world of nature, landscapes, still life, using
design concepts, developing personal expression and exploring variew of techniques.
Weekly critiques. Dist.: Yes.
9:00 a.m.-12:OO n.
M, T,W,Th
OM17
ART 299-85041499-8505 DIRECTEDIINDEPENDENT STUDY
ART HISTORY SURVEY
Swanson
Arr.
BIO 103-8506
HUMAN ANATOMY AND
Mickelberg
PHYSIOLOGY
Professional course in the structure and function of the human body. Dist.: Yes.
lO:30-1:OOp.m.Lect.
M,T,W,Th,F
Psy. Bldg.
1:30-4:30 p.m. Lab.
T, W,Th
FOREIGN LANGUAGES
GER 111-8530
BEGINNING GERMAN I
Steinmetz
Classroom practicespeaking, understanding and reading basic German for students
with no previous background in German. Dist.: Yes.
OM29
M, T,W, Th,F
8:30-10:50 a.m.
Hansen
BEGINNING NORWEGIAN
NOR 111-112
A 3-week total immersion language learning experience for 10-16 highly motivated
students ata lakesite in Northern Minn. Consult Prof. Leif E. Hansen (330-1292, Home
822-8726) for details by April 1. Dist.: Yes. Dates: June 8-30.
HEALTH EDUCATION A N D PHYSICAL E D U C A T I O N
HPE 410-8531
ADMINISTRATION & SUPERVISION
Borstad
OF SCHOOL HEALTH PROGRAM
Historical background, legal bases, school health services, and relationships to community health program and resources. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 320.
M5
5:OO-8:00 p.m.
M, T,W, Th
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
HPE 491-8532
THERAPEUTIC EXERCISE
Utterberg
Study of the treatment of disease and injury. General principlesand administration of
neuro-muscular re-education. Dist : No.
Prerequisites: 350, 351, 354
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
T,Th and Arr.
M22
(1st meeting 5/29, 6:00 p.m.)
BUS 101-8507
HPE 493-8533
PRINCIPLES OF FINANCIAL
Kader
ACCOUNTING
Introduction to business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of accounting,
the accounting cycle and preparation of financial statements. Dist.: No.
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M, T,W,Th,F
51 12
,
ENG 438-8529
SHAKESPEARE
Blackburn
Study of ten or twelve major plays with attention to the development of Shakespeare's
dramatic and poetic art. Dist.: Yes.
OM11
9:30-1 l:50 a.m.
M, T, W, Th,F
BUS 261-8508
FUNDAMENTALS OF FINANCE
Morgan
Theory of acquisition, allocation, and management of funds within the firm; sources
and uses of long and short term funds, cost of capital, capital budgeting, leverage,
dividend policy and related topics. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 101, 102
9:30-1 l:50 a.m.
M, T,W,Th,F
M22
BUS 399-8509
INTERNSHIPS
Kader
Arr.
ORGANIZATION &ADMINISTRATION
Husing
OF CORRECTIVE THERAPY
Administrative guidelines and history of ACTA and North Central Chapter. Construction
of CT treatment clinic; equipment, employment, public relationsand ethics. Dist.: No.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
T,Th and Arr.
M24
(1st meeting 5/29,6:00 p.m.)
HPE 495-85341496-8535 PROFESSIONAL AFFILIATION
497-8536
Hospital affiliation of 444 hours required. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 485,491 and approval of department.
HISTORY
HIS 299-85371499-8538
ECONOMICS
(
ECO 120-8510
Study of economic implicat
independent study only. D i
ECO 122-8511
MlCS OF URBAN ISSUES
Sabella
roblems facing a metro-urban environment. By
Arr.
Saugestad
DIRECTEDIINDEPENDENT STUDY
JAPAN, CHINA AND SOUTHEAST ASIA
(Diverse Topics: See Instructor)
Jensen
INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arr.
Arr.
INTERDISCIPLINARY
INS 399-8539
lntrodt~rl
on ~~:mmmwmnsrnics
m t i ~ ammms'an;tlvs!s,,~mt)ne~a~ry~am
l
t1501
policy, international trade, economic growth. Dist.: Yes.
1 :00-4:00 p.m.
M,T,W,Th
M5
ECO 392-8512
MONEY & BANKING
Gupta
Monetary and bankingsystems, particularly commercial banks, and the Federal Reserve
System. Emphasis on monetary theory and policy. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 122
9:30-1 l:50 a.m.
M, 1,W,Th,F
.,
- -
-
.
PHI 130-8540
INTRODUCTION TO LOCI?
Bailey
Examinationof rules which govern valid argumentsand aid in developing theability
to recognize and construct sound arguments. Dist.: Yes.
g:30-1 l:50 a.m.
M, 1,W, Th,F
M23
~oLITICALSCIENCE
POL 199-85431399-8544 INTERNSHIPS
Fraatz
Arr.
EDUCATION
PSYCHOLOGY
EDE 353-8513
Johnson
DEVELOPMENTAL PSYCHOLOGY:
ADOLESCENT A N D YOUNG ADULT
Emphasis on normal development and behavior. Consideration of data and theory
related to development during the adolescent and adult periods of life. Dist.: No.
Prerequisite: 105
PI
M, 1,W, Th,F
8:30-I O:50 a.m.
YOUNG CHILDREN WITH
R. Anderson
SPECIAL NEEDS
Understanding administrative guidelines and teacher competencies involved in a
mainstreamed prekindergarten or daycare program.
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M, 1,W,Th,F
OM4
(!h course) June 11-22
EDE 375-8514
DISCOVERY I N THE WORLD
Pelton
OF KINDERGARTEN
Kindergarten curriculum, materials, and teaching approaches. Lab. arr.
Prerequisite to student teaching at kindergarten level and to obtaining a license for
teaching at that level. Consent of instructor. Dist.: No.
9:30-1 l:50 a.m.
M, 1,W,Th,F
14
PSY 352-8545
RELIGION
REL 359-8546
BIBLICAL INTERPRETATION
Quanbeck
Survev of the issues and the methods used in the interpretation of the Bible.
~ist.:~es.
8:30-lO:50 a.m.
M, 1,W, Th,F
M24
STUDENT TEACHING
SOCIAL WORK
Student teaching for both elementary and secondary education is offered by the
Department of Education during thegeneral period from the middleofJuneto theend
of July. Theexact dates aredetermined in conjunction with the school system. All of
the courses require acceptance into the Department of Education program. Contact
the Registrah Office for exact dates and course number to be used in registration.
SWK 255-8547
R. Anderson
EDE 481-85151482-8516 STUDENT TEACHING:
483-85 171484-8518 PREKINDERGARTEN
Students required to have 160 child contact hours. Placement arrangement by
instructor. Dist.: No. Additional $35.00 fee.
Prerequisites: Acceptance, Education Department.
Arr.
EDE 481-85191482-8520 STUDENTTEACHING:
483-85211484-8522 ELEMENTARY OR KINDERGARTEN
Observing and directing learninaexoeriences in elementary schools under supervision
fee.
of collegeand public school perso'nnel. Dist.: No. ~ d d i t i o n a$35.00
l
Prerequisites: Acceptance, Education Department.
Arr.
'
EDS 481-85231482-8524 STUDENT TEACHING:
Fardig
483-85251484-8526 SECONDARY
Observing and directing learning experiences on secondary school level under
su~ervisionof colleae and hiah school oersonnel. Dist.: No. Additional $35.00 fee.
ENGLISH
Howerton
ENG 163-85271363-8528 WAR A N D WORDS: LITERATURE
A N D THE VIETNAM WAR
Focus on books written by people coming to terms with the Vietnam experience;
including navels, memoirs, personal narratives, essays, poetry, and journals which have
depicted, recreated, explained, hidden, and exposed the war. Dist.: Yes.
9:30-1 l:50 a.m.
M,T, W,Th,F
M4
GROUP WORK I N A
Perry
, i f - ~ l ~ ~MEDlUM
~ ~ ~ ~ S S
Canoes-an eight day car .&trip in I h r Q u ~ ~ ~ : h P r c nidl~ Park
i n i of Ontario. Gain practice and knowledge ntcvssary to lead wilderness trips effectively. Study the process
of a wilderness qruul) as a social system. Dist.: No.
(See instructor for details)
Addtiondl fee--SWK 499-8548
INDEPENDENT STUDY
Clark
SWK 399-8549
INTERNSHIPS
Clark
Arr.
Arr.
SOClOLOGY
H U M A N COMMUNITY A N D
Nelson
THE MODERN METROPOLIS
The cultural and structural dynamics of the modern world viewed from the perspective
of the metropolitan situation. Dist.: Yes.
OM13
M, 1,W, Th, F
9:30-1 l:50 a.m.
SOC 11 1-8550
Gerasimo
INTRODUCTION TO CULTURAL
ANTHROPOLOGY.
-An examination of the ideas:u!"~>rimitiv~~:l'rivilized:and "progress": a comparison
of alternate realities 4s fuuljd in,diflr.Wnt cultures and varying social contexts.
Dist.: No.
8:30-10:50 a.m.
M,T,W,Th,F
11
SOC 241-8551
?
SOC 19945521399-8553 INTERNSHIPS
.I 'm
SPC 11 1-8554
BEGINNING SPEECH
Basic approach to effective speaking and critical listening. Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:00 p.m.
M, T, W,Th
Hesser
Arr.
Cole
M23
1
PHYSICS
PHY 101-9618
ASTRONOMY
PaulsonlStaff
Study of Solar system, stars, galaxies. Optical instruments explained; use of Winch
reflecting telescope, 8-inch Celestron, 3-inch Questar. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisites: Elementary algebra.
LI
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
T, Th
NE 25-AUGUST 3
POLITICAL SCIENCE
ART 132-9601134
PHOTOGRAPHY
Friederichsen
The camera used as a tool for visual creativity and expression; black and white, color,
and photographic processes. Need access to a 35 mm camera. Dist.: Yes.
Estimated cost of film, etc.: $75.00.
2:30-6:00 p.m.
M, W Section I
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
M,W Section II
POL 299-96201499-9621 DIRECTEDIINDEPENDENT STUDY
AMERICAN GOVERNMENT
Fraatz
Arr.
POL 199-96221399-9623 INTERNSHIPS
Fraatz
Arr.
PSYCHOLOGY
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
BUS 399-9602
INTERNSHIPS
8:30-955 a.m.
M, T, W, Th, F
Kader
Arr.
M5
ECONOMICS
RELIGION
ECO 120-9603
ECONOMICS OF URBAN ISSUES
Sabella
Study of economic implications of problems facing a metreurban environment. By indeArr.
pendent study only. Dist.: Yes.
ECO 123-9604
PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS
Sabella
(MICRO)
Introduction to micrc-economics, the theory of the household, firm, market structures
and incomedistribution. Application of elementary economic theory to market policy.
I.
ECO 353-9605
.
REL 111-9626
INTRODUCTION TO THEOLOGY
Holt
An introduction to theacademicdiscipline of theology and to thedialogue between
the church and the world which concerns Christian doctrine. Dist.: Yes.
8:30-9:55 a.m.
M, T, W, Th, F
M23
L1
REL 341-9627
CHRISTIAN VIEWS O F HEALTH
Holt
A N D HEALING
Exploration of health and healing in Christian teaching and practice, including the role
of scientific technology and prayer and sacraments in healing. Required field trips.
Dist.: Yes.
10:05-11:30a.m.mm
M,T,W,Th,F
M23
.
ELEMENTS OF MATHEMATICAL
ECONOMICS
w
.SOCIAL WORK
SWK 255-9628
FOREIGN LANGUAGE
GER 112-9606
BEGINNING GERMAN II
Classroom practice in speaking understandingand reading basic German. Lab. Dist.: Yes.
Prerequisites: 111 or equivalent.
8:30-9:55 a.m.
M, T, W, Th
OM29
y be earned through the Camp Norway program in Norwav. Chal-
..
GROUP WORK I N A
Perry
SOClOLOCY
SOC 356-9629
Bloom
.
HEALTH E D U C A T I O N A N D PHYSICAL E D U C A T I O N
HPE 485-9607
APPLIED ADAPTED ACTIVITIES
Lieske
Consideration of ambulation, self care, adapted sports and games, and swimming for
the handicapped. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 350, 351, and
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
GROUP RELATIONS
The dimension of racial and minority group relations emphasizing prejudice, racism
and the role of self-understanding. Dist.: No. (PIN Grading only)
M, W
M6:OO-9:30 p.m.
3.3'
SOC 199-96311399-9632 INTERNSHIPS
Hesser
Arc
SPEECH, C O M M U N I C A T I O N , THEATER
THEATER I N THE TWIN CITIES
Cole
Studying, viewing, and critiquing the acting and production of five plays. Dist.: No.
HPE 487-9608
2815 41st Ave. So., Mpls., M N 55406 (Tel.: 721-2565)
HPE 495-96091496-9610 PROFESSIONAL AFFILIATION
497-961 1
Hospital affiliation of 444 hours required. Dist.: No.
Prerequisites: 485,491 and approval of department.
Saugestad
w
.F
Arr.
HIS 233-96121433-9613 WOMEN'S ROLES I N AMERICA
Stadum
Examination of women's roles in the family, the workplace, and in voluntaryorganizations from Colonial America to the 1980's. Includes comparisons based on class, race,
ethnicity and geographic region. Dist.: Yes.
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
T, T h
M23
HIS 369-9614
VIKING DISCOVERY
Nelson
York, England. The Viking expansion and its impact on the British Isles. History comes
alive through extensive archaeological finds, lectures, field trips. July 15-28. Contact
Liv Dahl, Sons of Norway Heritage Programs, for brochure. (612) 827-3611. Dist.: No.
INS 399-9615
INTERNSHIPS
DOWNTOWN
Hesser
Arr.
MATHEMATICS
MAT 114-9616
COLLEGE ALGEBRA A N D
Durkee
TRIGONOMETRY
Fundamental operations, factoring, fractions, functions and graphs, linear equations,
exponentsand radicals, quadraticequations, ratio and variation, progressions, binomial
theorem, logarithmsand trigonometricfunctions. Students who havecompleted 124
may register for credit only with consent of instructor. Dist.: Yes.
T, Th
S112
6:OO-9:30 p.m.
PHILOSOPHY
PHI 120-9617
ETHICS
Fuehrer
This course takes a long, hard look at possible grounds for making moral decisions,
and at the moral judgments about personal and social issues resulting from them..
10:05-1 l:30 a.m.
M, T, W, Th, F
M4
35W from the North-Take Washington Ave. exit and turn left on Washington
(turns right onto Cedar Ave.), turn left at Riverside, right at 21st Ave. S.
.
1-94 East from Minneapolis-Take 25th Ave. exit, turn left at 25th Ave., turn left at
Riverside, turn left at 21st Ave. S.
1-94 West from St. Paul-Take Riverside exit, turn right at Riverside, turn left at 21st
Ave. S.
I 1-
35W from the South-Follow 1-94 St. Paul signs (move right lane after each of two
mergers). Take 25th Ave. exit and turn left on 25th Ave., turn left at Riverside, turn
left at 21st Ave. S.
$
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg Weekend College Catalog, 1983-1984
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
Weekend Il S
College S
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1983-84 Calendar
Introduction to Augsburg Weekend College
Characteristics of the Educational Program
Degrees and Majors
Business Administration
Communication
*Management Information Systems (MIS)
Social Work
Student Support Services
Assessment of Pr...
Show more
Weekend Il S
College S
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1983-84 Calendar
Introduction to Augsburg Weekend College
Characteristics of the Educational Program
Degrees and Majors
Business Administration
Communication
*Management Information Systems (MIS)
Social Work
Student Support Services
Assessment of Previous Learning Program (APL)
Fees and Payment Schedule
Refund Schedule
Financial Aid
Admissions Procedure
About Augsburg College
Campus Map
Campus Location
114qd
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
WEEKEND COLLEGE
2
3
4
5
6
8
10
11
12
13
14
14
15
16
17
18119
inside back cover
WEEKEND COLLEGE OFFICE
For more information write or call:
Augsburg Weekend College Office
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis, MN 55454
I
Postmaster:
I
Volume 114, Number 1
I
AUGSBURG COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) is published four times a
year in Spring, Summer, Fall and Winter by Augsburg College, 731 21st
Avenue South, Minneapolis MN 55454. Second class postage rates
paid at Minneapolis, Minnesota.
Summer 1983
6121330-1782
-
INTRODUCTION TO
AUGSBURG WEEKEND COLLEGE
AUGSBURG WEEKEND COLLEGE
1983-84 CALENDAR
Purpose
FALL TRIMESTER
November 4-6, 18-20
Augsburg Weekend College provides an educational alternative to
adults who desire college experience but who work or have other
commitments during the week. It is a means by which men and women
may earn a baccalaureate degree, gain skills for professional
advancement, prepare for career change, or pursue a personal interest
in one or more areas of the liberal arts.
December 2-4
The Adult as Student
August 27,1983
OrientationIRegistration
September 9-11, 23-25
October 7-9, 21-23
December 9-11
Exams
WINTER TRIMESTER
December 3,1983
OrientationlRegistration
The Augsburg Weekend College program is designed to meet the
needs and preferences of adult learners. The program is based on the
assumption that the men and women who enroll in Weekend College
will be mature, selfdisciplined and well-motivated adult. learners who
seek a balance of classroom experience and individualized study. Each
course is therefore divided into periods of concentrated on-campus
study separated by time for independent study and class preparation.
January 6-8, 20-22
Alternate Weekends
February 3-5, 17-19
To accommodate this format for learning, classes meet on alternate
weekends for three and a half hours on either Friday evening, Saturday
morning, Saturday afternoon, or Sunday afternoon. Each class selected
by the student involves commitment to one of these four class periods.
Weekend College students may take from one to four different courses
by attending class every other weekend.
March 2-4, 16-18, 30-April 1
April 6-8
Exams
Community of Learners
SPRING TRIMESTER
March 31,1984
OrientationlRegistration
April 13-15, 27-29
May 4-6, 18-20
June 1-3, 8-10, 22-24
June 29-July 1
Exams
Essential to the goals of Augsburg Weekend College is participation in a
community of adult learners. Learning can be enhanced when the
student is involved in a stable community that provides opportunity and
encouragement to become involved in interaction both in and out oi the
classroom. This community will be enriched by the presence of both
men and women with a variety of work and life experiences.
To facilitate this kind of community interaction, Augsburg encourages
Weekend College students to make use of college facilities such as the
library and college center, to take the opportunity of having shared
meals and coffee breaks, to participate in optional chapel services and
lunchtime seminars, and to attend other college activities such as music
and dramatic presentations and athletic events.
CHARACTERISTICS
OF THE EDUCATIONAL PROGRAM
DEGREES AND MAJORS
I
1
Educational Mission
For over a century Augsburg College has emphasized intellectual
freedom in the search for knowledge. Our academic program builds on
a liberal arts foundation to help students understand the past, interpret
the present, and plan for the future.
As in the weekday program, Augsburg Weekend College offers
students a unique combination of the liberal arts disciplines and
professional education. Our goals are to help students develop the
intellectual skills and attitudes to be life-long learners, increase their
competence in selected areas of professional work, and accomplish a
higher level of personal growth.
Accreditation and Affiliations
Augsburg College is fully accredited by the North Central Association of
Colleges and Secondary Schools and The National Council for the
Accreditation of Teacher Education (Secondary and Elementary). Our
programs are approved by The American Chemical Society, The
Council on Social Work Education and the National League for Nursing.
We are a member of the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities
(ACTC), Lutheran Education Council in North America, Minnesota
Private College Council, National Association for Music Therapy, Inc.,
and are registered with the Minnesota Higher Education Coordinating
Board (HECB).
I
I
I
~
.
Baccalaureate Degree
The baccalaureate degree program in Augsburg Weekend College is
essentially the same as the weekday program. A total of 35 semester
courses are required to graduate and may be fulfilled through transfer
of previous work, assessment of previous learning experience, or
Weekend College coursework. (Augsburg semester courses are valued
at 4 semester credits and 6 quarter credits.) Included in the 35 total
courses must be an approved major program, eleven upper division
courses, and courses selected from the following liberal arts spectrum
(transfer courses and courses taken in the major may also be counted
for distribution requirements):
Augsburg College prides itself on its highly qualified faculty. Members of
the faculty serve .as academic advisers to students who are in the p r e
major stage of planning as well as to students in declared major fields.
One approved course from each of seven areas:
Art- Music
History- Philosophy
Economics- Political Science
English-Speech, Communication and Theater Arts
Psychology-Sociology
Chemistry- Biology
Mathematics- Physics
Library
Two courses or demonstrated competence in a foreign language
Students and faculty use a carefully selected library of some 138,000
volumes plus audio-visual materials, with access to over 5,000,000
volumes through the Twin Cities private college consortium and Minitex.
Three courses (or one course per year of study) in religious studies
Faculty
I
.
Augsburg Weekend College allows adults to begin a baccalaureate
degree program or to continue their education after beginning at
another time or institution. It also enables adults to add a second major
to an already completed college degree. The following information
outlines what is involved in completing a degree or major in Augsburg
Weekend College.
Internships
Internships on and off campus are an established part of most
academic programs, helping students make career choices and develop
experience in their chosen fields.
One course in the area of urban concerns, women's studies, or minority
studies
Demonstrated proficiency in two lifetime sports
Majors
Augsburg Weekend College students may select from four separate
majors, each with a number of career concentrations. A minor is
available in each of these academic areas.
BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION
This major prepares students in the areas of management, financial
accounting, finance, and marketing. To provide a combination of applied
skills and theoretical background, each of these majors is
interdisciplinary in approach, including an average of nine business
administration courses and six courses from supporting fields such as
economics, computer programming, communications, philosophy, and
mathematics. Majors in Business Administration are candidates for the
Bachelor of Arts degree.
Core Courses
All students who pursue a major in Business Administration will
complete the following core courses:
BUS 101 Principles of Financial Accounting
BUS 102 Principles of Managerial Accounting
BUS 131 Business Law
BUS 261 Fundamentals of Finance
BUS 379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
ECO 122 Principles of Economics (Macro)
ECO 123 Principles of Economics (Micro)
ECO 251 lntermediate Microeconomics
Accounting Major
Students who wish to pursue an accounting major will complete the
following courses in addition to the core:
BUS 262 Intermediate Accounting I
BUS 263 lntermediate Accounting II
BUS 381 Managerial Cost Accounting
BUS 483 Auditing
or 484 Advanced Accounting
ECO 258 lntermediate Macroeconomics
or 391 Public Finance
or 392 Money and Banking
Finance Major
Students will take the following courses in addition to the core:
BljS 262 lntermediate Accounting I
BUS 373 Financial Management: Theory and Cases
BUS 381 Managerial Cost Accounting
or 382 Tax Accounting
BUS 478 lnvestments and Financial Institutions
ECO 258 lntermediate Macroeconomics
or 391 Public Finance
or 392 Money and Banking
Management Major
Students will complete the following courses in addition to the core:
BUS 145 Fundamentals of Management
BUS 250 Data Processing
BUS 340 Personnel Administration
BUS 373 Financial Management: Theory and Cases
or 478 lnvestments and Financial Institutions
ECO 340 Managerial Decision Making
ECO 445 Managerial Economics
Supporting Courses:
PHI 120 Ethics
PSY 371 Psychology of the Individual: Male and Female
PSY 373 Organizational Psychology
SOC 241 lntroduction to Cultural Anthropology
SOC 375 Social Psychology
or 383 Racial and Minority Group Relations
SPC 354 Interpersonal Communications
or 355 Small Group Communications
SPC 113/313 Public Speaking OR
ENG 225, 226, or 227 Advanced Writing
Marketing Major
Students will complete the following courses in addition to the core:
BUS 135 lntroduction to Marketing
BUS 250 Data Processing
BUS 330 Marketing Research and Analysis
BUS 430 Marketing Management
ECO 258 lntermediate Macroeconomics
ECO 445 Managerial Economics
(Continued Next Page)
Communication Electives
Supporting Courses:
PHI 120 Ethics
SPC 351 Argumentation
or 352 Persuasion
SPC 353 Advertising
Business Minor
6 courses, including Business Administration 101, 102 and one of 261,
373, 379, 478; and one of 262, 379, 381 ; and Economics 122 and 123.
Other configurations for the Business Administration minor may be
permitted on consultation with the department chairperson.
COMMUNICATION
Communication is an interdisciplinary major which is broad in scope
and practical in application. The program consists of 15 courses; five in
related supporting fields such as psychology, sociology, speech, and
philosophy. Included is at least one course of internship experience in a
work setting serving the career goals of individual students. Students
may focus their lecture courses toward the development of career skills
in public relations and advertising, human relations, or supervisory
management. Majors in communication are candidates for the Bachelor
of Arts degree.
Required Communications Core
SPC 342 Mass. Communications in Society
SPC 351 Argumentation
or 352 Persuasion
SPC 354 Interpersonal Communication
SPC 399 Internship
ENG 225 Advanced Writing
Required Supporting Courses:
SPC 113 Public Speaking
PHI 130 Logic
PSY 105 General Psychology
SOC 121 Principles of Sociology
or 241 Introduction to Cultural Anthropology
SOC 375 Social Psychology
.
With the help of an academic advisor, the student will select five (5)
elective courses designed to meet additional background and skill
requirements in the career areas of public relations and advertising,
human relations, or supervisory management.
The following are some of the electives recommended in each area:
PUBLIC RELATIONS AND ADVERTISING:
BUS 135 lntroduction to Marketing
BUS 145 Fundamentals of Management
BUS 379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
ENG 226 or 227 Creative Writing or Journalism
PSY 373 Organizational Psychology
SPCl ART 132 Photography
SPCIART 225, 230 Visual Communications I, II
SPC 353 Advertising
SPC 480 Public Relations
HUMAN RELATIONS:
PSY 373 Organizational Psychology
PSY 485 Counseling Psychology
SOC 231 Sociology of the Family
SOC 383 Racial & Minority Group Relations
SPC 329 Intercultural Communication
SPC 353 Small Group Communication
SPC 480 Public Relations
SUPERVISORY MANAGEMENT:
BUS 145 Fundamentals of Management
BUS 250 Data Processing
BUS 340 Personnel Administration
BUS 379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
BUS 440 Operations Management
ECO 340 Managerial Decision-Making
PSY 373 Organizational Psychology
SPC 353 Advertising
SPC 355 Small Group Communication
SPC 480 Public Relations
Communication Minor
Five courses approved by the department.
MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEMS (MIS)
The MIS major prepares students to work in the growing field of
information management. The major combines courses and skills from
both the business and computer science majors to help students learn
about the identification, organization, analysis and processing of
information in a business setting.
MIS Major
MAT
CSC
CSC
CSC
CSC
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
174
240
340
350
352
101
102
145
250
261
375
475
479
ECO 122
ECO 123
Eta 445
ECO 340 ECO 379
Mathematical Algorithms for Computer Science
Elementary Computer Science
Digital Communications and Computer Networks
Data Structures and File Processing
Data Base Management and ~ecision
Principles of Financial Accounting
Principles of Managerial Accounting
Fundamentals of Management
Data Processing
Fundamentals of Finance
lnformation Systems in the Organization
lnformation Systems Analysis and Design
Intermediate Quantitative Methods for Economics and
Business
Principles of Economics-Macro
Principles of Economics-Micro
Managerial Economics m
Managerial Decision Makina
~uanitativeMethods for ~conomicsand Business
MIS Minor
I
1
I
MAT
CSC
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
BUS
ECO
174
240
250
375
475
101
261
123
Mathematical Algorithms for Computer Science
Elementary Computer Science
Data Processing
lnformation Systems in the Organization
Information Systems Analysis and Design
Principles of Financial Accounting
Fundamentals of Finance
Principles of Economics-Micro
SOCIAL WORK
Accredited by the Council on Social Work Education, the Bachelor of
Science in Social Work degree program at Augsburg College is built on
a solid liberal arts foundation, on theory-based training, and on
professionally directed field experiences. As important, social work
education at Augsburg is built on an appreciation for the needs,
concerns, and values of the individuals and groups who constitute
today's multi-cultural society. The Social Work major in Augsburg
Weekend College includes nine courses from the departments of
psychology, biology, and sociology. Concentrations are possible in the
areas of aging, chemical dependency, corrections, social ministries, and
youth work. Field work is an important component of the program.
Social Work Courses
SWK 257 Practicum in Human Services
SWK 361 Systems of Social Welfare
SWK 363 Methods and Skills of Social Work
SWK 364 Field Work l
SWK 461 Advanced Methods and Skills in Social Work
SWK 462 Field Work II
SWK 463 Community Development and Organization
SWK 464 Field Work lV
SWK 465 Social Policy: Analysis and Development
SWK 466 Field Work 111 (1/2 course)
SWK 467 The Social Worker as Professional
Required Supporting Courses:
BIO 101 Human Biology
PSY 105 General Psychology
PSY 351 Developmental Psychology: Child
PSY 352 Developmental Psychology: Adolescent and Adult
SOC 121 Principles of Sociology
SOC 231 Sociology of the Family
SOC 365 Quantitative Analysis and Program Evaluation
SOC 375 Social Psychology
SOC 383 Racial and Minority Group Relations
*Students interested in Social Work should begin their program with the
required supporting courses. The professional sequence will be offered
when a sufficient number of students are ready for that portion of the
program.
(Continued Next Page)
Social Welfare Minor
6 courses including 257 or department approved alternative internship,
361, 463; Psychology 351 or Sociology 375; Sociology 383; and
Political Science 121 or 158 or 325, or Social Work 465.
STUDENT SUPPORT SERVICES
Augsburg Weekend College provides a number of student services to
assist adults in making educational and career plans, accomplishing the
academic tasks of a college education, working on their own personal
development, and participating in activities beyond the classroom.
Some of these services are:
Academic Planning
All Augsburg Weekend College students will have access to expert
academic advising services on an on-going basis to provide for
efficient, effective planning. Students enrolling in Weekend College who
have had college experience will have their previous work evaluated
early in the admissions process.
Career Planning Services
Staff from the Career Planning and Placement Office will assist adults in
assessing their career goals and personal abilities. This service, in
combination with sound academic advising from faculty in a chosen
major field, can result in an appropriate and manageable educational
and career plan for the individual involved.
Academic Skills Center
This center exists to help students enhance their skills in the areas of
writing, reading, math, time management, and study skills. Academic
tutors in specialized course areas are also available through the Center.
CounselinglSupport Groups
Individual and group activities are available to students who wish to
work on a personal growth interest or concern or who simply want to
have the experience of being in a support group of people who share
some similar characteristics and/or interests.
Augsburg College recognizes that learning can and does take place in
many life situations. Some of this learning may be appropriate for credit
recognition within the disciplines that compose the academic programs
of a liberal arts college. The APL program (Assessment of Previous
Learning) at Augsburg provides a means by which a student's previous
learning, other than that which is transferred from another accredited
institution, may be presented for examination for possible credit toward
the completion of a baccalaureate degree.
Not all learning from life experience, however, is appropriate for credit
recognition at a liberal arts college. Such learning must meet two
essential criteria: (1) it is relevant to coursework in a field of study within
the Augsburg liberal arts curriculum and (2) it can be objectively
demonstrated either by comprehensive examination or committee
evaluation.
The APL program at Augsburg provides several means by which
students may have their previous learning assessed for credit
recognition:
CLEP (College Level Examination Program)
Students who achieve acceptable scores in CLEP exams may receive
academic credit in Augsburg College. CLEP exams are available in a
variety of general and specific subject areas. For more information,
contact the Admissions Office (330-1002).
Departmental Assessment
Students who wish to receive credit for a specific academic course and
do not have transcript evidence of completed work may request a
departmental assessment of previous learning. This will most often
include an examination that covers the essential components of the
course involved. For more information, contact the Registrar's
Office (330-1036).
CAP (Credit Assessment Process)
This is a credit assessment alternative in which a faculty committee
completes a credit evaluation of a learning portfolio submitted by the
student. Informational meetings and consultation are provided for
students who wish to prepare a portfolio of previous learning for credit
assessment. Students may apply for CAP after completing at least four
courses of academic work at Augsburg College with a cumulative GPA
of at least 2.5. For more information, contact the Registrar's
Office (330-1036).
FEES AND PAYMENT SCHEDULE
Application Fee
(payable once, non-refundable)
Tuition
(per semester course) *
1
Tuition
(per summer course)'
Tuition Deposit
Students must make a deposit of $50 when their application for
admission has been accepted. This advance payment is not refundable,
but will be credited to the student's tuition for the first term of
enrollment.
FINANCIAL AID
There are a number of ways in which students may receive assistance
in meeting the costs of Augsburg Weekend College. The Financial Aid
Office will assist adults in assessing financial need and constructing an
aidlpayment program from the following alternatives:
Company Tuition Assistance Programs
Many companies, agencies, and corporations offer full or partial tuition
assistance to employees who participate in work-related or degreeoriented college programs. Augsburg provides several payment plans
by which employees may handle tuition reimbursement.
Pell Grant Program
This is a federal aid program, based on need, that is available to
students who take at least a two-course load in Weekend College.
Minnesota Part-time Student Grant Program
REFUND SCHEDULE
A per course tuition refund will be made on the following basis:
(Students are responsible for cancelling courses with the Registrar's
Office in order to be eligible for the tuition refund.)
Prior to the first scheduled class meeting - 100%
Prior to the second scheduled class meeting - 80%
Prior to the third scheduled class meeting - 60%
No refund after the third scheduled class meeting.
The State of Minnesota provides an aid program, based on need, for
state residents who take a part-time load in an eligible Minnesota
institution such as Augsburg College.
Augsburg Tuition Grant
Augsburg College will provide grants and scholarships to Weekend
College students who show academic potential and have financial need.
Guaranteed Student LoanlMinnesota State Student
Loan Program
Students must carry at least one-half the normal full-time load. Eligibility
for the loan is determined by the Office of Student Financial Services.
When repayment begins, the student pays the full interest; 9% for
borrowers after January 1, 1981. The maximum loan is $2,500 per year
or the cost of education, whichever is less, and the aggregate
undergraduate maximum is $12,500. Loan applications are available at
Augsburg, some banks, and the Minnesota State Loan Office.
To Apply for Financial Aid
I
I
I
*Augsburg courses are comparatively large blocks of academic credit.
One Augsburg course is the equivalent of 6 quarter credits.-35 total
courses are needed to graduate.
**Tuition charge for 1983 summer terms.
1) Complete the Application for Admission and indicate your desire to
also apply for financial aid.
2) The Financial Aid Office will send you the necessary application
forms (or you may pick them up at the Financial Aid Office, 152
Science Hall).
3) Complete and return the financial aid forms by the deadlines
indicated.
4) Accept the financial aid offered, in whole or in part, within the
deadline stated.
ABOUT AUGSBURG COLLEGE
1
I
1
I
I
Who May Apply
History
Men or women who have:
1) Graduated from high school or have earned a G.E.D. Certificate.
2) Demonstrated academic ability with satisfactory performance in high
school or previous college work.
Augsburg College was founded in 1869 in Marshall, Wisconsin and
moved to Minneapolis in 1872. The name Augsburg College and
Seminary changed in 1963 when the Lutheran Free Church merged
with The American Lutheran Church.
Admissions Process
Location
1) Complete the attached application form and return it along with
$15.00 to the Augsburg Weekend College Office.
2) Have official transcripts from all previously attended post-secondary
institutions sent to the Augsburg Weekend College Office. Applicants
with less than one year of previous college work should include their
high school transcripts or G.E.D. Certificates.
3) The Augsburg Weekend College Admissions Committee will review
the application materials and notify students regarding acceptance
and registration procedures.
4) Students who are transferring previous college work to their
Augsburg Weekend College degree program will be informed with
their acceptance notification as to the number of courses and degree
requirements that remain to be completed for the baccalaureate
degree.
5) Students who are accepted and who choose to enroll in one or
more Augsburg Weekend College courses are asked to make a
$50.00 tuition deposit prior to registration for that term.
6) Students who wish to apply for financial aid please refer to that
section of this bulletin.
Augsburg's 23 acre campus is in the heart of the Twin Cities
metropolitan area, only blocks from downtown Minneapolis and the
intersection of Interstate Highways 94 and 35W. Adjacent to the
campus are Fairview and St. Mary's hospitals, the West Bank campus
of the University of Minnesota and the Mississippi River parkways.
Augsburg Weekend College students will not be required to take
college entrance examinations. The Admissions Committee may,
however, request that the student have a personal interview with a
Weekend College facultylstaff member or submit letters of
recommendation to the Committee. Students who are admitted
conditionally may be referred to the Academic Skills Center and
encouraged to participate in the developmental skills programs that
are available.
Campus
Skyways, tunnels and elevators provide accessible connection between
9 of the 14 major buildings-student housing towers, College Center,
main academic and administrative halls, the Library and Music building.
Accessibility
We have made a n?ajor effort to become one of the most accessible
campuses in the region. Our skyway-tunnel system lets you reach any
of the nine major buildings without going outside. In addition to building
changes, we have a student-run program to increase awareness and
provide extra help for students with disabilities.
Church Affiliation
Augsburg is a college of The American Lutheran Church. About 51 % of
the students are Lutheran, 15% other Protestant and 15% Roman
Catholic. Several other affiliations are represented among students and
faculty.
Nondiscrimination Policy
Augsburg College does not discriminate on the basis of race, creed,
national or ethnic origin, age, marital status, sex or handicap as required
by Title IX of the 1972 Educational Amendments or Section 504 of the
Rehabilitation Act of 1973 as amended in its admission policies,
educational programs, activities, and employment practices.
CAMPUS MAP
15. ~ i t t Theater
k
16. East Hall
G. practice ~ i e l d
H. Fairview-St. Mary's Parking Ramp
CAMPUS MAP
NOTES
CAMPUS LOCATION
lnterstate 94 east from Minneapolis to 25th Ave. exit, left to
Riverside Ave., left to 21st Ave. S., left at Augsburg sign.
lnterstate 94 west from St. Paul to Riverside exit, right on Riverside
to 21st Ave. S., left at Augsburg sign.
Parking: All posted Augsburg College parking lots are free and
open for student use from 4:30 p.m. Friday through Sunday evening.
Lots are located on 7th Street between 21st and 22nd Avenues and
south of 8th Street on 21st Avenue.
AUGSBURG
WEEKEND COLLEGE
Class Schedule & Course Dercrlptions
ri
I
1983-84 CALENDAR
FALL TRIMESTER
August 27,1983
OrientationIRegistration
September 9-11, 23-25
October 7-9, 21-23
-
-
November 4-6, 18-20
December 2-4
December 9-11
Exams
WINTER TRIMESTER
December 3,1983
OrientationIRegistration
January 6-8, 20-22
February 3-5,
17-19
March 2-4, 16-18, 30-April 1
April 6-8
Exams
SPRING TRIMESTER
March 31,1984
OrientationlRegistration
April 13-15, 27-29
May 4-6, 18-20
June 1-3. 8-10, 22-24
June 29-July 1
Exams
Winter Trimester, 1 0 8 4
Class Schedule
Fall Trimester, 1 0 8 3
Class Schedule
I
Friday
Thursday
6:OO-9:30
ART 352 Women's Art History
Friday
6:OO-9:30
BUS 145 Fundamentals of
Management
SPC 353 Advertising
SOC 383 Racial & Minority
Group Relations
Saturday 8:30-12:OO
Saturday
1:15-4:45
I
I
Sunday
1:15-4:45
I'
250
251
111
303
Data Processing
Intermediate Micro.
Effective Writing
Contemporary Nursing I:
~ommunications/Group
PSY 105 General Psychology
SPC 354 Interpersonal Comm.
REL 354 Life of the Church
in the City
*Courses may be added to or sclbtracted from the class
schedule on the basis of enrollment.
-
BUS 135 Intro. to Marketing
PSY 373 Organizational Psych.
Saturday 8:30-12:OO
BIO
BUS
BUS
CKM
101
102
373
110
Saturday
1:15-4:45
ART
BUS
ECO
MAT
225
340
123
114
Sunday
1:15-4:45
ENG 241 Intro. to Cinema Arts
E L 356 History of Religios~s
.
(.
BUS 101 Intro. to Financial
Accounting
BUS 261 Fundamentals of
Finance
CHM 109 General Chemistry
ENG 261 Modern Fiction
POL 342 Mass Communication
SPC 113 Public Speaking
BUS
ECO
ENG
NUR
6:OO-9:30
Human Biology
Managerial Accounting
Financial Management
Organic & Biological
Chemistry
PHI 130 Logic
SOC 121 Principles of
Sociology
Visual Communications I
Personnel Adininistration
Microeconomics
College Algebra &
Trigonmetry
NUR 304 Contemporary N~rsing11:
Nursing Theory
.
SPC 352 Persuasion
-
*Courses may be added to or subtracted from the class
schedule on the basis of enrollment.
Spring Trimester, 1084Class Schedule
Friday
6:OO-9:30
Saturday 8:30-12:OO
I
Course Descriptions
ART 225 VISUAL COMMUNICATIONS I
--
SOC 375 Social Psychology
SPC 480 Public Relations
BUS 131 Business Law
BUS 330 Marketing Analysis
& Research
ECO 340 Managerial Decision
Making
POL 121 American Government
& Politics
PSY 355 Brain & Behavior
(Winter, Sat. p.m.)
The theory and practice of visual perception and communication
using elements such as color, line, shape, texture, and pictoral images.
Distribution: Art
Major: Elective in public relations/advertising major
.
ART 330 VISUAL
-
COMMUNICATIONS
(Spring, Sat. p.m.)
A study of the visual communications in magazines, television,
film, advertising symbols, and other mass media. Practice in
the areas of photography, typography, and illustration.
(Prereq. : 225)
Distribution: Art (upper division)
Major: Elective in public relations/advertising major
Saturday
1:15-4:45
I
I
Sunday
1:15-4:45
ART
BUS
ECO
ENG
HIS
330
379
122
225
331
Visual Communications I1
Quantitative Methods
Macroeconomics
Advanced Writing
Topics in U.S. History:
1945 to present
NUR 330 Nursing Trends & Issues
E L 221 Biblical Studies
FEU3 111 Beginning French
GER 111 Beginning German
ART 352 WOMEN'S ART HISTORY
(Fall, Thurs. p.m.)
A study of women's image in the visual arts in relationship to
women's place within the cultural, economic, and sociolopical
environment of each period.
Distribution: Art, urban concerns/minority studies, (upper
division)
BIO 101 HUMAN BIOLOGY
----
(Winter, Sat. a.m.)
Basic biological concepts from an anthropocentric point of
view. An attempt to answer such questions as: What makes
man just another member of the biotic fold? Does man have a
niche in the ecosystem? What influence does man have on tile
environment? What influence does the environment, especially
ttie urban environment, have on man? (Does not apply to the
major or minor).
Distribution: Biology
Major: Required supporting course in Social Work
I
BUS 101 PRINCIPLES 3
--
*Courses may be added to or subtracted from the class
schedule on the basis of enrollment.
FINANClAL ACCOUNTING
(Fall, Sat. a.m.)
Introduction to business activities, basic concepts, and fundamentals of accounting, the accounting cycle and preparation
of financial stacen~encs.
Major:
Required for Business Administration core and MIS major
(Winter, Sat. a.m.)
BUS 102 PRINCIPLES 2 MANAGERIAL ACCOUNTING
Introduction to business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of managerial accounting. Planning and controlling
processes, decision-making and behavioral considerations.
(Prereq: 101)
Major:
Required for Business Administration core and MIS major
BUS 131 BUSINESS LAW
--
(Spring, Sat. a.m.)
Legal rules relating to contracts, agency, negotiable instruments, property and business organizations under the Uniform
Commerical Code.
Major:
Required for Business Administration core.
BUS 135 INTRODUCTION =MARKETING
--
(Winter, Fri. p.m.)
Principles of basic policy and strategy issues in marketing.
Legal, ethical, competitive, behavioral, economic and technological factors as they affect product, promotion, marketing
channel and pricing decisions.
Major:
Required for marketing major, elective in public relations/ advertising major
BUS 145 FUNDAMENTAL?
--
MANAGEMENT
Required for business Imnagement major in Business
Administration and MIS major, elective in public
relationa/edvertising and supervisory management
majors in Communication.
BUS 250 DATA PROCESSING
---
(Fall Sat. p.m.)
introduction to COBOL and other non-scientific programming
languages.
An
Major: Required in buslness managment and marketing major and
MIS major; elective in supervisory managment major.
(Fall, Sat. a.m.)
Theory of acquisition, allocation and management of funds
within the firm; sources and uses of long and short term
funds, cost of capital, capital budgeting, leverage, dividend policy, and related topics. (Prereq : 101,102)
Major:
Required for Business Administration core and MIS
major
BUS 330 MARKETING
--
RESEARCH
AND ANALYSIS
(Spring, Sat. a.m.)
Research process as an aid to decision-making in marketing
management; research methodology; marketing research results;
evaluation of the effectiveness of research in marketing.
(Prereq: Bus. Ad. 135 or consent of instructor).
Major: Required in marketing major (upper division)
BUS 340 PERSONNEL
--
ADMINISTRATION
(Winter, Sat. p.m.)
Personnel function in business, acquisition and utilization of
human resources, desirable working relationships; effective integration of the worker with the goals of the firm and society.
(Prereq: Bus. Ad. 145 or consent of instructor).
Major:
(Fall, Fri. p.m.)
Development of the theory of management. organization. staffing,
planning and control. The nature of authority, accountability
and responsibility, analysis of the role of the professional
manager.
Major:
BUS 261 FUNDAMENTALS OF FINANCE
--
Required for business management major, elective in
supervisory management major (upper division)
BUS 373 FINANCIAL
--
MANAGEMENT:
THEORIES AND CASES
(Winter, Sat. a.m.)
Advanced financial theory: a systems approach to financial
structure and policy. Emphasis on decision-making, presentation
through literature, readings, lectures and case material. (Prereq:
261).
Major:
Required in finance and business management majors
(upper division)
BUS 379 QUANTlTAl'IVE METHODS FOR ECONOMICS
--
BUSINESS (8P, Sat. p.m.)
An introduction to quantitiative reasoning, descriptive mea-
sures, probability, sampling distributions, inference and estimation with emphasis on their use in applletl problems in business
and economics. (Prereq: High School Algebra).
Major:
Required for Business Administratton core and MIS major
(upper division)
CHM 109 GENERAL, ORGANIC
-----
AND BIOLOGICAL CHEMISTRY
( F a l l , S a t . a.m.)
Designed f o r s t u d e n t s who need a s u r v e y of t h e fundamentals
of g e n e r a l . o r g a n i c and b i o l o g i c a l c h e m i s t r y f o r c a r e e r s i n
a l l i e d h e a l t h a r e a s s u c h a s n u r s i n g ( i n c l u d i n g Augsburg's
upper d i v i s i o n program). Open a l s o t o o t h e r s t u d e n t s .
F i r s t term, g e n e r a l c h e m i s t r y p r i n c i p l e s and a n i n t r o d u c t i o n t o organic chemistry. W i l l include arranged time f o r
l a b o r a t o r y work. T h i s c o u r s e d o e s n o t a p p l y toward t h e
major o r minor i n c h e m i s t r y .
Distribution:
Major:
Chemistry
Required p r e r e q u i s i t e f o r n u r s i n g major
CHH 110 GENERAL, --ORGANIC AND BIOLOGICAL
---
CHEMISTRY (W, S a t . a.m.)
C o n t i n u a t i o n of Chentistry 109. Organic and b i o l o g i c a l
c h e m i s t r y w i t h s p e c i a l a p p l i c a t i o n s t o human p h y s i o l o g i c a l
chemistry. W i l l i n c l u d e a r r a n g e d t i m e f o r l a b o r a t o r y work.
Does n o t apply toward t h e major o r minor i n c h e m i s t r y .
Distribution:
Major:
Major:
Required f o r B u s i n e s s A d m i n i s t r a t i o n c o r e .
ECO 340 MANAGERIAL DECISION MAKING
--
( S p r i n g , S a t . a.m.)
P r o v i d e s a sound c o n c e p t u a l u n d e r s t a n d i n g of t h e modern
t e c h n i q u e s of management s c i e n c e t o p r e p a r e s t u d e n t s t o
make b e t t e r b u s i n e s s and economic d e c i s i o n s . Emphasis
i s on a p p l i c a t i o n s , which a r e t a k e n from t h e a r e a s of
t r a n s p o r t a t i o n , m a r k e t i n g , p o r t f o l i o s e l e c t i o n , environm e n t a l p r o t e c t i o n , t h e s h o r t e s t r o u t e , i n v e n t o r y models,
i n f o r m a t i o n systems, e t c . ( P r e r e q : Econ. 123, Bus. Ad.
101 and h i g h s c h o o l a l g e b r a o r e q u i v a l e n t s ) .
Major:
Required f o r B u s i n e s s Managemenr major.
e l e c t i v e i n s u p e r v i s o r y management major
(upper d i v i s i o n )
Required p r e r e q u i s i t e f o r n u r s i n g major
ECONOMICS (MACRO)
( S p r i n g , S a t . p.m.)
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o macroeconomics; n a t i o n a l income a n a l y s i s ,
monetary and f i s c a l p o l i c y , i n t e r n a t i o n a l t r a d e , economic
growth. A p p l i c a t i o n of elementary economic t h e o r y t o curr e n t economic problems. May b e t a k e n i n d e p e n d e n t l y of Economics 123 o r 120. Economics 122 and 123 may b e t a k e n i n
e i t h e r order.
Distribution:
Economics
Required f o r Business A d m i n i s t r a t i o n c o r e .
ECO 123 PRINCIPLES OF
--
ECONOMICS (MICRO) (Wjnter, S a t . p.m.)
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o microeconomics. t h e t h e o r y o f t h e househ o l d , f i r m , market: s t r u c t u r e s and income d i s t r i b u t i o n .
A p p l i c a t i o n of e l e m e n t a r y economic t h e o r y t o market p o l i c y .
May b e t a k e n i n d e p e n d e n t l y of Economics 122 o r 120. ECOnomics 122 and 123 may b e t a k e n i n e i t h e r o r d e r .
Distribution:
Major:
( F a l l , S a t . p.m.)
Theory of r e s o u r c e a l l o c a t i o n , a n a l y s i s o f consumer beh a v i o r , f i r m and i n d u s t r y ; t h e p r i c i n g of f a c t o r s o f
p r o d u c t i o n and income d i s t r i b u t i o n ; i n t r o d u c t i o n t o welf a r e economics ( P r e r e q : 123).
Chemistry
ECO 122 PRINCIPLES OF
--
Major:
ECO 251 INTERMEDIATE MICROECONOMICS
--
Economics
Required f o r Business A d m i n i s t r a t i o n c o r e
ENG 111 EFFECTIVE WRITING
--
( F a l l , S a t . p.m.)
The s t u d y of composition w i t h emphasis on e x p o s i t o r y w r i t i n g .
A t t e n t i o n t o c o r r e c t usage, l o g i c a l o r g a n i z a t i o n , and t h e
r e s e a r c h p a p e r . The g r a d i n g system f o r t h i s c o u r s e i s e i t h e r
PIN o r 2.0-4.O/N.
Distribution:
ENG 225 ADVANCED
--
Required f o r g r a d u a t i o n
EXPOSlTORY WRITING ( S p r i n g . S a t . a.m.)
The development o f e s s a y s i n a v a r i e t y of r h e t o r i c a l modes,
which may i n c l u d e i d e n t i f i c a t i o n , d e f i n i t i o n . c l a s t l i f i c a t i o n ,
i l l u s t r a t i o n , comparison and c o n t r a s t , and a n a l y s i s . Part i c u l a r a t t e n t i o n w i l l b e g i v e n t o s t y l i s t i c and o r g a n i z a t i o n a l m a t t e r s through t h e c o u r s e ' s workshop f o r m a t , i n which
s t u d e n t s ' p a p e r s a r e r e a d and d i s c u s s e d . ( P r e r e q : 111).
Major:
Required f o r Communications c o r e , e l e c t i v e f o r b u s i n e s s managenlent major
ENG 241 INTRODUCTION
--
T O CINEMA ART
(Winter, Sun. p.m.)
An i n v e s t i g a t i o n of t h e a r t i s t i c q u a l i t i e s and t h e h i s t o r i c a l development of t h e f i l m medium. The c o u r s e i n c l u d e s t h e
viewing and d i s c u s s i n g of b o t h . f e a t u r e l e n g t h and s h o r t f i l m s .
Distribution:
English
ENG 261 MODERN FICTlON
----
( F a l l , S a t . a.m.)
S i g n i f i c a n t works of s e l e c t e d p r o s e w r i t e r s , c h i e f l y European, of t h e t w e n t i e t h c e n t u r y .
Distribution:
FRE 111 BEGINNING
--
English
FRENCH ( S p r i n g , Sun. p.m.)
Designed t o i n t r o d u c e t h e s t u d e n t w i t h no p r e v i o u s background i n French t o t h e language and t o French c u l t u r e .
The p r o n u n c i a t i o n system and b a s i c s e n t e n c e s t r u e t u r e s
a r e t a u g h t t o e n a b l e u n d e r s t a n d i n g and e x p r e s s i o n on a
rudimentary l e v e l . While t h i s c o u r s e i s open t o a l l s t u dents, t h e course w i l l focus i n p a r t on preparation f o r a
t r i p t o France t o t a k e p l a c e d u r i n g t h e summer s e s s i o n i n
c o n j u n c t i o n w i t h French 112.
Distribution:
GER 111 BEGINNING
--
Foreign Language
GERMrW
(Spring, Sun. p.m.)
Course 111 i s f o r s t u d e n t s w i t h no p r e v i o u s background. A i m s
a t d e v e l o p i n g b a s i c s k i l l s . Classroom p r a c t i c e i n s p e a k i n g ,
u n d e r s t a n d i n g and r e a d i n g b a s i c German. Goals: a b i l i t y t o
r e a d extended n a r r a t i v e s i n s i m p l e German, i n s i g h t s i n t o German c u l t u r e and p a r t i c i p a t i o n i n s h o r t c o n v e r s a t i o n s . Laboratory materials available.
Distribution:
F o r e i g n Language
HIS 331 TOPICS I N U.S. HISTORY:
------
1945 TO PRESENT (SP, S a t . p.m.)
A s u r v e y of t h e p r i n c i p a l t r e n d s i n American p o l i t i c s and
f o r e i g n p o l i c y from t h e end of World War I1 t o t h e p r e s e n t .
S o c i a l and c u l t u r a l t r e n d s a l s o a r e emphasized, p a r t i c u l a r l y
a s t h e y r e l a t e t o p o l i t i c s and t h e conduct of f o r e i g n p o l i c y .
Distribution:
H i s t o r y (upper d i v i s i o n )
MAT 114 COLLEGE ALGEBRA
-----
AND TRIGONOMETRY (Winter, S a t . p.m.)
Fundamental o p e r a t i o n s , f a c t o r i n g , f r a c t i o n s , f u n c t i o n s , and
g r a p h s , l i n e a r e q u a t i o n s , exponents and r a d i c a l s , q u a d r a t i c
e q u a t i o n s , r a t i o and v a r i a t i o n , p r o g r e s s i o n , binomial theorem,
l o g a r i t h m s and t r i g o n o m e t r i c f u n c t i o n s .
Distribution:
Major:
Math
S t r o n g l y recommended f o r Business A d m i n i s t r a t i o n major
p r i o r t o t a k i n g Bus 379 and f o r t h e MIS major p r i o r t o
t a k i n g Mat 174.
NUR -303 CONTEMPORARY
-
NURSING I: COMMUNICATIONS/GROUP_
(35 course--Fall, S a t . p.m.)
T h i s c o u r s e is one of t h e t r a n s i t i o n a l c o u r s e s t h a t int r o d u c e s t h e s t u d e n t t o components of t h e p r o f e s s i o n a l
r o l e and b e g i n s t h e p r o f e s e i o n a l and s o c i a l i z a t i o n p r o c e s s .
The communication p r o c e s s i s emphasized a s one means by
which t h e n u r s e - c l i e n t r e l a t i o n s h i p i s e s t a b l i s h e d and
m a i n t a i n e d . I n t e r a c t i v e communication t h e o r i e s a r e e x p l o r e d
f o r t h e i r a p p l i c a b i l i t y t o changing r o l e s and p r o f e s s i o n a l
practice.
Major:
Rquired f o r upper d i v i s i o n n u r s i n g major.
NUR 304 CONTEMPORARY NURSING
--
11: NURSING THEORY ($ c o u r s e )
(Winter, S a t . p.m.)
The c o u r s e i n t r o d u c e s t h e o r i e s and c o n c e p t u a l t h i n k i n g i n
t h e p r o c e s s of p r o f e s s i o n a l development. The f u n c t i o n of
t h e o r y i n g u i d i n g n u r s i n g p r a c t i c e is emphasized. S e l e c t e d
n u r s i n g t h e o r i e s a r e examined.
Major:
Required f o r upper d i v i s i o n n u r s i n g major.
NUR 330 TRENDS AND ISSUES IN NURSING ( S p r i n g ,
-
S a t . p.m.)
This course is designed t o i n v e s t i g a t e the c u r r e n t responsib i l i t i e s of t h e p r o f e s s i o n a l n u r s e .
Contemporary s o c i a l and
p r o f e s s i o n a l t r e n d s and i s s u e s a r e e x p l o r e d i n l i g h t of t h e i r
implications f o r nursing practice.
Major:
Required f o r upper d i v i s i o n n u r s i n g major.
PHI 130 LOGIC
---
(Winter, S a t . a.m.)
Suppose someone g i v e s you r e a s o n s . and t h e n s a y s you must acc e p t a p a r t i c u l a r c o n c l u s i o n . Must you? When does a conclus i o n v a l i d l y f o l l o w from p r e m i s e s ? Here we examine t h e r u l e s
which govern v a l i d arguments and work t o develop your a b i l i t y
t o r e c o g n i z e and c o n s t r u c t sound arguments.
Distribution:
Major:
Philosophy
Required s u p p o r t i n g c o u r s e f o r Communication major
POL 1 2 1 AMERICAN
--
GOVERNMENT AND POLITICS
( S p r i n g , S a t . a.m.)
The p o l i t i c s of American government i n c l u d i n g t h e forms of p o l i t i c a l i d e a s ; t h e p a t t e r n of p a r t i c i p a t i o n ; t h e dynamics of cong r e s s i o n a l , p r e s i d e n t i a l and b u r e a u c r a t i c policymaking; and
c u r r e n t i s s u e s i n American s o c i e t y . The c o u r s e was s e l e c t e d t o
c o i n c i d e w i t h t h e t i m e l e a d i n g up t o t h e e l e c t i o n y e a r p o l i t i c a l
p a r t y convent i o n s .
Distribution:
P o l i t i c a l Science
POL 342 MASS
---
COMMUNICATIONS I N SOCIETY ( F a l l , S a t . a.m.)
E f f e c t s of mass communications on i n d i v i d u a l b e h a v i o r ; t h e
u s e s and c o n t r o l of mass media f o r p o l i t i c a l and s o c i a l purposes i n c l u d i n g a s t u d y of c e n s o r s h i p , newsmaking, e n t e r t a i n ment and p u b l i c a f f a i r s progranrming.
Distribution:
Major:
Urban Concerns
Required f o r t h e Communication major.
PSY 105 CENERAL
---
PSYCHOLOGY
( F a l l , S a t . p.m.)
An i n t r o d u c t i o n t o t h e methods and approachea used i n psychology f o r t h e purpose of u n d e r s t a n d i n g b e h a v i o r . The s t r u c t u r e of t h e f i e l d of psychology, i n c l u d i n g i t s major sub-areas,
is emphasized.
Distribution:
Major:
Psychology
Required s u p p o r t i n g c o u r s e f o r Communication majors and
S o c i a l Work major, a p r e r e q u i s i t e f o r advanced c o u r s e s
i n psychology
REL .354
LIFE OF THE CHURCH IN THE CITY
-
Distribution:
REL 356 HISTORY
----
BEHAVIOR
( S p r i n g , S a t . a.m.)
A s u r v e y of t h e f u n c t i o n s o f t h e nervous system which a r e res p o n s i b l e f o r b e h a v i o r i n a n i m a l s and human b e i n g s . Major
t o p i c s include:
s l e e p and w a k e f u l n e s s , m o t i v a t i o n and emotion,
l e a r n i n g and memory and m e n t a l d i s o r d e r s ( P r e r e q : 105 and one
course i n biology).
Major:
Required p r e r e q u i s i t e c o u r s e f o r upper d i v i s i o n n u r s i n g
ma jo r
PSY 373 ORGANIZATIONAL
--
PSYCHOLOGY (Winter, F r i . p.m.)
T h e o r e t i c a l c o n c e p t u a l i z a t i o n s of o r g a n i z a t i o n a l b e h a v i o r .
F a c t o r s and p r a c t i c e s such a s management s t y l e s , e v a l u a t i o n and
m a i n t e w n c e of work e f f e c t i v e n e s s , and s o c i a l i n f l u e n c e s .
An
organizational f i e l d experience.
( P r e r e q : 105).
Major:
Supporting c o u r s e f o r Business Management major and
e l e c t i v e f o r a l l Communication majors (upper d i v i s i o n )
REL 221 BIBLICAL STUDIES
--
(Spring, S a t . p.m.)
Relgion o r Urban Concerns (upper d i v i s i o n )
OF RELIGIONS
(Winter, Sun. p.m.)
An i n t r o d u c t o r y s u r v e y of some of t h e major l i v i n g r e l i g i o n s
of t h e world, i n c l u d i n g Hinduism, Buddhism, Confucianism,
Taoism, S h i n t o and Islam. L e c t u r e s p l u s some d i s c u s s i o n of
primary documents from t h e s e r e l i g i o u s communities.
Distribution:
R e l i g i o n (upper d i v i s i o n )
SOC 121 PRINCIPLES
--
SOCIOLOGY
(Winter, S a t . a.m.)
Its a p p l i Sociology a s a mode o f a n a l y s i s o r way of knowing.
c a t i o n t o a n u n d e r s t a n d i n g of b a s i c a s p e c t s of s o c i e t y ; s o c i a l i z a t i o n , family l i f e , s o c i a l i n e q u a l i t i e s , large-scale i n s t i tutions, etc.
Sociology a s a n academic d i s c i p l i n e and p r o f e s s i o n .
Distribution:
PSY 355 BRAIN AND
----
( F a l l , Sun. p.m.)
The Gospel and v a r i o u s forms of m i n i s t r y e v i d e n t i n urban
structures.
Major:
Sociology
Required s u p p o r t i n g c o u r s e f o r Communication n ~ a j o rand
S o c i a l Work major.
SOC 375 SOCIAL
---
PSYC1tOI.OGY
( S p r i n g , F r i . p.m.)
An examination of t h e i d e a of "group", i t s r e l a t i o n s h i p t o ind i v i d u a l b e h a v i o r and s o c i e t y . An a n a l y s i s of t h e i d e a s of
" s e l f " and " i d e n t i t y " and what p a r t t h e y p l a y i n u n d e r s t a n d i n g
A ~ o c i o l o g i c a lv i s w
i n t e r p e r s o n a l r e l a t i o n s and human b e h a v i o r .
of m e n t a l h e a l t h .
A l o o k a t t h e major assumptions and p r o c e s s e s
u n d e r l y i n g o u r everyday l i f e - - a l o o k a t t h e t r i v i a l , t h e o r d i "Symbolic i n t e r a c t i o ~ l " , a n i m nary and t h e taken-for-granted.
p o r t a n t o r i e n t a t i o n I n s o c i a l psyctiology, w i l l b e used a s a way
of d e a l i n g w i t h t h e major i s s u e s i n t h e c o u r s e .
( P r e r e q : 121
o r Psych 105).
Major:
Required s u p p o r t i n g c o u r s e f o r Communication m a j o r s and
S o c i a l Work major, e l e c - t i v e s u p p o r t i n g c o u r s e f o r b u s i n e s s management major (upper d i v i s i o n ) .
SOC 383 RACIAL
-
AND EIINOKl'TY CROUP KEl.Al:IONS
( F a l l , F r i . p.m.)
The o r i g i n , l i t e r a r y c h a r a c t e r , and t r a n s m i s s i o n of t h e B i b l i c a l
documents. The t a s k of b i b l i c a l i n t e r p r e t a t i o n .
The h i s t o r y of
I s r a e l and t h e emergence of t h e church.
The dimensions of r a c i a l and m i n o r i t y group r e l a t i o n s . Major
a t t e n t i o n i s focused upon p r e j u d i c e , r a c i s m , and t h e r o l e o f
self-understanding.
Distribution:
Distribution:
Religion
Major:
Minority S t u d i e s
Required s u p p o r t i n g c o u r s e f o r s o c i a l . work major and
(upper d i v i s i o n )
bus l n e s s managelllent major.
-.
Important Academic D a t e s
SPC 11'3/313
PUHLlC Sl'EAKING
(Fall, Sat. a.m.)
Basic problems of effective speaking and lietening. May be
taken for lower and upper division credit upon consultation
with instructor.
Distribution: E~~glish/speech
Major:
SPC 352
Required supporting course in communication major
Elective supporting course in business management major
PERSUASION
(Winter, Sat. p.m.)
Theory of persuasion and propaganda, practical work in speech
and promotional projects.
Major:
Required for communications major, supporting course
in marketing major
(upper division)
SPC 353 ADVERTISING
(Fall, Fri. p.m.)
An introduction to print and broadcast advertising and promotion as important elements in modern marketing and comunication.
Major:
SI'C 354
I
I
Supporting course in marketing major, elective in
public relations/advertising and supervisory management majors.
INTERPERSONAL (:OMMUNICATION
(Fall, Sat. p.m. )
A study of the dynamics of human interaction through verbal
and lion-verbal messages; emphasis on factors that build
relationships and help to overcome communication barriers.
I
I
Distribution:
I
Major:
~nglish/S~eech(upper division)
Required for Communication Core, elective supporting
course in business management major
SPC 480 PUBLIC RELATIONS
-Public Relations in the modern world of communication, marketing
and business. An overview of public relations as a career and
how it fits into the total picture of communication.
Major:
Elective in all communication majors
(upper division)
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Golden Valley Lutheran College Catalog, 1983-1984
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN
COLLEGE C.4. T.4LOG
Published Annually by
Golden Valley Lutheran College
6125 Olson Highway
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55422
Phone (612) 542-1216
Golden Valley Lutheran College in compliance with State and Federal laws and
regulations, does not discriminate on the basis...
Show more
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN
COLLEGE C.4. T.4LOG
Published Annually by
Golden Valley Lutheran College
6125 Olson Highway
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55422
Phone (612) 542-1216
Golden Valley Lutheran College in compliance with State and Federal laws and
regulations, does not discriminate on the basis of race, color, national origin,
religion, sex, age, marital status, handicap, or status as a veteran in the administration
of its admissions policies, scholarship and loan programs, educational programs,
activities, and employment policies. Inquiries regarding compliance and grievance
procedures may be directed to the college office manager, Vivian Wiemerslage.
This catalog supersedes The Golden Valley Lutheran College 1982-83 Catalog.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
College Calendar
4
President's Greeting
5
General Information
7
History, The Campus and Its Location, Philosophy and Objectives,
Accreditation and Transfer of Credit, Affiliations, General Guidelines.
Student Life
11
New Student Pre-Registration, Counseling Services, Health Services,
Library, Insurance, Housing Services, Student Government and Social
Life, Religious Life, Chapel, Student Use of Automobiles, Alcohol and
Drug Abuse, Athletics, Music, Drama.
Admissions Information
17
Entrance Requirements, Application Procedure, Transfer Students,
Adult Students.
Costs
19
Student Costs, Charges by Quarter, Payment Plan, Refund Schedule,
Books and Supplies.
Financial Aid
23
Gift Aid, Deferred Payment Loans, Student Employment, Procedure
for Applying for Financial Aid, Scholarships.
Academic Program
29
General Academic Information, Orientation and Registration.
Graduaton Requirements
35
Liberal Arts and Transfer Program, Specialized Program, Junior
College Certificate, One-Year Vocational Certificate.
Programs of Study
39
Course Descriptions
55
Divisions: Biblical and Theological Studies; Communications; Social
Science; Mathematics and Sciences; Physical Education and Recreation
Leadership; Creative Arts; Business and Vocational Studies.
Di rectory
76
Board of Regents, Administration, Faculty, Student Services Personnel.
Index
82
4
COLLEGE CALENDAR
CALENDAR 1983-84
Fall Quarter
September 5-9
September
September
September
September
11
12
12
14
September 16
September 23
September 30
October 7
October 10-14
October 22
November 7-10
November 18-23
November 23
Student orientation and registration for all
students
All college worship
Classes begin
Opening convocation
9:50 a.m.
Final day for payment of fall quarter fees
without late fee
6:00 p.m. - Gymnasium
President's Reception
Final day to add a class or change a class section
Final day to withdraw from a course with a
grade of W
Final day to submit work for incomplete courses
Midquarter examinations
Homecoming
Registration for winter quarter
Final examinations
Vacation begins after completion of final examinations
Winter Quarter
December 5
December 7
December
December
December
December
11
16
22
22
January 9
January 13
January 16-20
January 24-26
February 6-9
February 27-March 1
March 1
Classes begin
Final day for payment of winter quarter fees without
late fee
Festival of the Christ Child
Final day to add a class or change a class section
Final day to withdraw from a course with a grade of W
Christmas vacation begins after the traditional observance at 11 :30 a.m.
Classes resume
Final day to submit work for incomplete courses
Midquarter examinations
Days of Prayer and Praise
Registration for spring quarter
Final examinations
Vacation begins after completion of final examinations
Spring Quarter
March 12
March 14
March 23
March 30
April 6
April 9-13
April 20-22
April 23
May 1-3
May 4
May 8
May 21-24
May 25
Classes begin
Final day for payment of spring quarter fees
without late fee
Final day to add a class or change a class section
Final day to withdraw from a course with a
grade of W
Final. day to submit work for incomplete courses
Midquarter examinations
Easter vacation
Classes resume
Pre-registration for fall quarter
Spring banquet
Honors Day
Final examinations
Commencement
Calendar Subject to Change
PRESIDENrs GREETING
5
President's
Greeting
Experiences during the first year after high school play a major role in
one's development of a philosophy of life. This consequently determines
how one lives his or her life.
Golden Valley Lutheran College was established with the main
purpose of providing an opportunity for the student to develop a
philosophy of life founded on Christian convictions.
We strive to provide this foundation for life by emphasizing a
personalized education which includes the opportunity for the study of
both liberal arts and the Scriptures. This is a curriculum we believe will
best help the student understand the world in which he or she will be
living and working.
We ask that those who come have an open mind, a grateful heart and a
desire to learn. Preparation for "making a living" is not sufficient for the
Christian today. Golden Valley Lutheran College is also designed to
provide an education which will serve as preparation for "making a life."
Bernt C. Opsal, President
GENERAL INFORMATION
7
GENERALI F RMATION
History
Golden Valley Lutheran college is a two-year coeducational liberal arts
college established in 1967 by The Lutheran Bible Institute of Minneapolis. Beginning as a Bible institute in 1919, The Lutheran Bible Institute
moved from St. Paul to Minneapolis in 1929. In 1961 it moved to Golden
Valley, a suburb four miles west of downtown Minneapolis. Through the
years this educational institution has addressed itself to the needs of
people and has sought to meet those needs by establishing programs
appropriate to the times. The College is inter-Lutheran and is not directly
affliated with any particular Lutheran synod. It cooperates with and seeks
to serve all synods and society as a whole. The College admits qualified
men and women from various geographic, cultural, economic, racial, and
religious backgrounds.
The Campus and Its location
Golden Valley Lutheran College is located on a beautiful 30-acre
campus in Golden Valley, a western suburb of Minneapolis. The greater
Twin City area is a cultural, recreational, and sports center of the Upper
Midwest.
The academic life of the students is centered in a large two-level
complex. Classrooms, library, faculty and administrative offices, a prayer
chapel, the College auditorium-gymnasium, cafeteria and lounges are
located in this building.
Four residence halls on campus, Alpha, Beta, Gamma, and Delta
dormitories, house approximately 400 students. The facilities include
fireplace lounges, laundry facilities, rooms for prayer and meditation,
and apartments for residence hall directors. Adjacent to Gamma dormitory is the Commons, a student lounge and recreation area. A student
center is located in Delta dormitory.
8
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Philosophy and Objectives
Golden Valley Lutheran College is a liberal arts institution with
programs of study in general education, Biblical literature, music,
physical development, and semi-professional training. It seeks to provide
two years of higher education for students interested in the arts and
sciences, and also to give opportunity for a study of the sources of the
Christian faith. Through special activities the College provides the basis
for personal growth and cultural enrichment. Students are encouraged
to participate in community and church activities.
In order to reach these goals, Golden Valley Lutheran College offers
students a choice of one of the following curricula:
1. Completion of a two-year liberal arts education that functions
according to the standards common to the academic enterprise
and that prepares the student to transfer to a four-year college or
university.
2.
Completion of a two-year program that provides the basis for semiprofessional employment in the fields of church staff work,
missions, secretarial work, social service, recreational leadership,
law enforcement and a cooperative computer training program.
3. Study of the Bible and liberal arts in a collegiate setting for
individuals who do not intend to pursue a degree or a semiprofessional program.
Golden Valley Lutheran College strives to supplement these curricular
programs by emphasizing the following objectives with opportunities ...
to develop knowledge of the Judea-Christian world view as set
forth in the literature of the Old and New Testaments and an
analysis on the part of each student concerning his or her basic
beliefs and spiritual commitments.
to develop service motivated standards of conduct for young
adults as they move into the many areas of national life, including
social improvement, community involvement and active membership in Christian congregations.
to appreciate the great works of art, music and the theatre through
courses and cultural events which take place on the campus and in
the metropolitan area.
to attain physical well-being through the application of standards
conducive to good health and through participation in physical
education and sports activities.
to develop personal self-confidence through the determination
of individual goals, the building of relationships with other people
and the experience of companionship in a Christian setting.
GENERAL INFORMATION
9
Accreditation and Transfer of Credit
Golden Valley Lutheran College received regional accreditation
through the North Central Association of Colleges and Schools in
July of 1978. Thus, entering students can be confident that if they
make a creditable record at Golden Valley Lutheran College, their
credits will normally transfer to other colleges and universities. Students
who are planning to continue their education at a college with limited
transfer of religion credits may register for the religion courses which are
listed in the liberal arts departments. Through the proper selection, most
religion courses are transferable. A student with a satisfactory academic
record can normally complete a bachelor's degree two full academic
years after receiving the Associate in Arts degree from Golden Valley
Lutheran College.
Affiliations
North Central Association of Colleges and Schools
Registered with the Minnesota Higher Education Coordinating Board
Lutheran Educational Conference of North America
National Association of Independent Colleges and Universities
American Association of Community and Junior Colleges
Minnesota Association of Community and Junior Colleges
National Junior College Athletic Association - Region XIII
Minnesota Community College Conference
General Guidelines
Golden Valley Lutheran College is oriented to the Christian Gospel
and expects its students to live accordingly.
The College reserves the right to discipline those who conduct
themselves in a manner which is not in the best interest of the individual,
other students, or the College. Each student is expected to be familiar
with the regulations and standards pertaining to student conduct as
described in the Student Life Handbook.
STUDENT LIFE
11
STUDENT LIFE
Campus life at Golden Valley Lutheran College provides activities and
experiences which help develop the whole person. The programs of the
College provide wholesome recreation designed to stimulate spiritual
and intellectual growth. Students are involved in the planning of social
activities which can enrich college life and foster friendships.
New Student Pre-Registration
Prior to the start of the fall quarter, new students are invited to the
campus to participate in pre-registration activities. During this time the
student will have an opportunity to learn more about the College and
meet staff and faculty personnel who will assist in course planning for the
coming year.
Selected sophomores are available to help the new students become
familiar with and adjust to college life.
Counseling Services
The major decisions which students have to make during their early
college years are often difficult and perplexing. Counseling provides a
service which helps students learn ways of solving their academic,
vocational, social, emotional and spiritual problems.
Each student is assigned to a faculty advisor who will assist him or her in
planning an appropriate schedule of classes for each academic term. In
addition to individual counseling, several counseling groups, concerned
with matters such as personal growth, chemical dependency and other
problems, meet regularly. Each student also may make appointments to
visit with instructors, residence hall directors, the deans, the College
nurse or others on the staff who can give assistance.
Study skills assistance is provided for students who need to improve
their reading rate, reading comprehension, spelling, mathematics skills,
study skills, or writing skills. Students seeking this assistance should
register for one of the Personal Orientation courses listed in the Course
Description section.
Health Services
The College has a full-time registered nurse on the staff to provide basic
medical services. Students requiring additional treatment are usually
referred to the Golden Valley Clinic which is located less than a mile from
the campus. Major Twin City hospitals also are readily accessible.
12
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
library
The iibrary, iocated on the ground fioor of the Main buiiding provides
a variety of materials and services to support the college curricula. There
are over 30,000 volumes, 247 periodicals, local and national newspapers,
and a substantial vertical file in the collection. In addition, there is a
sizeable audiovisual collection including phonograph records and
cassettes, as well as filmstrips with necessary listening and viewing
equipment available to the students.
Insurance
The College does not assume any responsibility for the loss of or
damage to personal property. Many families have homeowners policies
that will cover losses of family members at college.
Housing Services
Golden Valley Lutheran College is primarily a residential college. If
space is available, full-time students live in the College residence halls.
E~ceptions are those who commute from their homes, or who work for
their board and room. All students living on campus are required to
participate in the cafeteria program which provides three meals a day,
seven days a week. The price fixed for the weekly 21 meal plan is set with
the knowledge that a certain percentage of the meals will be missed
during a week. Students who are commuting may purchase either their
noon or evening meal in the College cafeteria.
Student Government and Social life
A forum for student expression and student-initiated improvements in
campus life is provided by a Student Senate chosen from the student
body. This representative group serves as a coordinator of studentfaculty relations. It seeks continually to improve and make student life
more enjoyable.
The social program of the College is under the supervision of the
Student Activities Commission (SAC). Homecoming, Sno-Daze and the
Spring Banquet are examples of the many social activities available.
Disciplinary problems are arbitrated by the student Judiciary Board.
Religious life
As an institution of Christian higher education, Golden Valley Lutheran
College believes that religious life activities are an integral part of its
program. Therefore the College provides regularly scheduled chapel
services, campus worship services, transportation to local church services,
all-campus devotions, dormitory devotions and Christian student organizations. Special programs include the Days of Prayer & Praise and the
Christmas Festival of the Christ Child. Religious activities are co-ordinated
by the faculty Chapel & Special Events Committee and by a student Faith &
Life Commission.
STUDENT LIFE
13
Many students also participate in Christian Service activities in the
community and in world mission activities. The College has a Fellowship
of Christian Athletes chapter in which many students take an active part.
There also is an opportunity to serve on outreach teams which travel to
present the Gospel in word and song.
Chapel
All classes are dismissed each morning for a 25-minute chapel
program. These programs are varied in content. Some are in the nature of
worship services conducted by students, faculty, or guest speakers, while
others include films, lectures, drama, music or other special convocation
programs.
The chapel service is the heart and center of our collegiate program. It
is here that messages are shared from the Scriptures, and opportunity is
given for worship, intellectual stimulation and the development of a
sense of community.
Each student is encouraged to participate in the chapel services of the
college community and to attend public worship every Sunday.
Student Use of Automobiles
Parking space is limited on campus. Those students who do not need
an automobile for commuting or transportation to or from work are
urged not to bring a vehicle to college. Those who do need an
automobile or motorcycle must secure a parking permit through the
business office. The Dean of Students has the right to terminate a permit
at any time if circumstances warrant such action. The College assumes no
responsibility for damage, theft, or vandalism involving student vehicles.
Alcohol and Drug Abuse
Golden Valley Lutheran College strongly discourages all students from
using alcohol and/or mood altering drugs. Students possessing, using, or
under the influence of alcohol or drugs on campus, in college-approved
housing, or at college-sponsored events both on and off campus will be
subject to disciplinary action. In instances where college officials are
informed that Golden Valley Lutheran College sturlents have caused a
disturbance off campus in connection with the use of alcohol or drugs
the College reserves the right to take disciplinary action.
Golden Valley Lutheran College upholds all federal and state statutes
pertaining to the illegal use of alcohol or drugs. A student who uses,
possesses, or persuades someone else to use alcohol or drugs in violation
of the law will be subject to disciplinary action. The College's action will
be determined by the circumstances surrounding each individual case.
The College provides counseling services and support groups for those
with chemical dependency problems.
14
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Athletics
Through the physical education and athletic prograiT1S the College
seeks to teach the value of good health and physical fitness, to cultivate
interest in the proper use of leisure time, to develop character and good
sportsmanship and to give instruction in various sports and games used in
recreaf1onal acf1vHies. Intercollegiate athletic competition for men is
available in football, baseball, basketball, wrestling, soccer, track, marathon, and cross country. Women may participate in intercollegiate
basketball, cross country, softball, volleyball, marathon and track competition. The College is a member of the Minnesota Community College
Conference, and the National Junior College Athletic Association.
Intramural programs are available for both men and women. These
include activities such as volleyball, basketball, broomball, softball, etc.
Music
Golden Valley Lutheran College is sensitive to the cultural and spir"1tual
values that music contributes to our society. It desires, therefore, to
cultivate and nurture student interest and participation in music by
giving opportunity for self-expression as a member of a performing
group. These groups include the Golden Valley Lutheran College Choir,
a selected group of 65 voices; the Madrigal Singers, a smaller ensemble
which specializes in certain types of music literature; the Golden Valley
Singers, a women's chorus; a pep band and concert band; the Golden
Valley Orchestra, a community and college organization; and various
vocal and instrumental ensembles. In addition to specific courses in the
field of music, the College offers private voice and instrumental
instruction.
The location of the College in the Twin City area provides opportunity
for students to gain a new appreciation of the fine arts. Community
concerts, the Minnesota Orchestra, the Minneapolis Civic Orchestra, the
St. Paul Chamber Orchestra, and programs given by other colleges
including the University of Minnesota, offer continuing opportunities
for cultural enrichment.
Drama
The drama program at Golden Valley Lutheran College is two-fold in its
purpose. It attempts to expose the student to the inner workings of the
College theatre, and it seeks to foster a sense of appreciation for
dramatics by encouraging active participation in the field.
STUDENT LIFE
15
ADMISSIONS INFORMATION
17
ADMISSIONS INFORMATION
Entrance Requirements
Golden Valley Lutheran College seeks students who are interested in a
quality education with a Christian orientation. All applicants for admission
must possess a high school diploma or its equivalent. In addition, each
applicant must furnish required reference letters, satisfactory test scores,
and complete a personal interview with an admissions counselor.
The College reserves the right not to accept an applicant or to
withdraw the privilege of a student to return after any quarter if it is
judged to be in the best interest of the individual or of the College.
Application Procedure
Application materials are available from the Director of Admissions.
Applicants are advised to follow these steps in applying:
1.
Secure an application blank from the Office of Admissions. Return
the completed form together with the non-refundable $10
application fee to: Office of Admissions, Golden Valley Lutheran
College, 6125 Olson Highway, Minneapolis, Minnesota 55422.
2. Request your high school to forward your academic transcript to
the Director of Admissions.
3.
Furnish test results from one of the testing programs described
below.
Minnesota Residents: Graduates of a Minnesota high school are
responsible for submitting the results of their participation in the
Minnesota State-Wide Testing Program or in the ACT Assessment
Program.
PLEASE NOTE:
e
~EW DEPOSIT Po.LLQL
,s
d
ALL STUDENTS ACCEPTED FOR ADMISSION ARE
REQUIRED TO PAY A $100,00 TUITIGN DEPOSIT.
THIS DEPOSIT WILL BE APPLIED TO THE
STUDENT'S FIRST QUARTER TUITION, THIS
DEPOSIT ALSO RESERVES HOUSING FOR ON
CAMPUS STUDENTS. THIS DEPOSIT IS NOT
REFUNDABLE PRIOR TO ENROLLMENT.
UCCI I
UCUULLCU,
e
is
e
II
g
d
e
18
5.
6.
7.
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Before a dormitory room can be assigned, a $50.00 room deposit
must be made, with priority given on the basis of the date payment
is received. A student contracts for a room for the entire school
year, beginning with fall term. Once paid this despoit is not
refundable prior to enrollment.
After the student has accepted the offer of admission, the College
will provide the medical history form to be completed and
returned.
Room assignments and matriculation information will be mailed
during the summer.
Transfer Students
College work done at other accredited institutions may be applied
toward a degree or certificate at Golden Valley Lutheran College.
Transfer students are required to follow regular admissions procedure
and submit an official transcript of their record from each college
attended. Credit for the college work done, if satisfactory in quality and
applicable toward the college's divisional degree requirements, will be
accepted toward an Associate in Arts Degree. Golden Valley Lutheran
College will not accept D's in transfer except by special petition
approved by the Scholastic Standing Committee.
Adult Students
An Admissions Counselor for Adult Education provides guidance for
those adults.
-who are deciding to attend college for the first time or
-whose education has been interrupted and who are now planning to
return.
Adult students are counseled concerning entrance requirements,
transfer of credits, financial aid and course planning. For those who apply
and are eligible, scholarship funds are available. Both full-time and
part-time students may apply.
COSTS
19
COSTS
Student Costs 1983-84
The following explains the basic costs to the student and the financial aids that are available to assist the student in meeting these costs.
The College reserves the right to change the costs of tuition, board, room
or fees at any time.
The charges that are made to students for tuition, room and board do
not adequately cover the costs of operating the College. Approximately
35% of the cost of operation must come from gifts and grants. In the
present budget, this amounts to over one million dollars a year.
Therefore, over and above all help given, each student receives the
equivalent of a $2,000 scholarship per year in order to cover the total
expenses of the operation.
The College does not receive direct financial support from any
denomination or Lutheran synod. Gift income is received from congregations, organizations and foundations, and by matching funds from
Lutheran Brotherhood and other corporations.
Most of the funds, however, come as individual gifts from alumni,
parents and friends of the College. Over 600 people are supporting the
College through the INASMUCH program whereby they have pledged
and/or paid from $1,000 to $25,000 over a three year period. As we make
our needs known, the Lord answers our prayers through the gifts of these
many friends.
20
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Charges By Quarter
The College operates on a quarter system vvith three quarteis per
academic year. A student who registers for 12 credits or more is
considered a full-time student; one who registers for less than 12 credits
is considered a part-time student.
Tuition for full-time student ............................. . $1,620.00
Tuition per credit for part-time student .................. .
135.00
Board, room, and telephone (average) ................... .
771.00
Laboratory fees per course
Science courses ...................................... .
12.00
Personal orientation courses ........................... .
12.00
Physical education fees per course
Varsity courses ....................................... .
10.00
Fee for swimming, karate, bowling,
golf, and tennis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.00-26.00
Fee for all other P.E. activity courses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5.00
Humanities 200 fee per credit
For GVLC students currently enrolled .................. .
15.00
For students not currently enrolled at GLVC ............ .
30.00
Music fees
Voice and instrument lessons .......................... .
75.00
Organ rental ......................................... .
14.00
Practice room fee .................................... .
10.00
Intern programs and off campus instruction
Student pays college on mileage basis if college
vehicle is necessary.
Late registration fee .................................... .
20.00
This fee is charged if a student fails to register during the
registration period for any quarter. It is waived only in cases
of illness or family emergencies.
Late payment fee ....................................... .
15.00
This fee is charged to a student who does not pay the
balance on his or her account within two days after classes
begin for the quarter.
Special fees not refundable after 10th day of classes include:
laboratory, personal orientation, physical education, organ
rental, practice room, and music fees for voice and
instrumental lessons.
Miscellaneous fees
Car registration and parking permit per quarter ......... .
5.00
Special examinations .................................. .
5.00
(For each final examination requested at a time other than
the regularly scheduled period)
Transcript fee (first copy free) ......................... .
2.00
Advance tuition deposit for second year students ......... .
100.00
Fall Registration is based upon the order in which the
above payment is received. (Non-refundable).
COSTS
21
Payment Plan
The account of each student is payable at the time of registration and in
accordance with the Full Payment Plan listed in this section.
Students in need of credit must make arrangements with the Business
Office before registration can be completed. When credit is extended, a
finance charge of one and one half percent a month (18% APR) is added.
No student is permitted to register if the account for a preceding
quarter has not been paid in full. Grades cannot be released, transcripts
cannot be forwarded, and degrees cannot be granted until all financial
obligations have been met.
Payment Schedule for 1983-84
On Campus
$ 700.00
700.00
700.00
336.00
$2,436.00
Winter Quarter On Campus
September 28
$ 700.00
October 14
850.00
818.00
November 1
$2,368.00
Spring Quarter On Campus
$ 700.00
December 8
850.00
January 9
818.00
February 1
$2,368.00
Fall Quarter
June 20
July 18
August 19
Registration Day
Off Campus
$ 650.00
650.00
320.00
+ Sp. fees
Sp. fees
$1,620.00
Off Campus
$ 650.00
650.00
+Sp. fees
320.00
$1,620.00
Off Campus
$ 650.00
650.00
320.00
+ Sp. fees
$1,620.00
+Sp. fees
+Sp. fees
Refund Schedule
Student who decide to withdraw from college after they have
registered and paid their tuition will receive a refund computed from the
date the withdraw! form was signed and returned to the Registrar.
Prior to first class meeting .................................. 100%
During first week .......................................... 90%
During second week....................................... 75%
During the third through the fifth week .................... 50%
During sixth week . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25%
After sixth week ...................................... No refund
Room and Board Refunds. If the student leaves school after the sixth
week, there will be no room refund. Through the sixth week, the student
will be charged for the time spent on campus plus a two-week room
charge. Students will be charged for board through the end of the week
in which they leave the campus. If a refund is due the student, a check will
be sent within a reasonable time.
22
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Books and Supplies
Textbooks, art and college supplies may be purchased at the college
bookstore. Stationery, college seals, banners, and other items also are
available for the convenience of students. All purchases must be paid for
in cash. Students should have $75.00 to $125.00 available at the beginning
of the school year for books. Estimated book costs for the entire year are
$225.00 to $325.00.
FINANCIAL AID
23
Fl ANCIAL AID
Golden Valley Lutheran College is concerned about the financial
problems of students. In order to assist students who have inadequate
financial resources, the Director of Financial Aid coordinates a program
of financial aid based on a student's academic achievement, special
abilities, and financial need.
Basically, there are three sources of financial aid:
Federal Government
State of Minnesota
Golden Valley Lutheran College
There are three forms of aid:
Gift Aid
Loans
Student Employment
All types of financial assistance are made for only one academic year.
Students, however, may expect to receive their financial assistance for
the second year if they remain in good academic and personal standing
and if their financial need continues. If a student withdraws during any
quarter, he or she forfeits the entire amount of gift aid that has been
awarded from College funds for that quarter. He or she also forfeits
proportionate amounts of aid awarded from state or federal funds for
that quarter.
24
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Gift Aid
Gift Aid is a categorical name given to all awards from GVLC pi us the Peii
Grant (formerly BEOG), Supplemental Education Opportunity Grant
(SEOG), and the Minnesota State Scholarship/Grant Program (MSS/G).
Such awards do not have to be repaid.
Pell Grant: This grant is provided by the Federal Government based on
financial need. The amount is derived from uniform methodology, using
family and student financial information. All students applying for
financial assistance at GVLC are required to apply for this grant.
Golden Valley Lutheran College President's Scholarship: This scholarship is available to the gifted student who has demonstrated outstanding
leadership in a given field and attained an unusual degree of academic
excellence. A recipient must be ranked in the upper five percent of his or
her high school or college class and be willing to provide leadership in
music, sports, theatre or other college related activities. The President's
Scholarship may be awarded without regard to financial need, but if a
recipient has a demonstrated financial need, the Federal and State
guidelines for financial assistance must be followed. The amount of the
scholarship may vary depending upon circumstances.
Supplemental Educational Opportunity Grant: Awarded by the Federal Government through the College, these funds allow GVLC to make
awards of $200 or more to students who show financial need based on
uniform methodology.
Golden Valley Lutheran College Gift Aid: Includes all awards granted
for scholarship, athletics, Christian service, drama and music as well as
the GVLC financial need grants. These awards are based on demonstrated excellence in specified areas and financial need as defined by the
ACT (American College Testing) Family Financial Statement. The GVLC
Gift Aid awarded to new students is based on their high school
achievement, while the Gift Aid awarded to returning students is based
on participation and achievement while enrolled at GVLC. One-third of
the award is credited to the student's account each quarter.
Minnesota State Scholarship/Grant Program: Available to qualified
Minnesota residents each year depending upon financial need. All
Minnesota residents who apply for financial aid at GVLC are expected to
apply for this aid.
Other Grants: There are a number of grants and scholarships available
from other sources. The student is encouraged to consult his or her high
school counselor and the Director of Financial Aid at GVLC for other
federal, state, and community-sponsored scholarships and grants.
FINANCIAL AID
25
Deferred Payment loans
National Direct Student Loans (NDSL) - Federal NDSL Loans are
available to students who have financial need and have been accepted
for admission to Golden Valley Lutheran College. Repayment and
interest do not begin until nine months after the student completes his or
her studies. The interest rate is 5% (APR), and repayment may be
extended over a ten-year period. Part of the loan is forgiven if the student
enters certain fields of teaching or specified military duty.
Guaranteed Student Loans: The Student may borrow up to $2,500 per
year from a bank and the federal government will pay the interest during
the time the student is in college. The borrower pays the principal and 9%
(APR) interest during the repayment period.
When a bank will not give the loan, the student may borrow up to
$2,500 per year from the Minnesota State Student Loan Program. First
year students are limited to $1,500 per loan, but may apply for a second
loan under the $2,500 limit. The federal government will pay the interest
during the time the student is in college. The borrower pays the principal
and 9% (APR) interest during the repayment period. These loans
are processed through the GVLC Financial Aid Office.
Parent Loan for Undergraduate Students: When necessary an application can be made for a Parent Loan for Undergraduate Students (PLUS).
The parent can apply for up to $3,000 per academic year to be used for
educational expenses. The interest rate on this loan is 12% (APR) and
repayment must begin 60 days after disbursement, with terms to be
worked out with the lender. The Financial Aid Office has a list of private
institutions which are participating in this program. Our list, however, is
incomplete and parents are free to inquire at the lending institution of
their choice.
Lutheran Brotherhood Loan - If a member of the student's family
holds a Lutheran Brotherhood Insurance policy, a student may borrow
up to $2,500 per year from the Lutheran Brotherhood Insurance Society
at the same terms described under Federal Insured Student Loans.
Student Employment
College Work-Study Program - Golden Valley Lutheran College
participates in State and Federal Work-Study Programs. The student's
eligibility depends on his or her financial need and individual skills.
Student Part-time Employment - The College offers a variety of
campus jobs with moderate pay. In addition, there are numerous parttime employment positions available in the Twin Cities and surrounding
suburban areas. The Student Employment Office maintains a listing of
opportunities available.
26
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Procedure for Applying for Financial
A :...J
tቢuu
Any student wishing to apply for financial aid must first make proper
application through the admissions department and be admitted to the
College.
The basic forms used to determine financial aid need are the Famil)"'
Financial Statement (FFS) from ACT, or the Financial Aid Form (FAF) from
CSS. Many qualified students fail to receive financial assistance because
they neglect to get their financial statements submitted on time.
Minnesota residents must file their FFS by April 1, 1983 to be eligible for
priority consideration from the Minnesota State Scholarship/Grant
Program.
As soon as all pertinent information has been assembled, the Financial
Aid Office sends the student an aid package. The student must
accept the aid package within 15 days to be guaranteed the funds.
Students are expected to contribute part of their summer earnings
toward the cost of education. The Federal Government also has
established an amount that each family is expected to contribute to the
educational expenses of a son or daughter.
We believe that Federal and State assistance programs, plus the
financial aid available through Golden ValJey Lutheran College, places
two years of quality college education within the reach of all who desire
it.
Scholarships
The AAL Lutheran American Minority Scholarship Program is available
for any Lutheran American minority person who is a member of a
Lutheran church, or is an immigrant who has been sponsored by a
Lutheran organization and is attending Golden Valley Lutheran College.
In any case, the recipient must be a member of a Lutheran church.
Scholarships range from $200 to $1,000 and can be renewed each year.
The A.Al Lutheran Campus Scholarship Program is for students who
hold a certificate of membership and insurance from the Aid Association
for Lutherans. The awards are based on academic achievement, Christian
character and professional promise.
The Berean Scholarship is given annually by the Bereans, an organization composed of the wives of the faculty and staff members at the
College.
FINANCIAL AID
27
The David Bjelland Memorial Scholarship is given by Mrs. David
Bjelland because of her late husband's keen interest in Bible study and
the training of lay people for service to the Lord.
The Ronald Chagnon II Memorial Scholarship has been established by
Mr. and Mrs. Ronald Chagnon, Sr. in memory of their son Ron who was a
student at Golden Valley Lutheran College. This scholarship is for
assisting handicapped students.
The Wilson Fagerberg Memorial Scholarship has been established in
memory of Pastor Wilson Fagerberg, a long time faculty member in
the Department of Biblical Studies at Golden Valley Lutheran College.
The Gjernes Scholarship is provided annually through the Martha
Gjernes Estate.
The James Robert and John William Gustafson Scholarship has been
established by Mrs. Thora Tofte in memory of her husband and son. It is
awarded to a student interested in Christian service, ministry, missionary
work or Bible study.
The Haaland Scholarship has been established by Mrs. 0. T. Haaland to
be awarded to a student interested in a career of Christian service.
The Jackson Scholarship is given by Mrs. Eddie Jackson and the late Mr.
Jackson in recognition of their keen interest in Bible study and the
training of lay people for service to the Lord.
The Gunnar I. Johnson Memorial Scholarship has been established by
the Johnson family in memory of Mr. Johnson who was the contractor
for the construction of the Golden Valley Lutheran College Campus,
1961-1977.
The M. T. !..illehaugen Memorial Scholarship is in memory of the late
Mr. Lillehaugen who was a good friend and supporter of the College.
It is to be used to "help defray the expenses for some good student
going into church work, a person with a Christian commitment and one
who indicates a good Christian example."
The Logefeil Memorial Scholarship is given by Mrs. Logefeil and the
late Dr. R. C. Logefeil who was the school doctor at one time. The
scholarship is to be used to aid a worthy student preparing for the
ministry, missionary or some full-time service in the Lord's work.
The Lutheran Brotherhood Junior College Scholarship is awarded on
the basis of scholastic achievement and religious leadership.
The Lutheran Brotherhood Graduate Award for junior and senior
years at a Lutheran College is awarded to a sophomore student planning
to transfer to a four-year Lutheran college.
The Mai Scholarship is an annual scholarship from Mr. and Mrs. Arthur
Mai, former students, as an expression of appreciation for what this
school has meant to them.
The Richard Meh1ig Memorial Scholarship has been established in
memory of Ricky Melvig who had wanted to become a doctor but didn't
live to realize his dream. It is given to a returning student who exhibits
faith, character, and an interest in the sciences.
The Nelson Mission Scholarship has been established by Dr. and Mrs.
Russell E. Nelson to be awarded each year to a worthy student who has
chosen to prepare for full-time work in the area of mission. Dr. Nelson
was a faculty member and director of mission at the College.
28
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
The Pihl Scholarship has been established by Mr. and Mrs. Charles R.
Pihl. Mr. Pihl served as chairman and member of the Board of Regents
of the College.
The Ponwith Scholarship has been provided by Miss Sadie Ponwith, a
former student, teacher, and librarian, and her sister, the late Miss Alice
Ponwith, also a former student and staff member. It is awarded to
students showing evidence of Christian character, leadership, and
scholarship.
The Sampson Memorial Scholarship is given in memory of August
Sampson, father of Mrs. Russell B. Helgesen, the wife of our Development Director.
The Savik Memorial Scholarship has been established by the family of
the late Oscar Savik, who was a member of the Board of Regents of the
College and advisor to the President.
The Tang Scholarship is provided by Dr. Christopher Tang, a former
faculty member, and Mrs. Tang in memory of their parents, Mr. and Mrs.
Han Ching Tang and Mr. and Mrs. Zi Hui Chang.
The Tang Church History Scholarship is given by Dr. and Mrs.
Christopher Tang in honor of Anna C. Tang and is intended for a student
who has shown excellence in church history courses.
The Manda Twete Scholarship has been provided by Miss Manda
Twete, a friend of the College. It is awarded to a student on the basis of
Christian character and demonstrated need.
The Mary D. Wagner Scholarship Fund has been established by Mrs.
Wagner for needy and worthy students who are particularly interested in
the study of the Bible.
ACADEMIC PROGRAM
29
ACADEMIC PROGRAM
Golden Valley Lutheran College grants three types of two-year
completion awards: the Associate in Arts Degree (Liberal Arts and
Transfer Program), the Associate in Arts Degree (Specialized Program),
and the Junior College Certificate. A one-year Vocational Certificate is
awarded for completion of a selected one-year vocational curriculum.
Golden Valley Lutheran College is a liberal arts institution which allows
a student to concentrate in the areas of general education, Biblical and
theological studies, or a specific vocation.
Students who plan to earn a four-year degree are encouraged to satisfy
general education requirements while attending Golden Valley Lutheran
College. When this suggestion is followed, students may concentrate on
their major and other requirements during the last two years of college.
General education courses invite the student to learn about the world,
the scientific method, the society in which he or she lives, the fine arts
and humanities, and the eternal values perceived in Biblical and
theological studies.
General Academic Information
Credit load and Student Classification
A normal credit load consists of 16 hours per quarter. Exceptions to this
credit load will be considered in consultation with a student's academic
advisor. Permission to take more than 18 credits must be granted by the
Academic Dean. Individuals enrolled for 12 or more credit-hours per
quarter are considered full time students. Individuals with less than 12
credit-hours are considered part-time students. A student who has
earned less than 45 cumulative credits is classified as a freshman. A
student who has earned 45 or more cumulative credits is classified as a
sophomore.
The auditing of courses is not encouraged since classroom capacities
are needed by students interested in earning college credit. Auditors are
required to do all work assigned by the instructor and tuition costs are the
same as costs for credit.
30
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Grading and Honor Point System
A student's grade point average is computed at the end of each
quarter. The grade point average is determined by dividing the number
of earned honor points by the number of earned credits. Honor points
are computed by the following scale:
Honor Points
Per Credit
Grade
Superior
4
for A.A. Degree
A
Above Average
3
for A.A. Degree
B
2
for A.A. Degree
c Average
Below Average
1
for A.A. Degree
D
Failure
F
0
for A.A. Degree
I
W
WF
s
u
Incomplete*
Withdrawn**
Withdrawn, failing**
Satisfactory***
Unsatisfactory***
2
for J.C.C. only
*Incomplete work, must be made up satisfactorily by the end of the
fourth week of the next term the student attends. If a student desires an
extension beyond four weeks, he or she must secure approval of the
instructor involved and must petition the Scholastic Standing Committee
for the extension. If the work is not completed, the grade becomes an F.
**Withdrawals after the third week of classes and through mid-term
are indicated by W or WF (to be determined by the instructor); and after
the mid-term and until the last regularly scheduled class day of each
quarter by a W, WF, or Fas determined by the instructor. A student may
not drop a course after final examinations begin.
***The grading system of Sand U is used only for those courses which
are taken to meet the requirements of the Junior College Certificate. An
S counts as two honor points per credit for the Junior College Certificate
only and will not be credited toward an Associate in Arts Degree. The U
grade yields no honor points or credits.
Academic Honors
An Honors List composed of those students who have earned a grade
point average of 3.00-3.49 is compiled at the end of each term. Those
students who achieve a grade point average of 3.50 or better are included
on the Dean's List.
ACADEMIC PROGRAM
31
Academic Progress
In accordance with policies established by the administration and
faculty, a student will be counseled in relation to academic progress
toward the Associate in Arts degree: (a) when a student's grade point
average is less than 2.00; (b) when his or her transcript shows two or more
grades of I (Incomplete) in one quarter. If a student's grade point average
falls below 1.50 he or she will be placed on academic probation until the
grade point average is raised to 1.50 or above. The College reserves the
right to dismiss a student if his or her academic performance is regarded
as unsatisfactory.
Eligibility for Varsity Sports
Eligibility rules for participation in varsity sports at Golden Valley
Lutheran College conform to the National Junior College Athletic
Association eligibility rules. In general, in order to participate in a varsity
sport, a student must be a full-time (12 credits) student during the
qualifying and competing quarter. During the qualifying quarter, he or
she must earn a grade point average of 1.5 or better in at least 10 hours of
course work listed in the College Catalog. Freshmen enrolled at GVLC in
their first quarter of college are exempt from the qualifying quarter
requirements. A student's eligibility is reviewed each quarter and all
hours of a complete course (subject) must be counted in computing a
student's grade point average. (See NJCAA Eligibility Rules.)
No student shall be certified on an eligibility list until the College has
received the final transcript indicating the high school graduation date
and any college transcript(s), if another college has been previously
attended. The responsibility to obtain any such transcripts rests upon the
individual student.
Credit by Spedal Examination
Under special circumstances, a student may seek to gain credits or
exemption by special examination, in accordance with specific departmental policies.
Transfer Students
The actual number of credits earned at other institutions are entered
on the student's record, but transferred credits and grade points are not
included in the computation of the grade point average.
Class Attendance
Each student is responsible for regular class attendence and for
completing work as required in each class. With respect to unexcused
absences, excused absences, or make-up work, it is the student's
responsibi I ity to learn the policy of each instructor. The instructor's
policy is usually stated in the course outline. At the discretion of the
instructor, a student may be withdrawn from a course for an excessive
number of unexcused absences or uncompleted assignments.
32
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Independent Study
A maximum of six credits in Independent Study may be applied toward
the Associate in Arts Degree. The student must meet the criteria
established by the department and have the approval of the chairperson of
the department in which he plans to do the study. Standards require a 3.0
average in the department in which Independent Study is taken, a limit of
four credits per term in Independent Study, and a demonstration of
relevance to the student's academic objectives. Independent Study
applications are available in the Registrar's Office.
Bible and English Requirements
All students enrolled for eight credits or more are required to take at
least one Bible course each quarter that they attend classes at the
College. A student who transfers from another college is not required to
complete the full 18 credits in Bible but is required to take one course
each quarter while enrolled at the College. All Bible core courses listed in
the Department of Biblical Studies will satisfy this requirement.
All degree seeking students are required to register for English until
the sequence, English 111and112 - College Composition, and English
113 - Introduction to Literature, has been completed. Placement in
English 100, 110, or 111 will be determined by specific English Placement
tests administered to all new students during student orientation in the
fall, or at the time of their registration for winter or for spring quarters.
Co-Curricular Activity Credits
A total of nine credits in co-curricular activities may be applied toward
an Associate in Arts Degree. The three credits of required physical
education are not included in this category. Co-curricular activities
include all music ensembles, Theatre Practice, Christian Service, additional physical education activity courses after the three required courses
are completed, and activity credits that a transfer student might bring to
the College.
With regard to co-curricular activities other than varsity sports, a
student who earns a grade point average of less than 1.5 for a quarter
may have co-curricular activities curtailed or programs of study reduced,
at the discretion of the Scholastic Standing Committee.
Orientation and Registration
All students must report to the College for Orientation Days as
indicated in the calendar in this catalog.
The orientation period includes a series of placement and personality
tests which are used to provide a more effective placement and
counseling service for students. Both new and returning students are
required to register on the days indicated in the calendar.
Registration is not completed until the student has made settlement for
the quarter charges at the Bookkeeping Office.
ACADEMIC PROGRAM
33
Changes in Registration
Necessary changes to eliminate conflicts and to correct evident
mistakes in registration may be permitted during the first ten days of
classes, with the written approval of the academic advisor. A Change of
Course Permit for this purpose may be obtained in the Registrar's Office.
After the tenth day, no regularly scheduled classes may be added except
by special permission.
Repeating a Course
A student may repeat only courses in which a grade of Dor F has been
received. The intention to repeat a course must be certified at the time of
registration for the course. If a student repeats a course in which a Dor F
grade has been received, only the more recent grade and credit earned
will be included in the computation of the grade point average. Both
grades, however, will remain on the student's permanent record.
Withdrawals from the College
A student who wishes to withdraw from the College during any term,
must make application for this action in the Office of the Registrar.
Failure to comply with this regulation may deprive a student of refund
privileges and result in an F grade in all classes. Partial refunds on fees
already paid will be based on the date the application was signed and
returned to the Registrar's Office.
GRADUATION REQUIREMENTS
35
GRADUATION
REQUIREMENTS
The responsibility rests with the student for seeing that his or her
program includes all requirements for graduation.
Applicants for admission should study the requirements for graduation outlined in this section of the catalog and plan their college
program as a whole as early as possible. A student who is in doubt about
how certain requirements are interpreted should consult with his or her
academic advisor, the Registrar, or the Academic Dean. When circumstances might warrant a justifiable modification in a requirement, a
petition (obtained from the Registrar) should be submitted to the
Committee on Academic Affairs.
36
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Associate in Arts Degree:
liberal Arts and Transfer Program
This program is designed for students who intend to gain a general
knowledge of the arts and sciences and who intend to transfer to a fouryear college or university for completion of a Bachelor's Degree. A
student receiving this degree must be in residence three terms, one of
which must be the term in which the student graduates. The requirements of this degree are:
1. Completion of the divisional requirement as outlined below. The
further requirements in a selected curriculum are recommended
and the student should attempt to fulfill them.
2. Completion of 92 credits with a minimum cumulative grade point
average of 2.00 (C average).
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
DIVISIONAL
REQUIREMENTS
Biblical and Theological
Studies
Communications
Social Science
Natural Science
CREDIT
HOURS
COURSES
18
Bible Core or alternatives
9
12
8-12
Creative Arts
6
Physical Education
3
English 111, 112, 113
Business 200, 210 and all Social
Science courses except History
102, Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation and Social Service
courses
All Natural Science courses except
Mathematics 100, 101
All Creative Arts courses except
Applied Music, Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education activity courses. (One
credit only per varsity sport)
GRADUATION REQUIREMENTS
37
Associate in Arts Degree:
Specialized Program
This program is designed for students who intend to seek employment
after two years of college or for those who intend to pursue an education
of a specialized nature. A student receiving this degree must be in
residence three terms, one of which must be the term in which the
student graduates. The requirements for this degree are:
1. Completion of the divisional requirements as outlined below plus
the additional requirements of a selected curriculum.
2. Completion of 92 credits with a minimum cumulative grade point
average of 2.00 (C average).
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
DIVISIONAL
REQUIREMENTS
Biblical and Theological
Studies
Communications
Social Science
CREDIT
HOURS
COURSES
18
Bible Core or alternatives
9
6
Natural Science
4
Creative Arts
3
Physical Education
3
English 111, 112, 113
All Social Science courses except
History 102, Humanities 200, Personal Orientation or Social Service courses
All Natural Science courses except
Mathematics 100, 101
All Creative Arts courses except
Applied Music, Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education activity courses. (One credit
only per varsity sport)
38
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
The Junior College Certificate
This certificate vvill be avvarded to those students who cornplete two
years of work on a curriculum but do not satisfy the requirements for an
Associate in Arts Degree. The requirements for the Junior College
Certificate are:
1. Completion of a minimum of 88 credits including one Bible
Course or alternative per term.
2. A minimum cumulative grade point average of 1.00.
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
The One-Year Vocational Certificate
This certificate will be awarded to those students who fulfill the
following requirements:
1. Completion of 46 credits (including one Bible Course or alternative per quarter) with a minimum cumulative grade point average of
2.00 (C average).
2. Completion of the requirements of a selected curriculum.
3. The approval of the faculty.
4. Fulfillment of all financial obligations to the College.
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
39
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
Details of the curricula listed below are outlined on the pages which
follow. The student should select a curriculum and be familiar with its
requirements before registration. The College reserves the right to
change curriculum requirements when the necessity arises.
A.
Curricula leading to the Associate in Arts Degree: Liberal Arts and
Transfer Program
1. Basic Liberal Arts
2. Basic Science
3. Liberal Arts with Concentration in Biblical and Theological
Studies
4. Liberal Arts with Concentration in Business Administration
5. Pre-Professional Programs
a. Education (Elementary Education, Secondary Education,
Special Education)
b. Physical Education
c. Music (Pre-Bachelor of Arts)
d. Recreation Leadership
e. Classics
f. Law
g. Agriculture
h. Forestry
i.
Pharmacy
j. Medicine
k. Dentistry
I. Nursing
m. Corrective Therapy
n. Occupational Therapy
o. Physical Therapy
B. Curricula leading to the Associate in Arts Degree: Specialized
Program
1. Social Service
2. Music (pre-Bachelor of Music)
3. Law Enforcement
4. Computer Training and Electronics Technician
5. General Secretarial
6. Legal Secretarial
7. Medical Secretarial
8. Office Administration
9. Parish Secretarial
10. Church Staff Work
11. World Mission
C. Curricula leading to the One-Year Vocational Certificate
1. General Secretarial
2. Legal Secretarial
3. Medical Secretarial
4. Office Administration
5. World Mission
40
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
A. Curricula leading to The Assodate in Arts Degree:
Liberal Arts and Transfer Program
1. BASIC LIBERAL ARTS This curriculum is recommended for those planning
to transfer to a university or four-year college. The courses listed below fulfill
the normal two-year general education requirements for the Bachelor of Arts
Degree. Since many colleges require one or two years of foreign language or
variations of work in some of the fields, the student and his or her advisor will
make the relevant selections in relation to the student's future plans and the
school to which a transfer is planned. Completion of this curriculum leads to
the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Social Science
Natural Science
Creative Arts
18
9
3
12
8-12
6
Physical Education
3
Foreign Language
Electives
0-15
14-33
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Business 200, 210 and all Social Science
courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal Orientation
or Social Service courses.
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
See department listings
Courses in special field of interest
2. BASIC SCIENCE This curriculum is recommended for those planning to
transfer to a university or four-year college for degrees in science or
technology. The student, with the aid of his or her advisor, will make the
relevant course selections in relation to his or her future plans and the school
to which a transfer is planned. Completion of this curriculum leads to the
Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Social Science
18
9
3
12
Natural Science
41-51
Creative Arts
6
Physical Education
3
Foreign Language
0-12
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Business 200, 210 and all Social Science
courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal Orientation
or Social Service courses.
Selections from Mathematics (except
100, 101), Biology, Chemistry, and
Physics
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
German 101, 102, 103 recommended
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
41
3. LIBERAL ARTS WITH CONCENTRATION IN BIBLICAL AND THEOLOGICAL
STUDIES This curriculum is recommended for those who want to combine
their general studies in the liberal arts and sciences with a more extensive
program of Biblical and theological studies. The Bible core sequence may be
supplemented by more extensive offerings in the study of the Bible,
Theology, and Applied Christianity. Completion of this curriculum leads to
the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Social Science
Natural Science
Creative Arts
27-36
9
3
15
8-12
6
Physical Education
3
Foreign Language
Electives
0-15
0-21
Bible Core or alternatives, Theology
121, 122, 123; selections from New
Testament
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Business 200, 210 and all Social Science
courses except history 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation or Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Greek 101, 102, 103 recommended
See department listings
4. BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION This curriculum offers courses to satisfy
requirements for two years of a four-year degree program. Admissions
requirements for junior-year status at four-year institutions vary. Students
should be guided by the program requirements of the universities to which
they plan to transfer. Advisors will assist in planning a program that will meet
the four year college's lower division requirements. Completion of this
curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Natural Science
18
9
3
8-22
Social Science
12
Creative Arts
6
Physical Education
3
Business Administration
Required Courses
Business Administration
Electives
General Electives
21
0-16
0-12
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 required
All courses except Mathematics 100
or 101; Mathematics 102, 110, 120,
200, 201, Biology 111, 112, 113
recommended
Business 200 & 210 required; Sociology
100, Psychology 202-203
recommended
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Business 101, 102, 103, 120, 150, 160
Business 110, 140, 170, 230, 270
recommended (Electives in Business
Administration should be selected
after consulting the four-year
college's requirements)
See department listings
42
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
5. LIBERAL ARTS CURRICULA FOR STUDENTS INTERESTED IN SPECIFIC
PROFESSIONS
a. Education Students planning to teach on the elementary or secondary
level will need a minimum four-year program in the Liberal Arts or Sciences
and the teacher education courses required for a certificate. The curricula
outlined below fulfill requirements for a Minnesota certificate for the first
two years. Completion or any one of these curricula leads to the Associate in
Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Elementary Education
The Basic Liberal Arts Curriculum and including:
Geography 100
Biology 113
History 201, 202, 203
Physical Education 120, 130
Private lessons in piano and voice are
Psychology 202, 203, 210
recommended
Secondary Education
The Basic Liberal Arts Curriculum and including:
Psychology 202, 203, 210
Sociology 110, 210, 212
Physical Education 120, 130
Emphasis on a special field of interest
Special Education
The Basic Liberal Arts Curriculum and including:
Psychology 202, 203, 210
Sociology 110, 210, 212
Physical Education 120, 130
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
43
b. Physical Education A four-year degree is required to teach physical
education. The first two years of this program may be taken at Golden Valley
Lutheran College. The curriculum outlined below will earn the Associate in
Arts Degree and provides the necessary prerequisites leading to the
Minnesota teaching certificate.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
Bible Core or alternatives
English
9
English 111, 112, 113
Social Science
15
History 121, 122, 123, 201, 203, or
Sociology 100, 110, 210 or Psychology
202, 203 recommended
16
Biology 111, 112, 232, 233
Natural Science
17
Physical Education 110, 120, 130, 200,
Physical Education
210 and including three one credit
Physical Education activity courses
6
All courses except Applied Music,
Creative Arts
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Electives
11
See department listings
c. Music The following curriculum may be used toward fulfillment of the
lower division requirements for the Bachelor of Arts Degree with concentration in music. Completion of the curriculum below leads to an
Associate in Arts Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
Bible Core or alternatives
English
9
English 111, 112, 113
Social Science
12
History 121, 122, 123 recommended
Natural Science
8-12
Selections from Biology or Mathematics
(except Mathematics 100, 101)
3
Three one credit Physical Education
Physical Education
activity courses
36
Music 111, 112, 113, 211, 212, 213;
Creative Arts
Applied Music - 6 credits,
Ensembles - 6 credits
2-6
See department listings
Electives
d. Recreation Leadership A program designed for persons desiring a
career in recreation leadership or related recreation fields. The program
leads to the Associate in Arts Degree and is transferable to many four-year
recreation programs.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
Bible Core or alternatives
9
English 111, 112, 113
English
Speech
3
Speech 100 or 130
Social Science
12
Sociology 100, 110, 212 or Psychology
202, 203 recommended
8-12
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
Natural Science
Physical Education 110, 120, 200, 210 and
Physical Education
15
including three one credit Physical
Education activity courses
15
Recreation Leadership 110, 120, 210,
Recreation Leadership
220, 230
6
All courses except Applied Music,
Crea'tive Arts
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
2-6
See department listings
Electives
44
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
The College has established specific preliminary training for students
desiring entrance into certain professions. Students interested in these
professions should consult the appropriate college catalogs and discuss
plans with their faculty advisor, and the Registrar to insure proper course
selection. Completion of one of the following curricula leads to an Associate
in Arts Degree and satisfies the basic requirements for the first two years of
the particular professional program.
e. Classics
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
f. law
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
g. Agriculture
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
h. Forestry
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
i. Pharmacy
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
j. Medicine
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
k. Dentistry
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
English 221
History 111, 112
Anthropology 100
Greek 101, 102, 103, 300
German 101, 102, 103 Recommended
Speech 100, 120
History 201, 202, 203
Political Science 100, 200
Psychology 202, 203
Sociology 110, 210, 212
Business 200, 210, 230
Speech 100 or 120
History 201, 202, 203
Geography 100
Mathematics 102, 103
Biology 111, 112, 113
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Business 200, 210
Mathematics 102, 103, 110, 200
Biology 111, 112, 121, 222, 223
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Physics 102
Business 200, 210
Mathematics 102, 103
Biology 111, 112, 113, 231
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Mathematics 102, 103, 201
Biology 111, 112, 113
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Physics 102, 103
One year of foreign language when
necessary
Mathematics 102, 103
Biology 111, 112, 113
Chemistry 101, 102, 103
Physics 102, 103
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
I. Nursing
The Basic Science
Curriculum and including:
m. Corrective Therapy
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
n. Occupational Therapy
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
o. Physical Therapy
The Basic Liberal Arts
Curriculum and including:
45
Psychology 202
Sociology 100 or 110
Biology 111, 232, 233
Chemistry 101, 102
Physics 102
German 101, 102, 103 Recommended
Speech 100 or 120
Psychology 202, 203
Biology 111, 232, 233
Physical Education 120, 130, 200, 210
Speech 100 or 120
Psychology 202, 203, 210
Biology 111, 112, 232, 233
Chemistry 101, 102
Physical Education 120, 130
Speech 100 or 120
Mathematics 102
Physics 102, 103
Biology 111, 112, 232, 233
Physical Education 120, 130
Psychology 120 or 210
Chemistry 101, 102, 103 recommended
46
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
B. Curricula Leading to The Associate in Arts Degree:
Specialized Program
1. SOCIAL SERVICE This program is designed to train the student to assist the
professional Social Service Worker in areas of reception, group care, case
work, teacher assistance, recreation, therapy and rehabilitation. Completion
of this curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree. The program is
designed for students who wish to find employment after two years in
college.
Required Coursers and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Speech
3
Social Science
27-36
Natural Science
Creative Arts
4
3
Physical Education
3
Electives
16-25
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 120 required; Speech 150
recommended
Psychology 202, 203, 210; Sociology
100, 110, 120; Social Service 101, 102,
103 (Social Service 201, 202, 203
recommended)
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Physical Education 120, 130, Recreation
Leadership 220, Sociology 210
recommended
2. MUSIC (Pre-Bachelor of Music) The following curriculum may be used
toward fulfillment of the lower-division requirements for the Bachelor of
Music Degree. Completion of the curriculum below leads to an Associate in
Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Social Science
6-9
Natural Science
4
Physical Education
3
Creative Arts
Electives
51
0-1
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
History 121, 122, 123 recommended
Biology 113 recommended
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Music 111, 112, 113, 121, 122, 123, 131,
132, 133, 211, 212, 213; Applied Music
-6 credits; Ensembles - 6 credits
See department listings
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
47
3. LAW ENFORCEMENT The following curriculum, combining courses in
Biblical studies, the liberal arts and law enforcement, leads to the Associate in
Arts Degree and provides a foundation for a career in law enforcement.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Speech
Social Science
18
9
3
12
Natural Science
Physical Education
4
6
Creative Arts
3
Law Enforcement
23
Electives
14
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 120
Political Science 100, Psychology 120,
Sociology 100, 110, 120, 210 or 212
recommended
Biology 113 recommended
Physical Education 120 and including
three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Law Enforcement 100, 110, 120, 130,
150, 160, 170, 180
See department listings
4. COMPUTER TRAINING OR ELECTRONIC TECHNICIAN Cooperative
educational programs are available between Golden Valley Lutheran College
and Control Data Corporation for training as computer technicians and
programmers, and between GVLC and Northwestern Electronics Institute
for training in the field of Electronics Technician. Students spend at least one
academic year at the College and complete a specified course with Control
Data or Northwestern Electronics. A maximum of 45 credits from these
institutions will be accepted toward the Associate in Arts Degree. Completion
of the entire curriculum leads to the AA Degree.
Required and Recommended Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Social Science
Natural Science
Physical Education
Creative Arts
Electives
9-12
9
6
10-15
3
3
0-21
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 13
History 123, Sociology 100, 110 or 120
recommended
Mathematics 102, 103, Physics 102, 103
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Art 100, Music 100 or Theatre 100
recommended
See department listings
48
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
5. GENERAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this two-year curriculum, combining instruction in Biblical studies, the liberal arts and secretarial skills,
leads to the Associate in Arts Degree and prepares the student for a career as
a general secretary.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Social Science
18
9
6
Natural Science
Physical Education
4
3
Creative Arts
3
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
38-48
1-11
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation or Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Business (110 or 160), 120, 150;
Secretarial Science 102, 103, 110, 112,
113, 123, 203, 211, 213 (Business 140,
Secretarial Science 101, 111 may be
required depending on background
of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
6. LEGAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this two-year curriculum, combining
courses in Biblical studies, the liberal arts and legal secretarial training, leads
to the Associate in Arts Degree and prepares the student for a career as a
legal secretary.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Social Science
18
9
6
Natural Science
Creative Arts
4
3
Physical Education
3
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
42-52
0-7
Bible Core or alterantives
English 111, 112, 113
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation or Social Service
courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre, 120, 140
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
Business 150, 230; Secretarial Science
102, 103, 110, 112, 113, 123, 203, 213
231, 232, 233. (Business 140,
Secretarial Science 101, 111 may be
required depending on background
of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
49
7. MEDICAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this two-year curriculum, combining courses in Biblical studies, the liberal arts and medical secretarial
training, leads to the Associate in Arts Degree and prepares the student for a
career as a medical secretary.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
English
Social Science
Natural Science
Physical Education
Creative Arts
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
18
9
6
8-12
3
3
38-48
0-7
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation or Social Service courses
Biology 111, 232
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Business 150; Secretarial Science 102,
103, 110, 112, 113, 123, 203, 213, 221
222, 223 (Business 140, Secretarial
Science 101, 111 may be required
depending on background of the
student
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
50
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
8. OFFICE ADMINISTRATION This two-year curriculum offers a variety of
business administration and office skills courses for the student interested in
an entry-level business position. Completion of this curriculum leads to the
Associate in Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Social Science
6-12
Natural Science
Physical Education
Creative Arts
4-8
3
3
Business
Ad ministration
14-20
Business/
Secretarial Science
Electives
General Electives
19-35
0-16
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation or Social Service courses
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Business 101, 102, 120, 150. (Business
140, Secretarial Science 101, 111 may
be required depending on
background of the student)
Selections from Business and
Secretarial Science courses
See department listings
9. PARISH SECRETARIAL Completion of this curriculum, which combines
training in Biblical studies, secretarial skills and liberal arts, prepares
the student for the position of Parish Secretary, and leads to the Associate in
Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
18
English
9
Social Science
6
Natural Science
Physical Education
4
3
Creative Arts
3
Business/Secretarial
· Science
32-42
Applied Christianity
16
Electives
0-1
Bible Core or alternatives
English 111, 112, 113
Courses in Psychology or Sociology,
including Psychology 120
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Business 150; Secretarial Science 102,
103, 110, 112, 113, 123, 203, 211, 213
(Business 140, Secretarial Science
101, 111 may be required depending
on background of the student)
Applied Christianity 122, 123, 130, 140,
221, 230
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
51
10. CHURCH STAFF WORK The following curriculum provides training for
the responsibilities of a church staff worker. The responsibilities that may be
assigned to a church staff worker often fall into the following general
categories: parish education, youth work, visitation, and parish secretary.
Completion of this curriculum leads to an Associate in Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
Theology and Church
History
English
Speech
Social Science
Natural Science
Physical Education
Creative Arts
Secretarial Science
Applied Christianity
Electives
18
9
9
3
6
4
3
3
3-9
25-27
1-9
Bible Core or alternatives
Theology 121, 122, 123; Church History
200
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 140
Psychology 120, Sociology 120
Biology 113 recommended
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Secretarial Science 102 (101, 103 may be
required depending on course
background of student)
Applied Christianity 122, 123, 130, 140,
201, 20~ 203, 211, 221, 223, 230
Sociology and Psychology courses
recommended
11. WORLD MISSION Current trends indicate that the Church's need is for
candidates with bachelor's degrees or with training in specialized fields such
as Bible and theology, medicine, education, business, agriculture, electronics,
aviation or secretarial skills. Interested students should plan for extended
and thorough preparation. The curriculum outlined below combines
concentrated Bible study, a liberal arts background, an introduction to the
missionary task, and opportunities for a variety of contacts with people
directly involved in church work in various parts of the world. Completion of
the two-year curriculum leads to the Associate in Arts Degree.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
Theology
English
Speech
Social Science
Natural Science
Physical Education
Creative Arts
Christian Service
Applied Christianity
World Mission
Electives
18
6
9
3
12
8-12
3
3
2
9
6
0-13
Bible Core or alternatives
Theology 121, 122, 123
English 111, 112, 113
Speech 100 or 110 or 200
All courses except History 102,
Humanities 200, Personal
Orientation or Social Service courses
Biology 113 recommended
Three one credit Physical Education
activity courses
All courses except Applied Music,
Ensembles, Theatre 120, 140
Christian Service 110
All Applied Christianity courses
Mission 100, 110, 120
See department listings
52
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
C. Curricula leading to the One-Year Vocational Certificate
1. GENERAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this one-year curriculum, com-
bining instruction in secretarial skills and Biblical studies, leads to a
Vocational Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Physical Education
1
Busi n ess/Secreta ria I
Science
Electives
33-40
0-3
Bible Core or alternatives
A one credit Physical Education
activity course
Business (110 or 160), 150; Secretarial
Science 102, 103, 110, 112, 113, 123,
203, 211 (Business 140, Secretarial
Science 111 may be required
depending on background
of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
Students entering the One-Year General Secretarial Program must have
completed one year of high school typing. Business 150 substitutes for
college composition. Students, however, must take English 100 and/or
English 110 if test results indicate need.
2. LEGAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this one-year curriculum, combining
Biblical studies and legal secretarial courses, leads to a Vocational Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Physical Education
1
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
32-39
0-4
Bible Core or alternatives
A one credit Physical Education activity
course
Business 150, 230; Secretarial Science
110, 112, 113, 123, 203, 232, 233
(Business 140, Secretarial
Science 111 may be required
depending on background
of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
Students entering the One-year Legal Secretarial Program must have
completed one year of high school typing. Business 150 substitutes for
college composition. Students, however, must take English 100 and/or
English 110 if test results indicate need.
PROGRAMS OF STUDY
53
3. MEDICAL SECRETARIAL Completion of this one-year curriculum, combininng Biblical studies and medical secretarial courses, leads to a Vocational
Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Natural Science
4
Physical Education
Business/Secretarial
Science
Electives
1
28-35
0-4
Bible Core or alternatives
All courses except Mathematics 100, 101
A one credit Physical Education activity
course
Business 150; Secretarial Science 110,
112, 113, 123, 203, 221, 222, 223
(Business 140, Secretarial Science 111
may be required depending on
background of the student)
Secretarial Science 220 recommended
Students entering the One-year Medical Secretarial Program must have
completed one year of high school typing. Business 150 substitutes for
college composition. Students, however, must take English 100 and/or
English 110 if test results indicate need.
4. OFFICE ADMINISTRATION Completion of this one-year curriculum,
combining Biblical studies and office administration courses, leads to a
Vocational Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
Physical Education
9
1
Business/Secretarial
Science
10-16
Business/Secretarial
Science electives
Electives
20
0-6
Bible Core or alternatives
A one credit Physical Education
activity course
Business 150, Secretarial Science 110,
123 (Business 140, Secretarial Science
101 may be required depending
on background of the student)
Selections from Business and
Secretarial Science courses
See department listings
Business 150 substitutes for college composition. Students, however, must
take English 100 and/or English 110 if test results indicate need.
5. WORLD MISSION Completion of the one-year curriculum leads to a
Vocational Certificate.
Required Courses and Credits
Biblical Studies
9
Theology and Church
History
English
Social Science
9
6
9
Physical Education
Christian Service
Applied Christianity
World Mission
Electives
1-2
6-12
6
0-5
Selected from N.T. 101, 103, 110, 120,
130, 140
Theology 121, 122, 123; Church History
200
English 111, 112
Philosophy 211, 212 or 213; Political
Science 200 or Anthropology
100 or 110
A one credit Physical Education
activity course
Christian Service 110
Applied Christianity 130, 140, 150, 211
Mission 100, 110, 120, 200
See department listings
55
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
The descriptions of courses are arranged according to divisions. The
course numbering system is as follows: The first digit of the course
number indicates (1) freshman course, (2) sophomore course, or (3)
special course for advanced students. The second digit indicates the
standing of the course within the Department. The third digit indicates
the term in which the course is offered - (1) fall quarter, (2) winter
quarter, (3) spring quarter, and (0) flexible scheduling.
The College reserves the right to cancel classes with inadequate
enrollment or to change course offerings when the necessity arises.
I.
DIVISION OF BIBLICAL AND THEOLOGICAL STUDIES
A sequence of Biblical courses has been established to provide maximum
coverage of Biblical concepts by students taking the minimum Bible requirement.
The Bible Core courses are:
N.T. 101, 103, 110, 120, 130, 140, 202, 203
O.T. 102, 201
Greek 101, 102, 103
History 102
English 230
The Bible Core Sequence is as follows:
FRESHMEN
N.T. 101 or 120
Fall Quarter
O.T. 102 or N.T. 140
Winter Quarter
or History 102
N.T. 103 or 110 or 130
Spring Quarter
SOPHOMORES
O.T. 201
N.T. 202
N.T. 203 or English 230
A student may substitute Greek 101, 102, 103 for 9 credits of re qui red Bible Core
courses.
DEPARTMENT OF BIBLICAL STUDIES
O.T. 102 Covenant History of the Old Testament
3 credits
The covenant purposes and acts of God as they appear in the historical record of
God's people in the Old Testament, with some reference to the continuation and
fulfillment of the covenant promise in the New Testament, especially the Gospel
of John. Student may not receive credit for both O.T. 102 and History 102.
O.T. 201 Isaiah-Jeremiah
3 credits
An historical survey of the last two centuries of the Kingdom of Judah and a study
of the prophecies of Isaiah and Jeremiah as they reached their fulfillment in the
Messiah of the New Testament.
N.T. 101 Luke-Acts
3 credits
A study of the life of Christ and the fundamental teachings of the Christian
Church through the student's personal involvement with the text of Scripture.
56
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
N.T. 103 Pauline Epistles
3 credits
The structure, historical setting, purposes and content of Paul's Epistles to the
Galatians, I Corinthians and Prison Epistles are studied vvith an en-1phasis upon
their relevance to our day.
N.T. 110 The Gospel According to Matthew
3 credits
A brief survey of the Jewish, Greek and Roman backgrounds, a short introduction
to the Gospels, and an intensive study of the life and work of Christ in the light of
Old Testament prophecy. Offered alternate years.
N.T. 120 Epistle to the Hebrews
3 credits
A study of the fulfillment of Old Testament prophecy in Jesus Christ and His
supremacy and finality. The student is involved with the inductive method of
studying the Bible. Offered alternate years.
N.T. 130 General Epistles
3 credits
An inductive study of the Epistles of James, Peter, John and Jude with special
attention paid to their unique features as compared to other New Testament
epistles. Offered alternate years.
N.T. 140 The Gospel of John
3 credits
An inductive study concentrating upon the Person and work of Jesus Christ as
seen uniquely in the theology of John.
N.T. 202 Romans
3 credits
An intensive study of the Epistle to the Romans, considering its background,
doctrinal content and inspirational message, and emphasizing the doctrine of
justification by faith with its implications for the Christian life.
N.T. 203 Apocalyptic Literature
3 credits
A survey of the struggle of the Church against Rome, 70-100 A.O. and the central
Christology of the Book of Revelation with student interpretation and evaluation of study results.
Bible 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Study of special Biblical problems or areas suited to students' needs and interests.
Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF THEOLOGY AND CHURCH HISTORY
Courses in this department cannot be substituted for the Bible requirement.
Theology 121 God's Way of Salvation
2 credits
A study of justification, sanctification and the Christian hope of eternal life as set
forth by the Scriptures. The course utilizes the inductive method.
Theology 122 The God of Redemption
2 credits
A study of the Scriptures and other sources utilizing the inductive technique and
with concentration on the attributes of God, the incarnation, the Person and
redemptive work of Christ, the sanctifying work of the Holy Spirit, and the
relevance of faith in the Triune God in relation to the great fact of redemption.
Theology 123 The Church and the Means of Grace
2 credits
A study of Scripture and collateral readings using the inductive technique with
respect to the means of grace and the role of the Church as custodian thereof.
Theology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Study of special theological problems or areas suited to students' needs and
interests. Department approval necessary.
Church History 200 Religion in Modern America
3 credits
Survey of the role and importance of religion in the United States with emphasis
upon changing conditions and practices among the various religious groups and
upon the Lutheran heritage. Especially for the Church Staff Work Curriculum.
Church History 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special problems and areas of study in Church History. Department approval
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
57
ii. DIVISION OF COMMUNICATIONS
DEPARTMENT OF ENGLISH
Placement in English 100, 110, or 111 will be determined by specific English
Placement tests administered to all new students during student orientation in
the fall, or at the time of their registration for winter or for spring quarters.
English 100 Basic Composition
1 credit for Junior College Certificate only
Designed for the student needing individualized instruction in basic sentence
and paragraph construction. Successful completion of the course (passing grade)
is necessary before the student can enter English 110 and then the required
English sequence (English 111, 112, 113). This course meets three hours each week.
English 110 Basic Composition
3 elective credits
For students entering college who need intensive work in mastering basic
academic skills in English Composition. Successful completion of this course
(passing grade) is necessary before these students can enter the required
sequence of English courses (English 111, 112, 113). Students are granted elective
credit toward the AA Degree, but since this course may not transfer to four-year
colleges, students are advised to take more than the normal 92 credits. Students in
this course are required to attend four hours of class and/or laboratory sessions
each week.
English 111, 112, 113 (A, B, C, D, E or F) College Composition and
Introduction to Literature
3 credits per course
The regular series of courses in freshman College Composition English 111 and
112 place emphasis on the students' development and competence in English
writing skills and their ability to understand and respond to selected readings.
English 113 offers study of specific genre, themes and/or topics in literature.
Course titles may vary and may include studies in the Immigrant Experiences,
Satire, Social Concerns in Literature, Poetry, the Contemporary Short Novel and
the Experience of Fiction. Nine credits of College English are required of all
students (with the exception of one-year vocational students). Normally, College
English courses must be taken in sequence.
English 120 Directed Study in Journalism
1 credit per term
(maximum of 3 credits)
Students are involved in the production of a major publication, including
exercise in layout and design, copywriting, photography, and editing.
English 130 Creative Writing
3 credits
Students are given the opportunity to write poetry, short stories, essays and other
literary forms. Topics such as literary criticism and marketing are discussed.
Students read and evaluate each other's work.
English 210 Topics in Literature
3 credits
Study of specific genre, themes and/or topics in literature. Course titles may vary
and may include studies in the Immigrant Experiences, Satire, Social Concerns
in Literature, Poetry, the Contemporary Short Novel and the Experience of
Fiction.
English 211, 212, 213 American Literature
3 credits per course
211: The New Garden of Eden: The 17th & 18th Centuries
212: The Snake in the Garden: The 19th Century
213: The Garden Becomes a Wasteland: The 20th Century
English 221, 222, 223 World Literature
3 credits per course
Chronological survey of major writers, works, genres, themes and movements in
world thought and literature from ancient to modern times. Fall Term: Ancient
East, Greece, Rome and the Middle Ages. Winter Term: Renaissance, Neoclassical and Romantic Literature. Spring Term: The Modern Age (1850 to the
present).
58
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
English 230 Literature of the Bible
3 credits
Students do extensive reading of the narratives, poems, and apocalyptic writings
primarily from the O!d Testament. Emphasis is placed on reading the selections as
pieces of literature.
English 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 cedits per term
Special study programs to fit student needs and interest. May be taken any term.
Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF SPEECH
Speech 100 Fundamentals of Public Speaking
3 credits
A study of the basic concepts used in organizing and delivering speeches.
Emphasis on preparing and giving informative speeches.
Speech 120 Interpersonal Communication
3 credits
Study of the concepts of interpersonal communication patterns and the
characteristics of ineffective and effective communication behavior.
Speech 130 Oral Interpretation
3 credits
Theory and practice of the techniques of selecting and performing literature
orally. Students will study methods of analyzing literature, and will develop
techniques for reading prose, poetry and other literary selections.
Speech 140 Communications for Parish Workers
3 credits
Development of skills in these areas: Interpersonal, for use in visitation and
informal counseling; Group, for use in leading study groups and committees;
Public Speaking, for use in addressing congregations and other large groups.
Open to first year or second year church staff work students. Offered alternate
years.
Speech 150 Small Group Communications
3 credits
Participation in and analysis of behavioral and work norms in small groups.
Includes a study of leadership roles, conflict resolution patterns, and the decision
making process. Prerequisite: Speech 120 or instructor's approval.
Speech 210 Public Speaking
3 credits
A study of theories and ethics of persuasion. Practice in the art of speaking to
persuade or actuate. Prerequisite: Speech 100 or instructor's approval.
Speech 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Research or other creative projects within a speech communication discipline.
Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF FOREIGN LANGUAGES
German 101, 102, 103 Elementary German
4 credits per course
Fundamentals of grammar, vocabulary, pronounciation, writing, reading and
speaking; reading of some simple German prose and poetry. Prerequisite:
completion of or concurrent registration in English 111.
German 201, 202, 203 Intermediate German
3 credits per course
Review of Elementary German and further study of literary selections; emphasis is
on speaking, reading and writing German during the winter and spring terms.
Prerequisite: German 10"!, 102, 103 or two years of high school German or
instructor's approval.
German 210 Directed Readings in German
2 credits per term
(maximum 6 credits)
Students become familiar with selected works of German literature, and increase
their reading speed and comprehension of German. Department approval
necessary.
German 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special study programs to fit students' needs and interests. May be taken any
,._,..... .. ..,.....
n..-....-..-..-t.....-. ... n t
"'>.-....r.rr..\1'"ll
naracc".lr\1
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
59
Greek 101, 102, 103 Elementary Greek
5 credits per course
Theoretical and practical. study of elementary Greek grammar; readings and
parsing of selections from the Book of Acts and other selections. Instructor's
approval necessary for first year students.
Greek 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special study programs to fit students' needs and interests. Department approval
necessary.
Additional Languages-Arrangements can be made for the study of other
languages, such as Spanish, French, and Russian if students can provide their own
transportation. Interested students should contact the Academic Dean.
Ill. DIVISION OF SOCIAL SCIENCE
DEPARTMENT OF HISTORY, POLITICAL SCIENCE AND GEOGRAPHY
History 102 History of Ancient Israel
3 credits
Survey of the history of Ancient Israel and the development of the religious
insight of the Hebrew people. Attention is also given to the importance of
Mesopotamia and Egyptian contributions to the literature of the Bible. Student
may not receive credit for both O.T. 102 and History 102.
History 111 History of Ancient Greece
3 credits
Survey of Greek history and culture from the Minoan period through Hellenistic
times.
History 112 History of Ancient Rome
3 credits
Survey of Roman history and culture from prehistoric times through the late
Roman Empire.
History 113 History of Medieval Europe
3 credits
Survey of European civilization from the transformation of the Roman Empire
through the fifteenth century.
History 121, 122, 123 History of Western Civilization
3 credits per course
Survey of the development and accomplishments of Western Civilization with
emphasis on institutional, intellectual and spiritual aspects. Fall term: Late
Medieval, Renaissance and Reformation. Winter term: Early Modern Europe.
Spring term; Modern Europe in a World Setting.
History 201, 202, 203 History of the United States
3 credits per course
Survey of the history of the American people with primary emphasis on their
social, intellectual, political, and economic growth. Fall: Pre-Colonial through
Early National Period; Winter: War of 1812through Reconstruction; Spring: 1877
to the present.
History 230 Topics in History
3 credits
Topics in history of special interest to students and instructors, such as the
history of women, ethnic histories, period histories, movement studies or
institutional histories. Prerequisite: Relevant survey course or consent of
instructor.
History 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special historical periods and problems; research into particular areas of student
interest. May be taken any term. Department approval necessary.
Political Science 100 American Government and Politics
3 credits
Study of the principles and structure of Federal Government in the United States
and of political issues of the current scene.
Political Science 200 Modern Political Thought
3 credits
Comparative study of Communism, Fascism and Modern Capitalism in the light
of the contemporary Christian thought.
60
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Political Science 210 Topics in Political Science
3 credits
Topics in political science of special interest to students and instructors, such as
comparative political thought, practical politics, foundations of democratic
thought or study of political institutions. Prerequisite: Relevant survey course or
consent of instructor.
Political Science 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Research into special areas of student interest. May be taken any term. Department approval necessary.
Geography 100 Human Geography
3 credits
Survey of the basic tools and concepts of geography and the distribution patterns
of physical and human environment, plus emphasis on selected areas.
Geography 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special interests and area studies. May be taken any term. Department approval
necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF PHILOSOPHY AND HUMANITIES
Philosophy 101 Introduction to Philosophy
3 credits
Introduction to the functions and problems of philosophy with more detailed
consideration of the problems of knowledge, existence, freedom, good and evil.
Philosophy 103 Logic
3 credits
A study of the principles of correct reasoning with emphasis on the recognition
and assessment of arguments. Equal consideration is given to informal and formal
logic.
Philosophy 200 Topics in Philosophy
3 credits
Philosophical problems and topics of special interest to particular students.
Philosophy 201, 202, 203 History of Western Philosophy
3 credits per course
Survey of the important men and movements in the development of philosophical thought from the Greeks to the present. Fall term: Ancient philosophy.
Winter term: Medieval philosophy. Spring term: Modern philosophy. Offered
alternate years.
Philosophy 211, 212, 213 Philosophy of
Non-Christian Religions
3 credits per course
A study of the philosophical systems of the major religions of the world, exclusive
of Christianity. Fall: Introduction to Philosophy of Religion, African and other
traditional religions, Islam; Winter: Review of Philosophy of Religion, Judaism;
Spring: Eastern religions (Hinduism, Shinto, Taoism Confucianism) with special
emphasis on Buddhism.
Philosophy 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Study of special philosophical problems or areas appropriate to the students'
needs and interests. Department approval necessary.
Humanities 200 Travel and Study
1 to 3 elective credits
Cultural enrichment through travel. Tours guided or arranged by faculty
members. Substantial papers and reports required. Normally this course counts
as elective credit. Credits may be used to fulfill divisional requirements upon
divisional approval.
DEPARTMENT OF PSYCHOLOGY AND PERSONAL ORIENTATION
Psychology 120 Psychology of Adjustment
3 credits
Development of a knowledge of psychology that will be useful in attaining more
effective personal living and relationships with other people.
Psychology 202, 203, General Psychology
3 credits per course
Study of the more significant facts and principles in the field of human behavior,
provides a basic introduction to several areas of specialization in psychology.
Prerequisite for Psychology 203: Psychology 202.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
61
Psychology 210 Child Development
3 credits
Study of human growth and development from conception through preadolescence. Review of research and theories. Prerequisite: Two or more terms
of college work completed or instructor's approval.
Psychology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Designed for students who wish to investigate special interests. May be taken any
term. Department approval necessary.
Personal Orientation 100 Individual Work in College Study Skills
one credit per term granted for Junior College Certificate only.
Arranged on an individual basis for students desiring to work on a single aspect of
study skills, mathematics, reading, spelling or vocabulary development.
Personal Orientation 110 Efficient Reading
1 elective credit
Arranged on an indi'vidual basis to enable students to develop skills in
vocabulary, reading comprehension, and reading rate for success in college and
later life.
Personal Orientation 120 College Vocabulary Development 2 elective credits
Designed to introduce students to basic principles of vocabulary development.
Aimed at general vocabulary as well as the specific vocabularies of various
academic disciplines.
Personal Orientation 130 How to Study
1 elective credit
Practice of methods of study developed from information based on research and
student experience. Concerned with efficient and effective methods of concentration, use of time, taking lecture notes, textbook reading, organizing
material, preparing for and taking examinations.
Personal Orientation 160 Fundamentals of Spelling
1 elective credit
Designed to provide the student with a systematic approach to spelling; the
course will utilize a self-paced, audio-tutorial format.
Personal Orientation 170 The Research Paper
1 or 2 elective credits
Designed to provide the student with the skills necessary to create a research
paper; the course will utilize the self-paced, audio-tutorial format. The end resu It
of the course will be the production of a research paper for another class.
Prerequisite: English 111 or instructor's permission.
Personal Orientation 200 Career and Life Planning
2 elective credits
Designed to teach skills for making career decisions appropriate to the student's
values, needs, aptitudes, skills or talents, interests and goals.
DEPARTMENT OF SOCIOLOGY, SOCIAL SERVICE AND ANTHROPOLOGY
Sociology 100 Introduction to Sociology
3 credits
Study of the structures and functions of society and culture as seen through
sociological perspectives; focus is on selected problems, social organizations and
socialization in the context of change.
Sociology 110 Social Problems
3 credits
Survey of contemporary social problems with development of the students'
understanding of the processes involved in historical, social and cultural change.
Sociology 120 Marriage and Family
3 credits
Study of the life cycle, mate selection, marital adjustment and parent-child
relationships; to provide practical help for those interested in preparing for
marriage from a Christian point of view.
Sociology 130 Urban Field Experience 1 credit per course (maximum 3 credits)
Combines theoretical and practical knowledge and experience designed to
orient students to the urban setting. Different offerings of the course will focus
on different topics. Hours arranged for lectures and laboratory periods.
62
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Sociology 210 The Urban Center
3 credits
Introduction to the problems of modern cities, urban ecology, urban institutions
and the urban way of life. Prerequisite: Sociology 100 or instructor's approval.
Sociology 212 Minority Group Relations
3 credits
Study of minority groups, especially Native and Black Americans, and the
problems of the contemporary scene. Prerequisite: Sociology 100 or by permission of the instructor.
Sociology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special sociological problems and areas of study to fit the students' interests. May
be taken any term. Department approval necessary.
Social Service, 101, 102, 103, 104, 201, 202, 203, 204 Internship 1-3 credits per term
Practical experience and observation in working with social service agencies;
orientation and help in choosing vocational goals in different areas of social
service. Designed for the Social Service Curriculum.
Anthropology 100 Introduction to Physical Anthropology and Archaeology
3 credits
Survey of the field of physical anthropology and the archaeological methods
used in the study of prehistory. Offered alternate years.
Anthropology 110 Introduction to Cultural Anthropology
3 credits
Survey of the field of cultural anthropology with the study of the varieties of the
human race, their origins, cultural characteristics, and spiritual orientation.
Offered alternate years.
Anthropology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special anthropological problems and areas of study to fit the students' interests.
Department approval necessary.
IV. DIVISION Of MATHEMATICS AND SCIENCES
DEPARTMENT OF MATHEMATICS
1 credit granted for
Junior College Certificate only
Review of arithmetic, factoring, the fundamental algebraic operations, rational
expressions, linear equations, roots and radicals, quadratic equations. Class
meets three hours per week.
Mathematics 101 Intermediate Algebra
3 elective credits
Introduction to basic mathematical concepts, sets, the number system, factoring,
fractions, inequalities, linear, and quadratic equations. Students are required to
attend three hours of class and an additional fourth hour each week in the skills
center. Prerequisite: one year of high school algebra.
Mathematics 102 College Algebra
5 credits
Algebraic operations with real numbers, linear and quadratic functions. polynomials, combinations, binomial theorem, probability, mathematical induction, analytic geometry, matrices and determinants. Prerequisite: Mathematics
101 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 103 Pre-Calculus
4 credits
Functions and inverse functions, exponential and logarithmic functions, trigomometric functions and trigonometric identities, solution of triangles, complex
numbers, polar coordinates and analytic geometry. Prerequisite: Mathematics
102 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 110 Introductory Statistics
4 credits
Study of basic statistical concepts: probability, sampling, normal distribution,
statistical estimation, and hypothesis testing. Problems are applied in the fields of
business, social and physical sciences. Prerequisite: Mathematics 101 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 100 Basic Algebra
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
Mathematics 120 Finite Mathematics
63
5 credits
Computing with BASIC computer language. Principles of counting and probability, business mathematics, matrices and inverse matrices, Markov chains,
linear programming includfng simplex method. Prerequisite: Mathematics 101 or
instructor's approval.
Mathematics 200 Elements of Calculus
5 credits
A short course with applications in biology, business and social sciences. Short
review of algebra. Continuity and the limit of a function. Derivative and its
interpretation, maximum and minimum problems, antiderivative, the definite
integral, exponential and logarithmic functions, functions of several variables.
Prerequisite: Mathematics 102 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 201 Calculus I
5 credits
Short review of algebra, introduction to plane analytic geometry. The derivatives
of functions and their applications. The integration of simpler functions and the
applications. Prerequisites: Mathematics 103 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 202 Calculus II
5 credits
Differentiation and integration of trigonometric and logarithmic functions.
Techniques of integration: by parts, by change, of variable, by approximation
methods, etc. Parametric equations and polar coordinates. Applications to
geometrical and physical problems. Prerequisite: Mathematics 201 or instructor's
approval.
Mathematics 203 Calculus Ill
5 credits
Vector treatment of three-dimensional analytic geometry, functions of two or
more variables, multiple integrals, indeterminate forms, infinite series, and
differential equations. Applications. Prererequisite: Mathematics 202 or instructor's approval.
Mathematics 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects and problems for advanced students. Department approval
necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF PHYSICS
Physics 100 Environmental Physics
4 credits
Survey of physics as related to the environment and everyday experiences of the
physical world. The concepts in mechanics, heat, sound, light and atomic physics
are developed non-mathematically. One double lab per week is devoted to
student projects or to experiments in laboratory. Primarily for non-science
majors. No prerequisite.
Physics 102 General Physics I
5 credits
Study of physical principles in mechanics, fluids, wave motion, and heat, with
applications to practical situations. Demonstration lectures and problem sessions. One double laboratory period per week. Primarily for students in science
or in various technical areas. Prerequisite: Mathematics 101 or instructor's
approval.
Physics 103 General Physics II
5 credits
The fundamental physical concepts in electricity, magnetism, optics, and nuclear
physics will be studied using practical applications. Demonstration lectures and
problem sessions. One double laboratory period per week. Primarily for students
in science or in technical areas. Prerequisite: Physics 102 or instructor's approval.
Physics 120 Field Experience in Physics 1 credit per course (maximum 4 credits)
Hours arranged for lecture and laboratory periods.
Physics 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects and problems for advanced students. Department approval
necessary.
64
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
DEPARTMENT OF BIOLOGY
Biology 111 Life Studies 1
4 credits
Introduction to biology ~~ life versus non-life, cellular design and process}
organism types (unity amidst complexity), energy sources, yields,.and efficiencies
in life systems. One lecture period, two discussions and one two-hour research
lab weekly.
Biology 112 Life Studies II
4 credits
The individual life pattern - cell regulation and division, sex cell formation and
union, genetics and embryology, intercellular effects and immune response,
physiology and neuromechanisms. One lecture period, two discussions and one
two-hour research lab weekly.
Biology 113 Environmental Biology
4 credits
Traces exploration - conservation - ecology - consciousness through perspectives of behavior, populations, ecosystems and biosphere understanding
and application. One lecture period, two discussions and one two-hour
research lab weekly.
Biology 114 Field Ecology and/or
4 credits
4 credits
Biology 115 Invertebrate Zoology
Wilderness camping experience during the month of June at the 120-acre North
Woods Field Station. Ecosystems analysis and survey of invertebrate phyla with
field equipment and techniques - team-taught small group with mobile lab.
Wilderness survival and ecorecreation (scuba, rock-climbing, sailing, recording
animal sounds, photography, astronomy, geology, wildlife and forestry employment opportunities). Prerequisite recommended: Biology 113.
Biology 120 Field Experience in Biology 1 credit per course (maximum 4 credits)
Combines theoretical and practical knowledge and experience designed to
provide career guidance and development to better direct educational and
occupational planning. Hours arranged for lecture and laboratory periods.
Biology 121 Plant Studies
4 credits
The study of plant cells and tissues with a survey of the major phyla of the nonvascular plants and their adaptions to the environment. Some field studies and
taxonomy of the local trees and fall flowers. Two lectures and two double lab
periods per week.
Biology 222 Introduction to Botany
4 credits
The study of major phyla of vascular plants and plant growth, regulations,
reproduction and photosynthesis. This course will give experience in the green
house environment. Two lectures and two double lab periods per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111, 112 or 113 or instructor's approval.
Biology 223 Introduction to Ecology
4 credits
The study of the structure and function of an ecosystem with field studies of at
least two major ecosystems. Two lectures and two double lab periods per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111, or 112 or 113 or instructor's approval.
Biology 231 Microbiology
4 credits
Practical application of bacteriological techniques in analyzing disease parameters, public health measures, agricultural and industrial usefulness of the
smallest life systems. Two lectures and two double lab periods per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111, or concurrent registration in Biology 111.
Biology 232 Anatomy
4 credits
Gross and microscopic structure of the human body from a functional standpoint
utilizing charts, models, skeletons and manikins. Cat dissection to demonstrate
mammalian anatomy. Two lectures and two double lab periods per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111, or 112 or instructor's permission.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
Biology 233 Physiology
65
4 credits
Organ systems of the human body. Laboratory exercises include blood typing,
recording of the heart beat, respiration, muscle contraction, experiments on
digestion, urinalaysis, coordinated with a brief study of the anatomy of each
system. Two lectures and two double lab periods per week. Prerequisite: Biology
232, or instructor's permission.
Biology 243 Genetics
4 credits
An introductory course in the principles of heredity will begin with Mendelian
genetics, and then progress to cell division and reproduction, molecular
structure, DNA, protein synthesis, gene expression, mutagenesis, and conclude
with population genetics, genetic engineering, and variabilities. Emphasis will be
on human inheritance. Three lectures and one double lab period per week.
Prerequisite: Biology 111 or instructor's approval.
Biology 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF CHEMISTRY
Chemistry 100 Environmental Chemistry
4 credits
Study of the environment and the role chemistry plays in life. Topics of current
interest such as storage of atomic wastes, food additives, air pollution, solid
wastes and the development of the environment are discussed, along with the
chemical principles required for a more thorough understanding of them. Three
lectures and one double laboratory period per week. Primarily for non-science
majors. No prerequisite.
Chemistry 101, 102, 103 General Chemistry
4 credits per course
Chemistry 101 is introductory, including measurement, reactions, stiochiometry,
atom structure, molecule bonding and structure, equilibrium, acids and pH.
Chemistry 102 has topics of states of matter, periodic table and properties of
elements, industrial applications, organic and biochemistry. Chemistry 103
stresses environmental concerns, redox and electrochemistry, chemical analysis,
nuclear chemistry, energy, and consumer chemistry. Laboratory sessions
parallel the lecture topics, with experiments on measurement, scientific method,
separations, equilibrium, acid-base, electrochemistry, polymers, organic reactions, biochemistry, gas laws, qualitative analysis of ions, and water analysis for
dissolved oxygen and hardness. Chemistry 101, 102, 103 must be taken in
sequence. Three lectures and one double period of laboratory per week.
Chemistry 201, 202, 203, Organic Chemistry
4 credits per course
Study of structure, reactions and nomenclature of both aliphatic and aromatic
hydrocarbons, halides, alcohols, ethers, carboxylic acids, aldehydes, ketones,
and amines. The latter part of the course deals with larger functional groups such
as keto acids, etc. Considerable time will be spent on l.R. spectra and N.M.R.
spectra to help identify compounds. Three lectures and one double lab per week.
Prerequisite for Chemistry 201 is Chemistry 103 or instructor's permission.
Chemistry 201, 202, 203 must be taken in sequence.
Chemistry 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
66
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
V. DIVISION OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND
RECREATION LEADERSHIP
DEPARTMENT OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION
Physical Education 101, 102, 103 (Activity Courses)
Fall
Winter
101E
1011
101)
101A
101 N
101S
101D
101T
101V
Bowling
Conditioning
Cross Country
Football
Karate
Soccer
Swimming
Tennis
Volleyball
102R
102B
102E
1021
102Q
102N
102V
102G
102K
1 credit per course
Spring
Badminton
103L Baseball
Basketball
103E Bowling
Bowling
1031 Conditioning
Conditioning
103W Golf
Cross Country Skiing103N Karate
Karate
103X Softball
Volleyball
103P Swimming
Weightlifting
103T Tennis
Wrestling
103U Track
1030 Women's Self
Defense
3 credits
Physical Education 110 Introduction to Physical Education
Study of physical education and athletics in the schools, and the philosophy and
basic principles of physical education and recreation leadership.
3 credits
Physical Education 120 Health and First Aid
Study of modern concepts and practices of health applied to the individual and
community. Also includes the American Red Cross First Aid Course.
2 credits
Physical Education 130 Drugs and Chemical Dependency
Study of the personal use and misuse of dependency on tobacco, alcohol, drugs
and other chemicals. Identification of users and information regarding the
resources and help available to people. Designed to meet certification requirements.
Physical Education 140 Cardiopulmonary Resuscitation (CPR)
1 elective credit
The procedure used when cardiac arrest occurs. Course includes instruction and
Official Certification in the skills of CPR.
Physical Education 160 Football Officiating
1 elective credit
Philosophy, principles and problems of officiating at football games. Interpretations of game rules and officiating procedures. One lecture period per week.
Laboratory hours arranged by the instructor.
Physical Education 170 Basketball Officiating
1 elective credit
Philosophy, principles and problems of officiating at basketball games. Interpretations of game rules and officiating procedures. One lecture period per
week. Laboratory hours arranged by the instructor.
Physical Education 180 Baseball and Softball Officiating
1 elective credit
Philosophy, principles and problems of officiating at baseball and softball games.
Interpretations of game rules and officiating procedures. One lecture period per
week. Laboratory hours arranged by the instructor.
3 credits
Physical Education 200 Individual and Dual Sports
Study of theory and practice in teaching and officiating individual and dual
sports.
3 credits
Physical Education 210 Team Sports
Study of theory and practice in teaching and officiating team sports.
Physical Education 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects and problems for advanced students. Department approval
necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
67
DEPARTMENT OF RECREATION LEADERSHIP
Recreation Leadership 110 Introduction to Recreation and Park Leadership
3 credits
Examination of the history and development of park and recreation movement;
professional and service organizations; orientation to the professional field.
Recreation Leadership 120 Introduction to Recreation Programming 3 credits
Introduction to the directing and leading of recreation work and the writing of
recreation programs. (YMCA, YWCA, Boy Scouts, Girl Scouts, churches, community centers, etc.)
Recreation Leadership 210 Camp Craft
3 credits
Basic skills and practical experience in various phases of camping and outdoor
education.
Recreation Leadership 220 Leadership in Social Activities
Techniques of leadership in social games, parties and outings.
3 credits
Recreation Leadership 230 Internship
1 to 3 credits per course
Practical experience under the direction of full-time workers in the fields of
parks, recreation management and Y.M.C.A.-Y.W.C.A.
VI. DIVISION OF CREATIVE ARTS
DEPARTMENT OF ART
Art 100 Introduction to Visual Arts
3 credits
Introduction to visual art through the study of aesthetics, philosophy, techniques
and history of art. Includes attending art exhibits and other cultural events and
researching personal ideas as they relate to the world of art.
Art 101, 102, 103 Art History of the Western World
3 credits per course
Survey of painting, sculpture and architecture as they relate to history and
culture in the Western world. Fall Term: Pre-history to Early Christian. Winter
Term: Middle Ages to Baroque. Spring Term: Nineteenth Century to Present.
Offered alternate years.
Art 110 Two Dimensional Design
3 credits
A basic study of the principles of design together with the discovery of design
sources in nature.
Art 121 Basic Drawing
3 credits
Exploration and use of various drawing materials and methods. Emphasis on
the development of visual perception and personal aesthetics.
Art 122 Drawing
3 credits
An extension of Art 121 with more extensive experiences in the manipulation
of visual elements and pictorial structure. Prerequisite: Art 121 or instructor's
approval.
Art 123 Drawing
3 credits
Continuation of Art 121 and 122. Students learn to see design and form
relationships and experiment with a variety of drawing media. Subject matter
includes still life and the figure. Prerequisite Art 122 or instructor's approval.
Art 130 Printmaking
3 credits
An exploration and study of wood and other materials for making prints in
monochrome and color.
Art 140 Watercolor
3 credits
An introduction to the watercolor medium with emphasis on compositional and
technical problems. Subject matter includes still life and landscape.
68
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
Art 202, 203 Painting
3 credits per course
Basic experiences in the use of oil and acrylic to acquaint the student with the
rnediurns and to encourage the developrnent of personal imagery and technique. Prerequisite: Art 121 or instructor's approval.
Art 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special study for advanced students based upon the proposal of the student in
consultat'1on with the 'instructor. Department approval required.
DEPARTMENT OF MUSIC
Music 100 Introduction to Music
3 credits
The development of perceptive listening through the study of representative
musical works, their styles, structure and relationship to cultural history. For
non-music majors.
Music 111,112, 113 Theory
4 credits per course
Course sequence in music theory developing the student's knowledge and skills
in part writing, keyboard sight-singing and ear-training. Includes studies of the
science of sound, the rudiments of music, intervals, triads and inversions,
survey of non-harmonic tones and seventh chords. Music 111, 112, 113 must be
taken in sequence.
Music 121, 122, 123 History of Music
3 credits per course
Survey of musical thought and achievement from primitive origins to the
twentieth century. Intended for music majors but may be taken by any student
upon approval of the instructor. Offered alternate years.
Music 131, 132, Choral Conducting
2 credits per course
Study of the fundamentals of conducting with practical experience in conducting
student ensembles. Includes studies of vocal problems, score and clef reading,
baton technique and transpositions. Meets three periods per week. Offered
alternate years.
Music 133 Instrumental Conducting
2 credits
Study of the fundamentals of conducting with practical experience in conducting
student ensembles. Includes studies of instrumental problems, score and clef
reading, baton technique and transpositions. Meets three periods per week.
Offered alternate years.
Music 211, 212, 213 Advanced Theory
4 credits per course
Study of Baroque composition including detailed study of non-harmonic tones,
seventh chords, altered chords, modal harmony and two-, three-, four-part
counterpoint. Also includes a survey of music styles from the Baroque to the
present with a concentration on twentieth century techniques of music composition. Prerequisite: Music 111, 112, 113 or instructor's approval. Music 211, 212,
213 must be taken in sequence.
Music 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. May be taken any term. Department
approval necessary.
APPLIED MUSIC
Applied Music 110A Voice
1 credit per term
Study of vocal technique and literature. Emphasis on sacred literature including
oratorio, with time devoted to Italian and German art songs. One half-hour
lesson per week.
Applied Music 1108 Piano
1 credit per term
Instruction in piano performance, including study of techniques through scales,
arpeggios and other exercises. One half-hour lesson per week.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
69
Applied Music 110C Organ
1 credit per term
Graded course in organ playing beginning with study of manual and pedal
techniques. Literature studies include examples from all periods of music.
Renaissance to Neo-Classic. Service playing problems also are studied. One halfhour lesson per week.
Applied Music 1100 Brass
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a brass instrument. One half-hour lesson per week.
Applied Music 110E Percussion
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a percussion instrument or instruments. One half-hour
lesson per week.
Applied Music 110F Strings
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a string instrument. One half-hour lesson per week.
Applied Music 110G Woodwinds
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on a woodwind instrument. One half-hour lesson per week.
Applied Music 110H Guitar
1 credit per term
Graded instruction on guitar. One half-hour lesson per week.
ENSEMBLES
Music Ensemble 110A Golden Valley Lutheran College Choir 1 credit per term
Open to all students by audition, but ·limited to 65 members. Examples from all
periods of music literature are selected for performance. Besides numerous
concerts in and around the Twin City area, an extended tour is made each spring.
The choir meets four periods per week.
Music Ensemble 110B Golden Valley Singers
1 credit per term
Open to all women students of the college. Study and presentation of treble
choral music, both accompanied and a cappella. The chorus meets four periods
per week.
Music Ensemble 110C The Madrigal Singers
1 credit per term
Twelve students selected from the Golden Valley Lutheran College Choir.
Literature used includes Madrigal and Carol. Numerous concerts are given
through the year.
Music Ensemble 1100 Symphonic Choir
1/2
credit per term
Open to all members of the student body and the community.
Music Ensemble 110H Band
1 credit per term
Open to all college students by audition. The group performs literature from all
eras and styles. A tour is organized each year. The band performs regularly for
College convocations and presents formal concerts each quarter. The pep band
and stage band are formed from this group. The band meets four periods per
week.
Music Ensembles 1101 College-Community Orchestra
1 credit per term
Open to all qualified students and community members by audition. The
orchestra performs standard orchestral literature each quarter in addition to
accompanying the College choirs at Christmas.
Small Ensembles
1 credit per term
Students are given opportunity to participate in small ensembles (trios and
quartets, instrumental and vocal). The ensembles perform regularly for convocations, concerts and at local church services. Membership is by audition or consent of director.
Music
Music
Music
Music
Music
Ensemble
Ensemble
Ensemble
Ensemble
Ensemble
110J Brass Ensemble
110K Percussion Ensemble
110L Stage Band
110M String Ensemble
110N Woodwind Ensemble
70
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
DEPARTMENT OF THEATRE
3 credits
Study of Theatre as a performing art. The aestheticfunction of theatre and its ro!e
Theatre 100 Introduction to Theatre
in Western culture will be discussed, as well as the role and function of the various
theatre artists such as actor, director, and designer.
3 credits
Theatre 110 Beginning Acting
An experiential course which focuses on honesty in characterization through
various means including theatre games, improvisation, and the development of
scenes.
Theatre 120 Theatre Practice
1 elective credit per term
(maximum of 3 elective credits for A.A. degree)
Participation in College sponsored theatre productions. Open to students
assigned performing or technical roles. Instructor's permission required.
Theatre 130 Elements of Technical Theatre
4 credits
A basic introduction to both design theory and design execution in the theatre.
Emphasis placed on the technical aspects of scene design, lighting, costuming
and sound. Prerequisite: Theatre 100 or instructor's permission.
Theatre 140 Mime
1 elective credit
A physical exploration of the art of mime, focusing on internalization, illusion
technique, and the performing of sketches. This class will meet two periods per
week.
Theatre 200 History of Theatre
3 credits
An examination of the phenomenon of Theatre Arts from a historical perspective. Emphasis will be placed on a particular period. The historical development
of both dramatic literature and staging techniques will be examined, as well as the
influence of other historical events upon them. Prerequisite: Theatre 100
or instructor's permission.
Theatre 210 Advanced Acting
3 credits
Intense scene study directed toward the development of a personal technique of
honest characterization through various periods and styles of plays. Prerequisite:
Theatre 110 or instructor's permission.
4 credits
Theatre 220 Directing for the Theatre
An introduction to the role and function of the director in modern theatre.
Emphasis will be placed on the elements of the director's craft as well as his
relationship to the other theatre artists. Preparation of scenes and exercises will
culminate in a final scene or a short one-act play. Prerequisite: Theatre 100 &
Theatre 110 or instructor's permission.
1 to 3 credits per term
Theatre 300 Independent Study
Special projects for advanced students of research projects within selected
theatre disciplines. Department approval necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
71
VII. DIVISION OF BUSINESS AND VOCATIONAL STUDIES
DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS
Business 101 Accounting I
4 credits
Study of fundamental principles and procedures of accounting; classifying and
reporting data on balance sheets and income statements.
Business 102 Accounting II
4 credits
Continuation of Accounting I; analyzing financial statements and analytical
functions of accounting; partnership and corporate accounting. Prerequisite:
Business 101 or instructor's approval.
Business 103 Accounting Ill
4 credits
Accounting as a planning and controlling tool in the decision-making process of
management; funds statements; cost accounting: job order and process cost.
Prerequisite: Business 102 or instructor's approval.
Business 110 Personal Finance
3 credits
Fundamental concepts of personal financial management: insurance, budgeting,
credit, savings, investments, retirement and estate problems and consumer
concerns. General Education course open to all students.
Business 120 Introduction to Business
3 credits
A survey of the ownership, organization, management, major functions, environment, and ethics of American business. Aimed at assisting students to
establish more specific career goals in the field of business. General Education
course open to all students.
Business 140 Business Mathematics
3 credits
Application of mathematical skills to practical business situations. Topics include:
fundamentals review, percentages, interest, discounts, payroll, taxes, profits,
losses, stocks, bonds, and insurance.
Business 150 Business Communications
3 credits
General principles of effective communication in business; writing of various
types of business letters and reports; stress on vocabulary and the mechanics of
language as applied to writing business reports and letters.
Business 160 Introduction to Computer Science
3 credits
An introduction to computers, the role of computers, current uses in business
and education, and functions in terms of hardware and software.
Business 170 Introduction to Programming
3 credits
Computers, programs, and construction of algorithms-fundamental programming and computing systems. Basic and Pascal language.
Business 200 Principles of Economics -
Macroeconomics
4 credits
National income economics, gross national product, indicators of economic
activity, the money and banking system, monetary and fiscal policies to fight
inflation and unemployment, principles of world economics, international trade,
and the balance of payments.
Business 210 Principles of Economics -
Microeconomics
4 credits
Supply, demand and price; competition, monopoly, oligopoly, and anti-trust
policy. Pricing of the factors of production and distribution of income. Prerequisite: Business 200 or instructor's approval.
Business 230 Business Law
4 credits
Relationship between the citizen and the business world. Topics include
contracts, bills and notes, courts, bailments, partnerships and corporations.
Business 270 Marketing
3 credits
Examination of the total marketing process, including the distribution of goods
and services from producer to consumer; processes of retailing, wholesaling,
pricing and government regulations. Offered alternate years.
Business 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Department approval necessary.
72
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
DEPARTMENT OF SECRETARIAL SCIENCE
Secretarial Science 101 Personal typewriting
3 credits
Mastery of the keyboard and proper technique of typewriting. Not open to
students with one year of high school typing except
instruct-or's app~oval.
by
Secretarial Science 102 Typewriting II
4 credits
Students build speed and accuracy in straight-copy typing, and increase their
skills in composition, rough-draft typing, editing production and analysis of the
following components of typewriting communication: business letters, memos,
manuscripts, business reports, business forms and tables. Prerequisite: Secretarial
Science 101 or permission of instructor.
Secretarial Science 103 Executive Typewriting
4 credits
This course emphasizes performance at the executive level requiring sustained
high-level production speed with the ability to edit, organize, solve problems
and produce high-quality work. Speed and accuracy in straight-copy and
production work are stressed. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science 102 or permission
of instructor.
Secretarial Science 110 Office Accounting
4 credits
General office accounting procedures; payroll records, tax records, records of a
physician and an attorney. Practice Set which will include basic accounting cycle.
General Education course open to all students.
Secretarial Science 111 Elementary Shorthand
4 credits
Fundamentals of Forkner Shorthand Theory for beginning students or for
students who have had less than one year of ~orkner or Gregg Shorthand.
Secretarial Science 112 Intermediate Shorthand
4 credits
Emphasis on speed, accuracy and vocabulary. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science
111 or instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 113 Advanced Shorthand
4 credits
Advanced dictation and transcription. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science 112 or
instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 123 Office Machines
3 credits
Instruction in the use of electronic printing calculators, electronic display
calculators, CPT (Cassette Powered Typewriter) plus study of practical business
computations.
Secretarial Science 203 Administrative Office Procedures
2 credits
A study of office duties, responsibilities, activities and procedures with emphasis
on obtaining a job, records management (filing) and business attitudes. No
prerequisite.
Secretarial Science 211 MachineTranscription
2 credits
Emphasis on transcription techniques, both from machine and textual material.
Transcribing machines are used. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science 103 or instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 213 Shorthand Transcription
2 credits
Refresher course for Gregg and Forkner students with emphasis on speed
building and transcription techniques. Prerequisite: Secretarial Science 113 or
instructor's approval.
Secretarial Science 220 Supervised Work Experience
1 credit per term
Credit for work experience in an office-type environment. Students must
register during quarter in which they receive credit. Applications must be
approved by secretarial science department in advance.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
73
Secretarial Science 221 Medical Office Procedures
2 credits
Study of medical records, medical law, medical societies, medical insurance,
medical filing, medical telephoning techniques, medical appointments, and
general medical office duties.
Secretarial Science 222 Medical Terminology
2 credits
Study of medical terms used in the branches of medicine; emphasis on prefixes
and suffixes; use of medical reference books.
Secretarial Science 223 Medical Transcription
4 credits
Study of the principles of medical machine transcription for all branches of
medicine. Typing of medical summaries, reports and letters. Medical cassette
tapes are used.
Secretarial Science 232 Legal Terminology and Transcription
4 credits
Study of legal terms used in probate, real estate, litigations, wills, estates,
partnerships and corporations.
Secretarial Science 233 Legal Office Procedures
4 credits
Study of procedures and legal forms involved in probate, appeals, real estate,
litigations, wills, estates, partnerships, and corporations.
Secretarial Science 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects for advanced students. Departmental approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF LAW ENFORCEMENT
Law Enforcement 100 Introduction to Criminal Justice
3 credits
Survey of the history and principles of law enforcement in American society, the
criminal justice system, courts, state and federal agencies.
Law Enforcement 110 Law Enforcement Operations and Procedures 3 credits
An overview of the relationships between the police and community and the era
of crime prevention, the elements of verbal and non-verbal communication, and
their role in effective law enforcement procedure.
Law Enforcement 120 Juvenile Problems & Justice
3 credits
An overview of the principles of the juvenile justice system, its laws, problems,
and procedures.
Law Enforcement 130 Criminal Evidence and Procedure
3 credits
Criminal evidence for police, types of evidence, criminal procedures in various
courts, arrest, search and seizure, collection of evidence, interviews and line-up
procedure.
Law Enforcement 150 Criminal Law
3 credits
The development, application and enforcement of local, state and federal laws
that deal with criminal behavior, including a study of the Minnesota Criminal
Code.
Law Enforcement 160 Constitutional Law
3 credits
Study and analysis of the United States Constitution and its amendments that
pertain to law enforcement. Also studied are Federal and State legal decisions
that apply to law enforcement problems.
Law Enforcement 170 Psychology for Law Enforcement
3 credits
An introduction to the psychological aspects of the Law Enforcement profession
with particular attention to the personal and professional adjustments demanded
by this career.
74
COLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
law Enforcement 180 Report Writing 2 credits
Interviews and Interrogation
Designed for Law Enforcement students. The course will have intensive work in
the techniques of interviewing and interrogations, fieid note taking, criminal
investigative and follow-up report writing.
law Enforcement 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects and research into areas of student interest in the fields of law
enforcement. Department approval necessary.
DEPARTMENT OF APPLIED CHRISTIANITY
Christian Service 110A, 1108, 110C Christian Service Projects
1 credit per course per term
Student assignments to various projects provide in-service training in various
phases of Christian work. Regular reports to the department are required.
Applied Christianity 122, 123 Christian Education
3 credits per course
Winter term: Study of the human relations of the teaching-learning process,
acquaintance with the age of ability differences, and individual potential of
children. An in-depth child study will be made by each student. Spring term:
Study of the objectives of Christian Education and practice of teaching methods.
Applied Christianity 130 Youth leadership
3 credits
Study of the needs and goals of youth leadership in the church, and of the
philosophies, organizational structures, resources and materials of the youth
organizations and departments of the major Lutheran synods.
Applied Christianity 140 Christian Ethics
3 credits
Study of ethical standards of Christian conduct and their relationship to the self,
family, society, church and state. Emphasis is placed on the student's practical
questions concerning right and wrong.
Applied Christianity 150 Evangelism
3 credits
The evangelical task of the church is recognized as of prime importance, and the
responsibility of the individual Christian to personalize the Gospel within the
parish and community is stressed.
Applied Christianity 201, 202, 203 Christian Education Project
1/
2
to
11/2 credits per term Maximum of 3 credits.
Classroom orientation and practical teaching experience under supervision.
Applied Christianity 211 Christian Education Seminar
3 credits
Study of materials available in the field of Christian Education; discussion of
teaching experiences (Applied Christianity 201); acquaintance with methods and
materials in adult Christian education.
Applied Christianity 221 Church Staff Work 1
3 credits
Study of basic principles and their relationship to professional ethics, professional relationships, the ministry of the laity, the organization and functioning
of the parish, techniques of visitation and public relations. For parish workers,
parish secretaries, and lay assistants.
Applied Christianity 223 Church Staff Work II
3 credits
Study of strategies and models for the development of programs designed to
meet a congregation's particular needs.
Applied Christianity 230 Church Staff Field Work
1 to 3 credits
Practical experience in the various aspects of parish work through personal
supervised field work with the cooperation of local congregations. Twenty-four
hours of work are required for one credit.
Applied Christianity 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Designed for students who wish to investigate special interests. May be taken any
term. Department approval necessary.
COURSE DESCRIPTIONS
Mission 100 Introduction to Mission
75
2 credits
Study of the theology of mission, some basic principles of communciating the
Gospel to non-Christian people, and some current practices in the work of the
Church in various countries of the world.
Mission 110 History of World Mission
2 credits
Study of the major leaders and developments in the missionary effort of the
nineteenth century.
Mission 120 History of World Mission
2 credits
Study of the major leaders and developments in the missionary effort of the
twentieth century.
Mission 200 Mission Internship
1 to 6 credits
A flexible program of study designed to provide the student opportunities for
contact with people directly involved in church work in various countries of the
world. Students may study and serve under the supervision of experienced
missionaries at times to be arranged.
Mission 300 Independent Study
1 to 3 credits per term
Special projects for the student who has a serious interest in some aspects of the
world mission of the Christian Church. Department approval necessary.
76
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
DIRECTORY
Board of Regents
OFFICERS
Chairman/
THE REVEREND
MAYNARD L. NELSON
Vice Chairman/
TRUDY ROGNESS JENSEN
Secretary/
LOUISE SUNDET
Treasurer/
ALLEN A. METCALF, JR.
MEMBERS OF THE BOARD
OF REGENTS
EVONNE ANDERSON
ALC, Farming, Homemaker
Halstad, Minnesota
DR. LAWRENCE M. BRINGS
Regent Emeritus
ALC, Chairman of the Board
T.S. Denison & Co., Inc.
Minneapolis, Minnesota
EARL BURANDT
LC-MS, Engineer
Honeywell, Inc.
Golden Valley, Minnesota
MARK S. DALQUIST
LCA, President
Maid of Scandinavia
Minneapolis, Minnesota
THE REVEREND MICHAELE. DOBBINS
LCA, Pastor
Holy Cross Lutheran Church
St. Paul, Minnesota
MRS. NORMA HAYER DOLLIFF
ALC, Officer and Director
F.C. Hayer Company
Edina, Minnesota
THE REVEREND JOHN P. FOLKERDS
LCA, Pastor
Zion Lutheran Church
Buffalo, Minnesota
THE REVEREND
VERNON D. GUNDERMANN
LC-MS, Pastor
Beautiful Savior Lutheran Church
New Hope, Minnesota
THE REVEREND RICHARD F. HOLY
ALC, Administrator
St. Olaf Residence
Minneapolis, Minnesota
THE REVEREND PAUL R. IDSTROM
ALC, Pastor
House of Hope Lutheran Church
New Hope, Minnesota
TRUDY ROGNESS JENSEN
ALC, Counseling Services, Homemaker
Edin?, Minnesota
DR. MARLIN J.E. JOHNSON
LCA, Specialist in Internal Medicine
Quain & Ramstad Clinic
Bismarck, North Dakota
WOODROW P. LANGHAUG
ALC, Vice Chairman of the Board
Lutheran Brotherhood
Minneapolis, Minnesota
ALLEN A. METCALF, JR.
ALC, President, Metcalf Mayflower
Moving Co.
St. Paul, Minnesota
THE REVEREND MAYNARD L. NELSON
ALC, Pastor
Calvary Lutheran Church
Golden Valley, Minnesota
RAY NORLING
ALC, Executive Vice President
Willmar Poultry Co.
Willmar, Minnesota
ELMER N. OLSON
ALC, Past President
Elmer N. Olson Co.
Minneapolis, Minnesota
PAUL G. PETERSON
LCA, Manager
Higher Education Support
Fraternal Division
Lutheran Brotherhood
Minneapolis, Minnesota
DIRECTORY
77
RUTH E. RUPP
LCA, Owner
Rupp Industries
Burnsville, Minnesota
MYRON H. BLANCH/Law Enforcement
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN. 1979-
LOUISE SUNDET
LCA, Homemaker
Excelsior, Minnesota
ROY BLOOMQUIST /Radio Director
B.A., Wisconsin State University, Superior, WI; Augustana Theological
Seminary, Rock Island, IL; Maywood
Seminary, Chicago, IL 1961-
RALPH 0. THRANE
LC-MS, Vice President and Director
of Acquistions and Mergers
The Pillsbury Company
Minneapolis, Minnesota
THE REVEREND
LAUREN E. YOUNGDALE
LCA, Chaplain
Fergus Falls, Minnesota
THE REVEREND CARLETON E. ZAHN
LC-MS, Pastor
Peace Lutheran Church
Robbinsdale, Minnesota
LEGAL COUNSEL
ROBERT M. SKARE, ATTORNEY
Best & Flanagan
Minneapolis, Minnesota
Administration
BERNT C. OPSAL/President
J. PHILIP WORTHINGTON/
Academic Dean
JOHN V. GRONLl/Dean of Students
RUSSELL B. HELGESEN/Director of
Development
MARILYN J. ADAMS/Registrar
LOIS STRAND/Financial Aid Director
ALTON C.O. HALVERSON/Director
of Public Relations
THOMAS R. HANSON/Director of
Admissions
VIVIAN WIEMERSLAGE/Business
Office Manager
Faculty
VERNON J. BITTNER/Counselor
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
B.D., Northern Baptist Theological
Seminary, Chicago, IL; S.T.M., Luther
Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN;
S.T.D., San Francisco Theological Seminary, San Francisco, CA 1978-
WILLIAM BOLM/Physical Education,
Recreation,Cou nselor
B.S., Western Michigan University, Kalamazoo, Ml; M.A. (Physical Education),
St. Thomas College, St. Paul, MN; M.A.
(Counseling), St. Thomas College, St.
Paul, MN 1971JOHN L. BREKKE/Sociology
B.A., Northwestern College, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., College of St. Thomas,
St. Paul, MN; additional graduate study,
University of Minnesota, Minneapolis,
MN 1975ROGER W. BROWN/Law Enforcement
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; graduate study, Mankato
State University, Mankato, MN 1979DOUGLAS CAREY /Voice
B.S. and M.Ed., University of North
Dakota, Grand Forks, North Dakota
1978JACQOL YN CHERNE/English, Applied
Christianity
B.A., Augsburg College, Minneapolis,
MN; M.A., United Theological Seminary, New Brighton, MN; graduate
study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1967, 1970
MICHAEL J. CRAWLEY /Karate
A.A., Inver Hills Community College,
Inver Hills, MN; B.A., Business Administration, Metro State University,
St. Paul, MN 1980
GERALD L. DAHL/Sociology
B.A. Wheaton College, Wheaton, IL;
M.S.W., University of Nebraska,
Lincoln, NB; member of Academy of
Certified Social Workers. 1975-
78
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
SONJA M. DAHLAGER/Business and
Personal Orientation
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
graduate study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1979STEVEN W. DOVE/Physical
Education, Philosophy
B.A., Concordia College, Moorhead,
MN; M.Ed., University of Minnesota,
Minneapolis, MN; graduate study,
Mankato State University, Mankato,
MN and St. Cloud State University, St.
Cloud, MN 1981PAUL E. DRANGEID/Biology,
Physical Education
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.S., South Dakota State University,
Brookings, S.D.; graduate work at:
Colorado School Mines, Golden, CO;
University of Chattanooga, TN; University of West Virginia, Morgantown,
WV; University of Vermont, Burlington, VT; Philadelphia College of Pharmacy and Science, PA; Boyce Thompson Plant Research Institute, Yonkers,
N.Y.; Ripon College, WS; Knox College, Galesburg, IL. 1979WILLIAM P. EFFERTZ/Law
Enforcement
B.B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; advanced study, FBI
Academy, 1976JANICE EGGERSGLUESS/Business
Education
B.A., Gustavus Adolphus College St.
Peter, MN; M.S., St. Cloud State
University, St. Cloud, MN 1969JEANNE EKHOLM/Music
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN
1978JAMES D. FREEMAN/Theatre
B.A., University of Idaho, Moscow,
Idaho; M.A. and Ph.D. course work
completed, University of Minnesota,
Minneapolis, MN 1982JANICE GRAVDAHL/Business
Education
B.S., Bemidji State University, Bemidji,
MN 1972-
JOHN V. GRONLl/Dean of Students,
Philosophy, Biblical Theology
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M. Div., Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN; M.A.,
Pacific Lutheran University, Tacoma,
WA; additional graduate study, Pacific
Lutheran Theological Seminary, Berkeley, CA; D. Min., Luther Theological
Seminary, St. Paul, MN 1976RUTH A. HALVERSON/Journalism
B.A., St. Cloud State University, St.
Cloud MN; additional study, University
of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1977LEE ANNE HANSEN/English, German
B.A., Augsburg College, Minneapolis,
MN; Graduate School, University of
Munich, Munich, Germany; finished
courses for Ph.D., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1973ALLEN L. HANSON/Chemistry
B.A., Concordia College, Moorhead,
MN; M.S., Ph.D., State University of
Iowa, Iowa City, IA 1980THOMAS R. HANSON/Director
of Admissions
B.S.B, University of Minnesota, Minapolis, MN; M.B.A., Rensselaer Polytecnic Institute; Troy, NY 1982JOHN HASTINGS/Residence Hall
Director, Biology, Personal Orientation
A.A., Golden Valley Lutheran College,
Minneapolis, MN; B.A., University of
Minnesota, Duluth, MN; additional
study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1981DOROTHY L. HAUGEN/Physical
Education
B.S., Wheaton College, Wheaton, IL
1978PAUL T. HIRDMAN/Sociology,
Psychology, Counselor
A.A., Waldorf College, Forest City, IA;
B.A.; Augsburg College, Minneapolis,
MN; M. Div., Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN; Ph.D., University
of North Dakota, Grand Forks, North
Dakota 1979-
DIRECTORY
JUDY HYLAND/Applied Christianity
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
graduate study, University of California
at Berkeley, Berkeley, CA; College of
Chinese Studies, Baguio, Philippines
1981JEAN JOHNSON/Business Education
B.S., University of North Dakota,
Grand Forks, ND 1974PATRICIA M. JOHNSON/English,
Speech
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
graduate study, Georgetown University, Washington, D.C. and University
of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1981PRI I DU Kl I VE/Physics, Mathematics
B.A., Berea College, Berea, KY; M.A.
University of Buffalo, Buffalo, NY 1973MARK KROLL/Computer Science
Bachelor of Mathematics, University
of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN;
Course work completed for E.E. Masters and Ph.D. in Mathematics, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN
1982GAIL LANDO/English
B.A., Wisconsin State, Eau Claire, WI;
additional graduate study, St. Cloud
State University, St. Cloud, MN 1972PHYLLIS LARSON/English, Mission
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A.T., College of St.
Thomas, St. Paul, MN; course work
completed for Ph.D. in Asian Studies,
University of Minnesota, Minneapolis,
MN 1973RICHARD LAUE/History Political
Science
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of Minnesota; additional graduate study,
University of Strasbourg, France. 1966SEVERT LEGRED/Physical
Education
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A., Mankato State College, Mankato, MN; additional graduate study,
Southern Illinois University, Carbondale, IL. 1969-
79
LUTHER LERSETH/Biblical
Theology,
B.A., Augustana College, Sioux Falls,
S. Dakota; B. Th., Luther Theological
Seminary, St. Paul, MN 1978ALLEN C. LINDHOLM/Law
Enforcement
B.S., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; J.D., Hamline University, College of Law, St. Paul, MN
1981HERBERT G. LODDIGS/Biblical
Theology, Greek
B.A., Wagner College, Staten Island,
NY; New York University, Hartwick
Seminary, Brooklyn, NY; C. Th., Luther Seminary, St. Paul, MN; additional
graduate study, College of Chinese
Studies, Baguio, Philippines; School
of Chinese Studies, Hankow, China;
Princeton Theological Seminary,
Princeton, NJ 1957KATHLEEN D. LOGAN/English
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A., Loyola University, Chicago, IL
1982WILLIAM E. LUNDQUIST/Physical
Education
B.S., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.Ed., University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1966PATRICK D. McGOWAN/Law
Enforcement
B.S., Mankato State University, Mankato, MN 1981HAROLD E. MOORE, JR./Business,
Director of Counseling Services
B.A., University of Denver, Denver,
CO; J.D., University of Denver, College of Law, Denver, CO; additional
study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; United Theological
Seminary, New Brighton, MN 1980PA TRICIA NORTWEN/Piano
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of Minnesota 1967-
80
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
BERNT C. OPSAL/President
B.A., Upsala College, East Orange,
NJ; B. Th., Luther Seminary, St. Paui,
MN; Biblical Seminary, New York, NY;
M.A., New York University, New York,
NY; additional graduate study, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN;
Litt. D., Concordia College, St. Paul,
MN 1954MAHLON PITNEY /Psychology,
Counselor
B.A., Macalester College, St. Paul, MN;
M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1970MARLO F. PUTZ/Biology
B.S., Gustavus Adolphus College, St.
Peter, MN; M.A., St. Cloud State
University, St. Cloud, MN 1968JAMES C. ROBERTSON/Law
Enforcement
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A. course work completed, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1976PAUL 0. ROM ST AD/Theology
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M. Div., Luther Theological Seminary,
St. Paul, MN 1981AL SCHOBER/Chemistry
B.A., Augsburg College, Minneapolis,
MN; M.S., Purdue University, Lafayette,
IN 1971DOROTHY SEAGARD/Music, Voice
and Choral
B.M., Westminster Choir College,
Princeton, NJ; graduate study, Chicago
Opera Guild; Eastman School of Music,
Rochester, NY; University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1962JOHN C. SEAGARD/Music, Choral,
Organ B.M:, M.M., Eastman School of
Music, Rochester, NY; Lutheran Bible
Institute; Augustana College, Rock
Island, IL; Westminster Choir College,
Princeton, NJ; Chicago Opera Repertoire Guild; additional graduate study,
Eastman School of Music, Rochester,
NY 1962RICHARD M. SERENA/Librarian
B.S., Columbia University, New York,
NY; M.L.S., Columbia University, New
York, NY 1976-
MARYS. SICILIA/ American Studies,
Personal Orientation and Speech
B.S., Northwestern Coiiege, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; Ph.D., course
work completed University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN
1977PAUL W. SIEMERS/Theatre
B.A., Bethel College, Roseville, MN;
M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; Ph.D. coursework completed, University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1981ROGER SNYDER/Music, Band and
Orchestra
B.S., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1977MARI LYN A. ST ALH El M/English and
Librarian
B.S., University of Wisconsin, Eau Claire,
WI; M.S., University of Wisconsin, Stout,
WI 197.6MARLIN STENE/ Applied Christianity
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
B. Th., Luther Theological Seminary, St.
Paul, MN; S.T.M., Wartburg Seminary,
Dubuque, IA; Barrett Biblical Seminary,
post S.T.M. work, 1977GERALD SWANSON/ Art
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; M.F.A., University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN 1972KA THRYN SWANSON/English
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN;
M.A., University of Minnesota, Minneappolis, MN 1971CAROL J. TOMER/Residence Hall
Director, Mathematics and
Philosophy;
B.A. Luther College, Decorah, IA; additional study, University of Minnesota,
Minneapolis, MN; Luther Northwestern
Theological Seminary, St. Paul, MN
1980LOIS UTZINGER/Music
B.A., Carleton College, Northfield,
Minnesota; M.M., University of Michigan, Ann Arbor, Ml; additional graduate study, University of Michigan, Ann
Arbor, Ml; University of North Dakota,
DIRECTORY
81
RUSSELL A. VIKSTROM/Biblical
Theology, Applied Christianity
B.A., Augustana College, Rock Island,
IL; M. Div., Augustana Seminary, Rock
Island, IL; additional graduate study,
Biblical Seminary, New York, NY; Luther Theological Seminary, St. Paul,
MN 1953-
Student Services Personnel
JERRY M. WALLEVAND/Biblical
Theology
B.A., University of Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN; B.A., Luther College, Decorah, IA; B.Th., Luther Theological
Seminary, St. Paul, MN; Ph.D., University of St. Andrews, Scotland; graduate
study Edinburgh University, Edinburgh,
Scotland 1982-
JULIE A. ELHARD/Residence
Hall Director, CSA Coordinator
B.A., Concordia College, Moorhead,
MN
J. PHILIP WORTHINGTON/ Academic
Dean, Biblical Theology
B.A., Gustavus Adolphus College, St.
Peter, MN; C.T.; Luther Theological
Seminary, St. Paul, MN; S.T.M., Biblical
Seminary, New York, NY; M.A., New
York University, course work completed for Ed.D., New York University,
New York, NY 1974-
DEON M. LIEN/Residence Hall
Director
B.A., St. Olaf College, Northfield, MN
CHERYL M. ECKSTAM/Housing
Director, Counselor
B.A., University of North Carolina at
Greensboro, Greensboro, NC; M.Ed.,
University of Virginia. Charlottesville,
VA
MARK W. HOVREN/
Residence Hall Director
B.A., Concordia College, Moorhead,
MN; additional study, University of
Minnesota, Minneapolis, MN
LOIS NYSTUL/Director of
Health Service
R.N., Fairview School of Nursing, Minneapolis, MN; B.A., Metropolitan State
University, St. Paul, MN
DOUGLAS L. SILL/Manager,
Student Union
A.A., Golden Valley Lutheran College,
Minneapolis, MN; additional study,
South Dakota State University, Brookings, SD; Dunwoody Institute, Minneapolis, MN; St. Paul Bible College,
St. Bonifacius, MN
SALLY TA VERNI ER/Security Officer
A.A., Golden Valley Lutheran College,
Minneapolis, MN
82
GOLDEN VALLEY LUTHERAN COLLEGE
INDEX
Academic Honors ................ 30
Academic Program ............... 29
Accreditation .................... 9
Activity Credits .................. 32
Administration ................... 77
Admissions Procedures ........... 17
Adult Students ................... 18
Affiliations ....................... 9
Agriculture ...................... 44
Alcohol and Drug ................ 13
Anthropology .................... 62
Application Fee .................. 17
Applied Christianity .............. 74
Art .......................... 67, 68
Associate in Arts Degree ...... 36, 37
Athletics ........................ 14
Attendance, Classroom ........... 31
Automobiles ..................... 13
Band ........................ 14, 69
Biblical and Theological
Studies .................... 41, 55
Bible Requirement ............... 32
Biology ...................... 64, 65
Board and Room Costs ........... 20
Board of Regents ............ 76, 77
Books and Supplies .............. 22
Business ..................... 41, 71
Calendar ........................ 4
Chapel .......................... 13
Charges by Quarter .............. 20
Chemistry ....................... 65
Choir ....................... 14, 69
Christian Service ................. 74
Church History .................. 56
Church Staff Work ............... 51
Classics .......................... 44
Co-curricular Activity Credits ..... 32
Computer Training ............... 47
Corrective Therapy ............... 45
Costs ......................... 19-22
Counseling Services .............. 11
Course Descriptions ........... 55-75
Dentistry ........................ 44
Deposits and Fees ......... 17, 18, 20
Directory ..................... 76-81
Dormitories ..................... 12
Drama .......................... 14
Economics ....................... 71
Education ....................... 42
Electronics Technician ............ 47
Eligibility for Varsity Sports ........ 31
Employment, Student ............. 25
English ...................... 57, 58
English Requirement ............. 32
Entrance Requirements ........... 17
Faculty ....................... 77-81
Fees ..................... 17, 18, 20
Financial Aid .................... 23
Foreign Language ................ 58
Forestry ......................... 44
General Guidelines ............... 9
General Information ............. 7
General Secretarial ........... 48, 52
Geography ...................... 60
German ......................... 58
Gift Aid ......................... 24
Grades and Honor Points ......... 30
Graduation Requirements ........ 35
Greek ........................... 58
Health Services .................. 11
History .......................... 59
History of College ................ 7
Housing Services ................. 12
Humanities ...................... 60
Incomplete Work ................ 30
Independent Study ............... 32
Institutional Objectives ........... 8
Instrumental Instruction ...... 68, 69
Insurance ....................... 12
Junior College Certificate ......... 38
INDEX
Law ............................. 44
Law Enforcement ............ 47, 73
Legal Secretarial ............. 48, 52
Liberal Arts, Basic ................ 40
Library .......................... 12
Loans ........................... 25
Location of the College ........... 7
Mathematics ................. 62, 63
Medical Secretarial ........... 49, 53
Medicine ........................ 44
Mission ............... 51, 53, 74, 75
Music .............. 14, 43, 46, 68, 69
New Testament Studies ....... 55, 56
Nursing ......................... 45
Occupational Therapy ............ 45
Office Administration ........ 50, 53
Old Testament Studies ............ 55
Orchestra ................... 14, 69
Orientation ...................... 32
83
Science, Basic .................... 40
Scholarships ..................... 26
Secretarial Curricula ........... 48-52
Secretarial Science ........... 72, 73
Social Life ....................... 12
Social Science ................... 59
Social Service ................ 46, 62
Sociology .................... 61, 62
Special Examination .............. 31
Speech .......................... 58
Student Government ............. 12
Student Life ..................... 11
Student Services Personnel ........ 81
Study Skills Assistance ............ 11
Theatre ......................... 70
Theological Studies ............... 56
Transcript Fee ................... 20
Transfer of Credits ............ 9, 31
Transfer Students, Admission of ... 18
Tuition .......................... 20
Unsatisfactory Academic Progress . 30
Parish Secretarial ................. 50
Part-Time Students ........... 19, 29
Payment Plan .................... 21
Personal Orientation ............. 61
Pharmacy ........................ 44
Philosophy of College ............ 8
Philosophy ...................... 60
Physical Education ........... 43, 66
Physical Therapy ................. 45
Physics .......................... 63
Political Science .............. 59, 60
Probation, Academic ............. 31
Programs of Study ............. 39-53
Psychology .................. 60, 61
Recreation Leadership ........ 43, 67
Refunds ......................... 21
Registration ..................... 32
Registration, Changes in .......... 33
Religious Life .................... 12
Repeating a Course .............. 33
Room and Board Costs ........... 20
Vocational Certificate ............ 38
Withdrawals from Class ........... 30
Withdrawals from College ........ 33
Women's Athletics ............... 14
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Interim Catalog, 1983
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
Minneapolis, Minnesota
1983 Interim Catalog
2/1 nterim
POSTMASTER
Volume 113, Number 4
Winter I982
612/300-1001
AUGSBURG COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) is published four times a year in Spring, Summer, Fall,
and Winter by Augsburg College, 731 21st Avenue South, Minneapolis, M ...
Show more
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
Minneapolis, Minnesota
1983 Interim Catalog
2/1 nterim
POSTMASTER
Volume 113, Number 4
Winter I982
612/300-1001
AUGSBURG COLLEGE (USPS #490-310) is published four times a year in Spring, Summer, Fall,
and Winter by Augsburg College, 731 21st Avenue South, Minneapolis, M N 55454. Secondclass postage paid at Minneapolis, Minnesota.
Augsburg College lnterim
The interim i s an integral part of the school year at Augsburg College. It is particularly
intended to be a time for both students and faculty to employ styles of teaching and learning
and to investigate questions and topics in places and ways not possible during the regular
term. Since one course equals a full time load, students should plan t o spend the same
amount of time i n class and preparing for class as they w o u l d for a four course load during
Fall and Spring semesters.
Calendar for Full Credit Courses
.............................................
..................................................
November 8-11
Interim Registration
December 6 ............................................Late Interim Registration
January 3..
First Day of Interim
Class 19:00 a.m.
Class 11 1:00 p.m.
Last day for cancel/add
January 4 . .
January 17..
Last day for determining grading system with Registrar
January 21.. ............................ Last day for withdrawing from full courses
January 28.. ....................................................... Interim ends
..............................................
.................
Calendar for Half Credit Courses
January 3.. ............................... First group of half credit courses begins
January 4 . . ............................. .Last day t o cancel/add half credit courses
January 10..
Last day for determining grading system for half credit courses
January 12..
Last day for withdrawing from half credit courses
First group of half credit courses ends
January 14..
January 17..
Second group of half credit courses begins
January 18.. ............................ .Last day t o cancel/add half credit courses
January 24. .......... Last day for determining grading system for half credit courses
Last day for withdrawing from half credit courses
January 26..
January 28..
Interim ends
.........
......................
................................
...........................
......................
.......................................................
The interim day is divided into two blocks of time:
I - 8:00 - 12:OO Noon
The number and length of class meetings as well as the beginning time will be arranged the
first day of class.
4/l nterim
Essential Information
One course i s considered a full time load during interim and no student i s permitted to
register for more than one course credit during the period.
There is no tuition refund for a student who chooses not to enroll in an interim course.
Most interim courses are graded traditionally on a scale of 4.0 to 0. Students generally have
the option to register on a Pass/No credit basis. A few interim courses are graded only on the
P/N system; this i s indicated in the course description.
Some courses are offered with either upper or lower division standing. Such interim courses
have two numbers listed and the student must select. Students registering for upper division
standing should anticipate additional assignments and a more rigorous grading standard.
To graduate, an Augsburg student is required to complete 35 courses of which at least three
must be interim courses (or one interim less than the number of years of full time enrollment
at Augsburg; e.g., a transfer enrolled full time for two years is required to complete one
interim for graduation.)
This Catalog
This catalog lists courses by departments with departments listed in alphabetical order. At the
end of the book are listings of other courses not offered by Augsburg but recognized by the
College for interim credit. Further descriptions and information about these courses are
available in the lnterim Office, Memorial 230. Students may register for one of the Lifetime
Sports listed on the last page.
Location Key
L-Library Building
M-Music Hall
OM-Old Main
P-Psychology Building
S-Science Hall
Options
June Interim - At least two interim courses will be offered in the June 1983 session of
summer school (see listings under Biology and Education) in lieu of January term, with no
additional tuition charge. Students planning to elect a June interim must register at the time
of interim registration in the fall. Students wishing to take the June interim in addition to the
January one will be required to pay the regular summer course tuition.
International Interims-Students are invited to consider being part of one of the six overseas
interims offered by Augsburg College during January 1983. These interims are under the
following departments:
Art - Europe: Art in London and Paris
Foreign Language - Mexico: Basic Conversational Spanish
- Europe: The Rhine Frontier
History - Hawaii: Laboratory of Multi-Ethnic Interaction
Music - Europe: Music in London and Paris
Political Science - Mexico: Theories of Social Change and Revolution
Other international interims are available through Upper Midwest Association for International Education (UMAIE) and St. Olaf College.
Further academic description, travel details and cost estimates are available in the Interim
Office and from Mary Kingsley in the International Center, Old Main 20.
Students interested in participating in one of these international interims should apply in the
International Center before November 1. Additions to the overseas groups usually cannot be
made after that date.
Internships - Students electing an internship interim must present a completed internship
learning contract to the Internship Office (Memorial 230) no later than Tuesday, November
16. Contract forms are available in the same office.
Independent or Directed Study - Students may elect a program of independent study
(upper division 499) or directed study (lower division 299) for interim. Faculty members are
strongly discouraged from accepting responsibility for more than one independent or
directed study per interim. Students choosing to pursue independent or directed study must:
A. Meet departmental requirements,
B. Present to the lnterim Director for approval a copy of the proposed study plan approved
by the supervising faculty member. This proposal must be submitted at least one week
before registration and not later than November 2. Appropriate study proposal forms can
be obtained in the Interim Office.
Interims at Other Schools - Augsburg students may enroll at any other 4-1-4 institution
which offers a reciprocal interim arrangement. Catalogs of these interims can be consulted in
the lnterim Office. The lnterim Secretary will help students in applying for registration at
other schools. Registration for interims at the other Twin Cities colleges will be done at
Augsburg during the regular registration period. Most courses taught during the interim at
other 4-1-4 schools are accepted for credit by Augsburg, but may not necessarily be accepted
as meeting Augsburg's distribution requirements. This qualification particularly affects
courses offered for the Religion requirement.
Non-Augsburg Students
Augsburg College welcomes students from other 4-1-4 schools for the January interim
without tuition charges provided the student's home institution agrees not to charge tuition
to Augsburg students for the January term. The waiver of tuition does not include special
fees, housing or board costs. Other students will be charged $670 for the interim course.
Students interested in registering for an Augsburg lnterim should write to the lnterim
Director for application forms or use the forms provided by the interim office at their own
school. These students are welcome to stay on campus but are not required to do so.
Requests for interim housing should be made to the Interim Office.
Augsburg Policy
Augsburg College admits students of any race, color, national and ethnic origin to all the
rights, privileges, programs, and activities generally accorded or made available to students at
the school. It does not discriminate on the basis of race, color, creed, national and ethnic
origin in employment practices or administration of its educational policies, admissions policies, scholarship and loan programs, and athletic and other school-administered programs.
Need More Help?
Check with:
The lnterim Office (Memorial 230),
The lnterim Secretary, Ruth Maertens at 330-1025, or
The Interim Director, Dr. Don Gustafson at 330-1192.
6/l nterim
Courses
-
16mm Film-Making I Film-Making I1
ART 242 - 4002,342 - 4005
Instructor: Paul Rusten
The procedure, techniques and philosophy of 16mm film-making for expression/communication.
Using professional 16mm equipment, students in teams will produce short black and white
synchronized sound motion pictures.
Students who have successfully completed Film-Making I (or equivalent) may take FilmMaking II, producing an advanced film project within the same class schedule and timeframe as Film-Making I.
Fees: $75.00 for filmstock and equipment rental
Prerequisites for 342: Film-Making I or equivalent
Distribution: Art - Music
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 17
Life Drawing
ART 247 - 4001
Instructor: Norman Holen
A study of undraped figures for art students and non-art students.
The figure will be depicted i n various settings with a variety of media for varying lengths of
time. The poses will extend from one minute to an hour and a half.
You will be introduced to the 2B and 48 pencils, the charcoal pencil, and pastels.
Fees: $20.00 to be paid on the first day of class.
Distribution: Art-Music
Time: I........ Room: O M 17
Europe January 3 - 28
Art in London and Paris
ART 378 - 4006
Instructor: Mary Swanson
This course will study art in the collections of museums in London and Paris. Stylistic,
historical and sociological perspectives will be emphasized in viewing artwork in museums,
galleries and architectural landmarks. Lectures will be given before visiting each museum so
that students will become acquainted with major works i n each collection. Students will keep
a journal on designated major works in each museum or gallery collection noting style,
function, subject, formal organization and medium. Additional opportunities will be provided for students who wish to emphasize a certain period in the history of art.
Fees: $1995
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication & Theater Arts
Human Anatomy and Physiology
BIO 103 - 4009
Instructor: Erwin Mickelberg
This is a one-term course used by nursing students, physical education students and others
who would like to be more knowledgeable about the human body and how it works.
Although the course is as thorough as is possible in one term, there are no science
prerequisites.
I n addition to a systematic study, various questions stimulate discussion and individual study.
Questions relating to product advertising and good nutritional principles, "fad diets," muscle
development and exercise, and many others will arise throughout the course.
The area of Anatomy is dealt with primarily i n the laboratory portion and Physiology in the
lecture portion. About 40 hours are used in each, the laboratory and the lecture room.
Time: Summer Interim.. . . . . . . Room: 5213 lecture, S214 lab
Ethical Issues in the Life Sciences
BIO 106 - 4113
Instructor: Ralph Sulerud
W e are Iivlng in a period of biological revolurlon whfrh scemr llkely to contlnuc. Many of the
d ~ v ~ l a p m e n twill
r , increasingly result in drarnaric changes in cthiral thinking and the
forrnularion of puhtic policy. Questions such as these musr be eflectivefy addre~ced:What
are the rights o( r h unhorn?
~
Shfiulrl hiwlogists he allowed to work on any typc of research no
matter where i t leads? Does the irlea of a moral responslhility toward the environment make
sense? What ethical and social problems would arise as a resull of cloning people? IS
recombinant DNA research likely to rrcate more p r o h l ~ m than
s
II soTves?Is euthanasia ever
justllledl Ir Is intended rhat ihrs courseshould provide a! leas! a small part of the hackground
necessary to answer such questions and make responciblr: ethical choices.
Each topic will he introduced by the instrucrar or a guest, but much of the class time will be
spent discussing assigned readings and various viewpoints. Formulation of a brief position
paper on one of thr! issues will be required. Grades will be based on the paper, class
participation and examination results.
Distribution: Chemistry - Biology
Time: I... . . . Room: 5 205
..
8/l nterim
Heredity, Evolution, and Humankind
BIO 110 - 4010
Instructor: Ralph Sulerud
Where did I come from? What am I ?Where am I going? certainly must rank among the more
fundamental questions which intrigue and torment members of our species. While at one
level we seek philosophical and religious answers, biology is invoked at another level. It i s the
intent of this course to address these questions and others through the study of evolution and
heredity (genetics). The concept of organic evolution continues to have its critics, a matter
which we shall consider. Yet to the vast majority of biologists the evolution of life i s not only
accepted but is regarded as the single most significant contribution which biology has made
to human knowledge. We will study the evidence in support of evolution, the proposed
mechanisms of the evolutionary process, and, as time permits, the course of evolution from
primitive forms to humans. Some principles of genetics will be studied for the primary
purpose of making it possible to understand evolutionary mechanisms. Ways in which people
influence their own evolution and that of other species will be discussed.
Classes will consist largely of lectures and discussions. Grading will be based on quizzes and
tests.
Prerequisites: A high school general biology course
Distribution: Chemistry-Biology
Room: 205
Time: I . .
......
Immunology
BIO 386 - 4011
Instructor: Neal Thorpe
A study of the immune system, emphasizing antibody structure and function, cell-mediated
immunity, the development of the immune system, immunopathology, molecular recognition at cell surfaces as related to immune phenomena, and cancer biology and immunology.
immunological and serological techniques will be considered and demonstrated.
Lectures and discussions with grades based on examinations.
Prerequisites: BIO 111,112
Time: 11.. ...... Room: S205
Laboratory Introduction to Chemistry
CHM 113 - 4014
Instructor: Earl Alton
way of learning
Finding which chemicals are I n a solutlon (qualltatlve analysis) Is a challengrn~
some principles of chemisrrj. This course will use laharntory experiments coupled with an
essentially non-mathematical explanation of the chemistry Involved to provid~a n introduction to chemistry. The laboratory work will center on solving chemical unknowns. There will
be several lecture-discussion r~sslonseach weck and about three hours of laboratory ~ a c h
day. Grading will be based upon solving unknowns and a few quizzes.
Prerequisites: High School Chemistry
Distribution: Chemistry - Biology
Time: This class will meet January 3 at 12:30. Thereafter it will meet as follows:
Lectures - 12:30 - 1:30 T,Th,F
Lab
- 8:30 -11:30 T,Th,F
- 1:30 - 4:30 T,Th..
Room: S 318
......
Physical Chemistry For The Life Sciences
CHM 301 - 4015
Instructor: Richard D. Olmsted
Objectives: The object of this course is to provide a working knowledge of basic physical
chemistry to students whose primary academic interests lie in the life sciences. This course
will provide a sound development of physical chemistry based on physical ideas and will use
only the minimum mathematical treatment of the material that will enable students to use
their new knowledge to solve relevant biochemical problems.
Topics Covered: Properties of matter and molcculrs, energy changes in chemical reactions,
entropy and the d i r e d o n of chemical change, f r ~ eenergy, chemical equilibrium and
chemical driving forces, equilibria in chrmlcal and biological systems, physlcal ~ q ~ l i l i h rand
ia
membrane phenomena. rates of transport processes, rates of ch~mit.alreaction, rcaction
mechanisms, rpraroscopy and quantum mechanics, molecules in crystals dnd molecular
structures.
Evaluation: Each student will be assigned a grade based on performance on in-class
examinations.
Prerequisites: 1 term Organic Chemistry, 1 term of Calculus
Time: I. ....... Room: S 318
Microeconomics Applied To Managerial Problems
ECO 451 - 4013
Instructor: Satya P. Gupta
I n teaching microeconomics most of the emphasis i s on developing the theoretical tools with
some scattered applications. This course, assuming the basic understanding of microeconomic tools, will concentrate on applying price theory to specific business decisions.
Grades will be based on one report and an examination.
Prerequisites: ECO 251 or Instructor's consent
Room: L 1
Time: 1 1 . .
......
Discovery in the World
of Kindergarten
EDE 375 - 4018
Instructor: Lauretta Pelton
This course i s a study of the kindergarten curriculum, an exploration of resources and
materials and a review of teaching approaches.
Laboratory requirement: Five half days in a kindergarten classroom. This is t o be arranged by
the student after consultation with the instructor. The laboratory experience should have
taken place prior t o the course itself.
The course is a prerequisite to student teaching at the kindergarten level and to obtaining a
license for teaching at that level.
Prerequisites: Consent of instructor
Time: Summer Interim.. ...... Room: to be announced
l O / l nterim
Theories of Learning Disabilities
EDE 383 - 4016, EDS 383 - 4017
Instructor: Barry Franklin
This course will examine the principal theories that have been advanced during the past 80
years t o explain the nature, causes, and treatments for learning disabilities. I n examining
these theories we will look at the behavioral charactCristics, methods of diagnosis, relationship between behavior and brain involvement, and treatment approaches advocated by
major theorists and practitioners in the field.
The course requirements include two take-home essay examinations and a short paper in
which the student will examine the work of a major theorist of the field. There will be a
number of field trips to look at representative learning disabilities programs in the Twin
Cities.
This course can be used as an elective in the special education minor. I t is designed for
students in education, psychology, social work, nursing, music therapy and corrective
therapy who anticipate working with handicapped individuals who exhibit learning and/or
behavioral disabilities.
Prerequisites: A general psychology course or consent of the instructor.
Time: I . . ...... Room: O M 11
Student Teaching
EDS 481 - 4023 EDC 481 - 4019
EDS 482 - 4024 EDC 482 - 4020
EDS 483 - 4025 EDC 483 - 4021
EDS 484 - 4026 EDC 484 - 4022
Instructor: Marie McNeff
Observing and directing learning under supervision of college and secondary school
personnel. This is a full day experience in a school.
Prerequisites: Acceptance in Education Program and permission of instructor.
Grading: P/N only
Room: L 6
Time: I . .
......
People Under Pressure
ENG 211 - 4027
Instructor: Barbara Andersen
The child, the youth, the middle-aged, the old, all live under pressure-political, social,
religious and personal. What these pressures are and how people cope with them provide the
focus for the course. This is not, however, a course in depression, for pressure and stress
often have positive results. And many people respond to pressure with courage, grace and
even wit.
We will read several genres, mostly of the 20th century, and works that are not usually
covered in literature courses. Among the works being considered are Waters, The Man Who
Killed the Deer; Potok, M y Name i s Asher Lev; Brautigan, Trout Fishing i n America; Wright,
Native Son; Pym, Excellent Women; Hassler, Simon's Night; Lindbergh, Gift from the Sea;
Turgenev, Fathers and Sons; Albee, The American Dream and The Zoo Story; Anderson, I
Never Sang for M y Father; Gordon, Final Payments. Students will have some choice of works
to read.
Evaluation will be based on discussions, some in-class writing, reading quizzes, oral reports
(optional) and two examinations.
Distribution: English - Speech, Communication & Theater Arts
Time: I . . ...... Room: O M 10
The American Short Story
ENG 241 - 4028
Instructor: Toni Clark
This course will feature films from the PBS series, The American Short Story. We will read the
seventeen stories comprising this series as well as numerous others from the American
Renaissance t o the present. Short fiction by women and men will be read. There will be a fee
of approximately $10 for films.
Evaluation will be based on class discussion, quizzes, papers and exams.
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication and Theater Arts
Time : I . . ...... Room: M 2 2
Literature Performed in the Twin Cities
ENG 269 - 4029,369 - 4030
Instructor: Richard B. Sargent
During January, we will attend a selection of the many plays and readings presented in the
Twin Cities. The emphasis will be on theater, but we will also attend poetry readings and prose
readings at places suc.h as the Loft and the Walker. We will be attending plays at theaters such
as the Guthrie, Actors' Theatre of St. Paul, Playwrights' Lab, and the Rarig. Students will keep
a journal of responses. Students will be responsible for paying for tickets, but we will take
advantage of group rates whenever feasible. We will have group discussion of performances,
and will be meeting with actors, directors, and writers for after-performance discussions.
There will be a few assigned readings. Those taking the course for upper division credit will
be expected to do an additional research paper.
Fees: Approximately $30 for tickets for plays and readings.
Distribution: English-Speech, Communication and Theater Arts
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 11
Five College Creative Writing Workshop (Fiction)
ENG 362 - 4097
Instructor: Jonis Agee, The College of St. Catherine
We will work to discover the necessary relationship between form and content, language and
narration, and character and voice, and to develop the special discipline that writing fiction
requires. We will attend some readings in the area by visiting writers. The format will be a
workshop, in which we will share what we read, what we write, and what we dream.
Participation i n this workshop will be limited to three Augsburg students who will be
selected on the basis of short manuscripts of fiction to be submitted to Toni Clark by
November 1. Contact Professor Clark (L 215, ext. 1053) for further details.
Time: 11.. ...... Room: at College of St. Catherine, to be announced
12/l nterim
Europe: January 3 - 28
The Rhine Frontier:
Germany Meets Rome and France
GER 333 - 4032
Instructor: Donald Steinmetz
I
Since Roman times, the lands along the Rhine have been one of the most significant frontier
areas of Europe. Here German and Roman cultures clashed and mixed. Here modern
Germany and France have their roots i n the empire of Charlemagne. Here romanesque and
gothic architecture flourished in the Middle Ages. Here Germans and French fought in three
recent wars. It is such events which have shaped life and left so many monuments between
the Rhine and the Meuse. The student will study and "relive" the history of this area on
location, from the Roman monuments of Trier and Cologne, Charlemagne's Aachen, to the
battlefields of World Wars I and II and the dynamic society of present-day Germany. The
course will be conducted primarily in Trier, Germany, with excursions to nearby sites. Trier i s
ideal for this purpose. Perhaps the oldest city in Germany, Trier is rich in monuments dating
from Roman times to the present, and important historical sites of five countries are less than
100 miles away. Lectures, discussions, and readings will be principally in German according to
the student's entering level of competence.
Cost: $1690
Prerequisites: German 112 or equivalent
Distribution: Foreign Language
Beginning Norwegian
Nor 111 - 4033
Instructor: Leif Hansen
The course provides an introduction to the basic skills of listening, speaking, reading, and
writing. The first class sessions are conducted without the use of a printed text. Later class
sessions provide a thorough introduction to the structures of contemporary Norwegian, but
oral expression i s emphasized throughout the course. Oral and written tests. Laboratory work
expected.
Distribution: Foreign Language
Time: 11.. . . . . . . Room: O M 29
Norwegian Conversation and Composition
Nor 311 - 4034
Instructor: Leif Hansen
Intensive practice in spoken Norweg~anwith emphasis on pronunciation and original
composition. Some attention given to regional variations in spoken Norwegian and to
differences between the two official languages of Norway. Laboratory work and field
experience required.
Prerequisites: 211 or equivalent
Time: To be arranged with instructor.. . . . . . Room: O M 29
.
Mexico: January 3 - 27
Basic Conversational Spanish
SPA 113 - 4031
Instructor: Mary A. Kingsley
Basic Conversational Spanish Is designed for students who have already covered the structures of the present, preterite. and imperfect tenses and arc ready to put their knowledge to
use on the scene in Mexico. There will he regular in-classsessions, small group conversations,
as well as a great d ~ aol l opportunity to use Spanish aclively and passively in conducting
Interviews, shopping, attending lectures, and just making Mexico home for a month.
Grading will be based on class participation, quizzes, and a final exam which will be written
and oral. Original materials will be used as the text.
Basic Conversational Spanish and Theories of Social Change and Revolution (see Political
Science) will have the same itinerary (Mexico, Oaxaca, Cuernavaca), and all the students will
be encouraged to take advantage of the opportunities presented by each of the courses. A lot
of time outside of class will be spent in informal group discussions.
Cost: $1195
Prerequisites: Spanish Ill or 2 years of high school Spanish
Distribution: Foreign Language for those needing 112 or 211.
Recreational Rhythms and Activities
HPE 232 -4076
Instructor: Staff
Theory and practice in teaching and performing American heritage and international folk
dances. Exposure to New Games concepts and activities. The majority of the course grade is
based upon participation in class activities, a teaching assignment, and a written test.
This offering equals only 1/2 course credit.
Time:ll -Jan. 3-13... . . . . . Room: Melby
Administration and Supervision
of the School Health Program
HPE 410 - 4036
Instructor: Richard Borstad
Historical background, legal bases, school health services, and relationships to community
health program and resources. Methods and materials in health education with laboratory
experience in classroom and community.
Periodic exams covering lecture and textbook assignments; written summaries of professional
journal articles; in-class activities, including a presentation on a teaching method.
Prerequisites: Health 320
Time: I . .. . . . . . Room: Melby I3
14/l nterim
Prevention and Care of Athletic Injuries
HPE475 -4035
Instructor: Al Kloppen
Emphasis placed on preventing injuries. Treatment of common athletic injuries. Practical
experience in taping and training-room procedures.
Prerequisites: HPE 350 Kinesiology
This course equals only 1/2 course credit.
Time: I -Jan. 3 13.. . . . Room: Melby 12
-
.. .
Coaching of Basketball
HPE477-4078
Instructor: Dave Boots
Theory, techniques and administration of coaching men's and women's basketball. Course
will include off-season, pre-season and in-season programs. Grade evaluation will be based
on preparation of a coaching notebook, a written exam and general participation.
There will be some out of class night work.
Prerequisites: Consent of instructor.
This course equals only 1/2 course credit.
Time: I l -Jan. 17 - 28.. . . . . . . Room: Melby I 3
Coaching of Hockey
HPE478-4079
Instructor: Ed Saugestad
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching hockey.
This course equals only 1/2 course credit.
Time: I - Jan. 17 - 28.. . . . . . . Room: Melby 24
Paris in the Nineteenth Century
HIS 114 - 4037
Instructor: Orloue Gisselquist
The French are sometimes accused of thinking of Paris as the "navel of the universe." There's
a bit of "sour grapes" caricature in that clever statement. For if one could pick out a city
which in the last thousand years has been more important to Western Civilization than any
other, one could make a good case for Paris. In this course we will study the history of that
city i n one period of its greatness, the nineteenth century. We will use some readings about
France, Paris, and Modern urbanism, but the main emphasis in our reading and approach to
the subject will be the use of some nineteenth century French novels as historical sources
for the study of Paris. We will thus have the opportunity to study the city of Paris in this
century i n some fullness, read some great literature, and develop our talents in the use of
historical material. As a bonus we will double (maybe quadruple!) our enjoyment of a future
trip to Paris. The course will be conducted in part as a lecture course and in part as a seminar
(discussion of readings, short papers, and shared reports-all part of the evaluation). There
will be a final exam.
Distribution: History-Philosophy: Urban
Time: 11.. . . . . Room: O M 23
..
20th Century South Asia
HIS 162 - 4038
Instructor: Don Gustafson
This geographic area has produced the largest working democracy in the world today; from
this people have come one of our century's greatest "saints" and also one of the most
renowned statesmen; it is a standard example for population crisis and world hunger
illustrations. South Asia is all this-and much more.
This course is designed for the student who has interest but little or no background in
non-western subjects-though others are also welcome. The heart of the course will be i n a
wide assortment of readings (some of them really excellent) but there will also be lectures,
time for discussion and freauent breaks for slide ~resentations.
Grades will be based on geAeral level of participation, on some written work and probably a
test.
Distribution: History - Philosophy
Time: I . . . . . . . . Room: L1
Hawaii January 3 - 27
Hawaii: A Laboratory
of Multi-Ethnic Interaction
HIS 240 - 439,340 - 440
Instructor: Khin Khin Jensen
Observation and study of Asian (Japanese, Chinese, Korean and Philippine), Polynesian
(Hawaiian and Samoan) and Caucasian cultures interacting i n the 50th state. Focus on
historical traditions, immigration patterns, religious heritage, educational experiences, commercial ventures, the media, cultural activities and current issues. Field trips include visits to
the Polynesian Cultural Center, Pearl Harbor-Arizona Memorial, lolani Palace & Bishop
Museum, Buddhist-Taoist Temple, East-West Center at the University of Hawaii, the Hawaiian
City of Refuge in Kona area, and visits with community leaders of varying ethnic backgrounds
in Hilo and Honolulu.
Evaluation will be based on participation in all components of the Interim such as field trips,
lectures and discussion sessions (including pre-interim orientations). Students will keep a
daily journal. There will be required readings.
Cost: $1895
Prerequisites: Upper division-sophomore standing and consent of instructor.
Distribution: History-Philosophy
Grading: P/N only
16/l nterim
The Minnesota Political Tradition
HIS 356 - 4041
Instructor: Carl Chrislock
An interpretive survey of Minnesota political history from territorial days to the present.
Attention will focus not only on narrative political history, but also on the underlying forceseconomic, ethnic, religious and cultural-that have helped shape the state's political culture.
Procedures will be essentially traditional: lecture-discussion, assigned and optional readings,
a term paper or book reviews, and a final examination (basically essay). Some audio-visual
aids (transparencies of political cartoons, video cassettes of Arthur Naftalin's conversations
with Minnesota governors, slides) will be used; and an effort to recruit outside speakers with
political experience will be made.
Prerequisites: One course in U.S. history, or consent of instructor.
Room: M 22
Time: 11..
......
Being and Becoming Well in American Culture
INS 265 - 4043,365 - 4044
Instructor: Ronald Palosaari
Within our culture are forces, patterns, and conditions that contribute to our degree of well
being. During January we will examine American culture trying to understand better some of
those factors that influence our wellness, to use the current popular term.
We will also consider the current wellness movement, examining its impact on American
culture and individually determine what it has to offer.
To take this class, one does not have to eat granola, seaweed, and brown rice nor run five
miles a day: One will be expected to walk or run regularly to class, to read several books and
articles, and to write some short papers. Those taking the class for upper division credit will
be expected to go up steps two at a time and write more extensive papers.
We may take a few field trips in the Twin Cities and one trip to outstate Minnesota. I expect
students to arrange any work schedule if necessary for such trips.
Room: O M 25
Time: I..
......
South Africa: Historical Mirrors,
Economic Laagers and the color Spectrum
INS 270 - 4045
Instructor: Bruce Reichenbach
The goal of the course is to provide a multi-faceted encounter with a complex, fragmented,
yet culturally familiar society. Approximately one week will be devoted to each of the
following topics. I n what ways does the South African experience mirror the American
experience; how do the economic policies of South Africa shape its relations to its economic
satellites and Africa as a whole; what roles do the church, education and athletics have in
molding a multi-cultural society?
The course will be conducted largely in seminar format. During the last three weeks students
will conduct relevant research and make presentations to the class, both individually and in
groups. Academic work will be assessed through tests and evaluation of class presentations.
Room: M 23
Time: I . .
......
Perspectives on the Humanities: The City in
American History, Literature and the Arts, 1865-1914
INS 275 - 4042
Instructor: Grier Nicholl
Rapid industrialization and the growth of cities between the Civil War and World War I
generated significant responses from American writers of fiction and poetry, painters,
photographers and architects.
How did the interpretations of major writers and artists compare to actual historical
developments of the city and technology in the period? What similarities and differences can
be discovered in the ideas, values, and attitudes reflected in literary and artistic responses to
industrialization? The course will examine these and other interdisciplinary questions to lead
the student toward an integrative perspective on the humanities.
Activities in the course will include active participation by urban and art historians; small
group discussions of selected poems of Walt Whitman, selected short stories of Stephen
Crane, and two controversial novels-Theodore Dreiser's Sister Carrie and Upton Sinclair's
The jungle; lecture and slide presentations on painting and architecture; and visits to the
Minneapolis Institute of Arts to view prints and photographs of the city during this period.
There will be three tests and individual oral presentations of projects.
Distribution: Urban
Time: I . . . . . . . Room: O M 21
.
Brush Up
MAT 103 - 4093
Instructor: Bev Durkee
This course is designed as a brush up in arithmetic and elementary algebra skills for students
scoring I on the Mathematics Placement examination. The course will be particularly helpful
for students in elementary education or who will be taking statistics as part of a major. Part of
the work will be done on the computer. There will be diagnostic tests to determine study
needs, homework assignments to gain skills, and written problem solving tests to determine
achievement. Grades will be determined by test scores. Course of study i s completely
individualized.
Prerequisites: Mathematics Placement Examination score I.
Time: I . . . . . . . . Room: S 108
18/l nterim
An Exposure of Chaos in Modern Cosmic Models
MAT 136 - 4047,336 - 4048
Instructor: Henry Follingstad
An exploration of math-retated ideas and Space-Age research which critically re-evaluat~s
present "scientlflt dogmas" on the universe and the smaller cosmic model5 of earth, life, and
mankind. New Space-Agr: dara, much of it ignored or misinterpreted, is uncovered to show
inadequacies and contradictions in cosmology, relativity, macroevolution, and t h ~ i links
r
to
geology, biology, and the humanities.
Class instruction and individual research will include study of the historical and modern
impact of math-related cosmic models, and will note some misuses of mathematics which
have transformed scientific speculation into "scientific fact." A written research paper is
required in one of six major areas discussed.
Upper division students will show broader research scope and writing ability and will present
oral summaries of their papers.
Distribution: Mathematics-Physics
Time: 1 1 . . ...... Room: O M 22
Pattern Processing Through Pascal Programming
MAT 144 - 4049
Instructor: Larry Copes
I n this course students will learn to write elementary computer programs in the Pascal
language. The programs will generate numerical and other mathematical data to be
examined for patterns. With the help of the instructor and each other, students will test
conjectures through data analysis and further programs. Work will be in individual, small
group, and classroom settings. Evaluation will be through individual programs and written
reports.
Prerequisites: Group I l l (formerly A) score on Augsburg Mathematics Placement Examination.
(See instructor if you have not taken this examination.)
Distribution: Math-Physics
Time: I . . ...... Room: S 112
Memorization for Musicians
MUS 151 - 4053, 351 - 4054
Instructor: lames D. Johnson
Multiple approaches to memorizing music via a foolproof system. These systems are derived
from the harmonic, melodic, rhythmic, and formal analysis of the music under study. For
instrumentalists and vocalists.
Upper division students will be expected to memorize more, perform more for the class and
do more memory work away from their instruments.
Prerequisites: Basic music study
Distribution: Music-Art
Time: I.. ...... Room: M 4
Luther-Bach and the Shape of the Liturgy
MUS 167 - 4051
367 - 4052
REL 364 - 4086
Instructors: Larry Fleming
Philip A. Quanbeck
The 500th anniversary of the blrth of Martin I-uther provides thc impetus for this FTOSSdidplinary offerlng focusing on thcrhape of the liturgy in t h r reformation and the historical.
theolo~icaland musicological background out nf which the Mass In R minor by I. S. Bach
emergps. Plenary sessions will be addrrsscd by Charles Anderson, Larry Flemlng, and Philip
(Suanheck. Stuttents may elect e i t h ~ one
r
of the supplernenlary group sessions.
1. Musico!ngiral - Baroque p~rformancepracrice, contras~lngMass seftings, t e ~ t l ~foreal
runners will be sti~diedtogether with detailed musical enrl theological analysis of the
complete score with instrumental and choral realization.
2. Religion - The shape of the liturgy. Historical development of the Mass, historical and
theological background of the reformation and the renaissance.
This course may not be used toward a music major.
Grades will be based on participation and examination. Upper Division credit will require
additional work.
Prerequisites: Religion - one course in religion
Music - consent of instructor
Time: 11.. . .. . .. Room: M 23
Europe January 3 - 28
Music in London and Paris
MUS 378 - 4045
Instructor: Robert Karlen
rt
These two great European cultural centers will be visited so that students might experience
the cultural milieu that produced such musical giants as Purcell, Handel, Britten, Franck,
Berlioz, and Stravinsky.
Performances ro be attended will include oprrctra, baller, chamber music, and symphonic
concerts hy leading orchee~ralensernbl~s.There will be opportunities to attend worrhip
services in the magnificent catherlralc of there rwo rap~lalcllfer. L@cturcsdesrxihing the
special sljinillcancc of the music ro h c heard, and p r o v i d i n ~importani hackgrai~ndinformation, wil/ h~ supplemenred by visits lo museums and libraries to see r o l l e c t i o n ~of
historical musical instriimrntr and view manuscript srorez or famous composers,
Evaluation will be made on the basis of attendance at lectures, participation in class activities,
four written concert reviews, and an informal final examination.
Cost: $1995
Distribution: Art-Music
Grading: P/N only
20/l nterim
Trends and Issues in Nursing
NUR 330 - 4055,330 - 4091
Instructors: Nancy Malcolm, Helen Woelfel
This course is intended to give students a broad perspective by introducing current trends
and issues in health care and the profession of nursing. Many of the issues are controversial,
are relevant to current practice and have potential for far-reaching effects in health care.
Students will be graded on group presentations and written examinations.
Prerequisites: Registered Nurse
Time: I or 4-8 p.m.. ....... Room: O M 12
Philosophy of Love
-
PHI 145 4056
Instructor: M . L. Fuehrer
This course presents an analysis of the four types of human love, seeking to locate their place
in human experience. Certain key writings of philosophers and works of literature will be
analyzed with this objective in mind. Evaluation will be based on written essay examination.
There will be a very small fee to cover film expenses.
Distribution: History-Philosophy
Room: O M 22
Time: I..
......
1983 Oak Ridge Associated Universities
Science Minimester
PHY 322 1 4057
Instructor: Kermit E. Paulson
A study of nuclear radiation detection and measurement with emphasis on applications in the
sciences and "hands-on" laboratory experience for the individual student. The course will
consist of (1) introductory work on nuclear radiation physics at Augsburg, (2) participation in
the 1983 Oak Ridge Associated Universities Science Minimester where the student will study
nuclear radiation physics, radiobiology, radiochemistry, radioecology, environmental radiation, health physics, and radiation safety; and (3) summary and evaluation of the program
back at Augsburg. Student's performance evaluation based on laboratory performance,
laboratory record, and formal laboratory reports on selected experiments.
This course is a cooperative venture with Oak Ridge Associated Universities-Professional
Training programs. Two weeks of the course will be spent in Oak Ridge, Tennessee utilizing
the instructional staff and laboratory facilities of ORAU. These facilities provide an opportunity for laboratory experience not normally available to undergraduate students.
The estimated cost for transportation and housing i s $275.
Prerequisites: Consent of instructor.
Time: 11.. ...... Room: S 112
Special Functions and their Applications
in the Physical Sciences
PHY 327 - 4058
Instructor: Mark Engebretson
Certain mathematical functions find use throughout the physical sciences and engineering
dlsdplinc~because of the high d e w ~ eof symmetry they can rppresent. This course will
acquainf the studcnl wlth three cijtegories of functions and ihelr applications: Legendre
polynomiats and spherical harmonics, Fourier serie~and rransforms, and functions of a
cnmpl~wvahable. High resolut~ongraphics using the T e k t r o n i ~1051 Graphic Computer will
hr u w d t o enhance underslanding of I h r syrnm~trtcsinvolvrd.
Student performance will be evaluated on the basis of several problem sets and project.
Prerequisites: Physics 122 or consent of instructor; Mathematics 224 or equivalent
Time: I... . . . . . Room: O M 21
The Supreme Court and the Supreme Being
POL 177-4060
Instructor: Myles C. Stenshoel
A n analytical case study approach to the Supreme Court's role as policy-maker, constitutional
interpreter and political subsystem, using the Court's church-state decisions from 1940 to
1983 as substantive focus.
Objectives of the class will be to help students (1) understand the political nature of the
American judicial system; (2) achieve competency in the analysis and criticism of original
SOUFCPS, I.e., judicial opinions and decisions; and (3) recognize the complexity of constitutional interprrtation and the interplay of values, precedents, personalities and interests in the
development of constitutional law.
Teaching methods will include lecture, library research, class presentations and discussions.
Evaluations will be based on (1) brief research reports, (2) quizzes and (3) class participation.
Prerequisites: None, other than freshman or sophomore status.
Distribution: Political Science-Economics
Time: 1 1 . . . . . . . Room: M 24
.
22/l nterim
Mexico: January 3 - 27
Theories of Social Change
and Revolution
POL 383-4059
Instructor: M u l f o r d Q. Sibley
This will be a course which surveys modern conceptions of social and political change and
revolution. Beginning with the European background i n days immediately after the French
Revolution, it will consider such theories as those of the utopian socialists, anarchists, liberals,
Tolstoyans, and Marxists. Particular attention will be devoted t o the place of economic factors
i n social change. Hobson's theory of imperialism, as well as Lenin's, will be considered.
Malthusians and neo-Malthusians, with their population and resources conceptions, will
occupy an important place. The modern world of North-South and East-West tensions will
constitute part of the background for modern theories of revolution. I s violence compatible
with democratic and egalitarian revolution? What is the theory of non-violent revolution?
During the latter part of the course, many of these questions will be examined i n the context
of Latin America i n general and of Mexico in particular.
Evaluation will be based o n class participation and the submission of a journal.
Theories of Social Change and Revolution and Basic Conversational Spanish (see Foreign
Languages) will have the same itinerary (Mexico City, Oaxaca, Cuernavaca), and all students
will be encouraged t o take advantage of the opportunities presented by each of the courses.
A lot of time outside of class will be spent in informal group discussions.
Cost: $1195
Distribution: Political Science-Economics
Grading: P/N only
U.S. Foreign Policy Today: Comparative Perspectives
POL 495 - 4084
Instructor: Mary Ellen Lundsten
This course will analyze current U.S. foreign policy problems i n two strategic regions: the
Middle East and the Caribbean. Course objectives include:
A. Examining central aspects of U.S. policy in what i s called the North-South dimension of
world politics. For this objective we will look at both (1) the dilemmas for U.S. policy makers
who must relate American interests in Third World countries within U.S. global strategy and
(2) the tensions created within Third World societies as their governments attempt modernization and simultaneously face the geopolitical concerns of the superpowers.
B. Employing comparative case study methods to analyze how U.S. policy instruments are
used i n two different regions of the world.
The course content will highlight recent debates over U.S. grand strategy, briefly review the
evolution of policies in selected Caribbean and Middle Eastern countries, analyze regional
changes which pose new problems for American policy makers, and evaluate current policy
recommendations.
Students will work in a dual capacity as individual decision-makers and as members of foreign
policy teams. Extensive reading will be required during the first 2/3 of the course. Students
will prepare briefing books on one country in each of the two regions. They will also present
an oral summary of their policy evaluations and will submit a final paper detailing how they
would implement their recommendations.
Prerequisites: One previous course i n international politics or comparative politics (e.g. POL
158 or 160); otherwise see instructor or department chair.
Distribution: Political Science or Economics
Time: I . . . . . . Room: M 24
. .
The Psychology of Personal Adjustment
PSY 101 - 4061
Instructors: Norm Ferguson, Linda Rodgers
The objectives of this course are to explore some of the basic principles of psychology and to
see how they may be used in coping with important life issues. The content of the course will
include topics such as: dealing. with success & failure, experiencing loss & grief, and
developing personal independence, intimacy, & values. Class time will be devoted mainly to
the discussion of issues such as these in small groups. Active participation by each student i s
expected along with the sharing of relevant individual experiences. Evaluation will be based
on class participation and one individual project or paper.
This course may not besubstituted for Psychology 105 for students pursuing a major or minor
in psychology.
Prerequisites: Consent of Instructor
Distribution: Psychology-Sociology
Grading: P/N only
Time: 11.. . . . . . . Room: P 1
24/l nterim
The Male Jail
PSY 286 - 4062,386 - 4096
Instructor: Lyla Anderegg
A prisoner of his sex, his gender, his society, he devotes his existence to the development of
serious disease and a death occurring a decade earlier than the female. His obituary: "He was
a real man."
A review of the psychological, physical and legal data bearing upon the status of the
American Male, circa 1982.
Additional assignments will be given to upperclass students requiring research, integration of
materials, added involvement in the community.
Evaluation by quality of oral presentation, kind and level of first-person information
gathering and written test.
Prerequisites: PSY 105 General Psychology for upper division status.
Distribution: Psychology-Sociology
Time: 11.. ...... Room: P 2
Learning
PSY 357 - 4063
Instructor: Grace Dyrud
Learning concepts, behavior change principles, skills and issues. Psychology of instruction.
Projects involving applications (e.g. student skills) and tests evaluate student learning.
Prerequisites: PSY 105 General Psychology, or consent of instructor.
Time: I . . ...... Room: P 2
Theology of Play, Games and Sport
REL 328 - 4064
Instructor: John Benson
There is nothing more familiar to us than play, games and sports. We are all involved with one
or more of them almost daily. Yet, there is usually little understanding of the human
significance of these commonplaces of experience. Philosophers of culture like Weiss and
Huizinga, however, together with sociologists like Caillois and psychologists like Bern have
helped us to see some of the deeper meanings of these things we usually take for granted. At
the same time, theologians concerned with cultural questions such as this have added their
contributions. Rahner, Miller, Pieper and Novak have helped us to see that religion itself has
a "play" structure.
I n the lectures, all of the above thinkers will be dealt with. And in the small groups two books,
one by Caillois, and the other by Novak, will be read and carefully discussed. Several special
preparations will be required as well, related to special discussions. An example of such a
special discussion i s the problem of the relation between the game proper and the
"intimidation game" that goes on within it at the same time. Such a problem can be shown to
have far reaching implications into many other areas of life as well as games.
Prerequisites: One course in Religion
Distribution: Religion
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 10
Luther-Bach and the Shape of the Liturgy
REL 364 - 4086
MUS 167 - 4051
367 - 4052
Instructors: Philip A. Quanbeck
Larry Fleming
The 500th anniversary of the birth of Martin Luther provides the impetus for this crossdisciplinary offering focusing on the shape of the liturgy in the reformation and the historical,
theological and musicological background out of which the Mass in B minor by J. S. Bach
emerges. Plenary sessions will be addressed by Charles Anderson, Larry Fleming, and Philip
Quanbeck. Students may elect either one of the supplementary group sessions.
1. Musicological - Baroque performance practice, contrasting Mass settings, textual forerunners will be studied together with detailed musical and theological analysis of the
complete score with instrumental and choral realization.
2. Religion -The shape of the liturgy. Historical development of the Mass, historical and
theological background of the reformation and the renaissance.
Grades will be based on participation and examination. Upper Division credit will require
additional work.
Prerequisites: Religion - one course in religion
Music - consent of instructor
Time: 1 1 . . . . . . . . Room: M 23
Christianity in Modern Africa
REL 366 - 4092
Instructor: Bradley Holt
This course will focus on two regions of Africa: the West and the South. Students will be
introduced to traditional African culture and religion, the introduction of Christianity, and
the present development of indigenous churches in West Africa. The newer "Independent
African Churches" will be studied, as well as attempts to formulate "African Christian
Theology." A major section of the course will focus on contemporary responses of churches
in South Africa to the apartheid system of racial segregation. There will be lectures and
discussion of reading materials, films, and visiting resource persons. Students will be
evaluated on several short tests and a short research paper.
Prerequisites: One course in religion.
Distribution: Religion
Time: 11.. . . . . . . Room: O M 18
Practicum in Human Services
SWK 257 - 4065
Instructor: Doug Perry
An opportunity to discover whether a career in human services i s for you. Thirty hours per
week of volunteer work in a human service agency i s combined with readings and weekly
seminars. Evaluation based on submission of journals, summary of experience and a final
examination.
Students will meet with instructor before the end of Fall Semester in order to discuss
selection of agency and structure of this course.
~
of problems for which people seek
Ohjectlvws arp ta d ~ v e l n pspecial awareness ol t h klnds
hrlp: increase k n o w l r d g ~of theservice givcn hy the agency in which student is serving; gain
knowledge of thr! profess~onalsin thc nrannizatinn, including their skills, competencies,
ducati ion, and Lsainlng: gain h ~ g i n n i n gk n o w l ~ d g cabout the diversity of human service
agencic<: and increase ~ ~ n d e r s t a n r lof
i nsrlf
~ tn rrlation 10 he human service field.
Time: II (for in~tialmeeting; group meetings will be arranged). . . . . . . Room: S 123
.
Social Services with American lndian People
SWK 400 - 4087,400 - 4066
Instructor: Rosalie V. Clark
Readings will be combined with lectures by American lndian people, who are either consumers or providers of services, and with visits to agencies serving American lndian people.
A research paper incorporating two special service theories and addressing a specific area of
service provision for American lndian people will be the basis for evaluation.
Actual class meeting times will be determined by class members on the first meeting day.
This course carries only 1/2 course credit.
Non-social work majors are welcome. Students wishing an additional 1/2 course credit in
independent work should consult the instructor before the beginning of interim.
prerequisites: Sociology 383
Time: 11.. . . . . . . Room: M 25
Field Work 111
SWK 466 - 4088,466 - 4068
Instructor: Edwina Hertzberg
The objectives of the class are to use supervisory rrlation~hipto increaw Interpretive as well
as social work performance competence; tn promote gradual enlry Into direct social work
practice; to increase competence in the clicni contact phase of thr problem solving process;
to increase student self-awareness in regard ro prof~ssinnalpractice interests, areas of
strength, and areas for personal/professionaI development; to promote competence in the
full process of problem solving, with special emphasis on analysis and resolution stages.
Course content will be continuation of Field Work Il-educationally focused field placement
in a social service agency.
Students will spend 15 (or 30) hours per week in field placement, plus one hour per week in
faculty facilitated supportive seminar held on campus.
Evaluations will be made in writing by Field Instructor using previously developed contract
and social work evaluation form.
Note: Course is offered for 1/2 (15 hours per week) or full (30 hours per week) credit. If for
full credit, 1/2 credit will be based on non-client contact tasks.
Prerequisites: Minimum of 2.0 in Field Work I and in Field Work II; candidacy status
. . . . Room: M 24
Time: II - 4:00 - 5:00 p.m. T,W,Th..
..
I nterim/27
The Sociology of Law
SOC 220 - 4068
Instructor: Diane Pike
This course examines the nature of law, its effect on society, and the effect of society on it.
Specific topics include: cross-cultural notions of law, regulating morality, deterrence, social
change, the legal profession, and corporate crime - all with respect to a sociological
approach to understanding law. The basic format will be lecture/discussion. Evaluation is
based on (in addition to participation) two (2) take-home examinations.
Prerequisites: SOC 121 or an introductory political Science course, or permission of the
instructor.
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 16
The Human Potential Movement and Identity:
A Sociological Analysis
SOC 394 - 4089
Instructor: Jerry Gerasimo
This will be a sociological and social-psychological analysis of that loosely connected
grouping of persons and movements which lays emphasis on identity, self-expression, selfawareness and growth. "Alternate life-styles" and "expanding consciousness" have become
increasingly central terms for the media and large parts of the American population. After a
brief history of the movement and its major figures (Freud, Rogers, and Maslow) we will
consider the Human Potential Movement's relation to other social movements and to the
dominant culture. There is a possibility of field work. Evaluation will be based on an
examination and a paper.
There will be a fee of about $5.00 to cover additional instructional materials.
Prerequisites: PSY 105 or SOC 121 or SOC 241
Time: 11.. ...... Room: O M 13
Story Theater (Children's Theater)
SPC 285 - 4072
Instructor: Ailene Cole
This class will improvise, produce, and perform a children's play. Whatever is needed-script,
costumes, props, lights, scenery, music, dance-will be created and executed by the class.
Performances are scheduled for the final week.
Stage 2
Time: 9:30-12:OO and 1:OO-3:00 p.m..
.......
Other Courses
These courses are offered by institutions or groups not connected with Augsburg College but
have been approved for credit by the College. Most carry a tuition cost plus other expenses
which are the responsibility of the student. They are offered only on a P/N basis. Fuller
descriptions and details for registering are available in the Interim Office.
ART 163 - 4095 Basic Spinning, Weaving and Dyeing
Offered by the Weavers Guild of Minnesota. Tuition and materials cost $174.
28/l nterim
HPE 106 - 4070 Ski Interim (Park City, Utah)
Comprehensive program with lessons and seminars by professional ski
instructors. Open to all from novice to expert. Special courses for those
interested in and qualified for ski patrol and ski instructor. Package fee of
approximately $975 includes lodging, lift tickets, lessons, lectures, seminars
and cross country ski outing. Does not include transportation or food
(condos have cooking facilities). Dates are Jan. 8 - 28. Contact Joyce Pfaff
(Melby Hall basement or at 330-1248) for further information and registration
materials.
GST 120 - 4071 Wilderness (branch of Plymouth Christian Youth Center)
A splendid course at the PCYC base on the edge of the Boundary Waters
Canoe Area in northern Minnesota near Grand Marais. Approximate cost:
$400.
POL 399 - 4073 Washington Interim
A study-internship program i n Washington, D.C. in connection with the
Washington Center of Learning Alternatives. Information on projects,
housing and financial assistance is available from Dr. Milda Hedblom i n
Memorial 117A.
SWK 312 - 4074 Training School on Alcoliol and Drug Abuse
Intensive experiential and didactic training at Johnson Institute combined
with week-long experience in chemical dependency treatment agency.
Students are evaluated according to participation in classes, experiential
learning and in the chemical dependency agency. Enrollment is very limited.
Social Work 95257, social work major and permission of contact person,
Eddie Hertzberg, are prerequisites. Cost: $100.
Augsburg Lifetime Sports
The following activities are available to students during interim. They do not carry official
credit, but they do meet the lifetime sports requirement for graduation. Students may
participate in any one of these without registering for the course, but will be expected to pay
any fees whether or not the student registers for the course.
Badminton
HPE002-4081
Instructor: Ernie Anderson
Basic techniques and theory of beginningbadminton - much of the class time will be spent in
singles and doubles games and tournaments. There will be no written tests or outside
assignments. Grading is P/N and is based on attendance and participation.
Distribution: Meets the general education requirement of one lifetime sport.
Melby
Time: 12:OO Noon..
......
Volleyball
HPE002 -4082
Instructor: Ernie Anderson
Learn rules and skills necessary to enjoy volleyball.
Distribution: Meets the general education requirement of one lifetime sport.
Time: 12:OO Noon.. ...... Melby
Racquetball
HPE 002 - 4083
Instructor: Ernie Anderson
Learn rules and skills necessary to enjoy racquetball.
Distribution: Meets the general education requirement of one lifetime,sport.
Time: 9:20..
Melby
......
International Studv
Augsburg College
Minneapolis, Minnesota 55454
Interims Abroad January3-28,1983
Cermany
Hawaii
The Rhine Frontier: Germany Meets Rome
and France
A Laboratory of Multi-Ethnic Interaction
German 333 - Donald Steinmetz
Since Roman time<,the lands along the Rhlne have b ~ e onn e ol the mu+[ jlgniilcai~t
ironlrer areas 01 Europe. Here Ccrman and Roman culture clajhed and rnlsed: Here
e
TOC)~,~ntheernpure of Cha~lemagne.Heft
modern Germany and France h a ~ their
romlneique and go1h ~ architecrure
r
ilurished ir: Ihe kirddle A ~ e s t-lere
.
Germaris and
French fought in rhree recent rvari. I r is such evcnts whuch h a w .;haper1 litc and left co
manv munlrments between rhc Rhine ancl the blcuse. The rlurlenl ill studr and "relr~c"
rhe history o i rhls area o n loratiori, firm the Roman munumen;, oi Trier and Cologne.
Charlemagnp'~:lachen. ro the baltteiields of tUorld b\ar$ I and It and ~ h dynarntc
c
socier)
of presenl-dai Germanv. The course will be c o n d u r ~ e dpr~marrlvIn Trrel.. Germany, r\lTh
excursion5 10 nc-arb, zites. Trier Ir ideal f o r lhis plrrpose. Perhaps the oltlest r l t v In Germanv.
Trier i s rich in monumenls. dat~netrom Roman times ro rhe prcsenl. and imporlanl
~ h a n700 miles away. Lecrures. d~scussions.and
historical sites o i iise counfries J r e
readings will be principally in German according tu the siudent.5 entering level of
competence.
.
Counts toward: German major and foreign language distr ihufron requirement . .
Prerequisites: German 112 or equivalent.. . Grading: P/N or traditional . . . Enrollmenl: 15
... Cost: $1690.
London and Paris
History 240,340 - Khin Khin Jensen
Observalian and s t u d y of 4sian I J a p a n e r r . Chinese. Korean arld Ph~llppinej.Polyne5ian
ItbwaiIan and Samoan,, and Caucasian cu[rures inkerac-tingIn the i i t t ~ e ~
stale.
h Focus on
hiaorrcal rraditions. immigrd~ionparrerns, religious heritage. erlucational eaperlences.
~nmrnercialvpnrurc5, the media. rulrural ~ r t j v i t j e .a~n .d current rssues. Field i r i p ~include
vihits to I ~ PFo l > n e i i a n Cultural Center. Pear[ Harbor-4rtzona h3ernorial. tulani I'alace and
Hishop h l u s e u m . tluddhr5:-Taoist Tcmple. East-\.\ei.i Center ar thc C!nlverrit) oi Han.aii, the
Hawallan Cir! of Reiuse rn Kona area. 2 n d V I ~ I ~ w
F i~h
cornrnunlty leaders or barying ethnic
backgrounds in Hilo and Honolulu.
Evaluation will be based on participation in all components of the Interim such as field trips,
lectures, and J i j c u ~ j i ~
n
sessions
~inrludingpre-~nterimorientations). Students will keep a
daily journal. There will b e requirt-d reading;.
Counts toward hlsrnr, major, Fas! ?\51an Studies major, history distribution requirement.
Prerequisites: l o n e r drv~s~un,
noni.; U*
division, sophomore standing and consent of
Grading: P N orrh . Enrollment: 15-18 . . . Cost: $1795.
instructor
.
Mexico
Clo!h course2 r ~A~PYICO
i
WIIIha\ e rllc same itinerary (Mexico, Oaxaca, Cuernavaca):
a l l qtudcnis will be encouraged t c t take advantage of the opportunities presented by
each of the courses. A lot of tlme outside of class will be spent in informal group
discussions.
Art in London and Paris
Theories of Social Change and Revolution
Art 378 - Mary Swanson
Political Science 383 - Mulford Q. Sibley
This course will study art in the collections of museums In Landon and Parls. S~vlistic,
historical and sociological perspectives will be ernphds~rdIn s rewng arlrnork in museums.
galleries and architectural landmarks. Lecture will be gnen briore v~siting~ n c h
museum
that students will become acquainted with malor work.; In each cultectron. 5iudr:nv wilt
This wlll be a course which surveys rr~odefnconceprlons of social and political change and
re\olut~on8t.einning with the European b,:ckground in days immediately after the French
Ktyolut~on,II wtll ~ o n r ~ d 8uch
c r theories as rhorcof the utopian socialists, anarchists,
b r a l s , Tolmyallanrl .Maruitrs. Parilrular atltnuon will be devoted to the place of
,\LC"
d
,""'.,"'
V"
U C - . ~ . . Y L C . .
....A,-,
.."I,.,
I..
C " < . I
_.-bYIICI,
.-..
C L , , " , , .,-..,.
style, function, subject, formal organization and medium. Additional opportunities will be
provided for students who wish t o emphasize a certain period i n the history of art. I
Counts toward art major or art history major, fine arts distribution requirement . . . Grading:
P/N or traditional . . . Enrollment: 25 . . . Cost: $1995.
be conslaereu. MalthuSlanS and neo-Maltnuslans, wlrn tnelr popularlon anu resource,
conceptio~s,will occupy an important place. The modern world of North-South and EastWest tensions will constitute part of the background for modern theories of revolution. Is
violence compatible wrth democratic and egalitarian revolution? What is the theory of nonviolent revolution?
During the latter part of the course, many of these questions will be examined i n the
context of Latin America i n general and of Mexico i n particular.
Music in London and Paris
Evaluation will be based on class participation and the submission of a journal
Music 378 - Robert ~ a r l e ' n
These t w o great European cultural centers will be visited so that students might experience
the cultural milieu that produced such musical giants as Purcell, Handel, Britten, Berliozi
Franck and Stravinsky.
Performances t o be attended will include operetta, ballet, chamber music, and symphonic
concerts by leading orchestral ensembles. There will be opportunities to attend worship
services i n the magnificent c a ~ h p d r ~of
l s these t w o capital cities. Lectures describing the
special significance of the music ro be heard and providing important background
information will be supplemented h! \,isits to museums and libraries to see collections of
historic musical instruments and view manuscript scores of famous composers.
Evaluation will be made on the basis of attendance at lectures, participation in class
activities, four written concert reviews, and an informal final examination.
Counts toward music major and fine arts distribution requirement .. . Prerequisites: none
. . . Grading: P/N o n l y . .. Enrollment: 15 . .. Cost: $1995.
Counts toward political science major (theory and comparative subfields) and the political
science distribution requirement.. . Grading: P/N only . . . Enrollment: 15 . . . Cost: $1195.
Basic Conversational Spanish
Spanish 113 - Mary A. Kingsley
Bal'ic C n n ~ e r w ~ i o n a I ~ S p a n15
i sderisnecl
h
tor sludents w h o have already covered the
~
and are ready t o put their
strurtL~reEaflh? pr-ent, preteritr. dnd ~ r n p e r f e cIcnsc3
k n u u letlgr t o tire o n the scene in htexico. There %ill
be regular in-class sessions, small
group conuwsations. as well as a ?rear deal or opporrunity t o use Spanish actively and
PASSIL.:~~ in runclucring interviews. siloppi1.1~.
atrending lectures, and just making Mexico
home for a month.
Grading will be based o n class participation, quizzes and a final exam w h ~ c hwill be written
and oral. Original materials will be used as the text.
Counts toward foreign language distribution requirement for 112 or 211 . . . Prerequisites:
Spanish 111 or 2 years of high school Spanish . . . Grading: P/N only . . . Enrollment: 15 . . .
Cost: $1195.
Ser..zster and Summer Opportunities
Program in Global Community February 3
- May 2-
B q r m in-gbklmmmununrty
is a 3% month study program based In C u e h l a r ~M
, ex~co
Primary fows is on the study of h u m @latiiAteglobal Iustlce and human IiQerarlon
firought~velaperiencesandfourofsir~~~rseopt~ons
The ~ & , ~ ~ , ~ ~ f S t ~ l t l ~ n ,
r o o m e d b d w d t r i ~ dbeweenTewarmd
l
Mexico A p p l ~ c a i m d e a & w : O c t o b e r 15,
1982
ACTC HECUA Programs
udents may partlclpate In the Assoc~atedC o l l e g e o f thtTwin C I t h (ACTC)
ermany and V ~ e n n aand the South Amerlcan Urban kmester and
Urban Study Term through the Hlgher E d u c a t i o n C o n ~ o n i u mf m t l r b a n
A) Many more opportunltles are ava~lable,and infarmation may be obta~ned
at the O f f ~ c eof lnternat~onalPrograms
The SPAN Program
Semester or Year Abroad
A n a ~ ~ l h Mbeen
+ ?@ t m d e r v r h ~ c hAugsburgmStil&nls may spend thelr
~ p h ~ ~or~jso
an-h
r reyear Ind y a# rfibmber of f o n ? @ d m t ~ o n a l lnstltutlons Among
themam: theUhivWty af 0 h . N ~ Sch~ller
;
CaUwin London and He~delberg,the
University &Bath, &gb& the U n i u e M y of ~undee,Soetlan$; the U n ~ v e r s ~of
t y Sev~lle,
Spain; and thelmtitutefor American Univers~t~es
in A v i p n , France
International Business
See under Business Administration in Augsburg College Catalog.
Students will spend two months during the summer of 1983 i n any one of three countries:
Mexico, Yugoslavia or Kenya. The summer will be preceded by a year-long orientation and
a paper will be written after returning. Scholarship help is available. Applications should be
made this spring for the program which begins i n the fall.
Scholarships, Deadlines
Scholarships apply to international study. Because enrollment in semester study
abroad i s limited, students should apply early in the year. Deadline: March 1 of
the preceding year. I f space is still available after that date, applications will be
accepted until the last day of class.
Mary A. Kingley, Director, Office of International Programs, Old Main 20
-612-330-1206
Show less
-
-
Title
-
Augsburg College Undergraduate Catalog, 1982-1984
-
Collection
-
Course Catalogs
-
Search Result
-
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
Minneapolis, Minnesota
1982-84 Catalog
Augsburg Advent Vespers in Central Lutheran Church
2/Campus Map
/
Minneapolis, Minnesota
-
-
,
Campus Guide (2182)
1. Admissions
2. Library
3. Science Hall
4. Old Main
5. West Hall
6. Mortenson Tower
7. Urness Tower
8. College ...
Show more
AUGSBURG COLLEGE
Minneapolis, Minnesota
1982-84 Catalog
Augsburg Advent Vespers in Central Lutheran Church
2/Campus Map
/
Minneapolis, Minnesota
-
-
,
Campus Guide (2182)
1. Admissions
2. Library
3. Science Hall
4. Old Main
5. West Hall
6. Mortenson Tower
7. Urness Tower
8. College Center
9. Memorial Hall
10. Music Hall
11. Psychology Building
12. Melby Hall
13. Ice Arena
14. Stage 2 Theater
15. Little Theater
16. East Hall
A. Admissions Parking
B. Student Parking
C. Main Entrance-TunnellRarnplSkyway
D. Quadrangle
E. Faculty-Staff Parking
F. Murphy Square
C.Practice Field
H. Fairview-St. Mary's Parking Ramp
.'-
Campus Map/3
Driving to Campus on Interstate 94
East from Minneapolis: take the 25th Avenue exit, turn left to Riverside Avenuegnd
left again to 21st Avenue South at the Augsburg sign.
West from St. Paul - take the Riverside Avenue exit right after you cross the
Mississippi River and then turn right onto Riverside. Watch for the Augsburg sign
and turn left at 21st Avenue South.
Campus M a p - 2
Introduction - 5
Facilities - 7
Admission - 8
Costs and Financial A i d - 12
Student Life - 24
Academic Information - 30
Brief Facts - 44
Course Descriptions - 45
Registers - 132
Index - 143
Academic Calendars - 146
Winter at Augsburg is also for snowmen
Introducing Augsburg
Few liberal arts c o l l e e s combine the excitement and vitality of a metropolitan
center with the smallness and intimacy of the rural setting, Augsburg i s one of the
few, very special Christian cnlleges which can offer you both, as indicated in the
Mission Statement adopted by the Faculty and the Board of Regents in 1977.
Mission Statement
Augsburg i s an accredited four-year Iiheral arts college o f The American Lutheran
Church located in Minneapolis, at the center of the Twin Cities merropolitan area.
The coeducational student body of approximately 1500, while largely of Lutheran
orlentation, includes students of diverse ages from a wide variety of religious,
,
cultural and ethnic backgrounds.
For over 100 years the college has emphasized intellecrual freedom in the search for
knowledge i n i t s disciplines, responsiveness ro the needs of society and the world,
and preparation of students for service and leadership in church and society.
The mission of Augsburg College is to educate students through a distinctive
combination of commitment to the Christian faith. the liberal artsand excellence in
academic program.
Au sburg College is known for its people, who strive to be a supportive, informal
ancf free community of learners involved with the metropolitan environment.
The academic program is primarily committed to providing opportuniti- for a
broad background in a variety of subject areasas well as personal development. The
college challenges srudenrs with a portion of the knowledgcand ~ h o u g hwhich
t
has
been formative within human historv and culture through a wide variety OF ideas,
di5ciplinesand selected professional and pre-professional programs: assists students
in developing intellectual skills a5 we'll a 5 in selecting a career: and encourages
within stutients the attitudes and skills necessary to prepare them to be learners
rhroughour their lives. Excellence in theacademic programs hascharacterized and i s
a conrinued goal of r he rollege.
Education at Augsburg i s based on the belief that the world i s Cod's, entrusted to us
for care, exploration and understanding.
& a Christian comrnunitv the college embraces a wide ran e of religiousexpression
and par~icipation.As part of its academic program ,4ugs urg weks to give all its
students a n inlormed understanding of the Christian faith and heritage as well as an
opportunity to encounter other segments of the world's religious herilage. In
addition to this intellectual rask rhe aim of thecolbege isto helpsludents understand
the Christian faith as relevant for t h ~ i own
r
experience and for partic~parioni n r h e
commitment to the role of the Christian community in rhe modern world.
t
Augsburg College seeks to act responsibly within the metropolitan community.
The qualiry of Augsburg's education is enriched by the people, culture and
educational resources provided by i t s location. However, the college i s also aware
that it has a responsibility ro contribute to ihe larger communitv. In doing this, the
college directs several of i ~ sprograms specificallv ar the metropolitan serting,
provides area5 of study not available elsewhere in the area, and offers irself as an
educational resource for a variety of new srudent populations.
History - Fjord to Freeway
Augsburg was the first seminary founded by Norwegian Lutherans i n America,
named after the confession of faith presented by Lutherans in Augsburg, Germany,
in 1530. Minneapolis replaced Marshall, Wisconsin,a3 Augsburg'~home three vears
later, in 1872. The first college students were enrol[ed in 1874 and rhe first c o l l ~ ~ e
graduation was in 1879.
The school was officially named .4ugsbur College i n 1963 when its former sponsor,
the Lutheran Free Church, merged with T e American Lutheran Church. Augsburg
Seminary joined with Luthrr Theological Seminary in St. Paul thar same war.
Continuiny lies with this heritage are reflected in the College Center's ~ u ~ s h u r g
Room and in replication of rhe original sign for Old Main. From Fjord lo Freeway, a
randTd history of the College and itr peopleduring the first 100 years, by AuqsburgJ.s
Carl E. Chrislock, is available in the Collcge Bookstore.
f
Location and Campus
Augsbur '5 campus i s located in the heart of the Twin Cities, surrounding Murphy
square, tReiirrt of155 parks in ihen'Ciryof Lakes."The University of Minnesota Wesr
Bank campus and two of the city's largest hospitals, Fairview and St. Mary's, are
adjacent to the campus. Downtown Minneapolis and St. Paul are minutes west and
east via Interstate 91 which forms the southern border of the campus, or on bus
routes that also connect with the suburbs.
Y.
Reaching the Twin Cities is eas Airlines providing daily service to Minneapolis-St.
Paul International Airport inc ude American, Capitol, Delta, Eastern, Northwest
Orient, Ozark, Republic, Trans World, united, USAir, and Western. Bus or train
connections can be made from all areas of the United States.
Policies
It i s the olicy of Augsburg College not to discriminate on the basis of race, creed,
nationa or ethnicorigins, age, marital status,sex or handicap as required by Title I X
of the 1972 Educational Amendmentsor Section 504of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973
as amended i n i t s admissions polides, educational programs, activities and employment prac~ices.lnqu~riesregarding compliance may be directed to the ~ndividuals
listed in the Communications Directory inside the front cover or to t h e Directory of
the Office of Civil Rights, Departmenr of Health, Eduration and Welfare, Washington, D.C.
f
The College and its faculty subscribe to the Statement of Principles on Academic
Freedom as promulgated by the American Association of University Professors and
the Association of American Colleges.
Accreditation and Memberships
Au sburg College i s fully accredited by the North Central Association of Colleges
anBSecondary Schools and The National Council for the Accreditation of Teacher
Education (Secondary and Elementary). Our Programs are approved by The
American Chemical Society, The Council on Social Work Education, and the
National League for Nursing.
We are a member of the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities (ACTC), Lutheran
Education Council in North America, Minnesota Private College Council, National
Association for Music Therapy, Inc., and are registered with the Minnesota Higher
Education Coordinating Board (MHECB).
Facilities and Housing
Instruction facilities and student housing at Augsburg are conveniently located near
each other. A tunnel/ramp/skyway system connects the tower dormitories,the five
buildings on the Quadrangle, Music Hall, and the Psychology Building.
Admissions Office, located at 628 21st Avenue South, provides offices for the admissions staff
and reception area for prospective students and their parents.
George Sverdrup Library, (1955) named i n honor of Augsburg's fourth president, contains
reading rooms, seminar rooms, work rooms, an audio-visual center, the Augsburg Archives,
classrooms and faculty offices.
Science Hall (1949) houses classrooms, well-equipped laboratories, a medium-sized auditorium, and faculty offices. The Lisa Odland Observatory on the roof was completed i n 1960.
O l d M a i n (1900) i s home for the Foreign Language and Art departments and has classrooms
used by other departments. Extensively remodelled i n 1980, O l d Main combines energy
efficiency with architectural details from the past.
West Hall (1966) is apartment housing for married and upperclass students.
Mortensen Tower, (1973), named i n honor of Gerda Mortensen, dean of women from 1923 t o
1964, has 104 one and two-bedroom apartments that house 312 upperclass students, plus
conference rooms and spacious lounge areas.
UrnessTower, (1967) named i n honor of M r . and Mrs. Andrew Urness, who have given several
generous gifts t o the College, provides living quarters for 324 students. Each floor is a "floor
unit," providing 36 residents, housed t w o t o a room, with their o w n lounge, study and utility
areas.
Augsburg College Center, (1967) center of non-academic activity, has spacious lounges and
recreational areas, dining areas, bookstore, and offices for student government and student
publications.
Sverdrup-Oftedal Memorial Hall, (1938) named i n honor of Augsburg's second and third
presidents, provides space for administrative and faculty offices and one floor of student
housing.
Music Hall, (1978) newest building o n campus, contains a 217-seat recital hall, classroom
facilities, t w o rehearsal halls, music libraries, practice studios and offices for the music faculty.
Psychology Building (1964) has classrooms, offices and laboratories for the Psychology
department i n the former studio building.
Melby Hall, (1961) named i n honor of 1. S. Melby, dean of men from 1920 t o 1942, basketball
coach, and head of the Christianity department, provides facilities for the health and physical
education program, intercollegiate and intramural athletics, chapel services, and general
auditorium purposes.
Ice Arena, (1974) with t w o large skating areas, is used for hockey, figure skating and
recreational skating for Augsburg and the metropolitan community.
Stage II Theater, formerly O l d Music Hall, was redesigned i n 1979 with a thrust stage as a
temporary performing facility for the Theater department, which also retainsspace i n the Little
Theater building.
South Hall, Kueffner apartments, and annex houses, all located i n or near the campus area,
provide additional housing accommodations for students, faculty and staff.
Freshmen Students - 9
Early Decision - 10
Early Admission - ID
Transfer Students - 10
Former Students - 11
Special Students
(Non-Degree) - 11
International Students - 11
Interests can be explored in a variety of classes
Admissions
Augsburg CoIleRp jeeks students who possess qualities of intellect and character
which will enahle t h e student to h e n e f ~ !fram and contribute to the college
community. Each applicant is 'udged on individuat merit without regard for race,
creed, sex. age, dirabiliry, and naiinnal or ethnic origin.
Augsburg's admissions office 51aff members are available to help srudents and
parents with college planning. The 4drnissions Ofiice is open weekdays from 8:00
a.m. t o 4:30 p.m. Tours can be arranged for Saturday and Sunday as well. Vis~torsare
asked to write or call the Adrnirsion3 Office (611) 330-1001 prior to the visir. The
admissions staff will arrange a campus tour. class visita~ions.and conferences with
professors according to the wishes of the visitor. The Admissions Office is located on
the northwest corner of 7th Street and 21st Avenue South in Minneapolis.
Application Procedures for Freshmen
1. Application for Admission
Applicants should complete an application for admission, and return it to the
Admissions Office together with the non-refundable $15.00 application fee.
2. Transcripts
A n official transcript from the h i h school i s required of freshman applicanrs.
Freshman applicanrs who are i t i l l f i e h iihool studenti at ihe rime of application
should have their nost receni transcript sent, f n l l o w ~ dbv a final transcript upon
graduarion. Graduate Examination Degree scores [G.E.D.) mav he presected
instead of the hiph srhool transcript,
3. Test Scores
Freshman applicants are required to submit results from the Preliminary
Scholastic Aptitude Test (PSAT), the Scholastic Aptitude Test (SAT), or the
American College Test (ACT). It will suffice if test scores are recorded on the
official high school transcript.
4. Additional Information
If there is personal information that may have affected the applicant's revious
academic performance, it may be included with the application or xscussed
personally with an admissions counselor. Academic recommendations may be
required by the Admissions Committee before an admissions decision is made.
5. Notification of Admissions Decision
Augsburg College uses a "rolling" admissions plan. Students are notified of the
admissions decision, usually within two weeks after the application file is
complete.
6. Completion of Admission
An accepted student i s asked t o make a $100 non-refundable tuition deposit by
April 1or within 15 days of financial aid notification. Extensions requests may be
granted upon request by the Admissions Office.
Early Decision for Freshmen
An Early Decision Program i s offered for students who select Augsburg as a primary
college choice. An Early Decision candidate must apply by N o v e m b e r 15 of the
senior year and will receive the admission decision about December 1. The
admissions decision i s based upon the academic record through the junior year, test
scores, and recommendations.
Students who are eligible for Early Decision will receive maximum consideration for
financial assistance.
Early Decision candidates applying for financial aid are required to complete the
Augsburg Early Decision Financial Aid Application, which enables our Financial Aid
Office t o compute a preliminary award. Candidates will be notified of their award by
January 1. This application i s available i n the Admissions Office.
A $100.00 non-refundable tuition deposit i s required by January 15 or within 15 days
of financial aid notification.
Early Admission of Freshmen
Students of exceptional ability who wish to accelerate their educational program
may by granted admission t o begin full-time work toward a degree following
completion of their junior year or first semester of the senior year of high school.
Applicants for early admission must complete the normal procedures for freshman
applicants, submit two academic recommendations from the high school faculty,
and arrange a personal interview with the Director of Admissions.
Application Procedures for
Transfer Students
Augsburg College welcomes students who wish t o transfer after having completed
work at other accredited colleges or universities. College credit i s granted for liberal
arts courses satisfactorily completed at accredited institutions. The College reserves
the right not t o grant credit for courses where it considers the work unsatisfactory, t o
grant provisional credit for work taken at unaccredited institutions, and t o require
that certain courses be taken at Augsburg.
A cumulative grade point average (GPA) of 2.0 or better i s required o n previous
college work.
Registered Nurses seeking a Bachelor of Science degree i n Nursing must have a 2.5
GPA and complete the Department of Nursing credit evaluation tests.
1. Application for Admission
Applicants should complete an application for admission and return i-t t o the
Admissions Office together with the $15.00 non-refundable application fee.
2. Transcripts
An official transcript f r o m the college(s) you have attended i s required. Transfer
student applicants must have an official transcript from their high school sent t o
the Admissions Office. Students who have completed a year or more of college
work will be evaluated primarily o n their college performance.
3. Additional Information
If there i s personal information that rnav have affected the applicant's revious
college performance, il mav be includrd wifh rhe application or &cursed
personally with an admissions counselor, Academic recommendations may be
required by the Admissions Committee before an admissions decic~onis made.
4. Notification of Admissions Decision
Augsburg College uses a "rolling" admissions plan. Students are notified of the
admissions decision within two weeks after the application file is complete. An
accepted student isasked to makea $100 non-refundable tuition deposit by April
1: or within 15 days of financial aid notification. Extensions can be granted by the
Admissions Office upon request.
Re-Admission of Former Students
A student who has interrupted attendance a t A u g s b u r ~College and who wishes t o
return applies for re-admission through the Registrar s Office. A student who has
s ) during the absence from Augsburg must have an
attended any other ~nst~turian
official transcript sent from eac oneto the Registrar'sOffice. Returningstudentsdo
not pay the application fee.
i,
Admission as a Special
Student (Non-Degree)
I n some circumstances, a person ma be admitted as a special student (non-degree)
and granted the privilege of enroling in courses for credit. Usually a part-time
student, he or she may subsequently become a candidate for a degree by petitioning
through the Registrar's Office.
Students regularly enrolled at another college may take course work at Augsburg
College as a special student (non-degree). A transcript must be sent t o the Registrar's
Office by the student's home institution.
An application form for special student (non-degree) status i s available from the
Registrar's Office.
Admission for International Students
International students should consult with the Director of Admissions regarding the
rocedures for applying as an international student. You may contact the Director
calling (612) 330-1001 or addressing your correspondence to:
Director of Admissions
Augsburg College
731 21st Avenue South
Minneapolis M N 55454
U.S.A.
py
12/Costs and Financial Aid
Costs 1982-83 - 13
Fees - 14
Deposits - 14
Payments - 15
Refunds - 15
Application - 16
Gifts - 17
Loans - 18
Student Employment - 19
Sponsored Scholarships - 19
Student employment options include Food Service crews
Costs and Financial Policies
Students pay less than the full cost of an education at Augsburg College.The balance
of instructional and operating costs comes from annual contributions from The
American Lutheran Church, endowment funds, and gifts from individuals,
corporations and foundations.
College Costs 1982-83
Costs listed have been approved by the Board of Regents for the 1982-83 academic
year. The board reviews costs annually and makes changes as required. The college
reserves the right to adjust charges should economic conditions necessitate.
Tuition (full-time enrollment). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $4,820.00
This rate applies to all full-time students e n r e r i n ~in September, f 981. Students are
considererl full-time when thev take thrce or more courses dus~ngthe semester
term5 for a ~ o t aof
l seven or more courses in the rchool vear. The charge includes
ruition. general fees, facilities, fees. suhscript~onto student publications, and
admission to college-sup orted events. concerts and lectures. The amount 1s
payable in two equal insla Iments a t the beginning of each semester.
P
Tuition (part-time enrollment) per course.
.............................
670.00
This rate applies to students taking fewer than three courses in a semester and/or an
Interim only.
Audit Fee (for part-time students) per course..
.........................
335.00
Full-time students may audit a course without charge. Part-time students taking
Lifetime Sports are charged the audit rate for that course.
Room Rent (includes telephone).
....................................
1,207.00
Linen service is available in residence halls on a direct contract basis from a local
linen supply company.
Full Board (19 meals a week). ........................................ 1,070.00
Other board plans are available as defined in the housing contract booklet available
from the Office of Student Life.
Other Special Fees (not refundable)
Fees Payable by Check/Cash
Fees Billed on Student Account
ACTC Bus (Full-time students
only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $
Late Registration (per day
after classes begrn) . . . . . . . . . .
5.00
10.00
5.00
....
35.00
Film Making (Interim) . . . . . . . . .
75.00
.........
20.00
ckys
Life Drawing (Interim)
Nursin Credit
Valifation Tests . . . . . . . .
Locker Rental
(for commuters)
Re istration Chan e after first 5
(cancelkdd/change
grade optlon, or combrnatlon
at one tlme) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Introduction to Cinema Arts
Application (new and/or
special students . . . . . . . . $ 15.00
Medical Technology
(Senior Fee) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 720.00
20.00
.......
5.00
Student Parking Lot
Permit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
20.00
Transcri t Fee (per copy
after t?rst, whrch
i s free) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.00
Special Examinations (Schedule on
file in Registrar's Office)
Music Therapy Internship (one
course credrt) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 670.00
Music Lessons
Private, per semester
(14 lessons) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150.00
Class, per semester . . . . . . . . . . 75.00
...
10.00
Theater Technical Production . .
35.00
..............
35.00
Radio-Television Production
Student Teaching
Study Abroad (in approved nonAugsburg programs) . . . . . . . . . 125.00
Books and Supplies
These costs are estimated to range between $175 - 225 per year.
Deposits
Tuition (non-refundable)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .$100.00
Required of all new students after acceptance. Applied to the tuition charge. There
are three deadline dates, each providing different benefits to you. For more
information, contact the Admissions Office.
Housing
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100.00
Required of all resident srudenrs a t rhe time of signing a contract, to reserve a
housing ass~gnrnent.Applied to t h e room charge. Keu. cclrlrract5 mav be r ~ r m i n a t e d
for Fall or Spring Term by notifyin the O f f ~ c eof Student Life rn writing by the tirst
davof registralion. Thp rpsident wi I be responsible for all costs incurred due to [ate
cancellation or lack ofproper notltication. It thp new contract is canrelled prior to
lulv 1 for Fall semester or lanuarv 1 for Spring Semester, 535.00 will he iorieired irom
rhe $100 deposir as a service charge. The entire deposit will be forfeited i f
cancellation ir after these dares.
7
.
Breakage and Fine . . . . . . . . . . .
. ... . ... . . . , ..... . .... . . . .. . ... .. . . .. .
25.00
Charged to all students at registration and refundable upon graduation, transfer to
another institution, or discontinuation of education at Augsburg.
Payments
Semester Fees - Prior to the start of each semester a "Statement of Estimated
Charges" showing basic charges and credits designated by the Student Financial
Services Office is sent to the student from the Business Office.
Payment Options - (1) Annual payments, due August 20 as billed; (2) Semester
Payments, due August 20 and January 20 as billed; (3) Payment Plan - upon
application and after College approval, a three-month plan is available each
semester. Details are included with the Estimate of Charges I ~ r t e r .( 4 ) Deferred
Payments, an individual contract with a private commercial aaencv which operates
independently of the College. Multiple year as well as sin le year contracts are
available. An information letter and brochure will be rnaiFL. Refrr a[so to the
Parent Loan Program (PLUS) on page 18.
Tuition is set on an annual basis, payable in two equal installments at the beginning
of each semester. Registration is permitted only if the student's account for a
previous term is paid in full. Augsburg College will not release academic or
financial aid transcripts until all student accounts are paid in full or, in the case of
loan funds administered by the College (National Direct/Defense Student LoansNDSL), are current according to established repayment schedules.
Refunds
Cancellation from College forms are available in the Center for Student Development. They must be filled out completely, signed, and turned in to the Registrar's
Office. Students who properly withdraw, drop to part-time, are dismissed, or are
released from a housing contract will have their accounts adjusted for tuition and
room (except for the minimum deduction of $100.00 to cover administrative costs)
according to the following schedule:
100% -through
90% - f r o m the
80% - f r o m the
70% - f r o m the
60% - f r o m the
50% - f r o m the
the first five days of classes.
sixth through 10th day of classes.
11th through 15th day of classes.
16th through 20th day of classes.
21st through 25th day of classes.
26th day of classes through the mid-point of the term.
N o refund will be made after the middle of the term. Board refunds are made o n a
proportionate basis.
If a student is forced to cancel registration during the first one-half of the term due to
illness or accident, the charges will be reduced by one-half upon submission of a
report from the attending physician stating the inability or inadvisability of
continued enrollment.
Student%who elect to omit an interim or to graduate in December are not entitled to
a refund af interim tuition, room, and board charges. Students who participare i n a n
approved off-campus interim are eligible to apply for a board refund and room
sub-lease. Details and request forms are available in the Office of Studenr Life.
All refunds of charges will be applied to the account of the student and all
adjustments for aid, loans, fines and deposits, etc. will be made before eligibility
for a cash refund i s determined.
16/Financial Aid
Financial Aid
The financing of post-secondary education may wet1 be one of t h e more significant
invenments that an individual or a family will make ~na n entire lifetime. Because this
is thecase, proper planning and wise choicesare important, not only in the selection
of an institution, but also in the methods utilized In paving he related expenses.
Augsburg College. through its Office of Student Financial Services, is committed to
he! provide students and their families with the needed assistance, both monetary
an8advir.ory, that will prorect arcerr to a quality edurarion i n rpiie of increasing
costs.
Finanrial assistance a w a r d ~ d~ h r o u g hA u g b u r g i s a combinat~onof scholarships,
grants, loans, and part-time work opportunities. The College cooperates with
Federal, State, church, and private agencies i n providing various aid rograms. For
the academic year 1981-82 ap roximately 90% of all students at Augs u r received
~
srh~larrhi~r,
laanr nnBpait-time employmenl totalling over S~CIOO.OOOfrom
all aid sources.
g
The primary responsibility for financing a college education rests upon the student
and family. Financial aid is intended to supplement student and family resources.
The amount of assistance for which a student is eligible i s determined with the help
and analysis of tlie Family Financial Statement (FFS) of the American CollegeTesting
Program (ACT) or the Financial Aid Form (FAF) of the College Scholarship Service
{CSS). These analyses estimate the amount a student and family can provide for
college expenses, taking into account such family financial factors as current
income. assets. number of dependents, other educational expenses, debts, retirement needs, and special considerations.
How and When to Apply
New Students - Regular Admission
1. A ply for admission to Augsburg College. No financial aid notification is made
untirthe student has applied and been accepted for admission.
2. Obtain the Family Financial S r a ~ e r n e n (FFS)
t
or Financial Aid form (FAFI from a
high school or college financial aid office. Comptere the applica~ionand send i t ta
the processing agency after January1bur before March 7 for priority cons~deratlon.
Minnesota residenrs must complete the FFS which includes t h e a pl~cationfor the
Minnesota State Scholarrhip/Cranr Program. (To be considere2 ure code 6500.)
Augsburg's code on.the FFS is 2080. For nun-Minnesota resid~ntsusing tlte FAF.
Augsburg's code is 6014.
3. Within three to four weeks, Augsburg will receive the analysis. If at that time you
areaccepted for admission, the Financial Aid Committee will meet and review your
eligibility for all the programs available. A letter will be sent to you detailing the
students' financial aid package.
4. Acceptance of this financial aid package i s required within the deadline stated. If
necessary, the appropriate loan forms and/or work applications will then be sent t o
you.
5. Transfer students must submit a financial aid transcript from each college
previously attended.
Financial A i d / l 7
New Students - Early Decision
This i s for students who select Augsburg as their primary college choice. An Early
Decision Candidate must apply by November 15 of the senior year and will receive
the admission decision about December 1.
1. 'Early Decision Candidates applying for financial aid may wish to complete the
Augsburg Early Decision Financial Aid Application, available by writing or calling the
Admissrons Office. This enables our Financial Aid Office t o compute a preliminary
award before the Family Financial Statement is filed. Candidates will be notified of
their award by Januarv 1.
2. For confirmation of the tinancial aid award package, with any necessary revision,
the FFS (or FAF for non-~Uinnesotaresidents) must be completed after prior
calendar year i n c o m ~infarmation is available. This is after January 1 but before
March 1.
Returning Students
Eligibility for assistance must be re-established each academic year by refiling the
application and financial statement. Renewal is based on financial eligibility,
satisfactory academic progress, and fund availability.
Kinds of Aid
A student applying for aid from Augsburg applies for assistance in general rather
than for a s ecific scholarship or grant. The various forms of aid available are listed
here for inkrmation only.
In addition to aid administered by Aupsburg College. students are ur ed to
invertigare the possibility ofrrholarihipr, g r a n s and loans thar might beavaiEbie in
their own camrnunities. It could be worthwhile t o check with churches, the
company or business employing parents or spouses, high schools, service clu bs, and
fraternal organizations for information on aid available to students meeting their
requirements. In addition to these sources, some students are eligible for aid
,
through Vocational Rehabiliration, Education Assistance for V e r e r a n ~ Educationaj
Assistance for Veterans' Children, and others.
Gift Assistance
Presidents Scholarships- Awarded to incoming freshmen based on high academic
achievement, personal qualities, a personal interview, and an essay. Several full
tuition and half tuition award winners are annually designated by the President of
Augsburg College.
Augsburg Tuition Grant - Available to students who have shown academic
potential and have financial need. A grant may pay up to full tuition and fees. A
student's scholastic standing, test scores, and high school and community involvement are taken into consideration.
Minnesota State Scholarshi and Grant - Awarded by the state to Minnesota
r ~ r i d e n r swho have iinaniiarneed. For 1982-83, they range from $100 to $1050. All
applicants from Minnesota are expected to apply before the priority deadline of
April 23.
18/Financial A i d
Supplemental Educational Opportunity Grant - 4 federal program administered by
t h c Colleye. To be ~ l i g r h l r a, person m u ~ r :(1) be a L.5, c ~ t i z e nor permanent
reqidcnt: ( 2 ) have s u i f ~ r i e n tf~nancial need as detincd bv rhe program and
d ~ r n o n s t r a ~ rt3v
d rhe FFS (or FAF); (31 bc c a p a b l ~of maintaining satisfactory
a r a d ~ m i cstanding at rhe College; and (4) he accepted for admision.
Pell Grants - A federal program that provides Pell Grant awards to students who
attend eligible institutions of higher education. The maximum grant eligibility for
each student for 1981-82 is $1670, minus the amount the student and family can be
expected to contribute. The grants are based on need as determined by the program
guidelines. Application is made by filing the FFS (or FAF) and requesting on the
application form that the necessary information be sent to the appropriate Pell
Grant office.
Bureau of Indian Affairs kholarships/Grant -American Indian students who meet
t ~ d r r aand
l stare requrremenr5 mai appIvfar Bureauof Indian Affairs,Tribal and/or
Indian State Scholarship monies. S l u d ~ n r smust bc r i degree Indian ancestry and be
enrolled with a fcdcrallv recognized tribc, lndian grants supplement all other
rourccs of financial aid. For assistance in application contact Augsburg's American
Indian Program Director or your tribal agency.
Loan Assistance
National Direct Student Loans (NDSL) - join1 Augsburg College-federally funded
program administered through the Cotlegc for studenrs who demonstrate financial
rligrbility. Loans arp interest free during your education. N o inrerest accrues nor
do avmenrs have to be made on the principal at any time you are enrolled a l least
halfiime. Slrnple interest of 5':. and repilvmenr of the principal (at ihc minimum of
5311 a rnnnzh) begin ~ i months
x
afrer vou leave schoot. Repavment rnav extend u
to 10 vears. The loan carries a teacher cancellation clause. She maximum whic
may be borrowed for undergraduate sturiv is $6,000
R
Guaranteed Student Loan (GSL) and Minnesota State Studmt Laan - Programs
backed bv either t h e f ~ d e r aor
l state governmen?. Loan funds are obtained directly
from a local lender or state povernrnent in stares which provide w c h programs.
LVhile the student is attending a t least half-time, rhere i s na inrerest charge.
Beginn~ngIanunrv 1.1981. simple annual interest of gom+
on the loan balance and
repavrnent of the principal begin six months after you leave schunl. Repaymen1
rnav extend up 10 10 wars. The maximum loan is $7500 ppr year w i t h the
cumulative undergraduate rnaximun~of $12.500. "Ipplications are available a t the
college. sc3rne banks, and the Minnesota Stare Student Loan Office.
Nursing Student Loan - Fcderal pro$ram with provisions similar to the National
Direct Student Loan pro ram, but restriaed to applicants accepted or enrolled in
t h e program leading tot i e baccalaureate degree in nursing. Recipients must have
financial n ~ e d
and be registered full rime. The maximum loan is $2500 per year.
i:
Parent Loan Program /PLUS) - PLUS i s a new loan program to help parents meet
collcge cost5. Parents m a v borrow up to 53,000 per year with a n rlggregate
rnaxtrnum ot $15.000. Repayment begins within 60 days of check disbursrmerlI a t a
simple interest rate of 14"r)and a minimurn paymcnl af '550 per month. Application
forms are available at 4upsbur College or the lending rnstitutions. .%ppEicarions
are normally filed with thc hanf or t h i i d,t 1n5titution with which vour farnilu.has a n
account.
A
Student Employment
Augsbury College provides work opportunities for studenrr with proven financial
need who are at least one-half time srudenrs. Assignmenr is made o n the basis of
need and potential compezence in performing the duries assigned. Part-time work
p r o v i d e d by r h College
~
i s considered financial atd. just as scholarships, loans, and
grants. A mavimum of 1 5 hours of on-campus emplovment pcr week i s
recommended.
All on-campus work is governed by policies stipulated in the work contract issued
to the student employee for each placement. Payment is made monthly by check
to the student employee.
College Work Study Program and Minnesota State Work Study Program - Under
these rograms the federal or state government supplies funds on a matching basis
with t k College r o provide some part-time work opportunities.
Aid Association for Lutherans Work Service Program - A special program of
off-campus placement in Lutheran congregations, with work assignments made at
the discretion of the congregation, which will support the life and mission of the
congregation.
Sponsored Scholarships
Scholarship winners are selected by the Student Affairs Committee. For departmental scholarships, winners are recommended by faculty of the department
involved.
These scholarships are available to Augsburg students who will be Sophomores,
Juniors and Seniors. Descriptions of awards are from statements of the donors'
wishes.
General Scholarships
Charles and Ellora Alliss Educational Foundation - A number of awards of varying amounts
(minimum $500) are made each year on the basis of financial need and ability.
Alma Jensen Dickerson Memorial Scholarship
- awarded annually to deserving junior/
senior students.
Elias B. Eliason, Sr. Memorial Scholarship - established in 1979 by his family. One or more
scholarships will be awarded annually to needy and deserving upperclass students.
Oliver M. and Alma Jensen Dickerson Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually to two
deserving junior/senior students.
M. J. Estrem Scholarship - awarded annually to a worthy student of the College
established in 1979 by members of his family. One or more
David J. Formo Scholarshi
scholarships will be a w a r f e d a n n u a ~ lto
~ a junior or senior student who has successfully
overcome adversity and has achieved excellence i n academic and extracurricular performnce
Catha JonesMemorial Scholarships - awarded annually to female students transferring from
Waldorf College. Preference given to those i n music and/or elementary education.
Memorial Scholarship -awarded
annually to an able and deserving upperclass student
Minnesota Mining & Manufacturing Scholarships - established i n 1972 t o b e distributed t o
needy students.
Douglas Ollila Memorial Scholarship - $250 awarded t o a senior.
Quanbeck Scholarship Fund - established i n 1963 by a bequest of J o h n G. Quanbeck,
awarded annually t o freshmen students who without assistance would be unable t o pursue
higher education.
Reader's Digest Endowed Scholarships -awarded
t o able and deserving upperclass students.
Tozer Foundation kholarships - u p t o 51000 ~ a c h
- awartfetf on the bas~sof scholarsh~p,
p e r ~ o n d l i t vand
,
n t r r l . I l i n n e n must be junior nr senior students ivho a r e residents of the
Slate of hllnnesota bur nor reridents of Pine. Kanahec or Xashinpron Counties. Separate
application re uired oi srml-itnallsts selertrtl hv rhe irholarshlp comrnirre~.FFS must be sent
to Twr.r Foun4datlon rod^ 65--)
Edward Yokie Memorial Scholarship - awarded to an able and deserving junior o r senior
student.
Special Scholarships
Aid Association for Lutherans - awarded t o able and deserving upperclass students w h o are
certificate (policy) holders with Aid Association for Lutherans Insurance Company.
Mildred Ryan Cleveland Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually t o able and deserving
students, w h o have physical disabilities and have demonstrated financial need.
Lutheran Brotherhood Scholarship - awarded t o able and deserving students who-are policy
holders with Lutheran Brotherhood.
The Rev. Horace E. Nyhus Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually t o a deserving senior.
M i n o r i t y Student Scholarships/Grants
Aid Association for Lutherans Minority Scholarship Program -awarded
American minority students w h o show financial need.
annually t o Lutheran
Minnesota Mining & Manufacturing Minority Student Scholarship - established i n 1973 t o
be awarded t o a Black student.
Marlys Johnson Simengaard Memorial Scholarship - awarded periodically t o a Black
American student.
National Scholarship & Grant Program for Minority Students (sponsored by The American
Lutheran Church) - Members of American racial and ethnic minorities w h o are either
seeking admission t o an American Lutheran Church (ALC) college OR are members of an
ALC congregation may be considered. Winners are selected by Augsburg's Student Affairs
Committee.
Marilyn Petersen Memorial Scholarships
students.
-
awarded annually t o upperclass Oriental
Homecoming Auction Scholarship - awarded annually t o t w o minority students by contributions from faculty, administration, staff and students at the Homecoming auction.
Religion & Christian Service Scholarships
Norman and Louise Bockbrader Scholarship - awarded t o students preparing for full-time
service careers i n the church.
Thorvald Olsen Burntvedt Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually t o a student(s) i n t h e
senior class w h o is preparing for the ministry.
lver and Marie lverson Scholarship - awarded on the basis of need, character and interest i n
Christian service.
Gerda Mortensen Memorial Scholarship - Winners are selected on the basis of scholarship,
characteristics of service and devotion to the Christian faith.
Onesimus Scholarship - awarded periodically to students preparingforthe Christian ministry.
The Reverend Olaf Rogne Memorial Scholarship- awarded on the basis of need, scholarship
and interest in Christian service.
The Reverend Lawrence and Gertrude Sateren Scholarship -awarded to students preparing
in fields leading to full-time service in the church.
Marguerite Hamilton Storley Memorial Scholarshir - awarded annually t o an able and
deserving junior/senior'student recommended by t e scholarship committee. Semi-finalists
are interviewed and selected by donor.
Morris G. C. and Hanna Vaagenes Missionary Scholarship Fund - awarded to a junior/senior
student preparing for service as a missionary through the World Missions Department of the
American Lutheran Church.
Departmental Scholarships
Art
Crown Princess Sonja Art Scholarship - established by the Crown Princess of Norway t o be
awarded anriually to a talented art student with financial need.
Athletic
Paul Dahlen MemorialScholarship- awarded annually t o an able and deserving male student
on basis of Christian purpose, athletic and academic achievement.
-
Paul Dahlen
Gerald Pryd Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually to a male student or
students on basis of personality, character, athletic and academic achievement.
Magnus A. Kleven Family Scholarship - awarded annually to a male student on basis of
achievement, personal character, and promise i n field of physical education.
James Winkler Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually to a male student on basis of
personality, character, athletic ability and academic achievement.
Peterson Football Scholarship - awarded to a freshman football player on basis of financial
need.
Sandbo Football Scholarship - awarded to a football player o n basis of financial need.
Keith Hoffman Memorial Scholarship - awarded to a student because of his academic
achievement, personal character, and ability in field of athletics.
David Gronner MemorialSchrrlarship Fund -awarded to two or more students participatin~
in athtetlcs or music. She award IS "made to students who have demonstrated financial need
and/or "oi h ~ g Christian
h
character". The tthleticscholarship i s for a male candidate only, with
a preference ror basketball.
Rory Jordan Memorial Scholarship - one or more scholarships are awarded annually to
upperclass students participating in intercollegiate sports, with preference given to wrestlers.
Biology
Biology Scholarships -established i n 1972 by the faculty of the Biology Department to honor
outstanding students who intend to major i n Biology, Natural Scienceor MedicalTechnology.
Business
Gamble-Skogmo Foundation Scholarship - awarded to one or more upperclass students
interested i n the field of business.
Reid Scholarship - awarded to one or more upperclass students who are interested in business
and/or education.
GertrudeS. Lund Memorial Scholarship - One or more scholarships will be awarded annually
t o a junior or senior majoring i n Business Administration.
Chemistry
Ellen and Courtland Agre Chemistry Award - given to a chemistry major, preferably one
going into graduate studies to earn the doctorate in chemistry.
Awarded to students whose academic record indicates promise of achievement i n the field of
Chemistry.
Manivald Aldre Memorial Chemistry 5cholarship.
Carl Fosse Memorial Chemistry Scholarship.
Federick C. and Laura E. Mortensen Chemistry Scholarship.
Dr. W. M. Silndsfrom Chemistry Scholarship.
Walter Cordon Schell Memorial Chemislrv Scholarship.
Walter E. Thwaite, Jr. Memorial Chemistry Scholarship.
Covey Hendrickson Memorial Chemistry Scholarship.
Education
David Mathre Scholarship - awarded to qualified full-time students in need of financial
assistance during the term i n which they are student teaching.
English
Anne Pederson English Scholarship - awarded annually to junior/senior students who are
majoring in English with preference given to those who plan to teach English as a career.
Professor P.A. Sveeggen Memorial Scholarship - awarded to an outstanding student i n the
field of English.
Foreign Language
M i m i Baez Kingsley M o d e r n Language Scholarship - awarded annually to junior/senior
students who are majoring in a modern language with preference given to those who plan to
teach language as a career.
Foreign Travel Scholarship - available to language majors studying a language abroad during
the academic year, to help with travel expenses. Aspecial application i s required by the Foreign
Language Department.
Health-Related
Ellen and Courtland Agre Pre-Medicine Award - given to a student of any major who i s
planning on entering medical school to earn a doctorate in medicine.
Eleanor Christensen Edwards Memorial Scholarship - established in 1978 for upperclass
students preparing for a career in medicine or health.
History
Dr. Carl H. Chrislock History Scholarship - awarded annually to a history major.
The Rev. and Mrs. 0.1.Haukeness Award - given to a senior student for excellence in the
study of history.
H. N. Hendrickson History Scholarship - awarded annually to students majoring in history
with preference given to those who plan a career i n the field.
Library Science
Library ScienceScholarship -established
choosing librarianship as a career.
in 1971 to honor one or more outstandingstudent(s)
Mathematics
Minnesota Gas Company Scholarship - generally awarded to able and deserving junior/senior
students majoring i n mathematics or the sciences on basis of need and academic ability.
Matheinatics Scholarship - awarded to an able and deserving student in the field of
mathematics.
Music
Peggy Christensen Benson Memorial Scholarship - awarded annually to a student studying
choral music.
lngaborg C. Christenson Scholarship - awarded to a student on the basis of skilled
performance or aptitude in stringed instruments.
David Gronner Memorial Scholarship Fund -awarded to two or more students participating
in athletics or music. The award is "made to students who have demonstrated financial need"
and/or "of high Christian character."
0.1. Hertsgaard Scholarship - awarded annually to junior/senior students who have
demonstrated proficiency i n choral and/orinstrumental music, who show interest or potential
in conducting and who show promise of over;~ll academic success.
Leonard and Sylvia Kuschel Scholarship - awarded to upperclass students seeking to acquire
musical and performance skills in instrumental music with preference given to those
candidates who have shown proficiency in keyboard instruments.
Edwin W.and Edith B. Norberg Scholarship-awarded to music majors preparingforcareers in
church music.
Henry P. Opseth Music Scholarshippromise i n the field of music.
awarded to a sophomore/junior student of outstanding
Schubert Club Scholarship - awarded annually to a music therapy student.
Marilyn Solberg Voice Scholarship - awarded to an Augsburg student who has music as a
rnajor/minor and who shows outstanding promise for achievement in the art of singing.
John and Vera Thut Scholarship - one or more scholarships will be awarded annually to
upperclass students who have achieved excellence in music.
Physics
Theodore
physics.
J.Hanwick Scholarship - awarded annually to an upperclass student majoring i n
Political Science
Political Science Scholarship - A n
political science.
award of recognition to an outstanding senior majoring in
Sociology
Adolph Paulson Memorial Prize - awarded annually to a student i n the general field of
Christian Sociology.
24/Student Life
Religious Life - 25
Student Government - 25
'Athletics - 26
Student Activities - 26
Student Services - 26
Center for Student Development - 27
Intercultural Center - 27
Health Service - 28
Food Service - 28
Residence Life - 28
Student Rights - 29
' D a y in May"
- a Spring celebration
Student Life/25
Student Life
Your experiences in rhe classroom are the primary aspecr of your colle e life, but
learning and development also occur i n formal and informal aaivitiesof t e College
and the metropolitan area. Whether you are a resident or commuter student, you
will find that the climate for learning and living a t Augsburg can add dimension to
your education.
&,
Religious Life
As a college of the church, we are concerned about spiritual, as well as academicand
social, growth. Our concern for spiritual growth is evident in the opportunities we
encourage and provide for students to explore their own faith.
Since our campus is comprised of individuals from many different religious and
cultural backgrounds, QUr worship life i s characterized by a similar diversity and
richness of tradition. Bibhe studies, fellowship groups, Gospel teams, planning
committees, retreats, Peace and ]usrice forums, Hunger conferences, concerts, and
plays and movies are examples of the wide variety of activities on campus.
This ministry finds its most visible expression i n chapel worship where students,
faculty and staff gather each Monday, Wednesday, and Friday to give thanks and
hear the Word proclaimed by a number of speakers. Each Wednesday night
students gather for Holy Communion.
W e seek ro develop a
graduafly change and
church. we encourage
the kind and quality of life that reaches beyond one's years at Augsburg.
The College Pastor has an office in the College Center t o be readily available for
counseling, consultation or information on ways to get more involved in religious
activity and groups.
Student Government
Student government i s the vehicle through which students can secure a closer
relatfenship and better understanding with the administration and faculty, and
provide input into t h e decision-making process a t Aug~burg.Student government
also sponsorsand direasstudent aaivities, protectsjtuclent righrs, and provides the
means fordisclrisiansand action on a l l issues pertaining to student life at Augsburg.
Student government i s organized info the executive branch, the legislative branch,
and t h e judicial branch. Elections are held in the spring except for freshmen who
elea their r e resentatives in !he fall of their first year. Many kinds of involvement
are posr;lble ram proqram planning to writing or editing to service opportunities.
li you want to get in~oliled,contact the President or Vice President of the student
society in their offices in the College Center.
/'
Social, Cultural, and Recreational
Throu hout the year, a variety of social and cultural activities takes place on campus
as we~fasi n the Twin Cities. These activities include dances, special dinners, name
entertainment, and visiting personalities i n various fields.
26/Student Services
The College Center is the focus of leisure-time activ%yo n campus. Offices for the
College newspaper, the Augshur Echo, and the yearbook, the Augburgian, are on
the lower level. l s n y of the c l u f r rhat unite clarrroom or non-clasrroorn related
intererrs meet in r h e Center. KC,MR, fludent-operated nan-profit radio station
serving the needs of Augsburg and t h e surrounding Cedar-Riverside community, is
located i n Mortensen Tower.
There are several opportunities for partici ation in music and drama. In addition to
appearing an campus and in the city, t e Augsburg Choir, Concert Band, and
Orchestra perform o n national and international tours. Many other ensembles are
available to cover the entire range of musical styles and previous musical
experience. Several plays are given on campus each year under the direction of the
theater a n 5 department.
R
lntercollegiate Athletics
Au sburg is affiliated with Minnesota Intercollegiate Athletic Conference (MIAC)
a n 8 is a member of both the National Association of Intercollegiate Athletics
(NAIA) and the National Co[legiate Athletic Association (NCAA). Men annually
compete in football. soccer, cross country, basketball, hockey, wrestling, baseball,
track, and golf. Women annually compete in volleyball, cross country, gymnastics,
basketball, track Pc field. and $oftball.
lntramurals
Every student is urged to participate in some activity for recreation and relaxation.
An intramural program provides competition i n a variety of team sports as well as
individual performance activities. Broomball has been an especially popular coed
sport. Check schedules for times when there i s open use of the gymnasium and ice
arena.
Student Activities
A variety of interests are served by groups and clubs and by events sponsored by the
student government. If you need information or wish to initiate a new group or
activity, contact the Student Activities Director.
Student Services
kugsburg College i s concerned with educating the whole person and recognizes
that the cont~xZin which l ~ a r n i lakes
n ~ place i s a crirical tactor in a t h i ~ v i n optimal
g
growth. Knowled e grows from mare than intellectual endeavors. Expandin
iela~ionships,e r p 6 r i n g v ~ i u e r ,identifying Me styles, develnping auranomy an
~nterdependence,
finding purposeand commitment -all combine with in~ellectual
content and skills to produce the desired educarional impact of the collegc on its
3
students.
The Division of S t u d ~ n thifairs has been created to sup' ort this task. During the
summer before your freshman year, or at the t i n e of trans er, you will receive a copy
of SEMAPHORE: Student Guide to a College Educat~on.This book will help you
assess the possibilities in your education, choices to make, directions to consider
and different destinations for which to pIan. SEMAPHORE was designed tb act as a
sort of road map for you.
P
CSD, Intercultural Center/27
Center for Student Development
The Center for Student Development provides a variety of services to help make
your journey as rich and meaningful as possible. Some of the opportunities you may
wish to participate in are listed below.
Summer Orientation. You can plan your firrt academic year and pre-register for
classes. You and your parents ger acquainred with classmates, faculty, and staff as
well as with the campus. You stav in thcdormitorv, attend events in the metropolitan
area and seek answers to the many quesi~omyou have about college life.
Career Plannin and Placement. You rnav be uncertain about where you want to be
when you finis r your undergraduate experience, whether your life style will be a
balanced one, how work will provide opportunity for service and fulfillment.
Augsburg has a lour-year career development plan to help vou assess yourself.
explore possibilities, test realities and prepare for entry inlo the next phase of your
life. All new students will have a chance to review rheir interests with a counselor.
?
Human Devefo ment Seminars. A serles of informal "mini-courses'' are offered
each year to herp you grow in understanding of yaurrelf and vour relatinnrhip ro
orhers. Such topics a s PEER (Positive Educational Experiences in Relationships],
y.
JobSeeking, and Sexuality are
Issues i n Men'< and Women's I d ~ n t ~ rAssertiveness.
available. Information on current offerings and opparrunityto register are provided
several times during t h e year.
Academic Enrichment. You may want to improve your skills in such areas as reading,
studving, n o t e - t a k i n ~and
,
testing by attendine one or more of the workshop5
offered. You a150 win have an opportunity to meet with a counselor T O diagnose
your needs. If a particular course proves difficult, you can arrange for tutoring
through the Center.
Counseling and Guidance. Sometimes students find it difficult t o cope with relationships or situations which they encounter during their college experience.
Counselors are available to help students who are experiencing personalhnterpersonal difficulties by providing individual and group counseling and a variety of
personal growth groups.
Learning for Living. A series of mini-classes designed for the person who has a desire
t o explore new interests, enhance leisure time, and meet others doing the same.
This i s a non-profit effort of the Student Activities program.
Intercultural Center
As a College in the city, committed t o the values and insights of cultural diversity,
Augsburg offers special advocacy and counseling for all minority students in close
cooperation with administrators, faculty and community. At the present time these
efforts concentrate in two major areas:
American lndian Programs. Augsburg offers an American lndian student support
program to meet the special needs of lndian students. The American lndian
Programs Director provides recruitment, courses, supportive services, community
service and activities to improve educational opportunities for American Indians.
Black Student Programs. A counselor with responsibilities in recruitment, supportive services, community service and activities coordinates Black student activities.
The Black Student Union (BSU) provides a focus for many activities and programs.
28/Residence Life
The other facet of Augsburg's Intercultural Center focuses on students who are
from or are interested in studying in other countries, and in planning activities and
events which can increase intercultural awareness of students, faculty and staff.
Foreign Study. If you are interested in study abroad, consult the faculty member
who serves as Director of lnternational Programs to check on the many opportunities
available.
lnternational Students. If you are a student from another country or would like to be
part of the activities of this group, contact the faculty member who i s appointed
lnternational Student Adviser.
Health Service
Your health needs will be met by the staff of Smiley's Point Clinic located on
Riverside A v ~ n u ~ a c r o rhc
s s strcer from the campus. Visits are free except for special
testing or service. and prescriptions a r e availab[e through the Fairview Pharmacy at
cost. Be sure to check \,our iarnily health coverage toc3etermine if you are included;
if n o r , a studen7 health insurance plan is avarlahle.
Food Service
The Commons, situated on the top floor of the College Center, is the main food
service facility for students, faculty and staff. This pleasant room features small table
units for easy conversation and overlooks the College Quadrangle and Murphy
Square. The portions are generous and modestly priced. Students on board plan
who live in residence halls eat their meals in the Commons.
Thechinwag, located on the ground floor of the Center,features short orders and is
open through the noon hour and in the evenings.
Augsburg provides a variety of board plan options for those living in College houses
or nearby apartments.
Residence Life
Because Augsburg recognizes t h a ~a srudentk aabilitv to respond to the learning
r
conditions, a variety of l~ousing
environmen r depends, i n art, upon his or h ~living
aliernatives i i provided. TEe residence hall program i i designed to promoterrudcnt
growth throu3h relationships with other students and being an acjive parricipant in
yroupdeci51on-makin?. Each restdenc~unit h a s o n e o r m o w Resiclent Staff who are
able to factlitare the process of group living asnell asdiscuss personal concernswith
Individual students.
All freshmen and sophomores not living at home are required to live i n collegeoperated housing. Married student housing is available in annex housing and
Kueffner Apartments.
Students enpaye a room at the beginning of the fall term for the entire school year.
New studentc r ~ c e i v eroom assignments during the summer before they enroll at
Augsburg. Upperclass students make housing arrangements in the spring. All
res~dentstudcnts must 3ign housing contracts.
Freshmen and transfer students are urged to make the tuition deposit by June 1 i n
order to secure housing. Students who deposit after June1will be provided housing
only if space i s available.
Student Rights/29
All students living on campus are required to pay an advance payment when they
sign the housing contract. The fee i s credited to the students' accounts when they
move into the residence.
All new freshmen and some upperclass students live in Urness Tower. This elevenstory high-rise houses 324. Each floor is considered a house unit providing 36
students, two to a room, with their own lounge, study and utility areas.
Mortensen Tower, the newest residence hall, i s an alternative to traditional
residence hall living. It contains 104 one- and two-bedroom apartments t o accommodate 312 upperclass students.
South Hall contains 12 apartments housing 34 upperclass students.
West Hall contains 12 one-bedroom apartments housing 24 upperclass students.
Another alternative option i s Annex Housing which provides a unique opportunitv
to f r v R r O U p living. Grou 5 of upperclass men or women share living space, house
ieiponribil~rier.and coo!ine. Houier are loca~edin the campus area. One way to
maximize the living-learning aspects of your housing situation ii TO avail vourself of
the opportunitv to bid far a house as a Special lnteresr House. Groups of 5tudents
have c r ~ a t ~evciting
d
projects by writing and implementing educational impact
proposals o n such ropics as Environmeniat Concerns, Men's and Women's A w a r e
ness, International Living, Simplified Life Styles, and Scandinavian Studies.
Mortensen Tower i s carpeted, air conditioned, and contains kitchen units. It is
otherwise unfurnished. In other residence halls or houses, rooms are furnished
except for bed linens, towels, blankets, bedspreads,and lamps. Laundry facilitiesare
available in each residence.
Student Rights
The College has adopled a statement of student rights and responsibilities and has
providecl lor due proces5 in matters of disciplinarv action, grievances. and grade
appeal. The judicial Council i s clecred by s~udenzsandIacultvand serve5 tocondua
hearings and review matterr of concern. 4ny student who wishes to identify
appropriate procedures forcomptainr should rontaa the Vice President for Student
Affairs.
The College operates in romptianre with the Family Rights and Privacy Act and Title
IX. Studenrs have the right t o inspect all official records, filesand data which pertain
ro them and w h ~ c hare maintained i n the Officeof the Registrar and the Placement
Office and to challenge inaccurate or misleading information. Exceptions are
parents' financial records and confidential letters and statements placed in the
record before lanuary 1, 1975. or placed under conditions where students have
signed a waiver of right of access. Students have the right to experience education
free from discrimination based on sex, race, ethnic, or cultural background,
handicap, creed, marital status or age.
Persons seeking additional information on these topics should contact the Center
for Student Development or the appropriate coordinator as listed in the Communication Directory on the inside front cover of this Catalog.
30/Academic Information
Degrees - 31
Academic Calendar - 31
Faculty - 31
Library, Audio-Visual, Computer - 32
Divisions - 32
Majors & Minors - 33
Teaching Licensure - 34
Certification Programs - 34
Pre-Professional Programs - 34
inter-Institutional Programs - 36
Study Abroad - 37
Honors Program - 38
Internship Program - 38
Continuing Education - 38
Registration - 38
Graduation Requirements - 39
Hats off to the graduating seniors!
Distribution Requirements -40
Grading - 41
Auditing Courses - 41
Grade Point Average - 42
Classification - 42
Advanced Placement - 42
Advanced Standing - 42
Probation and Dismissal - 42
Dean's List - 43
Graduation with Distinction - 43
lndependent/Directed Study - 43
Veterans - 43
Brief Facts - 44
Course Numbering - 46
Prerequisites - 46
Academic Information/31
Academic Information
Requirements for a degree from Augsburg College provide studen~swirh a broad
liberal arts backgrount! - In the humanities, the natural sciences and the social
sciences - and concentrated major studv i n one or more fields. Students are
encouraged to plan their own course af study with the help of facult! advisers.
Augsburg graduates are expecred to bc able to write effectively, to be knowledgeable about urban concerns. and 20 have some understand~ngof cultures
outside the United Stares. General recreational activirres roursej acquaint students
with and e uip rhem for lifetime sports. Courses In religion assist i n reflection on the
~
Church rhruugh i t u d v a i i a h e l i r i r rcrlprure.and mission.
meaning 0 7 t h Chrlrrian
Degrees Offered
Augsburg offers the Bachelor of Arts, the Bachelor of Music, and the Bachelor of
Science dcgrees. The B.S. degree i s a w a r d ~ dto graduates with majors in Medical
TcchnoEoyv, Music Therapv. Nursing and Social Work. Majors in music may select
the program lor the achet tor of Arts or the Bachelor of Music degree. Graduates
with majors i n other fields rcceive the Rachclor of Arts degree.
Academic Calendar
Augsburg follows the 4-1-4 calendar, with Fall and Spring semesters of approximately 14weeksseparated by a 4-weekJanuary Interim. Students normally take four
courses each semester and one course during Interim. A maximum of three courses
can be earned in the two annual summer sessions, one of four weeks and one of six
weeks.
The calendar i s coordinated with those of the four other colleges of the Associated
Colleges of the Twin Cities, so students can take courses on another campus during
the regular term. (See Registration).
Ianuarv Interim i 5 particularly intended to be a time for both srudenrs and facuttv to
ernplov styles of teaching and learning and to investigate questions and topics in
places and ways not possible during the r ~ g u l a rtrrm. The Interim cafalog.
publishetj in the fall of each year. I S d i ~ ~ r i h l r t etod a l l ~tudentsand i s available bv
contacting the tnterim Ofiice. In addirion to classes offcrcd on campus, there are a
variety of travel oppor~unitieswilhinthe IJnited Statesand abroad. Independent or
directed study and internships are among the many In~erirnoptions.
Faculty
Augsburg has an able faculty with a long-standing tradition of taking a personal
interest in their students. The student-faculty ratio i s approximately 14 t o 1.
Faculty membersserve as academicadvisers and are available for help on individual
problems. All students are assigned a faculty adviser to help in planning their
programs and approving their choice of courses. Faculty members are listed in each
departmental listing, u i t h f u r t h ~ rinformation in the Augsburg College Faculty
section.
Library and Audio-Visual Services
A relaxed atmosphere, a helpful staff and triendjy student library assistants make the
library a favorite place to 5tudy. The main library houses over 138,000 books,
periodicals, records, tapes and films, Music, Chemistry, and Art History slide
libraries are located within the departmental areas.
32/Academic Organization
Access to over 1,000,000 volumes is available via daily interloan and courier service
among seven private liberal arts colleges and the Hill Reference Library. Through
Minitex, the statewide network, the additional resources of Minnesota and
Wisconsin libraries are accessible to Augsburg faculty and students.
A service-dedicated staff providesstudents with assistance 10 meet diverse informainstruction in the use of the library, standard ref~renceservice,
tion needs includ~ng
guidance in pursuing term paprr topius, and directions to other local sources of
information. Special arrangements arr made for access by srudentr with physical
handicaps.
The Library Audio-Visual Center provides facilities for classes in broadcasting and
for audio-visual materials. Assistance with the production of slides, transparencies,
filmstrips and audiohide0 tape recordings is available for faculty and students.
Equipment such as movie and slide projectors and tape recorders may be borrowed
for limited periods. Film bibliographies and other advice on materials selection are
available.
Computer Resources
Augsburg has a PDP 31-60 with central memory of 256 kilobytes and terminals at
several campus locations. The College also has several Apple S
I microcomputers, a
Tektronix 4051 graphics microcomputer, and KIM-1 laboratory microcomputers.
Augsburga150 has a access to large computers through both Minnesota Educational
Computer Con5ottium and the University of Minnesota.
Academic Organization and Programs
Divisions and Departments
The colle e curriculum i s offered by 20 departments which are grouped into four
divisions or administrative and instructional purposes.
B
Humanities - Catherine Nicholl (Chairperson)
Art, English, Foreign Languages, Philosophy, Religion, Speech, Communication and
Theater Arts
Natural Science and Mathematics - Earl R. Alton (Chairperson)
Biology, Chemistry, Mathematics, Physics
Social and Behavioral Sciences - Myles Stenshoel (Chairperson)
Business Administration and Economics, History, Political Science, ~sychology,
Sociology
Professional Studies - Rosalie V. Clark (Chairperson)
Education, Health and Physical Education, Music, Nursing, Social Work
Majors and Minors/33
Majors and Minors
Majors, or concentrations of study, may be within one department, within one
division, or cross academic disciplines. Some students decide on a major or majors
before they enter college. Others test a variety of disciplines before deciding.
Normally a major should be elected by theend of the fourth semester and earlier i n
some disciplines. Details of majors and minors are in the course description section.
M a j o r s available at Augsburg are:
A r t History
Biology
Business Administration
(Accounting, Finance,
International Business,
Management, Marketing)
Chemistry
Communication
East Asian Studies'
Economics
Economics-Business Administration
Elementary Education
Engineering2
English
Foreign Languages
French, German,
Norwegian, Spanish
Health Education
History
Humanities
International Relations
Mathematics
M i n o r s available at Augsburg
Art History
Biology
Business Administration
Chemistry
Communication
Computer Science
East Asian Studies'
East and Southeast
Asian Studies
Economics
English
M e d i c a l Technology3
M e t r o - U r b a n Studies
Music
Music Therapy
Natural Science
Nursing
Philoso h y
Physica~Education
Physics
Political Science
Psychology
Religion
Russian Area Studies'
Scandinavian Area Studies
Social Science
Social W o r k
Sociology
Speech
Studio A r t
Theater Arts
Transdisciplinary
are:
Foreign Languages
French, German,
Norwegian, Spanish
Health Education
History
Library Science
Mathematics
Music
Philosophy
Physical Education
Physics
Political Science
Psychology
Religion
Russian Area Studies'
Scandinavian Area Studies
Social Welfare
Sociology
Special Education
Speech
Studio Art
Theater Art
It i s possible for students t o complete other majors through the ACTC. Students w h o wish t o
complete a major offered at one of the other ACTC colleges must apply through the Augsburg
Registrar's Office.
1 -Cooperative
Program of the Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities and agreements with
the University of Minnesota. It is possible for students t o take beginning and intermediate
courses i n Chinese, Japanese and Russian.
2 - Three-Two Plan with Washington University School of Engineering and Applied Science
and Michigan Technological University
3 - Cooperative program with Metropolitan Medical Center and Abbott-Northwestern
Hospital
34/Licensure, Certification
Teaching Licensure
Teaching Licemure programs are offered at Augsburg i n Elementary Education,
Kindrrpartcn. Prekindergarten, and thp iolrowing t i ~ l d sin 5econdarv Education:
English-Languag~Arts. Frrnch, German, Health. Lite Science, Mathematics, Physrcal
Science (Chcrnis~rvor Physics), Scienc~(Grades 5-9), Social Studies, Spanish,
Speech. Theater Arts. and in the special areas of Art (K-121, MUSIC[K-12). and
Phvsical Education (K-72). h minor i50ffered i n L~brilrvSci~nre.Students planning TO
teach an the secondary level h a t e advisers both in the Education department and
t h e area of their academic rnajor(~I.
Certification Programs
Special programs certifying skills and knowledge have been established at Augsburg
to increase vocational possibilities and/or to enhance personal growth:
Certification in Art -requires eight courses, one of which must be in art history.
Special professional or avocational concerns of those wanting to teach art in less
formal circumstances than a college are addressed. For further information, contact
the Art Department Charrperson.
Women's Studies Certification - may be earned by completing six courses focusing
on women's perspectives. Each individually planned program should include
courses in the social sciences, humanities, or other academic areas focusing on
women. Interested students should contact Dr. Toni Clark.
Church Staff Work Certification - is designed to prepare for full-time specialized
lay work in the Lutheran Church. It consists of nine courses for a Church Staff
Worker major in Religion plus additional specialized courses in psychology,
sociology, speech and physical educatian. The pro ram i s designed to meet or
exceed criteria used i n The American Lutheran C urch certification program.
Interested students should contact the Religion Department Chairperson.
t
- Provides the background for performing
systematic assessmentsof programsfor social improvements. Students are required
to complete a group of five psychology and sociology courses, including an
internship. For futher information, contactthe Psychology or Sociology Department
Chairperson.
Program Evaluation Certification
Pre-Professional Programs
Students who plan to enter the fields of law, medicine, dentistry, the ministry,
veterinary science, pharmacy, or engineering can profit from a liberal arts
education at Augsburg.
It i s recommended that requirements for admission to graduate schools or
seminaries be reviewed and the course of study a t Augsburg planned accordingly. A
faculty adviser is available in each held to assist students in their planning. It i s
recommended thar students who want to plan a pre-professional program consult
with a faculty adviser early in their freshman year.
Augsburg offers a wide scope of courses in the humanities, natural and social
sciences, religion and philosophy which will provide the preparation for future
professional study.
Pre-Dentistry - These courses are recommended to fulfill the minimum requirements of the School of Dentistry at the University of Minnesota: English, 2 courses;
Biology 111, 112; Phy~i- 727, 122; Chemistry 115, 116 (or 105, 106), 351, 352;
Mathematics 124; General Psychology, 1course. Requirementsat other universities
may vary.
Pre-Engineering - Augsburg offers a dualdegree program of liberal arts and
engineering in c o o p ~ r a t i o nwith t h e Washington University of Engineering and
Applied Science in St. Louis, Missouri,and the M~chiganTechnological University i n
Houghton, Michigan. See Engineering in the department/course section for
information on the course requirements i n t h ~ sThree-Two Plan of studies.
Pre-Law - Students planning to pursue a career i n law should consult the
handbook published by The Association of American Law Schools. and consult the
Augsburg pre-law adviser, Dr. Myles Stenshoe!. Students may wish to take the
political science course, Law i n the United States, to help determine whether they
possess an interest i n law. Since law schools encourage students to maintain a high
grade point average, the pre-law student ~ h o u l dbe aware that many graduate
schools consider the grade P given for a course as a C.
Pre-Medicine - Many medical schools are encouraging a liberal arts education t o
repare for study in medicine. A t Augsburg, the biology and chemistry departments
eave majors specially der~ynedior pre-medical students. Barh require Chemistry
115, 116 (or 105, 106), Matnematics 124, 125; and Physics 124, 122. The Chernisrry
major also requires Chemistry 353,361, one advanced course, seminar. and two or
more biology courses. The Biology major also requires Biology 117,112,491 and one
from each of three groups (351, 353, 361), (355,473,474),1440, 471,476), with 353
recommended. Designed t o meet the Univenity of Minnesota requirements, both
programs also encourage courses in the behavioral sciences and humanities,
including psychology and sociology. Requirements at other medical schools may
vary. Students are encouraged t o consult with the faculty adviser early in the
freshman year.
Pre-Pharmacy - Augsburg has a two-year program designed to fulfill minimum
requirements of the College of Pharmacy at the University of Minnesota: Biology
111,112; Chemistry 115,116,351.352; Econarnicsl22,123; English 111 andasecond
course; Health Education 110; Mathematics 124; Physics 121, 122: electives from
humanities, literature and the arts to futfill the semester hour requirements.
Requirements at other universities may vary.
Pre-Seminary - A student may enter a theological seminary with any of several
different majors, such as history, philosophy, English, psychology, sociology, or
religion. Recommended preparatron includes Religion 111, 221; at least two
semesters of history (Western Civilization); one or more courses in the history of
philosophy: and Creek in the junior and/or senior year.
Pre-Veterinary Medicine - To meet minimum requirements of the College of
Veterinary Medicine a1 the University of Minnesota, these courses are recommended: English.? courses; Mathematics 124; publics eaking,l course; Chemistry
115,116 (or 105,106), 351,352,353; Biology 111,112; Pfysics 121,112; Economics, 1
course; 2 courses in art, literature, music, humanities, theater, or upper division
foreign languages; and anthropology, economics, geography, histor , political
science, psychology or sociology courser ta fulfill the rest of the Jstribution
requirements. Requirements a t other universities may vary.
36/1 nter-l nstitutional
Inter-Institutional Programs
Augsburg cooperates with other colleges and institutions in the Twin Cities area on
several programs.
Library and Media Center - Through C.L.I.C., the Twin Cities private collcgps
library consortium, and Minitex, the statewide library network, he ,%ugsbur~
community has access to over 5,000,000 volumes. Augsburg's library works with a
collection of education materials including approximately 138,000 books, periadicals, records, tapes, scores and films.
Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities - Full-time students at Augsburg and the St.
Paul colleges of Hamline, Macalester, St. Catherine and St. Thomas may elect a
course each semester at another campus. No additional fee i s required for such an
exchange, except for private ins~ructionin music and some independent studies.
SPP Independent Study For further details. Students mav elen to participate i n zhe
cooperative program to ~ a i n
new p~rzpecrives,to get berter acquainted wirh the
other school^, or ro undertake a specific course or major not offered on the home
campus. Thc c o l l ~ q e shave c o a r d i n a t ~ dcalendarr. The interim term mav also be
l a k e n on another campus. .4 regularly scheduled busshutt les students between the
campuses.
Augsburg College also cooperates with other colleges in planning study opportunities for the January interim.
The Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs (HECUA) - This group is
composed of colleges and universities i n Minnesota, South Dakota and Wisconsin.
Planned activities include innovative curricular programs for students, interchange
and sharing of academic personnel and other college resources, cooperative
research projects, foreign study, joint sponsorship of a metro-urban affairs conference, and development of programs consistent with the needs and resources of
the community organizations of the Upper Midwest.
Chemical Dependency Program - A cooperative effort between Augsburg
College and Minneapolis Community College in downtown Minneapolis has
resulted in the establishment of a four-year program i n social work, sociology or
psychology with a chemical dependency specialty. The program is designed t o
train specialists to help professional people in dealing with chemical dependency
problems. Courses are taken both on the Augsburg and Metropolitan campuses.
Conservation of Human Resources (CHR) - These co-learning classes bring
together Augsburg students, prison inmates, mental hospital patients, guards, and
students at rehabilitation centers. Classes are held at such places as the Shakopee
Institution for Women, Stillwater State Prison, Trevilla of Robbinsdale (a center for
the severely physically handicapped), or on the Augsburg campus. The classes
offered through several departments give students first-hand views of the prisons,
hospitals and rehabilitation centers. The response of students involved in the
courses, both from Augsburg and the institutions, has been extremely favorable.
Computer Programming - Augsburg and Control Data Institute have an arrangement whereby students may transfer the equivalent of three courses i n computer
programming taken at CDI to Augsburg College.
Study Abroad/37
Air Force ROTC - Augsburg students may participate i n Air Force ROTC at The
College of St. Thomas under the ACTC consortium agreement. Students are
eligible to compete for 2- and 3-year AFROTC scholarships. For more information,
contact the Dean of the College.
Opportunities for Study Abroad
Several types of international experience are available to Augsburg students. Some
of them are briefly described below. For application procedures and further
information, request the special brochure on lnternational Study at Augsburg from
the Director of lnternational Programs. Since there is a limit on the number of
students who may study abroad each year it is wise to apply in the fall prior to the
year one wishes to participate in an international program.
Associated Colleges of the Twin Cities Programs - Students may participate in the
ACTC program in Germany and Vienna, spending January and February in
intensive language study in Germany, and March through May in a regular
semester program in Vienna, where a variety of course offerings is available.
Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs - Augsburg students may take
part in the Scandinavian Urban Studies Term (Oslo) or the South American Urban
Semester (Bogota) programs. Both programs are interdisciplinary and stress cross
cultural comparison in development and planning, including study tours to other
nations in their respective regions.
'
Interim - Study abroad during the interim is planned for each year. See listings
under the Augsburg lnterim Catalog and in the brochure on Interims Abroad
issued each spring for the following January.
lnternational Business Program - See under Business Administration, page 53.
Program in Global Community - Augsburg's 3% month IivingAearning program
based in Cuernavaca, Mexico, focuses on the study of issues related to global
justice and human liberation in the light of Christian proclamation. Includes
intensive Spanish instruction, group trips, home stay with a family, and cultural
activities. The cost, including travel, is equivalent to full room, board, and tuition
for one term at Augsburg. Application and interview required, enrollment limited.
Semester or Year Abroad - Arrangements have been made under which Augsburg
students may spend their sophomore or junior year in study at a number of foreign
educational institutions. Among them are the University of Oslo, Norway; Schiller
College i n London and Heidelberg; the University of Bath, England; the University
of Dundee, Scotland; the University of Seville, Spain; and the Institute for
American Universities in Avignon, France.
Student Project for Amity Among Nations - Augsburg participates i n the SPAN
program. This is a joint venture of the University of Minnesota and several colleges
in the state. Each year three or four countries are selected, and qualified students are
granted partial scholarships to enable them to spend a summer in informal study in
one of the countries chosen. Applications to the program are made in the spring of
the freshman or sophomore year. The SPAN program consists of three stages:
language study and group meetings during the school year before departure,
independent study abroad a topic of one'schoice during the following summer,and
the writing of a paper upon return.
38/Academic Policies
Summer School - There is a wide variety of possibilities for those who wish-to
spend a summer studying abroad. Recently Augsburg students have spent
summers in Norway, Spain, Mexico, France, Greece, Germany, and England. Those
interested in further information should contact the Director of International
Programs.
Honors Program
The Honors Program at Augsburg is designed to provide opportunities for
qualified students to pursue an enriched and sometimes accelerated course of
study. Special seminars, colloquia, honors student forums and options i n completing the general education requirements are all parts of the Honors Program.
Inquiries should be addressed to Dr. Benjamin Cooper, Honors Director.
Internship Program
The Internship Program i s a college-wide program. It provides students i n almost
all fields of study an opportunity to gain practical on-the-job experience that can
be related to their academic program or personal interests. Internships are
available with a variety of companies, agencies and community organizations.
Continuing Education Program
Augsburg College offers a number of courses, both credit and non-credit, through
its Continuing Education Program. Classes are generally i n the evening. Since
continuing education courses are offered on a semester-hour basis, the courses vary
in length from four weeks to fourteen weeks. Students wishing to know more about
Augsburg's continuing education offerings should call or write the Office of the
Associate Dean.
Academic Policies and Procedures
Registration - Semesters, Interim, Summer
A student must be registered for a course to receive credit for it.
Students normafly register for four courses a semester and onecourse in the interim.
Students registered for three or more courses in a semester are classified as full-time
students. To register for more than 4.5courses,~tudentsmu57 contact the Registrar's
office to petition the Committee on Student Standing for permission.
A joint class schedule i s published each Spring by the Associated Colleges of the
Twin Cities, listing courses and their location at the five colleges for the following
semesters.
Se arate catalogs of courses are published by the lnterim Office and Summer
Sc ool Office for those sessions at Augsburg, listing registration times and
procedures.
FI
Specific information on registration and help with registration on another campus
are available from these offices:
Office of the Registrar, Science 114, Fall and Spring terms
Interim Office, Memorial 230, Interim
Summer School Office, Memorial 230, Summer School
Graduation Requirements/39
Freshmen and transfer students have an opportunity to pre-register during summer
for courses in the fall. All currently enrolled students have an opportunity to
pre-register duringtheiall for the spring and duringthespring for both the fall and
the following spring. All students must confirm their registration at rhe beginning of
each semester and complete financial arrangemenrs.
Arthough a student may register up t o two weeks after the semester begins,
registrarlon i s encouraged at the regularly scheduled rime. Special fees are charged
for late cegistration. Special feesalso are c h a r g ~ sfor cancelling or adding courses or
changing grading option after t h e f1r51 f ~ v edays of a semester.
Students are urged not to abandon murscsfor which thev are registered, since this
results i n a failing grade on the official record. Cancellation of courses or
cancellation from College must be done i n the Registrar's Office. Cancellations
from college and resulting adjustments i n accounts are effective as of the date the
completed Cancel from College form IS rerurned to t h e Office of the Registrar.
Graduation Requirements
The responsibility for seeing that all degree requirements are satisfied rests with the
student. Academic advisers, department chairpersons, the Academic Dean and the
Registrar are available for counsel and assistance in program planning.
Each student must apply for graduation at the time specified by the Registrar.
Application forms are available in the Registrar's Office.
All degree and course requirements must be completed and verified i n the
Registrar's office prior to the anticipated date of graduation (there may be no
incompletes or open courses on the academic record).
1. Completion of 35 courses.
.4t least 71 courses musr he upper division, numbered in the 300sand 400s. Not m a r e
~ h a n13 may be in one d c p a r ~ m e n t except
,
i n certa~napproved majors for !he
B a c h ~ t o rof Science/Arts degrec. 1: for the Barhelar of Music ancl Bachelor of
Scienre in Musrc Jhera v degrees, and 18 In the Bachclor of Science i n Nursing
degree. The course rota must tnclude t h r e ~
In~erimsfor student5 w h o s ~complete
academic work 1 5 a t Augsburg. Far rransfer students, the course toral m u ~includc
t
one less inrrrim course than the number of vears at 4ugsburq.
F
No more than these maximums may be applied toward the 35rotal courses required:
4 Conservation of Human Resources 4CHR) courses: ? courses bv inde ~ n d e n t /
directed study; 4 courses of internship: and 8 courses with a grade o Pass tP).
Non-traditional grading (P) also has these lirnirs: 2 in the major except Elemcnrarv
Education and Nursing; 1 i n the minor if approvcd by the department chairperson.
P
Students who enter an academic program with a baccalaureate or higher degree
should contact the Office of the Registrar about specific requirements for a second
baccalaureate degree or for the equivalent of a major.
2. Completion of a major.
Requirements for each major are listed under the departmental headings. A minor
or double-major i s not required, but i s encouraged.
3. Grade Point average - 2.0 for most majors.
A grade point average of 2.0 i s required in all courses taken and in courses which
apply toward the major, except for Nursing and licensure i n education, where 2.5
averages are required.
40/Distri b u t i o n R e q u i r e m e n t s
4. Residence
The last year of full-time study or equivalent (minimum of 7 courses for part-time
students) must be at Augsburg.
5. Distribution requirements (See below)
Distribution Requirements
Writing - A course i n writing (English 111) or certification of demonstrated
proficiency by the Department of English. Exemption tests are given during the
summer and fall orientation periods.
Liberal Arts
An approved course from each of these seven areas:
Mathematin-Physics
Chemistry-Biolog
Psychology-Sorio ogv
English-Speech. Communication
Rc Theater Arrs
Y
Economics-Political Science
History-Philosophy
Art-Music
Foreign Languages - Two courses (I11 and 112) of one foreign language at
Aufsburg. Students who test above the Illlevel of a foreign language will take one
ad ~ t ~ o ncourse
al
at placement level in that language o r t w o courses (111 and 112) of
another foreign language.
Religious Studies - Three approved courses i n religious studies, of which not more
than one may be an interim course. For transfer students, the number required i s
one for each year of study or equivalent at Augsburg.
Urban Concerns, or Women's Studies, or Minority Studies - Courses approved to
meet this requirement are published each term. Information is available at the
Office of the Registrar.
Lifetime Sports - Two lifetime sports or demonstrated proficiency in two lifetime
sports.
Evaluation and Grading
Student achievement i n courses i s measured primarily by final examinations. Shorter
tests, written papers, oral reports, and other types of evaluation also are used.
Most courses are-offered with grading oprions - traditional grading on a 4.0 to 0.0
scale or rhe Pass/NonCreditsystem.in which P means a grade of 2.0 or better and N
means no credit and a grade of less than 2.0. Students are cautioned to use the P/N
grade o tion with care since some graduate and professional schools do not look
favorabc on a large number of P-graded courses, or rank each as a "C". See P/N
limitations under Graduation Requirements.
Certain courses are offered on one grading system only. Sociology 383 and several
interim courses are graded only on the P/N grading system. Some education courses
are raded only on the P/N system or only on the traditional s y s t ~ m English
.
Illis
grafed P or N, or 2.0-4.O/N. Some other courses are graded only P, 1.0, N.
Music organizations and performance studies, Chemistry Seminar, gnd Lifetime
Sports are graded P/O.O.
In courses where there is a choice, students will be graded on the traditional system
unless they indicate on their registration that they wish to use the P/N grading
option. Any changes i n choice of grading system must be made according to dates
published each term. A fee i s charged for any changes after the first five days of
classes.
Explanation of Grades
Number grades are used with these definitions:
4.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
Achieves highest
standards of excellence
"
Achieves above basic course standards
Meets basic standards for the course
Performance below basic course standards
Unacceptable performance (no credit for the course)
Grades of P (Pass) or N (No credit) are not computed in the grade point average. A
grade of P represents work at or above the 2.0 level; N represents work at the 1.5 or
below level.
r2n incomplete qrade mav be given ontv in the case of extreme emergency. To
rcceive it, a siudent must file a pelifinn with he Carnmirtee on Student Sfanding
staling the reasons for the rtqucrt, the plan and d a t p tor removing it.and comments
from the insrructar If permission is granted, the i n c o r n p l ~ tmust
~
be removed
during the foTlowing scrnester, ar i t becomes rhe grade s u b m i t t ~ dbv the teacher
along wirtl rhe incomplete.
A grade of X may be given for an independent o r d i r e r r ~ ds1udvcour5eor internship
that is to be spread aver more than enesemester. Strch a course must be completed
during the second semester or the grade of S wi[I remain on the t ~ c o r dIf. X i s given,
the course must be registered for a s 1 Y In the lollowing term tn order that credit and
a grade may be a5sipncdm
A course in which a grade of 0,1.0,1.5, N, I, or X has been received may be repeated
for credit. Courses i n which higher grades have been earned may not be repeated
for credit, but may be audited. All courses taken remain on the academic record.
Only the credits and grades earned the second time are counted toward graduation
and in the grade point average.
A course i s given a grade of W when it is dropped after the deadline for dropping
classes without a notation on the record.
Auditing Courses
Students who wish to take courses without credit or grade may do so by registering
for Audit (V). Full-time students may audit a course without charge. The charge for
part-time students is listed under Expenses. Students who audit a course should
confer with the instructor within two weeks of the beginning of the term to
determine expectations, attendance and any other requirement. If expectations
have been met, the course will be listed on the transcript as having been audited. If
expectations have not been met, the course will be listed with a grade of W
(Withdrawn).
42/Classification, Probation
Grade Point Average
The grade point average (GPA) i s based on final grades for all work at Augsburg. It
does not include credit and grade points for work transferred from other colleges.
Courses taken on the P/N grading option are recorded, but not computed i n the
G PA.
Classification
Sophomores - 7 courses completed with at least 14 grade points
Juniors - 16 courses completed with at least 32 grade points
Seniors - 25 courses completed with at least 50 grade points
Advanced Placement
Advanced placement in courses beyond the be inning level i s granted to students
with scores of 3.4, and 5 a n t h e CEtB Advanced Wacement Program Test. ~ d d i t i o n a l
credit or placement i s at the discretion of the department. Inquiries should be
addressed to the Office of rhe Registrar.
Advanced Standing
College credit is granted to high school students who havesuccessfuIIycompleted a
college level course and who have scored high on he Advanced Placement
Examinations. Augsburg will also award credir on the basisof scorer. received on the
College Level Examination Proyam (CLEF) ofiered by the College Entrance
Examination Board. Requests for detailed information should b~ addressed to the
Office of the Registrar.
Probation and Dismissal
A student will be placed ort schotastic probation at the end of t h e term i f his or her
athie~ernentis unsat~sTac~ory.
A student who has been on probation two or morc
C O ~ S P C U serncjrera
~ ~ ~ C
is subject to di;rn~ssal at the end of tlie term. Dismissal f r o m
the College is not automatic. Each c a w I S reviewed bv the Committee on Student
Stand~ng.A student who has a poor a c a d ~ m i crecord mav b e s~rongtyadvised to
withdraw before t h e end of the term. ,4 studenr who has been on probation for two
terms and withdraws from the College voluntarily must have special permission to
re-enroll.
A student will be placed on probation under these conditions:
Freshman - below 1.6 cumulative GPA or 2 zero grades, having taken fewer than 7
courses.
Sophomore - below 1.7 cumulative GPA or 3 zero courses, having taken 7 but fewer
than 16 courses.
Junior - below 1.9 cumulative GPA having taken 16 but fewer than 25 courses.
Senior - below 2.0 cumulative GPA having taken 25 or more courses.
A student will be removed from probation when the cumulative GPA reaches the
minimum levels above. Students placed on probation as a freshman for earning 2
zero grades will be removed from robation if their classification changes to
sophomore and ihev h a v e not earnexadditional zero grades. Students placed on
probation as a sophomore for earning 3 zero grades will be removed from probation
if their classification changes to junior and their cumulative GPA reaches 1.9.
Study Options, Veterans/43
Dean's List
The Dean's List i s published after each semester, listing students whose grade point
average for a semester is 3.5 or better, based on a minimum of three full courses, or
equivalent, graded on the traditional grading system, with no incompletes in
courses offered for credit.
Graduation with Distinction
Graduation with distinction is determined as follows:
Summa cum laude 3.8 to 4.0 cumulative GPA
Magna cum laude 3.6 up to but not including 3.8 cumulative GPA
Cum laude 3.3 up to but not including 3.6 cumulative GPA
To qualify for graduation with distinction, transfer students must have completed
two years (14 traditionally graded courses) of work at Augsburg.
Independent/Directed Study
Many departments offer opportun~tiesforconscientioussrudents who demonsrrate
sufficient background and preparation i n a given field to carry out upper division
level work on an independent basis. Somed~partmentsalsoofferan opportunity for
directed stud!: on a lower division level. A srudent who resisters for directed or
independent study should normally expect to complete i t in one semester but may
extend i t into the next term by permission of the instrucror. In such ca5es.a grade of
X isgiven a t theend of the f l r 5 t term. and zhestudentwill registerapain forthe course
to receive the final grade.
Student3 interested in registering for directed or independent study must first
secure permission from the faculty who will direct the study. A maximum of two
courses in Independent Study and/or Directed Study may count toward the 35
courses required for the degree.
Srudents may cross-register for inde endent studies at another ACTC school only
when the majorfield in which rheinBcpendenl study i s proposed is not available on
their home campus, and will be charged by the host campus for any special costs
a~tarhed.Requests for exception to this policvshould be made directly to their own
academic dean.
Veterans of Military Service
Augsburg is approved by the State Approving Agency for Veterans Training.
Veterans should consult with the Office of the Registrar about completion of the
enrollment certificate and the forwarding of other information to the Veterans
Administration.
Veterans will be referred to the State Approving Agency after anv period of two
consecutive terms in which they did not earn a t least three courses per term, the
rntnirnum for classification as full-time students, It i s the responsibility of each
veteran to report any change i n registration and/or academic load to the Office of
the Registrar, as it i s for all students.
A non-punitive rade which brings a veteran's academic load for the term below
to the Veteran's Administration. Veterans will need ro
three courses w i r bc n p o r ~ e d
meet the requirements ol the Veterans Administration regarding repayment of
educational assistance funds received.
46/Departments, Courses
Departments and Course
Course descriptions are listed by department or interdisciplinary program. The
descriptions are brief summaries of topics to be considered. For a more precise
description and clarification of content and requirementsfor individual courses, the
student should consult the inctructors of the courses.
Courses and terms listed are subject to change. In general, classes are offered Fall
and/or Spring terms, unless anerher frrquency isspecified. The Schedule of Classes
published each spring lists offerings and locations for Fall and Spring terms.
Descriptions and schedules for courses offered in January Interim and Summer
School are published in separate catalogs.
A full course is offered for one credit. A few fractional courses, for one-half credit,
are offered in the Division of Professional Studies. Afull course has the approximate
value of 4 semester credits or 6 quarter hours.
Most courses meet for three 60-minute periods or two 90-minute periods a week, in
addition to laboratories.
Numbering
Courses numbered below 300 are lower division courses. Courses numbered 300
and above are classified as upper division. In general, courses in the 100s are
primarily for freshmen, 200s sophomores, 300s juniors, and 400s seniors.
Prerequisites
Coursesthat must be taken before enrolling in a higher level course are listed i n the
caurse descrip~ion.A student may enroll in a course when a prerequisite has not
been fulfilled if there is prior approval of a professor teaching the course and of the
academic adviser. Consent of the instructor is indicated in some course descriptions
by this sign: (#)
Art
Philip Thompson (Chairperson), Robert Friederichsen, Norman Holen, August
Molder, Paul Rusten, Mary Swanson, Dorothy Williamson
Studio Art Major: 9-13 studio courses with Foundations 102,107, 225; 3 art history
courses including 240. One course must be i n 2-dimensional art (118,223,360) and
one in 3-dimensional art (150,221,250). Majors are required t o begin their programs
with the Foundations, although advanced placement i s possible with portfolio on
approval by the Art faculty.
Teaching Licensure Major: Foundations 102,107,225; Studio 118,132,150,221,223
and 250 plus a second course in two areas; Art History 240 and two other art history
courses. Consult wirh Department of Education for requirements i n education for
teacher licensure.
Art History Major: 8 art history courses including 240 and 388; 2 studio courses
including one from 102,107 or 225 and 118 or 221.
Studio Art Minor: 4 studio courses including 107; Art History 240.
Art History Minor: 5 art history courses including 240.
Certificatein Art: 8art courses, including one in Art History. Up to four courses may
be taken in one studio area or in art history.
Foundations in Studio Art Courses
102 Environmental Aesthetics
Fine arts i n the urban and world setting. Concern for thevisual content of experience in the
environment leading toward appreciation and criticism. Individual and group projects
exploring design problems i n representation, symbolism and abstraction.
107 Drawing
Drawing in pencil, charcoal, ink, and pastels. Subjects include still-life, figures, building
interiors and exteriors, and experimental work.
225 Visual Communications I
The theory and practice of visual perception and communication using elements such as
color, line, shape, texture, and pictorial images.
Studio Art Courses
100, 300 Special Topics
Occasional courses dealing with subjects not usually offered by the department.
118 Painting I
Introduction to painting media and technique in acrylic and oil.
132 Photography
The camera used as a tool for visual creativity and expression with attention to black and
white photographic process. Need access to 35 mm. camera. (Spring)
150 Jewelry
An introduction to the making of jewelry in copper, brass, pewter, and silver. You learn
how to cut, forge, enamel and cast these metals.
221 Sculpture I
An introduction to sculpture. Choice of media: clay, welded steel and bronze, plaster,
stone, and plexiglass. You learn to model, carve, cast, weld and assemble the respective
media.
223 Print hIakhg I
Principles and methods of print making in a variety of media includingetc hing,silk-screen
and woodcut.
242 Film Making
Film making through practical laboratory experience. Discussion and observation of the
expressive and structural elements of film. (Summer, Interim)
247 Life Drawing
See Interim Catalog
250 Ceramics I
An introduction to the making of pottery with an emphasis on handbuilding and glazing.
330 Visual Communications II
A study of visual communications i n magazines, television, film, advertising symbols, and
other mass media. Practice in areas of photography, typography, and illustration.
(Prereq.:225)
351 Ceramics II
Advanced work in ceramics with an emphasis on throwing or handbuilding and a
continuation of glazing. (Prereq.:250)
355 Painting II
Advanced study of painting. (Prereq.:llB)
360 Watercolor Painting
Design concepts using descriptive and experimental techniques i n transparent watercolor.
(Alternate years)
368 Print Making II
Advanced work with color and composition i n various media, including silk-screen,
etching, and woodcut. (Prereq.:223)
399 Internship
Consult chairperson or internship director to determine project.
478 Sculpture II
Advanced work i n sculpture. Choice of media: clay, welded steel and bronze, plaster,
stone, and plexiglass. (Prereq.:221)
499 Independent Study
Advanced study in area of the student's choice, intended for senior art majors.
Art History Courses
240 Art History Survey
A survey of art from prehistoric to modern times. Includes reading, research, viewing of
slides, visits to museums.
Note: The following courses are offered intermittently, usually two or three sections a year.
352 Women's Art History
A study of women's image in the visual arts in relationship to women's place within the
cultural, economic, and sociological environment of each period.
382 Scandinavian Arts
Survey of the visual arts in Scandinavia from pre-history to modern times.
385 Prehistoric and Ancient Art
The art of the Ice Age through the Roman Period to the 4th Century A.D. (Alternate years,
Fall, 1982)
386 Medieval Art
Early Christian through late Gothic and proto-Renaissance painting, sculpture, and
architecture in Europe.
387 Renaissance and Baroque Art
European painting, sculpture, and architecture, 14th to 18th century. (Alternate years,
Spring 1983)
388 19th and 20th Century Art
European painting, sculpture, and architecture from Neoclassicism through the present.
(Alternate years, 1983-84)
389 American Art
A study of early colonial art through contemporary American art, with specificemphasis on
19th and 20th century art and its relationship to European art as well as indigenous
movements. (Alternate years, 1983-84)
Biology
Neal T h o r p e (Chairperson), Robert Herforth, Roberta Lammers, Erwin Mickelberg,
Ralph Sulerud
Major - Option 1: 7 courses, i n c l u d i n g 111,112,491 a n d at least o n e course f r o m
each o f t h r e e groups: (1) 351,353,361; (11) 355,473,474; ( I l l ) 440,471,476; Chemistry
115, 116 (or 105, 106), 351, 352; Mathematics 124, 125; Physics 121, 122. Students
i n t e n d i n g t o enter graduate school should ordinarily choose this major.
Major - Option 2: 9 courses, i n c l u d i n g 111,112,491 a n d at least o n e course f r o m
each o f five groups: (I) 351,353; (11) 355,474; (111)361,481; (IV) 471,473; (V) 440,476;
Chemistry 115, 116 ( o r 105, 106), 351 and 352. Students w h o plan t o teach i n
secondary schools o f t e n select this major. Licensure f o r teaching i n Minnesota also
requires t r e e courses i n earth a n d life sciences. Students p l a n n i n g t o teach are
advised t o consult w i t h t h e Education Department early i n their planning.
Pre-Medical Biology Major: Option I major. In addition, medical schools usually
require Chemistry 353.
Minor: 5 courses, including Ill,
112 and three upper division courses; Chemistry
115,116 (or 105, 106).
Honors Major: GPAof 3.5 in biology and 3.0overal1, active participation in seminar,
one course of approved independent study with an oral defense of the research
report. Application should be made no later than the first term of the senior year.
101 Human Biology
Basic biological concepts from an anthropocentric point of view. An attempt to answer
such questions as: What makes man just another member of the biotic fold? Does man
havea niche in the ecosystem? What influence does man have on the environment?What
influence does the environment, especially the urban environment, have on man?(3 hours
lecture, 1-1/2 hours discussion section. A student may not receive credit for both Biology
101 and 103. Does not apply to the major or minor)
103 Human Anatomy and Physiology
A professional course i n the structure and function of the human body. Lecture and
laboratory. (Fall for nursing and certain other paramedical students, or #; Spring for
Physical Education, Music Therapy and other interested students. A student may not
receive credit for both Biology 101 and 103. Does not apply to the major or minor).
105 Biology and Society
What are some of the biologically-based problems with which our society must deal?What
threats are posed by pollution, the prospect of war, and by shortages of food, water and
non-renewable resources?What are the implicationsof genetic research,scientificracism,
socio-biology, and inequities i n thedelivery of health care? (3 hour lecture. Does not apply
to the major or minor. Spring)
108 Microbiology
Basic microbial features are considered as well as applicationsof microbiology to the fields
of medicine and sanitation. (3 hours lecture, 3 hours laboratory. For student nurses, health
majors, or #. Prereq.: Chemistry 109 and concurrent registration in Chemistry 110 or #.
Spring. Does not apply to the major or minor).
109 Special Topics i n Biology
Offered periodically through Augsburg's Conservation of Human Resources (CHR)
program. Generally conducted off campus with community people taking the course
together with college students i n a co-learning model. Topics will vary depending upon
needs and interest. Does not apply to the major or minor.
111,112 General Biology
A comprehensive introduction to biological science. For biology and other science majors.
The course includes an introduction to molecular biology, cellular biology, genetics,
developmental biology, evolutionary mechanisms, anatomy, physiology, ecology, and
phylogenetic relationships of organisms. Must be taken in sequenceexcept by permission
of instructor. (3 hours lecture; 4 hours laboratory. 111, Fall; 112, Spring)
323 Experimental Human Physiology
A laboratory-based course in which the principles of human function are learned by
experimentation and class discussion of the theory and results. Clinical applications will
also be considered. Intended for students in nursing, medical technology, corrective
therapy, health, physical education and related programs as well as biology majors
(primarily Option 11). (3 hours lecture-discussion, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 103 or 112.
Fall 1984 and alternate years)
351 Invertebrate Zoology
A study of the invertebrate groups stressing classification, morphology, behavior, life
history, and evolutionary relationships. (3 hours lecture, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 112,
Spring, 1983 and alternate years)
353 Comparative Vertebrate Zoology
A comparative study dealing with the classification, morphology, distribution, evolution,
behavior and population dynamics of thevertebrates. (3 hours lecture,4 hours laboratory.
Prereq.: 112. Spring)
355 Genetics
The principles of heredity with emphasis on recent advances in human genetics.
Laboratory work stressing Drosophila genetics. (3 hours lecture, 4 hours laboratory.
Prereq.: 112, Spring)
361 Plant Biology
A survey of the major divisions of the plant kingdom including the study of anatomy,
physiology, life histories, taxonomy and ecology. (3 hours lecture, 4 hours laboratory.
Prereq.: 112, Fall)
367 Biochemistry
An introductory consideration of the chemistry of proteins, carbohydrates, lipids and
nucleicacids including intermediary metabolism. (3 hours lecture. Prereq.: 112, Chemistry
352 or #. Fall)
440 Plant Physiology
A consideration of the chemical and physical mechanisms involved i n photosynthesis,
respiration, growth and development, and water relations in vascular and nonvascular
plants. The relationships of these processes to plant structures. (3 hours class, 4 hours
laboratory. Prereq.: 112, Spring, 1984 and alternate years)
471 Cellular Biology
A study correlating cell function with ultrastructure. Laboratory work includes microtechnique, cytological studies, cell physiology and tissue culture. (3 hours class, 4 hours
laboratory. Prereq.: 112, 367 or #. Spring)
473 Animal Physiology
A study of animal function with emphasison the vertebrates. Wherever possible, functions
are explained on the basis of physical and chemical principles. (3 hours class. 4 hours
laboratory. Prereq.: 112; Chemistry 106 or 116: Physics 103 or 122 or #. Fall, 1983 and
alternate years)
474 Developmental Biology
A consideration of the physiological and morphological changes which occur during the
development of organisms with emphasis on the vertebrate animals. Experimental as well
as descriptive studies are included i n the laboratory work. In addition to embryonic
development, the topics of malignancy, aging, and regeneration are discussed. (3 hours
class, 4 hours lab. Prereq.: 112. Spring)
52/Business Administration & Economics
476 Microbiology
An introduction to the study of microorganisms with emphasis on bacteria and viruses.
Microbial taxonomy, morphology, physiology, genetics, and pathogenicity are considered
as well as certain methods. (3 hours class, 4 hours laboratory. Prereq.: 112,367 or #. Fall)
481 Ecology
A survey of representative biological communities; the study of reciprocal relationships
between organisms and their environments. (3 hours class. 4 hours laboratory, some
Saturday field trips. Prereq.: 112, 361 or #. Fall)
491 Seminar
Oral presentations and written papers relating to recent biological literature and research.
(For seniors majoring i n biology, Fall)
499 Independent Study
Individual laboratory, field, or library research under the direction of an instructor.
Intended for biology majors who are juniors or seniors. (Prereq.: 112, and previous
arrangement with instructor)
Business Administration
& Economics
Amin Kader (Chairperson), JamesE. Billings,Satya Gupta, Douglas Heidenreich, Roy
LaFayette, Keishiro Matsumoto, Kenneth Rich, Edward M. Sabella.
Business Administration
Major in Accounting: 9 Business Administration courses (101,102,131,261,262,263,
379,381, and 483 or 484); 4 Economics courses (122,123,251, and one f r o m 258,391,
392). At least three upper division courses a r e required. Far thoseplanningcareers i n
accounting, completion of thetwo remaining courses i n thesequence 381,382,483,
484 is recommended. Courses i n data processing and compuTer programming are
strongly recommended.
Major in Finance: 9 Business Administrat ion courses (101,102,731,267,262,373,379,
478, and one from 381,382,483); 4 Economics courses (122,123,257, and one from
258, 391, 392). At least five upper division courses are required. Economics 392,
Mathematics 114 and courses i n data processing and computer programming are
strongly recommended.
Major in Management: 10 Business Administration courses (101, 702,131,145,250,
261, 340, 379, 410, and 373 or 4781; 5 Economics courses (722. 123, 251, 340, 445);
Philosophy 120; Psychotogy 371,373; Sociology 241 and 373 or 383; Speech 111 or
English 223; Communications 354 or 355. Math. 114 is srronglv recommended.
Major in Marketing: 9 Business Administration courses (101,102,131,135,250,261,
330,379,430); 5 Economics courses (122,123,251,258,445); Philosophy 120; Speech
and Communications 351 o r 352 and also 353. Mathematics 114 i s strongly
recommended.
Majors i n Marketing and Management are strongly encouraged t o take other
courses offered i n the department i n addition t o those listed above.
Business Administration & Economics/53
M a j o r in l n t e r n a t i o n a l Business: 8 Business Administration courses (101,102,131,
135,261 a n d 399 o r 499 a n d two f r o m 381,382,484); 3 Economics courses (122,123,
379); Political Science 160; 3 Ian uage courses (or demonstrated proficiency) f r o m
o n e o f t h e following: Arabic. C f i n e w , French, German, Greek, Italian, Japanese,
Norwegian, Russian, Spanish; 1 History course (coordinated w i t h t h e foreign
language courses) f r o m 103,104,222,322,323,324,331,332,440,474;
8 International
C o r e counes, i n c l u d i n g ~nternsh~p
or i n d e p e n d e n t stud Core courses must be
taken abroad (England and Germany, aiherr ro be addYedi. Erceprionr may b e
p e r m i t t e d with department a proval General descriprions follow. Students who
plan to major in lnternafionaPBusin& should mnract t h e depanment's international adviser. Amin Kader, as s o o n as possible t o carefully p l a n their p r o g r a m o f
study.
lnternational C o r e Courses - Required
Comparative Business Law - Advanced discussion of business law including the
comparison of U.S. and European laws governing corporations, partnerships and foreign
investment; European business regulations; tax laws; etc.
European Marketing - Factors affecting consumer demand and methods of satisfying it;
structure of the European market; market analysisand sales management; pricing policies;
distribution systems; planning of marketing operations. Emphasis will be placed on comparison with marketing activities in the U.S.
Import-Export Operations -The practical, technical and procedural aspects of import and
export business operations. The successive steps in the promotional, organizational and
financial development of international sales and purchases, including an analysisof international trade terms, sales terms, documentation and governmental regulations.
Multinational Corporation - Comparative study of the methods of organizing and
managing the multinational enterprise. Topics include: organization structure; subsidiarie; and parent company; ~r~anizational'behavior;
management policy; comparative
industrial relations; comparative tax laws; optimization principles in the international
setting.
lnternational C o r e Courses - 3 to b e Elected
Economics of the Developing Countries - Source of economic backwardness and
obstacles to economic growth. Analysis of specific problems such as population pressure,
land reform, lack of capital, foreign trade imbalance, foreign investment, colonialism.
European Common Market - EEC; political will: objectives, implications; forms'of
economic integration; freedom of factor movements; agricultural policies; European path
to monetary integration; energy, regional, and social policy; regulation of transport;
industrial policy; current membership negotiations.
lnternational Economic Institutions - Regional economic integration and the relation of
domestic and international policies. lnternational monetary cooperation.
lnternational Economic Policies - The economic factors i n diplomacy; tariff techniques
and problems; commercial bargaining; foreign investment problems; economicaspectsof
economic development; regional integration techniques and problems; foreign aid
policies; exchange rate policies.
Theory of lnternational Finance -The relevance of international finance; participants i n
the international payments scene; balance of international payments; spot market and
forward market for foreign exchange; exchange rate systems; international liquidity; the
impact of international payments on the domestic price level; employment and the
performance of monetary policy.
54/Business Administration & Economics
Minor: 6 courses, inchding Business Administration 101,102, and one of 261,373,
379,478; and one of 262,379,381; and Economics 122 and 123. Other configurations
for the Business Administration minor may be permitted on consultation with the
department chairperson.
Honors Major: GPA of 3.50 in the major and 3.0 overall; a senior thesis and
comprehensive oral examination i n the major field of concentration.
C.P.A. Certification: Graduates who wish t o take the Certified Public Accountants
(C.P.A.) examination prior to fulfilling the experience requirement must have
corn feted the major i n Busine5s Administration-Accounting, taken all accounting
and !usines, Taw counes offered, fulfilled the Mathematics-Phyrici general college
requirement by taking mathematics, and completed at least 5 courses but not more
than 1 2 courses of related business subjects (Economics, Finance and Mathematics).
Students who have completed theabove requirements arequalified under the rules
of the Minnesota State Board of Acceuntancy to sit for the examination immediately
after graduation.
Notes: Students who plan to major in the department are strongly encouraged t o
select a department adviser as soon as possible, in order t o carefully plan their
program of study.
In addition to the courses listed below, these have been offered under Business
Administration 295, 495 Topics: Research Methods for Economics and Business,
Computer Simulation for Business, Income Taxes for Individuals, Computer
Applications, and Discrete Event Simulation.
101 Principles of Financial Accounting
lntroduction to business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of accounting, the
accounting cycle and preparation of financial statements.
102 Principles of Managerial Accounting
lntroduction to business activities, basic concepts and fundamentals of managerial
accounting. Planning and controlling processes, decision-making and behavioral considerations. (Prereq.: 101)
131 Business Law
Legal rules relating to contracts, agency, negotiable instruments, property and business
organizations under the Uniform Commerical Code. (Spring)
135 Introduction t o Marketing
Principles of basic policy and strategy issues in marketing. Legal, ethical, competitive,
behavioral, economic and tech~ologicalfactors as they affect product, promotion,
marketing channel and pricing decisions. (Spring)
145 Fundamentals of Management
Development of the theory of management, organization, staffing, planning and control.
The nature of authority, accountability and responsibility, analysis of the role of the
professional manager. (Fall)
250 Data Processing
An introduction to COBOL and other non-scientific programming languages. Does not
apply toward a major or minor i n economics. (Fall)
261 Fundamentals of Finance
Theory of acquisition, allocation, and management of funds within the firm; sources and
uses of long and short term funds, cost of capital, capital budgeting, leverage, dividend
policy, and related topics. (Prereq.: 101,102)
Business Administration & Economics/55
262 lntermediate Accounting I
An analysis of accounting theory pertaining to financial statements, income concepts,
capital stock and surplus accounts, current and long-term assets. (Prereq.: 101, 102, Fall)
263 lntermediate Accounting II
An analysis of accounting theory pertaining to investments, tangible and intangible fixed
assets, liabilities and reserved, actuarial topics. Additional emphasis on income determination considering price level changes. (Prereq.: 262, Spring)
330 Marketing Research and Analysis
Research process as an aid to decision making i n marketing management; research
methodology; marketing research results; evaluation of the effectiveness of research in
marketing. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 135 or #. O n Demand)
340 Personnel Administration
Personnel function in business, acquisition and utilization of human resources; desirable
working relationships; effective integration of the worker with the goals of the firm and
society. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 145 or #. O n Demand)
373 Financial Management: Theory and Cases
Advanced financial theory: a systems approach to financial structure and policy. Emphasis
on decision-making, presentation through literature, readings, lectures and case material.
(Prereq.: 261)
379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
An introduction to quantitative reasoning, descriptive measures, probability, sampling
distributions, inference and estimation with emphasis on their use in applied problems in
business and economics. (Prereq.: High School Algebra. Fall)
381 Managerial Cost Accounting
Accounting tools for planning and control of economic activities. Planning, budgeting,
standard cost systems, as well as other quantitative and behavioral topics. (Prereq.: 101,102)
382 Tax Accounting
The more common and important provisions of federal income taxes for individuals and
various forms of business enterprises. (Prereq.: 101,102. Fall)
399 Internship Program
A student may receive course creditsthrough an internship program which is applicable to
graduation, but not to the major. This program will afford the student the opportunity to
spend one full term working with some industrial organization. In addition thestudent will
write a report on his or her activities. (Prereq.: #. Cannot be taken in Interim only).
430 Marketing Management
Integration of marketing with other business functions; marketing management and
decision making, planning marketing programs, channels of distribution, pricing, product
selling and promotion policies. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 330 or #. O n Demand)
440 Operations Management
Concepts and principles related to the management of operating functions. Examplesfrom
service industries, non-profit organizations and manufacturing. Taught from a managerial
point of view. Topics include: an overview of operations, planning operation processes,
productivity measurement, standards, forecasting, concepts of quality, inventory management, principles of scheduling, and operational control information systems. (Prereq.:
Junior or Senior or #. Spring)
56/Business Administration & Economics
478 Investments and Financial Institutions
Appraisal of the risk/return relationships of various types of securities from the viewpoint
of both individual and Institutional investors. Extensive coverage of capital markets and
portfolio management. (Prereq.: 261. Economics 392 is strongly recommended. Fall)
479 Intermediate Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
Provides the opportunity to become familiar with statistical research methodsthrough use
of the electronic computer. This course stresses the understanding of statistical methods
and computer programming techniques. The materials to be presented in the course are:
Computer Programming Techniques; Statistical Methods: General Linear Models, Analysis
of Variance, etc. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 379 or equivalent or #. Spring)
483 Auditing
Internal and external auditing procedures. Emphasis on internal checks and controls for
accounting systems. (Prereq.: 263. Fall)
484 Advanced Accounting
Accounting for business combinations, governmental accounting, partnership accounting
and fund accounting. (Prereq.: 263. Spring, 1983)
295,495 Topics
Lectures, discussions, meetings with members of the staff or visiting faculty regarding
research methodology and readings in the areas of Accounting, Finance or General
Business. (Prereq.: #)
499 Independent Study
The student may earn independent study credits through individually supervised projects
designed to afford him or her the opportunity to analyze some topic or issue in depth.
(Prereq.: #)
Economics
Major in Economics: 8 Economics courses (122,123, 251, 258, 454 and three other
upper division); Business Administration 101, 102, 379; Mathematics 114. Mathematics 373 may be substituted for Business Administration 379. The complete
calculus sequence i s very strongly recommended for those planning graduate study
in economics. I n addition, courses in data processing and computer programming
are strongly recommended.
Major in Applied konomics: I] Economics courses 1122,123,251,258,454 and 445 or
453 and t h r e e other upper division); Business Adrninistrarion 101, f 02, 379, 479:
Philosophy 130; Mathemafics 124,125, 215, 224, 2'14. Mathematics 211 is strongly
recommended. Mathematics 373 may be substituted for Business Admrnistration
379. Thestudent isstrongly encouraged to take ather Economics course^. in addition
t5 those I isted above.
Combined Major in Economics - Business Administration: 5 Economics courses
(122,123,251,258 and one upper division); 6 Business Adm~nistrationcourses (101,
102,261,373,379and one upper division). Courses in data processing and computer
programming are highly recommended. The student i s very strongly encouraged to
take additional courses both i n business administration and economics.
Minor: .Economics 122, 123, 251, 258 and one upper division course. Other
configurations may be permitted on consultation with the department chairperson.
Business Administration & Economics/57
Honors Major: GPA o f 3.50 i n t h e major, a n d 3.0 overall; a senior thesis a n d
comprehensive oral examination i n t h e major f i e l d o f concentration.
the courses listed below, these topics have b e e n o f f e r e d
u n d e r 295, 495 Topics: Consumer Economics, History o f Economic Thought,
Research Methods f o r Economics, a n d Business Advanced Economic Theory a n d
Decision-Making w i t h f i n i t e Markov Chains,
Notes: I n addition t o
Economics 120,122 a n d 123 w i l l satisfy general education requirements. Economics
120 w i l l satisfy t h e urban concerns requirement.
Students w h o Ian t o major i n t h e d e a r t m e n t are strongly encouraged t o select a
department alviser as soon as porsibre i n o r d e r t o carefully p l a n their p r o g r a m o f
study.
120 Economics of Urban Issues
Study of economic implications of many problems facing a metro-urban environment.
Some of the topics to be discussed are: Population "Crisis", Crime Prevention, Ecology and
Income Distribution; Distributing Free Bread; Mass Transit Systems, etc. Fundamental
microeconomics tools introduced to facilitate discussion of the above-mentioned topirs.
(Economics 120 i s a basic course designed for those studenrswho dn not plan to major in
Economics or Business Administration. It does not apply toward an Ecunomirs major or
minor. Students who plan to major i n Business Administration andfor Economics should
instead enroll i n 122 and 123, which also are open to non-majors)
122 Principles of Economics (Macro)
An introduction to macroeconomics; national income analysis, monetary and fiscal policy,
international trade, economic growth. Application of elementary economic theory to
current economic problems. May be taken independently of Economics 123 or 120.
Economics 122 and 123 may be taken i n either order, or may be taken i n the same term i n
order for the student to progress more rapidly to the other courses.
123 Principles of Economics (Micro)
An introduction to microeconomics, the theory of the household, firm, market structures
and income distribution. Application of elementary economic theory to market policy.
May be taken independently of Economics 122or 120. Economics 122and 123 may betaken
i n either order.or may be taken in the same term in order for the student to progress more
rapidly to other courses.
250 Data Processing
An introduction to COBOL and other non-scientific programming languages. Does not
apply toward a major or minor i n economics.
251 lntermediate Microeconomics
Theory of resource allocation, analysis of consumer behavior, firm and industry; the
pricing of factors of production and income distribution; introduction to welfare
economics. (Prereq.: 123)
258 lntermediate Macroeconomics
Determinants of national income, employment and price level analyzed via macromodels. Attention paid to areas of monetary-fiscal policy, growth and the business cycle.
(Prereq.: 122. Fall)
58/Business Administration & Economics
340 Managerial Decision Making
Provides a sound conceptual understanding of the modern techniques of management
science to prepare students to make better business and economic decisions. Emphasis is
on applications, which are taken from the areas of transportation, marketing, portfolio
selection, environmental protection, the shortest route, inventory models, information
systems, etc. (Prereq.: Econ. 123, Bus. Ad. 101 and high school algebra or equivalents.
Spring, O n Demand)
379 Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
An introduction to quantitative reasoning, descriptive measures, probability, sampling
distributions, inference and estimation with emphasis on their use in applied problems in
business and economics. (Prereq.: High School Algebra. Fall)
391 Public Finance
Analysis of the principles of taxation and publicexpenditures; the impact of fiscal policy on
economic activity; debt policy and its economic implications. (Prereq.: 122,123. Fall)
392 Money and Banking
Functioning of the monetary and banking systems, particularly commercial banks, the
Federal Reserve System and its role i n relation t o aggregate economic activity. Emphasis
placed on monetary theory and policy. (Prereq.: 122. Spring)
399 Internship Program
A student may receive course credits through an internship program which i s applicable to
graduation but not to the major. This program will afford the student the opportunity to
spend some time working with some organization. In addition, the student will write a
report on his or her activities. (Prereq.: #. Cannot be taken in Interim only)
442 Labor Economics
Analysis of labor markets; labor as a factor of production; determination of wage collective
bargaining; labor legislation and effects upon society. (Prereq.: 251 or #. O n Demand)
445 Managerial Economics
Integrates economic theory and corresponding practices i n business. Among the topics
considered are theories and practices in forecasting, estimation of demand and cost
functions, price and non-price competition, production and cost considerations, and an
analysis of economic problems of relevance to management. (Prereq.: Econ. 251 or
equivalent or #. Spring, O n Demand)
453 Mathematical Economics
Mathematical economics with emphasis on the application of mathematical tools to the
areas of micro and macro economic theory. (Prereq.: Econ. 251,258 and at least Math. 122
or equivalent or #. O n Demand)
454 Welfare Economics
Basic concepts and propositions; Pareto optimality, economic efficiency of alternative
market structures; social welfare functions; normative concepts of economic theory.
(Prereq.: 251 or #. O n Demand)
479 Intermediate Quantitative Methods for Economics and Business
Provides the opportunity to become familiar with statistical research methodsthrough use
of the electronic computer. This course stresses the understanding of statistical methods
and computer programming techniques. The materials to be presented i n the course are:
Computer Programming Techniques; Statistical Methods: General Linear Models, Analysis
of Variance, etc. (Prereq.: Bus. Ad. 379 or equivalent or #. No lab fee. Spring)
295,495 Topics
Lectures, discussions, meetings with members of the staff or visiting faculty regarding
research methodology and current national and international economic problems and
policies. (Prereq.: #)
499 Independent Study
The Student may earn independent study credits through individually supervised projects
designed to afford him or her the opportunity to analyze some topic or issue in depth.
(Prereq.: #)
Chemistry
Earl R. Alton (Chairperson), Arlin Gyberg, John Holum, Richard Olmsted, Sandra
Olmsted
Graduation M a j o r in Chemist : 175,176, (or 105,106) 35I,352,353, 361 and one
advanced c a u n e which may inxude Biochemistry; participation i n seminar; Physics
127,722; Mathematics 124,125. Since u per division courses have mathematics and
physics prerequisires, students shoul plan to take Mathematics 124, 125 i n the
freshman year and Physics 121,122 in the sophomore year.
d'
American Chemical Society Approved Major: 11courses including 115,116 (or 105,
106) and all chemistry courses above 350, Chemistry seminar partici ation; Mathematics 224; Physics 121,122 (which rhould be taken during the sopromore year).
Reading ability i n German equivalent to one semester also required.
Teaching Literrsure: Physical Science Emphasis-Chemistry Major: Recommendation for licensure in Physical Science requires general chemistry (115, 116 or 105,
106); 3 courses i n earth and life sciences; Chemistry 351,352, 353,361, 362,482,491
(Biology 367 may be substituted for362); Physics 245. Studentsare advised t o consult
with the Education Department early in their planning.
Pre-Medical Chemistry Major: The same as the graduation major. I n addition,
medical schools expect at least t w o courses (and usually more) i n biology. Students
should consulr members of the chemistry department for assistance i n planning a
course program early i n their coilege career.
Minor: 5 courses which must include 115, 116 (105, 106), 353 and t w o other
chemistry courses above 300 (Biology 367 may be one of the courses).
Honors Majors: Full ACS major; average of 3.5 i n chemistry, mathematics, and
physics, 3.0 over-all; one summer o r course of approved research; participation i n
seminar.
Notes: Credit will not be granted for both 105 and 115, or for both 106 and 116.
Most courses in this department have prerequisites, courses that must be completed
beforeenrolling in thegiven course. A prerequisite must be completed with a grade
o f 2.0 or higher t o count. Otherwise, permission of the instructor is necessary. These
requirements also must be met when using the first term o f a two-term course i n
registering for the second term.
Placement i n 105 or 115 i s determined by the score o n the Mathematics Placement
Examination. High school chemistry i s a prerequisite for 115.
105, 106 Principles o f Chemistry
Somewhat less rigorous than 115,116; designed especially for students w h o will not major
i n chemistry, although students may go from 106 into 351, 353. Concepts and laws
underlying chemistry illustrated by a variety of examples including organic and environmental systems. (3 one-hour lectures, 3 hours of laboratory. Prereq.: math placement. 105,
Fall; 106, Spring)
109,110 General, Organic and Biological Chemistry
Designed for students w h o need a survey of the fundamental principles of general, organic
and biological chemistry for careers i n allied health areas such as nursing (including
Augsburg's Upper Division Program), inhalation therapy, histotechnology, physical
education, and others. O p e n also t o students in the humanities and social sciences. First
term, general chemistry principles and an introduction t o organic chemistry. Second term,
organic and biological chemistry with special applications t o human physiological
chemistry. (3 one-hour lectures, 2 hours of laboratory. This course does not apply toward
the major o r minor i n chemistry. Credit cannot be earned for both Chemistry 109 and 105
o r 115 nor can credit be earned for both Chemistry 110 and 351. Prereq.: High school
chemistry within the last 3 years. 109 Fall, 110 Spring)
115, 116 General Chemistry
A n intensive course for premedical students and future chemists. First semester includes
chemical equations and calculations, energetics, and bonding theory with examples from
inorganic chemistry. Thesecond emphasizes equilibrium and solution chemistry including
kinetics and electrochemistry. (3 one-hour lectures, 3 hours of laboratory. Prereq.: high
school chemistry, math placement. 115 Fall, 116 Spring)
351,352 Organic Chemistry
Important classes of organic compounds with special emphasis o n mechanisms and multistepsynthesis. Descriptive material is correlated by means of modern theories of chemical
bonds, energy-relations, and reactor mechanism; many applications of organic chemistry
t o biological, environmental and industrial fields. (3 one-hour lectures, 1 four-hour
laboratory. Prereq.: 106 o r 116, 351 Fall; 352, Spring)
353 Quantitative Analytical Chemistry
Covers gravimetric and volumetric analysis and solution equilibrium i n detail and gives an
introduction t o spectrophotometric techniques of analysis. The laboratory involves
quantitative analysis of a variety of samples, and includestrace analysis. (3 hours of lecture,
1 four-hour laboratory. Prereq.: 106 o r 116. Fall)
361, 362 Physical Chemistry
The basic theoretical concepts of chemistry: thermodynamics, kinetics, quantum theory,
and states o f matter are studied in the first semester. Applications of these conceptsto areas
of molecular structure, equilibria and electrochemistry i n the second semester. (3 onehour lectures, 1 four and one-half-hour laboratory. Prereq.: 353; Physics 121, 122;
Mathematics 124, 125. 361, Fall; 362, Spring)
399 Internship
Opportunity for off-campus experience as a chemist.
464 Advanced Organic Chemistry
Organized around the problems of identifying organic compounds in the laboratory.
Lecture topics include structure-spectra correlations for IR, UV, NMR, and mass spectroscopy; use of the literature (including Beilstein); and further study of organic reactions.
Infrared, nuclear magnetic resonance, and ultraviolet spectra routinely used. (3 hours of
lecture, 6 hours of laboratory. Prereq.: 352, 353, 361 or #; some reading knowledge of
German. Fall)
481 Advanced Analytical Chemistry
Emphasis upon advanced equilibrium theory and principles of atomic and molecular
spectroscopy as applied to analytical methods as well as chromatographic and electroanalytical techniques of analysis. (3 hours lecture, 1 four and one-half-hour laboratory.
Prereq.: 353, 361, or #. Spring)
482 Advanced Inorganic Chemistry
Correlation of inorganic reactions using the electrostatic, valence bond, and molecular
orbital models. Coordination chemistry is discussed in terms of ligand field theory. The
laboratory involves preparations of inorganic compounds using a variety of techniques. (3
one-hour lectures, 1 three-hour laboratory. Prereq.: 352,361, or #. Spring)
483 Quantum Chemistry
Presents quantum theory in terms of Schrodinger's wave equation and uses the equation to
solve the problems of the harmonic oscillator and the hydrogen atom. Approximate
solutions are introduced and used to develop molecular orbital theory for molecules.
Includes commutators, electron spin, angular momentum and group theory. (3 one-hour
lectures. Prereq.: 361 or #. Fall)
491 Chemistry Seminar
This seminar, which has no course credit, i s a weekly meeting of chemistry majors under
the direction of the Augsburg Chemistry Society. Juniors and seniors are expected to
participate, with seniors presenting papers. Outside visitors are occasionally invited to
participate.
497 Introduction to Chemistry Research
Chemistry majors planning research careers need research experience beforegraduation.
Such experience may be obtained by working on a summer research project in the
department (not counted as a course) or by research participation during the academic
year (which may be counted as a course). (Juniorstanding).
499 Independent Study
Chemistry majors who are interested in non-laboratory research such as theoretical or
historical chemistry may pursue their interest via independent study. (JuniorStanding)
62/East and Southeast Asian Studies
East and Southeast Asian Studies
Khin Khin Jensen (Director)
This program offers two options:
1. Major or minor in East Asian Studies through Augsburg and the other Associated
Colleges of the Twin Cities (ACTC). This is an inter-college, interdepartmental
program which provides a foundation for careers in international business,
government, teaching, global ministries, work with social and recreational agencies,
or graduate study.
Two years of Japaneseare tought on one of the five ACTC campuses, o r Augsburg
students maytake Chinese coursesat Harnline University. Therealso i s a contracrual
arrangement with the University of Minnesota East Xrian Studies Department for
Chinese and lapanese language coursps. Opportunities for language study abroad
are available in japan, China, Taiwan, Korea, Hon kong and Singapore. Summer
inrii~uterare ava~lablei n ihe Paeple'r Republic ofChina and in the U.S. See the
director for information and procedureto register for any of thesecourses or t ravel.
Non-majors in the program are eligible to take the Chinese or Japanese language
courses, which may be taken for distribution requirement.
Ma'or in East Asian Studies - 10 courses, including 4 courses (2 years) of basic
col ege Chinese or Japanese, or equivalent competencies; 2 courses in History; 2
courses in cultural specialization or comparative studies; and 2 courses from a list of
approved electives.
I
Minor in East Asian Studies -5 courses, including 2 courses (1year) of basic college
Chinese or Japanese or equivalent competencies; 1 course in history of East Asia;
and 2 upper division courses in cultural specialization from a list of approved
electives.
2. Minor in East and Southeast Asian Area Studies is an area concentration at
Augsburg College that does not include a language component. I t is designed t o be
useful for a variety of careers when combined with other majors.
Minor in East and Southeast Asian Studies - 5 courses, 2 from History 322,323,324;
one from Philosophy 355, Religion 356, Sociology 241; one from History 474, Political
Science 351,363, 382; and one from History 226,399,495,499. History 104 is strongly
recommended.
Note: Interim courses related to the East and Southeast Asian Studies program may
be substituted when appropriate, with the consent of the Director.
226 Asian and Asian-American Women in Public Life in the 20th Century
(See under Department of History)
299 Directed Study
(See Director of program)
322 Modern Southeast Asia
(See under Department of History)
323 Modern China
(See under Department of History)
324 Modern Japan
(See under Department of History)
351 Communist Political Systems
(See under Department of Political Science, Comparative Politics and Analysis)
363 Communist Foreign Policies
(See under Department of Political Science, International Politics)
382 Marxist Visions: Past, Present, and Future
(See under Department of Political Science, Political Theory and Analysis)
399 Internships
(See Director of program for guidelines t o apply for an internship)
474 The World and The West
(See under Department of History)
495 Seminar
(See Director of program)
499 Independent Study
(See Director of program for guidelines)
tconomics
See Business Administration and Economics
Education
Marie McNeff (Chairperson), Bobbi Anderson, Sheldon Fardig, Barry Franklin, Einar
Johnson, Lauretta Pelton
Augsburg College offers programs leading to licensure in Elementary Education,
Kindergarten, Prekindergarten, and Secondary Education.
Students wishing t o become licensed teachers are advised to consult with the
Education Department for licensure requirements. For students transferring t o
Augsburg College from other institutions of higher education, it i s within the
jurisdiction of the Education Department and/or other appropriate departments t o
determine essential equivalency of course content taken at other institutions as
applicable to requirements of the approved teacher licensure programs at Augsburg
College.
Orientation t o Education, both elementary and secondary, and Techniques of
Teaching Reading are open to all students of sophomore standing or above. To
enroll i n other education courses, a student must first apply and be admitted t o the
teacher education program. Students are advised to apply for admission in the
spring semester of the sophomore year, during or after the Orientation course.
Students transferring from an education program at another college must be
readmissible to that program.
Elementary Education
Marie McNeff (Coordinator)
Major and licensure Requirements: M i n i m u m of 8.5 education courses (255, 351.
383, and two profesrional semesters); Health Education 114,775; Library Science347,
358; Academic rnlnor (major recommended); GPA of 2.0 overall and 2.5 in major and
academic rninor,and grades of P in srudent teachin courres required for Iicensure;
fulfill requiiementr of Minnesota Board of Teac\ing 5 MChR 3.041 in Human
Relations. The first professional semester, forjuniors, includes341,352,353.381,382,
384. [Courses 381, 382, 383, 384 are one-half courses. The secand professional
semester includes 481,482 and eleaives (483.484,478,499).
Kindergarten License R e uirements: Elementary Education requirements plus 385
and student teaching at t%e Kindergarten level.
Prekindergarten Education
Bobbi Anderson (Coordinator)
License Requirements: Elementary Education requirements plus Sociology 231;
Prychology 351; Elementary Education 325, 425, 483 or 484 (160 hours of student
teach~ng).For a Prekindergarten license with other than an education major, consult
with the program coordinator.
255 Orientation to Education in Urban Setting (Elementary)
Investigation of various aspects of the teaching profession and opportunity for in-school
work. Open to a l l students. (Prereq.: sophomore standing or above)
282 Introduction to Special Education
(See Special Education)
325 Contemporary Influences in Prekindergarten Education
Focus is upon the young child as a person and the importance of the early years of h~s/her
life in relat~anro the eifects of present-dav society and culture upon the child. Current
developments include innova!ions,Head Start, implementation of planned variations, and
other ~nrerventionsandcompensatorvprograms.Class sessions and two hours per week of
lab. experience in a day care center and/or nursery school. (Spring)
341 Media Technology (1/2 course)
(See Library Science)
351 Techniques of ~ e a c h i n
Reading
~
Thestudy and utilization of a variety of techniquesand resources in theteaching of reading
at both secondary and elementary level. (Fall)
352,353 Creating Learning Environments: Elementary
The mastery of theories and their applicationsfor teaching in learningsettings. Laboratory
experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265 or #. Spring)
381 Elementary Curriculum: Art, Music (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materials and resources for art and music taught at the
elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265, concurrent r-egistrationin
352, 353. Spring)
382 Elementary Curriculum: Science, Mathematics (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materials and resources for science and mathematics
taught at the elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265, concurrent
registration in 352, 353. Spring)
383 Elementary Curriculum: Physical Education, Health (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materials and resources for physical education and health
taught at the elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265. Fall)
384 Elementary Curriculum: Social Studies, Language Arts, (1/2 course)
Examination and preparation of materials and resourcesfor social studies and language arts
taught at the elementary level. Laboratory experiences. (Prereq.: 255 or 265, concurrent
registration in 352, 353. Spring)
385 Discovery in the World of Kindergarten
A study of the kindergarten curriculum, exploration of materials, and review of teaching
approaches. The course requires laboratory experience. Required for Kindergarten
licensure. (Prereq.: Orientation to Ed. and acceptance into the Dept. of Ed., Summer I)
399 Internship
The student may select from a variety of situations for professional work experience. A
learning contract must be developed and must have education faculty approval.
425 Prekindergarten Curriculum
Learning about and demonstrating knowledge and skills of teaching the young child. The
course concentrates on details essential to the organization of a good program for
children: records, reports, physical facilities, equipment, parental involvement, and
working with children who have uniquely different needs. Classsessionsand two hours per
week of lab experience in a day care center and/or nursery school. (Fall)
481,482 Student Teaching I
Observing and directing learning at the following levels: N, K, and/or elementary levels
under the supervision of college and elementary school personnel. (Prereq.: Admission t o
student teaching and program approval. Fall, Spring)
483,484 Student Teaching II
Additional experience in teaching. (Prereq.: 481,482. Fall, Spring)
478 School and Society
(See Secondary Education)
491 Practicum and Seminar in Special Education
(See Special Education)
498 lndependent Study ('/2 or 1 course)
Study of specific areas i n education as determined by candidate seeking licensure in a
teaching area. May be taken more than once for credit (by permission).
499 lndependent Study
Opportunity for advanced and specialized research projects not otherwise provided for i n
the departmental curriculum. A projected program must be outlined and approved by the
elementary education faculty.
Secondary Education
Sheldon Fardig (Coordinator)
It is the responsibility of each student to meet a!! specific requirements of the
Education Department. Secondary Education students are advised to consult with
Education faculty regarding state requirements for teacher licensure.This consultation is, recommended in addition to conferring with rhe student's major field
adviser.
ticensure Program Requirements for Secondary Education: (1) Application for
admittance and acceptance into the Depanment of Education teacher licensure
program. This may be made before, concurrently or after the Orientalion course.
Application formsare available in the Education Department oRice. Belare applving
for admission, studentsshauld receive approval from the department or division of
'their declared major. A student ma take education courses after the Orientation
course only i f he or she has been adYmiited into the program of the Department of
Education: (2) GPA of 2.0 everalt,2.Qin required education couries,and at least 2.5 i n
the major and minor; (3) Applicarion for admittance and acceptance into student
teaching; (41 Completion of Minnrsota Board of Teaching 5 MCAR 3.041 i n H u m a n
Relations through hugrburg's Education program; (5) Successful completion of the
required courses 0%t h e education program: Psychology 105: Health Education 114,
115; Educatian 265,354,388,478, specia I methods i n thrl area of t he student's major,
and a minimum of two or three courses in student teaching ar required.
Requirementsfor State of Minnesota L-icensurefor Teaching in SecondarySchaols:
(through the Augsburg College Education Department Program): 11) 5.A- or 8.5.
degree; (21 College major or minor in a teaching area; (33 Fulfill hlinnesota Board of
Teaching 5 :MCAR 3.011 in Human Retarions Isucces5ful completion of Augsburg
Education program meets requirerncnr); (4) Psvchologv 105: (5) Health Education
114,115: (6)2.0 GPA i n professional education courses and a ? i n required s ~ u d e n t
teaching courses, 2.5 GPA in major or minor.
Art, Music and Physical Education Licensure: A person preparing for licensure in
one o f t hese areas follows the secondary educarion program even though he or she
plans to reach at the elementary school level. A person with a major in one of these
special arras will take three courses i n studen1 teaching and do some student
teaching at both rhe secondary and elemen~aryrevels. In addition to 354, the art
major will register for 367,361: rhe Physical Education major i o r 365: and t h e music
major for 373. Arl and Physical Education reacher education programs lead to
licensure in K-12. Music teacher education programs lead l o liccnsure in r h e
following areas: ( 7 ) Band (K-12) and Classroom Music (5-12): 121 Orchestra (K-121
and Classroom Music (5-12): (3) Vocal and Classroom Music (K-9); or (4) Vocal and
C[assroom Music (5-11).
Foreign Language Licensure: For foreign language teachers (French, German,
Spanish), achievement of at least four "good" and three "minimal" ratings on the
Modern Language Association Competency Tests is required. The candidate will
take the MLA tests before undertaking student teaching. The results will be
recorded in the candidate's permanent file in the Department of Education.
The Professional Term: Student Teaching i s taken concurrently with Educ. 478 in
one full-time term in professional education, Special afternoon and/or evening
seminars are held during the term aspart of the professional work, kstudent taking
two courses i n student teaching may elect to take one course i n Inde endent Study.
AII studenrs are expecred robe ~nvolvedfull-time i n theactivities of tRe prOfR5iOI?a~
term.
265 Orientation t o Education i n an Urban Setting (Secondary)
Investigate5 various aspects of the teaching profession, with opportunity for in-school
work. Open to all students. (Prereq.: Sophomore Standing)
282 Introduction t o Special Education
(See Special Education)
341 Media Technology (1/2 course)
(See Library Science)
351 Techniques of Teaching Reading
(See Elementary Education)
354 Creating Learning Environments: Secondary
The mastery of theories and their applications for teaching i n learning settings. Laboratory
experiences. (Prereq.: 265, Psychology 105)
N o t e o n Special M e t h o d s Courses: With the general methodology course, one or
more education courses i n special methods must be taken from the department of
the major field. (Prereq.: 265, or Elementary Education 255, and 354or may be taken
concurrently with 354. Courses 361,365,373 and 410 are one course; others are 1/2
course.)
361 Art Methods (Elementary and Junior High School)
Procedures, materials and issues relating to the teaching of art i n the elementary, middle,
and junior high schools. (Fall)
362 Art Methods (Senior High School) (1/2 course)
Procedures, materials and issues relating to the teaching of art i n the senior high school.
(Fall)
364 English Methods (1/2 course)
Materials and methods suitable for students in secondary schools. Emphasis on the
preparation of lesson and unit plans. Teaching i n a local high school. (Spring)
365 Physical Education Methods (K-12)
(See Physical Education Department)
366 Foreign Language Methods (1/2 course)
Language learning theory. The theory and practice of language teaching. (Consult with the
Foreign Language Department.)
373 Music Methods (K-12)
Trends and issues in music education. The development of music skills and teaching
procedures for school music K-12. Workshops and laboratory experience. (Spring)
374 Natural Science Methods (K-12) (1/2 course)
Course structures, goals, and procedures i n science education. Consideration of ability
levels of students. Survey and assessment of classroom textbooks and materials. Development of a file of teaching materials and references. (Fall)
375 Social Studies Methods (1/2 course)
Introduction to the teaching of social sciences and history i n secondary school classrooms.
Emphasis on instructional strategies and curriculum development. (Spring)
376 Speech and Theater Arts Methods (1/2 course)
The teaching of basic speech, interpretative reading, discussion, and theater and the
directing of co-curricular speech and theater activities. (Spring)
377 Mathematics Methods (1/2 course)
Study of the basic techniques and materials for teaching secondary school mathematics,
and the consideration of trends and issues in mathematics education. (Spring)
410 Health Methods
(See Health Education 410 Administration and Supervision of the School Health Program)
388 Human Relations (1/2 course)
Emphasis on thestudy of values, of communication techniques, and of the major minority
groups in Minnesota for the development of interpersonal relations skills applicable to
teaching and other professional vocations. Open to all.
399 Internship
The student may select from a variety of situations for professional work experience. A
learning contract must be developed and must have education faculty approval.
478 School and Society
The emphasik in this course i s on the school in relation to society with particular attention
t o urban education. Introduced by a study of educational philosophy and the development of American education, current major issues in education will be studied. (Prereq.:
senior standing)
481,482,483,484 Student Teaching
Observing and directing learning at the secondary level under supervision of college and
secondary school personnel. (A minimum of two courses,except three courses required of
Art, Music, Physical Education majors. Prereq.: Admission to student teaching and
program approval)
499 Independent Study
Opportunity for advanced and specialized research projects not otherwise provided for i n
the departmental curriculum. A projected program must be outlined which meets the
approval of education faculty.
Special Education
Barry Franklin (Coordinator)
M i n o r : 6 courses, including 282,491; Psychology 351,357; one course chosen from
Health and Physical Education 354, Music 110 (Interim) or 395, Psychology 362,
Secondary Education 385 (Interim), or Social Work 304 (CHR); and one course
chosen from Linguistics 289, Psychology 352 or 359, or Secondary Education 388.
Biology 103 i s recommended as an additional course.
282 lntroduction to Special Education
lntroduction to the field of special education. An examination of the mature, causes, and
educational interventions for such exceptionalities as mental retardation, physical disability, hearing and vision impairment, learning disabilities, behavior disorders and
giftedness. (Spring)
491 Practicum and Seminar in Special Education
I
A supervised field placement i n a facility for an,exceptional population plus on-campus
seminar. Prereq.: Completion of courses for special education minor or consent of
instructor. Students planning to take this course should consult with the special education
coordinator about a placement prior to registering for the course. (Fall)
Engi neeri ng/69
Library Science
Marjorie Sibley, Grace Sulerud (Coordinators), Karen Harwood,
James Olson, Irene Schilling, Louisa Smith
Minor: M i n i m u m o f 4 courses, including 245,358,359,475.
341 Media Technology (1/2 course)
Psychological and philosophical dimensions of communication through the use of
instructional technology. Selection, preparation, production and evaluation of effective
audio visual materials for teaching/learning situations. (Spring)
345 The Media Center: Organization and Administration
Organization of materials, including acquistion, cataloging, classification, and processing.
Services of the media center and methods of evaluation.( Fall)
358 The Elementary School Library: Materials Selection and Guidance
Characteristics and purposes of an elementary school library. Evaluation of materials
related to curriculum support and recreational needs. Study of selection sources and
guidance in use of print and non-print materials. (Fall)
359 Reference Services and Sources
Study of basic English language reference sources. Students learn how to select and
evaluate reference books for home, school and other libraries; how to find information
and use libraries effectively. (Spring)
399 Internship
Open to juniors and seniors. An opportunity to do field work in a variety of library
situations in the metropolitan area.
475 The High School Library: Materials Selection and Guidance
Survey and evaluation of library materials on the secondary school level, with attention to
their use in relation to curricula as well as for personal interest and needs of adolescents.
(Spring)
499 Independent Studv
Independent study and research on some topic of interest in the field of library service,
worked out in consultation with a faculty adviser. Open to juniors and seniors, with
department approval.
Engineering
Ken Erickson (Adviser)
Augsburg College i s cooperating with the Washington University School of
Engineering and Applied Science (St. Louis, Missouri) and Michigan Technolo ical
University (Houghton, M ichigan),in a Three-Two Plan of studies which w i l l ena l e a
student to earn the Bachelor of Arts degree from Augsburg College and an
e n ineering baccalaureate degree f r o m Washington University or Michigan Technokpical University in a five-year period.
6
The first three ears are spent a t Au sbusg followed by two years at the affiliated
university. Stu ents accepted into t e program are guaranteed admission to the
en ineering school, provided they have met course requirements, haveaB average,
an8 are recommended by a designated representative of Augrburg College.
d
E
Students receiving financial aid who are participants i n the Three-Two Plan will be
encouraged t o apply t o the engineering school of their choice for continuing
support. Their applications will be evaluated using need and academic performance
as criteria.
M i n i m u m Course Requirements for Admission fo the Three-Two Plan: Math 124,
125,224,226; Physics 121,122; Chemistry 115,176; Computer Science 245; English
111; additional courses to meet general education requirements and a total of 27
courses at Augsburg. Normally Math 124,725 and Physics 127,122 are taken in the
freshman year.
Students are encouraged t o apply for admission to the program during their
sophomore year. Early consultation with the adviser i s encouraged.
English
Richard Sargent, (Chairperson), Barbara Andersen, Timothy Blackburn, Toni Clark,
John Gidmark, Ann Goodwin, John Mitchell, Catherine Nicholl, Grier Nicholl,
Ronald Palosaari, Richard Sargent, Donald Warren, David Wood
Major: 9 English courses above 717, including 225; one course in American
literature; one course in Western literary tradition (271 or272); and three courses in
British literature,oneon literature before1660 (for exarnpie,331 or438) and one that
surveys a number of writers (336,337,423). Majors are encauraged ta take Enulish
245 early i n their colllege work and tocrensu~ttheirdeparrmental adviser regular7 A
rtudenrwith a double major or r ecial program that involver considerable w o r t in
the English departrnenr should apo work closely with an adviser in the department.
Major for Teaching Licensure i n English-Language Arts: 10 English courses, includingthose listed for the major and a course in the English language; 2Speech courses,
one from 111,351,352,354 or 355 and either 360 or 366; Library Science 475. Courses
i n early American literature, Shakespeare and film arerecommended. I n addition to
fie1 ' experience and student teaching required by rhe D e p a r t m ~ n of
t Education,
majors rvill be required to gain practical experience in teaching writin
be
arranged through the department chairperson. Students are encouragec to rake
courses toward their major d u r ~ n the freshman and ~ophornoreyears, enroll i n
Orientation to Education i n the all term of the sophomore year and applv for
teacher education not later than the fall of their iunior year. i n addition to planning
their courses with the English department chairperson, students should consult an
adviser in the Department of Education.
'"
B
Minor: 5 courses above 111, including one in British literature and one writing
course.
Honors Major: GPA of 3.5 i n the major and 3.0 overall, submit program t o
department chairperson early in senior year, defend honors thesis before faculty
committee i n senior year. Honors thesis may be an independent study program.
Noteon Concentration: I n additionto meeting requirementsfor the major, English
majors may, i f they wish,develo an area of emphasis,such as British concentration,
f
American concehtration, worl literature concentration, or writing concentration.
A student arranges a concentration by careful selection of electives i n the major, by
the designof an independentstudy course that ap lies to the cancentration, and by
the selection of some related courses outside the epartrnent. English majors should
B
work closely with their advisers i n developing a concentration. Interim courses,
special courses, and courses at other ACTC schools will often fit well into a
concentration.
Note on Prerequisites: English 111 is strongly r e c o m m e n d e d b u t n o t a prerequisite
f o r a l o w e r division literature course. Prerequisite f o r an u p p e r division course is
successful c o m p l e t i o n o f a l o w e r division literature course o r consent o f t h e
instructor.
101 Developmental Writing
.4preparatory course for Effective Writing for students identified by an examination as
needing additional preparation. Instruction and practice in basic writing skills will be
given. Students will write short papers based on their own observation, experience, and
thought. P/hl grading only.
111 Effective Writing
The study of composition with emphasison expository writing. Attention t o correct usage,
logical organization, and the research paper. The grading system for this course is either
P/N or2.0-4.O/N. I n order to hold a place in the course the student must either attend class
the first day or personally notify the instructor that s/he cannot be present.
223 Writing for Business and the Professions
A practical course designed to improve writing skills for those preparing for business and
professional careers. The writing of reports, letters, and proposals will be emphasized.
Students will be encouraged to use material from their own areas of specialization.
(Prereq.: 111 or equivalent)
225 Advanced Expository Writing
The development of essays in a variety of rhetorical modes, which may include
identification, definition, classification, illustration, comparison and contrast, and analysis.
Particular attention will be given to stylistic and organizational matters through the
course's workshop format, in which students'papers are read and discussed. (Prereq.: 111)
226 Creative Writing
The purpose of the course i s to encourage and guide, by means of appropriate models,
theories, and criticism, writing in narrative and poetic modes of expression. Short stories,
personal narratives, and poems may be selected by students for experimentation and
development, according to the student's preference.
227 Journalism
An introduction to newswriting, with secondary emphasis on the feature and the news
feature. The student i s first introduced to the principles of writing the news story, what
constitutes news, copy preparation, and editing practices, then goes on to write real and
imagined obituaries, press releases, speech stories, and community newsstories. A unit on
the feature and the news feature concludes the course. Throughout the semester,
attention is paid to ethics, comparisons and contrasts with the electronic media, and
stylistic trends inside and outside the journalism establishment.
241 lntroduction to Cinema Art
An investigation of the artisticqualitiesand the historical development of the film medium.
The course includes the viewing and discussing of both feature length and short films.
(Spring)
245 lntroduction to Literature
An introduction to the study of fiction, drama, and poetry. Particular attention will be
devoted t o developing critical and analytical skills in reading and writing about literature.
Strongly recommended for English majors and minors.
250 American Literature to 1920
Reading and analysis of some significant works of selected American writersfrom colonial
times to the emergence of literary naturalism. Attention i s also given to the writer's
contribution to the historical development of American literature.
261 Modern Fiction
Significant works of selected prose writers, chiefly European, of the twentieth century.
-271 European Literature: Homer to Dante
Astudy of majorworksof Greekand Roman literature,for example theepicsof Homer and
Virgil, the tragedies of Aeschylus,Sophocles, and Euripides, thecomedies of Aristophanes
and Ovid's Metamorphoses. Dante's Inferno will be studied as a work in which the
Christian and the classical traditions are combined. These works will be studied with
reference to their mythological foundations, their cultural background, their influence on
later literature, and their enduring relevance. (Fall)
272 European Literature: From the Renaissance to the Modern Period
Study of masterpieces of literature, chiefly European, from the medieval to the modern
period, including such authors as Moliere, Cervantes, Montaigne, Goethe, Dostoyevsky.
(Spring)
282 Topics in Literature
Individual courses designed to investigate specific themes, movements,authors, or works.
The subjects selected for study in any year will be listed in the class schedule for that year.
331 Chaucer and His Age
While the primary study of the course will be the writings of Geoffrey Chaucer, attention
will be given to the medieval literary milieu out of which Chaucer wrote. Medieval poetry,
romance, and drama may be examined. (Alternate years, 1982-83)
332 Milton and His Age
A study of Milton's major poems and selected prose. In addition the Renaissance literary
tradition out of which Milton created his works will be examined. (Alternate years, 1983-84)
336 British Literature, from Donne to Blake
Reading, analysis and discussion of works of selected writers from the metaphysical poets
to Blake, with attention t o the historical, intellectual, and social influences and the major
literary movements. (Fall)
337 British Literature, the Romantics and the Victorians
A study of major writers of the nineteenth century, emphasizing Romantic poetry,
Victorian poetry, Victorian prose and two or three novels of the period. Relationships
amongthese writersand their influence on one anotherwill be emphasized as well as their
relationship t o their own age and their lasting contribution to the forms of poetry and
prose. (Spring)
351 American Literature Since 1920
A study of some recent and contemporary writers and literary movements. Attention is
given to the dynamics of American society and its intricate relationship to the literature.
Special emphasis i s given to the city as setting and symbol i n modern American literature.
366 Poetry
Study of the poem as a concentrated, esthetic form of human expression and experience.
The course emphasizes modern American and British poetry, but also includes a generous
selection of traditional and contemporary poems, both in English and i n translation from
selected international poets such as Rilke and Neruda. A diverse range of forms, moods,
themes, and techniques i s represented, and the relationship between traditional poetry
and modern poetry i s examined. (On demand)
Foreign Languages/73
368 Modern Drama
Slgnlflcant worLr of Ameriran.Rritish, and continental dramatlstsof the twent~ethcentury,
wlth emphasls on represen1arlrbcr.from the major movements such as Naturalism,
Ex~stent~al~sm,
T h e a t ~ rof the Absnrd, and Tran~forrnat~onal~sm
Plays by women and
mlnorltles are included. [On demand)
399 Internship
The department offers on-campus internships in teaching writing and various off-campus
internships. Interested students should consult the department chairperson.
423 Studies in the British Novel
A survey o i the development of the novel in Engiand from its eighteenth century
beginnings up trr the twentieth century. Novels studied wiIl be selected from the works of
such authors as Defoe, R~chardson,Fielding.Sterne, Austen, Dickens, Bronte,Thackeray,
Elio~,H~ardy,and
Butler. Attention will beqiven to theconditionscontributing to therlseof
the novel and its emergence by the twentieth centrrry a5 rhe dominant literary form.
(Alternate years, 1982-83)
438 Shakespeare
Study of ten or twelve major plays- comedies, histories,tragedies-with attention tothe
development of Shakespeare's dramatic and poetic art. Additional plays assigned for
reading analysis.
490,491 English Seminar
Course490, a themeor movement; course491, a majorwriter or a major work. Enrollment
open to juniors and seniors. (On demand)
498 lndependent Study - Metropolitan Resources
Open to junior or senior English majors with a grade of 3.0 or consent of department
chairperson. Provides directed independent study which makes use of the resources of
Augsburg's urban location, such as theaters, poetry readings, and writers' groups.
499 lndependent Study
Open to junior or senior English majors with a grade of 3.0 or consent of department
chairperson. Provides directed independent study in the area of the student's choice.
Foreign Languages
Mary Johnson (Chairperson), Ruth Aaskov, Liv Dahl, Leif Hansen, Mary Kingsley,
William Oyler, Madeleine Renaud, Gunta Rozentals, Maria Schweikert, Soterios
Stavrou, Donald Steinmetz
Students with previous foreign language study should register i n courses suited t o
their level of preparation.
Placement Levels: 111, under t w o years of high school study i n that language or
equivalent background; 211, t w o t o three years of languagestudy; 311,four years or
m o r e of that language.
Students should arrange for the Language Placement Test only if they wish t o take a
course above the level determined by previous studies i n that language. Those with
satisfactory levels o n the test may be placed i n 112,212, o r 311.
Students who elect t a t a k ~a course below the one in which they are placed by r h e
Language Department may d o so, bat grading for such a course must be P/N only.
The language requirement will b e satisfied only by completion of the course i n
which the studenr was originally placed. Credit and grading far that course may be
traditional.
74/Foreign Languages
For majors, a minimum of four upper division courses at Augsburg Coltege is
required for graduation. A maximum of four upper division nun-kugsburgcourses
may be accepted. No fewer than two of these four courses should be taken abroad.
For minors, a minimum of two upper division courses at Augsburg College i s
required for graduation.
For transfer students intending t o major or minor, a minimum of one upper division
credit per year attended is specified. See department faculty for limits on nonAugsburg courses and career information.
Course 112 completes basic elements of the language. Courses numbered 211,212
meet useable skill levels. Course 311 i s prerequisite to all upper division courses.
Teaching Litensure: Teacher candidates in French. German and 5 anish mug
consult with the Department of Educalion for specific information an enrollment
in rhe program. Methods courses bv language are joinr ACTC offerings and should
be taken in the fall of t h e s ~ n i o year.
r
A 3 0 average in Advanced Conversation and
Composition i s a departmental requirement forteachin? majors. Licensur~requires
successfulcorn letion of the Modern Language As5ociation Competencv Exam. See
Requirements or State of Minnesota ticensure for Teaching in Secondary Schools.
p. 66.
8
P
Chinese
Chinese language studies are possible through a contractual arrangement with the
ACTC East Asian Studies Program and the University of Minnesota East Asian Studies
Department. See East and Southeast Asian Studies Director.
French
Major: 8 courses above 212, including two in conversation-composition, one in
civilization, and three in literature, of which one should be course 352. Study in
France strongly recommended.
Minor: 4 courses above 212, including one in conversation-composition, one i n
civilization, and one in literature. Interim or summer of study in France strongly
recommended.
Teaching Minor: Five courses beyond 212, including one in conversation-composition, 350, one in civilization, and two electives. All courses must be upper
division courses. Study in France strongly recommended.
Recommended Supporting Courses: European History, a second language, philosophy, linguistics, English literature. Study Abroad. Also see Interim catalog.
011 Directed Study
Conversational French, readings. Once weekly. No credit. (On Demand)
111 Beginning French
Designedto introduce thestudent with no previous background in French to the language
and to French culture. The pronunciation system and basic sentence structures are taught
to enable understanding and expression on a rudimentary level. Two hours laboratory
work. See above on placement.
Foreign Languages/75
112 Beginning French
for hose who have had 111 or equivalent. Through conversations, sentence practice, and
readings, the study of tenses and forms iscompleted to make possible basic communication, b e g i n n i f i ~reading rkills,and acquaintance with French culture and way of life. Two
hours laboratory work. See above o n placement. (Spring)
211 Intermediate French
20th Century selected articles and a grammar review are the basis for practice i n
communication, vocabulary building and developing greater ease in reading. For those
who have studied most of the basic structures. Two hours of laboratory work. (Fall)
212 Intermediate French
Through informative and controversial articles, interviews and literary readings, this course
works toward the goals of oral fluency, communication of ideas, and the acquisition of
sufficientskiltsro pursue general reading in French. Completes a review of basicstructures.
habora~orywork. 1Spring1
243 French Literature i n Translation
Major representative works of French literarure read in English translation. Through
individualized background readingand crass discussion.studen1s become acquainted with
artistic qualities and culrvral-hinorical sign~f~cance
of these works. Sophomore standing.
Does not count toward a French major or minor. [Offered o n Demand)
311 Conversation-Composition
Explores topics of current interest in both oral and written form to build fluency, accuracy,
and facility of expression. Emphasis on vocabulary enrichment, grammatical refinements,
effective organization of ideas. Laboratory assignments. Post-intermediate level. A
prerequisite to other upper division courses. (Fall)
312 French Expression
A two-pronged approach to coherent and correct expression in speaking and writing.
Attention to grammatical structures, French turns of phrase and elementary stylistics for
business and personal use. French phonology and speech groups practiced. Study of
writien models. [Prereq.: 311 or #. O n demand)
331 French Civilization: Historical Perspective
A study of the diversified development of the French from their beginnings to the modern
period. Special attention to cultural manifestations of their intellectual, political,social and
artistic self-awareness. Readings, reports, extensive use of audio-visual materials. I n
French. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
332 French Civilization Today
Topics i n twentieth-century problems, ideas. Cultural manifestations that promote
understanding of French people and their contribution to the contemporary scene.
Readings, reports, extensive use of audio-visual materials and periodicals. I n French.
(Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
350 Introduction t o Literature for Language Students
Theory and practiceof literarvstudies. A theoreticat component (inEnglish) treats the basic
principles of literature, literary genres, and different approaches to literary analysis. I n the
practical component, students apply rhe elements of theor), rhrough reading, analyzing,
and discussing selected works of French li~erature.Recommended for majors and ~ i n o r s .
Open to all qualiiied students. (Prereq.: 311 or Offered on demand)
*.
76/Foreign Languages
352 Creativity and Restraint
A survey of the major literary creators of the Renaissance and Classical periods, and the
French intellectual, social and ethical currents reflected in their works. Poetry and the
essay, theater, early novel, letters and other prose forms. Classes, oral and written reports,
and laboratory work in French. Required of all majors. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
354 Realities: Inner and Outer Worlds
A survey of the romantics, major novelists, Baudelaire and hissuccessors in poetry,and the
literature of ideas that led to new forms and emphases with the turn of the century (Proust,
Gide, Claudel, Apollinaire, etc.) Classes, oral and written reports, and laboratory texts in
French. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Offered alternate years)
355 Twentieth Century Literature
A survey of the major French literary movements since World War I, including the novel,
the theater, poetry, the essay, and criticism. Classes, oral and written reports, and
laboratory texts in French. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
411 Advanced Conversation-Composition
By means of reading, speaking and writing on topics of intellectual, social, or political
interest the student acquires extensive training i n the four skills at an advanced level.
Attention to accuracy and effectiveness, characteristic levels of expression, refinements in
style and organization as individual needs indicate. Provides for self-improvement and
self-evaluation. Laboratory assignments. Required for all majors. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n
Demand)
450 French Seminar
Study in depth of an author, topic or genre in French literature (e.g. Novel, Drama, 18th
Century literature, poetry). Student presentations i n French. (See also Interim offerings.
Prereq.: 352,354 or 355. O n Demand)
451 The French Novel
A study of major authors (LaFayette, Proust, Balzac, Gide, Flaubert,Zola, Mauriac, Malraux,
Sartre, Camus, etc.) that shows the evolution of this genre i n theme and form. Analyses,
discussion, and papers in French. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Recommended 331. O n demand)
499 Independent Study
Individual pursuit of a topic, movement, or genre at an advanced level. Designed to
complete a balanced program, enhance research, or meet individual interests. In literature
a major paper and its defense are included. (Consultations with French teachers required.
Junior standing. Fall, Interim, Spring. Subject and plan to be clarified early with study
adviser.)
German
Major: 8 u p p e r division courses, i n c l u d i n
311 a n d 411. Interim, summer o r
semester i n Germany strongly r e c o m m e n d e d
Minor: 4 u p p e r division courses, i n c l u d i n g 311 a n d 411. Interim, summer o r
semester i n Germany strongly recommended.
Teaching Minor: Five courses b e y o n d 212, i n c l u d i n g o n e i n conversation-composition, 350, o n e i n civilization, and t w o electives. A l l courses must b e u p p e r
division courses. Study i n Germany strongly recommended.
Recommended Supporting Courses: Linguistics, European History, another language, English literature.
Foreign Languages/77
111,112 Beginning German
Course 111 i s for students with no previous background; 112 i s for students who have had
111 or equivalent or less than two years of high school German. Aims at developing basic
skills. Classroom practice in speaking, understanding and reading basic German. Goals:
ability t o read extended narratives i n simple German, insights into German culture and
participation in short conversations. Laboratory materials available.
211,212 Intermediate German
For students with two terms (or two years high school) of previous German. Aims at
developing basicskills into working knowledge of German. Review of basicstructureswith
emphasison extending rangeof vocabulary and idiomaticexpression through reading and
discussion of materials representing contemporary German life and literature. (211, Fall;
212, Spring)
244 German Literature i n Translation
Principal works of German literature representing various periods and movements are
read and discussed in English. The readings are considered not only in the particular
context of German cultural history, but also discussed in terms of their relevance to
perennial human problems. Credit for this course does not apply to a German major or
minor. (On Demand)
301 German Business Communication
German trade correspondence. (Prereq.: 212 or #. O n Demand.)
311 German Conversation and Composition
Aims at developing facility in the use of grammatical structures, vocabulary and idiomatic
expressions most common in colloquial German. Intensive practice in speaking is
supplemented with exercises in written composition. (Fall)
331 German Civilization and Culture I
The Earlv Background. Foltows the cultura1 and social development of the German5peaking peoples from the preh~sroricfnda-European origins (ca. 3,000 B.C.) to the Thirty
Y e a r s h a r (16.131,with emphasison the impact of Roman crvilization, the re-emergenceof
German cultural s e l f awareness d u r ~ n gtheMiddle Agesoandthe intellectual and religious
upheavals o l the Reformation. In German. (Prereq.: 311 or Alternate years)
*.
332 German Civilization and Culture I1
Survey of significant currents of deveropment which have shaped present-day Germany,
Austria and swirzerfand since the Age of Enlightenment. The contemporary scene i s
cansidered in view oiits roots in fhe intellectual, geopolitical, artisticand scientific history
o i the German-speaking peoples. In German. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
350 Introduction t o Literature for Language Students
Theory and practice of lirerarvstudies. Arheorctica~cornponent(in English)treatsfhe basic
principles of literature, literary genres, and different approaches to bitcrarvanafyj~r.In the
practical component, students apply the elements of theory through reading, analyzing
and discussing selected worksof German litesaturc. Recommended far majors and minors
Open t o all qualified students. (Prereq.: 377 or Offered on Demand\
=,
351 German Literature through 18th Century
Brief survey of hemtt. courtly, Reformarion, Baroque, Aufklarung and Sturm und Drang
literature. Exrenrive rcadingr and discussions in Classic and Romanticperiods. Readings in
German.supplernented by [eaures on the history or German literature in its cultural and
geopolitical context. Class djscussrons help to improve students' ability t o express ideas i n
German. (Prereq.: 311 or *. O n Demand)
78/Foreign Languages
-
352 German Literature: The 19th Century
Includes later Romanticism, lung-Deutschland, poetic realism, Naturalism and Impressionism. The literary reaction to the decline of idealistic philosophy and the importance of
the individual and the rise of materialism, technology and mass man. Readings in German.
Class discussions help to improve students' ability to deal with concepts and express
themselves i n German. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n Demand)
353 German Literature: The 20th Century
Literary responses to the crises and upheavals of our time. Writers of international stature
are discussed: Kafka, Hesse, Mann, Brecht. Readings in German with class discussions are
designed to aid students' self-expression i n German. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n Demand)
411 Advanced German Composition and Conversation
Aimsat developing and refining the student's use of German as avehiclefor expressing his
own ideas and opinions. Emphasis on written composition including control of style. Oral
practice through use of German as classroom language. (Prereq.: 311 or#. Alternate years)
451 German Prose
Reading and discussion of German prose masterpieces from Goethe to the present.
Lectures treat the development of the epic genre as a mirror of cultural and geopolitical
history. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n Demand)
452 German Drama
Representative dramaticworks from late 18th century to the present are discussed and read
assymptomaticof perennial human concerns. Lectures treat the historical development of
the drama. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n Demand)
499 Independent Study
Greek
See the instructor for supporting courses at Augsburg i n history, philosophy, art,
literature, linguistics which can apply toward a classics concentration i n cooperation
with Macalester College.
111,112 Beginning Greek
Theoretical and practical study of Greek grammar, with special emphasis on morphology.
Translation exercises from and into Greek. (111, Fall; 112, Spring. A minimum of 9 hours
preparation per week required.)
350 Introduction to Literature for Language Students
A first course in the theory and practice of literary studies. A theoretical component (in
English) t r e a t r t k baslc principles of IIterature, literary genres, and different approaches to
literary analysis. In the practical component, the class will divide into small groups
according to foreign language, where the elements of theory will be applied through
reading, analyzing, and discuss~ngselected works for foreign literature in the language.
Recommended for majors and minors. Open to all qualified students. (Prereq.: 212 or #.
Offered on demand)
Japanese
Japaneselanguage studies are possible through a contractual arrangement with the
ACTC Easr Asian Studies Program and the University of Minnesota East Asian Studies
Department. See fast and Southeast Asian Studies Director for more information.
Foreign Languages/79
Linguistics
289 Introduction to Linguistics
An introduction to linguistic analvsis and general Iingulstic principles, with focus on
[ingutst~c
universals (organtzational principles and features common to all language) and
psycholinguirric5 (inquiry i n to the mechanicsof language learning and thestructure of the
mind as revealed in language). Theoretical questrons will be approached by studying
sarnplesof various Languages. No prerequisite. Recommended for all language majorsand
minors. (Fall)
311 Theories of Grammar
Camparat~vcanalysis of various views of language represented in current linguistic
research w ~ t h
the aim af l[luminaringunderiyingphilosophical assumptions, investigational
criteria, and explanarory goals which dlsringuish them. Jhr rheories wi[l becnntrasred with
those of adjacenrdisciplinessuch asanthr~pology.psy~fiology,logic,and
c~mmunrcation
theory to explore ways In which each theory seeks to overcome rhe inadequacies of
traditional grammar. (On Demand)
Norwegian
a n d 499, a n d o n e
Scandinavian literature course. I n t e r i m o r summer i n Norway recommended.
Major: 8 courses above 211, i n c l u d i n g 311,312,331,350,353,411,
Minor: 4 courses above 211, i n c l u d i n g o n e i n conversation-com osition, o n e i n
civilization, a n d o n e i n literature. I n t e r i m o r summer study abroaBencouraged.
Recommended Supporting Preparation: Study i n Norway, a second foreign language, linguistics, additional courses u n d e r Scandinavian Area Studies.
111,112 Beginning Norwegian
lntroduction of the four basic language skills: speaking, listening, reading and writing.
Stress on spoken ratherthan literary Norwegian. Laboratory work expected. (111, Fall; 112,
Spring)
211 Intermediate Norwegian
Continued conversation and composition to improve comprehension and facility of
expression. Selected readings in Norwegian used as basis for classdiscussion and exercises.
Laboratory work and some field experience expected. (Prereq.: 112 or equivalent.)
311 Norwegian Conversation and Composition
Intensive praaice in spoken Norwegian with emphasis on pronunciation and original
composition. S a m e anention given to regional variations in spoken Norwegian and to
differences between tfretwoofilcial languages of Norway. Some laboratory work and field
experience required. (Prercq.: 211 or equivalent.)
312 Old Norse
An introductlon to thestructure of Old West Norse through thestudy of selections from
Old Norse literature. Some attention given to Old Easr Norseand aspects of the history of
four modem Nordiclanguages. Knowledge of oneof the latter is desired but not required.
Norwegian language minors will have special assignments. (Alternate years)
331 Norwegian Civilization and Culture
This study of Norwegian cultural history will include significant aspects of the contemporary Norwegian society. Through extensive readings (in Norwegian as far as
possible), the domestic and foreign influences at work in the comparatively homogeneous
population of Norway will be examined. Written and oral reports i n the Norwegian
language will be required along with some field work. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
80/Foreign Languages
350 lntroduction to Literature for Language Students
Theory and practice of literary studies. A theoretical componenr [in English) treats !he basic
principlesof IIrerature, literary genres, and different approaches to literary analysis, fn the
practical component, students apply the elements of theory through reading, analyzing,
and discussing selected works of Norwegian literature. Recommended for majors and
minors. Open to all qualified students. (Prereq.: 311 or +. Offered on demand)
353 Survey of Norwegian Literature
Selected readings i n contemporary Norwegian literature provide a base for the study of
original works from earlier periods e~rendingback ro 01d Norse literature. All genres are
examined, and considerable atnention is given t o writings i n the Nynorsk language,
particularly poetry. Lectures, readings, oral and written reports are in Norwegian. (Prereq.:
211 or equivalent. Spring 1981. Alternate years)
411 Advanced Norwegian Conversation and Composition
Further intensive practice in spoken and written Norwegian. Attention given to the other
ScandirBvian languages and to the historical development of the Norwegian language.
Laboratory work and field experience required. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
499 Independent Study
Russian
One year of elementary Russian is offered at Au sburg. Russian language studies
may be continued in the ACTC Russian Area Stucfies Program, which re uires two
years of language for the major. See Russian Area Studies Campus Coor%inator.
111,112 Elementary Russian
Aimed t o develop reading, writing, understanding, and conversational skills through oral
classroom practice, developing ease i n reading, short compositions, and acquaintance
with Russian culture. Extensive use of the language lab.
Spanish
Major: 8 courses above 212, including 311, 411, 456 or 457, two of 352, 353, 354.
(Study in Spain or Latin America i s strongly recommended)
Minor: 4 courses above 212, including one in conversation-composition, one in
civilization, and one in literature. Interim or summer study abroad strongly
recommended.
Teaching Minor: Five courses beyond 212, including one in conversation-composition, 350, one in civilization, and two electives. All courses must be upper
division courses. Study in Spain or Latin America.
Recommended Supporting Courses: Linguistics, another language, Pre-Columbian
civilization, Latin-American Area studies. Consult department for other supporting
courses in humanities.
111,112 Beginning Spanish
Aims to develop the four basic skills: understanding, speaking, reading, and writing of
elementary Spanish. lntroduction to culture of Spanish-speaking world. Laboratory work i s
an integral part of the course.
Foreign Languages/81
211,212 Intermediate Spanish
Through the reading of selected Latin American and Spanish texts which stimulate
intellectual growth and promote cultural understanding, students review all of the basic
structures of Spanish, and build conversational skills through class discussions. Designed
for students with 2-4 years of high school Spanish or its equivalent.
249 Selected Works of Spanish and Latin American Literature in Translation
Major works of Spanish and Latin American literarure representing various periods and
movements are read in English iranslarion. Through background reading and class
discussion in English !he strident i s acqualn~edwith the salient artistic qualities and
cultural-hisroricalsignificanc~?
of thereadings, Credit in thiscourse does not count toward
a major or minor in Spanish. Sophomore standing preferred. (On Demand)
311 Spanish Conversation and Composition
Thorough oral and writlen practice in correct expression with the aims of fluency and
facility. Enrichment of vocabulary. Labnrarorv work. This course i s a prerequisite for all
upper-division courses. I P r ~ r e q . :211 or equivalent. Fall)
312 Spanish Expression
Intended for students who havea basic command of writing and speaking skills in Spanish
and wish to expand them. Intensive practice to improve oral and written expression with
emphasis on conversationaT facility, 5tressing idiomatic usage and the finer points of
grammar. Readings to stimulate discussion and broaden cultural background from
contemporary literary texts and manazine ar~irles.Conducted in 5panish. (On Demand)
331 Spanish Civilization and Culture
Study of the Spanish character and of Spanish contribution to world civilization through
historical, intellectual, literary, and artistic movements. I n Spanish. (Prereq.: 311 or #.
Alternate years.)
332 Latin American Civilization and Culture
A study of the cultural heritage of theSpanish American countries from the Pre-Columbian
civilizations to the present. In Spanish. (Prereq.: 311 or 212, with #. Alternate years)
350 Introduction to Literature for Language Students
T h ~ o r y a n dpracticed literarystudier..4 rhcorezical component (in English)treats the basic
principles at lirerarurr, literary gerlres, and different approaches to literary analysis. In the
pracricat component.studenrsapply the theorv through reading, analyzing, and dlscusslng
selected works ot Ii~eraturein Spanish. Recammended for majors and minors. Open to all
clualrfed rrudents. (Prrrcq.: 311 or i;. o i i e r e d on demand)
352,353 Survey of Spanish Literature I, II
A study of representative authors in Spanish literature, supplemented by lectures on the
literary movements and development of Spanish literature. Lectures, discussion, written
and oral reports in the language. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n Demand)
354 Representative Hispanic American Authors
An introduction to Spanish-American literature. Lectures, discussions, written and oral
reports in the language. (Prereq.: 311 or #. O n Demand)
411 Advanced Conversation and Composition
Emphasis on increasing facility and correctness of written and oral expression through
conversations, discussions, reports, debates, and written compositions and grammatical
exercises. (Prereq.: 311 or #. Alternate years)
82/Geography, Health and Physical Education
456 Spanish Drama
Study of the masterpieces of dramatic literature in Spain. Oral and written reports in the
language. Emphasis on the Golden Age and the Modern Period. (Prereq.: One survey
course. Alternate years)
457 Spanish Novel
Study of the outstanding novelists of the nineteenth and twentieth century i n Spain. Oral
and written reports in the language. (Prereq.: One survey course. Alternate years)
499 Independent Study
Geography
Paul Grauer
114 Human Geography
An introduction to the basic concepts and tools of geography followed by a survey of the
distribution patterns to be found in our physical and human environment.
Health and Physical Education
Richard Borstad (Chairperson), Ernest Anderson, David Boots, Paul Grauer, Al
Kloppen, Doug Nelson, Jack Osberg, Pamela Paulson, Marilyn Pearson, Ronald
Petrich, Joyce Pfaff, William Ross, Edwin Saugestad, Jeff Swenson, Mary Timm
Health Education
Major: 110, 114, 115, 320, 354, 410; Biology 103, 108, 111; Chemistry 105 or 109;
Psychology 105; Sociology 231, 241.
Teaching Major: Same as health education major plus 355. Students wishing t o
become licensed teachers should consult with the Education Department for
requirements.
Minor: 110, 114, 115, 320; Biology 103; Sociology 231
110 Personal and Community Health
Modern concepts and practices of health and healthful living applied to the individual and
the community. (Fall)
114 Health and Safety Education (1/2 course)
Principles and practices of safety education in school and community life. Includes
information about school health programs and prevalent health needs and problems of
school age children, and American Red Cross First Aid course.
115 Health and Chemical Dependency Education (1/2 course)
An analysis of chemical abuse and what can be done for the abuser. Includes information
about school health programs and prevalent health needs and problems of scbool age
children.
Health and Physical Education/83
320 School Health Curriculum
Techniques for developing a course of study based upon growth and development for
grades K-12. Special work units in nutrition and diseases. (Prereq.: All courses in the major
sequence numbered in the 100 and 200 series; also #.)
354 Teaching the Exceptional Child (1/2 course)
Education of the exceptional child with special reference to the analysis of functional and
organic abnormalities and the role of school health and physical education programs.
(Prereq.: Physical Education 350. Spring)
355 Tests and Measurement (1/2 course)
Survey of basic statistical procedures and evaluation of tests i n health and physical
education. (Spring)
410 Administration and Supervision of the School Health Program
Historical background, legal bases, school health services, and relationships to community
health program and resources. Methods and materials in health education with laboratory
experience in classroom and community. (Prereq.: 320)
Physical Education
Major: Health Education 114,115,354,355; Physical Education 223,231,232,243,350,
351, 471, 472, 474,475; Biology 103.
Teaching Major: Health Education 114,115, 354,355; Physical Education 223, 231,
232, 243, 350, 351, 365, 471, 472, 474; Biology 103. Students wishing to become
licensed teachers should consult with the Education Department for requirements.
Major with Specialization in Corrective Therapy: Health Education 114, 115, 354,
355; Physical Education 223,231,232,243,350,351,365,471,472,474,475,485,487,
491,493; Professional Affiliation Block495-496-497-499; Biology 103; Psychology 105,
355, 362. All C.T. specialists must be accepted bv the education department for
teaching and student teaching in an adapted situation. Approval must be secured by
the corrective therapy coordinator.
Major with Specialization in Adapted Physical Education: Consult department
chairperson for individual program planning.
Minor: Health Education 114,115; Physical Education 223,231,232 or 472, and 243.
Coaching Endorsement: 243, 351,475, one of 476-483, and practicum in coaching
(Independent Study 499 i s an optional method for meeting the practicum
requirement).
Notes: Physical education major plus coaching practicum meets the coaching
requirement. Coaches entering their first headcoaching assignment in Minnesota
high schools are required to have at least a coaching endorsement in the field of
physical education and athletics.
102, 103 Lifetime Sports
Three hours per week. Two lifetime sports meet the general education requirement. N o
course credit.
223 Team Sports
Theory and practice in skills, teaching, and officiating team sports. (Spring)
84/Health and Physical Education
231 Individual and Dual Sports
Theory and practice i n skills, teaching, and officiating individual and dual sports. (Fall)
232 Recreational Activities and Rhythms (1/2 course)
Theory and practice in performing American heritage and international folk dances.
Exposure to New Games concepts and activities. Practice in teaching and performing
selected social dances. (Interim and Spring)
234 Outdoor Education (1/2 course)
This course will look at a wide variety of outdoor activities that can be taught in a school
setting. The following activities will be emphasized: Canoeing, back-packing, cycling,
outdoor cooking, camping and water safety. Students must be prepared to spend some
weekends participating i n these activities. (Spring, even # years)
243 History and Principles of Physical Education
History, principles, and philosophy of physical education. (Spring)
350 Kinesiology
Mechanics of movement with special emphasis upon the muscular system and analysis of
movement. (Prereq.: Biology 103; Fall)
351 Physiology of Exercise
The major effects of exercise upon the systems of the body and physiological principles
applied to exercise programs and motor training. (Prereq.: Biol. 103. Spring)
I
354 Teaching the Exceptional Child
(See Health Education)
355 Tests and Measurement
(See Health Education)
365 Physical Education Methods (K-12)
Procedures, materials, and issues for teaching physical education at the elementary and
secondary levels. (Fall)
373 Modern Dance (1/2 course)
A n introductory course in modern dance technique, composition, improvisation, and
problem solving. No previous dance experience necessary. (Interim)
399 Internship
Consult department chairperson.
471 Physical Education Programming
Procedures and techniques of management, leadership and decision making for physical
education and interscholastic athletic programs. Curriculum analysis and preparation.
(Prereq.: 243. Fall)
472 Gymnastics (1/2 course)
Theory and techniques of teaching gymnastics. Opportunity to teach and perform in all
apparatus events and tumbling. Experience in spotting and skill analysis. (Fall)
474 Swimming and Aquatics
Theory and practice in teaching swimming, lifesaving, and water safety. Open only to
junior and senior Physical Education majors and minors. (Prereq.: Swimming competence
as determined by pre-test. Fall)
Health and Physical Education/85
475 Prevention and Care of Athletic Injuries (1/2 course)
Emphasis placed on preventing injuries. Treatment of common athletic injuries. Practical
experience in taping and training-room procedures. (Prereq.: 350. Fall, 1st half of term)
476 Coaching of Football (1/2 course)
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching football. (Fall, 1st half of term,
odd #years)
477 Coaching of Basketball (1/2 course)
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching basketball. (Interim, odd #years)
478 Coaching of Hockey (1/2 course)
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching hockey. (Interim, odd # years)
479 Coaching of Track and Field (1/2 cours4
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching track and field. (Spring, 2nd half
of term, odd #years)
480 Coaching of Baseball/Soft Ball (l/2 course)
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching baseball and softball. (Spring,
2nd half of term, odd years)
483 Coaching of Volleyball (1/2 course)
Theory, technique and administrative aspects of coaching volleyball. (Fall, odd #years)
485 Applied Adapted Activities
Explores recreation as applied to a corrective therapy program, application of corrective
exercise to the atypical, self care and ambulation, prosthetics and orthotics. Equal attention
i s given to physical and mental habilitation, physical education for the handicapped and
recreation in rehabilitation. (Prereq.: 350,351; Health Education 354. Summer school only)
487 Neurology and Pathology
Astudy of the nervoussystem and the diseasesassociated with it and the nature and cause
of disease involving changes in structures and functions. Equal attention i s given to
neurology and pathology. (Summer School only)
491 Therapeutic Exercise
Exercise techniques as applied to various disabilities, testing muscle strength and range of
joint motion and association of muscle actions as applied to various human movements.
Equal attention is given to human movement, kinesiotherapy and evaluation and research
applied to C.T. and A.P.E. programs. (Prereq.: 350, 351; Health Education 354. Summer
school only)
493 Organization and Administration of Corrective Therapy
A study of organization, administration, history, philosophy and professional ethics as
applied to C.T. intertherapy relations in a rehabilitation setting. Basic supervisory and
personnel management decisions and practices. Most of the course deals with organization and administration of C.T.; about one-sixth of the course deals with intertherapy
relations. (Summer School only)
495,496, 497 Professional Affiliation
Includes actual hospital experience in four areas of corrective therapy: (1) Psychiatry, (2)
Orthopedics, (3) Neurology, and (4) Rehabilitation. Course 497 i s study of Neurology and
Pathology (Prereq.: 485,491 and approval of department.)
499 Independent Study
Directed intensive study in an area of physical education. Open only to junior or senior
majors.
History
Orloue Gisselquist (Chairperson), Carl Chrislock, Don Gustafson, Khin Khin Jensen,
Richard Nelson
Major: 8 courses plus 1 seminar. At least four of these courses must be upper
division. A major must have at least one course (either survey or upper level) from
each of the four areas. Ancient and Medieval; Modern Europe; U.S.; and nonWestern.
Major for Teaching Licensure: Students interested in secondary education may
take a history major in combination with specified social science courses and the
required educational courses, in compliance with the state requirements. For more
information, see the department chairperson or the Social Studies Coordinator.
Minor: 5 courses, at least three of which must be upper division.
Honors Major: G P A of 3.6 in t h e major and 3.0 overall; except in special instances,
application before rhe end of the first term of the junior year; two years of aforeign
language at the college level (or its equivalent): an honors thesis (equal t o one
course credit) to be defended before a faculty committee.
Notes: Freshmen should enroll in one or more of the History 101-104 courses.
History 221-222 are normally reserved for sophomore or upper division students.
Students are required t o have at least one lower division course before registering
for an upper level course.
There are 17 upper division courses (numbered 300and up) in this department. Five
or six are offered each term, or 11 per year. Offerings depend upon faculty
schedules and student registration.
101 The Beginnings of the Western Culture
An analysis of the primary civilizations in the Near East, the classical world of Greece and
Rome, and the middle ages of Europe into the 13th century.
102 The Shaping of Western Civilization
A consideration of European institutions and values from the waning of the middle ages
through the remodeling of Europe by Napoleon.
103 The Modern World
A study of the main currents in western civilization from the time of Napoleon to the
present.
104 The Modern Non-Western World
An introduction to various centers of cultural and political power in Asia and Africa of the
last 200 years.
221 U.S. History to 1877
A survey of Americans from Jamestown through the efforts to reconstruct a nation torn
apart by The Civil War. (Fall)
222 U.S. History Since 1877
An assessment of the century which precedes our modern day. (Spring)
226 Asian and Asian-American Women in Public Life in the 20th Century
An exploration of the experiences and contributions of selected women in China, Japan,
India, Korea, Philippines, and the state of Hawaii. Includes cross-cultural perspective,
responses to impact of modernization and Western education.
299 Directed Study
An opportunity for a student to do readings or study on topics not covered i n the
scheduled courses. The proposed study must be approved by thedirectingfaculty member
and the chairman of the department before registration. A maximum of one course i n
directed study may be applied to the major.
322 Modern Southeast Asia
A study of the major historical events, personalities and political developments in this area.
A comparative analysis of the nationalist movements and the process of decolonization will
especially focus on Indonesia, the Philippines, Burma and Vietnam.
323 Modern China
A selective treatment of Chinese history since the Opium War of 1839. The erosion of
China's isolationism and collapse of the imperial system. The Nationalist and Communist
revolutions of the 20th century.
324 Modern japan
An examination of the emergence of Japan as a major world power in the 20th century.
Components of the course will include a study of the distinctive features of the Pre-Meiji
era, modernization factors since 1868, interaction and encounter with China, urban
development, ecological problems, role of women and Japan's trade in Asia and Africa.
331 Topics in U.S. History
Exploration in depth of selected topics in U.S. history (excludingforeign policy; see History
332). The specific topics to be offered will be announced prior to registration.
332 History of American Foreign Policy
The relationship of foreign policy to general American development i s stressed.
345 Scandinavian-American Experience
(See under Scandinavian Area Studies)
353 Select Topics in Minnesota History
A survey of topics relating to the emergence of modern Minnesota: Indian-white
relations; immigration and ethnic adjustments; rise of the Twin Cities; economic and
political development. Primary emphasis will be on the late 19th and early 20th centuries.
360 The Ancient Near East and Greece to 338 B.C.
The development of civilization i n the Near East from earliest times through i t s extension
and elaboration by the Greeks. Emphasis is placed on the development of writing,
achievement in the arts and sciences and political institutions.
361 Hellenistic Greece and Rome to 330 A.D.
A study of the development of Alexander's Empire, the Hellenistic kingdoms and the rise of
Rome as the world's greatest power. Emphasis i s placed on personalities, the arts and
sciences and Rome's contributions in law and the political process.
90/Mathematics/Computer Science
Mathematics
/Computer Science
Beverly Durkee (Chairperson), Benjamin Cooper, Lawrence Copes, Henry Follingstad, Leo Lake
Mathematics Major: 9 courses including 124,125,215,224,314,324.
Also required:
Computer Science245. The following courses do not count towards this major: 104,
174,121, 122, '131, 242. For teacher licensure in mathematics, courses 351, 373,441
must be included. Students wishing to become licensed teachers are advised to
ronsulr with the Education Department for requirements.
Mathematics Major with Computer Science Concentration: 10 courses, including
Mathematics 124, 125, 215, 224, 314, 355, Computer Science 245, 345, 350 and
Mathematics 226 or Computer Science 261.
Honors Major: GPA of 3.5 in mathematics and computer science, 3.1 overall.
Independent study at an advanced level with participation i n a department seminar.
Mathematics Minor: 5 courses, including 124,125, 224. The following courses do
not coun! towards the minor: 704,114,121,122,131,242. For a teaching minor, the
two additional courses must be selected from 215, 314, 351,373,441.
Computer Science Minor: 5 courses, including Computer Science 245,261,345,350
and one of Mathematics 355, Business Administration 479, Sociology 363, Computer
Science 395, 495.
Prerequisites/Placement Test - Before enrolling i n any course in this department
the student must have satisfied certain course and/or placement test prerequisites.
A course must be completed with a grade of 2.0or higher to count as a prerequisite.
The Placement Test i s given during col!ege orientation sessions and at other
announced times during the year. Score requirements on the rest for entrv to
courses are: ll {or course 104: [ l l for courses 114,171,122.131,242:lY for course724.
Siudents whose score is V, o r who have taken the College Board Advanced
Placement Euarn, should consult w i t h the department about appropriate courses to
take.
Any exceptions t o course or placement test score prerequisites must be approved by
the instructor.
Mathematics Courses
104 Basic Mathematics I I
A review of basic arithmetic concepts and a study of algebraic expressions including
exponents, radicals, and rational expressions; algebraic processes including factoring;
solving equations and inequalitiec in one variable, including linear and quadratic; and
graphs of linear and quadratic equations and linear inequalities in two variables. Does not
satisfy the general education requiremen1 in ma~hematics.(Spring)
114 College Algebra and Trigonometry
Fundamental operations, factoring, fractions, functions and graphs, linear equations,
exponents and radicals, quadratic equations, ratio and variation, progressions, binomial
theorem, logarithms and trigonometric functions. Students who have completed 124 may
register for credit only with consent of instructor. (Fall, Spring)
121 Finite Mathematics
Topics of linearity and probability with applications to the social and behavioral sciences.
(Fall)
122 Calculus for the Social and Behavioral Sciences
Differential and integral calculus of a single variable with applications to the social and
behavioral sciences. Students who have completed 124 may not register for credit. (Spring)
124, 125, 224 Calculus I, 11, 111
Topics of the elements of planeand solid analyticgeometry integrated with differential and
integral calculus including calculus of several variables and series with applications
primarily from the physical sciences. Primarily for students in the natural sciences. (124,
Fall; 125, Spring; 224, Fall)
131 Mathematics for the Arts
An introduction t o the structure of mathematical systems and mathematical modelswhich
have had a primary historical impact on the other liberal arts. Primarily for students not
intending,further study of mathematics. (Fall)
211 Number Theory
A transitional course from computational to abstract mathematics. A study of the integers
and their properties. (Prereq.: #)
215 Elementary Linear Algebra
A study of systems of linear equations, determinants,vector spaces, lineartransformations,
and matrices. (Prereq.: 224. Spring)
226 Differential Equations
Solutionsof ordinary differential equations with applications; solutions by special integral
transforms; systems of differential equations with matrix algebra techniques; series
solutions. (Prereq.: 224. Spring)
242 Basic Concepts of Mathematics
The structure of mathematics underlying arithmetic and geometry. Emphasis i s placed on
the inductive techniques of discovery. Includes the ideas of modern elementary school
mathematics curricula. (Prereq.: Admission to Elementary Education Program)
314 Abstract Algebra
A rigorous investigation of the basic structures of algebra including groups, rings, integral
domains and fields. (Prereq.: 215. Fall)
324, 325 Advanced Calculus I, I1
A study of the fundamental concepts of calculusforfunctions of several variables including
the topology of Euclidean spaces, transformations, sequences and series of functions.
improper integrals, differential formsand manifolds, and vector analysis. (Prereq.: 224.324.
Spring; 325, Fall)
351 Modern Geometry
A study of Euclidean and,non-Euclidean geometries by synthetic, coordinate, vector and
transformation methods with projective axioms as a basis. (Prereq.: 122or 125. Spring 1984
and alternate years)
92/Mathematics/Computer Science
355 Numerical Analysis (Formerly 361 or Computer Science 355)
A study of methods used to solve problems on computers. Analysis of computational
problems and development of algorithms for their solutions, applications of a procedureoriented programming language in numerical analysis. Topics include the general concept
of iterative formulae, solution of equations, Newton's method, linear systems, interpolation, numerical differentiation and integration. (Prereq.: 224, Computer Science 245)
373 Probability and Statistics
An analytic study of probability and statistics, including probability distributions and
densities, expectation, sampling distributions, central limit theorem, estimation, correlation and tests of hypotheses. (Prereq.: 224. Fall)
399 Internship
Consult Chairperson or lnternship Director to determine project.
441 Foundations of Mathematics
Set theory, logic, axiomatic method, and development of number systems. (Prereq.: 314,
324, concurrent registration, or #. Spring, 1983 and alternate years)
481 Topics in Mathematics
Study of advanced topics selected from real or complex analysis, abstract algebra,
topology, probability, statistics, or computer science. (Prereq.: 314, 324, or #. Spring)
499 Independent Study
Topics defined through consultation between student and department.
Computer Science Courses
145 lntroduction to General Computer Programming
An introduction to computer methods including flowcharts, algorithms, and data
representation. Extensive programming in a general higher level language. Primarily for
students in non-science areas. Does not count toward a computer science minor.
245 An Introduction to Computer Science
An introduction to computer languages and methods. Techniques studied include
flowcharts, algorithms, data representation and manipulation, hardware register operations, and computer organization. Programming i s done in machine language, assembly
language, and a higher level language such as PASCAL. (Prereq.: Mathematics 125)
261 Electronics
(See under Department of Physics)
345 Computer Systems
Survey of computers, languages, systems, and applications. lntroduction to operating
systems, including batch, time-sharing, and real-time. Continued development of
competence in structured programming, algorithms, and assembly language will be
emphasized throughout the course. (Prereq.: 245)
350 Data Structures and File Processing
Concepts and algorithms used in the solution of non-numerical problems. Applications to
data management systems, file organization, information retrieval, list processing, programming languages, and storage devices. (Prereq.: 245)
Medical Technology, Metro-Urban/93
395 and 495 Topics in Computer Science
Specifictopics are selected each year. Prerequisites will depend o n the topics selected. 395
for Interim, 495 for fall and/or spring terms.
399 lnternship
Consult Chairperson or lnternship Director t o determine project.
499 Independent Study
Topics defined through consultation between student and department.
Medical Technology
Neal 0. Thorpe (Adviser)
This major involves the completion of three years of academic work at Augsburg
College and twelve months of internship at Metropolitan Medical Center or
Abbott-Northwestern Hospital.
Specific recommended courses vary to some extent depending on the hospital with
which the student plans to affiliate. I t i s important to work closely with the Medical
Technology adviser. Augsburg College does not guarantee that all students will be
accepted by the hospitals for the 12-month internship. Students must negotiate
directly with the hospitals involved.
Student5 rransferring to Augsbur College with an Associate of Arts degree or its
equivalenr should expect to s en two vears a t Augsburq before participating in the
internship year. The MedicaPTcchnologv major I S nor derignrd for persons who
already have the baccalaureate degree from another ~nstitution.
f
Required Science Courses: 1) Biology 111, 112 and two additional upper division
(usually 367and476); 2) Chemistry: 105,106 (or 115,116),351,352,353; 3) Physics: 103
(or 121, 122); one math course; one course in immunology.
Metro-Urban Studies
Carry W. Hesser (Director)
Major: 15 courses includinglOcore requirements: Economicsl23; Political Science
122; History 431; Sociology 111, 381; Economics 379 or Sociology 362; Political
Science 384 or Sociology 363; a minimum of one course of internship or
independent study; two non-social science courses with an urban emphasis, at least
one of which must be in the humanities (current options include: Art 102, Religion
354, English 351, Speech 342, Physics 111, Biology 105, Philosophy 362, Interdisciplinary Studies 233, 260).
To complete the major, the student has a choice among three emphases or tracks:
GeneraVLiberal Arts, Planning or Public Administration. These five elective courses
must include a minimum of three disciplines. Options include a wide variety of
courses, interims, internships, independent studies, and urban courses at other
ACTC colleges, as well as those offered through the Higher Education Consortium
for Urban Affairs (HECUA).
94/Metro-Urban Studies
Minor: To be linked with appropriate majors (such as business administration,
history, political science, psychology, religion, sociology, speech). Core courses are
required for the concentration: Economics 120 or 123; Political Science 122;
Sociology 111, 381; an approved Social Science Research course; an approved
internship and/or independent study.
199 lnternship
Lower Division internship. Consult Program Director to determine project. (Fall, Interim,
Spring and Summer)
299 Directed Study
lndependent study for lower division students (Prereq.: # and Sociology 111 or 121. Fall,
Spring, Summer)
399 lnternship
Consult the Program Director for details. (Prereq.: #. Fall, Interim, Spring)
498 lndependent Study - Metropolitan Resources
An independently designed course a student (or group of students) develops, making
extensive, systematic and integrated utilization of resources available in the metropolitan
community, e.g. lectures,symposia, performances, hearings. These resources become the
core of the course, supplemented by traditional college resources. The course is designed
in consultation with and evaluated by a department faculty member. (Prereq.: Sociology
111 or 121 and #. Fall, Spring, Summer)
499 lndependent Study
Student must present written proposal containing rationale, objectives and methodology
of the proposed study according to department guidelines. (Prereq.: Sociology 111 or 121
and #. Fall, Interim, Spring)
Urban Studies Options Through HECUA
A. Metro-Urban Studies Term (MUST)
This program focuses upon the Twin City metropolitan area.
358 Readings Seminar: Urban Issues
Reading materials are assigned to complement morning field seminar topics. Included are
government and institution publications, journal articles and books.
359 Field Seminar: Twin Cities Metropolitan Area
Using the community as a classroom, students visit agencies, talk with specialists in various
fields, and investigate current issues in the Twin Cities area. Topics include: geography,
government, economics, historic preservation, populations, ethnic communities; transportation, planning and social services.
399 lnternship
Students are placed in a variety of public and private agencies for work experience. A
learning contract i s developed with MUST faculty approval. Students may choose an
internship of one or two courses.
Metro-Urban Studies/95
B. Scandinavian Urban Studies Term (SUST)
This p r o g r a m is located at t h e University o f Oslo a n d focuses u p o n Scandinavian
urbanization and city planning.
272 Norwegian Life and Culture
Language instruction emphasizes conversational vocabulary to support student course
work and daily living in Oslo. An orientation to current issues in Norwegian life and society
i s coordinated with the language instruction.
372 Norwegian Language and Culture
Students are placed in intermediate or advanced study depending on proficiency. An
orientation to current issues in Norwegian life and society is coordinated with the language
instruction.
373 Growth and Development of Scandinavian Cities
Themes on the growth, function, distribution, and social organization of Scandinavian
cities are approached through a combination of lectures, guest speakers, and field work.
Emphasis i s placed on Norwegian urban development with comparative analysis of other
Scandinavian countries.
396 Urban Planning in Scandinavia
Theory and practice of Scandinavian approaches to urban development are viewed
through a series of topical lectures, field trips, and guest speakers. Course focus i s on the
Norwegian planning system with comparative analysis of other Scandinavian countries.
499 lndependent Study
In consultation with SUST faculty, student selects a specific topic for library and field
research related to subjects of seminar and/or major academic interests.
C. South American Urban Semester (SAUS)
This "semester i n t h e city" p r o g r a m is located i n Bogota, Columbia. I t focuses u p o n
urbanization a n d development i n t h e Third World.
261 Spanish Language
Spanish instruction at intermediate or advanced levels.
362 Proseminar: Urbanization in Latin America
Readings, discussions, and lectures in both English and Spanish, with aid of SAUS staff and
visiting Columbian urbanists.
363 Field Seminar: Wealth, Poverty, and Community Development in the Latin American City
Structured field course focusing on plight and prospects of the urban poor in Bogota, with
field trips to other Colombian and foreign cities for comparison. Visits to various types of
barrios and t o public and private agencies dealing with urban problems.
499 lndependent Study
In consultation with SAUS faculty, student elects a specific topic for library and/or field
research related to subjects of seminar and/or major academic interests.
D. San Francisco Summer Term
A nine-week program integrating a field seminar, an internship, and independent
'study.
383 Field Seminar: San Francisco
(See MUST 359)
399 Internship
(See MUST 399)
499 Independent Study
(See SUST 499)
Music
L. t. Fleming (Chairperson), Robert Adne Robert E, Beverlev,Michael Brand. haine
Bryce,Siephen Cabrielien, Thomas G ~ h e g , Cymhia G o e f i , James D. lohnron,
Robert Karl&, MeriTee Klemp, Nicholas Cenz, Paul Lohman. Cynrhia Melson,
Robert Metzler, Celeste O'Brien. Alice Preves. Dana Skoglund, Emma Small, George
S~ahl,Daniel Sturrn, James ten RenseT. Paul Thomas, D a ~ l Tubergen,
d
Mary Wilson,
Angela Wyatt
See Music Department Handbook for additional and explanatory information
guidelines and requirements. Students wishing to major or minor in music must
apply to the department.
Specific Music Major Requirements
Bachelor of Arts: 12 courses: Core Curriculum plus 457,458,350 or 476,354 or 355,
365 or 375, music elective. French or German.
Bachelor of Arts (Music Education): 11 courses: Core Curriculum plus 457,458,350
or 476, 354 and one of 355, 365, 375. Consult with Department of Education for
requirements in education.
Bachelor of Music: 17 courses: Core Curriculum plus 350,457,458,476,499,354 or
355,365 or 375, music electives. 4 years of Performance Studies with double periods
in the last? years,and junior and senior recitals; French or German. Voicestudy - 2
years of foreign language.
Bachelor of Science - Music Therapy: 17 courses: Core Curriculum plus 354, 360,
382,383,395,399,435,457,495,350 or 476, one of 355,365,375, and 110 Introduction
to MusicTherapy (lnterimj.5 anish i s recommended. Other requirements: Biology
703, Education 282: 2 Physica Education (232 and 373 recommended); 3 Psychology
and I Sociology, including Psychology 105,362 and Psychology 263 or Sociology 362
(Recommended courses include Psychology 264, 351. 352, 355, 356, 357, and
5ocioIogy 111,121, 231. 241, 362,375); 1 Speech (116 recommended).
P
Music Minor: 5 courses: 101, 102,260 or 261,457 or 458, elective. Applied Music:
Major Ensemble 2 consecutive years, Performance Studies 4 semesters, concurrent
with Ensemble; Examinations: 2 Music Repertoire Tests, Piano Proficiency Test.
Honors Major: Students may qualify f o r graduation honors if they have earned a
GPA o f at least 3.0 i n music courses a n d have demonstrated leadership i n
performance. H o n o r s may b e achieved by o n e o f t h e following: Senior thesis a n d its
defense b e f o r e a faculty committee; presentation o f an additional senior recital o f
graduate quality; c o m p o s i t i o n o f a w o r k f o r vocal a n d / o r instrumental ensemble o f
n o t less t h a n 15 minutes duration. Application should b e made b e f o r e t h e senior
year.
Core Curriculum (Required of all Majors)
1. Courses: 101,102, 223, 224, 260, 261.
2. Applied Music: M a j o r Ensemble, 8 semesters; Performance Studies, 8 semesters;
Recital appearance.
3. Examinations: 3 M u s i c Repertoire Tests, Piano Proficiency Test.
Applied Music
Ensembles: M e m b e r s h i p i s d e t e r m i n e d by a u d i t i o n d u r i n g t h e first week o f t h e fall
semester. Times a n d locations are posted o n t h e d e p a r t m e n t bulletin board. These
organizations exist n o t o n l y f o r t h e benefit o f t h e musicstudent, b u t f o r any student
w h o wishes t o participate:
Augsburg Choir
Chorale
Concert Band
Orchestra
Brass Ensemble
String Ensemble
Jazz Ensemble
Woodwind Ensembles
Performance Studies: Four synergistic elements are required: lessons, jury examinations, performance and listening.
Private Lessons: Vocal and instrumental instruction i s available to all students in any area.
Music students must register on the traditional grading system and take a jury exam at the
end of each semester to fulfill the requirement of private study toward a music degree.
Other students may register for private lessons in the same manner or use P/N grading.
During the junior and senior year, a student accepted by the Department of Music as a
major receives lessons in the area of concentration without extra cost. Instruments are
available for rent.
JuryExamination: All studentstaking private lessonsfor credit are required to perform each
semester for a faculty jury.
Performance Workshop: An informal setting for student performances,seminars and guest
lecture demonstrations. All students studying applied music for credit must attend weekly
workshops and, once a semester, perform on their instrument.
Listening: All students studying applied music for credit must attend a predetermined
number of designated music events each year.
Recital: One-half recital i s r e q u i r e d o f B.A. a n d B.S. candidates. B.M. students must
present f u l l j u n i o r a n d senior recitals.
Examinations
A l l music majors and minors are required t o pass a Piano Proficiency Test. M u s i c
majors must pass t h r e e M u s i c Repertoire Tests, a n d Music minors must pass two.
101,102,223, 224 Theory
Music Theory i s an integrated course extending over four terms. Taught by a team of
instructors, the various aspects of musical theory (i.e., ear training, harmony, counterpoint,
and analysis) are presented in parallel, rather than in sequence. (101, 223, Fall. 102, 224,
Spring)
110 lntroduction to Music Therapy
A survey of the music therapy programs i n the surrounding area, with field trips t o various
institutions; an introductory course for the freshmen and sophomores considering music
therapy as a major; gives the students a broad background in the ways i n which music i s
used as a therapy. (Interim)
230 Introduction to the Fine Arts
The development of music through the study of selected works of great composers f r o m
each period. Emphasis is placed upon relationships between music and the other fine arts.
For the non-music major. (Fall)
260 History and Literature of Music
Music of the Baroque and Classical eras. (Fall)
261 History and Literature of Music
Music of the Romantic and M o d e r n eras, and non-Western topics. (Spring)
325 Scandinavian Music
I n a historical approach t o the study of music i n the five Nordic countries, opportunity is
offered for investigation into topics of particular interest. Suitable for both non-musicand
music majors. (Fall)
330 Vocal Repertoire
A historical survey of solo vocal literature from 1600 t o the present. The study includessuch
aspects of concern for the performer as interpretation, style, and diction. (Spring)
331 Diction for Singers
(Spring, alternate years)
350 Choral Technique and Arranging
Fundamentals of voice as related t o choral ensemble; methods, materials, techniques and
arranging for various combinations of voices and instruments. (Spring)
354 lnstrumental Technique
The technique of playing and teaching brass and percussion instruments. (Fall)
355 Instrumental Technique
The technique of playing and teaching woodwind instruments. (Spring)
360 Therapeutic Recreational Music
Study of guitar and recorder, Orff instruments, applications of recreational musicactivities
t o clinical settings. Practicum/experience required as part of course work.
365 Instrumental Technique
Elementary technique i n the playing and teaching of string instruments. (Fall)
375 lnstrumental Technique
Advanced technique i n the playing and teaching of string instruments. (Spring)
380 Music of the Western Church
Development and influence of the music of the Christian church. Designed for thegeneral
student as well as for organists, choir directors, and pre-theological students. (Spring)
382 Psychological Foundations of Music I
An objective approach to musical stimuli and response, with an emphasis on the sociopsychological aspects of music. An understanding of the research process and development of an experimental research project.
383 Psychological Foundations of Music I1
Implementation of group and individual research projects, emphasis on music in a clinical
setting. Varioustheories of learning music, musical talent, and performance. (Prereq.: 382)
395 Influence of Music on Behavior
A study of human behavior as it relatesto music, with emphasis on psychological, cultural,
and biological aspects of musical behavior. Use of music with the mentally retarded and
emotionally ill.
399 Music Therapy Clinical Internship
Full-time placement i n an internship setting approved by the National Association for
Music Therapy for six months. This i s started after completion of the senior year and i s
necessary for registration by the NAMT. Applications for internship sites must be made
nine months in advance. Sites in Minnesota are limited.
435 Music in Therapy
Thestudy and application of the uses of music with the emotionally ill, mentally retarded,
physically handicapped, geriatric, and gifted populations. (Prereq.: 395)
440 New Music Seminar
Offers an opportunity to apply information and techniques acquired in music theory and
history classes to the study of 20th century music. (Prereq.: 224. Spring)
457 Conducting
Techniques of conducting, preparation of and conducting choral scores, organization of
choral ensembles. (Fall)
458 Conducting
Preparation of and conducting instrumental scores, organization of instrumental
ensembles. (Spring)
476 Orchestration
The craft of orchestrating and arranging music for instrumental ensemblesof varyingsizes
and types. (Fall)
488,489 Piano Teaching Methods
Instruction in the principles, methods, and techniques for teaching piano. Students will
give individual lessons to children under the supervision of the instructor. No course
credit.
495 Practicum in Music Therapy
Volunteer work i n a clinical setting, two hours a week, six terms. N o credit.
499 Independent Study
Permits advanced and specialized studies and projects not otherwise provided for i n the
departmental curriculum. Open only t o advanced students upon approval of the f_aculty.
100/NaturaI Science
Natural Science
Earl R. Alton (Coordinator)
Major for Pre-Medical Students: 14 courses including Biology 111,112,491 or 492,
and t w o upper division courses; Chemistry 115, 116 (or 105, lob), 351, 352, and
Quantitative Analytical Chemistry; Mathematics 121 and 122 or 124and 125; Physics
121,122.
This major i s presented as an option for pre-medical students who wish t o take a
major which provides the science courses necessary and recommended for
admission t o most medical schools, including the University of Minnesota Medical
School, and also permits a number of electives. The student should choose electives
carefully, keeping i n mind the specificrequirementsof the medical schools t o which
he o r she intends t o apply. Early consultation with a premedical adviser i s
recommended.
Licensure Program for Teachers: The Minnesota Board of Teaching has approved
t h e Ifcensure program for science teachers and authorized A u ~ s b u r gto recommend
candidates in Life Science, grades 7-12; Life Science (minor), grades 7-12; Physical
Science, Chemistry major or Physics major, grades 7-12; Chemrstry (rninorl. grades
7-12; Physics (minor), grades 7-12; and Science (Grades 5-9).
All Natural Science teaching majors must complete the Broad Basic courses and i n
addition meet the requirements for a Life Science, Physical Science or Middle
School Emphasis.
The program of courses IS designed t o provide a broad, basic background in science
and allow for sp~cializationi n an area. The following programs assume t h a t the
student wil[ mee? the general education requirements of the college and, in the
physical science, have at least one year of calculus. ConsuTt with the Department of
Education for requirements i n Education. Early consultation with adviser i s
recommended.
Broad Base Courses: 7 courses, Ii n Earth Science (Physics 101 or 161); 2 i n Life
Science (Biology Ill,
112); 4 i n Physical Science (Physics 121,122 and Chemistry 115,
116 or (105,106). To make the program slightly more flexible, i t i s recommended that
students with emphasis i n life science have both courses i n earth science and
substitute Physics 103 for Physics 121,122.
Life Science Emphasis: 8 courses, 1 Cognate; 7 Biology courses, including 491
Seminar and at least one from each of the following groups: (1) 351 or 353; (11) 355 or
474; (111) 361 or 481; (IV) 471 or 473; (V) 440 or 476.
Physical Science Emphasis - Chemistry Major: 7 courses and chemistry seminar,
Chemistry 351,352,353,361 and 362 (or Biology 367, Biochemistry), 482, Physics 245.
Physical Science Em hasis - Physics Major: 7 courses, Physics 245,351,362,395 and
three additional t o e! selected from Physics 261, 270, 352, 363,481, 486, 488.
Note: Candidates may be recommended for licensure i n Physical Science upon
completion of either Physical Science Emphasis-Chemistry major or Physical Science
Emphasis - Physics major. The student licensed i n Physical Science may teach
chemistry and/or physics i n grades 7-12.
Science(Grades.5-9): 7 courses,2 in Earth Science (Physics 101 or 161, the alternative
course not taken in the Board Base section); 2 i n Life Science (and two biology
courses above 112); 3 in Physical Science (Chemistry 353; Physics 245).
Licensure with Minor: For Life Science, 7 courses in Biology plus the Broad Base; for
Chemistry, 351,352,353,361 and 362 or 482 plus the Broad Base; for Physics, any four
courses above 122 plus the Broad Base.
Nursing
Beverly Nilsson (Chairperson), Carol Hoffman, Nancy Malcolm, JoEtta A. Vernon,
Helen Woelfel
Augsburg offers an upper division major in nursing leadingto a Bachelor of Science
degree. The program is accredited by the National League for Nursing. Graduates of
the program are eligible to apply for Public Health Nurse Certification in Minnesota.
Requirements for admission to the major are: completion of an associate degree or
d ~ p l o m aprogram in nursing with a minimum overall grade point average of 2.5; a
currenr license to practice as an R.N. in the state of Minnesota; and completion of
courses in inorganic chemistry, organic or biochemistry, anatomy and physiology,
rnicrcrbiolagy, English composition, introductory sociology and introductory
psychology. Studenrs must take these courses a t Augsburg or another accredited
college or univerritv prios to admission to the nursing major. The prerequisite
courses i n sociology, psychology, English, chemistry and biology listed above may
apply toward distribution requirements as well as toward admission ro the major.
I n addition, each applicant must successfully complete theoretical and simulated
clinical performance testing prior to acceptance to the major. These tests are given
at Augsburg through the Department of Nursing.
Applicants must give evidence of current nursing clinical practice, within the past
five years. This may include 1) graduation from a school of nursing, 2 ) work
experience, or 3) completion of a nursing refresher course or an acceptable
equivalent.
Major: 11 courses (10 course credits) i n nursing including 303,304,310,311,325,330,
350, 403, 404, 423, 427: Psychology 355. ,4 minimum grade of 2.0 i n each nursing
course and a cumulative CP.4 of 2.5 a t the completion of the courses of study are
required. Courses i n interpersonal communications and ethics are supportive to
the major.
Course5 inrhe nursing major aredesignedso that they may becorn leted within two
academ~cyears. However. more than two years may be require to complete t h e
total course of study, depending on rhe number of credits transferred from other
colleges or universities. Students in nursing may pursue part-time nudv, but are
required 10 complete 13 courses, a t Augsburg College. Students inrerested i n
pursuing day, evening, or summer part-time study should consult with an adviser
from rhe nursing depastment for program planning.
8
303 Contemporary Nursing 1 (1/2 course)
This course i s one of the transitional courses that introduces the student to components of
the professional role and begins the professional and socialization process. The communication process i s emphasized as one means by which the nurse-client relationship is
established and maintained. Interactive communication theories are explored for their
applicability to changing roles and professional practice. (Fall-Junioryear.)
304 Contemporary Nursing 11 (1/2 course)
This course introduces theories and conceptual thinking in the process of professional
development. The function of theory in guiding nursing practice i n emphasized. Selected
nursing theories are examined. (Spring-Junioryear.)
310 Community Health Nursing I
This course focuses on systems theory, change, and concepts of health as they apply to
current community health issues and the practice of nursing. Clinical application of course
content will involve making a health assessment and exploring a community health issue.
(Fall-Junioryear. Prereq.: Acceptance into the nursing major)
311 Community Health Nursing II
This course provides a knowledge base for understanding community characteristics and
cultural diversity related to health care. The nurse's role as a generalist and as a member of
the health team i s explored. This course i s primarily a clinical course. The student will
demonstrate knowledge of community health concepts in providing care to a selected
caseload of clients. (Spring-Junioryear. Prereq.: 303, 310, 325, Psy 355)
325 Nursing Process
I n this course the student learns approaches to assessment and the use of assessment tools
i n the nursing process.Thestudent usescommunication skillstoobtain a health history and
negotiate health goals. Clinical experiences provide the student with an opportunity to
make a holistic health assessment within a developmental framework. (Fall-Junior year.
Prereq.: Acceptance into the nursing major).
330 Trends and Issues in Nursing
This course i s designed to investigate the current responsibilities of the professional nurse.
Contemporary social and professional trends and issues are explored in light of their
implications for nursing practice. (Interim-Junioryear).
350 Introduction to Nursing Research
The research process and methods appropriate to nursing are the focus of this course.
Issues of ethics in nursing research are explored. Students critique nursing research for its
applicability to nursing practice. (Spring-Junioryear. Prereq.: Acceptance into the nursing
major, Math 121 or a course i n descriptive statistics)
403 Contemporary Nursing 111
This course provides a theoretical basis for family nursingcare. Content includesfamily asa
group, family and group dynamics in light of situational and developmental events.
Consideration i s given to the emerging role of the nurse i n family health care. (Fall-Senior
year. Prereq.: 304, 311, 325, 330, 350. To be taken prior to or concurrently with 423)
404 Contemporary Nursing IV
This course relates leadership and management theories and emerging professional nurse
roles to primary nursing. Concepts of change, conflict, communication and system
dynamics are explored. Ethics, accountability and advocacy provide the basis for role
development and professionalism. (Spring-Senior year. Prereq.: 403. To be taken prior to
or concurrently with 427)
423 Practicum in Nursing I
This course i s a clinical practicum offering the student an opportunity to apply content
from 403 i n providing complex nursing care to families in a selected practice setting.
(Fall-Senior year. Prereq.: To be taken concurrently with or following 403')
427 Practicum in Nursing II
This course i s a synthesis course utilizing knowledge and skills from 404. Opportunity i s
provided to apply leadership and management theory in a selected hospital setting.
(Spring-Senior year. Prereq.: 403,423. To be taken concurrently with or following 404*)
499 Independent Study
This learning experience provides the opportunity for the student to study a selected topic
or issue i n depth. Students consult with faculty and submit written study proposals,
objectives, and methods of evaluation prior to registration.
*If the practicums i n nursing are not taken concurrently with their respective theory courses,
students are required to consult with faculty prior to registration regarding review of the
theoretical content.
Philosophy
Bruce Reichenbach (Chairperson), Kenneth Bailey, Mark Fuehrer
Major: 9 courses, including 130,241,242,343,344, and one course in the400's (other
than 499). Five of the courses must be upper division.
Minor: 5 courses, including t w o courses from 241,242,343,
and 344.
Honors Major: Admission to the Philosophy Honors. p r o ram is by recornmendation of the philosophy facuf~y.Suchrecommendations w i l l b e made st rheend of the
junior year. The program will consist of an honors thesis o n an approved topicof the
student's choice, involvin research above the cour5e level, and a defense of this
thesis before the faculty ofthe department.
Note: Courses 110, 120, and 130 are recommended for fulfilling the general
education requirement.
110 Introduction to Philosophy: Ideas and Method
Though each person has his own set of ideas and beliefs, rarely have they been critically
analyzed or evaluated for their consistency, adequacy or truth. One reason for this is that
individuals lack the needed skills. Another i s that they may have had little opportunity to
examine critically some of the ideas basic to western culture. The purposes of this course
are to provide the student with some experience i n examining ideas, and thereby to
sharpen the critical and analytical skills required to evaluate and construct a system of ideas
and beliefs.
120 Ethics
Sometimes you say that a certain action i s right or condemn it as wrong. Why do you think it
i s right? Because you like it? Are there better reasons for thinking something right or
wrong? This course takes a long, hard look at possible grounds for making moral decisions,
and at the moral judgments about personal and social issues resulting from them.
130 Logic
Suppose someone gives you reasons, and then says you must accept a particular
conclusion. Must you? When does a conclusion validly follow from premises? Here we
examine the rules which govern valid arguments and work to develop your ability to
recognize and construct sound arguments.
241 History of Philosophy I: Plato and Aristotle
How, when and why did philosophy begin? Who were Socrates, Plato, Aristotle and the
Stoics; what did they believe? Why did Plato think that the physical world was not overly
important, and what did he value? How did Aristotle, the scientist, respond to this? The
answers to these and other questions will be considered so as to reveal what these great
philosophers can contribute to our contemporary problems and ideas. (Fall)
242 History of Philosophy 11: Medieval and Renaissance Philosophy
The Middle Ages are often regarded as a period of darkness, whereas the Renaissancewasa
timeof rediscovery and enlightenment. How dark were the Middle Ages; how enlightened
the Renaissance?We shall attempt to discoverthe grandeur of the Medieval philosophers,
learn how the Christian tradition was carried forward in the Age of Faith, explore the
worship of the world and the individual in the Renaissance, and the new methodology of
the 17th Century rationalists. (Spring. Suggested prior course, 241.)
343 History of Philosophy Ill: Enlightenment and 19th Century Philosophy
Where does knowledge begin? In innate ideas or with experience? What can we really
know about the world? What impact did Romanticism have on philosophy? This course
studies the major empiricists of thelBth century (Locke, Berkeley, Hume). Kant's synthesis
of philosophy, 19th century idealism, and the reaction to idealism by men such as Marx,
Kierkegaard and Nietzsche. (Fall. Suggested prior course, 241 or 242.)
344 History of Philosophy IV: Contemporary Philosophy
What lies behind 20th century philosophy's love affair with language? Is truth that which
works? Can we remake philosophy as a rigorous science? These and other issues are dealt
with in a study of the major representatives of linguisticanalysis, pragmatism, existentialism,
and phenomenology. (Spring. Suggested prior course, 241,242, or 343.)
350 Philosophy of Religion
What i s the relation between faith and reason? Does God exist, and what can besaid about
him if he does? Can we reconcile the goodness of God with human and animal suffering? I s
man really immortal? Are miracles possible? We will conduct a systematic inquiry into
these questions which form the basis of religious beliefs. (Suggested: one prior course in
philosophy.)
355 Oriental Philosophy
A study of the basic concepts and philosophies which underlie Hinduism, Buddhism,
Confucianism and Taoism. (Suggested: one prior course in philosophy.)
362 Political Philosophy
As residents of an urban college we are citizens of the city. What i s the relation between the
citizen and the city? In a larger context, what i s the origin of the State and the basis for its
laws?What relation holds between law and morality, and between God, the Church and
the State?This course studies the key concepts of politics found in the tradition of western
political thought.
365 Philosophy of Science
The scientist's knowledge of the world i s purported to be profoundly different and better
than that of the non-scientist. Is this true?What constitutes scientific knowledge?Are there
certain real questions which science cannot answer? How certain are the methods used by
the scientist to recover knowledge? In addition to dealing with these questions, students
will work in researching and developing philosophical problems in the special sciences.
(Suggested prior course, 130 or one course i n natural science.)
370 Existentialism
Studies i n the writings - both philosophical and literary - of prominent Existentialist
authors. We will examine what i t means to be a being-in-the-world, and explore such
themes as absurdity,freedom, guilt, despair and paradox. (Suggested: One prior course in
philosophy)
380 Ethics of Medicine and Health Care
Application of ethical principles to problems which arise in the areas of health care and
delivery, human experimentation, human engineering, abortion, care for the dying and
euthanasia.
410 Topics in Philosophy
Advanced studies covering a specific area of philosophy, such as studies in the thought of
individual philosophers, philosophical movements, the history of an idea or specific
problem, or interdisciplinary problems. Seminar format. May betaken morethan once for
credit. (Suggested prior courses, any from.241,242, 343,344 or #.)
430 Studies in Individual Philosophers
Advanced studies i n the philosophy of particular philosophers,e.g., Plato, Descartes, Marx,
Hegel, Kierkegaard or Wittgenstein. Seminar format. (Suggested prior courses: 241,242,
343, or #)
499 Independent Study
Individual study and research on some philosophical topic of interest to the student,
worked out in consultation with the faculty adviser.
Physics
K e r m i t E. Paulson (Chairperson), Kenneth N. Erickson, M a r k J . Engebretson
a n d 395 plus t h r e e courses above
122. I n Planninglheir coursesof study, students are encouraged to work closely w i t h
members o f the physics faculty. Normally, students should have Mathematics 124,
125, a n d Physics 721, '122 the freshman year, a n d Mathematics 124 and 226 t h e
s o p h o m o r e year.
Major: 9 c o u r s e , i n c l u d i n g 121,122,245,351,362
Teaching Licensure Major: The same'as t h e major. Students are advised t o refer t o
t h e Education Department section o f t h e catalog a n d consult w i t h t h e Education
Department early i n t h e i r planning.
Minor: 5 courses, i n c l u d i n g 121,122, and t h r e e courses above 122.
Honors Major: A GPA o f 3.6 i n physics a n d 3.0 overall. A n independent invertigat i o n o f a physics t o p i c w i t h an oral defense o f t h e w r i t t e n research repbrt.
Application f o r t h e honors major should b e made n o later than rhe first t e r n of the
senior year.
Societ of Physics Students: The Augsburg chapter o f Society o f Physics Students
proviJes students t h e o p ortuniiiei of membership i n a national physics society a n d
o f participating i n t h e pl?ysio cornrnunily on a professional basis. M e m b e r s h i p i n
SPS is o p e n t o all students interested rn physics.
Sigma Pi Sigma: M e m b e r s h i p i n t h e Augsburg chapter o f this national physics
h o n o r society is o p e n t o those students w h o have c o m p l e t e d t h e equivalent o f a
m i n o r i n physics, have a G P A o f 3.0 i n physicsand overal1,and rank i n t h e u p p e r t h i r d
o f their class.
101 Astronomy
A descriptive course requiring elementary algebra. Our solar system, stars and galaxies.
The necessary optical instruments are explained and use i s made of a 12-inch reflecting
telescope, and eight-inch Celestron, and a 3-inch Questar. Occasional night viewing. (3
one-hour lectures.)
103 Physics for the Life Sciences
An introductory course in which the applications, problems, and experiments areselected
not only to illustrate fundamental principles, but also to demonstrate the relevance of
physics to the lifesciences. The course i s designed to serve students in biology, psychology,
physical education (therapy programs), medical technology and other health science
programs. The course i s also a very suitable elective or distribution requirement for the
liberal arts student. (3 one-hour lectures, 2-hour laboratory. Prereq.: Elem. algebra. Fall)
106 Introductory Meteorology
A study of thescience and wonders of the atmosphere. The course i s designed to provide a
working knowledge of the basic science principles required for understanding weather
and climate. Attention will be given to the overall weather patterns of the earth and to the
many varied aspects of weather, some of which include: Clouds and precipitation,
thunderstorms, tornadoes and hurricanes, weather monitoring and forecasting, the
influence of weather on pollution, fronts and cyclones, and optical phenomena of the sky.
The course i s designed to be an elective or to satisfy the distribution requirement for the
liberal arts student. (3 one-hour lectures. Prereq.: Elementary Algebra. Spring)
111 Physics, Computers, and Society
A study of the historical development of selected topics in physical science. Attention will
be given to the interaction of physics and its associated technology with philosophy,
religion, and culture. Study of mechanics, electricity, and digital electronics will lead up to
discussion of the meaning of twentieth century physics and of the role of elctronics and
computers in modern society. Microcomputers will be used extensively in the laboratory.
(3 one-hour lectures, 2-hour laboratory. Fall)
121,122 General Physics I, II
A rigorous study of classical physics including mechanics, wave motion, thermodynamics,
electrjcity, magnetism, and optics. Designed for physics majors, pre-engineering students
and other specified majors. Must be taken in sequence. (3 one-hour lectures, 3-hour
laboratory. Prereq.: Mathematics 124 or concurrent registration. 121, Fall; 122 Spring)
245 Modern Physics
An introduction to modern physics from a historical and experimental basis. Relativity,
quantum effects, atomicand molecular physics, nuclear and solid state physics. This course
indicates the need for, and develops the experimental basis of quantum mechanic. (3
one-hour lectures. Prereq.: 122. Fall)
261 Electronics
A review of AC and DC circuits and study of analog electronics comprises the first half o f
the semester. The second half includes study of digital electronics culminating in analysis
and use of microprocessors and microcomputer systems. (Prereq.: 103, 111 or 122; and
Mathematics 122 or 125)
270 Optical Physics
The emphasis is o n physical optics, making frequent use of the complex expression for a
wave: interference, diffraction, polarization, and an introduction t o the electromagnetic
theory. (3 one-hour lectures. Prereq.: 122. O n demand)
351,352 Mechanics I, II
A careful study of classical mechanics i n terms of Newton's laws of motion and the
Lagrangian and Hamiltonian formalisms. Topics include conservation principles, single
par~irle
motion,svsrernsof particles, oscillatory systems, central-force motion, dynamics of
rigid hndie5, gravttation. kinematics of two-particle systems and noninertial reference
frames. (3 one-hour lectures. Prereq.: 122, Math. 226. 351, Fall; 352 Spring)
362, 363 Electromagnetic Fields I, II
The clasrical electrornagnet~c f ~ e l dtheory IS developed uslng the vector calculus
~ h r o u g h o u t .Eleclrostat~cs,magnetostatlcs, solut~onof Laplace's and Po~sson'sequations,
elecrrrr and magnetic properties of mater~als,and the theory of electromagnet~cr a d ~ a t ~ o n
bared on Maxwell's equatlons (3 one-hour lectures Prereq M a t h 226, 362, Fall, 363,
Sprlnp)
395 Comprehensive Laboratory
A n emphasis nn independent laboratory investigat~ons,including participation in physics
seminars. Experiments in the area of mechanics, thermodynamics, vacuum ph\,sic~.
electronics, ~ l e c t r i c i t v magnetism,
,
optics, and modern physirs. (2 three-hour laboraton:
and 1 seminar hour per week. Prereq.: Junior standing or consent of instructor. 5pring)
481 Thermal Physics
The study of properties of systems and processes for which temperature is an important
variable. The subject i s developed from iwo independent vet complementary viewpoints;
the experimental, macroscopicclassical thermodynamics and the theoretical, microscopic
statistical mechanics. (3 one-hour lectures. Pr~req.: 351. Spring)
486 Quantum Physics I
h development from f i n t principles, including de Brogl~e'spostulates, the Schroedinger
equation, operators, rvavefunctions, expectation values, angular momentum, and ap-
proximation methods. Spec~iicproblems studied include potential wells and potential
barriers. the harmonic oscIl[ator, and the hydrogen atom. (3 one-hour lectures. Prereq.:
245, 357,352 Fall)
488 Quantum Physics II
The application of quantum mechanics t o specific topics chosen from the areas of solid
state physics, atomic and molecular physics, nuclear physics, and particle physics. (3
one-hour lectures. Prereq.: 486. Spring)
499 Independent Study
A n opportunity for students t o explore systematically a problem i n experimental or
theoretical physics, worked out i n consultation with a faculty adviser. O p e n t o juniors and
seniors with departmental approval.
108/Political Science
Political Science
M i l d a H e d b l o m (Chairperson), N o r m a Noonan, Myles Stenshoel
Major: 9 courses, plus Statistical Analysis (Soc. 362). Required: 121 o r 122 o r 160 o r
170; 158; 384; and at least 5 o t h e r u p p e r division courses i n 4 o u t o f 5 Political Science
Areas. A seminar i n o n e o f t h e five areas may b e c o u n t e d f o r that area.
Minor: 5 courses, including: 121 o r 122 o r 170; 158; a n d at least 3 u p p e r division
courses i n 3 o u t o f 5 Political Science Areas.
Honors Major: The Honors M a j o r in Political Science includes the requirements
listed above, plus the following: The student's grade-point average must be 3.5 in
t h e major and 3.0overall. Thestudent r n u i r t a k e a n Honors Independent Study and a
seminar, and rnun submit, not later than March 1 of the senior vear. an Honors
Thesis to be defended before a faculty committee. Studenrs may w o r k with any
m e m b e r o i the Departmenr on their Honors Thesis. For specific r q u i r e m e n r s .
consult the De artmental Chairperson.Students shoukd apply for the H o n o r s ,Major
no later fhan e!t
f i r i t term o f f h e j u n i o r year.
Political Science Areas: (I) American G o v e r n m e n t and Politics (11) Comparative
Politics a n d Analysis ( I l l ) International Politics (IV) Public Law (V) Political Theory
a n d Analysis. A n y course listed i n m o r e t h a n o n e area may b e c o u n t e d i n o n l y o n e
area t o w a r d major o r m i n o r requirements.
Note: Students interested i n secondary education may take a political science
major i n c o m b i n a t i o n w i t h specified social science courses, i n compliance w i t h state
requirements. For m o r e information, see t h e department chairperson o r t h e Social
Studies Coordinator.
See t h e class schedule f o r precise listing o f terms i n w h i c h courses are offered.
I. American Government and Politics
121 American Government and Politics
The politics of American government including the forms of political ideas; the pattern of
participation; the dynamics of congressional, presidential and bureaucratic policymaking;
and current issues in American society.
122 Metropolitan Complex
Politics in the urban setting, including important issues, actors, and structures influencing
public policy in the modern urban complex. Discussion-lecture, simulation, and meetings
with political experts and activists.
325 Public Administration
The politics of public administration and bureaucratic policy-making i n the United States;
governmental regulation, promotion and management, emphasizing political and economic interaction. (Prereq.: 1 course in Political Science or #)
326 Political Parties and Behavior
The political behavior of the electorate emphasizing publicopinion and political parties in
the electoral process. Field work with political parties and interest groups and media i n
presidential elections (optional in non-presidential election years). (Prereq.: 1 course in
Political Science or #. Fall term of election years)
Political Science/lO9
342 Mass Communications in Society
Effects of mass communications on individual behavior; the uses and control of mass media
for political and social purposes including a study of censorship, newsmaking, entertainment and public affairs programming.
370 Constitutional Law I
(See Section IV for description. Offered alternate years)
371 Constitutional Law II
(See Section I V for description. Offered alternate years)
421 Topics in American Politics
Selected themes, including legislative, executive or judicial process, and policy process in
American politics; national, urban or state focus; topic to be included in subtitle. (Prereq.:
Two courses in Political Science or #. Offered on demand.)
11. Comparative Politics and Analysis
158 Political Patterns and Processes
An analysis of basic patterns i n the political system and decision-making process with some
comparison of major political systems and discussion of contemporary issues.
350 Comparative Democracies
The emergence, maintenance and decline of selected democracies, focusing on political
behavior, institutions, and processes. (Prereq.: One course in Political Science or #)
351 Communist Political Systems
A comparative analysis of thesoviet Union and other communist states in termsof political
behavior, institutions, processes and politics. (Prereq.: One course i n Political Science or
#.I
381 Democratic Theory and Practice
(See Section V for description)
459 Topics in Elite and Mass Behavior
In-depth study of the elite and/or mass participation i n the political system. (Offered on
demand. Prereq.: One course in Political Science or #).
Ill. International Politics
160 World Politics
Introduction to the processes and issues of international politics, including the dynamics of
the international system, theories of international relations, and a focus on recent
problems.
363 Communist Foreign Policies
Analysis of the motivation, formulation, and implementation of foreign policies of
Communist nations with emphasis upon the Soviet Union and China. (Prereq.: One course
i n Political Science or #)
461 Topics in International Politics
Selected themes including interpretations of international politics, foreign policy decision-making, simulations of international problems. Topic to be included i n subtitle.
(Prereq.: One course i n Political Science or #. Offered alternate years.)
llO/PoIiticaI Science
IV. Public Law
170 Law in the United States
A survey of American law and legal process. Theories of law; law and society; roles of
courts, police, lawyers, and juries; the United States Constitution as "supreme" law; law as
politics; historic and contemporary legal issues.
370 Constitutional Law I
The legal-political-philosophical role of the Supreme Court in the American political
system in significant decisions affecting the allocation of powers in the national
government and in the federal system. (Prereq.: 170 or #. Offered alternate years)
371 Constitutional Law II
Constitutional limitations of the Bill of Rights and of the Fourteenth Amendment as applied
by the Supreme Court to the protection of human rights and civil liberties of individuals.
(Prereq.: 170 or #. Offered alternate years)
V. Political Theory and Analysis
158 Political Patterns and Processes
(See Section I1 for description)
380 Western Political Thought
A study of influential political philosophers from Plato through Rawls, emphasizing the
values, goals, and assumptions which continue to inform and t o rationalize human
governance. (Prereq.: One course in Political Science or #.)
381 Democratic Theory and Practice
A study of democratic theory and public policy practice with focus on the emergence of
political democracy, capitalism and the welfare state in comparative perspective. (Prereq.:
One course in Political Science or #.)
382 Marxist Visions: Past, Present, and Future
Origins and evolution of Marxist theory and movements emphasizing Marxism as
developed i n Russia and China. Consideration of the political, social, and economic
dimensions of the theories, with some focus on the preferred futures envisaged i n the
doctrine. (Prereq.: 158 or #.)
384 Political Analysis
An analysis of different approaches and theories in the study of politics including an
examination of the requirements of science as a model for political study; major research
required. (Prereq.: Statistical Analysis; Political Science 158 and two upper division
courses, or #.)
Seminars, Independent Study and Internships
199 Internship
Lower division internship. Consult Internship Supervisor in the department to determine
project. (Fall, Interim, Spring.)
295 Lower Division Seminar
Special topics. Consult department chairperson concerning terms and subject matter.
(Offered on demand)
299 Directed Study
Independent study for lower division students. (Prereq.: #. Fall, Interim, Spring)
399 lnternship
Consult Chairperson or lnternship Director to determine project. (Prereq.: #. Fall, Interim,
Spring)
495 Seminar
Selected topics. Consult department chairperson concerning terms and subject matter.
(Prereq.: #.)
498 Independent Study: Metropolitan Resources
An independently designed course a student (or group of students) develops, making
extensive.~\sternaticand integrated utilization of resources available in the metropolitan
commwniry, e.g. lectures, symposia, performances, hearings. These resources become the
core of the course, supplemented by traditional college resources, and designed i n
consultation with and evaluated by a faculty member of the department. (Prereq.: #. Fall,
Interim, Spring)
499 Independent Study
Topics defined through consultation between instructor and student. (Prereq.: #. Fall,
Interim, Spring)
Psychology
Richard Marken, (Chairperson), Lyla Mae Anderegg, Grace Dyrud, Norman
Ferguson, Duane Johnson
Major: f 0 courses including 105,264,265,381 or 399, and 493, with a minimum of 5
courses at Augsburg; Physics 103. Nw mare than two courses from among299,399
and 499 may be counted toward the minimum 10 psychology courses required f o r a
major. This restricrion applies toward rhe minimum requirement only. The student
may actually take more such courses. The major program should include I05 in the
freshman year, 264 and 265 i n the freshman or saphomore year, 381 or 399 in t h e
junior year and 493 i n the senior year. The major program is planned in consultation
with an adviser i n the ps cholo6y department and is a proved by the department
chairperson. The a v e i a i plan i c d i r e c t e d toward a pasic understanding of the
discipline af psvchology and toward the particular educational, vocational and
professional goals of the individual student. A written plan forthe major should be
completed a n d approved by the beginning of the junior year. It i s recommended
rhal psychology majors rake additional course work from other areas that will
complement and strenpthen their particular interests in psychology; for example,
deiteloping a minor in business admintstration, biology, or communication is
recommended for many studen~s.
Minor: 5 courses including 105, with a minimum of 2 courses at Augsburg. Not more
than one course from 299,399, and 499 may be counted toward the minor.
Honors Major: GPA of 3.5 in the major and 3.0 overall, and completion of a high
quality research project culminating the major program. Application for honors
consideration must be made during the junior year. Please consult the department
chairperson for more detailed requirements.
Certificate In Program Evaluation: 5 courses includ~ng264 (orSociology 362). 399,
450: Sociology 362 and 363. These courses are designed to rovide back round and
skills to p e r f o r m as a research assistan7 for agencies or i r m s which CI program
evaluation or self-assessment programs. See department chairperson for f u r t f i ~ r
f
details.
105 General Psychology
An introduction to the methods and approaches used i n psychology for the purpose of
understanding behavior. The structure of the field of psychology, including its major
sub-areas, is emphasized.
251 Sensing and Perceiving
An ecologically oriented approach to the study of perceptual systems. Emphasis on the
processing of environmental information and how this relates to adaptive behavior and
subjective experience. Topics include: adaptation to novel environments, machine
intelligence, and anomalous perception such as illusions. (Prereq.: 105, Alternate years)
264, 265 Research Methods: Design, Procedure, and Analysis I, II
A two-term sequence including experimentation in human and animal learning, problem
solving, social psychology, and sensation-perception. Emphasis will be placed on both
statistical and experimental design methodology. Research Methods I may be taken for
credit without continuing i n Research Methods 11. Majors in psychology must take both
terms of the two-term sequence; 264 must precede 265; 265 should be taken in the term
immediately following 264. (Prereq.: 105)
299 Directed Study
Limited registration by special permission. Specific planning for the study must be
completed and approved well in advance of the time of registration.
351 Developmental Psychology: Child
Emphasis on normal child development and behavior. Consideration of theoretical
systems used for viewing the developmental sequence and process. Active inquiry into
practical implications and applications of data and theory in respectto the development of
children. (Prereq.: 105)
352 Developmental Psychology: Adolescent and Young Adult
Emphasis will be on normal development and behavior. Consideration of data and theory
related to development during the adolescent and adult periods of life. (Prereq.: 105. Fall,
1983)
353 Developmental Psychology: Middle Adult and Older Adult
Emphasis will be on normal development and behavior. Consideration of data and theory
related to development during the middle adult and older adult periods of life. Includes
perspectives on death and dying. (Prereq.: 105. Fall, 1983)
355 Brain & Behavior
A survey of the functions of the nervous system which are responsible for behavior in
animals and human beings. Major topics include: sleep & wakefulness, motivation &
emotion, learning & memory, and mental disorders. (Prereq.: 105 and one course i n
biology. Fall)
356 Environment and Behavior
A study of the influence which the environment, both natural and man-made, has on
behavior. Major topics include: overcrowding and environmental stress, territoriality,
defensible space & crime, and built environments such as rooms, buildings & cities.
(Prereq.: 105. Spring)
357 Learning
Learning concepts, behavior change principles and psychology of instruction. Behavior
change and individualized instruction projects. (Prereq.: 105)
359 Measurement
Theory and principles of measurement. Analysis and practicum with achievement, interest,
personality and intelligence tests. (Prereq.: 105)
361 Personality
An introduction to the field of personality study with special attention directed toward
personality theories and contemporary application of those theories. (Prereq.: 105. Fall)
362 Abnormal Psychology
An introduction to maladaptive human behaviors from the social, organic and psychological points of view. Visitation to a variety of community serviceagencies will accompany
classroom learning. (Prereq.: 105. Spring)
371 Psychology of the Individual: Female and Male
A study involving knowledge of materials bearing on the development of sex differences
and roles, the effect of society upon values and goals, differential legal status of each sex
and psychophysiological data bearing upon these differences. (Prereq.: 105 or #)
373 Organizational Psychology
Theoretical conceptualizations of organizational behavior. Factors and practices such as
management styles, evaluation and maintenance of work effectiveness, and social
influences. An organizational field experience. (Prereq.: 105)
375 Social Psychology
See under Department of Sociology.
381 Psychology in Historical Perspective
Historical development of psychological viewpoints and theoretical positions. (Prereq.:
two psychology courses. Alternate years)
399 Internship
Interested students should consult with the departmental internship coordinator regarding requirements and permission to register.
450 Program Evaluation
The application of scientific research techniques and statistical analysis to programs for
social improvement. Designing information systems for the ongoing monitoring of
programs. Assessing community needs. Assessing program effectiveness and efficiency.
The political and organizational context of program monitoring and evaluation.The role of
evaluation research for social policy and program improvement. (Prereq.: 264orSociology
362; Sociology 363)
485 Counseling Psychology
Principles, methods, and attitudes involved in the counseling process. Consideration given
to goals and ethical guidelinesfor a counseling relationship. (Prereq.: 5 courses and senior
standing. Spring)
490 Current Topics in Psychology
Study of selected areas and topics in psychology that are not treated extensively through
current course offerings. Specific topics will be published prior to registration. (Prereq.:
105 and #. Alternate years)
493 Seminar: Contemporary Issues
Discussion of contemporary societal issues from a psychological viewpoint. Consideration
of the approaches and methods used by psychologists in studying such issues. (Prereq.: 5
courses)
499 Independent Study
Limited registration by special permission for advanced students in psychology. Students
must present a written plan prior to registration including carefully considered rationale
and purpose for the proposed study.
Religion
Philip Quanbeck (Chairperson), John Benson, Bradley Holt, Richard Husfloen,
Eugene M. Skibbe, Paul Sonnack, Bruce Stuart, Sheldon Torgerson, Daniel Zemel
Major: 8 courses, including 111, 221, 356, 4 8 7 and 495. the seminar especially for
majors, taken in the junior or senior year. Before takrng seminar, each major must
have written one formal research paper and placed I1on file with the department
chairperson. Only one interim course may be applied to the major. One upper
division New Testament Greek course may be applied to the major.
Major in Church Staff Work: 9 courses, including 111,221,356,362,399,481,354 or
358, 360 or 483, 471 or 473. These together with specified courses in other
departments can lead to Augsburg certification.
Program tor Christian D a y Schoof Teachers: Students pursue one of he regular
teacher education programs i n the Department of Education to prepare for
licemure by the Stare of Minnesota. In addit~onto the licensure program, five
courses i n religion a r e required: 771.221. 362, The Christian Day School (Interim)
and The Lutheran Heritage (Interim). Student Teaching experience is required in
both a public school setting and in a Christian D a y School.
This program prepares students who are interested in teaching i n Christian Day
Schools, particularly those of the American Lutheran Church, although participation
i s not limited to such schools.
Minor: 5 courses. Not more than one interim course may be counted for the minor.
Honors Major: GPA of 3.3 in the major and 3.0 over-all; research project approved
by the department and colloquium with the department.
Certificate in Church Staff Work: 9 Religion courses (II1,22'1,356,362,48f, 359 or
358,360 or 483.471 or474,3991; Psychology 105,351,352or 371,485, Sociology 111or
Psychology 373, Sociology 231 1; Physical Education 232; Speech 354 or 355,499.This
program meets or exceeds rhe educational requirements of The American Lutheran
Church, bur certification b the church i s a separate function. By addingrwo or three
courses from appropriate epartments, thestudent can develop special emphases in
parish education. busines management or diaconal work.
d
Notes: Religion 111 or221 is prerequisite to all other courses. Department approval
i s necessary before courses taken in other colleges can be accepted for Religion
Department and/or general education course credit.
All majors are urged to consult with the department chair.
111 Introduction to Theology
An introduction to the academic discipline of theology and to the dialogue between the
church and the world which concerns Christian doctrine.
221 Biblical Studies
The origin, literary character, and transmission of the biblical documents. The task of
biblical interpretation. The history of Israel and the emergence of the church.
350 Philosophy of Religion
(See under Department of Philosophy)
353 Denominations and Sects in America
A study of the beliefs and worship practices of the major denominations and sects. Some
contemporary cultic movements will also be considered. (Spring)
354 Life of the Church in the Life of the City
The Gospel and various forms of ministry evident i n urban structures.
356 History of Religions
An introductory survey of some of the major living religions of the world, including
Hinduism, Buddhism, Confucianism, Taoism, Shinto, and Islam. Lectures plus some
discussion of primary documents from these religious communities. (Fall)
357 Survey of Church History
A survey of Christian history i n the early, medieval, Reformation, and modern periods.
Some attention will be given to primary sources, in addition to interpretations of the
periods i n question.The expansion of the church, its inner life, its relation to the state, and
the development of its doctrine will be major elements of the study.
358 Life and Work of the Church
Congregational life i n its varied character with attention directed to Christian education
and curriculum, youth work and parish work.
360 Religion and Society
An examination of the interaction of religion and society i n terms of sociological analysis
with particular emphasis on contemporary sociological research on religious movements
i n American society. (Spring)
361 Church Fathers
A stucky o f ~ h early
e
Christian Church in the context of the Roman Empire, including such
ropics as persecution and martyrdom, the deveIopment of the creeds. Christianity in
conllict with GnoSticlsm and mystery religions, monasticism and mysticism, early Christian
worship: also includingthe rhealogy of several earlv Christian leadersand a special unit on
the life and thought of Augus~ine.(Spring 1983)
362 Theology of the Reformers
An introduction to the theological thought of the Protestant reformers of the sixteenth
century. Special attention to the writings of Martin Luther and other representative figures.
(Fall)
363 Religion in America
A study of the development of religion in America. Special attention to the rise of religious
liberty, revivalism, denominations and the responses of religion to the challenges of its
environing culture. (Fall)
364 Scandinavian Immigrant Church History
Topics and themes related to church history and Scandinavian immigration to this country.
(Offered as funding permits)
380 Music of the Western Church
(See under Department of Music)
399 Internship
Limited to students who have completed at least four academic courses, have at least first
semester Junior standing, and satisfy department guidelines.
471 Jesusand His Interpreters
Consideration of the New Testament documents, particularly the Gospels, dealing with
their context, literary structure and relationships. Attention to the variety of interpretations
given the person of Jesus, including the "quest for the historical Jesus." (Fall)
472 Theology of Paul
A study of the Apostle Paul including his historical background, his relationship tothe early
church, and some of the themes to be found in his writings. (Spring, 1984)
473 The Message of the Old Testament
The various types of Old Testament literature. The distinctive ideas of Hebrew thought with
emphasis on the message of the prophets. (Spring 1983)
475 Judaism
A survcv of the history of Judaism from the end of the O l d Testament period to modern
tlrnes, with emphasis placed upon the reJigious development. A special interest i n such
modern Jewish thinkers as Buber and Heschel. The lewirh Chatauqua Society annually
makes a grant to kugsburg College in partial support of this course in Judaism offered i n
the religion department. (Fall)
481 Contemporary Theology
An introduction to some representative trends i n Christian theological thought today, as
seen from the systematic perspective, i n the light of the continuing theological task of the
Christian Church. (Spring)
482 Contemporary Roman Catholic Theology
New trends of Roman Catholic theology as expressed in the writings of some of its
representatives. Relation of new theological and biblical insights to the dogmatic
definitions of the church.
483 Christian Ethics
The bases of Christian social responsibility, in terms of theological and sociological
dynamics. Emphasis on developing a constructive perspective for critical reflection upon
moral action. (Fall)
486 Psychology of Religion and Theology
A study of current psychological views of religion i n thecontext of the tradilional Christian
view of human nature. Special attention will be given to the dassia in the field by Freud,
Jung, and William James, and to those Christian theologians who have been influenced by
them. (Spring 1984)
495 Seminar
Selected topics. Required of majors in the junior or senior year. Others by permission of
instructor. (Fall)
499 Independent Study
Limited to students who are religion majors and satisfy departmental guidelines.
Russian, Scandinavian Studies/II7
Russian Area Studies
Norma C. Noonan (Campus Coordinator)
The major in Russian Area Studies is a cooperative program of the Associated
Colleges of the Twin Cities (ACTC). It seeks to give the studenr the broadest possible
expowre to Russian and Soviet life, history, politics, literature, tradition, and
philosophy. In addition ro providing a good liberal education, the program can
enable students to prepare for graduate study, or careers i n areas such as
governmenz. international business, or teaching.
Major: 11 courses: 4 courses (2 years) of basic college Russian (or equivalent
competencies); 2 courses in Russian history; 1 course in Marxist theory; 1 course in
Russian literature; 1 course in Soviet politics; 2 other courses of approved
electives.
Minor: 6 courses: 2 courses (1 year) of basic college Russian (or equivalent
competencies); 1 course in Russian history; 1 course i n Soviet politics; 1 course in
Marxist theory; 1 other course from the approved list of electives.
Each student's major program must be approved by the Coordinator.
Scandinavian Area Studies
Liv Dahl (Director)
Major: 8 upper division courses.
Minor: 4 upper division courses.
Note: Major programs must contain 4 courses Fisted in the Augsburg Catalog or
transferred ro Augsburg as upper division Scandinavian Area Studies courses, I.e.,
courses taughtbva Scandinavian languagedepartment or$ubdepartmentregardless
of r h e ~ content,
r
which may he linguistic, literary or culrural. Students graduating
with a major or minor must a150 present the equivalent of intermediate level
competence in a Scandinavian language. See Norwegian courses under Department
of Foreign Languages
Recommended Supporting Preparation: Study in Scandinavia, elective courses
which may lead toward a second major such as English, history, urban studies,
business administration.
272 Norwegian Life and Culture
Offered under Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs. SeeMetro-UrbanStudies,
Scandinavian Urban Studies Term (SUST).
312 Old Norse
An introduct-ionto the structure of Old U'est None through the study of selections from
Old Norse Ifterature. Some attentron given to Otd East Norseand aspects of the history of
four modern Nordic languages. Knowledge of one of the fatter is desired but not required.
Norwegian language majors and mlnors will have special assignments (Alternate years)
325 Scandinavian Music
(See under Department of Music)
118/Scandinavian Area Studies
330 Contemporary Scandinavia
A broad survey of Scandinavian culture with special emphasis on conditions and
developments in the twentieth century. Knowledge of Scandinavian language desirable
but not required.
345 Scandinavian - American Experience
The O l d World Background and rise of "America Fever," adaptation to the New Land,
aspects of Scandinanvian - American culture. (Alternate years. Spring, 1982)
351 The Modern Scandinavian Novel
Lectures provide a survey of the Scandinavian novel. Class discussion based on assigned
reading of selected novels by JonasLie, Sigrid Undset,Selma Lagerlof, Par Lagerkvist, Knut
Hamsun, Halldor Laxness and others. Knowledge of a Scandinavian language desirable.
Language majors and minors will be required to do assigned readings and written work i n
a Scandinavian language. (Alternate years. Fall, 1982)
352 The Modern Scandinavian Drama
Readings include dramatic works by Ibsen, Bjgrnson, Strindberg, Lagerkvist, Munk and
other twentieth century dramatists. Lectures provide a survey of Scandinavian drama with
emphasis on lbsen and Strindberg. Knowledge of a Scandinavian language desirable.
Language majors and minors will be required t o do assigned readings and written work in
a Scandinavian language. (Alternate years. Fall, 1981)
364 Scandinavian Immigrant Church History
(Offered under Department of Religion)
372 Norwegian Language and Culture
Offered under Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs. See Metro-Urban Studies,
Scandinavian Urban Studies Term (SUST).
373 Growth and Development of Scandinavian Cities
Offered under Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs. See Metro-Urban Studies,
Scandinavian Urban Studies Term (SUST).
382 Scandinavian Arts
(See under Department of Art)
3% Urban Planning in Scandinavia
Offered under Higher Education Consortium for Urban Affairs. See Metro-Urban Studies,
Scandinavian Urban Studies Term (SUST).
450 Nineteenth Century Scandinavia
(Offered under Department of History)
495 Seminar: Ethnic/lmmigration Experience
(Offered periodically under Department of History 495 Seminar)
499 Independent Study
I n consultation with a faculty member, student selects a specific topic for study.
Social Science, Studies/lIg
Social Science
Myles C. Stenshoel (Division Chairperson)
Two emphases exist within the Social Science rnajor: t h e General Major and the
Non-Western emphasis. A student may not list a double major in Social Science and
in one of the component disciplines unless the distribution selected in the Social
Science major is significantly different from the o t h ~ major.
r
General M ajar: 15 courses: 10 required courses (Economics122,123; History 221,222;
Geographv 114: ~ociology127,241; ~ s ~ c h o l o g y l O 5
Political
;
Science158 and I21 or
170); 4 upper division courses in one of the fo[lowing disciplines: Economics,
History, Political Science, Psychology or Sociology; a statislia course approved by
r h e department in which the 4 upper division courses are taken. The student should
choose an adviser who i s a member of the department i n which the upper division
courses are to be taken. (For supplemenrary information and alternative ways ro
f uifill the state-approved competency-based rogram for secondary teacher education, see the following recrion on Social S t u g e i for Secondary Educa~ion.)
Non-Western Major: f 4 courses: History 104; 1social science methodofogy course
[Economicr, 379, Psvcholog), 264, Sociology 362 or 365); and 12 counes, in at least 4
discipIines, from the follawing: Economicj 122, 258: Hislory 103, 322, 323,324,440,
474; Political Science 351,363,382,461; Phiiosoph y 355; Religion 356; Sociology 241;
seminars, independent study or interim courses an relevant topics i n History andlar
PoliticaF Science. The student planning to fulfill this social science major should
consult the chairperson of rhe Department of History in choosing a major adviser.
Social Studies
Myles C. Stenshoel (Coordinator)
Students preparing to reach social studies on the high school level must complete, in
addition t o the professional requirements to be met within the De artment of
Education, a competency-bared program designed to provide a broacffoundation
in the social sciences.
Social Studies Teaching ticensure: 7 courses [Economics 122 or 123, Geography 114,
History 222, Political Sc~ence158, Psychology 105, Sociology 121and247) pIusa major
in one of ftvef~elds- Economics, History, Pol~ticalSc~ence,~ s y c h o l oy or Sociology
O ~
- o r incorporated in a Social Science Major, described in S ~ C T a~ ove).
k
Students considering a career in social studies education should consult, as soon as
possible, the Augsburg Department of Education and the Social Studies Coordinator.
120/Social Work
Social Work
Edwina Hertzberg (Chairperson), Maria Brown, Rosalie Clark, Douglas Perry
The Augsburg College Social Work Program is accredited by the Council on Social
Work Education.
The core program of Social Work begins in the junior year. However, ir is strongly
advised that the foundation courses required in other departments (see Major,
below) be begun in the freshman or sophomore vears. Advisement should also be
soughtfrom social work Faculty as t o the sequence of thesecourses. All studentsare
adv~sedro rake 257 as freshmen or sophomores unless exempted bv the faculry.
Candidacy: Students planning to major i n Social Work must apply to the department for candidacy status before the beginning of the senior year. Candidacy status
i s required for admission into senior social work courses.
Majar: The Augsburg Social Work Program is a professional program in preparation
for social work practice leading to a Bachelor of Science degree. The core program
consists oi 257*, 361*, 363*.364*. 467,462,463,464,465,466 and 4 7 :Biology 101':
Psvchalogy 10Y,351*. and 35?*; Sociology 121*, 231*, 365, 3rS*, and 383*,Ar least
one Conservation of Human Resource; (CHR) course is strongly recommended. A
minimum gradeof 2.0 i s required in each upper division social work courserequired
in the major.
*These courses are to be completed before the beginning of the senior year.
Concentration: Concentrations i n Aging, Chemical Dependency.Crime an'd Corrections, Social Miniztries,and Youth are possi ble. Concentration consists of courses
descriptive of functional, dystunctional, and programmatic aspects, plus field work
placement i n the senior year in the special area. For Social Ministries, a minor in
religion with specific coursework is required. CompIetion of a concentration i s
noted on the transcript.
Social Welfare Minor: 6 courses including 257 or department approved alternative
internship, 361, 463; Psychology 351 or Sociology 375; Sociology 383; and Political
Science 121 or 158 or 325, or Social Work 465.
School Social Work Certification: State Department of Education-required Human
Relations Certification for school social work i s available through successful
completion of Education 388.
257 Practicum in the Human Services
With faculty apgrova1,student selects a placement for 30 hours per week as avolunteer in a
social agency or institution. Opportunity to know social work professionals, social service
delivery systems, and career aspects of the helping vocations. Independent study with a
term paper report and weekly review conferences. Especially recommended for freshmen
and sophomores. Open to all students.
340 Policies, Program and Skills for the Aging
This course will include the study of the impact of social policy on the older population,
older population impact on social policy, services planned to address needs of older
population and skills needed to work with this population. Class conducted in Senior
Citizen Residence. (Prereq.: Course work i n Human Development, Systems of Social
Welfare, experience in work with the aged, #. Offered occasionally.)
Social Work/'l21
361 Systems of Social Welfare
A n examination of fundamental aspects of the various systems of social welfare in rhe U.5.
and the roleof social work i n them. Special emphasison analysisof the major assumptions
and movements conrrlbutory to the rise of the welfare state; description olaselection of
modern service systems, the profession of rocial work, its ethicr, value5, and historical
development, Three class periods per week; guest lecrures, research paper. (Sophomore
or f. Fall)
363 Methods and Skills of Social Work
Basic features of the helping process; theoretical foundations, principlesand techniques of
social work interventive methods, and practical experience necessarv for social work
practice with individuals and small groups; development of the student's repertoire of
relationship building skills. Lecture-discussion sessions and/or laboratory exercises each
week. (Prereq.: 361, Junior. 5pring)
364 Field Work I
Beginning supervised professional experience i n a social work agency focusing on
interviewing experience and relationship building. Ten hours per week, plus one small
group supportive/discussion seminar per week. (Prereq.: 361,Junior, concurrent with 363.
Spring)
399 Internship
Consult the Department Chairperson or lnternship Director for details. (Prereq.: #)
461 Advanced Methods and Skills in Social Work
Enlargement and refinement of practice sk111s through lecture. classroom exercise and
regular class work. Enlargement of social group work skills, emphas~son development of
generalist practice skills and c c l e a ~ capproaches. terrures and/or laboratory exercises
each week. (Prereq.: 2.0 i n 363and In 364,candidacy status,or=. Concurrent with 462. Fall)
463 Community Development and Organization
locality development and social change through community organization, socIal planning,
and social actron. Emphasis on: 71 survey o i histar~calforms o l soctal change, 2)
understanding the b a r ~ r15suesand strategies relevanr to social protesr and change, 3)
examination of the role oi staff, and o i the functions and interrelationships of cornmunip
organizat~ons.and 4) knowledge of and actual practice In the essenrial principles and
~echniquesof organizing. (Prereq.: senior or *. Fall)
462,464, Field Work I1 and IV:
Progressively responsiblesupervised professional social work experience including work
with individuals, families, groupsandlor communities in a 50c1alserviceagency-Ten hours
per week, plusonesupportive/discursian seminar per week. (Prereq.: completion and 2.0
i n 361, 362,364. candidacy status: concurrent with 461 and 467: Fall and Spring)
465 Social Policy: Analysis and Development
Includes the study of theories of Social Policy formularion and methods of analysis
associated with needs and services, and analysis of the impact of policy on social w o r i
practice. Developmenr and implementation will beviewed f~rsthand through work with a
public policy maker, 4 hours per week. O ~ class
P period per week, reading, analytical
pape:integratingclasscon~epr~
wilh practical experience. [Prereq.:361.463.and senlor or
2. Spring)
466 Field Work 111 (1/2 or 1 course)
Continuation of 462 conducted during Interim.
467 The Social Worker as Professional
Ethical practice, bureaucraticsurvival, professional job attainment, personnel policies and
practices, organizational theory, and resource development will be studied i n the course.
The field work practice becomes the laboratory for class exercises. (Prereq.: 461,462,463,
466, concurrent with 464, or #. Spring)
468 Special Topics (1/2 to 1 course)
Current issues in social work theory or practice. To be announced. ( # half or full credit.
Interim)
498 lndependent Study - Metropolitan Resources
An independently designed course a student (or group of students) develops, making
extensive, systematic and integrated utilization of resources available i n the metropolitan
community, e.g. lectures,symposia, performances, hearings. These resources become the
core of the course, supplemented by traditional college resources, and designed i n
consultation with and evaluated by a faculty member of the department.
499 lndependent Study
Student must present written proposal containing rationale, objectives and methodology
of the proposed study according to department guidelines. (Prereq.: 257 and #)
Sociology
Gordon L. Nelson (Chair erson), Robert Clyde, JerryGerasimo,Garry Hesser,Anita
Kolman, Diane Pike, Joe Torstenson
P
Major: 10 courses including 121, 362,363, 375,485. Highly recommended: a CHR
course, internship,independentstudv or upper division interim course i n sociology.
This recommendation i s made in the hope that thestudent will take advantage of the
variety of learning models offered through the department. Consult department
chairperson concerning areas of concentration.
Minor: 5 courses including 121 and two upper division courses (i.e., 300 and above.)
Honolr Major: The studenr must have a minimum GPA of 3.5 i n the major and 3.0
overall. Applicarion for honors i n S Q C ~ Q candidacy
~ O ~ ~
shall consist of submission of
roposal to Department Chairperson before April 1 nf the junior year.
Candi acy IS
- contingen! upon departmental approval of proposal bv April 30 of
junior year. After acceptance as a candidate, the student will register for Independent Studv (Sociology 499) through which work on thesis will be comptcted. Honors
degree i n socialogy will be g r a n r ~ dtea candidate i f heJshe successfully defends the
thesis before March 31 of senior year and maintains GPA through graduation.
B
Certificate in Program Evaluation: 5 course including 362 (or Psychology 264), 363,
Psychology 399, 450. These courses are designed to provide the cognitive background and skill development to perform well as a research assistant for a enciesor
i ~ r r nwhich
i
do
evaluationror an employee who can develop an4 maintain
o